United States
               Environmental Protection
               Agency
               Office of Solid Waste
               and Emergency Response
               Washington DC 20460
SW-874
April 1983
Revised Edition
              Solid Waste
c/EPA
Hazardous Waste
Land Treatment

-------
        ,,,„ ,  ,  .^UNITED STATES ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
        MAY I  I  . ...
  DATE:

      Technical Resource Document
SUBJECT:
  FROM:Arthur Day, Acting Program Manager"JouJL ' • '-x3-ft^**^y j
      Land Disposal Branch (WH-565E)
    ToAddressees Below
           Attached is a copy of Hazardous Waste Land Treatment
      (SW-874).  This is the 8th and final volume of the revised
      Technical Resource Document (TRD) series for your reference
      collection.   The first five volumes were distributed  in  December
      1982, the 6th in April 1983, and the 7th.earlier this month.
      Several new TRDs are currently being developed; they will be
      forwarded to you as they become available.

           Because of the budget limitations, our office is not able
      to provide complementary copies of our publications to all
      requestors.   Complementary copies are being sent to principal
      offices and libraries serving the hazardous waste management
      community for reference purposes.  A list of the current TRDs
      with information for ordering copies is also attached.   If you
      have any questions or comments about the documents in this
      series, please call (382-4680) or write.

      Attachments

      Addressees:

      OSW Senior Staff
      HIWD Branch Chiefs
      Gene Lucero, WH-527
      William Hedeman, WH-548
      Barry Korb,  WH-562A
      Lisa Friedman, A-131
      Mark Greenwood, A-131
      Dov Weitman, A-131
      Thomas Padden, RD-681
      Solid Waste Branch Chiefs, Regions I-K
      State Hazardous Waste Agencies
      EPA Regional and Laboratory Libraries
      EPA Headquarter*s Library
      U.S. Corp of Engineers Library, Vicksburg
      USA Aberdeen Proving Ground Library

-------
     Copies of the Technical Resource Documents are available

for purchase from the Superintendent of Documents, U.S.

Government Printing Office, Washington, D.C., 20402,

(202) 783-3238,  The following is a list of  all eight Technical

Resource Documents with GPO stock number and price for those

currently available.
                                               GPO
                                             Stock No.
                 GPO
                 Price
1.  Evaluating Cover Systems for
    Solid and Hazardous Waste (SW-867).

2.  Hydrologic Simulation on Solid Waste
    Disposal Sites  (SW-868).

3.  Landfill and Surface Impoundments
    Performance Evaluation  (SW-869).

4.  Lining of Waste Impoundment and
    Disposal Facilities (SW-870).

5.  Management of Hazardous Waste
    Leachate (SW-871).

6.  Guide to the Disposal of Chemically
    Stabilized and  Solidified Waste
    (SW-872).

7.  Closure of Hazardous Waste Surface
    Impoundments (SW-873).

8.  Hazardous Waste Land Treatment
    (SW-874).
055-000-00228-2  $ 4.75
055-000-00225-8  $ 6.00
055-000-00233-9  $ 5.00
055-000-00231-2  $11.00
055-000-00224-0  $11.00
055-000-00226-6  $ 6.00
055-000-00227-4  $ 5.50
055-000-00232-1  $11.00

-------
                                            SW-874
                                            April, 1983
      HAZARDOUS WASTE LAND TREATMENT
         Contract Nos. 68-03-2940
                68-03-2943
              Project Officer
               Carlton Wiles
Solid and Hazardous Waste Research Division
Municipal Environmental Research Laboratory
          Cincinnati, Ohio 45268
MUNICIPAL ENVIRONMENTAL RESEARCH LABORATORY
    OFFICE OF RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
   U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
          CINCINNATI, OHIO 45268

-------
                                  DISCLAIMER
     This report has been reviewed by the Municipal  Environmental  Research
Laboratory, U. S. Environmental Protection Agency, and  approved  for publica-
tion.  Mention of trade names or commercial products does  not  constitute
endorsement or recommendation for use.
                                     ii

-------
                                  FOREWORD
     The Environmental Protection Agency was created because of increasing
public and  governmental  concern  about  the  dangers of  pollution to  the
health and welfare  of the  American people.  Noxious air,  foul water,  and
spoiled land are  tragic testimony  to  the deterioration  of   our  natural
environment.  The complexity of  that  environment  and the interplay of  its
components require  a  concentrated and  integrated attack  on  the problem.

     Research and development  is the first necessary step in problem solu-
tion; it involves defining  the  problem,  measuring  its impact, and searching
for solutions.   The Municipal  Environmental  Research Laboratory develops
new and  improved technology  and  systems to  prevent,  treat,  and manage
wastewater and solid and hazardous waste pollutant  discharges from municipal
and community sources; to preserve and treat public drinking water supplies;
and to minimize the adverse economic,  social, health, and aesthetic effects
of pollution.  This publication is one  of  the products of that  research  --
a vital communications link between the researcher  and the  user  community.

     This report provides  state-of-the-art  information  on hazardous waste
land treatment   units.   Information  is  provided  on site selection,  waste
characterization, treatment  demonstration  studies, land  treatment   unit
design, operation,  and  closure,  and  other topics  useful  for design  and
management of land treatment units.
                                         Francis T. Mayo
                                         Director, Municipal  Environmental
                                         Research Laboratory
                                    iii

-------
                                    PREFACE
     Subtitle C of the  Resource  Conservation and Recovery Act (RCRA) requires
the Environmental Protection  Agency  (EPA)  to  establish  a  Federal hazardous
waste management program.  This  program must  ensure  that  hazardous wastes are
handled safely  from  generation until final  disposition.   EPA issued a series
of hazardous waste regulations under Subtitle C  of  RCRA that is published in
40 Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) 260  through  265  and  122  through  124.

     Parts 264  and  265  of 40  CFR contain standards  applicable  to owners and
operators of all facilities that  treat,  store, or dispose  of hazardous wastes*
Wastes are identified or  listed  as  hazardous under 40 CFR Part  261.  The Part
264 standards  are implemented through permits issued by  authorized States or
the EPA in  accordance  with 40 CFR  Part  122 and Part  124 regulations.  Land
treatment, storage,  and disposal  (LTSD) regulations  in  40 CFR Part 264 issued
on July 26,  1982, establish performance standards for hazardous waste landfills,
surface impoundments, land treatment units,  and  waste piles.

     The Environmental Protection Agency is developing three  types of documents
for preparers  and  reviewers  of  permit  applications  for  hazardous waste LTSD
facilities.  These  types include RCRA Technical Guidance  Documents,  Permit
Guidance Manuals, and Technical  Resource  Documents  (TRDs).   The  RCRA Technical
Guidance Documents present design and operating specifications or design  evalua-
tion techniques that  generally comply with or demonstrate compliance with the
Design and Operating Requirements and the  Closure and Post-Closure Requirements
of Part 264.   The Permit  Guidance Manuals are being  developed to describe the
permit application Information the  Agency  seeks  and to  provide  guidance to
applicants and  permit  writers  in   addressing  the  information  requirements.
These manuals will include a discussion  of each  step in  the permitting process,
and a description of each set of specifications that must  be  considered for
inclusion in the permit.

     The Technical  Resource  Documents  present   state-of-the-art  summaries of
technologies and evaluation techniques  determined  by the Agency  to constitute
good engineering designs,  practices, and  procedures.  They  support  the RCRA
Technical Guidance  Documents   and Permit   Guidance   Manuals  in  certain  areas
(i.e., liners,  leachate management, closure, covers,  water balance) by describ-
ing current technologies and  methods for  designing hazardous  waste facilities
or for evaluating the performance of a  facility design.   Although  emphasis is
given to  hazardous  waste facilities, the  information presented  in these TRDs
may be used in designing and  operating  non-hazardous waste  LTSD  facilities as
well.  Whereas the RCRA Technical Guidance  Documents and Permit Guidance  Manuals
are directly related to the  regulations,  the information in these  TRDs covers
a broader perspective and  should not be used to interpret the  requirements of
the regulations.

-------
     A previous version of this document dated September 1980 was announced in
the Federal Register for public comment on December  17, 1980.  The new edition
incorporates changes as  a  result  of  the  public comments,  and  supersedes the
September 1980 version.  Comments on this revised publication will be accepted
at any time.   The Agency intends to  update these TRDs  periodically based on
comments received and/or the development  of  new information.   Comments on any
of the current TRDs should be addressed to Docket Clerk, Room S-269(c), Office
of Solid Waste  (WH-562), U.S.   Environmental Protection Agency,  401  M Street,
S.W., Washington, D.C., 20460.   Communications should identify the document by
title and number (e.g., "lining of Waste  Impoundment and Disposal Facilities,"
SW-870).
                                      vi

-------
                                    ABSTRACT
     This technical resource document provides state-of-the-art information on
all aspects of hazardous waste land treatment (HWLT).  The document is a practi-
cal reference for people involved in design and design review, beginning with
site selection  and  waste  characterization  and  progressing through  facility
design, operation, and closure.   Information on the fate of  both  inorganic and
organic compounds in the soil environment is included and provides a basis for
developing treatment  demonstrations.   Non-hazardous  waste  constituents  are
also discussed  because they  are likely to  be  important  to  the overall design
and management of the HWLT unit.  Waste-site interactions that  affect treatment
processes are discussed as  well as  laboratory,  greenhouse,  and  field testing
protocols for assessing land treatment performance.  Methods  for calculating
loading rates and determining limiting constituents are presented.

     Plot layout, water  control, erosion  control, management  of soil  pH and
fertility, vegetation establishment,  waste storage facilities, waste application
methods and  equipment,  site inspection,   and  recordkeeping  requirements are
discussed.  Monitoring procedures  for  waste,  soil  cores,   soil-pore liquids,
runoff water,  ground water,  and vegetation  are  presented.   The contingency
plans and emergency equipment needed  at HWLT units  are also included.  Finally,
closure requirements and  recommendations  are  presented  with the   objective of
closing the  site  so that  little  environmental hazard will  exist both during
and after the post-closure care  period.

     The information in this document  supplements the  permitting and interim
status standards in 40 CFR Parts 264  and 265 and related Agency  guidance manuals
under the Resource  Conservation and   Recovery  Act  for establishing the design
and management of hazardous waste land treatment  units.
                                      vii

-------
                             TABLE OF  CONTENTS


                                                                        Page

FOREWORD   ...............  ...............   HI

PREFACE ...............................     v

ABSTRACT   ..............................   vil

LIST OF FIGURES  ...........................  vlll

LIST OF TABLES   ...........................

ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
1.0  INTRODUCTION  ..........................     1
   1.1  The Role of Land Treatment  .................     2
   1.2  Controlling Contaminant Migration ..............     5
   1.3  Sources of Technical Information  .. ............     7
   1.4  Overview of Regulations ...................     7
2.0  THE DYNAMIC DESIGN APPROACH  ..................    13
   2.1  Site Assessment   ......................    15
   2.2  The Treatment Medium  ....................    15
   2.3  The Waste Stream  ..... ......... . ...... .    16
   2.4  Expected Fate in Soil ........ .. ....... . « ,    16
   2.5  Waste-Site Interactions ...................    16
   2.6  Design and Operating Plan ..................    17
   2.7  Final Site Selection  ....................    17
   2.8  Monitoring  ....................... ,,    ig
   2.9  Contingency Planning  ......... . ......... .    ig
   2.10 Planning for Site Closure ..................    19
   2.11 Permit Application/Acceptance ................    19
   2.12 HWLT Operation  .......................    19
   2.13 Site Closure  ........................    19

3.0  PRELIMINARY ASSESSMENT OF SITES  ................    21
   3.1  Regional Geology  ... ............ .......    25
   3.2  Topography and Drainage ...................    26
   3.3  Climate ...........................    27
      3.3.1  Winds  .........................    29
      3.3.2  Temperature and Moisture Regimes ............    29
   3.4  Soils ............................    33
      3.4.1  Soil Survey  ......................    33
      3.4.2  Erosion  ......  . ...... ...........    34
      3.4.3  General Soil Properties  ...... ..........    41
      3.4.4  Leaching Potential ....... . ........ ...    43
      3.4.5  Horizonation ...............  .......    44
   3.5  Geotechnical Description  ..................    45
      3.5.1  Subsurface Hydrology  ....  ..............     46
      3.5.2  Groundwater Hydrology  .................    46
      3.5.3  Groundwater Quality  .....  . .....  ..  .....     46
   3.6  Socio-Geographic Factors  ..................    47
                                     ix

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                        Page

4.0  THE TREATMENT MEDIUM	    51
   4.1  Soil Properties	    52
      4.1.1  Physical Properties  ..... 	    52
         4.1.1.1  Particle Size Distribution  	    52
         4.1.1.2  Soil Structure  	    55
         4.1.1.3  Bulk Density	    57
         4.1.1.4  Moisture Retention  	    57
         4.1.1.5  Infiltration, Hydraulic Conductivity and Drainage .    59
         4.1.1.6  Temperature  	    61
      4.1.2  Chemical Properties	    66
         4.1.2.1  Cation Exchange 	    67
         4.1.2.2  Organic Carbon  	    67
         4.1.2.3  Nutrients 	    68
         4.1.2.4  Exchangeable Bases  	    70
         4.1.2.5  Metals  	    71
         4.1.2.6  Electrical Conductivity 	    71
         4.1.2.7  pH	    72
            4.1.2.7.1  Acid Soils	    72
            4.1.2.7.2  Buffering Capacity of Soils  	    73
      4.1.3  Biological Properties  	    73
         4.1.3.1  Primary Decomposers 	    74
            4.1.3.1.1  Bacteria 	    74
            4.1.3.1.2  Actinomycetes  	    74
            4.1.3.1.3  Fungi	    76
            4.1.3.1.4  Algae   	    76
         4.1.3.2  Secondary Decomposers ..... 	    76
            4.1.3.2.1  Worms   	    76
            4.1.3.2.2  Nematodes, Mites and Flies 	    77
         4.1.3.3  Factors Influencing Waste Degradation 	    77
         4.1.3.4  Waste Degradation by Microorganisms 	    81
   4.2  Plants	    84
   4.3  Atmosphere	    86
5.0  HAZARDOUS WASTE STREAMS   	    92
   5.1  Sources of Hazardous Wastes 	    92
      5.1.1  Specific Sources  	    92
      5.1.2  Nonspecific Sources of Hazardous Waste 	    95
      5.1.3  Sources of Information on Waste Streams  	    95
   5.2  Waste Pretreatment  	    95
      5.2.1  Neutralization	   103
      5.2.2  Dewatering	   104
      5.2.3  Aerobic Degradation  .	   104
      5.2.4  Anaerobic Degradation  .	   106
      5.2.5  Soil Mixing	   106
      5.2.6  Size Reduction	   107

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

   5.3  Waste Characterization Protocol 	   107
      5.3.1  Preliminary Waste Evaluation 	   108
      5.3.2  Waste Analysis	•.	108
         5.3.2.1  Sampling and Preparation  	   108
         5.3.2.2  Physical Analysis 	   110
         5.3.2.3  Chemical Analysis 	   112
            5.3.2.3.1  Inorganic Analysis 	   113
               5.3.2.3.1.1  Elements  	   113
               5.3.2.3.1.2  Electrical Conductivity 	   113
               5.3.2.3.1.3  pH and Titratable Acids and  Bases ....   113
               5.3.2.3.1.4  Water 	   113
            5.3.2.3.2  Organic Analysis 	   114
               5.3.2.3.2.1  Total Organic Matter  	   114
                  5.3.2.3.2.1.1  Volatile Organic Compounds 	   114
                  5.3.2.3.2.1.2  Extractable Organic Compounds  ...   118
               5.3.2.3.2.2  Residual Solids 	   125
         5.3.2.4  Biological Analysis 	   125
            5.3.2.4.1  Acute Toxicity 	   127
            5.3.2.4.2  Genetic Toxicity 	   127
      5.3.3  Summary of Waste Characterization Evaluation ......   134
      5.3.4  Final Evaluation Process 	   134
6.0  FATE OF CONSTITUENTS IN THE SOIL ENVIRONMENT	148
   6.1  Inorganic Constituents  	   148
      6.1.1  Water	148
      6.1.2  Plant Nutrients	150
         6.1.2.1  Nitrogen  	   150
            6.1.2.1.1  Mineralization 	   154
            6.1.2.1.2  Fixation 	   157
            6.1.2.1.3  Nitrification  	 . 	   160
            6.1.2.1.4  Plant Uptake 	   160
            6.1.2.1.5  Denitrification  	   163
            6.1.2.1.6  Volatilization 	   166
            6.1.2.1.7  Storage in Soil	166
            6.1.2.1.8  Immobilization 	   167
            6.1.2.1.9  Runoff 	   167
            6.1.2.1.10 Leaching 	   169
         6.1.2.2  Phosphorus  	   170
         6.1.2.3  Boron 	   176
         6.1.2.4  Sulfur  	   177
      6.1.3  Acids and Bases	179
      6.1.4  Salts	180
         6.1.4.1  Salinity  	 .....   180
         6.1.4.2  Sodiclty  	   190
      6.1.5  Halides	194
         6.1.5.1  Fluoride  	   194
         6.1.5.2  Chloride  	   195
                                   xi

-------
                          TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                    Page

      6.1.5.3  Bromide	197
      6.1.5.4  Iodide  	  198
   6.1.6  Metals	198
      6.1.6.1  Aluminum	•	201
      6.1.6.2  Antimony	202
      6.1.6.3  Arsenic	205
      6.1.6.4  Barium  	  209
      6.1.6.5  Beryllium 	 	  209
      6.1.6.6  Cadmium	211
      6.1.6.7  Cesium  	  217
      6.1.6.8  Chromium  	  217
      6.1.6.9  Cobalt  	  220
      6.1.6.10 Copper  	  224
      6.1.6.11 Gallium	228
      6.1.6.12 Gold	228
      6.1.6.13 Lead	229
      6.1.6.14 Lithium 	  232
      6.1.6.15 Manganese 	  234
      6.1.6.16 Mercury 	  238
      6.1.6.17 Molybdenum  	  244
      6.1.6.18 Nickel  	  247
      6.1.6.19 Palladium ...... 	 • 	  251
      6.1.6.20 Radium  	  252
      6.1.6.21 Rubidium  	  252
      6.1.6.22 Selenium  	  253
      6.1.6.23 Silver  	  256
      6.1.6.24 Strontium 	  257
      6.1.6.25 Thallium  	  257
      6.1.6.26 Tin	258
      6.1.6.27 Titanium  	  259
      6.K6.28 Tungsten	259
      6.1.6.29 Uranium 	  260
      6.1.6.30 Vanadium  	  261
      6.1.6.31 Yttrium	262
      6.1.6.32 Zinc	262
      6.1.6.33 Zirconium 	  270
      6.1.6.34 Metal Interpretations 	  270
6.2  Organic Constituents  	  282
   6.2.1  Hazardous Organic Constituents 	 . 	  282
   6.2.2  Fate Mechanisms for Organic Constituents 	  295
      6.2.2.1  Degradation 	  295
      6.2.2.2  Volatilization  	 ...  298
      6.2.2.3  Runoff  	  299
      6.2.2.4  Leaching  	  300
         6.2.2.4.1  Soil Properties That Affect Leaching 	  300
         6.2.2.4.2  Organic Constituent Properties That Affect
                      Leaching	304


                                xii

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

         6.2.2.5  Plant Uptake  	   305
      6.2.3  Organic Constituent Classes  	   310
         6.2.3.1  Aliphatic Hydrocarbons  	   311
         6.2.3.2  Aromatic Hydrocarbons 	   314
         6.2.3.3  Organic Acids 	   315
         6.2.3.4  Halogenated Organics  	   317
            6.2.3.4.1  Chlorinated Benzene Derivatives  	 .   319
            6.2.3.4.2  Halogenated Biphenyls  	   321
         6.2.3.5  Surface-Active Agents 	   324

7.0  WASTE-SITE INTERACTIONS  	   365
   7.1  Review of Available Information	367
   7.2  Laboratory Studies  	   368
      7.2.1  Degradability	368
         7.2.1.1  Soil Respirometry 	   369
            7.2.1.1.1  Sample Collection	371
            7.2.1.1.2  Experimental Procedure 	   371
               7.2.1.1.2.1  Soil Moisture 	   372
               7.2.1.1.2.2  Temperature 	   372
               7.2.1.1.2.3  Nutrient Additions  	   372
               7.2.1.1.2.4  Titrations	373
               7.2.1.1.2.5  Application Rate and Frequency  	   373
         7.2.1.2  Data Analysis	374
            7.2.1.2.1  Degradation Rate	376
            7.2.1.2.2  Half-life Determination  	   377
            7.2.1.2.3  Considerations for Field Studies of
                         Degradation	378
      7.2.2  Sorption and Mobility	378
         7.2.2.1  Soil Thin-Layer Chromatography  	   379
         7.2.2.2  Column Leaching 	 	   380
      7.2.3  Volatilization	381
      7.2.4  Toxicity	382
         7.2.4.1  Acute Toxicity  	   382
            7.2.4.1.1  Microbial Toxicity 	   383
            7.2.4.1.2  Phytotoxlcity  	   383
         7.2.4.2  Genetic Toxicity  	   384
   7.3  Greenhouse Studies  	   384
      7.3.1  Experimental Procedure	384
      7.3.2  Acute Phytotoxicity  	   385
      7.3.3  Residuals Phytotoxicity  	   385
   7.4  Field Pilot Studies 	   386
      7.4.1  Degradation	387
      7.4.2  Leachate	387
      7.4.3  Runoff	387
      7.4.4  Odor and Volatilization	388
      7.4.5  Plant Establishment and Uptake 	   388
                                  xiii

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

   7.5  Interpretation of Results 	  388
      7.5.1  Feasibility and Loading Rates	389
      7.5.2  Management Needs and Monitoring Criteria 	  390
      7.5.3  Calculating Waste Loads Based on Individual
               Constituents 	  390
         7.5.3.1  Organics  	  390
            7.5.3.1.1  Volatilization 	  391
            7.5.3.1.2  Leaching 	  391
            7.5.3.1.3  Runoff 	  391
            7.5.3.1.4  Degradability  	  393
         7.5.3.2  Water 	  396
         7.5.3.3  Metals  	  397
         7.5.3.4  Nitrogen  	  398
         7.5.3.5  Phosphorus  	  400
         7.5.3.6  Inorganic Acids, Bases and Salts  	  400
         7.5.3.7  Halides 	  401
      7.5.4  Design Criteria for Waste Application and
               Required Land Area	402

8.0  FACILITY DESIGN AND OPERATION  	  409
   8.1  Design and Layout	409
      8.1.1  Single Plot Configuration	412
      8.1.2  Progressive Plot Configuration 	  412
      8.1.3  Rotating Plot Configuration  	  419
      8.1.4  Overland Flow	419
      8.1.5  Buffer Zones	422
   8.2  Land Preparation	422
   8.3  Water Control and Management	422
      8.3.1  Water Balance for the Site	423
      8.3.2  Diversion Structures 	  425
      8.3.3  Runoff Retention 	  425
      8.3.4  Runoff Storage Requirement 	  426
         8.3.4.1  Designing for Peak Stormwater Runoff  	  427
         8.3.4.2  Designing for Normal Seasonal Runoff  	  429
            8.3.4.2.1  Monthly Data Approach  	  429
            8.3.4.2.2  Computer Methods 	  449
         8.3.4.3  Effects of Sediment Accumulations 	  449
         8.3.4.4  Summary of Retention Pond Sizing  	  449
      8.3.5  Runoff Treatment Options 	  450
      8.3.6  Subsurface Drainage  	  451
   8.4  Air Emission Control	452
      8.4.1  Volatiles	452
      8.4.2  Odor	452
      8.4.3  Dust	454
   8.5  Erosion Control	455
      8.5.1  Design Considerations for Terraces 	  455
      8.5.2  Design Considerations for Vegetated Waterways  	  459


                                   xiv

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

   8.6  Management of Soil pH	465
      8.6.1  Management of Acid Soils	465
         8.6.1.1  Liming Materials  	  467
         8.6.1.2  Calculating Lime Requirements 	  468
      8.6.2  Management of Alkaline Soils 	  470
   8.7  Vegetation  	 ...........  471
      8.7.1  Management Objectives	471
      8.7.2  Species Selection  	  474
      8.7.3  Seedbed Preparation  	  475
      8.7.4  Seedings and Establishment 	  496
         8.7.4.1  Seeding Methods 	  496
         8.7.4.2  Seeding Rate	496
         8.7.4.3  Seeding Depth 	  497
         8.7.4.4  Plant Establishment 	  497
      8.7.5  Soil Fertility	498
         8.7.5.1  Fertilizer Formulation  	  498
         8.7.5.2  Timing Fertilizer Applications  	  499
         8.7.5.3  Method of Application	499
   8.8  Waste Storage	499
      8.8.1  Waste Application Season 	  502
      8.8.2  Waste Storage Facilities .... 	  503
         8.8.2.1  Liquid Waste Storage  	  503
         8.8.2.2  Sludge Storage  	  505
         8.8.2.3  Solid Waste Storage 	  505
   8.9  Waste Application Techniques  	  505
      8.9.1  Liquid Wastes	506
         8.9.1.1  Surface Irrigation  	  507
         8.9.1.2  Sprinkler Irrigation  	  .  	  507
      8.9.2  Semiliquids	509
         8.9.2.1  Surface Spreading and Mixing	  .  509
         8.9.2.2  Sursurface Injection  	  510
      8.9.3  Low Moisture Solids	511
      8.9.4  Equipment	512
      8.9.5  Uniformity of Waste Application	  513
         8.9.5.1  Soil Sampling as an Indicator	513
         8.9.5.2  Vegetation as an Indicator  	  514
   6.10 Site Inspection	514
   8.11 Records and Reporting	514
9.0  MONITORING	526
   9.1  Treatment Zone Concept	528
   9.2  Analytical Considerations 	  530
   9.3  Statistical Considerations  	  531
   9.4  Types of Monitoring	531
      9.4.1  Waste Monitoring 	  532
      9.4.2  Unsaturated Zone Monitoring	532
                                   xv

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

         9.4.2.1  Locating Unsaturated Zone Samples 	  534
         9.4.2.2  Depth to be Sampled   	536
         9.4.2.3  Soil Core Sampling Technique  	  536
         9.4.2.4  Soil-Pore Liquid Sampling Technique . . 	  538
            9.4.2.4.1  Pressure-Vacuum Lysimeters 	  539
            9.4.2.4.2  Vacuum Extractor 	  541
            9.4.2.4.3  Trench Lysimeters  	  541
         9.4.2.5  Response to Detection of Pollutant Migration  . .  .  542
      9.4.3  Groundwater Monitoring 	  544
      9.4.4  Vegetation Monitoring  	  545
      9.4.5  Runoff Water Monitoring  	  546
      9.4.6  Treatment Zone Monitoring	546
         9.4.6.1  Sampling Procedures 	  547
         9.4.6.2  Scheduling and Number of Soil Samples 	  547
         9.4.6.3  Analysis and Use of Results	548
      9.4.7  Air Monitoring	548

10.0 CONTINGENCY PLANNING AND OTHER CONSIDERATIONS  	  552
   10.1 Routine Health and Safety	552
      10.1.1 Site Security	552
      10.1.2 Personnel Health and Safety  	  554
      10.1.3 Personnel Training 	  555
   10.2 Preparedness and Prevention Measures		555
      10.2.1 Communications	555
      10.2.2 Arrangements with Authorities  	  556
      10.2.3 Equipment  	  557
         10.2.3.1 Required Emergency Equipment  	  557
         10.2.3.2 Additional Equipment  ..... 	 ...  557
         10.2.3.3 Inspection and Maintenance  	  558
   10.3 Contingency Plans and Emergency Response  	  558
      10.3.1 Coordination of Emergency Response 	  559
      10.3.2 Specific Adaptations to Land Treatment 	  561
         10.3.2.1 Soil Overloads  	  561
         10.3.2.2 Groundwater Contamination 	  562
         10.3.2.3 Surface Water Contamination 	  564
         10.3.2.4 Waste Spills  	  564
         10.3.2.5 Fires and Explosions  	  566
   10.4 Changing Wastes	567
11.0 CLOSURE AND POST CLOSURE	569
   11.1 Site Closure Activities	569
      11.1.1 Remedying Metal Overload 	  569
      11.1.2 Preparation of a Final Surface 	  571
      11.1.3 Vegetative Cover Requirement 	  571
      11.1.4 Runoff Control and Monitoring  .............  572
         11.1.4.1 Assessing Water Quality 	  572
         11.1.4.2 Controlling the Transport Mechanisms  	  573
                                   xvi

-------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                       Page

      11.1.5 Monitoring 	  573
   11.2 Post-Closure Care	574
   11.3 Partial Closure	575
APPENDIX A - A Survey of Existing Hazardous Waste Land
               Treatment Facilities in the United States  	  577
APPENDIX B - Hazardous Constituents Regulated by the EPA	625

APPENDIX C - Soil Horizons and Layers	631
APPENDIX D - Industrial Land Treatment Systems Cited in
               the Literature	635
APPENDIX E - Sample Calculations	644
  APPENDIX E-l - Water Balance and Retention Pond Size Calculations  .  645
  APPENDIX E-2 - Loading Rate Calculations for Mobile Nondegradable
                   Constituents 	  649
  APPENDIX E-3 - Calculation of Waste Applications Based on
                   Nitrogen Content 	  650
  APPENDIX E-4 - Examples of Phosphorus Loading Calculations  ....  652
  APPENDIX E-5 - Choice of the Capacity Limiting Constituent  ....  653
  APPENDIX E-6 - Organic Loading Rate Calculations   	  654
  APPENDIX E-7 - Calculation of Facility Size and Life	659
APPENDIX F - Glossary	663

APPENDIX G - Conversion Factors	670
                                  xvii

-------
                               LIST  OF  FIGURES
Figure
No.
2.1
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
4.1

4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
Title
Essential design elements and potential areas
of rejection to be considered when planning an
HWLT system
Factors considered during site selection
Standard wind rose using data presented in
Table 3.3
Areas where waste application may be limited
by excess moisture
Average annual values of the rainfall erosion
index
The soil-erodibility nomograph
Slope-effect chart
Characterization of the treatment medium for
HWLT
Textural triangle of soil particle size
separates
Schematic representation of the relationship
of the various forms of soil moisture to plants
Effect of temperature on hydrocarbon biodegra-
dation in oil sludge-treated soil
Average depth of frost penetration across the
United States
Diagramatic representation of the transforma-
Sectlon
No.
2.0
3.0
3.3.1
3.3.2
3.4.2
3.4.2
3.4.2
4.0

4.1.1.1
4.1.1.4
4.1.1.6
4.1.1.6
4.1.2.3
Page
No.
14
22
31
32
36
37
38
53

56
58
64
65
69
        tions of carbon, commonly spoken of as the
        carbon cycle

4.7     Cycle of organisms which degrade land applied    4.1.3          75
        waste

4.8     The influence of temperature on the biodegra-    4.1.3.3        79
        dation rate of three oil sludges
                                 xviii

-------
                LIST OF  FIGURES  (continued)
Figure
No.
4.9
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.7
6.8
Title
Effect of treatment frequency on the evolution
of CC>2 from Norwood soil amended with petro-
chemical sludge and incubated for 180 days at
30°C and 18% moisture
Characterization of the waste stream to be
land treated
Categories of hazardous constituents
generated by nonspecific sources
Typical acid-base extraction scheme for
isolating organic chemical classes
Mutagenic activity of acid, base, and neutral
fraction of wood-preserving bottom sediment
as measured with S. typhimurium TA 98 with
metabolic activation
Mutagenic activity of liquid stream from the
acetonitrile purification column as measured
with S. typhimurium TA 98 with metabolic
activation
Constituent groups to be considered when
assessing the fate of wastes in the land
treatment system
Chemical composition of thundershower samples
Nitrogen cycle illustrating the fate of
sludge nitrogen
Influence of added inorganic nitrogen on the
total nitrogen in clover plants, the propor-
tion supplied by the fertilizer and that fixed
by the Rhizobium organisms associated with the
clover roots
Typical sigmoid pattern of nitrification in
soil
Effect of soil water content on denitrification
Effect of temperature on denitrification
Clay-fixed NH^"1" in three soils resulting from
Section
No.
4.1.3.3
5.0
5.1
5.3.2.3.-
2.1.2
5.3.2.4.2
5.3.2.4.2
6.0
6.1.2.1
6.1.2.1
6.1.2.1.2
6.1.2.1.3
6.1.2.1.5
6.1.2.1.5
6.1.2.1.1
Page
No.
82
93
97
120
132
133
149
153
155
159
161
164
165
168
five applications of a solution containing
100 mg/1 NH4+-N, without intervening drying
                           xix

-------
                        LIST OF FIGURES (continued)
Figure                                                   Section       Page
 No.    Title	No.	No.

6.9     Phosphate distribution with depth in non-        6.1.2.2       171
        flooded soil and soil flooded with sewage
        water

6.10    General Langmuir isotherms of Merrimac sandy     6.1.2.2       174
        loam and Buxton silt loam after successive
        phosphorus sorptions and following wetting
        and drying treatments for regeneration of
        phosphorus sorption sites

6.11    Correlation of salt concentration in the soil    6.1.4.1       183
        to the EC of saturation extracts for various
        soil types

6.12    Effect of increasing exchangeable sodium         6.1.4.2       192
        percentage on hydraulic conductivity

6.13    Schematic diagram of the yield response to an    6.1.6         200
        essential but toxic element and a nonessential
        toxic element

6.14    Cyclical nature of arsenic metabolism in         6.1.6.3       206
        different environmental compartments

6.15    Distribution of molecular and ionic species      6.1.6.6       212
        of divalent cadmium at different pH values

6.16    Cobalt concentrations in tall fescue grown in    6.1.6.9       222
        Marietta and Norwood soils at 400 mg Co kg"1
        (added as Co(N03)2 • 6 H20) with varying layer
        thicknesses of uncontaminated soil overlying
        the cobalt amended soil

6.17    Distribution of molecular and ionic species      6.1.6.13      230
        of divalent lead at different pH values

6.18    The cycle of mercury interconversions in         6.1.6.16      239
        nature

6.19    Removal of various forms of mercury from         6.1.6.16      241
        DuPage landfill leachate solutions by
        kaolinite, plotted as a function of pH at 25°C
                                   xx

-------
                 LIST OF  FIGURES (continued)
Figure
No.
6.20
6.21
6.22
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
Title
Forms of selenium at various redox potentials
Distribution of molecular and ionic species
of divalent zinc at different pH values
Solubilities of some metal species at various
pH values
Topics to be addressed to evaluate waste-site
interactions for HWLT systems
Schematic diagram of a respirometer
The information needed to determine if a waste
may be land treated
A comprehensive testing format for assessing
the interactions of organic waste constituents
with soil
Topics to be considered for designing and
managing an HWLT
Hazardous waste compatibility chart
Possible layout of a land treatment unit in
a gently sloping uniform terrain when only one
plot is used
Possible layout of a land treatment unit in
a gently sloping uniform terrain when a
progressive plot configuration is used
Possible layout of a land treatment unit in
rolling terrain showing 12 plots and associated
runoff retention basins
Possible layout of a land treatment unit in
level terrain
25-year 24-hour rainfall for the United States
Estimating direct runoff amounts from storm
Section
No.
6.1.6.22
6.1.6.32
6.1.6.34
7.0
7.2.1.1
7.2.1.2
7.5.3.1
8.0
8.1
8.1.1
8.1.2
8.1.2
8.1.3
8.3.4.1
8.3.4.1
Page
No.
254
264
271
366
370
375
392
410
415
417
418
420
421
428
434
rainfall
                           xx i

-------
                         LIST OF FIGURES  (continued)
 Figure                                                    Section       Page
  No.     Title                                              No.	No.

 8.9     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     437
         tinental United  States  for the month of
         January  based  on data  taken  from 1931  to 1960

 8.10     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     438
         tinental United  States  for the month of
         February based on data  taken From 1931 to  1960

 8.11     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     439
         tinental United  States  for the month of  March
         based On data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.12     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     440
         tinental United  States  for the month of  April
         based on data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.13     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     441
         tinental United  States  for the month of  May
         based on data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.14     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     442
         nental United  States for  the month of June
         based on data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.15     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     443
         tinental United  States  for the month of  July
         based on data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.16     Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     444
         tinental United  States  for the month of  August
         based on data  taken  from 1931 to 1960

 8.17    Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     445
         tinental  United  States  for the month of
         September based  on data taken from 1931
        to 1960

8.18    Average  pan  evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  con-      8.3.4.2.1     446
         tinental United  States  for the month of  October
        based on data  taken  from  1931 to  1960

8.19    Average  pan evaporation (in  cm)  for  the  conti-    8.3.4.2.1     447
        nental United States for the month of November
        based on data taken from 1931 to  1960
                                   xxii

-------
                        LIST OF FIGURES (continued)
Figure
No.
8.20

8.21
8.22
8.23
8.24
8.25
8.26
8.27
8.28
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
Title
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the conti-
nental United States for the month of December
based on data taken from 1931 to 1960
Schematic diagram of general types of terraces
Values of a and b in terrace spacing equation
Cross-sectional diagram of a parabolic channel
Nomograph for parabolic cross sections with a
velocity of 3 fps
The lime requirement curve for a Mawmeu
sandy loam
Major land resource regions of the United
States
Seeding regions in the U.S.
Estimated maximum annual waste storage days
based on climatic factors
Topics to be considered in developing a
monitoring program for HWLT
Various types of monitoring for land treatment
units
A modified pressure-vacuum lysimeter
Schematic diagram of a sand filled funnel
Section
No.
8.3.4.2.1

8.5.1
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.5.2
8.6.1.2
8.7
8.7
8.8.1
9.0
9.0
9.4.2.4.2
9.4.2.5
Page
No.
448

457
458
463
464
469
494
495
504
527
529
540
543
        used to collect leachate from the unsaturated
        zone

10.1    Contingency planning and additional considera-    10.0           553
        tlons for HWLT units

H«l    Factors to consider when closing HWLT units       11.0           570
                                  xxiii

-------
                       LIST OF  TABLES
Table
No.
1.1
1.2
1.3

3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
4.1

4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
Title
Land Treatment Usage by Major Industry Group
Land Treatability of the Six Main Groups of
Hazardous Materials Migrating from Disposal
Sites
Sources of Information on Land Treatment of
Waste
Use of Preliminary Site Assessment Information
The Influence of Atmospheric Variables on
Land Treatment Operations and Processes
Two-way Frequency Distribution of Wind Speed
and Direction
Typical Values for the C Factor
P Values and Slope-Length Limits for
Contouring
P Values, Maximum Strip Widths, and Slope-
Length Limits for Contour Strip Cropping
P Values for Contour-Farmed, Terraced Fields
Suitability of Various Textured Soils for Land
Treatment of Hazardous Industrial Wastes
Treatment Processes of Soil in a Land Treat-
ment Unit
Corresponding USDA and USCA Soil Classifi-
cations
Saturated Hydraulic Conductivity Classes for
Native Soils
Seven Classes of Natural Soil Drainage
The Effect of Soil Texture on the Biodegrada-
Section
No.
1.1
1.1
1.3

3.0
3.3
3.3.1
3.4.2
3.4.2
3.4.2
3.4.2
3.4.3
4.0

4.1.1.1
4.1.1.5
4.1.1.5
4.1.3.3
Page
No.
4
5
8

23
28
30
39
40
40
41
42
51

54
60
62
80
tion of Refinery and Petrochemical Sludge
                          xx iv

-------
                        LIST OF TABLES  (continued)
Table
No.
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
5.9
5.10
5.11
5.12
6.1
6.2
Title
Projected 1985 Waste Generation by Industry
Potentially Hazardous Waste Streams Generated
by Nonspecific Industrial Sources
Pretreatment Methods for Hazardous Wastes
Samplers Recommended for Various Types of
Waste
Minimum Number of Samples to be Selected from
Multiple Containers
Sampling Points Recommended for Most Waste
Containments
Purgable Organic Compounds
Scale of Acidities
Typical Hazardous Organic Constituents
Amenable to Acid-Base Extraction Techniques
Reactions of Various Compounds to Alkaline
Hydrolysis
Biological Systems Which May be Used to Detect
Genetic Toxicity of a Hazardous Waste
Hazardous Waste Evaluation
Chemical Composition of Sewage Sludges
Chemical Analyses of Manure Samples Taken from
Section
No.
5.1.1
5.1.2
5.2
5.3.2.1
5.3.2.1
5.3.2.1
5.3.2.3.-
2.1.1
5.3.2.3.-
2.1.2
5.3.2.3.-
2.1.2
5.3.2.3.-
2.1.2
5.3.2.4.2
5.3.3
6.1.2.1
6.1.2.1
Page
No.
94
96
100
109
110
111
115
119
121
126
128
135
151
151
        23 Feedlots in Texas

6.3     Amounts of Nitrogen Contributed by Precipita-    6.1.2.1       152
        tion

6.4     Ratio of Yearly Nitrogen Input to Annual         6.1.2.1.1     156
        Nitrogen Mineralization Rate of Organic Wastes

6.5     Release of Plant-Available Nitrogen During       6.1.2.1.1     157
        Sludge Decomposition in Soil

                                   xxv

-------
                         LIST  OF  TABLES  (continued)
Table
No.
6.6
6.7
6.8
6.9
6.10
6.11
6.12
6.13
6.14
6.15
6.16
6.17
6.18
6.19
6.20
Title
Nitrogen Fixed by Various Legumes
Nitrogen Gains Attributed to Nonsymblotic
Fixation in Field Experiments
Removal of Nitrogen from Soils by Crops and
Residues
Nitrogen Returned to the Soil from Unharvested
or Ungrazed Parts of Stubble Above the Ground
Percentage of Added Nitrogen Lost During
Incubation of Waterlogged Soil with Nitrate
and Different Amounts of Organic Materials at
25 °C
Transport of Total Nitrogen in Runoff Water
From Plots Receiving Animal Waste
Summary of Phosphorus Adsorption Values
Removal of Phosphorus by the Usual Harvested
Portion of Selected Crops
Crop Tolerance Limits for Boron in Saturation
Extracts of Soil
Water Classes in Relation to Their Salt
Concentration
General Crop Response as a Function of Elec-
trical Conductivity
The Relative Productivity of Plants with
Increasing Salt Concentration in the Root Zone
Sodium Tolerance of Various Crops
Typical Total Halide Levels in Dry Soil
Phytotoxicity of Halides from Accumulation in
Section
No.
6.1.2.1.2
6.1.2.1.2
6.1.2.1.4
6.1.2.1.4
6.1.2.1.5
6.1.2.1.9
6.1.2.2
6.1.2.2
6.1.2.3
6.1.4
6.1.4.1
6.1.4.1
6.1.4.2
6.1.5.1
6.1.5.1
Page
No.
158
158
162
163
166
169
173
175
178
181
184
185
193
194
196
        Plant Tissue and Applications to Soil




6.21    EPA Drinking Water Standard for Fluoride         6.1.5.1        197
                                  xxv i

-------
               LIST OF  TABLES  (continued)
Table
No.
6.22
6.23
6.24
6.25
6.26
6.27
6.28
6.29
6.30
6.31
6.32
6.33
6.34
6.35
6.36
Title
Plant Response to Aluminum In Soil and
Solution Culture
Plant Response to Arsenic in Soil and
Solution Culture
Yields of Grass and Kale with Levels of
Beryllium in Quartz and Soil
Yield of Beans Grown on Vina Soil Treated with
Beryllium Salts Differing In Solubility
Cadmium Addition to a Calcareous Soil
Associated with a 50% Yield Reduction
of Field and Vegetable Crops
Plant Response to Cadmium In Soil and Solution
Culture
Cadmium Content of Bermudagrass on Three Soils
with Different Applications of Sewage Sludge
Plant Response to Chromium in Soil and
Solution Culture
Plant Response to Cobalt in Soil and Solution
Culture
Plant Response to Copper in Soil and Solution
Culture
Copper Concentration in Plant Tissue in Rela-
tion to Copper Addition in an Acid Soil
Copper Concentration in Plant Tissue in Rela-
tion to Copper Addition in a Calcareous Soil
Plant Response to Lead in Soil and Solution
Culture
The Influence of Leaf Lithium Concentration on
Plants
The Influence of Solution Culture and Soil
Section
No.
6.1.6.1
6.1.6.3
6.1.6.5
6.1.6.5
6.1.6.6
6.1.6.6
6.1.6.6
6.1.6.8
6.1.6.9
6.1.6.10
6.1.6.10
6.1.6.10
6.1.6.13
6.1.6.14
6.1.6.14
Page
No.
203
208
210
210
214
215
216
219
223
226
227
227
231
233
234
Concentration of Lithium on Plant Growth and
Yield

                          xxvii

-------
                         LIST OF TABLES  (continued)
Table
No.
6.37
6.38
6.39
6.40
6.41


6.42

6.43


6.44
6.45
6.46
6.47
6.48
6.49
6.50
6.51
6.52
Title
The Influence of Leaf Manganese Concentration
on Plants
Plant Response to Manganese in Soil and
Solution Culture
The Influence of Mercury on Plant Growth and
Yield
Plant Concentration of Molybdenum from Growing
in Molybdenum Amended Soil
Nickel Concentration in Plant Tissue in Rela-
tion to Nickel Addition in a Calcareous
Soil
Nickel Concentration in Plant Tissue in Rela-
tion to Nickel Addition in an Acid Soil
The Influence of Solution Culture and Soil
Concentration of Nickel on Plant Growth and
Yield
Selenium Accumulator Plants
Plant Response to Zinc in Soil
Trace Element Content of Soils
Summary of Suggested Maximum Metal
Accumulations
Water Quality Criteria for Humans and Animals
Normal Ranges and Toxic Concentration of Trace
Elements in Plants
The Upper Level of Chronic Dietary Exposures
to Elements Without Loss of Production
Hyperaccumulator Plants
Suggested Metal Loadings for Metals with Less
Section
No.
6.1.6.15
6.1.6.15
6.1.6.16
6.1.6.17
6.1.6.18


6.1.6.18

6.1.6.18


6.1.6.22
6.1.6.32
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
6.1.6.34
Page
No.
236
237
243
246
249


250

250


255
266
273
274
276
277
278
279
281
        Well-Defined Information




6.53    Properties of Hazardous Constituents             6.2.1         283





                                 xxviii

-------
                LIST OF TABLES (continued)
Table
No.
6.54
6.55
6.56
6.57
6.58
6.59
6.60
6.61
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
8.1
8.2
8.3
Title
Percent Degradation After 10, 20 and 30 Years
for Organic Constituents with Various Half-
Lives in Soil
Two Classes of Synthetic Organic Constituents
Widely Found in Groundwater
Depth of Hydrocarbon Penetration at Five
Refinery Land Treatment Units
Organic Constituents Absorbed by Plant Roots
Critical Soil Dose Level for Four Aliphatic
Solvents
Decomposition of Three Carboxylic Acids and
Glucose in Sandy Soil
Degradation of Chlorinated Benzenes, Phenols,
Benzoic Acids and Cyclohexanes and Their
Parent Compounds
Aerobic and Anaerobic Degradation of Phenol
and its Chlorinated Derivatives in Soil
Considerations in a Comprehensive Testing
Program for Evaluating Waste-Site Interactions
Soil Half-life of Several Oily Wastes as
Determined by Various Methods
Nitrogen Mass Balance
Waste Constituents to be Compared in Determin-
ing the Application, Rate, and Capacity Limit-
ing Constituents
Potentially Incompatible Wastes
Seasonal Rainfall Limits for Antecedent
Moisture Conditions
Runoff Curve Numbers for Hydrologic Soil-Cover
Section
No.
6.2.2.1
6.2.2.4.1
6.2.2.4.1
6.2.2.5
6.2.3.1
6.2.3.3
6.2.3.4.1
6.2.3.4.1
7.0
7.5.3.1.4
7.5.3.4
7.5.4
8.1
8.3.4.1
8.3.4.1
Page
No.
296
301
303
306
313
316
321
322
367
394
399
402
413
429
430
Complexes
                          xxix

-------
                        LIST OF TABLES (continued)
Table
No.
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
8.9
8.10
8.11
8.12
8.13
8.14
Title
Curve Numbers (CN) and Constants for the Case
Ia - 0.25
Maximum Terracing Grades
Terrace Dimensions: Level or Ridge Terrace
Terrace Dimensions: Graded or Channel Terrace
Permissible Velocities for Channels Lined with
Vegetation
Composition of a Representative Commercial
Oxide and Hydroxide of Lime Expressed in
Different Ways
Alternative Management Techniques to Replace
the Role of Plants in a Land Treatment System
Regional Adaptation of Selected Plant
Materials
Average Composition of Fertilizer Materials
Waste Consistency Classification
Checklist of Items Needed for a Thorough
Section
No.
8.3.4.1
8.5.1
8.5.1
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.6.1.2
8.7.1
8.7.2
8.7.6.1
8.8
8.11
Page
No.
432
459
460
460
462
468
473
476
500
506
516
        Record of Operations at a Land Treatment Unit

9.1     Guidance for an Operational Monitoring Program   9.4.1         533
        at HWLT Units

10.1    Costs of Constructing a Portland Cement Bottom   10.3.2.2      563
        Seal Under an Entire 10 Acre (4.1 Hectare)
        Land Treatment Facility
                                   XXX

-------
                              ACKNOWLEDGEMENT
     This document  was  prepared by K. W.  Brown and Associates,  Inc.   The
authors wish  to express  appreciation to  Carlton C. Wiles  whose valuable
assistance  as  Project  Officer  helped  guide  this  work  to  a  successful
completion.   Michael  P. Flynn of  the  Office of  Solid  Waste also provided
valuable assistance as  the  document was  being revised,  and a number of his
ideas  and  concepts have  been  Included.   Many  others in  the  scientific
community,  government  and  industry  commented  on  the   draft  and  their
suggestions have helped  generate  this  document  describing  the emerging
technology of land  treatment.

     The following  people  were  responsible  for  writing  and  editing  this
document.

                               Kirk W. Brown
                            Gordon  B. Evans, Jr.
                             Beth  D. Frentrup
                             David C. Anderson
                               Christy Smith
                             Kirby C. Donnelly
                              James C. Thomas
                             D. Craig Kissock
                              Jeanette Adams
                             Stephen G.  Jones
                                  xxxi

-------
1.0                             CHAPTER ONE

                               INTRODUCTION
     The problem of eliminating vast and increasing quantities of hazardous
waste  is  an  important  issue facing  any growing,  industrialized society.
Waste  products,  the  inevitable  consequence of  the  consumptive process,
require  proper  handling  to  minimize  public  health  and  environmental
hazards.   Historically,  instances of poor  disposal  technology  have caused
extensive environmental  damage  and human suffering.   In the United States,
problems related to waste  disposal surfaced whose real and potential rami-
fications led  to the  passage of the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act
in 1976 to regulate the  management of  hazardous waste.  The limitations of
many of the disposal  technologies  used in the past are becoming apparent to
representatives of industry;  federal,  state and local governments; and the
general public.  Along  with these realizations has  come a reassessment of
the waste factor when evaluating  the technical and economic feasibility of
any industrial process.

     Development  of  best  available  technologies  for  handling  hazardous
waste is essential.   Ideally, a method of treatment and disposal  results in
the degradation of any decomposable hazardous materials and the transforma-
tion  and/or  immobilization  of  the  remaining  constituents  so  that  there
would be no  risk to  human health  or the environment.   Although all tech-
niques will fall short  of  this  ideal,  some  methods  will prove more effec-
tive than others.

     Land treatment  is  one  alternative  for handling  hazardous  waste that
simultaneously  constitutes  treatment  and  final  disposal  of   the  waste.
Hazardous waste  land treatment (HWLT)  is   the  controlled  application  of
hazardous waste onto  or into the surface horizon of the soil accompanied by
continued monitoring  and management, to degrade transform or immobilize the
hazardous constituents  in  the waste.   Properly designed  and  managed HWLT
facilities should be  able to accomplish disposal without contaminating run-
off water, leachate water,  or the atmosphere.  Additionally,  in some sys-
tems the land  used  for  disposal may be  free of undesirable concentrations
of residual materials that would  limit the  use of the  land  for other pur-
poses in the future.

     Land  treatment   is  already widely  practiced by some  industries  for
handling hazardous  industrial waste.   Although many  facilities  have suc-
cessfully used land treatment for  their waste, the lack of systematic stud-
ies or monitoring  of  most facilities  has  limited the  amount  of knowledge
available on important parameters  and waste-site interactions.  Additional-
ly, many potentially  land treatable wastes have  not been tested  or have
been examined under only a limited range of  conditions.  To evaluate a pro-
posed HWLT unit,  information is needed  on  site and waste characteristics,
soil   and   climatic   conditions,   application   rates  and   scheduling,

-------
 decomposition products, and contingency  plans  to avert environmental  con-
 tamination.    In  addition, the  facility  design  should minimize  potential
 problems  such  as the  accumulation  of  toxic  inorganic  and  recalcitrant
 organic waste constituents in the soil, as well  as  surface  and  groundwater
 pollution  and unacceptable atmospheric emissions.  Given  these many  con-
 cerns ,  the   preparation   and   review  of  permit  applications   should  be
 approached with interdisciplinary expertise  having  a  ready source of  cur-
 rent  information  on  land  treatment  performance  and practice.

     The guidance presented in this  document  is to be  used  in assessing the
 technical aspects of hazardous waste land treatment.  Generally, the  values
 given in subsequent  chapters  for the parameters important  to land treatment
 (e.g.,  application  rates)  are  intended  to provide a guide  to  reasonable
 ranges  for  these  parameters  as gathered from  the best available  sources.
 Because  the  actual   range  for  a given  parameter  will  be  largely site-
 specific, design and operating  parameters may frequently  fall  outside  of
 the  ranges  presented  in  this  document.    Instances where parameters  fall
 outside of these  ranges signal  that  further  information is needed or  that
 the waste or  site may not  be suitable for land  treatment.

     The objectives  of this  Technical Resource  Document  are  to  describe
 current land  treatment knowledge and  technology  and to provide  methods  to
 evaluate  the  potential performance  of a  proposed or  existing HWLT  unit
 based on information supplied  about design parameters, operation and main-
 tenance, monitoring, and  closure plans.   Unlike  other  documents  in  the
 Technical  Resource  Document   series,   which  present  information  only  on
 limited aspects of unit design or operation, this  document  presents  Infor-
 mation on all aspects of  land treatment  unit design and management.   This
 document takes  a  comprehensive decision-making approach to  land treatment,
 from  initial  site selection  through  closure  and post-closure  activities.
 Additional  information sources  are  referenced liberally  to help  provide
 state-of-the-art  answers  to  the multitude of  design  considerations.    As
 noted in the  preface,  the EPA Technical  Resource Documents  provide  state-
 of-the-art information  on  hazardous  waste  technologies and  are not  Intended
 to be used to  specifically interpret  the  hazardous waste regulations.  This
 document follows  the approach  of these other documents; however, the guid-
 ance presented  in this  document is  consistent with  the current  EPA regula-
 tions which are briefly summarized in  Section 1.4 of this  chapter.
1.1                     THE ROLE OF LAND TREATMENT
     An understanding  of the potential  usefulness  and associated  environ-
mental risks of  the  various  disposal options helps to place land  treatment
In perspective-as a  sound means of waste  treatment  and disposal.   Hazardous
waste disposal  options are narrowing due  to increasing environmental  con-
straints, soaring energy costs, widespread capital shortages, and  a  desire
to decrease potentially  high long-term liabilities.  In a properly managed

-------
HWLT unit, treatment processes may decrease the hazard of the applied waste
so that the potential for groundwater contamination is lowered.

     Compared to other disposal options, properly designed and managed land
treatment units carry low combined short and long-term liabilities.  In the
short-term, the land treated wastes are present at or near the land surface
so that monitoring  can rapidly detect any  developing  problems and manage-
ment adjustments  can  be made in a  preventive  fashion.   Also  by  virtue of
using surface  soils for waste  treatment,  management activities  can exert
direct and immediate control on the treatment/disposal process.  Since most
organic wastes undergo  relatively rapid  and near complete degradation, and
hazardous metals  are  practically immobilized  in an aerobic  soil environ-
ment, long-term monitoring,  maintenance and potential  cleanup liabilities
are potentially lower  than with other  waste disposal options  if  the HWLT
unit is properly  managed.   Many wastes  are well suited  to  land treatment
and  because  of  the  potentially  lower  liabilities  associated with this
method  of waste  disposal and  the  relatively  low  initial  and  operating
costs, this option is becoming increasingly attractive to industry.

     In a recent  nationwide  survey of  HWLT,  197 facilities  disposing of
more than 2.45  x  ICr  kg of waste  per year were  identified.   Over half of
these were associated  with petroleum refining and  production (K. W. Brown
and Associates, Inc., 1981; see Appendix A).   In a study of the waste dis-
posal practices of petroleum refiners, 1973 records were compared with pro-
jections  for  1983 and  a  general  trend toward  the  increasing  use  of land
treatment was evident  (Rosenberg  et al., 1976),   Approximately 15% of the
HWLT units were associated with chemical production.  Industries providing
electric, gas  and sanitary services  and producing  fabricated metal  items
were the  next  largest users of HWLT,  each having approximately  7% of the
total number of units (K. W. Brown  and Associates,  Inc., 1981).  Table 1.1
shows the numbers of land  treatment units  classed  according to industry,
using the standard  industrial classification  (SIC)  codes  for major  indus-
trial groups.  Geographically, land treatment  units are  concentrated  in the
Southeastern United States from Texas to the Carolines with a few scattered
in the Great Plains and Far  West  regions (Appendix A).   Most are found in
areas having intensive petrochemical refining  and processing  activities and
moderate  climates.

     Ten  to fifteen percent of all  industrial  wastes (roughly 30-40 billion
kg annually) are considered to be hazardous  (EPA, 1980b).  Many wastes  cur-
rently being disposed by other methods  without  treatment could be  treated
and rendered less hazardous by  land treatment, often at  lower cost.   Of the
six main  groups of hazardous  materials which have been  found to migrate
from sites to cause environmental  damage (Table  1.2), three are prime  can-
didates for land treatment.  These  three are (1)  solvents  (halogenated  sol-
vents may benefit  from some  form  of pretreatment  to  enhance their  blode-
gradability), (2) pesticides, and (3) oils  (EPA,  1980b).  Land treatment is
not, however, limited to  these  classes of  wastes and may be  broadly  appli-
cable to  a large  variety of wastes.   The  design principles and management
practices  for   land treatment  of  waste  discussed in  this  document are

-------
TABLE 1.1  LAND TREATMENT USAGE BY MAJOR  INDUSTRY GROUP*
SIC Code*
29
28
49
Description
Petroleum refining and related industries
Chemicals and allied products
Electric, gas, and sanitary services
Number of
Units
105
30
16
   34           Fabricated metal products, except machinery
                  and transportation equipment                        12
   97           National security and international affairs            9
   24           Lumber and wood products, except furniture             7
36

20
22
39
35
26
13
44
76
02
30
33
37
51
82
Electrical and electronic machinery,
equipment , and supplies
Food and kindred products
Textile mill products
Miscellaneous manufacturing industries
Machinery, except electrical
Paper and allied products
Oil and gas extraction
Water transportation
Miscellaneous repair services
Agricultural production - livestock
Rubber and miscellaneous plastics products
Primary metal industries
Transportation equipment
Wholesale trade - nondurable goods
Educational services

5
4
4
3
3
3
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
* K. W.  Brown and Associates, Inc. (1981).

* A listing of HWLT units by more specific SIC codes appears in
  Appendix A.

-------
directed  to  the  treatment  and  disposal of hazardous industrial waste.  The
same  principles  and  practices apply  to  the land  treatment of  any waste
material,  whether or  not  it  is presently  described as  being hazardous;
however,  some of  the controls  and  precautions  necessary  when  disposing
hazardous waste may be unnecessary when disposing nonhazardous waste.
TABLE  1.2  LAND TREATABILITY OF THE SIX MAIN GROUPS OF HAZARDOUS MATERIALS
           MIGRATING FROM DISPOSAL SITES**


Hazardous Material Group                                  Land Treatability
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Solvents and related organics such as
trichloroethylene, chloroform and toluene
PCBs and PBBs
Pesticides
Inorganic chemicals such as ammonia, cyanide,
acids and bases
Heavy metals
Waste oils and greases
High
Limited
High
Limited
Limited
High
* EPA (1980b).

* High land treatabllity does not infer immunity from environmental
  damage.  Only through proper design and management of a land treatment
  unit can the desired level of treatment be obtained and the migration of
  hazardous materials be prevented.
1.2                  CONTROLLING CONTAMINANT MIGRATION
     In a well  designed and operated HWLT  unit,  most hazardous waste con-
stituents  become less  hazardous  as they  degrade  or are  transformed  or
immobilized within the  soil matrix.  In addition, the  long-term maintenance
and  monitoring  liabilities  and  the concomitant risk  of  costly cleanup
efforts are  minimized.   However, it  is  important  to remember  that land
treatment activities  use  unlined surface  soils which are subject  to  direct
contaminant  losses  via air,  water  or  food chain;  consequently, facility
management has  a tremendous  Impact on both the treatment effectiveness and
the  potential  for contamination.  If improperly  designed or managed, land
treatment units  could cause  various  types of human health or environmental
damage.  The potential  for such problems has  not been closely studied for
land  treatment  of  hazardous  wastes,  but, it  is  evident  from research

-------
 conducted on the  land  treatment of nonhazardous  waste that damages  some-
 times  occur.   For land treatment  to  be an  effective  system,  the  process
 must  be managed  to  operate within  given ranges  for  various design  para-
 meters.   Frequent or consistent  violation of these parameters could  cause
 the  inadvertant release of pollutants to  the  environment.   The  following
 brief  discussion of the various  means of contaminant migration  emphasizes
 the importance  of  careful  design and management.

     Probably the most obvious  pathway for  contaminant  migration at  HWLT
 units  is  runoff since waste materials  are often exposed on the  soil  surface
 or mixed  into a nonvegetated soil surface.   If control  structures for run-
 off are improperly constructed or  maintained,  high concentrations of  sus-
 pended and  soluble waste constituents  could be  released to the  environment.
 Therefore,  control  structures that  are  adequate  to  prevent  release  of
 untreated runoff water  are obviously  essential  parts  of a good  design and
 the management  plan should  ensure  that these structures are inspected and
 repaired, when  necessary.

     Since  HWLT units are  not  lined, attention must be given to  the  poten-
 tial for  leaching of hazardous  constituents to groundwater.   Interactions
 between the waste  and soil at  the site may either  increase  or  decrease the
 leaching  hazard.  Management  practices,  which can affect the biological,
 physical  and chemical  state of  waste  constituents in the  treatment  zone,
 can be designed to minimize leaching if the mobility of the  waste constitu-
 ents and  their   degradation products is carefully  evaluated before  opera-
 tions  begin.  During the  operating  life  of the facility, unsaturated zone
 monitoring  provides  information  that can  be used  to adjust management prac-
 tices  to control leaching.

     Release  to the atmosphere  is  the  third pathway  that  should be  con-
 trolled.    Emissions  of volatile organic  constituents can  be reduced  by
 carefully choosing the  method and  time of  waste  application.    Wind-blown
 particulates  can be  controlled by management practices such  as maintaining
 a  vegetative cover  and/or  optimal  water  content in  the treatment  zone.
 Odors, another  cause for  concern, can also generally be  controlled  through
 management  practices.

     Migration  of  contaminants to  the food  chain must  be  prevented.   If
 food chain  crops  are grown during the  active  life of  the  HWLT  unit,  the
 crop must  be free of  contamination  before  it  is harvested and used  for
 either animal or human  food.   In  addition,  waste constituents should  not be
 allowed to  accumulate in  surface soils to levels  that  would cause a  food
 chain  hazard  if food chain crops  are likely to  be  grown.

     Sites  for   HWLT  units  should  be  selected considering  the   potential
 pathways for  contamination.  Testing  methods that can  be used  to  predict
waste-site  interactions and  the potential for  contamination  by  each  of
 these  pathways   are  presented  in   this  document.    Facility  design  and

-------
management to minimize  operational problems during the active  life  and at
closure are also discussed.
1.3                  SOURCES OF TECHNICAL INFORMATION
     This document  is  not intended to  encompass  a thorough  review of all
the literature pertinent to the topic of land treatment of waste.  Instead,
information is provided which  is  specifically pertinent to the land treat-
ment of hazardous waste.  For many considerations, specific Information and
examples are  sparingly few in the literature;  therefore,  it  was necessary
to draw on professional experience, the available published information on
land treatment of  municipal effluents and sludges, and associated litera-
ture concerning the fate of chemicals applied to soils.  There are a number
of sources from which  the reader may obtain  additional information on the
principles and procedures  of  land treatment  of waste.   Some  of the avail-
able books dealing  with various  aspects of this topic  are listed in Table
1.3.
1.4                       OVERVIEW OF REGULATIONS
     Standards for  all  hazardous waste land  disposal facilities regulated
under the Resource  Conservation and Recovery Act were  issued  on July 26,
1982.   These  regulations were issued  by  the  U.S. Environmental  Protection
Agency  (EPA)  after  a wide  range of  regulatory options  were considered.
Briefly, the regulations for land disposal facilities contain a groundwater
protection standard  and  certain  design and operating requirements for  each
type of land disposal  unit (e.g.,  landfill, land  treatment,  waste pile,
etc.).

     Part 264,  Subpart  M of  the July  1982  regulations specifically deals
with HWLT  units  (EPA,   1982)  and applies  to both  new and  existing  land
treatment  units.    Of  key  importance  to HWLT   is  the  treatment   program
established by  the  owner or  operator  to  degrade,  transform or  Immobilize
the hazardous constituents  (Appendix B)  in  the  waste  placed  in the unit.
The  regulations  define the  three  principal  elements  of  the  treatment
program  as  the  wastes  to  be disposed,  the  design  and operating measures
necessary  to  maximize  degradation,  transformation  and  immobilization  of
hazardous waste constituents,  and the unsaturated zone monitoring program.
HWLT units are also  required to  have a groundwater monitoring program.

     A  treatment  demonstration is required to  establish that the combina-
tion of  operating practices at  the unit  (given  the  natural constraints  at
the  site,  such as  soil and  climate)   can be used  to  completely degrade,
transform or immobilize  the hazardous  constituents of the  wastes  managed  at
the  unit.   The  treatment demonstration  will be used  to determine unit-

-------
     TABLE 1.3  SOURCES OF INFORMATION ON LAND TREATMENT OF WASTE
                Title
                                   Author/Editor   Publisher (Date)
                                                Area
00
     Proceedings of the International
       Conference on Land for Waste
       Management


     Land Treatment and Disposal of
       Municipal and Industrial
       Wastewater

     Soils for Management of Organic
       Wastes and Waste Waters
Land as a Wastewater
  Management Alternative
     Managing the Heavy Metals
       on the Land
     Sludge Disposal by Land-
       Spreading Techniques
     Design of Land Treatment
       Systems for Industrial
       Wastes-Theory and Practice
     Decomposition of Toxic and Non-
       Toxic Organic Compounds in
       Soils
                                   J. Tomlinson
                                   R. L. Sanks
                                   and T. Asano
T. F. Elliott
and F. J.
Stevenson

R. C. Loehr
                                   G. W. Leeper
                                   S. Torrey
                                   M. R. Overcash
                                   and D. Pal
                                   M. R. Overcash
                Agricultural
                Institute of
                Canada (1974)
Ann Arbor Science
Publications,
Inc. (1976)

ASA, SSSA, and
CSSA (1977)
Ann Arbor Science
Publications,
Inc. (1976)

Marcel Dekker,
Inc. (1978)
                Noyes Data Corp.
                (1979)
                Ann Arbor Science
                Publications,
                Inc. (1979)


                Ann Arbor Science
                Publications,
                Inc. (1981)
Overview of waste disposal and
its interaction with soils with
particular emphasis on northern
areas.

Summary of land treatment
technology as of March 1975.


A collection of papers dealing
mainly with municipal and
agricultural waste.

Proceedings of a symposium
dealing mainly with municipal
and animal waste disposal.

Summary of the movement and
accumulation of soil applied
metals.

A collection of a group of
government sponsored research
projects dealing with sewage
sludge disposal.

Provides information on land
disposal techniques for both
hazardous and nonhazardous
industrial wastewaters.

Provides information on the
terrestrial effect of various
organic compounds.

-------
specific  permit  requirements   for  wastes  to  be  disposed  and  operating
practices to be used.

     HWLT units must be  designed,  constructed,  and operated  to  maximize
degradation, transformation  and immobilization of  hazardous constituents.
In addition, HWLT units must have  effective run-on and runoff controls and
the treatment zone must be designed to minimize runoff.  Runoff collection
facilities must  be  managed  to  control  the  water  volume generated  by a 25
year,  24  hour  storm.   Wind  dispersal  of  particulate matter must  be con-
trolled.  If food chain crops  are grown,  the owner or operator must demon-
strate that the crops meet certain  criteria.

     HWLT units must follow  a groundwater  monitoring program  similar to
that followed  by all disposal  facilities.   The  goals of  the groundwater
monitoring program are to detect and correct any groundwater contamination.
HWLT units must also have an unsaturated zone monitoring program, including
both soil core  and  soil-pore liquid monitoring, to provide feedback on the
success of treatment in the treatment  zone.

     The July,  1982 regulations also set forth  requirements  for closure and
post-closure care.   The  owner  or operator  must continue  managing the HWLT
unit to maximize degradation, transformation, and immobilization during the
closure period.   A vegetative  cover capable of maintaining growth without
excessive maintenance is  generally  required.  During the closure and  post-
closure care period the owner or operator must  continue many of the activi-
ties required  during the active  life  of  the  unit including:   control of
wind dispersal,  maintenance  of run-on  and  runoff  controls,  continuance of
food chain  crop restrictions,  and  soil core monitoring.   Soil-pore  liquid
monitoring may be suspended 90  days after  the date  of the last waste  appli-
cation.   The  post-closure care regulations also  contain  a variance  which
allows the owner or operator to be  relieved  from  complying with the vegeta-
tive cover requirements and  certain post-closure  regulations if it is dem-
onstrated that  hazardous  constituents within  the  treatment  zone  do not
significantly exceed background values.

     The regulations also contain  requirements for recordkeeping, reactive
and ignitable wastes, and incompatible wastes.  In addition to the general
recordkeeping  requirements  for  all hazardous  waste  disposal  units  (Part
264, Subpart E  (EPA, 1981)), records must  be kept of  waste application date
and rate to properly manage  the HWLT unit.  Special  recordkeeping require-
ments  for wastes disposed by  land  treatment are necessary  to ensure  that
the treatment processes are not inhibited.

     The effective  date  of  the Part  264  regulations  is  January 26,  1983.
Existing  facilities  with interim status  authorization are  subject  to the
interim status  standards (Part 265 regulations)  until they obtain a Part
264  permit.    This  document  provides   useful  guidance for  interim  status
facilities as well as new facilities with  Part  264  permits.

-------
     The information  presented  in this technical  resource  document  can be
used to design  and operate HWLT units  that are technically  sound.   There
are a number of other guidances available  to assist  the  owner or operator
in determining the  specific HWLT  design and operating procedures that will
comply with the EPA Part 264 regulations.   Guidances are also available for
preparing the permit  application  and  to assist  the permit writer in evalu-
ating information submitted in applications for HWLT units.  The availabil-
ity of these guidances is discussed in  the  preface of this document.
                                   10

-------
                            CHAPTER  1 REFERENCES
Elliott, T. F. and F. J.  Stevenson.  1977.  Soils  for management of organic
wastes and waste waters.  Am.  Soc. Agron.,  Soil Scl. Soc. Am., and Crop Scl.
Soc. Am. Madison, WI. 650 p.

EPA. 1980a. Interim  status  standards  for owners  and operators of hazardous
waste treatment, storage  and  disposal facilities.  Federal Register Vol. 45,
No. 98, pp. 33154-33258.  May  19,  1980.

EPA. 1980b. Damages  and threats caused by  hazardous material sites. Oil and
Special Materials Control Division, EPA. Washington, D.C. EPA 430/9-80-004.

EPA. 1981. Standards for  owners and operators of hazardous waste treatment,
storage and disposal facilities:  Subpart E - Manifest system, recordkeep-
ing, and reporting.  40 CFR  264.70-264.77.

EPA. 1982. Hazardous waste  management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol.  47, No. 143, pp. 32274-
32388. July 26, 1982.

K. W. Brown and Associates, Inc.  1981.  A survey  of existing hazardous waste
land treatment facilities in  the United States.  Submitted to the U.S. EPA
under contract no. 68-03-2943.

Leeper, G. W. 1978. Managing  the heavy metals on the land. Marcel Dekker
Inc., New York. 121 p.

Loehr, R. C. (ed.) 1976.  Land as a waste management alternative. Ann Arbor
Science Publ. Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan. 811 p.

Overcash, M. R. and D. Pal. 1979. Design of land treatment systems for
industrial wastes-theory  and  practice.  Ann Arbor Science Publ. Inc. Ann
Arbor, Michigan, p. 481-592.

Overcash, M. R. (ed.) 1981. Decomposition  of toxic and non-toxic organic
compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ. Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Rosenberg, D. G., R. J. Lofy, H. Cruse, E.  Weisberg, and B. Beutler. 1976.
Assessment of hazardous waste practices in the petroleum refining industry.
Jacobs Engineering Co. Prepared for the U.S. EPA.  PB-259-097.

Sanks, R. L. and T. Asano (eds.) 1976.  Land treatment and disposal of muni-
cipal and industrial wastewater. Ann  Arbor Science Publ. Inc. Ann Arbor,
Michigan. 300 p.
                                   11

-------
Tomlinson, J. (ed.) 1974. Proceedings of the international conference of
land for waste management. Ottawa, Canada. October 1973. Agricultural
Institute of Canada. 388 p.

Torrey, S. 1979. Sludge disposal by landspreading techniques. Noyes Data
Corp., New Jersey. 372 p.
                                   12

-------
2.0                             CHAPTER TWO

                        THE DYNAMIC DESIGN APPROACH
     This chapter  outlines  a comprehensive land  treatment  design strategy
based on sound environmental  protection principles.   Basic elements of the
design are described  as  they  fit  into a total  system  approach.   An under-
standing of  this dynamic design  approach  is essential  and is  the  key to
using this document.   The remaining  chapters more thoroughly describe the
specific components of  the  strategy and show how each component is impor-
tant to an effective hazardous waste  land treatment  (HWLT)  unit  design.

     Anyone involved with some aspect of land treatment  of  hazardous waste,
whether treatment  unit  design,  permit writing, or site management, should
understand the  basic  concepts behind land treatment.   The primary mecha-
nisms  involved  in land  treatment  are  degradation,  transformation and
immobilization of hazardous constituents in the waste so that the waste  is
made less hazardous.   Land treatment is considered  a final treatment and
disposal process rather than a  method  for long-term  storage of  hazardous
materials.   Thus,  facilities  are  designed  to  prevent  acute or  prolonged
harm to human health  and the environment.   Land  treatment of  wastes is  a
dynamic process.  Waste, site, soil,  climate and  biological activity  inter-
act as a system  to  degrade  or immobilize waste constituents, and  the  prop-
erties of each of these  system components varies  widely,  both initially and
temporally.   Furthermore,  land  treatment is an open  system which, if mis-
managed or incorrectly  designed,   can potentially lead  to  both  on-site and
off-site problems with  groundwater, surface water, air, or food chain con-
tamination.   Therefore,  design,  permitting  and  operation  of  HWLT  units
should  take   a   total  system approach  including adequate monitoring  and
environmental  safeguards,  rather  than an  approach  which  appraises  the
facility only as a  group of unrelated components.

     The dynamic design approach  discussed  in this Chapter is based on  a
logical flow  of  events  from the initial choice of waste stream to  be land
treated  and   potential  site  through operation  and closure.    This  design
approach is used throughout  the  document and  is presented as an appropriate
method  for  evaluating  permit  applications for HWLT units.   This  approach
assures  that  all  critical  aspects  of  hazardous  waste land  treatment  are
addressed and provides  the permit  evaluator with a  better  understanding of
each individual  HWLT  unit.   Although  this  document has been written  to  be
consistent with current federal  regulations,  it  is important  to  note that
the  approach  presented  here  can  be  used  to adequately evaluate  all land
treatment systems  regardless  of  regulatory changes because this approach is
based on scientific principles.

     This  strategy for  designing  and  evaluating HWLT units  is  patterned
after a computer flow diagram (Fig.  2.1) and suggests the essential  design
elements  .and  choices   to   be   made.    Several  others  have  dealt  with
comprehensive planning, and  their basic  considerations are  comparable  to
this  suggested  strategy,  although the format and  emphasis of  each vary
(Phung et al.,  1978a  &  b;  Overcash and Pal, 1979; Loehr et al., 1979a & b).

                                      13

-------
                       WASTE
                 CHARACTERIZATION OF

                  THE WASTE STREAM
(POTENTIAL
| SITES
1

                EXPEaEO FATE OF SPEC-
                 IFIC COMPOUNDS AND
                  ELEMENTS IN SOIL
   ASSESSMENT OF SITES'
       FOR HWLT
CHARACTERIZATION OF THE

   TREATMENT MEDIUM
                                         I
                                 (   HASTE - SITE

                                 \INTERACTIONS
1

MANAGEMENT DESIGN
AND OPERATING PLAN
                                  MONITORING 3ESI6H
                                  CONTINGCNa PLAN
                                    CLOSURE PLANS
                                   PERMIT APPLICATION
                                    HWLT OPERATIC*
                                                                1
                                                                DESIGN MODIFICATIONS
Figure  2.1.   Essential design elements and  potential areas  of  rejection to
                be considered when planning and evaluating HWLT systems.
                                            14

-------
For a  given  permit application, the  particular  approach may likewise  vary
somewhat from Fig.  2.1  depending  on the background of the facility planner
or conditions unique  to the specific waste  or site.  However,  all of  the
elements introduced in  the figure and discussed below should be  considered,
and in all cases, conclusions must  be supported by appropriate evidence.
2.1                     PRELIMINARY SITE ASSESSMENT
     The  first  fundamental decision  to  be made  is  locating the  facility.
The preliminary  assessment of  a  site involves  a two  faceted  approach  to
evaluating technical site  characteristics (i.e., hydrogeology, topography,
climatology, soils, etc.)  and  socio-geographic factors (i.e., land use  and
availability,  proximity to  the waste  generator, public  relations,  local
statutes, etc.).  In designing and permitting  HWLT units, evaluation  of  the
technical site  characteristics is  emphasized  since  these factors  directly
affect the  environmental  acceptability of  a  proposed site.   The  owner  or
operator   considers  the   socio-geographic   factors  to   determine   the
feasibility of land treatment  among the available waste management options.
In situations  where an HWLT unit will  be located near  a large  population
center or where waste  will be  hauled long  distances over  public  roads,
sociogeographic  factors are  also  important   to  environmental protection.
Chapter  3  deals with  the  factors  considered  in  the   preliminary  site
assessment  in  greater  detail.   However,  the final  choice  of  site  often
cannot be made without considering the  specific waste to  be treated,  the
results  of  waste-site  interaction  studies, and  the  preliminary  management
design;  these topics are discussed in Chapters 4  through  8.
2.2                        THE TREATMENT MEDIUM
     Soil is the  treatment  medium for HWLT.  Although  soils  are  considered
during  the  preliminary  site  assessment,  a more thorough  analysis of  the
treatment medium is necessary to:

     (1)  develop a data base for  pilot  laboratory  and/or field exper-
          iments; and

     (2)  identify any limiting  conditions which may restrict  the  use
          of the site as an HWLT unit.

The major components of  interest  are  the variations in  biological,  physical
and chemical properties  of  the soil.  Native  or  cultivated  plants,  if  used,
and the climate modify  the  treatment  medium.  Methods  for  evaluating  soil,
as the treatment medium, are discussed in  Chapter 4.
                                     15

-------
 2.3                           THE WASTE STREAM
      Since  wastes  vary in their constituents,  hazards and treatability, one
must  determine if  the waste is  (1)  hazardous  and (2) land  treatable.   The
determination  of whether a waste is  hazardous  is based on general knowledge
of  the industrial  processes  involved in  generating the  waste and  on the
chemical,  physical  and biological  analyses of  the waste  as required  by
regulation.  Knowledge of waste generating and pretreatment processes helps
determine  which compounds  are  likely to  be present.   In some  cases,  the
treatability of a waste  stream can  be improved  by  controlled pretreatment
or in-plant process  changes.   Chapter 5 presents information  to  be  used in
evaluating waste streams proposed for land treatment.
2.4                         EXPECTED FATE  IN SOIL
     Information on  the  expected  fate of  specific compounds and elements in
the  soil,  drawn from current  literature  and experience in  land  treatment,
is presented.   This  information helps to identify  waste  constituents  which
may  be  resistant to  degradation  or  that may accumulate  in soils.   Since
waste streams  are  complex mixtures,  the  fate of  the  waste mixture in  the
environment  can  be estimated based on the information  presented  in Chapter
6.   However,  to  specifically define waste treatability and  the suitability
of the  land  treatment option,  waste-site interactions  need  to  be evaluated
by laboratory and/or  field studies.
2.5                       WASTE-SITE  INTERACTIONS
     The key to the successful  design  of  land  treatment  units  for hazardous
waste is  the  interpretation of  the  data  emanating from preliminary  waste-
site interaction pilot studies.  To  justify  using  land  treatment, the owner
or operator must demonstrate that degradation,  transformation,  or immobili-
zation will make the waste  less hazardous.  In addition,  preliminary test-
ing establishes the following:

     (1)  the  identity of  waste constituents that  limit  short-term
          loading rates  and the total allowable  amount  of waste  over
          the life of  the HWLT unit;

     (2)  the assimilative  capacity  of soils  for  specific waste  con-
          stituents ;

     (3)  criteria for management;

     (4)  monitoring   parameters  to  indicate  possible   contaminant
          migration into  groundwater,  surface water,  air  and  cover
          crops;

     (5)  the land area  required to treat a given quantity of  waste;
          and

                                     16

-------
     (6)  the ultimate fate of hazardous constituents.

The laboratory, greenhouse and field  tests  are set up to determine degrad-
ability, mobility  and  toxicity of  the  waste in the  land treatment system
(Chapter  7).    The amount  of testing  required depends  on the  amount of
available  information  on  the specific  waste  disposed  at  similar sites.
Waste-site  interaction  studies are the  major focus  of  HWLT design,  since
the independent inputs of waste and site converge  here and  the results  form
the foundation for subsequent planning and engineering.
2.6                      DESIGN AND OPERATING PLAN
     The  design  and  operation  of an  HWLT unit  are  based  largely  on  the
results obtained from the waste-site interaction  studies.  Management  deci-
sions include  design  of both the  structure  of the physical plant and  the
strategy  for  its  operation.   The  various  components  considered  in  the
management plan, include:

     (1)  water control, including run-on  control and runoff retention
          and  treatment;

     (2)  waste application, including technique,  scheduling,  storage,
          and monitoring for uniform distribution;

     (3)  air  emissions control  which  is closely  related  to  waste
          application   considerations,   including  control   of   odor,
          particulates, and and volatile constituents;

     (4)  erosion  control,   involving  largely  agricultural  practices
          which are employed to limit wind and water erosion;

     (5)  vegetative  cover and cropping practices; and

     (6)  records, reporting and  inspections.

The management plan must adequately  control waste  loading and  to  provide
effective  waste  treatment   under varied  environmental  conditions;   these
topics are discussed  in Chapter 8.
2.7                        FINAL  SITE  SELECTION
     Where  more  than one  potential site  is  being considered  for an  HWLT
unit, adequate knowledge of site limitations  and  facility  economics,  devel-
oped at this point in the  design process  (Fig.  2.1),  provides  the basis for
deciding the location.   Detailed management  plans  need not be  prepared  to
determine  the  final site; however, consideration  should  be  given  to the
topography, method  of  waste  application, and  required  controls  to  manage
water.  These  considerations affect the  management,  environmental  protec-
tion, and  the  operating costs  of  the  proposed facility  and  so  should  be
considered  during site  selection.   Where severe  environmental  or treatment


                                     17

-------
constraints have not  already limited  the  choice  of  sites,  the decision will
be based partly on  economics  and partly on the preferences of  the  owner or
operator.   Since  it  is  likely  that no site will  be ideally  suited,  final
site selection is often  based on the  best  judgment  of  the  owner or  operator
and the permit writer after careful review of  all  the  data.
2.8                             MONITORING
     Monitoring  is  intended  to achieve the threefold purpose  of  (1)  deter-
mining whether  the  land treatment  process  is indeed decreasing  the  hazard
of a waste,  (2)  identifying  contaminant migration, and  (3)  providing feed-
back data for site management.  Comprehensive monitoring includes following
hazardous  constituents along  all  of  the  possible routes  of  contaminant
migration.   Soil treatment is  generally sampled  in  the treatment zone  to
characterize waste  treatment  processes.  Analysis of  soil  cores  and soil-
pore liquid in the  unsaturated zone below the treatment  zone  aids  the soil
monitoring  program in  detecting  the  occurrence  of  contaminant  leaching.
Surface runoff may  be  analyzed.   Air sampling may be advisable where vola-
tile wastes are  being  land treated.   Finally, since vegetation  can  trans-
locate some hazardous  compounds  into the food chain, crops  should  be moni-
tored when  they  are raised for  human  or animal  consumption.   Methods  and
requirements for monitoring  the possible routes  of contamination  are dis-
cussed in Chapter 9.
2.9                        CONTINGENCY  PLANNING
     After final site selection  and before the owner or  operator  of  a pro-
posed HWLT unit  applies for a permit,  the final  design must  be  completed
and  several   additional considerations  must  be  addressed  (Chapter  10).
Routine  health  and  safety  procedures   must   be  developed  as   well  as
preparedness for environmental emergencies.  Contingency plans  must also be
developed to determine  the  remedial actions that will  be taken  in  the event
of:

     (1)  waste spill;

     (2)  soil overload;
     (3)  breach of surface water  control  structures;

     (4)  breakthrough  to groundwater; or
     (5)  fire or explosion.

     In addition, since permits  for a particular waste  stream  are approved
on the basis of the results from preliminary testing, the  decision to dis-
pose of an alternate waste  or  to drastically change the  composition  of the
approved waste  stream may  need  to  be  accompanied  by  further  data  demon-
strating that  the  new treatment combination  also  meets  the  land  treatment
objectives.   Permits  must  then  be  amended as appropriate.   The  amount  of

                                      18

-------
additional  testing  required will  depend  on  the waste  stream,  but  the
requirements may  range  in scope from simple  loading  rate adjustments  to  a
complete preapplication experimental program.
2.10                     PLANNING FOR  SITE  CLOSURE
     Plans  for  closure must be  completed before  a  permit can  be  approved
for an HWLT unit.   Site closure  relies  on the philosophy  of  nondeteriora-
tion of the  native  resource and emphasizes the eventual  return  of  the land
to an acceptable range of  potential uses (Chapter 11).   Plans must include
the method of  closure and  procedures  for site  assessment and monitoring
following  closure.   In addition, costs of closure and  post-closure activi-
ties should  be  estimated.
2.11                   PERMIT APPLICATION/ACCEPTANCE


     In  Fig.  2.1,  an  application-modification-acceptance  feedback  loop
illustrates the permit application  process.   Because of the need for treat-
ability data and the  complexity  of  the design of  any HWLT  unit,  the permit
writer and the owner  or  operator are encouraged  to  cooperate  in interpret-
ing  results  from  preliminary  studies,  evaluating data  and modifying  the
HWLT unit design.  The permitting process  may vary depending on whether the
U.S.  Environmental  Protection Agency  or  a  State agency has  the authority
for  permit  issuance.   Administrative  procedures  of the  permitting  process
are  not discussed  in  this document.
2.12                          HWLT  OPERATION
     After  receiving the appropriate  permit, the  owner or operator  of an
HWLT unit begins  operations following the design and  monitoring plans out-
lined  in  the permit application.   Wastes delivered  to the unit  should be
tested to determine  if  they contain the  chemicals  that are expected and for
which  the unit waa  designed.   Monitoring and  inspections must  be carried
out during the operation  of the HWLT unit.
2.13                            SITE  CLOSURE
     When  the  site capacity for which the HWLT  unit  has been  designed is
reached, the unit  must be properly closed.   HWLT units may  also  be closed
for other  reasons  before this time.   The closure plans  submitted  with the
permit  application must  be followed.  The owner  or  operator  is  responsible
for implementing these plans  and  is financially liable  for  closure costs,
including  any  costs resulting from ensuing off-site groundwater pollution.
Site closure requirements are  discussed In detail In Chapter 11.

                                      19

-------
                           CHAPTER 2 REFERENCES
Loehr, R. C., W. J. Jewell, J. D. Novak, W. W. Clarkson, and G.  S. Fried-
man. 1979a. Land application of wastes. Vol.  1. Van Mostrand Relnhold Co.,
New York. 308 p.

Loehr. R. C., W. J. Jewell, J. D. Novak, W. W. Clarkson, and G.  S. Fried-
man. 1979b. Land application of wastes. Vol.  2. Van Nostrand Reinhold Co.,
New York. 431 p.

Overcash, M, R., and D. Pal. 1979. Design of  land treatment systems for
industrial wastes - theory and practice. Ann Arbor Sci. Publ. Inc. Ann
Arbor, Michigan. 684 p.

Phung, T., L. Barker, D. Ross, and D. Bauer.  1978a. Land cultivation of
industrial wastes and municipal solid wastes: state-of-the-art-study. Vol.
1. EPA-600/2-78-140a. PB 287-080/AS.

Phung, T., L. Barker, D. Ross, and D. Bauer.  1978b. Land cultivation of
industrial wastes and municipal solid wastes: state-of-the-art-study. Vol.
2. EPA-600/2-78-140b. PB 287-081/AS.
                                    20

-------
3.0                            CHAPTER  THREE

                      PRELIMINARY ASSESSMENT  OF  SITES


     The assessment of  sites  proposed as  locations  for  hazardous  waste land
treatment  unite  involves a technical evaluation of the characteristics  of
each site  and an  evaluation of socio-geograpMc  factors including area land
use.  The  following objectives are  fundamental to decision-making:

     (1)   Site  characteristics  should  minimize  the  probability  of
           off-site  contamination via  groundwater,  surface water,  or
           atmospheric emissions.

     (2)   Site characteristics should  minimize the associated risk  to
           the public  and the environment  in  case of accidental  fire,
           explosion, or  release of  hazardous  substances.

Chapter 2  presented a model showing the flow  of  events  from site  assessment
through site closure (Fig. 2.1).  Figure  3.1  expands  that  model to indicate
the aspects of site assessment and  selection  discussed  in  this  Chapter.

     Careful selection  of  sites  is  critical because, once  the HWLT  unit  is
in operation, the owner or operator has  little  control over natural  proc-
esses  (e.g.,  water  table fluctuations,  floods,  winds)  or  over  external
societal influences  (e.g.,  urban or industrial development).  The  operator
of an existing HWLT unit  can  only adjust  management practices to  respond  to
these influences  since  the unit cannot  be relocated without great cost.

     Site  analysis  is  essentially  the  same for  both existing and  proposed
facilities.   In  permitting existing HWLT units, the permit evaluator must
determine  the appropriateness of  continued operation.  For existing units,
the site assessment  will indicate  the  aspects  of the  design or  management
that need  to be modified  to assure  protection of human  health and the envi-
ronment.   For example,  a unit where excessive water during the  wet season
has historically  caused odor problems  due  to system anaerobicity might  be
allowed to continue operation if water  control devices  and water  management
were modified.   In this  case,  reduction of  wet season waste  applications
and modification  of water management  techniques might be required  before
permit approval.

     In addition  to determining the  suitability of a  given site for land
treatment, predesign site analysis  provides input  for  the  design of demon-
stration  studies  and  for subsequent  management  design.    Site  data also
establish  background conditions  and furnish knowledge  of  the likely routes
of contaminant migration for damage assessment  in the event of  accidental
discharges.   Table  3.1 shows  how  the information  gained from the  site
assessment can be used  throughout the design  and management of  the unit.

     Evaluating the technical acceptability of a site involves  establishing
threshold  conditions  beyond which  land treatment is not feasible,  and the
failure of a site  to  meet  any  one of these criteria may eliminate land
                                     21

-------
r
WASTE
r
POTENTIAL
  SITE
         REGIONAL
         GEOLOGY  § 3.1
         OROGRAPHY AMD
         RAINAGE § 3.2
         CLIMATE § 3.3
         SOILS  S 3.4
         GE0TECHNICAL.
         DESCRIPTION §3.5
                                         SITE
                                       ASSESSMENT
                                      HAPTER THREE
                                   IS THE PROPOSED SITE

                           ^TECHNICALLY AMD ENVIRONMENTALLY)^ REJECT^

                               SUITABLE FOR HWLT? (SECTIONS,

                                        3.1 - 3.5)
  CHARACTERIZATION OF
  THE WASTE STREAM
    CHAPTER FIVE
                                ARE THE SOCIO-GEOGRAPHIC

                                CONSIDERATIONS COMPATIBLE
                                WITH HWLT?  (SECTION 3.6}
                           I
                           t
                                 CHARACTERIZATION OF THE
                                    TREATMENT MEDIUM
                                      CHAPTER FOUR
          Figure  3.1.   Factors  considered during  site  selection,
                                    22

-------
TABU 3.1  USB W HELIMINARY SITE ASSESSMENT INFOKHATIOH
FACTORS
CONSIDERED
IN THE SITE
ASSESSMENT
PHASE
Regional
Geology









Topography
and Drainage







Climate














INFORMATION GATHERED [It THE SITE ASSESSMENT PHASE USED
waate-Sall
late ractlon
Studies
o determine effect
on the ability
of the soil to
remain aerobic







o determine effect
on the ability
of the soil to
remain aerobic
o determine the
risk of mobile
constltuen* t
being leached
to groundwater
o determine effect
of temperature
and moisture
regimes on-waite
degradation











Management
Design











o determine facil-
ity layout — plots
roada. retention
basins, etc.
o consider modifi-
cation* to natu-
ral topography


o determine waste
application
methods
o determine waste
storage capacity
required due to
wet or cold con-
ditions
o determine need to
control wind dis-
persal of con-
taminants
o determine (optimal)
timing of opera-
tlona

Monitoring
Design
o determine the
placement of
monitoring
wells







o determine the
placement of
unsaturated
cone monitoring
devices




o determine the
placement of
air monitoring
devices
(optional)










IN teCISION-MAKINC OF LATER PHASES;

Final Site
Selection
o determine if the
unit lies la a
floodplaln or aqui-
fer recharge zone,
over a fault zone,
etc.
o determine the local
availability of
suitable materials
for pond and levee
construction
o choose site to
minimize amount of
soil to be moved
o avoid unstable
areas




o choose location
downwind of major
population centers













Closure
Planning
o consider long-
term stability
of the site








o consider drain-
age pst terns
needed at time
of closure





o consider Che
potential for
acid rain and
possible
effects on
waste constitu-
ent mobility








                                                      -continued—

-------
TABLE 3.1   (continued)
FACTORS
CONSIDERED
IN THE SITE
ASSESSMENT
PHASE
INFORMATION GATHERED IN THE SITE ASSESSMENT PHASE USED

Waste-Soil
Interaction Management Monitoring
Studies Design Design
IN DECISION-MAKING OF


Final Site
Selection
LATER PHASES:


Closure
Planning
Soils
o detemlne effect
  of physical and
  chemical soil
  properties on
  waste degrada-
  tion, transfor-
  mation , and
  Immobilization
                                      o determine erosion
                                        hazards,  calculate
                                        terrace spaclngs
                                      o consider  horlzon-
                                        atlon
o consider how the
  leaching poten-
  tial of soil
  will affect the
  choice and
  placement of
  monitoring
  devices
o determine overall
  suitability of
  soils as a treat-
  ment medium for
  HWLT
o consider ero-
  sion potential
  of soils fol-
  lowing waste
  application
Geotechnical
 Description
o determine if
  groundwater will
  adversely affect
  treatment zone
o determine the
  placement of
  upgradient
  and down-
  gradient moni-
  toring wells
o consider exist-
  ing quality of
  water In under-
  lying aquifers
o consider depth to
  water table
o consider other
  potential sources
  of groundwater pol-
  lution In the area
Soclogeo-
 graphlc
                     o consider how  to
                       minimize public
                       risk  from opera-
                       tions
                     o determine need  for
                       buffer zones
                    o consider public
                      opinion, zoning,
                      current and future
                      land use, etc.
                    o avoid special use
                      areas
                    o choose a site close
                      to waste generator
                       o  consider  public
                          opinion and
                          future land use
                          when deter-
                          mining closure
                          method

-------
treatment as an option.  Threshold  values  are determined on the basis of a
point or level beyond which the site constraints cannot  be reasonably over-
come by management.   In formulating criteria, some threshold values appear
rather arbitrary,  even  though an attempt has  been  made to remain flexible
to  account  for the  diversity of needs  and circumstances.   However,  many
limitations are ultimately a  question of management extremes versus econom-
ics.  For example, where alternate  treatment or disposal techniques are not
reasonably  available,  an industry  may,  for economic  reasons,  choose land
treatment and  use extreme management procedures to  overcome site restric-
tions.  The factors which determine the technical suitability of a site are
discussed in  Sections 3.1 to  3.5.   These  sections  present  general guide-
lines based on a  moderate level of management, and  the permit writer must
recognize that exceptions  to  these could be  acceptable.  Section 3.6 dis-
cusses  socio-geographic   factors  associated  with   the   site  selection
process.
3.1                          REGIONAL GEOLOGY
     An understanding of the regional geology  of  the  area  in which  the HWLT
unit is located is an essential  part of the site assessment.  Knowledge  of
the geology of the site also helps determine the  proper  design and  monitor-
ing needs  of  the  unit.   Geologic  information,  published by  federal and
state geological surveys,  describes  the location, physical make-up,  thick-
ness and boundaries of  geologic units which may be aquifers (EPA, 1977).   A
map of  the proposed  site(s) should be  prepared to  show the  significant
geologic features of the area, including:

     (1)  depth to bedrock;

     (2)  characteristics  of the  unconsolidated materials  above  the
          bedrock;

     (3)  characteristics  of the bedrock;

     (4)  outcrops;

     (5)  aquifer recharge zones;  and

     (6)  discontinuities  such as  faults,  fissures, joints, fractures,
          sinkholes, etc.

     The depth to bedrock and the  characteristics  of  the unconsolidated
materials above the bedrock  affect the conditions of  the  soil where  treat-
ment of wastes will  take  place,  such as  the ability  of  the soil to  remain
aerobic.  Shallow water tables often occur in  fine-grained geologic materi-
als with low  hydraulic  conductivities.   This does not necessarily  make  the
site unacceptable  for  HWLT  because these fine-grained materials  may  not
provide a groundwater resource.   Fine-grained materials are more effective
than  coarse-grained materials  in  slowing  the   movement  of  leachate  and
removing  contaminants   and are,  therefore, more effective  in  protecting


                                     25

-------
 aquifers  (Cartwright et  al.,  1981).   The characteristics  of  the  bedrock
 underlying the HWLT  site  also help  to  determine  the  potential for wastes  to
 reach the  groundwater unchanged.   For example,  a site  underlain by  lime-
 stone bedrock may  be unacceptable because it may contain solution channels
 or develop sinkholes through which wastes  could be  rapidly transmitted  to
 groundwater.

      Outcrops of  rock on  or  near  the  proposed  site  may  indicate  aquifer
 recharge zones.   If  water in a  shallow aquifer  is  of high quality, or  is
 being used as a drinking water source,  this may  be an  unacceptable location
 for an HWLT unit.   In addition,  if  any discontinuities  exist,  they should
 be carefully  investigated  to  determine  if  they  will  allow contaminated
 leachate to reach  groundwater (EPA,  1975).   Hazardous waste facilities are
 required to be located  at least  61  m (200 ft) away  from a  fault which has
 had displacement in Holocene time (EPA, 1981).  How  the  groundwater  direct-
 ly beneath the site is connected  to regional groundwater systems and drink-
 ing water aquifers is  also an important  consideration for  choosing  a site
 and designing effective monitoring systems.


 3.2                       TOPOGRAPHY AND DRAINAGE
      Sites selected  for HWLT  units  should  not  be  so  flat as  to prevent
 adequate surface drainage, nor  so  steep as  to  cause excessive erosion and
 runoff  problems; however, in selecting  a  site,  it is important to remember
 that  topography  can  be modified to  some extent  by facility  design.   The
 advantages of a relatively flat location  include  the ability to make waste
 applications  by surface  flooding  in  a  slurry,   minimization of  erosion
 potential, and  easy access by equipment.  A  1%  grade is usually sufficient
 to avoid standing water and prevent anaerobic conditions.  One advantage of
 rolling terrain is that with careful  design, less  earth  needs to be moved
 to construct  retention basins  and  roads can be placed along ridges, provid-
 ing all-weather site  access.   Slopes  steeper  than 4%  may  require special
 management practices  to reduce erosion hazards.    Management  designs  for
 different  terrains are discussed in Chapter 8.

      Generally  the most desirable areas for  HWLT  units  are  upland flat and
 terrace landforms where the probability for  washouts is low.   Washouts are
 more  likely in  areas  that are  adjacent to stream  beds or  gullies  or are in
 a  floodplain.   Site assessment and/or selection can be  done by analyzing a
 topographic map for  the area surrounding  the  HWLT  site.   The map  should
 include the location of all springs,  rivers  and  surface  water bodies near
 the proposed  site.   Drainage  patterns  for the  area should  be determined.
 If  the  site  lies  within the  100-year  floodplain,  the  level  of  the  flood
 should  be  Indicated on  the map.  Management of HWLT units located  in the
 100-year floodplain must include provisions  to  prevent washout of hazardous
wastes  (EPA,  1982).

     The characteristics of the soil  also  affect the ability of the soil to
remain  aerobic  and to  support  traffic.   Aerobic  conditions  are  necessary
for the degradation  of many wastes,  so  well  drained  or moderately well


                                    26

-------
drained  soils  are needed.   Poorly  drained soils may  become anaerobic and
may limit the use  of  heavy  equipment,  and very well drained soils in humid
regions may encourage rapid  leaching of  contaminants.  Soil  characteristics
are discussed in  Section  3.4
3.3                               CLIMATE
     Although  climate  greatly influences waste  treatment, climatic condi-
tions  are  not necessarily  a major consideration  in site  selection.   The
principal  reason  for this is  that  the  owner or operator  of  a proposed or
existing unit has little  choice about site location  with respect  to climate
since  conditions do  not usually vary greatly within  a given region and  long
distance waste shipment  could be  risky as well  as uneconomical.   An addi-
tional  reason  is that few  regions within  the United  States exhibit  such
restrictive  climatic  conditions  that  land treatment  is  economically or
technically infeasible.   Careful  design and a moderate level  of  management
can  safely overcome most  climatic restrictions.   An exception  to  this
reasoning  would  be  where inadequate  land is available  to treat  the given
waste  stream  based  on climatic constraints  (i.e., extended periods of  low
temperatures or excessive wetness).

     The atmosphere  directly affects the  land  treatment system by providing
transport  mechanisms for  waste constituents, and acts indirectly  as a modi-
fier  of soil-waste   interactions.   Table 3.2  lists these  effects  and  the
controlling atmospheric  parameters which are  important considerations  for
site selection.  HWLT design and management  plans  should receive  particular
scrutiny if a  temperature or moisture regime is  present which would greatly
influence  treatment  effectiveness.    As a  general  rule,  less  land is
required to  treat  a given  quantity of waste  if the unit  is located  in  a
warm,  humid climate  than  in  a cold, arid  climate.

     Since few if any  HWLT  sites  have a sufficient  historical  data base to
make  reliable  design decisions, climatic data must be extrapolated from  a
reporting  station  exhibiting  conditions  similar to those of  the proposed
site.   For reliable climatological data  it  is best to choose an official
National Weather Service  reporting station.  These  stations  have standard-
ized   instrumentation,   scrupulous   instrument   placement,   and  trained
observational personnel.  It is not always easy  to choose  a Weather Service
reporting  station  that has  a similar  climate.   Simply extrapolating  from
the  nearest station is  not  necessarily acceptable.   Due  to  orographic
effects  and major  climatic modifiers, such as large  bodies  of water,  a
weather  station  50  km from  the proposed  HWLT site  may better match  local
conditions than  observations  made at  a  station  only  5 km  away from  the
site.  Based on these  considerations, the owner  or operator of an HWLT  unit
or  the  permit  writer   should  consult  the  services   of a  professional
meteorologist.
                                    27

-------
       TABLE  3.2  THE INFLUENCE OF ATMOSPHERIC VARIABLES ON LAND TREATMENT OPERATIONS AND PROCESSES
      Operation or Process
Atmospheric variable
                      Effect
      Biodegradation
Temperature


Precipitation-
Evapotranspiration
Indirect - controls soil temperature which con-
   trols microbial populations and activity

Indirect - controls soil moisture which controls
   (1) soil aeration,  the supply of oxygen for
   microbes, and (2) adequacy of water supply
      Waste  application
Temperature
ro
oo
                                 Precipitation-
                                 Evapotranspiration

                                 Winds
                                 Atmospheric stability
Direct - cold temperatures increase waste viscos-
   ity, thus decreasing ease of handling and hot
   temperatures may restrict application due to
   waste volatility hazard

Indirect - cold temperatures keep soil temperature
   low, which can limit soil workability and waste
   degradation, and may increase the amount of
   runoff

Indirect - soil wetness can inhibit field access-
   ability and enhance the waste leaching hazard

Direct - hazard of off-site pollution due to
   transport of particulates and volatile con-
   stituents

Direct - surface inversions can lead to fumigation
   of the surface layer by volatile waste con-
   stituents
       Site  selection
Winds
Direct - potential hazard to public from advected
   particulates and volatile constituents

-------
 3.3.1                               Winds
     Winds  directly control site selection because of  the  need  to minimize
public  risk  from treatment  operations.    Although  management  strives  to
reduce  air emissions  to  a minimum,  atmospheric  transport of  contaminants
may  unavoidably occur when:

     (1)  hot weather or  recent  waste applications  cause  volatiliza-
          tion of waste  constituents;

     (2)  aerosols from  spray irrigation or  suspended  particulates
          from surface erosion are  carried by high winds;  or

     (3)  noxious vapors  are released due to an accident  such  as  fire
          or  explosion.

Therefore,  HWLT units should be placed downwind of major population centers
whenever  possible.  Methods  to control wind dispersal  of  contaminants  are
discussed in  Section  8.4  and are  particularly Important during  parts of  the
year when winds may blow  toward a population center.

     Siting  with  regard  to winds  is based  on an  analysis  of  prevailing
winds during  the waste application  season.  The  application season  is  of
particular  Importance since  fresh  wastes have the greatest potential  for
atmospheric  emissions and  applications often  coincide with warm weather,
which increases volatility and ignitability.  Atmospheric  stability at  the
time of waste application is  also  important.   Accidents are more probable
during waste  handling operations  and in  case  of  fire or other  emergency
that  release  air contaminants,  a  knowledge  of  wind  direction  and  speed
helps the operator to assess the hazard and plan  the response.   Wind is a
vector quantity,  described by both magnitude and  direction.  Consequently,
a frequency analysis  to determine prevailing winds uses a two-way frequency
distribution  (Table  3.3)  to  construct a  standard wind  rose,  (Fig.  3.2)
which.simultaneously  considers wind  speed  and  direction.


3.3.2                 Temperature  and Moisture Regimes
     Although climatic variables  other  than wind have a very limited effect
on site suitability,  two  additional  factors should be considered during the
site  assessment since management of HWLT units  Is  greatly influenced  by
climate.   An appreciation of  two broad climatic  relationships  can  illumi-
nate  regions where  particular scrutiny is  required to  determine  if  the
design properly accounts  for  climatic  effects.   First, the  degradation  of
organic wastes  effectively ceases when  soil temperatures  remain  below 5°C
(Dibble and  Bartha,  1979).   Therefore, units located  in  cold  northern  or
mountainous  regions  (Fig.  3.3) may have seasonal treatment restrictions and
will  need to  have  storage  capacities,  pretreatment methods  and/or  land
areas that are  adequate to handle the projected  quantity of waste.  Second,
when  soil  moisture content exceeds  field capacity,  aerobic  decomposition,


                                    29

-------
                  TABLE 3.3  TWO-WAY FREQUENCY DISTRIBUTION OF WIND SPEED AND DIRECTION*
u>
o
Rating
Weak


Moderate




Strong





SPEED,
1.8 -
3.2 -
4.5 -
5.9 -
7.2 -
8.6 -
9.9 -
11.3 -
12.6 -
14.0 -
15.3 -
16.7 -
18.0 -

m/sec
3.1
4.4
5.8
7.1
8.5
9.8
11.2
12.5
13.9
15.2
16.6
17.9
19.3

S

6
11
11
5
1


1




35
SW

8
12
16
8
5
1

1




41
W
2
2
5
10
9
6
5
4
4
2
1


50
NW


4
14
22
37
26
11
14
4

5
1
138
N
1
16
16
21
8
8
2
2


2


76
NE

13
8
7
1








29
E
1
17
15
6
5
1
2






47
SE

2
7
2
5

1

2




19

4
64
78
87
63
58
37
17
22
6
3
5
1
445
                  * Modified from Panofsky and Brier  (1958).

-------
                                            Strong  Winds
                                          Moderate  Winds
                                      []  Weak Winds
NW
                                                      10%  Occurrence
                                                   20% Occurrence
SW
SE
  Figure 3.2.  Standard wind rose using data presented in Table 3.3
               (Modified from Panofsky and Brier, 1958). Reprinted
               by permission of Pennsylvania State University.
                              31

-------
--
•
                              	'-._
                     Figure 3.3.   Areas where waste application may be limited by excess moisture,

-------
which  is  the  primary  treatment mechanism active  in land  treatment,  is
inhibited  (Brown  et  al.,  1980).   Seasonally  wet climates  promote  soil
anaerobicity  and  may  also  restrict  access  to  the  field.    Regions  with
excess moisture  (Fig.  3.3) may require special  designs or operational  pro-
cedures such as  increased  waste  storage capacity,  field drainage  systems  to
control  water table  depth, major  runoff  and  run-on  control structures,
careful waste  application timing, and/or  vehicles equipped with  flotation
tires.  A  more detailed discussion of how management must respond to  cli-
matic influences appears in  Chapter 8.

     As noted  above,  in some  areas  there  may  be  seasonal restrictions  on
waste application  based on  climate.   The  waste application  season may  be
restricted  in the  northern  and  mountainous  regions  because  of  prolonged
periods of  low temperatures.  The Southeast and Pacific Northwest may  have
restrictions  due  to seasonal  wetness.   If  these  restrictions are  severe
enough  to  halt  the application  of  wastes,  then  sufficient  waste  storage
capacity  must  be   provided  for  the  wastes   being produced  during  these
periods.   Section 8.8.1 discusses  how to  determine the waste application
season.

3.4                                SOILS
     Since  soil  is  the  treatment medium for HWLT,  careful  consideration
must be given  to  selecting  a site with soil properties  suitable  for  reten-
tion and degradation of  the wastes to be  applied.   The potential  for  ero-
sion and leaching of  hazardous  constituents  must  be evaluated.
3.4.1                           Soil  Survey
     A detailed  soil  survey conducted according to standard U.S.  Soil  Con-
servation Service  (SCS)  procedures should be completed  to  identify  and map
the soil series  on sites proposed  for HWLT units.  For  each soil  series,  a
general description of  soil properties is needed to  select potential  areas
for waste application and  to determine uniform areas for monitoring.   Soil
samples should be  taken to adequately  characterize the site and  to deter-
mine the physical  and  chemical properties required for  design  (Chapter 5).
Information, usually  included in  soil  survey  descriptions, that  is useful
during various phases  of the design  and  management of  HWLT units includes
the following:

     (1)  estimates of  the  erodibility  of the  soil  (Section  3.4.2),
          used to calculate  terrace spacings and  other  erosion  control
          structures (Section 8.5);

     (2)  information on the depth  and  texture  of  subsoils  (Section
          3.4.5), used  to  determine  if suitable soil is available for
          constructing  clay  berms  and  clay   lined   retention  ponds
          (Section 8.3); and
                                    33

-------
      (3)  measurements  of  surface  texture,  used to estimate acceptable
          waste  application  rates,  water retention capacity,  and types
          and  amounts  of constituents  that  will be  retained  (Section
          3.4.3).

     An SCS  soil survey may also contain information  on  the  average and/or
seasonal  water  table  height.   Additional  information  on the  historical
water  table  height  can  be  gained from a visual inspection of  the soil hori-
zons.  Differences  in  soil  color and patterns  of  soil  color  such as mottl-
ing  and  the gray colors  that  accompany gleying  (a process that  occurs  in
soils  that  are  water  saturated for  long periods)  are good  indicators  of
poorly drained soils (USDA,  1951).   Poor drainage can. result  from a season-
ally  high water  table, a perched  water  table,  or  the  internal  drainage
characteristics  of  the  soil.   In this inspection it is important to realize
that the  soil  color may indicate past conditions  of  poor  drainage and that
drainage  may be  improving.   In this  case, soils  will  gradually become more
oxidized  as  indicated  by red,  yellow and reddish brown colors.   Geotechni-
cal  investigations  described  in Section 3.5  should be designed  to verify
water  table  fluctuations  if  soil color indicates poor drainage.
3.4.2                              Erosion
     Erosion  is  a function  of the  climate,  topography, vegetative  cover,
soil properties and  the  activities of animals and man.   The  Universal Soil
Loss Equation  (USLE) is  commonly  used to  estimate soil lost due to erosion;
it  is  an  empirical  formula  based on years  of  research  and  actual  field
work.   The equation includes  factors that affect  soil loss  and  considers
management  alternatives  to  control  soil  loss.   The  USLE calculates  loss
from sheet  and rill erosion.   This  is  not the  same  as sediment  yield  at
some downstream  point;  it  equals sediment yield plus  the amount of  soil
deposited  along  the way to  the  place  of measure  (Wischmeier and  Smith,
1978).   The USLE  equation  and  tables for  each factor  use  English  units
rather  than metric  for  two  reasons, 1)  the  USLE  has traditionally  used
English units  and  direct conversion  to  metric units  produces numbers  that
are  awkward to use, and 2)  data  to be  used  in the  USLE  is  more readily
available  in English units.   The value of  soil  lost per acre  per  year can
be multiplied  by 2.24  to convert  the  value to metric tons per hectare per
year.  Wischmeier and  Smith  (1978) provide additional  guidance on using the
USLE with  metric  units  for  all  factors.   Although  the soil  losses  calcu-
lated are  estimates  rather  than absolute data,  they are  useful for select-
ing sites.  Choosing management practices that  minimize  the  factors  in the
equation will  minimize erosion.   The USLE is written as:
                                    34

-------
                                 A - RKLSCP                            (3.1)

where

     A -  Soil-loss  in tons/acre/year;
     R -  Rainfall factor;

     K «  Soil-erodibility  factor;
     L -  Slope-length factor;

     S -  Slope-gradient  factor;

     C -  Cropping management  factor; and

     P "  Erosion control practice  factor.

          Rainfall  (R).  The  amount, intensity  and  distribution of  precipi-
tation determine the  dispersive action of  rain  on soil,  the amount  and
velocity  of runoff,  and  the losses due  to  erosion.   Maps  of the  United
States with iso-erodent lines,  indicating  equally erosive annual  rainfall
have been prepared; the R factor  can  be read  off  these  maps.  Wischmeier
and Smith (1978) developed a  map for the continental U.S.  (Fig. 3.A).

          Soil-erodibility (K).   Some  soils erode more readily than  others
even when all other factors are  equal.  This  difference,  due  to the proper-
ties of the soil itself,  is  called soil erodibility.  K values have  been
determined  experimentally  and can  be obtained from  nomographs (Fig. 3.5).

          Slope-length and Slope-gradient  (LS).  These factors  are closely
interrelated and are  considered  as  one value.   Slope length is the  distance
from the  point of  origin  of  overland  flow  to the point  where the  slope
gradient  decreases  to the extent that deposition  begins  or to the  point
where  runoff  enters a well-defined  channel.   The  soil  loss  per unit  area
increases  as  the  slope  length  increases.    As  sj.ope  gradient  becomes
steeper,  the  velocity of  the runoff water increases,  increasing the power
of the  runoff to detach particles  from the soil and transport them  from the
field.  Figure 3.6  shows how  to  determine  the LS factor  for a given site.

          Cropping  Management (C).  This  factor shows  the combined  effect
of all the  interrelated cover and  management variables.   The C factor  is
the ratio of soil loss from land managed under  specified conditions  to the
corresponding  loss  from continuously  fallow land.  Values vary widely  as
shown  in Table 3.4.   Vegetation  to be  selected for  levees  and  land treated
areas  between applications,  or at  closure,  should  have  a minimum  C  value.
A  dense stand of permanent vegetation will  give a C value  of 0.01  after
establishment.
                                    35

-------
Figure 3.A.   Average annual values of the rainfall erosion index
             (Wischmeier and Smith, 1978).

-------

Where the silt fraction does not exceed 702, the equation is
100 K - 2.1 M1'14 (10-*) (12 - a) + 3.25 (b - 2) + 2.5 (c - 3) where M
organic matter  b » structure code, and c - profile permeability class.

Figure 3.5.  The aoll erodibility nomograph (Wischneler and Smith, 1978).
(percent si -f vfs)  (100 - percent  c),  a  -  percent

-------
.
                       ao.o
                       10.0
                        0.0
                        40
                        2.0
g
I
 I
a
•-
o
~  ...
0
0
o  o •
O
0.
8  0.4
                        02
                        O.I
     iOX
     IflH
     40X


     BOX
      MX

      MX

      I2X
                                                         10
                                                         mi
                                                         •X
                         20
                                       «
                                              I
•0   100           200

  SLOPE LENGTH I FEET)
                                                                                         600
                                                                                               •oo   1000
                       Note:  LS =  (A/72.6)"1 (65.41  sln26  + A.56 sin 9 + 0.065) where A = slope
                       length in  feet;  6 = angle of slope;  and m = 0.2 for gradients  < 1 percent, 0.3
                       for  1 to 3  percent slopes, 0.4  for 3.5 to 4.5 percent  slopes,  and 0.5 for
                       slopes of  5  percent or steeper.

                       Figure 3.6.   Slope-effect chart  for  the topographic factor,  LS
                                     (Wischmeier and Smith,  1978).

-------
TABLE 3.4  TYPICAL VALUES FOR THE C FACTOR
         Cover                                                    C Factor

1.  Bare soil conditions freshly disced to 15-20 cm               1.00
    After one rain                                                0.89
    Undisturbed except scraped                                    0.66-1.30
    Sawdust 5 cm deep, disced in                                  0.61

2.  Seedings
    Temporary, 0 to 60 days                                       0.40
    Temporary, after 60 days                                      0.05
    Permanent, 0 to 60 days                                       0.40
    Permanent, 2 to 12 months                                     0.05
    Permanent, after 12 months                                    0.01

3.  Weeds and brush
    No appreciable canopy, 100% ground cover                      0.003
    No appreciable canopy, 29% ground cover                       0.24
    75% canopy cover* of tall weeds or short brush,
    100% ground cover                                             0.007
    75% canopy cover of brush or bushes,
    100% ground cover                                             0.007

4.  Undisturbed wood land
    100% canopy cover with forest litter on 100% of  area          0.0001
    20% canopy cover with forest litter on 40% of area            0.009

* Portion of total area that would be hidden from view  by canopy  projec-
  tion.
          Erosion Control Practice  (P).  This  factor  is the ratio  of  soil
loss with the supporting practice to  the soil  loss with  straight  uphill and
downhill plowing.  Support  practices  that  slow the runoff water  and reduce
the amount  of soil  it can  carry include  contour tillage,  contour  strip
cropping, and terrace  systems  (Wischmeier  and Smith,  1978).   Tables  3.5
through 3.7 show the P values that have been prepared  for  various conserva-
tion practices*
                                    39

-------
TABLE 3.5  P VALUES AND SLOPE-LENGTH LIMITS FOR  CONTOURING*
         Land Slope
                               P Value
Maximum LengtJr
    (feet)
1 to 2
3 to 5
6 to 8
9 to 12
13 to 16
17 to 20
21 to 25
0.60
0.50
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
400
300
200
120
80
60
50
* Wischmeier and Smith (1978).

t Limit may be increased by 25% if residue  cover  after  crop  seedlings
  will regularly exceed 50%.
TABLE 3.6  P VALUES, MAXIMUM STRIP WIDTHS, AND  SLOPE  LENGTH  LIMITS  FOR
           CONTOUR STRIPCROPPING*
Land Slope
(%)
1 to 2
3 to 5
6 to 8
9 to 12
13 to 16
17 to 20
21 to 25
P Values*
A
0.30
0.25
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0.45
B
0.45
0.38
0.38
0.45
0.52
0.60
0.68
C
0.60
0.50
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
Strip Width''
(feet)
130
100
100
80
80
60
50
Maximum Length
(feet)
BOO
600
400
240
160
120
100
* Wischmeier and Smith  (1978).

t P values:
     A For 4-year rotation of row  crop,  small  grain  with meadow seeding,
       and 2-years of meadow.  A second  row  crop  can replace  the small
       grain if meadow  is established  in it.
     B For 4-year rotation of 2-years  row crop, winter  grain  with meadow
       seeding, and 1-year meadow.
     C For alternate strips of row  crop  and  small grain.
* Adjust strip-width limit, generally  downward, to accomodate widths  of
  farm equipment.
                                    40

-------
 TABLE  3.7   P  VALUES FOR CONTOUR-FARMED,  TERRACED FIELDS**


                   Farm Planning           Computing Sediment Yield*
LAND SLOPE
Percent
1 to 2
3 to 8
9 to 12
13 to 16
17 to 20
21 to 25
Contour
Factor*
0.60
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
0.90
Stripcrop
Factor
0.30
0.25
0.30
0.35
0.40
0.45
Graded Channels
Sod Outlets
0.12
0.10
0.12
0.14
0.16
0.18
Steep Backslope
Underground Outlets
0.05
0.05
0.50
0.05
0.06
0.06
* Wischmeier  and  Smith  (1978).

* Slope  length  is the horizontal  terrace interval.   The listed values are
  for contour farming.   No  additional  contouring  factor is  used in the
  computation.

* These  values  include  entrapment efficiency and  are used  for control of
  off-site sediment within  limits and  for estimating the field's contribu-
  tion to watershed sediment  yield.

+ Use these values for  control  of interterrace erosion within specified
  soil loss tolerances.
3.4.3                     General  Soil  Properties


     The description of  each  soil  series  should include information on soil
texture,  permeability,  available  water  holding capacity  and the  shrink-
swell potential.   Soil  texture  is an  important consideration in  the  site
selection  process  because  texture influences  many  other  soil  properties,
including  the  infiltration  and  subsoil  percolation  rates  and  aeration.
Table 3.8  presents advantages  and disadvantages of  various  soil  textures
for  use  in land  treatment  units.   In  general, HWLT  units  should not  be
established  on extremely deep,  sandy  soils  because  of  the  potential  for
waste migration to groundwater.  Similarly, silty soils with crusting  prob-
lems  should  not be selected  since  they  have  the  potential  for  excessive
runoff.  Generally,  the soils  best  suited to  land  treatment of  hazardous
waste fall into one of  the  following  categories:    loam,  silt  loam,  clay
loam, sandy  clay loam,  silty clay  loam,  silty clay,  or  sandy  clay.    The
leaching potential of  soils,  discussed  in Section 3.4.4,  depends  greatly on
soil texture.
                                     41

-------
TABLE 3.8  SUITABILITY OF VARIOUS TEXTURED SOILS FOR LAND TREATMENT OF
           HAZARDOUS INDUSTRIAL WASTES
Texture
Advantages
Disadvantages
sand          very rapid infiltration
              usually oxidized & dry
              low runoff potential
loamy sand    high infiltration
              low to medium runoff
loam          moderate infiltration
              fair oxidation
              moderate runoff potential
              generally accessible
              good CEC
silt loam     moderate infiltration
              fair oxidation
              moderate runoff potential
              generally accessible
              good CEC
silt          low infiltration
              fair to poor oxidation
              good CEC
              good available water
silty clay    medium to low percolation
loam          fair structure
              high CEC
silty clay    good to high available
                water

clay loam     medium to low percolation
              good structure
              medium to poor aeration
              high CEC
              high available water
clay          low percolation
              high CEC
              high available water


sandy clay    medium to low percolation
              medium to high CEC

sandy clay    medium to high available
  loam          water
              good aeration
                             very low CEC
                             very high hydraulic conductivity
                             low available water
                             poor soil structure

                             low CEC
                             moderate to high hydraulic con-
                               ductivity rate
                             low to medium available water

                             fair structure
                             some crusting
                             fair to poor structure
                             high crusting potential
                             poor structure
                             high runoff

                             medium to low infiltration
                             some crusting potential

                             moderate runoff
                             often wet
                             fair oxidation
                             medium to low infiltration
                             moderate to high runoff
                             often wet
                             low infiltration
                             often massive structure
                             high runoff
                             sometimes low aeration

                             fair structure
                             moderate to high runoff
                             medium infiltration
                                     42

-------
     Permeability  of  each horizon  or  zone  should  be determined  by  the
methods  discussed  in  Section  4.1.1.5,  from available  soil  surveys of  the
area, or  by  the methods listed in other sources  (Bouwer,  1978; Bouwer  and
Jackson,  1974;  Linsley et  al.,  1975).   Permeability  is  an  indication of  the
length of time  the mobile  constituents  of  the waste  will remain in  the soil
(Sommers  et  al.,  1978),  and  thus,  Is  an  indicator of the  potential  for
groundwater  contamination.  High  permeabilities of 2.5  cm/hr  indicate  rapid
transmission of  water  associated  with wastes and thus  a high potential  for
groundwater  contamination.  The  permeability of  lower horizons  influences
the amount of water  that will  remain  In the surface  horizon following  rain-
fall or  irrigation.   A textural  discontinuity  from  coarse texture to fine
texture  or  vice  versa will  result  in  greater  amounts  of  water   being
retained  above  the discontinuity than  would be  retained in a  deep uniform
profile,  thus resulting in wetter conditions than would otherwise be expec-
ted.  Permeabilities of less than 0.05  cm/hr for the most  restrictive  layer
in the top 1 m  of  soil may require artificial drainage.

     Available  water holding  capacity  (AWC) is a  measure  of  the amount of
water held  against the pull  of  gravity.   High AWC  reduces  the chance  of
runoff under high  antecedent moisture  conditions  by permitting more  mois-
ture to be held.   Water holding capacity also affects  the amount of leach-
Ing.  The higher the AWC  the lower  the chances  for  rapid contamination of
groundwater.  For  example, a  medium textured soil, when dry  enough so that
plants begin to wilt,   with an  AWC  of  15-20% can  adsorb 20-30 cm  of  water
from sludge, wastewater or rainfall  In the upper 1.5 m of the  soil profile
before transmitting  the water  to  an  underlying  aquifer  (Hall  et al.,  1976).
Acceptable values  for  the  AWC  of  the  top 1.5 m of the  profile  would be  7.5
to  20  cm for   humid  regions  and no   less  than  7.5 cm  for   arid regions
(Sommers  et  al., 1978).

     Shrink-swell  potential, especially in montmorillonitic  clay soils,  can
increase  groundwater contamination hazard  due  to  formation of  cracks  deep
in the soil  during extended periods  of dry weather.   Soils  with a low to
moderate  shrink-swell  potential are  preferred  for.HWLT.


3.4.4                       Leaching Potential


     Based  on  the  minimum infiltration rate of  bare  soil after  prolonged
wetting  the  SCS has developed  a classification  system which  divides  the
soils into four  hydrologic groups,  A through D (USDA,  1971).   These  groups
indicate  the potential for water to  flow through the  entire  soil  profile.
They may  also be used  as  an  indicator  for  the transmission of  contaminants
through the  soil.   Hydrologic  Group A  consists mainly  of  sands and gravels
that are  well drained, have high infiltration  rates  and high  rates  of  water
transmission.   The greatest  leaching potential is with Group A soils.  The
danger from leaching  is  highest with  deep sandy soils which  may connect
with shallow aquifers. These  soils  have low cation  exchange  capacity (CEC)
and high  infiltration  and hydraulic conductivity and will not  be as  effec-
tive  in   filtering  water   as will a  finer soil with  a  higher  CEC,  lower
infiltration and lower hydraulic conductivity  (Groups B and C).


                                     43

-------
      Group B  soils  are moderately  deep to  deep,  moderately well  to well
 drained, and moderately  fine  to moderately  coarse in texture.   They have
 moderate infiltration  rates  and water  transmission rates.   Group  C soils
 are moderately fine to fine textured  soils with  a layer  that impedes down-
 ward water movement.  Both infiltration rates  and water  transmission rates
 are slow in this group.

      Group D soils have the lowest  leaching  potential  and  one will need to
 be very  cautious in  applying  liquids  to avoid  excessive  runoff  because
 these soils have very slow rates of infiltration and transmission.  Group D
 soils are  generally  clays with high  swelling  potential,  soils  with  a
 permanent high  water table,  soils with  a  claypan near  the  surface,  or
 shallow  soils over nearly impervious materials.

      Leaching of applied  wastes can be minimized by good design and manage-
 ment.  High  volume  applications of  liquid  effluent to  sandy  soil  may be
 permissible only if  there is  no evidence of  leaching or groundwater contam-
 ination   by  mobile  constituents  such  as  nitrates  or   mobile  organic
 compounds.   In most  cases, soils in hydrologic Group C,  or possibly D, are
 best  suited for the  land  treatment  of hazardous wastes.

      Soil structure  as  well   as  texture influences  the  leaching  of  waste
 constituents.   If an organic  waste  is  applied  to a soil via irrigation or
 if  the waste  contains a high  percentage of liquids,  soils  with very porous
 structure (such as crumb) or  a high  percentage of pore space to  soil par-
 ticles  (low bulk density) have  a  high  leaching  potential.    Leaching  is
 increased in  these soils  because the detention  time of the  organic waste in
 the  soil is decreased and the surface area  of  soil particles available to
 react with the  waste  is   also  decreased.   Leaching  of  this  nature  can be
 expected  when  the moisture holding  capacity  of  the soil is  exceeded.
3.4.5                           Horizonation
     Surface  soil characteristics  alone  are not  sufficient to  assess  the
suitability  of a site  for land  treatment  of hazardous  waste.   Many soil
profiles  have properties which make  them a poor  choice  for use as  a dis-
posal  facility.   The specific properties  that  need to be  examined include
the  depth to  bedrock,  an impermeable  layer  and/or the  groundwater  table,
and  the presence  of  an  inadequate textural  sequence within the soil.

     The  profile  depth to bedrock  should be approximately  three times  the
depth  of  the waste  incorporation or  1.2 m (6 ft),  whichever  is  greater.
Soils  having  an  impermeable layer or  a deep  groundwater table  may be well
suited  to HWLT.   If an impermeable  layer is  present,  it  should  be at  a
depth  of  1.5 m  or  greater to allow sufficient soil  profile to treat  the
waste.   Although data  is available  on which to  base estimates of  needed
profile  depth to the  groundwater  table  for  nontoxic  sludges  (Parizek,
                                    44

-------
1970), none  is  available for hazardous waste.   Certainly, further work is
needed to clarify these  needs.  The presence  of  a  sand  or  loam  layer  in the
profile, within 3 m of the surface, overlying a  fine  textured clay  pan also
creates  a potential  for  horizontal  flow and  contamination  of  adjacent
areas.   Such a  profile  is thus unsuited for  use as a hazardous waste dis-
posal medium without special precautions.

     While deep  soils  of relatively uniform  physical and chemical charac-
teristics  are occasionally  found,  more often  soils are  characterized by
distinct horizons which differ in  texture,  water  retention, permeability,
CEG and  chemical characteristics.  Appendix C lists the major horizons that
may be  present  in a soil.   Most  of the biological activity  and the waste
decomposition is  accomplished in  the  treatment zone which  may  range from
several  inches to one foot.  Therefore, the characteristics of  this horizon
will  be  an important design consideration.   Lower horizons will influence
the rate of  downward  water movement  and may  serve to  filter and  remove
other waste  constituents or their degradation  products which  would  other-
wise move below these depths.

     There are  advantages to  selecting soils which  have coarser  textural
surface  horizons  over  those with fine  textured  slowly  permeable surface
materials.   Such soils will generally have  greater  infiltration  rates  and
may be  easier to work  and incorporate large amounts  of  waste  than  those
with  clay  surfaces.  A clay subsoil  will,  however, slow the movement  of
leachate  and protect groundwater.   When  such  soils are  selected,  it  is
essential  that  water retaining  levees are  keyed  into  the less  permeable
subsurface materials.
3,5                      GEOTECHNICAL DESCRIPTION
     A  geotechnical description which  characterizes the  subsurface condi-
tions at the site  should  be prepared during the site assessment.   The fac-
tors that  need  to  be evaluated are  the groundwater depths  and  flow direc-
tions,  existing wells,  springs, and  other water supplies,  and other activi-
ties located  near  the  facility  boundaries that might  affect or  come into
contact with  the groundwater.  Any nearby sources  of  potential  groundwater
pollution  other than the  HWLT unit  should also be  considered.   All data
should  be  compiled  on  a  map to  assess  the  subsurface  conditions  at  the
site.

     Some  estimate of the  groundwater recharge zone needs to be made during
the  site  assessment.   Whenever possible,  it  is  desirable to  locate HWLT
units over areas with an  isolated  body of groundwater.   If this  is not pos-
sible,  estimates of mixing between  aquifers  which may be  impacted need to
be made.
                                     45

-------
3.5.1                      Subsurface Hydrology
     Hydrologic  characteristics of the  soil  and subsoil  govern the speed
and direction  of fluid movement through  the  soil.   Surface and subsurface
hydrology are  interrelated processes which are very important in evaluating
the feasibility  of  using  a given site for HWLT.  The  depth of  soil to the
seasonal water table is an important  factor  for judging potential ground-
water contamination.   The  soils at the site  should be deep enough so that
the desired  degree  of treatment is  attained within the  treatment zone so
that  hazardous constituents  do not percolate  through the  soil and reach
groundwater.   Shallow  soils especially over karst formations and those with
a  sand  classification have  a  high  potential  for  transmitting  hazardous
wastes to groundwater. The  maximum depth of the  treatment zone  should be
1.5 m and at least  1 m (3 ft)  above the  seasonal high water table to pre-
vent contamination  of  the  water table with untreated waste, and to provide
sufficient soil  aeration  to  allow microbial treatment  and degradation of
hazardous wastes, and  to  provide room to install an unsaturated zone moni-
toring system.
3.5.2                      Groundwater Hydrology
     Water  table  data are needed  to position  upgradient  and downgradient
monitoring  wells  and to determine  if the water  table is so  close to the
surface that it will interfere with  land treatment.  The depth of the water
table  tends to vary with  surface topography  and is  usually  shallower in
relatively  impermeable  soils than in permeable soils.   Since local water
table  depths  and gradients  cannot  be accurately  estimated  from available
regional data, it may be necessary  to install observation wells at various
locations within  and surrounding the land treatment  area.   Sampling  fre-
quency of these observation  wells  should be chosen to account for  seasonal
changes.  If care  is taken in locating  and  properly installing these  ini-
tial  observation  wells,  future  groundwater  monitoring can  use  these  same
wells, minimizing  the requirement and  cost of additional  well placement.
Torrey (1979)  recommends  collection  and analysis  of  three  monthly samples
from  each   well  prior to  waste  application  at new  sites.    For  existing
sites,  only the  upgradient  well is useful  for  establishing  background
values.  More information on groundwater monitoring can be found in Chapter
9.
3.5.3                       Groundwater Quality


     Current uses of  groundwater  in the area should  also  be noted.  Where
state regulations vary based on  the  current or  potential  uses of ground-
water, groundwater  quality may be  an  important  concern during site selec-
tion.  Information  on groundwater quality,  available from the U.S.  Geolo-
gical Survey and state agencies,  can  be used for preliminary site  investi-

-------
gations, but site specific  background quality  data  are  needed  for  each  HWLT
unit.
3.6                       SOCIO-GEOGRAPHIC  FACTORS
     Land use  considerations  generally have little impact on the  technical
grounds  for  site selection.  Instead,  land use encompasses the  restraints
imposed  by the public and local or regional  governmental  authorities  on  the
use of  a parcel of land  for  HWLT.   Occasionally  past  land use  diminishes
the ability  to manage the area as an HWLT unit.  For  example, areas former-
ly used  for  landfills or areas contaminated with persistent residues from
past chemical spills are  likely to be  unsuitable for  HWLT units.

     Evaluation  of land use at and near  a proposed or existing HWLT unit is
primarily the responsibility  of the  owner  or operator.    There are a  number
of  legal constraints  that  affect  facility  siting.   Factors  to consider
include  zoning restrictions,  special ecological areas, historic or archaeo-
logical  sites,  and endangered species habitats.   Local,  state and federal
laws concerning  these factors will affect  the siting of  an HWLT unit.   The
proximity of the unit  to  the waste generator and  the accessibility  of  the
site both  affect the transportation requirements.  Ideally, a land  treat-
ment  operation  would  be  located  on-site   or immediately  adjacent  to  the
waste generator.  If wastes  must be  transported  to  an  off-site HWLT unit
via public roads,  rail  systems  or other means, the transporter must  comply
with 40  CFR  Part 263, under  the  jurisdiction of  the EPA,  and  49 CFR Sub-
chapter  C, enforceable  by the Department of Transportation.  The operator
may  also want  to route  the waste  through  industrial   areas  rather than
through  residential neighborhoods.

     In  addition to the  legal  constraints  to  be considered,  there  are  a
number of social factors  which  must  often  be dealt with  during the evalua-
tion of  proposed sites.  How  the  owner or operator handles these  issues  may
determine whether  the  public accepts or rejects  the location of the unit.
Social  factors  may include wooded  areas and  bodies  of  water  that  may  be
important visually or  for recreational purposes,  prime agricultural  lands,
existing neighborhoods,  etc.   Although facility  design  should  strive  to
prevent  deterioration  of  local   resources  while  maximizing   public   and
environmental  protection,  the possibility  for conflict  exists  since most
sites are  less  than ideal  and  are  often  situated near  populated  areas
or in zones  of  high  growth potential.   Some potential  areas  of conflict
include:

     (1)  proximity  of  the site  to  existing or  planned  community or
          industrial developments;

     (2)  zoning restrictions;

     (3)  effects on the  local economy;  and

     (4)  relocation of residents.

                                    47

-------
     Socio-geographic  considerations and  interactions  with the  public  are
beyond  the scope  of  this  manual,  except  for the  above  discussion  which
points  out  the  importance of including  the public in  the  permitting  proc-
ess.  It is the responsibility  of  the  owner or operator to  maintain an open
and credible  dialogue  with local public officials and  with individuals  who
will be directly  affected  by the  HWLT unit.   The  role of  the EPA  in this
respect is simply  to assess whether  the  plans, as proposed, are technically
and environmentally sound.
                                    48

-------
                            CHAPTER 3 REFERENCES
 Bouwer,  H.  1978.  Groundwater hydrology.  McGraw - Hill Book Company,  New
 York.  480 p.

 Bouwer,  H., and R.  D.  Jackson.  1974. Determining soil properties, p. 611-
 673. In.  Tom Van Schilfgaarde (ed.) Drainage for agriculture.  Number 17,
 Agron. Soc. Amer. Madison,  Wisconsin.

 Brown, K. W.,  K.  C.  Donnelly, J.  C.  Thomas, and L.  E. Deuel,  Jr. 1980.
 Factors  influencing  the biodegradation of API separator sludges applied to
 soils. Final report  to EPA.  Grant No. R  805474-10.

 Cartwright, K., R. H.  Gilkeson,  and  T. M. Johnson.  1981. Geological consid-
 erations  in hazardous  waste  disposal. Journal of Hydrology, 54:357-369.

 Dibble,  J. T.,  and R.  Bartha. 1979.  Effect of environmental parameters on
 the biodegradation of  oil  sludge. Appl.  and Environ.  Micro. 37:729-739.

 EPA. 1975. Evaluation  of land application systems.  EPA 430/9-75-001.

 EPA. 1977. Process design manual  for land treatment of municipal waste-
 water. EPA 625/1-77-008. PB  299-665/1BE.

 EPA. 1981. Standards for owners  and  operators of hazardous waste treatment,
 storage,  and disposal  facilities. Federal Register  Vol. 46, No. 7, p. 2848.
 January  12, 1981.

 EPA. 1982. Standards for owners  and  operators of hazardous waste treatment,
 storage,  and disposal  facilities. Federal Register  Vol. 47, No. 143, p.
 32350. July 26, 1982.

Hall,  G.  F., L. P. Wilding,  and A. E. Erickson. 1976. Site selection
 considerations  for sludge and wastewater application  on agricultural land.
^Application  of sludges and wastewaters on agricultural lands: A planning
 and educational guide.  (Research  Bulletin 1090) B.  D. Knezek  and R.  H.
Miller (eds.) Ohio Agricultural Research and Development Center, Wooster,
 Ohio.

Linsley, R. K. Jr., M.  A. Kohler, and J. L. H.  Paulhus. 1975.  Hydrology for
engineers. McGraw - Hill Inc., New York. 482 p.

Loehr, R. C., W.  J. Jewell,  J. D. Novak, W. W.  Clarkson, and  G. S. Fried-
man. 1979. Land application  of wastes, Vol. 1.  Van  Nostrand Reinhold Envi-
ronmental Engineering  Series, New York.  308 p.

Panofsky, H. A.,  and G.  W. Brier. 1958.  Some applications of  statistics to
meteorology. The  Pennsylvania State  Univ. Press. University  Park, Pennsyl-
vania.  224 p.
                                    49

-------
Parizek,  R. R»  and B. E.  Lane,  1970.  Soil-water  sampling using  pan  and depp
pressure-vacuum lysimeters. J.  of Hydrology 11:1-21.

Scanners,  I. E.,  R. C. Fehrmann, H. L.  Selznlck,  and C. E. Pound.  1978.
Principles and  design criteria  for sewage  sludge application on land.  Pre-
pared  for U.S.  EPA, Environmental Research Information Center Seminar
entitled  Sludge  Treatment and Disposal.

Torrey, S. 1979. Sludge disposal by landspreading techniques.   Noyes Data
Corp., New Jersey. 372 p.

USDA.  1951. Soil Survey Manual. Handbook No.  18.  Agricultural Research
Administration*  U.S. Government Printing Office,  Washington, D.C.

USDA,  Soil Convervation Service. 1971. SCS national engineering handbook.
Section 4, hydrology. U.S. Government  Printing Office, Washington,  D.C.

Whiting,  D. M.  1976. Use of climatic data  in  estimating storage days for
soils  treatment  systems. U.S. EPA, Ada, Oklahoma. EPA 600/2-76-250. PB
263-597/7BE.

Wlschmeier, W. H., and D. D. Smith. 1978.  Predicting rainfall erosion
losses -  a guide to conservation planning.  U.S. Dept. of Agriculture. Agr.
Handbook  No. 537. 58 p.
                                   50

-------
4.0                             CHAPTER FOUR

                            THE  TREATMENT MEDIUM
     Soil  characterization is  essential  to the  design of  hazardous  waste
land treatment units  since  soil is  the waste treatment medium.  When gener-
ally  acceptable  values  for   the  various  system  properties  are  known,
analyses  may reveal  conditions that  make  land  treatment  unsuitable,  and
consequently,  may  eliminate  a  proposed   site  (Chapter 3).    In  addition,
analysis  of  the  treatment medium will  aid  in  efficiently  designing labora-
tory or field waste treatability experiments.   Preliminary soil characteri-
zation can be used  for  the  following:

     (1)  to  choose  the  soil  parameters  to be  studied that  will be
          most important  in waste treatment;

     (2)  to determine  the  practical  range of  these parameters and the
          specific  levels  at  which  tests  will  be made;

     (3)  to choose the extremes to be measured; and

     (4)  to  provide  background  data for comparison against  later
          sampling  results.

     Many  of  the processes  that occur in soils  that  treat  the  waste and
render it less hazardous  are  the same  processes that are used in Industrial
waste  treatment   plants.    Table 4.1  lists soil  treatment  processes that
are  similar  to  the categories  of  treatment  to  be  used  by  industries  in
describing their  processes  (from Appendix I of 40 CFR  Part 264).


TABLE 4.1  TREATMENT  PROCESSES OF SOIL IN A LAND  TREATMENT UNIT


     Absorption                                Flocculation
     Chemical fixation                         Thickening
     Chemical oxidation                       Blending
     Chemical precipitation                   Distillation
     Chemical reduction                       Evaporation
     Degradation                               Leaching
     Detoxification                           Liquid ion exchange
     Ion  exchange                             Liquid-liquid extraction
     Neutralization                           Aerobic  treatment
     Photolysis                                Anaerobic treatment
     Filtration
     The  treatment medium is  a part  of  the larger  system including  soil,
plants  and atmosphere.   Plants and  atmospheric conditions  can modify  the
processes  occurring  in  the  treatment medium.    Plants  can  protect  the
treatment  zone  from the adverse effects of wind and water.  Plants may also
take up water and  waste constituents and,  if not harvested, supply the soil.

                                     51

-------
with additional  organic matter.   Atmospheric conditions control  the  water
content  and   temperature   of  the  soil  and   consequently   affect   waste
degradation  rates  and  constituent  mobility.    The modifying  effects  of
plants  and  atmosphere are  briefly discussed.   Figure 4.1 illustrates  how
the  information  presented  in  this  chapter  fits into  the overall  design
process for HWLT  units  (Fig.  2.1).


4.1                            SOIL PROPERTIES
     Soil  characterization is  commonly  done by  conducting  a  soil  survey,
either  in conjunction  with the  Soil  Conservation  Service   (SCS)  or  by  a
certified  professional   soil   scientist  (Section  3.4.1).     In  such  an
endeavor,  the  soil  series  present at  a  given  site  are  identified  and
sampled.   Soil  series are  generally  named for  locations and  are  based on
both  physical  and  chemical  characteristics.    These  characteristics  vary
widely  from  place  to  place, and classification  distinguishes  one soil from
another based on recognized limits  in  soil  properties.
4.1,1                        Physical  Properties


     Physical  properties of  a  soil are  defined as  those  characteristics,
processes or reactions  of  a soil  that are caused by physical forces and are
described by physical  terms or  equations.  Physically,  a mineral soil is a
porous  mixture of inorganic  particles, decaying  organic matter,  air, and
water.  The  percentage of each of  these  components as well  as  the type of
inorganic and  organic  particles determine the behavior of the soil.


4.1.1.1  Particle Size  Distribution
     Particle  size distribution  is  a measure  of the  amounts  of inorganic
soil separates  (particles  < 2 mm) in a  soil.   This  property  Is most often
called soil texture and  is  probably  the  most important physical property of
the soil.   The USDA  (United  States  Department of  Agriculture) classifica-
tion is  generally accepted and used by agricultural  workers,  soil scien-
tists, and most  of the current literature.  The  USCS (Unified Soil Classi-
fication System) was  developed for engineers and is based on particle size
distribution as  influenced by the overall  physical  and chemical properties
of the soil.   A comparison of  the two  systems  is given in  Table  4.2.   The
standard methods  used to measure particle  size distribution are the hydro-
meter and pipette  methods  as  described  by Day (1965).
                                     52

-------

         WASTE
        (POTENTIAL
        I   SITE
                                           CHARACTERIZATION OF THE

                                               TREATMENT MEDIUM
                                                 CHAPTER FOUR	
[PHYSICAL
[PROPERTIES
§4.
1
.1

CHEMICAL
PROPERTIES
§4-
1
.2

BIOLOGICAL
PROPERTIES
§4.
1
.3






                                               HAS THE SOIL BEEN
                                          ADEQUATELY  CHARACTERIZED TO"
                                            TO PROVIDE DATA FOR PILOT
                                          STUDIES AND DESIGN OF THE
                                                  HWLT UNIT?

                                                 (SECTION 4.1)
                                                        yes
                       ASK FOR
                       FURTHER
                       INFORMATION
  HAVE THE MODIFICATIONS
TO THE TREATMENT MEDIUM BY
PLANTS AND THE ATMOSPHERE
     BEEN CONSIDERED?
  (SECTIONS 4.2 AND 4.3)
 CHARACTERIZATION OF THE
     WASTE STREAM
     CHAPTER FIVE
     FATE OF WASTE
CONSTITUENTS IN THE HWLT
  SYSTEM   CHAPTER SIX
              yes
                                  T
  Figure 4.1.  Characterization of  the treatment medium for HtfLT,
                                 53

-------
 TABLE 4.2  CORRESPONDING USDA AND USCS SOIL CLASSIFICATIONS*

                                                Corresponding  Unified  Soil
 United States Department of Agriculture       Classification  System (USCS)
          (USDA) Soil Textures                           Soil Types
  1.   Gravel,  very gravelly loamy sand                   GP, GW,  GM
  2.   Sand,  coarse sand, fine sand                       SP, SW
  3.   Loamy  gravel, very gravelly sandy                  GM
      loam,  very gravelly loam
  4.   Loamy  sand, gravelly loamy sand,                   SM
      very fine sand
  5.   Gravelly loam, gravelly sandy clay                 GM, GC
      loam
  6.   Sandy  loam, fine sandy loam, loamy                 SM
      very fine sand, gravelly sandy
      loam
  7.   Silt loam,  very fine sandy clay loam               ML
  8.   Loam,  sandy clay loam                              ML, SC
  9.   Silty  clay loam, clay loam                         CL
 10.   Sandy  clay, gravelly clay loam,                    SC, GC
      gravelly clay
 11.   Very gravelly clay loam, very                      GC
      gravelly sandy clay loam, very
      gravelly silty clay loam, very
      gravelly silty clay and clay
 12.   Silty  clay, clay                                   CH
 13.   Muck and peat                                      PT
 * Fuller  (1978).
     The  three  dominant soil particles  are  sand, silt  and  clay.   Sand  and
gravel  particles  are the  coarse  separates.    Coarse  textured soils  usually
have low water  holding  capacity,  good drainage, high permeability  and  aera-
tion, and generally  have  a loose  and friable structure.  Sand grains may be
rounded  or  irregular  depending   on the   amount  of   abrasion  they   have
received.  They do not  have the capacity to be molded  (plasticity) as  does
clay.
     The  silt  and clay particles  are the  fine separates.   Silt  particles
are  irregularly  fragmental,  have  some  plasticity,  and  are predominantly
composed of quartz.   A  high percentage  of silt is  undesirable  and leads to
physical  problems such  as  soil  crusting.   Clay particles  are  very smalli
less than 0.002  mm  in diameter,  and therefore have  a very  high  surface

                                     54

-------
area.  Clays are plate-like, highly plastic,  cohesive,  and have a very high
adsorptive capacity for water,  ions and  gases.  This high adsorptive  capac-
ity may  be very useful to hold ions, such as  heavy metals,  in an immobile
form and prevent their movement.

     The USDA has  devised  a method for naming soils based on particle size
analysis.   The relationship between  textural analysis  and  class names  is
shown  in Pig.  4.2 and is  often referred to as a  textural  triangle.   When
the percentages  of at least two size separates are known,  the name  of  the
compartment where  the  two  lines intersect is  the textural class name  of  the
soil being evaluated.
4.1.1.2  Soil Structure
     Soil structure is  the grouping  of  soil  particles  of  a general  size and
shape into  aggregates,  called pads.   Structure generally  varies  in differ-
ent  soil  horizons and  is greatly influenced  by  soil  texture and  organic
matter content.   The  arrangement of  the primary soil  separates  greatly in-
fluences water  movement, aeration,  porosity and  bulk density  (Pritchett,
1979).  Addition  of organic matter and  the use  of  sod  crops helps build and
maintain good soil  structure.  Other factors which  promote aggregation in-
clude 1) wetting  and  drying,  2) freezing and  thawing, 3)  soil  tillage,  4)
physical activity of  plant roots and soil organisms, 5) influence of decay-
ing  organic  matter,  and 6)  the modifying effects   of  adsorbed  cations
(Brady, 1974).  Sandy soils need to  be  held  together,  into granules, by the
cementing action  of organic  matter  to  stabilize  the  soil surface  and in-
crease water  retention.  Fine  textured soils  also  need  adequate structure
to aid in water and air movement  in  the soil.   Some types of  organic waste
additions may help  soil structure by increasing aggregation.

     Four primary types  of  soil  structure  are recognized:   platy,  prism-
like, block-like  and spheroidal.   All  structural types  except  platy have
two  subtypes  each.    Subgroups  for  the  prism-like Structure  are, prismatic
and  columnar; for block-like,  cube-like  blocky and subangular  blocky;  and
for  spheroidal, granular and  crumb.   The names of the  categories imply the
form or shape of  the aggregates, with  crumb being  the smallest structural
aggregate.  Two or  more of  the structural conditions may  exist  in the same
soil, for example,  a soil may have  a granular  surface horizon with a sub-
surface horizon that  is subangular blocky.

     Porosity and pore   size  distribution are  related   to  soil  structure as
well as soil  texture.  Nonaggregated (poor  structured) fine-textured soils
have small  pores  with a  narrow range of pore  sizes.   Nonaggregated coarse
textured soils have large pores also with a narrow range of pore sizes.  An
intermediate  situation   is  desirable in  soils  chosen  for  land  treatment,
such as  a  soil with  texture  to  give  several  pore  sizes  as  well  as good
structure for a wide  distribution of sizes.
                                    55

-------
                    100,
        AX\A
        \ «**\ v\   /
                 PERCENT SAND
Figure 4.2. Textural triangle of soil particle size separates.
         Shown is an example of a soil with 35% silt,  30%
         clay and 30% sand, which is classified as a clay
         loam.
                    56

-------
4.1.1.3  Bulk Density


     Bulk  density  is  a weight measurement  in which  the  entire soil volume
is taken into consideration.   It  is defined as the mass of a unit volume of
soil  and  is  generally  expressed  as gm/cm^  (lb/ft^).    This measurement
takes into account  both  the volume  of the soil particles and the pore space
between them.   Techniques for measuring  bulk  density are outlined by Blake
(1965).

     Soils that  are loose and porous will have low weights per unit volume,
and thus,  low bulk densities.  Soils  that  are more  compact  will have high
bulk  density values.    Soil  bulk  density generally increases  with depth
because  there is less organic  matter and  less  aggregation  with depth and
greater soil compression due  to  the weight of overlying soil.  Bulk density
is also  influenced  by soil texture  and  structure.   Sandy  soils  which have
particles  that  are  close together,  that  is,  have  poor structure, have high
bulk densities  usually in the range  of  1.20  to  1.80  g/cm3.   Fine textured
soils generally  have  a higher organic content,  better structure, more pore
space and  thus, lower  bulk   densities.   Bulk densities for  fine textured
soils generally  range  from 1.0 to 1.6 g/cm^ (Brady, 1974).

     Good  soil   management procedures will decrease surface  bulk density
because the factors that build and  maintain good soil structure will gener-
ally  increase  with  management.    Conversely,  intensive  cultivation  and
excessive  traffic  by  equipment  generally increases bulk  density values.
Land treatment  management should minimize  unnecessary tillage and traffic,
and  maximize structural  formation through  organic  matter  additions  and
vegetative covers.   Good  structure and  relatively  low soil bulk  densities
promote  good aeration and drainage, which  are  desirable  conditions  for
waste treatment.
4.1.1.4  Moisture Retention
     Moisture  retention or  moisture holding  capacity  is a  measure of  the
amount  of water  a  given  soil  is  capable  of  retaining and  is generally
expressed  as  a weight  percentage.   The most  common method  of expressing
soil moisture percentage is  grams  of water associated with 100 grams of  dry
soil.   Soil tensions  from  the  strong  chemical  attraction  of  polar water
molecules  are   responsible  for  the adsorption  of  pure water  in  a soil.
Water  commonly  considered  to  be  available  for  plant and microbial use  is
held at tensions  between 1/3 and 15 atm.  This  water is retained in capil-
lary or extremely small soil pores.   Moisture  retained  at tensions greater
than  1/3  atm   is  termed  gravitational  or  superfluous  water  (Fig.  4.3).
Gravitational water  moves  freely in the  soil  and  generally  drains  to lower
portions  of  the  profile   carrying  with  it  a  fraction  of  plant nutrients
and/or waste constituents.  After  all water has drained from the large soil
pores  and  the  water is held in the  soil at 1/3  atm the soil  is  at field
capacity.   Moisture  retained at  tensions  greater than  15 atm  is termed
unavailable or  hygroscopic water because it is  held too tightly to be used

                                     57

-------
100
Wilting Point - 15 Atms. Field Capacity - 1/3 Atms. Pore S|
1 /
HYGRO.
WATER
CAPILLARY
WATER
1 A J
AIR SPACE AND
DRAINAGE WATER
\^ J
o/
/o
Dace
Ln
00
UNAVAILABLE
   WATER
                                    AVAILABLE
                                      WATER
SUPERFLUOUS
    WATER
                     Figure 4.3. Schematic representation of the relationship
                                of  the various forms of soil moisture to plants
                                (Buckman and Brady, 1960).  Reprinted by permission
                                of  the Macmillan Publishine Co., Inc.

-------
 by  plants.   A  soil  is  said to be  at  the permanent wilting point  when the
 water  is held at >15 atm.   Generally, finer textured high  organic content
 soils  will retain  the  most water  while sandy,  low organic  content  soils
 will retain  only very small amounts of available water.

     For management  of  a  land  treatment unit,  knowledge of  the  moisture
 retention of  the soil is needed to help  determine  water  loading rates that
 will not cause  flooding  or standing water, to  predict  possible irrigation
 needs,  and to estimate  leaching losses and downward migration of waste con-
 stituents.   At a minimum, the  values for 1/3 and 5  atm of suction should be
 measured to  give  an estimation  of how  much  water will be  available  for
 plant  and soil chemical  reactions.   Moisture retention  can be measured by
 the pressure  plate  technique as outlined by Richards (1965).
4.1.1.5   Infiltration,  Hydraulic Conductivity and Drainage
     Infiltration  is  the  entry of  water into  the soil  surface,  normally
measured  in cm/hr.   Knowledge  of this  parameter is  critical  for  a land
treatment  unit  since application of a liquid  at  rates  exceeding the infil-
tration rate will  result in runoff and erosion,  both of  which are undesir-
able in such a  system.   Infiltration rates are also needed when calculating
the water  balance  of an area.

     Permeability,  also  called hydraulic  conductivity,   is  the  ease with
which  a  fluid  or gas  can pass through the  soil, and is  measured  in  cm/hr.
Once a substance enters a soil, its movement  is  governed, in part, by soil
permeability.   Permeability is closely associated  with particle size, pore
space, and bulk density.  Table 4.3 lists  the classes  of hydraulic conduc-
tivity for soils.    Fine textured  clays  with  poor structure  and  high bulk
densities  usually  have  very low permeabilities.   Knowledge  of  the permea-
bility is  necessary to estimate the rate  of movement of  water or potential
pollutants through  the soil of the land  treatment  unit.   The potential for
a given chemical to alter the  permeability of the soils on-site needs to be
determined as a safeguard to prevent deep leaching and reduce the potential
for groundwater contamination.

     Hydraulic  conductivity (K) is  conventionally measured  in  the labora-
tory by either  the  constant head or falling head techniques  as outlined by
Klute  (1965).   For  more exact, on-site determinations,  field techniques are
available. If  the  soil is above the water  table,  the  double tube or "per-
ueameter"  method  (Boersma, 1965a)  is  used; if  below  the  water table,  the
auger  hole or the  piezometer method is used  (Boersma,  1965b).  More  exten-
sive reviews  of field  and laboratory methods for  measuring  hydraulic con-
ductivity  are  given  by  the  American  Society  of Agricultural  Engineers
(1961) and Bouma et al. (1982).  These reviews cover most methods currently
vised to measure permeability.

     Drainage refers to the speed and  extent  of the removal of water from
the soil by gravitational forces in relation to additions by surface  run-on
or by  internal  flow.   Soil drainage, as a condition  of  a soil,  refers to

                                     59

-------
TABLE 4.3  SATURATED HYDRAULIC  CONDUCTIVITY CLASSES FOR NATIVE SOILS
   Class*
      Saturated
Hydraulic Conductivity*
        cm/hr
            Description
Very high
         >36
High
       3.6-36
Moderate
      0.36 - 3.6
Moderately
  low
     .036 - 0.36
Low
    0.0036 -  0.036
Very low
        <.0036
Soils transmit water downward  so
rapidly that they remain wet for
extremely short periods.   Soils are
coarse textured and dominated  by
coarse rock fragments without
enough fines to fill the voids or
have large permanent cracks or
worm holes.

Soils transmit water downward
rapidly so that they remain satu-
rated for only a few hours.  Soils
are typically coarse textured  with
enough fines to fill the voids in
the coarse material.  Soil pores
are numerous and continuous.

Soils transmit water downward  very
readily so that they remain wet  for
a few days after thorough  wetting.
Soil layers may be massive, granu-
lar, blocky, prismatic  or  weak
platy and contain some  continuous
pores.

Soils transmit water downward  read-
ily so they remain wet  for several
days after thorough wetting.   Soils
may be massive, blocky,  prismatic,
or weakly platy with a  few continu-
ous pores.

Soils transmit water downward  slow-
ly so they remain wet for  a week of
more after a thorough wetting.
Soils are structureless  with fine
and discontinuous pores.

Soils transmit water downward  so
slowly that they remain wet for
weeks after thorough wetting.
Soils are massive, blocky, or  platy
with structural plates  or  blocks
overlapping.  Soil pores are few,
fine, and discontinuous.
* USDA (1981).
                                     60

-------
the frequency  and duration of  periods  of saturation  or  partial  saturation
of the soil profile.   Drainage is a broad concept  that encompasses surface
runoff,  internal soil  drainage,  and  soil  hydraulic  conductivity.   Seven
classes of natural soil  drainage  are  recognized in Table 4.4.  Drainage nay
be controlled  to maintain an  aerobic  environment and  to  minimize leaching
hazards.   Surface drainage can be managed by  diversion structures, surface
contouring, and  ditches  or grassed waterways  to  remove excess water before
it totally saturates  the  soil.   An  understanding  of these  principles is
necessary  since  rainfall and  runoff must be managed  and  directed to appro-
priate  locations.  Subsurface  drainage  systems  use  underground  drains to
remove  water  from the  upper  portion  of  the  soil  profile and can  also be
successfully used to lower the water  table  and  drain the  treatment zone.
Section  8.3 provides  additional  information on  managing  water  at  HWLT
units.
4.1.1.6  Temperature
     Soil temperature  regulates  the rate of many soil chemical and biologi-
cal  reactions.   Most  biological activity  is  greatly reduced at  10°C  and
practically  ceases  at  5°C, as illustrated  in  Fig.  4.4.   Waste degradation
during  the  cool spring  and fall months is  lower  than in  summer  when  the
soil biological activity is at  its  peak.  Thus, loading rates in some  areas
of  the  country need  to  be varied  according  to  the  soil  temperature  on  a
site-specific basis.   In general,  locations  where  soil temperatures are at
or near freezing for much of  the year will need seasonal adjustments in  the
amount  of waste  applied   per  application.    Moreover,   soil temperatures
should  be considered  when estimating  application  rates and  the land area
required  to  treat the  waste.

     Freezing  of  the  soil  also  changes many physical and  chemical  proper-
ties.   Infiltration   and  percolation  are  nearly  stopped  when  soil  water
becomes  frozen so  that  surface waste applications  need  to be  curtailed
(Wooding  and Shipp,  1979).  Subsurface injection of' wastes may be  success-
ful  in  some  cases if  the soil is not frozen  below a 10-15  cm  depth.  Figure
4.5  illustrates  the area of  the country where frost penetration is a con-
sideration.

     Reliable  predictions  of soil  temperature are  needed  for a sound HWLT
management plan, but  there are  few sources of  soil  temperature information.
Only recently have  soil  temperature measurements been taken routinely.  The
owner or  operator  should check  with  the state climatologist  to see  if soil
temperature  data are  available  for the  area  of the  proposed HWLT unit.  The
lack of  extensive  historical records   is  further   complicated  by the fact
that most observations have been only  seasonal as   they related  to  agricul-
tural  needs.   Therefore,  a stochastic approach  to  soil temperatures  in
facility  design is not  possible for most  locations.  No  attempt has been
made to directly  correlate  soil  temperatures  with  atmospheric  parameters
for  which better records exist.
                                     61

-------
      TABLE 4.4  SEVEN CLASSES OP NATURAL  SOIL DRAINAGE
         Class*
         Physical Description
                    Use
      Excessively
       drained
      Somewhat
       excessively
        drained
ro
      Well
       drained
      Moderately
       well
        drained
Water is very rapidly  removed  from the
soil as a result of very  high  hydraulic
conductivity and low water holding
capacity.  Soils are commonly  very
coarse textured, rocky or shallow.  All
soils are free  of mottling related to
wetness.

Water is removed from  the soil rapidly
as a result of  high hydraulic
conductivity and low water holding
capacity.  Soils are commonly  sandy
shallow and steep.  All are free of
mottling related to wetness.

Water is removed from  the soil readily,
not rapidly, and the soils have an
intermediate water holding capacity.
Soils are commonly medium textured and
mainly free of  mottling.
Water is removed  from the soil somewhat
slowly.  Soils  commonly have a layer
with low hydraulic conductivity, a wet
state relatively  high in the profile,
receive large volumes of water, or a
combination  of  these.
Soils are not suited to  crop production
without supplemental irrigation.   Soils  not
suited for land treatment due  to  possible
high leaching of constituents.
Soils are suited for  crop  production  only
with irrigation but yield  will  be  low.
Soils are poorly suited  for  land treatment
due to leaching and low  water holding
capacity.
Soils are well suited  for  crop  production
since water is available through  most  of
the year and wetness does  not  inhibit
growth of roots  for significant periods  of
the year.  Soils  are well  suited  for land
treatment.

Soils are poorly  suited  for  crop  production
without artificial drainage  since free
water remains close enough to  surface  to
limit growth and  management  during short
periods of the year.   Soils  are not well
suited for land  treatment  as a result  of
free water being  at or near  the surface  for
short periods of  time.
                                                   —continued—

-------
      TABLE 4.4  (Continued)
        Class
                          Physical Description
Use
U3
Somewhat        Water is removed slowly enough that the
 poorly         soil  is  wet for significant periods
  drained       during the year.  Soils commonly have a
                slowly pervious layer, a high water
                table, an addition of water from seep-
                page,  nearly continuous rainfall, or a
                combination of  these.

Poorly          Water is removed so slowly that the
 drained        soil  is  saturated for long periods.
                Free  water is commonly at or near the
                surface  but the soil is not contin-
                uously wet directly below plow depth
                (6").  Poor drainage is a result of a
                high  water table, slowly pervious layer
                within the profile, seepage,  continuous
                rainfall or a combination of  these.

Very            Water  is removed so slowly from the
 poorly         soil  that free  water remains  at or
  drained       below  the surface during much of the
                year.  Soils are commonly level or
                depressed and frequently ponded yet in
                areas  with high rainfall they can have
                moderate to high slope gradients.
                                                                  Soils are not suited for  crop production
                                                                  without artificial drainage since  free
                                                                  water remains at or near  the surface  for
                                                                  extended periods.  Soils  are poorly suited
                                                                  for land treatment since  they remain
                                                                  saturated for extended periods.
                                                                  Soils are not suited for production under
                                                                  natural conditions since they remain
                                                                  saturated during much of the year.  Land
                                                                  treatment operations are greatly limited
                                                                  due to free water remaining at or near  the
                                                                  surface for long periods.
                                                                  Soils are suitable for only rice crops
                                                                  since they remain saturated during most of
                                                                  the year.  Soils are not acceptable for
                                                                  land treatment unless artificially drained
                                                                  due to excessive wetness.
      * USDA (1981),

-------
     50r
Q  4O
i
o
liJ
Q
O
CD  2
      0
     10
      0
                       10              20

                           TEMPERATURE (°C)
                                                       30
40
Figure 4.4. Effect of temperature on hydrocarbon biodegradation in oil sludge-treated soil

           (Dibble and Barthi, 1979).  Reprinted by permission of the American Society of

           Microbiology.

-------
                -Depih ot I'rost penlration, inches
Figure 4.5.  Average depth of  frost penetration across
             the United States (Stewart  et  al., 1975).


-------
      Work by Fluker  (1958) is  the  only published  study of  an attempt  to
 predict  the  annual soil temperature cycle.  Fluker presented  a  mathematical
 expression to calculate  soil temperature  at  a  given depth  from  the  mean
 annual  soil  temperature,  as follows:

           ezt -  ava.  annual + 12.Oe~0' 1386zsin [Ui-1.840-0.132z j      (4.1)
                 soil  temp.                      ^364              /

 where

      62t  » the average soil temperature in °C at depth z;
        z  = the depth  in the soil in feet; and
        t  - time  in days after Dec. 31.

      The  average annual  soil  temperature can be  approximated as equal  to,
 or  slightly  higher  than,  the  average  annual  air  temperature.   The  term
 used  to represent  the  change in temperature with depth is 12e~0'*386zg   The
 factor  of  12  is  defined as one-half  the  difference between the maximum and
 minimum  average  soil  temperatures.   Short of  measuring these values,  an
 estimate  can be  obtained  by using  the  difference between  the  maximum  and
 minimum air  temperatures  and adding  20%.   Although the  equation was  devel-
 oped  empirically for a particular locale, the  coefficients may be similar
 for  other sites.   The equation,  however,  should be  used  with  caution,
 particularly  in  extremely cold climates.

      Based  on the  lack of better  predictive  tools  for  soil temperatures,
 one  approach is to  collect data  from  one  year  at  an  on-site recording
 station  and   use it  as a  reasonable approximation   of  future  conditions.
 Since a demonstration  of  waste treatability is required before  an HWLT  unit
 may  be  permitted,  there  would generally  be  time  to  take  soil temperature
 measurements  at  the  10 cm depth.   Climatic records  can be  consulted  for
 guidance  as  to  how the  recorded year  compares  with  other  years;  however,
 site  topography  and other  factors cause  local soil temperature  variations.


 4.1.2                        Chemical Properties
     Chemical  reactions  that occur between  the  soil  and waste constituents
must be considered  for  proper HWLT management.   There are large numbers  of
complex  chemical reactions  and  transformations  which occur  in  the  soil
including exchange  reactions,  sorption and precipitation, and complexation.
By understanding  the  fundamentals of  soil chemistry and the soil components
that control  the reactions,  predictions  can  be made  about  the fate of «
particular  waste in  the  soil.    Fate  of  specific  waste  constituents  is
discussed in more detail  in  Chapter 6.
                                     66

-------
4.1.2.1  Cation Exchange


     Cation  exchange capacity  (CEC) is  the total  amount  of  exchangeable
cations that  a  soil  can sorb and is measured  In msq/100 g  of  soil.   These
cations are bound  on negatively charged sites on  soil  solids  through elec-
trostatic bonding  and are subject  to  interchange with cations  in the soil
solution.  Among  the exchangeable  cations  are  some of  the  essential plant
nutrients including  calcium, magnesium,  sodium,  potassium, ammonium, alumi-
num, iron and hydrogen.   In  addition to these,  the  soil  can also sorb non-
essential cations  and effectively remove and retain heavy metals (Brown et
al,, 1975).   The  CEC depends on the amount  of  specific  types  of clay,  the
amount and chemical  nature  of  the organic matter  fraction,  and the soil pH
(Overcash  &  Pal,  1979).   The  cation  exchange  reactions  take  place very
rapidly and are usually reversible  (Bohn et al., 1979).

     Cation  exchange capacity  Is  associated  with  the  negatively charged
surface  of  the soil colloids  which arises  from isomorphic  substitutions
(e.g.,  A13+  for  Si 4+)  in  many  layer  silicate  minerals.    The  total
charge  of  soil colloids  consists  of  a permanent charge as  well  as  a pH
dependent  charge.    All  cations,  however,  are  not retained  on  the soil
colloid to  the  same  degree.   Usually,  trivalent  and  divalent  cations  are
more tightly  held than monovalent  cations  with the exception of hydrogen
(H+) ions.   Also,  ions  are lass  tightly held  as the degree  of hydration
increases 
-------
 decompose organic  residues,  resulting  in  the evolution  of carbon  dioxide
 (C02).   Figure 4.6 illustrates the carbon cycle.

      The effect of organic  matter on the physical  properties of  soils  has
 already been discussed.   It  improves soil  structure by increasing aggrega-
 tion,  reduces plasticity  and  cohesion,  increases the infiltration rate  and
 water holding capacity, and imparts  a dark  color to the soil.   The organic
 fraction of  the soil has  a very  high CEC,  and consequently, increasing  the
 organic  matter  content   of  a  soil  also  increases  the  CEC.     However,
 increases in organic carbon  from large  waste applications  cannot  be  relied
 upon to  provide  long-term  increases in soil sorption  capacity  since  the
 organic matter decomposes over time  and ultimately, the organic content  of
 the  soil will  return  to  near  the original  concentration.   Measurement  of
 the  amount of  soil  organic  matter is normally done by  using the  Walkley-
 Black method as outlined  by Allison  (1965).

     Native  soil  organic  matter is comprised  of humic substances Which have
 a  large influence on  the  soil chemistry.   Soil  organic  matter exhibits  a
 high degree  of pH-dependent  affinity for cations in solution by  a variety
 of  complexation  reactions.   Humic  substances with  high  molecular  weights
 complex with  metals  to   form  very  insoluble  precipitates,  however,   low
 molecular weight  organic  acids  have high  solubility  in  association with
 metals.   A  discussion of  the reaction of   organic matter  with metals  is
 found in Chapter  6.
4.1.2.3   Nutrients
     There  are  sixteen elements  essential  for plant  growth.   Of  these,
carbon  (C),  hydrogen  (%),  and  oxygen  (0£)   are  supplied  from  air  and
water, leaving  the  soil to supply the other thirteen.   Six  of  the  essential
elements, nigrogen  (N), phosphorus (P), potassium (K),  calcium (Ca),  magne-
sium  (Mg),  and  sulfur  (S),  are  required  in  relatively  large   amounts.
Nitrogen, F and K are considered primary plant nutrients while  Ca,  Mg and  S
are referred  to as  secondary plant nutrients.

     All  three  of  the  primary  plant  nutrients (N,  P and  K)  are  normally
included  in  inorganic fertilizers.  Nitrogen  Is of  prime importance  since,
if  deficient,  it  causes  plants   to  yellow  and  exhibit  stunted growth.
Nitrogen  deficiencies  also greatly  inhibit  the  degradation  of  hazardous
organic wastes  because  N is also essential  for  microorganisms.  If N is in
excess, it  is  readily  converted to nitrate  (NC^) which is  a uobile  anion
that can  leach  and  contaminate  groundwater.  Phosphorus is normally present
in low  concentrations  and is specifically sorbed  by soil  colloids.   The
amount of K in  the  soil Is sometimes adequate but often it is present  in  a
form that is  unavailable for plant use.

     Each  state generally has   an  extension  soil  testing  laboratory  that
will  analyze  soil  .samples  for  primary  and   secondary   plant  nutrients.
Nitrogen  analysis is usually  done by  the Kjeldahl  method (Bremner,  1965)
                                     68

-------
   SOIL
REACTIONS
                                         MICROBIAL ACTIVITY
                        CARBON
                        DIOXIDE
Figure 4.6. Diagramatic representation of the transformations of carbon,
           commonly spoken of as  the carbon cycle.   Note  the stress
           placed on carbon dioxide both within and without the soil
           (Buckman and Brady,  1960).  Reprinted by permission of the
           Macmillan. Publishing Co., Inc.
                                 69

-------
 and  P and K are  usually analyzed in an ammonium acetate extract as outlined
 by Chapman  (I965a,  1965b).

     Calcium  and Mg are  also required  in relatively  large  amounts  when
 plants  are  grown.   Deficiencies in  Ca  usually occur in acid  soils  and can
 be corrected  by liming.   Most lime contains  some Mg,  but  if the  soil  is
 deficient in  Mg,  the use of dolomitic  lime  is  suggested.   Sulfur, although
 required by plants  in  large amounts,  is usually found  in  sufficient quan-
 tities  in soils.  Small amounts of  S are normally  in  fertilizers  as a con'
 stituent of one  of  the other  components.   Sulfur compounds  can be  used  to
 lower soil  pH.

     Elements  required  by plants in relatively small  amounts include iron,
 manganese,  boron, molybdenum,  copper and zinc, and  chloride  ions.  Most  of
 these mlcronutrients occur  in adequate  amounts  in native  soils.   Excess
 concentrations  of  certain  elements  often  cause  nutrient  imbalances  that
 will adversely affect plant survival.  Therefore,  careful  control of waste
 loading rates  and routine monitoring of soil  samples  for these elements  is
 essential to  prevent buildup  of  phytotoxic concentrations  when plants arc
 to be grown during  the active  life  or  at  closure.   The single most impor-
 tant management  consideration  is pH since  the solubility of  each of these
 elements is pH dependent.   Chapter  6 discusses this issue  in greater detail
 for each element.
4.1.2.4  Exchangeable Bases
     The exchangeable  bases  in a soil  are those positively charged cations,
excluding hydrogen,  held  on  the surface exchange sites that are in equilib-
rium with the soil solution.  These cations are  available  for plant use as
well as  for reaction  with  other ions  in the  soil  solution.   As  they are
absorbed  by  plants,  more   cations  are  released  into  solution  from  the
exchange sites.   This  is a  type  of  cation exchange  reaction  (discussed in
Section 4.1.2.1).  The major cations Include  calcium (Ca), magnesium (Mg)i
sodium (Na), and  potassium  (K).  Plants can tolerate a fairly wide ratio of
cations but the optimum ratio,  as calculated by Homes (1955) is 33 K:36 Ca:
32 Mg.  This ratio can be varied on  a  field scale as necessary by additions
of lime, Ca(C03); dolomite,  CaMg(C03)2; or potash fertilizer.

     Laboratory analysis  for exchangeable bases can be done by the ammonium
acetate  extraction procedure  as outlined  by  Chapman  (1965b) followed by
measurement  of  Ca,  Mg, Na  and K in  the  extract  using atomic  absorption
spectroscopy.  The sum of the exchangeable bases expressed in meq/100 g ifl
multiplied  by 100 and  divided by the CEC to give the  percent base  satura-
tion.   In essence,  this tells  what  percentage of  the CEC is occupied bf
bases.  The percentage of the  CEC that  is not occupied by bases is predomi-
nantly  filled by hydrogen  ions which  form  what  is  called the  reserve
acidity.  Percent base saturation depends on  the  climatic conditions, the
materials from which the  soil  was formed, and the vegetation growing on the
site (Pritchett,  1979).  Generally,  the percent base  saturation  increases
as the pH and fertility of  the soil  increases.


                                    70

-------
4.1.2.5  Metals


     Analysis of soil  samples  for metals content is normally done using an
air dried sample ground with a porcelain mortar and pestle  to  pass  a 2 mm
sieve  and  digested  using concentrated  HN03  (EPA,  1979)  or  hydrofluoric
acid in  an  acid digestion bomb  (Bernas, 1968).  Extracts  can be analyzed
for arsenic,  cadmium,  copper, chromium,  iron,  manganese, molybdenum, lead
and  zinc using  atomic  absorption  spectrophotometry.    Boron  is normally
measured in a  hot  water extract  as described  by  Wear  (1965).   Selenium
determinations  can  be  done  according  to  a  procedure  outlined  by Fine
(1965).   The  EPA  has  also  established methods  for  analyzing arsenic,
barium,  beryllium,  boron, cadmium, chromium,  copper,  cyanide, iron,  lead,
magnesium,  manganese,   mercury,  molybdenum,  nitrogen,  nickel,  potassium,
selenium, sodium,  vanadium,  and  zinc  (EPA,  1979).    The normal  ranges  for
metals  in  soil  and plants  are  presented  in  Chapter 6  (Tables 6.52  and
6.49).  Prior to waste disposal  by land treatment,  the concentrations  of
various metals  in the  soil and waste should be measured.  From these data,
loading  rates for  waste can  be  calculated  and background  concentrations
established.
4.1.2.6  Electrical Conductivity


     Electrical  conductivity (EC) is used  to measure the  concentration of
salts in a solution.   Since  electrical  currents are carried by charged ions
in  solution,  conductance increases as electrolyte  concentration increases.
The standard  method for  assessing the salinity status of  a soil is to pre-
pare  a  saturated paste   extract  and  measure  the  EC using  standard  elec-
trodes (USDA,  1954).   This can be related  to the actual salt concentration
in  the soil solution  that  might be taken up  by plants.   The EC measurement
of  the saturated paste extract is considered to be  one-half  the salt con-
centration at field  capacity and one-fourth  of that  at  the permanent wilt-
ing point (-15 bars).  As  a general rule,  where  saturated paste extract EC
values are  less  than 4 mmhos/cm  salts  have  little effect  on plant growth.
In  soils with EC values between 4 to 8 mmhos/cm  salts will restrict yields
of  many  crops*   Only a small  number of tolerant  species can  be  grown on
soils with EC values  above 8 mmhos/cm.

     When  selecting  a site  and  evaluating it for land treatment, careful
attention should be  given  to the soluble salt  content of  both the soil and
the proposed  waste stream.   Applications  of large amounts of salty wastes
to  an already alkaline  soil may decrease  microbial  degradation and result
in  barren conditions.  These problems are  most common to low rainfall, hot
areas and to  areas  near large bodies of salt water.  Remedial actions to be
taken in the  event  of accidental salt buildup  include stopping  the addition
of  all salt  containing materials, growing salt tolerant crops,  and if prac-
tical, leaching  the  area with water.  In some cases  leaching salts may not
be  acceptable because hazardous constituents would also leach.

                                     71

-------
 4.1.2.7  pH


      Soil pH  is  probably the most  informative  and valuable parameter  used
 to characterize the chemical property of a soil.   Standard  measurement  pro-
 cedures are  given  by Peech  (1965).  There  are three  possible basic  soil
 conditions:    acidic  (pH<7.0),  neutral (pH-7.0),  and  alkaline  (pH>7.0).
 Acidic soils are formed  in areas where  rainfall  leaches the soluble bases
 deep into the soil  profile.  Alkaline soils form in areas where rainfall  is
 small and evaporation is high, allowing the accumulation of  salts  and bases
 in the soil  profile.

      Large amounts  of lime or other neutralizing agents  are  needed to raise
 the pH of acidic soils.   In  general the pH should be maintained  between 6
 and 7 to have adequate nutrient  availability  for plants and microbes with-
 out danger of toxicity or deficiency.   The  addition of large quantities  of
 organic wastes  may  require  liming  over and  above  that  required  by  the
 native soil  since many organic and  inorganic  acids are formed  and released
 from the decomposing of organic wastes.  The  decision to add large  quanti-
 ties of fertilizer  should be based on the potential for  soil acidification,
 for example,  ammonium sulfate may lower the soil pH.

      Geographic  areas  of  low  rainfall  and high  evaporation  tend to  have
 alkaline soils where cations  (Ca, Mg and K) predominate.  When  base  satura-
 tion is above 90%,  the formation of  hydroxide  is  favored resulting  in  high
 pH.   These conditions alter  the  nutrient availability since boron,  copper,
 iron,  manganese,  phosphorus and zinc are only slightly available at  a pH of
 8.5 and above.

     Measures  commonly used for altering soil  pH include liming and sulfur
 applications.  Liming is the most  common procedure used  to raise soil pH>
 Normal  agricultural  lime,  CaC03   is   most  often   used,   but  dolomite
 CaMg(CC>3)2 is also  available for soils of limited  Mg  content.   Lowering
 soil  pH is much less  commonplace,  but  can  be accomplished  by addition of
 ferrous sulfate  or  flowers of  sulfur.   Both  of these  compounds  result in
 the  formation  of  112804,   a  strong  acid.     Sulfur  flowers  have  a   much
 higher potential  acidity;  however,  in special situations, sulfuric acid may
 be  used directly.   Management of  soil  pH  at HWLT  units  is  discussed in
 Section 8.6.
4.1.2.7.1  Acid Soils.   As exchangeable bases are  leached  from the soil in
areas of high  rainfall,  surface soils gradually  become  more acidic.  Local
acid  conditions  can also  result from  oxidation of  iron pyrite  and other
sulfides exposed  by mining.   Many  conifers  grow  best  at  low  soil  pH and
simultaneously take up  and hold basic cations from the  soil while dropping
fairly  acidic  pine needles,   thus,  pine  forests  tend to increase  soil
acidity.    Continued  use  of  ammonia  (Nl^)  or  ammonium  (NH^"1")  ferti"
lizers  may also  lead  to  a gradual  increase  in acidity as this reaction
takes place in the soil:
                    NH4+ +  202	>  2H+ + N03~ + H20        (Brady, 1974)
                                    72

-------
     Many plants  grow poorly In  acid soils due  to  high concentrations  of
soluble aluminum  (Al) or manganese  (Mn).  Aluminum at  a solution concentra-
tion of 1 ppm slovs  or  stops  root growth In some  plants.   Solution  concen-
trations of 1-4 ppm  Mn  produce  symptoms of toxlcity In  many  plants  (Black,
1968).  Although most plants  can  tolerate slightly higher  levels of  Mn than
Al, Mn levels In  flooded  or poorly drained  acid soils  can reach 10  ppm
(Bohn  et al., 1979).
4.1.2.7.2   Buffering  Capacity of Soils.   The  ability of the  soil  solution
to  resist  abrupt  pH  changes  (buffering  capacity)  is due  to presence  of
hydrolyzable  cations,  specifically  Al^+,  on  the  surface  of   the  clay
colloid.    Thus,  the buffering  capacity  is   proportional  to  the  cation
exchange capacity  if  other factors  are  equal (Brady,  1974).
     In  the  soil  environment  Al    Ions   sorbed   on  the   clay  surface
maintain equilibrium with Al^"1" ions  iti the soil  solution.  As solution Al^"*"
Ions  are  hydrolyzed  and precipitated as AKOH)^,  surface-bound Al^+ ions
migrate into  solution  to maintain equilibrium.  As  the Al^+  ions hydrolyze
and  remove OH**  from  solution,  the  solution pH  tends  to remain  stable.
Simultaneously as the  sorbed Al^+  ions migrate into  solution, other cations
replace the Al^+  ions  on the soil colloid.   Cations such  as Na+, Ca2+ and
and Mg2+  are  defined   as  basic  cations  because of  their  difficulty  in
hydrolyzing  in basic  solution as compared  to  Al^+.    As  the  pH of  the
soil solution is  increased, the percentage  of the  cation  exchange complex
occupied by basic cations  (base  saturation) increases.   There is a gradual
rise in pH and the percent base saturation  increases.

     At the high  and  low extremes of  base  saturation  in soils,  the degree
of buffering  is  lowest.  Buffering  capacity  is greatest at  about 50% base
saturation  (Feech,  1941).   Titration curves  vary somewhat  for  Individual
soils.  The pH of soils dominated  by montmorillontic clay is  4.5-5.0 at 50%
base saturation.   At  50% base  saturation soils  dominated  by kaolinite or
halloyite are at a pH  6.0-6.5  (Mehlich,  1941).

     Soils resist a sharp decrease in pH.  When acid is added to a neutral
soil,  Al(OH)-j dissolves,   enters  the  soil   solution,   and   the  available
Al^+ ions replace the  basic  cations  on the exchange  complex.   The decrease
in pH is gradual (Tisdale and Nelson,  1975)  because  of  the  stoichiometry of
the neutralization reaction.

     Plants and microorganisms depend  upon  a relatively stable environment*
If the  soil pH were  to fluctuate widely,  they would  suffer  numerous  ill
effects.  The buffering capacity of  the  soil stabilizes the pH and protects
against such  problems  (Brady,  1974).


4.1.3                      Biological Properties


     The soil provides a suitable habitat for a diverse range of organisms
which help  to render  a waste less hazardous.  Hamaker  (1971) reports that


                                    73

-------
biological  action accounts  for approximately  80%  of waste  degradation in
soil.   The  types  and numbers  of  decomposer organisms  present  in  a waste
amended  soil are dependent  on  the soil moisture  content,  available oxygen
and nutrient composition.

     The  population  establishment of  decomposer  organisms  following  the
land application of a waste material begins with  bacteria, actinomycetes,
fungi  and algae  (Dindal,  1978).   These  organisms have  diverse enzymatic
capabilities and   can   withstand   extremes  in  environmental  conditions.
Following  establishment  of   microbial  decomposers,  the  second  and  third
level  consumers establish themselves and  feed  on the  initial decomposers
and each  other  (Fig.  4.7).   Secondary and tertiary consumers include worms,
nematodes,  mites  and flies.    As these  organisms  use waste components,
energy  and  nutrients from  organic materials  are   released  and distributed
throughout the  immediate environment.
4.1.3.1  Primary Decomposers
4.1.3.1.1   Bacteria.   Soils contain  a diverse range  of  bacteria which can
be  used  to degrade a  wide  range of  waste  constituents.    Bacteria are the
most abundant  of  soil microorganisms,  yet  they account  for  less than half
of  the  total  microbiological  cell  mass (Alexander,  1977).   Bacteria found
in  soil may be  indigenous  to the soil  or invaders  which  enter via precipi-
tation, diseased  tissue, or land  applied  waste.    The  genera  of bacteria
most  frequently   isolated  from  soil  include   Arthrobacter,  Bacillus,
Pseudomonas,  Agrobacterium,  Alcaligenes,  and  Flavobacterium   (Alexander,
1977).

     Bacterial  growth or inhibition  is  influenced  by moisture, available
oxygen,  temperature,   pH,  organic  matter  content,  and  inorganic nutrient
supply.   In temperate areas,  bacterial populations  are  generally greatest
in  the upper layers of soil, although in cultivated soils the population is
less dense at  the  surface  due  to the  lack  of  moisture and the bactericidal
action of  sunlight (Alexander,  1977).  Bacterial activity is usually great-
est  in  the  spring and  autumn  months but  decreases  during the  hot,  dry
summer and during  cold weather.

     Soil  bacteria may require organic nutrients as  a source of carbon and
energy, or they may   obtain carbon  from  carbon dioxide (002)  and  energy
from  the  sun.   Fungi,  protozoa,  animals,  and most bacteria  use organic
carbon as  a source of energy.     Autotrophs,  which obtain carbon from C02,
obtain energy  from sunlight  or the  oxidation of inorganic materials.
4.1.3.1.2   .Actinomycetes.   Under  conditions  of  limited  nutrient supply,
actinomycetes  become  the predominate microorganism  and  use compounds vtoich
are less susceptible  to  bacterial  attack.   They are heterotrophlc  organisms
that utilize  organic  acids, llpids,  proteins, and  aliphatic hydrocarbons.
These  organisms  are  a  transitional group  between bacteria  and  fungi,  and
appear  to  dominate other  microbes in  dry  or  cultivated  areas (Alexander,

                                     74

-------
01
               MICROORGANISMS'

             Fly (Dlptera)

             Boundworas (neaatodes)
             Sowbug  (Isopod)
             Millipedes
             Earthworas
             Beetle altes
             White uora
             Snails and slugs •
Nocardla
Streptouyees
 ycobacterliun
Pseudoaonas
Arthrobacter
Micrococcua
                                                                             PRIMARY
                                                                            CONSUMERS
             Soil flatwonaa (tubellarlans)
                   Rotlfera
                   Procoxoa
                   Heutodes
                                                                                                FUNGI
Penlcllllua
Cunnlnghaaella
CephaloBooriua
Trlchoderoa
             Centipedes
             Ant (foratlld)
             Rove beetles (staphyllnld)
                            Predatory nlte
                            Paeudoacorplon
                            Ground  Beetles (Carabld)
                                                                                                                  TERTIARY
                                                                                                                  CONSUMERS
                        Figure  4.7.   Cycle  of organisms  that degrade  land applied  waste.  (Jensen and Holm,
                                        1972;  Perry and Gerniglia,  1973;  Dindal,  1978; Austin et  al.,  1977)

-------
 1977).   Primary  ecological influences  on actinomycetes  include moisture,
pH, temperature,  and  amount of organic matter present.  Addition of organic
matter  to  the  soil   greatly  increases  the  density  of   these  organisms.
Following  the  addition of  organic matter,  they  undergo a  lag  phase  of
growth  after which they  show increased  activity indicating  that  they are
effective  competitors  only  when the more  resistant compounds  remain.    In
addition,  actinomycetes seem to influence  the  composition of  the mlcrobial
community  due  to  their ability to  excrete antibiotics and their capacity  to
produce  enzymes  capable   of  inhibiting  bacterial  and fungal  populations
(Alexander,  1977).
4.1.3.1.3  Fungi.   This  group of heterotrophic organisms is affected by  the
availability  of  oxidizable organic substrates.   Other environmental influ-
ences affecting  the density of fungal populations include moisture  content,
pH,  organic   and  inorganic  nutrients,   temperature,  available  oxygen,  and
vegetative composition.   Fungi can withstand a wide range of pH and temper-
atures.   They also  have  the ability to  survive  in a  quiescent  state when
environmental  conditions  are no  longer  favorable  for  active metabolism.
These  organisms,  because  of their extensive  mycelial or  thread-lilce net-
work,  usually compose a  significant  portion of  the  soil biomass.   One  of
the major  activities of fungi in  the mycelial state  is  the degradation  of
complex  molecules.   In  addition, fungi  are  active   in the  formation  of
ammonium and  simple nitrogen compounds.
4.1.3.1.4  Algae.   This  group of organisms uses light as a source  of  energy
and  CO2 as  a  source  of  carbon.    Thus,  algae are  abundant  in habitats
where  light  is  plentiful and  moisture  is  available.   The  population  of
algae  is  normally smaller than bacteria, actinomycetes  or fungi.  Because
of the  inability  of  algal populations  to  multiply  beneath the zone of  soil
receiving sunlight,  the  most dense populations are found between  5 to 10 CD
deep.    Algae  can  generate  organic  matter  from  Inorganic  substances.
Normally, they  are the  first  to colonize barren surfaces,  and the organic
matter  produced  by  the  death  of  algae  provides  a  source   of  carbon  for
future  fungal  and bacterial  populations.   Surface  blooms produced by algae
bind  together  soil  particles  contributing  to  soil  structure  and erosion
control.
4.1.3.2  Secondary  Decomposers
4.1.3.2.1   Worms.    The  major  importance  of  small  worms  In  decomposing
organic material  is  their  abundance and relatively high metabolic  activity.
When sewage  sludge  Is land applied,  the total number  of  earthworms in  the
biomass Is enhanced  with  increasing treatment.  Increased earthworm  popula-
tions also enhance  soil porosity and  formation of water stable  soil aggre-
gates,  thus   improving the  structure  and  water  holding  capacity  of  the
soil.
                                     76

-------
     Mitchell et al.  (1977)  found  sludge decomposition was increased two to
five times by the manure  worm.   Specific physical and biological character-
istics improved  by  the manure worm  include:   1) removal  of  senescent bac-
teria, which  results  in new  bacterial  growth; 2) enrichment  of  the sludge
by  nitrogenous  excretions;   3)  enhancement  of  aeration;  4) addition  of
mineral  nutrients;  and 5) influence on the  carbon  and nutrient  flux pro-
duced by interactions  between the  microflora, nematodes and protozoa.  In a
later  study  they  found  that fresh anaerobic  sludges killed  earthworms,
although  aging  the anaerobic sludge for  two months  removed  this toxicity
(Mitchell et  al., 1978).
4.1.3.2.2   Nematodes,  Mites and Flies.   As these organisms  use waste com-
ponents,  energy  and  nutrients  are released  and made  available  to  other
decomposers.    Nematodes  harvest   bacterial   populations  while  processing
solid  waste material.   Both nematode  and  bacterial  populations  in sewage
sludge are  increased  by the feeding of the isopod Oniscus sellus (Brown et
al.,  1978).   Mold mites  will feed  on yeast  and  fungi.  Beetle  mites and
springtails  will also  feed  on  molds,  but usually  under  drier  and  more
aerobic  conditions.   Flies  are  vital  in the  colonization  of  new organic
deposits.   These insects are used  to  transport  the  immobile organisms from
one site to  another.
4.1.3.3  Factors  Influencing Waste Degradation


     Following  the  land application  of  a hazardous  waste, macrobiological
activity is  suppressed until the microorganisms  stabilize the environment.
The full range  of soil organisms  are important  to  waste degradation,  how-
ever,  habitation by  macr©organisms  depends  on  mLcrobial  utilization  and
detoxification  of waste  constituents.   The  rate at  which microbes  attack
and  detoxify waste  constituents  depends  on  many  factors  including  the
effect  of  environmental  conditions  on mLcrobial life and  the presence  of
certain  compounds  which  are  resistant   to   microbial   attack (Alexander,
1977).

     The adverse  effects  of  land treatment on the soil fauna  may  be  reduced
by a  carefully  planned program which may involve  modifications  of  certain
waste characteristics  or  environmental parameters.  Through the use  of  pre-
treatment methods of  in-plant process controls  (Section 5.2)  certain  waste
characteristics  may  be modified  to  improve the  rate  of  waste degradation.
The factors  affecting  degradation which  may be  adjusted  in the  design  and
operation of a  land treatment  unit include soil parameters  (moisture  con-
tent, temperature, pH, available nutrients,  available oxygen,  and soil  tex-
ture or structure) and design parameters (application rate and frequency).

     In most cases,  it is not feasible  to adjust the soil moisture  content
in the  field to enhance degradation.   However,  when  soil moisture  is  low,
it may  be  advantageous to  add moisture  through  irrigation  and when  the
moisture  content  is  high,  to  delay  waste  application  until  the  soil
moisture content  is  more favorable for  waste  degradation.  Water,  although

                                    77

-------
 essential  for microbial growth  and  transport, has  a  limited effect on  the
 rate  of waste  degradation over  a broad  range  of  soil  moisture  contents.
 Only  under  excessively wet  or  dry  conditions  does  soil  moisture  content
 have  a  significant  effect  on   waste  degradation  (Brown  et  al.,  1982).
 Dibble  and  Bartha  (1979)  found  a negligible  difference  in the  microbial
 activity of  oil-amended soil  at  moisture contents between  30 and 90% of  the
 water holding capacity of the soil.

     Both  moisture  content and temperature  will  exert a significant effect
 on  the  population size  and species  composition  of  microorganisms in waste
 amended  soil.  The  influence of temperature  on  the metabolic  capabilities
 of  soil bacteria  was observed in a study by Westlake et al.  (1974) in which
 enrichment  cultures  of soil  bacteria  grown  on  oil  at  4°C were  able  to
 utilize  the  same oil  at 30°C, while  enrichment   cultures  obtained at  30°C
 exhibited  little  capacity for growing on the  same oil  at  4°C.   At 4°C,  the
 isoprenoid  compounds  phytane  and pristane  were  not biodegraded,  while  at
 30°C the bacteria metabolized these compounds  (Westlake  et al., 1974).   In
 a six month  laboratory  study  evaluating the  rate of  biodegradation of  two
 API-separator sludges in  soil,  the  rate  of biodegradation  of  both wastes
 doubled between 10°  and 30°C,  but decreased slightly at 40°C (Brown  et  al.,
 1982).   Similarly,  a  50 day  laboratory study by Dibble  and Bartha (1979)
 showed  little  or no  increase in  the  rate of  hydrocarbon biodegradation
 above  20°C.    The influence  of   temperature on  the biodegradation  of  oil
 sludge in  these laboratory studies is presented in Fig. 4.8.  These  results
 indicate that the optimum temperature for  degradation of  these oily wastes
 is between 20°  and 35°C; and,  that biodegradation increases  with decreasing
 application   rates.     While   temperature   adjustments  in   the  field   are
 impractical,  enhanced  biodegradation  rates  may  be  achieved  by  delaying
 or reducing  waste applications according to the soil temperature.  Measure-
ment of soil  temperature is discussed in Section  4.1.1.6.

     Through management activities such as the addition  of  lime,  the  soil
 at a land  treatment  unit is generally maintained  at or above 6.5 to  enhance
 the immobilization  of certain waste  constituents.  This  pH is also within
 the optimum  range for  soil microbes.  Verstraete et al.  (1975)  found  the
 optimum pH for  microbial activity to be 7.4 with inhibition occurring  at  a
 pH of 8.5.   In  addition, Dibble  and Bartha  (1979) found  that lime applica-
 tions favored oil-sludge biodegradation.

     Another  soil parameter which may be  readily  adjusted at a land treat-
ment unit Is  nutrient  content.  The  land application of sludges with a  high
hydrocarbon  content  stimulates microbial activity and results in the deple-
tion of available nitrogen which eventually slows degradation.  Through  the
addition of  nitrogen  containing  fertilizers the  C:N ratio can be reduced,
thus stimulating  microbial activity  and maintaining the rate of biodegrada-
tion.  It appears that optimum use is made  of  fertilizer  when the applica-
 tion  is  delayed  until   after   the  less   resistant  compounds  have   been
degraded.  In a field  study by Raymond et  al.  (1976), the rate of  biodegra-
dation  in  fertilized  plots  was  not  increased  until  a  year  after waste
application.  The rate of fertilizer needed depends on the  characteristics
of  the  waste.    While  the  addition  of  proper   amounts  of  nutrients  can
increase  biodegradation,   excessive   amounts,  particularly  of   nitrogen,


                                     78

-------
   6O
   50
   40-
Q 3O-

<
S
320-
   10-
                       10
 2O                30
TEMPERATURE  (°C)
40
  Figure 4.8. The influence of temperature on the biodegradation rate of  three oil sludges.
             (A-A)  500 mg hydrocarbon applied, Dibble and Bartha (1979);  (O~O) 100 rag
             hydrocarbon applied, Brown et al.  (1982); (X-X) 620 mg hydrocarbon applied,
             Brown,  et al. (1982).

-------
 provide  no  benefit and may contribute  to  leaching of nitrates.  Dibble  and
 Bartha  (1979)  determined that the optimum C:N ratio  for  the  oily waste  they
 studied  was  60:1;  while, in a study by Brown et al.  (1982) a  refinery waste
 exhibited  optimum degradation  at  a C:N ratio  of 9:1,  and  a  petrochemical
 waste  at 124:1.   Thus, it  appears that  optimum degradation  rates  can  be
 achieved when  the fertilizer  application  rate is  determined on a case-by-
 case basis.

     The texture and  structure  of the soil  exerts  a significant  influence
 on  the  rate of waste  biodegradation.   Although the  choice  of soil will  in
 many cases  be  restricted, a  careful evaluation  of  the  rate of biodegrada-
 tion  using  the  specific  soil  and waste  of the  land treatment  unit  will
 result  in the most  efficient  use of  the  land  and  minimize  environmental
 contamination.   In a  laboratory study evaluating  the biodegradation rates
 of  two  wastes in  four  soils,  the most rapid  degradation  occurred  in  the
 silt loam  soil and the  least  rapid  in the clay  (Table  4.5) (Brown et  al.,
 1982).   In  fine  textured  soils  where the  availability  of oxygen may limit
 degradation,   frequent    tilling   may  increase   aeration   and   enhance
 degradation; although, excessive tilling can promote  erosion.
TABLE 4.5   THE  EFFECT OF SOIL TEXTURE ON THE BIODEGRADATION  OF  REFINERY AND
            PETROCHEMICAL SLUDGE*

                                                  % Carbon Degraded  as
                          Total Carbon               Determined  by
                            Appliedt        	
       Soil                   (mg)           C02-C Evolved       Residual C

Refinery Waste
Norwood sandy clay             350               60                  63
Nacogdoches clay               350               44                  54
Lakeland sandy  loam           350               37                  45
Bastrop clay                   350               37                  47
Petrochemical Waste
Norwood sandy clay
Nacogdoches clay
Lakeland sandy loam
Bastrop clay
2,100
2,100
2,100
2,100
15
9
13
0.3
34
32
30
19
* Brown et al.  (1982)
t Sludge was applied at  a rate of 5% (wt/wt) to soils at  field  capacity  and
  incubated for  180 days at  30°C.
     The  frequency and rate  of  application are  design parameters  that  can
be used to enhance waste  biodegradation.   The  amount of residual  sludge  in
the soil  influences both the  availability of  oxygen and  the toxic  effects
of waste  constituents on soil microbes.   When small  amounts  of  waste  are
                                     80

-------
applied  frequently,  the  toxic effects  of  the  waste  on  the  microbes  are
minimized and  microbial activity is maintained  at  an optimum level.  Brown
et  al.  (1982) observed  that  repeated  applications  of  small  amounts  of
waste  resulted in greater degradation over  the same  time  than occurred if
all of  the  waste  was applied at one  time  (Fig. 4.9).   These results agree
with those  of  Dibble  and Bartha (1979) and  Jensen  (1975)  who found maximum
degradation at application  rates  of oily waste of  less  than  5%  (wt/wt).
Thus,  it  appears  that  the best results  will be obtained  when  a balance is
reached  between  the  most efficient use  of the land  treatment  area and the
optimum  application rate and  frequency.    Calculations  are  described  in
Sections  7.2.1.5  and  7.5.3.1.4 which  can  be used  to assist in determining
these  parameters.

     Land treatment  of  hazardous waste is  a dynamic  process  requiring care-
ful  design  and  management  to  maintian  optimum  degradation   and  prevent
environmental  contamination.  The  laboratory  studies described in  Sections
7.2-7.4 can be used  to  evaluate the  value  of each parameter  that will allow
optimum  biodegradation.  In  situations  where an equivalent waste  has been
handled  at  an equivalent  land treatment  unit such  testing  may  not  be
necessary.  However,  due  to  the variability  of  waste  streams,  soils, and
climatic  conditions,  a  careful evaluation  of environmental parameters is
required  in order  to  obtain  maximum degradation  rates  using  the minimum
land area.

     Environmental  modifications  to enhance  biodegradation may  take the
form of  amendments applied  to the  soil,  as  discussed above,   or  they may
take the  form  of  a microbial spike added to act on a specific  class of  com-
pounds.    Soil particles in   sludges  may  hold  bacteria  or   fungi  in   a
resistant state.  Once  these organisms become acclimated  to  waste  constitu-
ents,  they  may flourish whenever environmental conditions are  improved.  In
most cases,  the  addition of limited  amounts of organic matter to  the  soil
results  in  increased microbial activity.    Excessive  additions of  organic
matter,  however,  can result  in microbial  inhibition because of the  nature
of the organic matter.

     Pretreatment of recalcitrant  waste constituents by chemical,  physical,
or biological  degradation may  render a waste  more amenable to  degradation
in the soil.   For example,  pretreatment of  PCB containing wastes  by  photo-
decomposition  can remove one or two  chlorine  atoms per molecule  (Hutzinger
et al.,  1972).  Since  the most significant factor  in the  relative degrad-
ability  of  PCB wastes  the degree  of  chlorination (Tucker,  1975),  pretreat-
ment of  PCBs could render the  waste more susceptible  to  microbial attack.
Methods  of  pretreatment that  may  be  useful  for   HWLT  are  discussed in
Section  5.2.
4.1.3.4  Waste  Degradation by Microorganisms
     It  is difficult  to predict  the effect  of  a hazardous  waste on  the
microbial  population  of  the  soil.   Most  hazardous  wastes  are  complex
                                     81

-------
00
               30
             CM
            o
            o
             o>
            .g
            '•*-•

            2 10
            'a.
            W
            a>
            DC
                     Petrochemical Wastes


                     o One-5% Applcation

                     •One-K)% Applications

                     a Two-5% Applications

                     AFour-5% Applications
                   fl
                   o
                                                                                    a
                                                                         D
   A £D°
                                                 a
                                                                              o
                                   50
      100

Time (Days)
150
200
                Figure 4.9.  Effect of treatment frequency on the evolution of  C(>2 from Norwood soil

                            amended with petrochemical sludge and incubated for 180 days at 30 C

                            and 1BX aotatute CBrowa et al. . 1982) .

-------
mixtures  which contain a variety  of toxic compounds,  resistant  compounds,
and  compounds  susceptible  to microbial  attack.    The application  of  a
readily available  substrate  to the soil stimulates the microbial  population
and  should provide  a  more  diverse  range of  organisms to  deal with  the
resistant  compounds  once  the preferred substrate has been degraded.   Davies
and Westlake  (1979)  found that the inability of  an  asphalt  based crude  oil
to support growth  was  due to the  lack of n-alkanes rather than the presence
of  toxic  compounds.   Therefore,  it  appears  that  the  effect  of  toxic
inorganic  and organic  compounds on microorganisms will  be  reduced if there
is a readily  available substrate  which can be used by these organisms.

     Many  hazardous  wastes  contain substantial  quantities  of toxic  inor-
ganic  compounds, such  as  heavy metals.  Kloke  (1974) suggests that  concen-
trations  of lead  in  soil  above 2000  mg/kg inhibit microbial  activity.   In
addition,  the recommended limit for  total lead plus  four  times  total zinc
plus forty times  total cadmium is  2000 mg/kg  (Kloke,  1974);  however, this
calculation fails  to account for  both the synergistic effects between these
cations and the effect of soil characteristics. Doelman and Haanstra (1979)
found  that a  lead concentration  of 7500 mg/kg  had  no  effect  on microbial
activity  in   a  peat soil with  a  high cation  exchange  capacity.    These
results were  verified  by Babich  and Stotzky  (1979) who  found   that  lead
toxicity was  reduced by a high pH (greater than 6.5), the addition of phos-
phate  or  carbonate anlons,  a  high  cation exchange  capacity,  and the pres-
ence of soluble organic matter.   Thus, it is  evident that no fixed limit on
heavy  metal concentration can be  generally applied  to  all  waste-soil mix-
tures.  Inorganic  toxicity  can be  better determined  empirically on a case
by case basis.  Similarly, the toxicity of organic compounds in a hazardous
waste  is  dependent on  the concentration of organic  and inorganic constitu-
ents  and  the properties   of the  receiving  soil.    Under  certain  circum-
stances,  the  application  of  toxic  organic compounds  to  soil  may stimulate
fungal or  actinomycete populations while  depressing  bacterial populations.
Applications  of 5000 mg/kg 2,4-D  reduced the  number of bacteria and actino-
mycetes, but  had little effect on the fungal population (Ou et al., 1978).
Since many hazardous wastes  can have  an adverse  effect  on biological forms
in the  soil,  land treatment should be  carefully planned and monitored to
ensure that the biological forms responsible for degradation have not been
adversely affected.

     There are indications  that  after long-term exposure  to  toxic  com-
pounds, microbes can adapt and utilize some of  these compounds.  Results of
numerous experiments indicate that microbes  have the capacity to adapt  and
use introduced substrates.   The majority  of these  studies,  however, have
dealt  with microbial  utilization of  a  relatively pure substrate and even
those dealing with the use of crude oil are  examining a substrate which is
predominantly composed of saturated hydrocarbons.

     Poglazova et  al.  (1967) isolated a soil bacterium capable of destroy-
ing the  ubiquitous  carcinogen benzo(a)pyrene.   This study  indicated that
the ability of  soil  bacteria  to  degrade benzo(a)pyrene may  be enhanced by
prolonged  cultivation   in media  containing  hydrocarbons.   This indicates
that the  land treatment  of  hazardous wastes may  stimulate  the  growth of
microorganisms with  the increased enzymatic capabilities to deal  with toxic


                                    83

-------
waste constituents.   Jensen  (1975)  states that  the  most common genera  of
bacteria showing  an  increase in activity  due  to the presence  of  hydrocar-
bons  in the  soil include Corynebacterium,  Brevibacterium,  Arthrobacter,
Mycobacteria, Pseudomonas  and Nocard!a.   Of  all groups  of bacteria,  Pseudo-
monas appear  to have the  most  diverse enzymatic capabilities,  perhaps  due
to  the  presence  of  plasmids which  increase their ability  to  use  complex
substrates  (Dart  and Stretton, 1977).   Friello  et  al. (1976)  have  trans-
ferred  hydrocarbon  degradlve  plasmids  to a  strain of  Pseudomonas  which
gives the  bacterium a  broader  range  of  available  substrates.   Enrichment
cultures  of such organisms  may  be useful  for  rapidly degrading  certain
classes of  compounds.   It  may be useful  to apply this type  of  an enrichment
culture to  enhance the  degradation of  a  particular  recalcitrant compound  or
group of  compounds,  although in the case of many  complex wastes,  a mixed
microbial population is  required to  co-metabolize the various  waste  consti-
tuents .

     Large  additions of  chlorinated  hydrocarbons into the environment exert
selective pressure on microorganisms to  detoxify or utilize  these compounds
(Chakrabarty, 1978).   As  a  result,  bacteria are frequently isolated which
have  the  capacity to use  compounds  previously  thought to be  resistant  to
microbial attack.  For  example,  mixed  or enrichment  cultures  of  bacteria
have  been shown to degrade  PCBs  (Clark  et al.,  1979), DDT (Patil  et al.,
1970), polyethylene  glycol (Cox and Conway,  1976),  and all classes  of  oil
hydrocarbons  (Raymond   et  al.,  1976).    However, some compounds,   such  as
hexachlorobenzene,  appear  to  be  resistant  to  microbial  attack  (Ausmus
et al., 1979).

     Various strains of actinomycetes are  capable  of  degrading  hazardous
compounds.  Walker et al.  (1976) isolated petroleum degrading  actinomycetes
from polluted creek  sediments which  composed over 30%  of all  the organisms
isolated.   In  addition, Chacko et  al.  (1966)  isolated several  strains  of
actinomycetes that could use DDT.

     Fungi  capable of degrading the  persistent  pesticide dieldrin were iso-
lated in a  study  by  Bixby  et al.  (1971).  Perry  and  Cerniglia (1973) found
fungi able  to  degrade  greater  quantities  of  oil  during growth  than bac-
teria.  This capability  was  probably due to  the ability of  fungi to grow as
a mat  on the  surface  of  the oil.   The  most  efficient hydrocarbon using
fungi isolated  by Perry and Cerniglia (1973) utilized  30-65%  of an asphalt
based crude oil.  Davies and Westlake  (1979) also isolated fungi that could
use  crude  oil.    The genera most  frequently isolated  in their  study were
Penicillium and Verticillium.
4.2                                PLANTS
     Plants modify  the  treatment functions that occur  in soil.   Primarily)
a crop cover  on the active  treatment  site, protects the soil-waste matrix
from adverse  impacts  of wind and  water,  namely erosion  and  soil crusting'
Plants also function  to enhance removal of excess  water  through transpira-
tion.  Some of  the more mobile,  plant-available waste constituents may be

                                    84

-------
absorbed along with  the  water and then altered  within the plant.  Absorbed
wastes ultimately  are returned  to  the soil  as  the decaying  plants supply
organic matter.   The organic matter,  in turn,  enhances  soil  structure and
cation exchange  capacity.   The  plant  canopy  may range from  spotty to com-
plete coverage and may  vary with the  season  or  waste  application schedule.
Also, cover  crops are not  required during the operation  of  an HWLT unit so
management  decisions about  the  selection of   species,  time  of  planting,
desired periods  of  cover,  or whether  or  not  plants are  even desirable are
all  left  to  the discretion  of  the  owner or operator.   A  cover  crop  is
advantageous  in  many cases but  it  is  not essential.   The functions plants
serve can be  divided into  two classes, protective functions and cycling and
treatment functions.

     Plants  protect  the soil by intercepting and  dampening  the effects of
rainfall and  wind.   In  climates  where wetness is  a problem for land treat-
ment, a  plant canopy can  intercept  precipitation and  prevent significant
amounts  of  water  from  ever  reaching the  soil; however, this  depends  on
plant species,  completeness of  cover, rainfall intensity,  and atmospheric
conditions.   Plants  also decrease the erosive effects of  raindrop  impact on
the  soil,  preventing detachment  of  particles from  the  soil  and decreasing
the  splash transport of  soil  and waste particles.  Plants enhance  infiltra-
tion  and  lessen  runoff  transport  of   waste  constituents   by decreasing
surface  flow velocities and  by  filtering  particulates  from  runoff water.
Wind erosion  Is  reduced  since the plant  canopy  dampens  wind  speed  and tur-
bulent mixing at ground  level.

     Cycling  and treatment  functions include  translocation  of substances
from soil to  plant,  transformations within plants,  and loss from  plants to
the  atmosphere  or back  to  the  soil.  Land  treatment in  a wet climate  can
benefit from  an  established  crop cover to enhance water  loss  through  uptake
and  transpiration.   Certain  soluble, plant available  waste constituents  and
plant nutrients  can also  be  absorbed through plant  roots.   If testing of
plant tissues indicates  no food  chain hazard from these  absorbed  constitu-
ents, crop  harvest  can  be a  removal pathway.   However,' crops may not be
harvested either because  tissue  analyses have  indicated unacceptable con-
centrations  of hazardous constituents or because the  expense  of plant  moni-
toring exceeds  any potential benefit  from harvesting.   In  such cases,  the
crop residues can  be returned to the soil organic matter  pool.

     Where  it has   been  determined  that cover crop  is  desirable,  proper
selection of  plant  species or mixture of species  can maximize the desired
function.   The   choice of  plant  species  will vary depending  on the  season
and  the  region  of  the  country.   It  is  a good idea  to  consult  with area
agronomists  from the State Agricultural  Extension Service,  U.S. Department
of Agriculture,  or  the  agronomy department at a nearby university  to  obtain
information  on varieties and cultural practices which are suited to a given
region.  Section 8.7 provides additional information  on  species selection.
                                     85

-------
4.3                             ATMOSPHERE


     The atmosphere primarily operates as a modifier of treatment processes
in the soil.  Atmospheric conditions control the water content and tempera-
ture of the  soil  which in turn control  biological  waste  degradation rates
and waste constituent mobility.  Winds act  along with the heat balance and
moisture  content  to  provide for  gas  exchange,  such as  the movement  of
oxygen, carbon  dioxide,  water vapor, and waste  volatiles  between soil and
atmosphere.   In addition to soil-atmosphere interactions,  the  atmosphere
exchanges gases with  plants  and  transmits  photosynthetically active radia-
tion to plants.   Finally,  shortwave radiation may  be responsible for some
degree of photodegradation of some waste organics exposed at the soil sur-
face.  Comprehension  of soil, plants and atmosphere interactions and of the
various  active  treatment   functions directs  attention   to  those  system
properties  which influence  treatment effectiveness  and  which   should  be
examined more thoroughly.

     The important  climatic  parameters  affecting land  treatment should be
understood from the  perspective  of site history  for  design purposes.  On-
site  observations  are  essential   as  an   input  to  management  decisions
(Chapter 8).  An  off-site weather  reporting station will ordinarily be the
source of climatic  records.   Section 3.3 discusses  the selection of reli-
able sources of information  that will be representative of  site  conditions.
During the operational life  of the HWLT unit it may be useful to install an
instrument  package  and  make regular  observations  of important  climatic
parameters,  such  as temperature,  rainfall, pan evaporation and  wind velo-
city.  Measurement  of soil  temperature  and  moisture  and particulate emis-
sions may also be useful.

     Climate  affects  the management  of  hazardous  waste  facilities.   Air
temperature  influences many  treatment processes  but has an especially pro-
found effect on the  length  of  the waste  application season, the  rate of
biodegradation, and the volatilization of waste constituents.  On an  opera-
tional basis,  temperature  observations  can aid in application  timing for
volatile wastes and  surface irrigated   liquid  wastes.   Wind,  atmospheric
stability and temperature determine application timing for  volatile wastes.
The moisture budget at an HWLT unit  is  critical to  timing waste applica-
tions and  determining loading  rates and  storage requirements.   Climatic
data can  be  used in the  hydrologic simulation  to  predict  maximum water
application  rates,  and to  design water  retention and diversion  structures.
A discussion of how the management of the  unit  can be developed to respond
to climatic  influences is included in Chapter 8.
                                     86

-------
                           CHAPTER 4 REFERENCES
Alexander, M. 1977. Introduction to soil microbiology.  John  Wiley  and Sons
Inc., New York. p. 1-467.

Allison, L. E. 1965. Organic carbon,  pp. 1367-1378.  In  C.  A.  Black (ed.)
Methods of soil analysis. Part  2. Chemical and microbiological  properties.
Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr. No. 9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

American Society of Agricultural Engineers.  1961. Measuring  saturated
hydraulic conductivity of soils. Am.  Soc. Agr. Engr. St. Joseph, Michigan.
p. 1-18.

Ausmus, B., S. Kimbrough, D. R. Jackson, and  S.  Ldndberg.  1979. The
behaviour of hexachlorobenzene  in pine  forest microcosms:   transport and
effects on soil processes. Applied Science Publ.  Ltd.,  England. Environ.
Pollut. 0013-9327/79/0020-0103.

Austin, B., J. J. Calomiris, J. D. Walker, and R. R. Colwell 1977. Numeri-
cal taxonomy and ecology of petroleum degrading  bacteria.  Appl. and
Environ. Micro. 34(l):60-68.

Babich, H., and G. Stotzky. 1979. Abiotic factors affecting the toxicity of
lead to fungi. Appl. and Environ. Micro.  38(3):506-513.

Bernas, B. 1968. A new method for decomposition  and comprehensive analysis
of silicates by atomic absorption spectrometry»  Anal. Gtiem. 40:1682-1686.

Bixby, M. W., G. M. Bouah, and  P. Matsumura.  1971.  Degradation of dielorin
to carbon dioxide by a soil fungus Trichoderma koningi. Bull. Environ.
Contam. Toxicol. 6(6):491-495.

Black, C. A. (ed.). 1968. Methods of  soil analysis. Part 2. Chemical and
microbiological properties. Am. Soc.  Agron.  Monogr. No. 9. Madison,
Wisconsin.

Blake, G. R. 1965. Bulk Density,  pp.  374-390. In C. A.  Black (ed.) Methods
of soil analysis. Part 1. Physical and  mineralogical properties including
statistics of measurement and sampling. Am.  Soc. Agron. Monogr. No. 9.
Madison, Wisconsin.

Boersma, L. 1965a. Field measurement  of hydraulic conductivity above a
water table, pp.  234-252. In  C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of soil analysis.
Part 1. Physical and mineralogical properties including statistics of
measurements and sampling. Am.  Soc. Agron.  Monogr.  No. 9.  Madison,
Wisconsin.
                                     87

-------
Boersma, L.  1965b.  Field  measurement  of  hydraulic conductivity below a
water table, pp.  222-233.  In C.  A.  Black (ed.) Methods of soil analysis.
Part 1. Physical  and mineralogical  properties including statistics of meas-
urement and  sampling. Am.  Soc. Agron.  Monogr. No. 9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

Bohn, H. L., B. L.  McNeal,  and G. A.  O'Connor. 1979.  Soil chemistry. John
Wiley- and Sons, New York.

Bouma, J., R. F.  Paetzold,  and R. B.  Grossman. 1982.  Measuring hydraulic
conductivity for  use in soil survey.  U.S.  Department  of Agriculture, Soil
Conservation Service. Report No.  38.  14  p.

Brady, N. C. 1974.  The nature and properties of soils. 8th ed. MacMillan
Co., New York. 639  p.

Bremner, J. M. 1965. Inorganic forms  of  nitrogen pp.  149-176. In_ C. A.
Black (ed.) Methods of soil  analysis.  Part  2. Chemical and microbiological
properties. Am. Soc. Agron.  Monogr.  No.  9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

Brown, B., B. Swift, and  M.  J. Mitchell. 1978. Effect of Oniscus aesellus
feeding on bacteria and nematode  populations in sewage sludge. Oikos
30:90-94.

Brown, K. W., L.  E. Deuel,  Jr.,  and  J. C.  Thomas. 1982. Soil disposal of
API pit wastes. Final Report of  a Study  for the Environmental Protection
Agency (Grant No. R805474013). 209  p.

Brown, K. W., C.  Woods, and  J. F. Slowey.  1975. Fate  of metals applied  in
sewage at land wastewater  disposal  sites.  Final report AD 43363 submitted
to the U.S. Army  Medical  Research and Development Command, Washington,
D.C.

Buckman, H.  0., and N. C.  Brady.  1960. The  nature and properties of soils.
MacMillan Co., New  York.  239 p.

Chacko, C. I., J. L. Lockwood, and M.  Zabick. 1966. Chlorinated hydrocarbon
pesticides - degradation  by  microbes.  Science 154:893-894.

Cnakrabarty, A. M.  1978.  Molecular  mechanisms in the  bio-degradation of
enviromental pollutants.  Am. Soc. Micro. News 44(12):687-690.

Chapman, H.  D. 1965a. Cation exchange capacity, pp. 891-900. Jn C. A. Black
(ed.) Methods of  soil analysis.  Part 2.  Chemical and  microbiological
properties.  Am. Soc. Agron.  Monogr.  No.  9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

Chapman, H.  D. 1965b. Total  exchangeable bases, pp. 902-904. In C. A. Blacj*
(ed.) Methods of  soil analysis.  Part 2.  Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr. No. 9.
Madison, Wisconsin.

Clark, R. R., E.  S. K. Chian, and R.  A.  Griffin. 1979. Degradation of poly"
cholorinated biphenyls by mixed  microbial cultures. App. Environ. Micro-
biol. 37(4):680-685.

                                     88

-------
Cox, D. P. and R. A. Conway.  1976. Microblal  degradation of  some  polyethy-
lene glycols. pp. 835-841. Jtn J, M.  Sharpley  and  A.  M.  Kaplan (ed.)
Proceedings of the Third International Bio-degradation  Symposium.  Appl.
Scl. Publ., London.

Dart, R. K. and R. J. Streton.  1977. Microbial  aspects  of pollution  con-
trol. Elsevier Sci. Publ. Co.,  Amsterdam,  pp.  180-215.

Davies, J. S. and D. W. S. Westlake. 1979.  Crude  oil utilization  by  fungi.
Can. J. Microbiol. 25:146-156.

Day, P. R. 1965. Particle fractionation  and particle size analysis pp.  545-
566. In C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of soil  analysis.  Part 1.  Physical and
mineralogical properties including statistics  of  measurement and  sampling.
Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr. No.  9.  Madison,  Wisconsin.

Dibble, J. T. and R. Bartha.  1979. Effect  of  environmental parameters on
biodegradation of oil sludge.  Appl.  Environ.  Micro.  37:729-738.

Dindal, D. L. 1978. Soil organisms and stabilizing wastes. Compost Sci./
Land Utilization. 19(4):8-11.

Doelman, P. and L. Haanstra.  1979. Effects  of  lead  on the decomposition of
organic matter. Soil Biol. Biochem.  11:481-485.

EPA. 1979. Methods for chemical analysis of water and wastes. Environmental
Monitoring and Support Laboratory. Office  of  Research and Development,  EPA.
Cincinnati, Ohio. EPA 600/4-79-020.  PB 297-686/8BE.

Fine, L. 0. 1965. Selenium,  pp. 1117-1123.  In C.  A.  Black (ed.) Methods of
soil analysis. Part 2. Chemical and  microbiological  properties. Am.  Soc.
Agron. Monogr. No. 9. Madison,  Wisconsin.

Fluker, B. J. 1958. Soil temperatures.  Soil Sci.  86:35-46.

Friello, D. A., J. R. Mylroie,  and A. M. Chakrabarty. 1976. Use of
genetically engineered multi-plasmid microorganisms  for rapid degradation
of fuel hydrocarbons, pp. 205-214. In_ CRC  Critical Reviews in Micro.

Fuller, W. H. 1978. Investigations of landfill leachate pollutant attenua-
tion by soils. Municipal Environmental Research Laboratory. Office of
Research and Development, EPA.  Cincinnati,  Ohio.  EPA 600/2-78-158.

Hamaker, J. W. 1971. Decomposition:  quantitative  aspects, pp. 253-4340. In
C. A. I. Goring and J. W. Hamaker  (ed.)  Organic chemicals in the soil
environment. Vol. 2. Marcel  Dekker,  Inc.,  New York.

Homes, M. V. 1955. A new approach  to the problem of  plant nutrition and
fertilizer requirements. Soils Fertilizers 18:1.

Hutzinger, 0., S. Safe, and  V.  Zitko. 1972. Photochemical degradation of
chlorobiphenyls (PCB's). Environ.  Health Perspect.  1:15-20.


                                     89

-------
Jensen, V. 1975. Bacterial  flora  of  soil  after application of oily waste.
Oikos 26:152-158.

Jensen, V. and E. Holm.  1972. Aerobic  chemoorganotrophic bacteria of a
Danish beech forest. Oikos  23:248-260.

Kloke, A. 1974. Blei-zink-cadmium: anreicher in boden and pflanzen. Staub
34:18-21.

Klute, A. 1965. Laboratory  measurement  of hydraulic conductivity of satu-
rated soil. pp. 210-221. Iii C.  A.  Black (ed.) Methods of soil analysis.
Part 1. Physical and mineralogical properties including statistics of
measurement and sampling. Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr.  No. 9. Madison,
Wisconsin.

Mehlich, A. 1941. Base saturation  and  pH  in relation to soil type. Soil
Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 6:150-156.

Mitchell, M., R. M. Mulligan, R.  Hartenstein, and  E. F. Neuhauser. 1977.
Conversion of sludges into  "topsoils"  by  earthworms. Compost Sci.  18(4):28-
32.

Mitchel, M. J., R. Hartenstein, B. L.  Swift, E. F. Neuhauser, B. I. Abrams,
R. M. Mulligan, B. A. Brown,  D. Craig,  and D. Kaplan. 1978. Effects of
different sewage sludges on some  chemical and biological characteristics of
soil. J. Environ. Qual.  14:301-311.

Ou, LL-tse, D. F. Rothwell, W.  B.  Wheeler, and J.  M. Davidson. 1978. The
effect of high 2,4-D concentrations  on degradation and carbon dioxide
evolution in soils. J. Environ. Qual.  7(2):241-246.

Overcash, M. R. and D. Pal. 1979.  Design  of land treatment systems for
industrial wastes—theory and practice. Ann Arbor  Science Publ. Ann Arbor,
Michigan. 684 p.

Patil, K. C., F. M. Matsumura,  and G.  M.  Boush. 1970. Degradation  of
Endrin, Aldrin, and DDT  by  soil microorganisms. Appl. Micro. 19(5):879-
886.

Peech, M. 1941. Availability of ions in light sandy soils as affected by
soil reaction. Soil Sci. 51:473-486.

Peech, M. 1965. Lime requirement.  Agron.  9:927-932.

Perry, J. J. and R. Cerniglia.  1973. Studies on the degradation of petro-
leum by filamentous fungi.   J-n  D.  C. Ahearn and S. P. Meyers (ed.) The
microbial degradation of oil pollutants.  Louisiana State Univ. Center for
Wetland Resources. Baton Rouge, Louisiana. LSU-SG-7301.

Poglazova, M. N., G. E.  Fedoseeva, and A. J. Klesina, M. N. Meissel, and L.
M. Shabad. 1967. Destruction of benzo (a) pyrene by soil bacteria. Life
Sci. 6:1053-1067.

                                     90

-------
Pritchett, W. L. 1979. Properties and management of Forest Soils. John
Wiley and Sons, New York.

Raymond, R. L., J. 0. Hudson, and V. W. Jamison. 1976. Oil degradation in
soil. Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 31(4):522-535.

Richards, L. A. 1965. Physical condition of water in soil. pp. 128-152. In_
C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of soil analysis. Part 1. Physical and mineralog-
ical properties, including statistics of measurement and sampling.  Am.
Soc. Agron. Monogr. No. 9. Madison, Wisconsin.

Stewart, B. A., 0* A. Woolhiser, W. H. Wischmeier, J. H. Carow, and M. H.
Frere. 1975. Control of water pollution from cropland: Vol I. A manual for
guideline development. U.S. Department of Agriculture. Report ARS-H-5-1.'
Hyattsville, Maryland. Ill p.

Tisdale, S. L. and W. L. Nelson. 1975. Soil fertility and fertilizers. 3rd
ed. MacMillan Publishing Co., New York.

Tucker, E. S., V. W. Saeger, and 0. Hicks. 1975. Activated sludge primary
biodegradation of polychlorinated biphenyls. Bull. Environ. Contam. Toxic.
14(6):705-713.

USDA. 1954. Diagnosis and improvement of saline and alkali soils. L. A.
Richards (ed.) Agriculture Handbook. No. 60. 160 p.

USDA. 1981. Examination and description of soils in the field. Revised
Chapter 4, pp. 4-31-4-37. In Soil survey manual. U.S. Soil Conservation
Service, Washington, D.C.

Verstraete, W., R. Vanlooke, R. de Borger, and A. Verlinde. 1975. Modeling
of the breakdown and mobilization of hydrocarbons in unsaturated soil
layers, pp. 98-112. In J. M. Sharpley and A. M. Kaplan (eds.) Proceedings
of the Third International Biodegradation Symposium. Applied Science Publ.,
London.

Walker, J. D., R. R. Colwell, and L. Petraskis. 1976. Biodegradation of
petroleum by Chesapeake Bay sediment bacteria. Can. J. Microbiol.
22:423-428.

Wear, J. I. 1965. Boron, pp. 1059-1063. In_C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of
soil analysis. Part 2. Chemical and microbiological properties. Am. Soc.
Agron. Monogr. No. 9. Madison, Wisconsin.

Westlake, D. W. S., A. Jobson, R. Phillippee, and F. D. Cook. 1974.
Blodegradability and crude oil composition. Can. Jour. Microbial.
20:915-928.

Wooding, H. N. and R. F. Shipp. 1979. Agricultural use and disposal of
septic tank sludge in Pennsylvania - information and recommendations for
farmers, septage haulers, municipal officials, and regulatory agencies.
Penn. State Univ. Cooperative Ext. Ser. Special Circular 257.

                                     91

-------
5.0                            CHAPTER FIVE

                          HAZARDOUS WASTE STREAMS
     This  chapter presents  information  to be  used  in  evaluating  waste
streams  proposed  for land treatment.   There  are  three main  factors that
need to be considered when evaluating the information on waste streams sub-
mitted with a permit application for an HWLT unit.  These  three factors are
the characterization of  the  wastes,  the pretreatment options available and
the techniques used  for  sampling  and analysis.  Figure  5.1  shows how each
of these topics fits into the decision-making framework for evaluating HWLT
units, first presented in Chapter 2 (Fig. 2.1).

     Each  section in this chapter  focuses  on one  of  the topics  shown in
Fig. 5.1.   Section 5.1  briefly discusses  sources  of  hazardous waste.   A
number of  pretreatment options are  available  that can  reduce the hazards
associated with certain waste streams; Section 5.2 discusses these options.
Finally, in  order to  accurately  predict  the fate  of  a given waste  in an
HWLT unit, the  permit  evaluator must know  what  analytical techniques were
used  by  the  applicant  in   performing  the  waste  analysis.   Section 5.3
discusses procedures that are appropriate for analyzing hazardous wastes.
5.1                     SOURCES OF HAZARDOUS WASTE
     The first step in  evaluating a waste stream  is  to determine what the
expected waste constituents are based on what is known  about the  sources of
the  waste.    Hazardous  waste  sources  fall  into  two  broad  categories as
follows:

     (1)  Specific  industrial  sources  that generate  waste   streams
          peculiar  to  the  feedstocks  and   processes  used  by  that
          industry, such as leather, rubber  or textiles; and
     (2)  Nonspecific  sources  of waste  that  cut across  industrial
          categories, but  may  still  be characterized  according to  the
          raw materials  and processes  used,  such  as  solvent cleaning
          or product painting.


5.1.1                        Specific Sources


     Industries that produce a waste unique  to  that industry are "specific
sources" of  that  waste.    Examples  of  "specific" industrial  sources are
textiles, lumber,  paper, inorganic chemicals, organic chemicals, petroleum
products,  rubber  products,   leather  products,   stone  products,  primary
metals and others.  Table  5.1  ranks  most of the specific sources according
to the volume of hazardous waste  each is projected to generate  in 1985.
                                    92

-------
                    WASTE
                      POTENTIAL
                        SITE
               CHARACTERIZATION OF
               THE WASTE STREAM
                 CHAPTER FIVE
    /HAS THE APPLICANT INCLUDED ADEQUATE
   / INFORMATION ON  HAZARDOUS WASTE CONSTITU-\
     ENTS AND THE SOURCES OF THESE CONSTITU-
   V   ENTS?                               /n°
    \.           (SECTION 5.1)            S~~~
                        yes
    /IF THE APPLICANT MAKES IN-PLANT PRO-   N
   /CESS CHANGES OR PRETREATS THE WASTES, ARE!
    THESE METHODS GOING TO PERFORM CONSIS-    '
   UENTLY, SO THAT THE WASTES REMAIN CONS-   7no
   \^ TANT?  (SECTION 5.2)               /
                        yes
ASK FOR CONTIN-
GENCY PLANS  FOR
WHEN WASTES  VAR1
SIGNIFICANTLY
FROM THE ANA-
LYZED WASTE
              ARE THE ANALYTICAL
          ' CEDURES USED TO ASSESS THE
               WASTES APPROPRIATE?
                  (SECTION 5.3)
                        yes
            ASSESS THE EXPECTED FATE
              OF WASTE CONSTITUENTS
                  CHAPTER SIX
                 CHARACTERIZATION OF
                 THE TREATMENT MEDIUM
                    CHAPTER FOUR
                                             WASTE - SITE
                                             INTERACTIONS
                                             CHAPTER SEVEN
Figure 5.1.   Characterization  of  the  waste  stream  to be land  treated.
                                             93

-------
TABLE 5.1  PROJECTED  1985 HAZARDOUS WASTE  GENERATION  BY  INDUSTRY*
                                          Annual  Volume  of Waste  Generatedt
                                                            1985  Projection
ij J.VI
Code
28
33
—
34
29
37
26
36
31
35
39
30

22
27
38
24
25
32
Industry
Chemicals & Allied Products
Primary Metals
Nonmanufacturing Industries
Fabricated Metal Products
Petroleum & Coal Products
Transportation Equipment
Paper & Allied Products
Electric & Electronic Equipment
Leather & Leather Tanning
Machinery, Except Electrical
Miscellaneous Manufacturing
Rubber & Miscellaneous Plastic
Products
Textile Mill Products
Printing & Publishing
Instruments & Related Products
Lumber & Wood Products
Furniture & Fixtures
Stone, Clay & Glass Products
1980 Estimate
25,509
4,061
1,971
1,997
2,119
1,240
1,295
1,093
474
322
318

249
203
154
90
87
36
17
Low''
24,564
3,699
1,882
1,807
1,789
1,309
1,201
1,145
342
330
299

226
162
145
99
75
29
15
High+
30,705
4,624
2,352
2,259
2,236
1,636
1,501
1,431
428
413
374

282
203
182
124
94
36
19
        TOTAL
41,235
39,118    48,899
* Booz-Allen and Hamilton, Inc. and Putnam, Hayes and Bartlett,  Inc.
  (1980).

t In thousands of wet metric tons.

* Based on a reasonable estimate of the potential reduction  (20%)  in
  waste generation.

"*" Based on the industrial growth rate used to calculate  1980  and 1981
  estimates.
                                     94

-------
 5.1.2              Nonspecific  Sources  of Hazardous  Waste
      There  are several hazardous waste  generating  activities  that are not
 specific  to a particular  industry.   For  instance, many manufactured pro-
 ducts are cleaned and painted before they are marketed.  Product  cleaning
 is  usually done with solvents and,  consequently,  many industries  generate
 spent solvent  wastes.   Similarly, industrial  painting  generates paint resi-
 dues.   Eighteen  nonspecific wastes are listed in Table 5.2.   There are
 three main categories of hazardous  constituents generated by these nonspe-
 cific sources  which  are  solvents, heavy  metals and  cyanide, and paint (Fig.
 5.2).
5.1.3              Sources of Information on Waste Streams
     The  applicant  and the permit writer  can use published information on
the  chemical analysis of  similar  hazardous wastes  to  help them determine
the  constituents expected  in the wastes to  be land treated.  In some cases,
this information  may indicate the presence of  constituents which may need
to be pretreated before they are disposed in  an HWLT unit.

     There  is little  information on  the  waste  streams from  the organic
chemicals  Industry  because each  plant uses  a unique  collection of feed-
stocks and  unit chemical  processes to produce its line of  products.   How-
ever,  some  information  about  the  nature  of  the waste  can be  gained if
information is  known about the  chemical feedstocks and  unit  process used
(Herrick et al., 1979).

     A  document  is  currently  being prepared  for EPA  by K. W.  Brown and
Associates,  Inc. that  will pull  together information on waste streams gen-
erated by the industries that produce hazardous wastes.   This document will
present chemical analyses  (where  available) and information on the hazard-
ous  constituents contained in the waste streams of these  Industries accord-
ing  to the  standard industrial classification.  This document together with
waste analyses supplied to EPA should form  a basis for  a  better understand-
ing of hazardous waste streams*


5.2                         WASTE PRETREATMENT


     Pretreatment processes may be used  to  render a waste more amenable to
land treatment.   This  can be accomplished  by altering the waste in  a way
that either changes  its  physical  properties or reduces its content of the
waste  constituents  that  limit  the  land   treatment  operation.    Physical
alterations  include  premixing the waste with  soil  and  reducing the unit
                                     95

-------
            TABLE 5.2  POTENTIALLY HAZARDOUS WASTE STREAMS GENERATED BY  NONSPECIFIC  INDUSTRIAL SOURCES
ON
                      Hazardous
            Modified    Waste
            SIC Code    Number         Activity
                                                                                                LAND TREATMENT POTENTIAL*
                        FOOI     Degreasing opera-
                                   tions (halogenated
                                   solvent)
                        F002     llalogenated solvent
                                   recovery
            F003     Nonhalogenated sol-
                       vent recovery

            F004     Nonhalogenated sol-
                       vent recovery

            F005     Nonhalogenated sol-
                       vent recovery

3471.1      F006     Electroplating

3471.2      F007     Electroplating
3471.3      F008     Electroplating

3471.4      F009     Electroplating
            3398.1      F010     Metal heat treating

            3398.2      F011     Metal heat treating

            3398.3      F012     Metal heat treating

                        F013     Metal recovery
                        F014     Metal recovery


                        F015     Metal recovery

            3312.1      F016     Operations involving
                                   coke ovens I. blast
                                   furnaces
                                                 Haste  Stream
                                         Rate  (R)  or  Capacity  (C)
                                           Limiting Components
Spent halogenated
  solvents & sludge

Spent halogenated
  solvents & still
  bottoms

Spent nonhalogenated
  solvents & still
  bottoms
Spent nonhalogenated
  solvents t still
  bottoms
Spent nonhaolgenated
  solvents & still-
  bottoms
Wastewater treatment
  sludge
Spent plating bath
Plating bath bottom
  sludges
Spent stripping t
  cleaning bath
  solutions
Quenching oil bath
  sludge
Spent salt bath
  solutions
Wastewater treatment
  sludge
Flotation trailings
Cyanidation Wastewater
  treatment tailing
  pond bottom sediments
Spent cyanide bath
  solutions
Air pollution control
  scrubber sludge
                                                                     Tetrachloroethylene (C); carbon tetrachloride (C);
                                                                     Trichloroethyllene (C); 1,1,1-trichloroethane (C);
                                                                     Methylene  chloride (C)i chlorinated fluorocarbons (C)
                                                                     Tetrachloroethylene (C); methylene chloride (C);
                                                                     Trichloroethylene (C); 1,I,1-trichloroethane (C);
                                                                     1,1,2-trichloro-l, 2,2-fluoroethane (C) Chlorobenzc-ne  (C)
                                                                     o-dichlorobenzene (C) ; trichlorofluoroethane (C)
                                                                     Flammable  solvents (R)
                                                                                 Cresols  (R)  and cresylic acid (R);  nitrobenzene (C)
Methanol (R); toluene  (R); methyl ethyl  ketone  (R);
Methyl isobutyl ketone  (R); carbon disulfide  (R);
Isobutanol (R); pyridine  (R)
Cadmium (C); chromium  (C); nickel (C);
Cyanide (complexed)  (C)
Cyanide salts (C)
Cyanide salts (C)

Cyanide salts (C)
                                                                     Cyanide salts (C)

                                                                     Cyanide salts (C)

                                                                     Cyanide (complexed) (C)

                                                                     Cyanide (complexed) (C) and metals from  the ore
                                                                     Cyanide (complexed) (C)


                                                                     Cyanide salts (C)

                                                                     Cyanide (complexed) (C)
3479.1

3479.2

F017 Industrial painting

F018 Industrial painting

Paint residues

Wastewater treatment
sludge
Cadmium
toluene
Cadmium
toluene
(C);
(R)i
(C);
(R);
chromium (C); lead (C);
tetrachloroethylene (C)
chromium (C); lead (C);
tetrachloroethylene (C)
cyanides (C) ;

cyanide (C);

            *  Values for waste constituents may vary; hence,  loading  rates  and  capacities should be based on the analysis of the
              specific waste to be land treated and on  the  results of  the pilot studies performed.  Organic compounds are labeled (C)
              when it is believed that there may be some soil conditions under  which  the compound may not degrade rapidly enough to
              prevent tosicity hazards, either due to accumulation in  soil  or migration via water or air.

-------
                                      NONSPECIFIC WASTE
                                        CATEGORIES
                                                                     HEAVY METAL  OR CYANIDE
                                                                        BEARING WASTES
                                         Industrial
                                          Painting
                                          Residues
                                          Metal recovery
                                            wastes
      Solvent Recovery
        Sludges
Industrial Painting
Wastewater Treatment
   Sludges
Figure 5.2.   Categories  of hazardous constituents generated by nonspecific  sources.

-------
size of  waste  materials.  Specific  waste constituents  can  limit the ulti-
mate capacity,  yearly loading rate,  or  the single application  dosage of a
waste disposed  in an  HWLT  unit  (Section  7.5.1).   Pretreatment processes are
available  that will  reduce  the  concentration of  a  limiting  constituent.
Pretreatment may improve both  the economic and environmental aspects of the
HWLT unit.   When waste  form or  waste  constituents warrant  examining pre-
treatment options,  in-plant  process  changes should also be explored.

     It  is  beyond  the scope  of  this document  to  review  all  the available
pretreatment techniques  and  their treatment efficiencies  for  the thousands
of pollutant species.  However,  EPA (1980a) has  recently published a five
volume  manual   that  exhaustively  covers  the  following  topics  that  can be
used to  evaluate pretreatment.

     (1)  Volume one  is  a compendium of  treatability  data,  industrial
          occurrence  data,  and  pure species  descriptions  of  metals,
          cyanides, ethers,  phthalates,  nitrogen containing compounds,
          phenols,  mono  and  polynuclear aromatics,  PCBs, halogenated
          hydrocarbons,  pesticides,  oxygenated compounds, and a  number
          of miscellaneous organic compounds.  This  volume  focuses on
          the  129   priority  pollutants  and other compounds  that are
          prevalent  in industrial wastewaters and  that  do not readily
          degrade  or disappear  from aqueous  environments,  which are
          the  ultimate receivers of  leachates  generated by land  treat-
          ment  units.
     (2)  Volume  two is  a  collection   of  industrial  wastewater dis-
          charge  information  and  includes   data for  both  raw  and
          treated wastewaters.
     (3)  Volume three is  a compilation  of  available  performance data
          for  existing wastewater treatment technologies.
     (4)  Volume  four is  a  collection  of  capital and  operating cost
          data for  the   treatment  technologies   described   in   volume
          three.
     (5)  Volume five is an  executive summary and describes the  use  of
          information contained  in volumes one through  four.

     To  determine the most desirable mix of pretreatments for a  land  treat-
ment system, total  costs should  be weighed  against the degree  of treatment
required.   Possible pretreatment  steps  for  enhancing the land  treatability
of waste as  presented by Loehr et al. (1979),  are discussed below.

     (1)  Preliminary treatment  (coarse  screening or  grinding)  is used
          to remove  large  objects  such  as  wood,  rags  and  rocks  to
          protect piping and spray systems.
     (2)  Primary  treatment  usually involves  the removal  of  readily
          settleable  and  floatable  solids.   The  primary  treatment
          effluent  can  then be  land treated  by   spray irrigation  or
          overland  flow.   Since the removed solids can  clog both spray
                                     98

-------
           nozzles and the soil surface,  these  solids are usually  land
           treated by soil incorporation.

      (3)   Secondary treatment  includes several  biological treatments
           (such  as  aerated lagoons,  anaerobic  digestion,  composting
           and  activated  sludge)  and  any  subsequent  solids settling.
           Secondary pretreatment systems may be  necessary where it  is
           desirable to  remove soluble organics  or  suspended  solids
           that  may clog  the  soil.   Secondary  treatment  effluents are
           usually suitable  for spray  irrigation while  the secondary
           treatment sludges can be  incorporated into  the  soil.    Land
           treatment of  a  waste  often results  in  the   breakdown  of
           organics as  rapidly as  secondary treatment but  the addi-
           tional   treatment  may  be  necessary  for  some  refractory
           organics.

      (4)   Disinfection is the  treatment  of  effluents  to  kill disease
           causing organisms such  as pathogenic  bacteria,  viruses and
           amoebic cysts.   Chlorination effectively kills pathogens but
           may  also generate chlorinated organics  and have undesirable
           effects on cover crops  and  leachate  quality.   Ozonation  is
           more  expensive  than chlorination,  but effectively disinfects
           a  waste stream without the  undesirable  effects  of chlorina-
           tion.    Coupling  ozonation  with  irradiation by ultraviolet
           light may improve its economic feasibility and enhance over-
           all waste treatment.  Compounds normally refractory  to ozone
           alone are rapidly converted  to carbon dioxide and water  when
           subjected to the  combination (Rice and Browning, 1981).

      (5)   Advanced (tertiary)  wastewater treatment refers to processes
           designed to  remove   dissolved  solids  and  soluble   organics
           that  are  not  adequately treated by  secondary  treatment.
           Land  treatment  usually  exceeds  the  results  obtainable
           through tertiary  treatment  for removal  of  nitrogen,  phos-
           phorous and  soluble organics.   In  these  cases  a  tertiary
           treatment  may not  be useful; however, tertiary treatment for
           the  removal  of dissolved  salts  (such as  reverse  osmosis  or
           distillation)  may   produce  an  effluent  of  drinking  water
           quality and  circumvent  the need for land treatment.

      Table  5.3  lists  the different  pretreatment methods  and  their  applic-
ability  to hazardous waste  treatment.  Although,  in many cases,  pretreat-
ment  of  the  waste is  not  necessary prior to land  treatment,  pretreatments
with  the  most  potential  for enhancing the land  treatability  of wastes are
examined  in  the following sections  (5.2.1 through  5.2.6).   Neutralization,
dewatering,  degradation processes, premixing with  soil,  and size  reduction
may greatly  increase  the  effectiveness of land  treatment for a given waste;
however,  in-plant  process  changes   may  also  be   effective  in  reducing
troublesome  waste constituents.  In all cases,  care must be taken when pre-
treatment  processes  are being  considered to  evaluate the cost effectiveness
of the process  and to determine if  the process  (which may  have originally
been  developed  to render a  waste  compatible with  another disposal  option)
is appropriate for land treatment  operations.


                                     99

-------
TABLE 5.3  PRETREATMEHT  METHODS FOR HAZARDOUS WASTES*
Pretreatnent
He t hod
Activated
sludge
Aerated
lagoons
Anaerobic
digestion
Composting

Enzymatic
biological
treatment
Trickling
filters
Waste
stabilization
r; ponds
O Carbon
adsorption
Resin
adsorption
Calcination


Catalysis
Centrifugation
Chlorinolysis

Dialysis
Dissolution
Distillation
Electrolysis
Heavy
Metal
Removal
Yes

No


llo
No


No

No


No

Yes

Possible

Possible


Ho
Yes
No

Yes
Yes
Ho
Yes
Organic
Removal
Yes

Yes


Yes
Yes


Yes

Yes


Yes

Yes

Yes

No


No
No
tlo

No-
No
Yes
No
Organic
Destruction
Yes

Yes


Yes
Yes


Yes

Yes


Yes

No

No

Yes


Yes
Ho
Yes

No
Ho
No
No
Waste
Volume
Reduction
Yes

Yes


Yes
Yes


No

Yes


Yes

No

No

Yes


Ho
Yes
Yes

No
Ho
Yes
!Jo
Comments
Waste must have heavy metal content
less than 1%
Used in temperate climates


Very sensitive to toxic compounds
Least sensitive method of biological
treatment

Only works for specific chemicals

Low efficiency for organic removal


Waste must have dilute concentrations
of organic and inorganics
efficient for wastes with less than 1%
organics
Extracts and recovers mainly organics
ganics solutes from aqueous waste
Will require volume of nonorganics
and convert them into a form of low
teachability

Primarily used for dewatering sludge
Conversion of chlorinated hydrocarbons
to carbon tetrachloride
Separation of salts from aqueous
Removal of heavy metals from fly ashes
Recovery of organic solvents
Removal of heavy metals from concen-
Physical
Liquid,

Liquid ,



Slurry,


Liquid ,

Liquid ,


Liquid,

Liquid

Liquid

Liquid,


Liquid
Slurry
Liquid

Liquid
Liquid,
Liquid,
Liquid
Form Treated
slurry.

slurry,



sludge ,


slurry,

slurry,


slurry,





slurry.







slurry.
slurry.

sluri'JG

sludge



liquid


sludge

sludge


sludge





sludge







sludge
sludga

                                                                 trated aqueous solution
                                                          —cont iijued —

-------
TABLE 5.3  (continued)
Pretreatment
Method
Electrodialysis
Evaporation
Filtration
Precipitation,
f locculation.
sedimentation

Flotation-
biological
Freeze
crystal! zat ion
Freeze drying
Suspension
freezing
Hydrolysis
Ion exchange

Liquid ion
exchange

Liquid-liquid
extraction of
organics
Microwave
discharge
Neutralization
Chemical
oxidation
Ozonolysis
Heavy
Metal
Removal
Possible
No
Yes


Yes

Yes

Yes

No
Yes

No
Yes

Yes




No
Mo

No
Possible

No
Organic
Removal
No
Possible
No


Yes

No

Yes

No
No

No
Yes

No




Yes
Possible

No
Ho

No
Organic
Destruction
No
No
No


Ho

NO

NO

No
No

Yes
No

No




No
Yes

No
Yes

Yes
Haste
Volume
Reduction
No
Yes
Yes


Yes

No

Yes

Yes
Yes

No
No

No




Ito
Yes

No
No

No
CoMents
Recovery of inorganic salts
Recovery of inorganic salts
Removal of Metal precipitates


Removal or recovery of solids fron
aqueous solution
Separation of solid particles sus-
pended in a liquid medium
Desalination of water

Separation of pure water from solids
Separation of suspended particles
magnetic particles from liquids
May increase toxicity of waste
Selective removal of heavy metals and
hazardous anions
Selective removal and/or separation of
free and couple xed metal ions in high
concentrations


Solvent recovery
Developmental stages; primarily for
small quantities of toxic compounds
Renders waste treatable by other
Detoxification of hazardous materials

Hay be used to make toxic wastes more
Physical
Liquid
Liquid
Slurry


Liquid.

Slurry

Liquid,

Liquid,
Liquid

Liquid,
Liquids

Liquid,




Liquid
Liquid

Liquid,
Liquid

Liquid
Form Treated





slurry



slurry, sludge

slurry


slurry, sludge


slurry, sludge







slurry, sludge



                                                              susceptible to biological action,
                                                              especially chlorinated hydrocarbons
                                                        —continued—

-------
TABLE 5.3  (continued)
Pretreataent
Method
Photolysis
Chemical
reduction
Reverse osmosis
Size reduction
Soil nixing
Steam
distillation
Air stripping
»— *
o
to Steam stripping
Ultra
filtration
Zone refining
Heavy
Metal
Removal
No
Possible
Yes
No
Ho
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Organic Organic
Removal Destruction
No
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
Possible
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
Waste
Volume
Reduction Comments
No
No
Yes
Ho
No
Yes
Ho
No
Ho
No
Degradation of aromatic and
chlorinated hydrocarbons
Detoxification of hazardous materials
Purification dilute wastewaters
For spill debris such as contaminated
pallets and lumber
Volume of waste will increase, this
technique applies to stick or tarry
waste
Solvent recovery
Recovery of volatile compounds from
aqueous solutions
Recovery of volatile compounds from
aqueous solutions
Separation of dissolved or suspended
particles from a liquid stream
Purification technique for obtaining
high-purity organic and inorganic
materials
Physical Form Treated
Liquid
Liquid
Liquid
Solid

Liquid, slurry, slurige
Liquid, slurry
Liquid, slurry
Liquid
Liquid
* De Renzo <1978).

-------
5.2.1                        Neutralization
     Neutralization  (pH  adjustment)  may  be a  desirable  pretreatment  for
strongly  acidic  or   alkaline   wastes   being  land  treated.    Biological
treatment systems, such  as  land  treatment, rely on ndcrobial degradation as
the  major  treatment  mechanism  for  organic  constituents  in  the  waste.
Microbial   growth  and,   hence,   treatment   efficiency   are  optimized  by
maintaining the pH near  neutral.

     Neutralization  involves  the reaction of a solution with excess hydron-
ium or hydroxide ions  to form water and neutral salts (Adams et  al., 1981).
Care should be taken to  select  a neutralizing agent that will not produce a
neutral  salt   that  is  detrimental to   the  land  treatment  process.    For
instance, lime (CaCC^) is  vastly preferable to  caustic soda  (NaOH)  as an
agent to neutralize  an acidic waste.   Lime  adds  calcium to the waste which
will improve  the workability of the treatment soil.   Calcium  is  also an
essential nutrient for cover crops and  microbes.   Conversely,  caustic  soda
adds sodium which can decrease   the  workability  of  the  soil  and,  at  high
concentrations, sodium is toxic  to  cover crops and microbes.

     It  should be  noted  that the biological treatment  process that occurs
in  land  treated soils may itself  change the  pH  of a  waste-soil mixture.
The pH of treated soil is reduced by  the following (Adams  et al., 1981):

     (1)  Hydroxide  alkalinity  is destroyed by the biochemical produc-
          tion of C02;
           Carbohydrate + (n)02 -?•             ""* (n) C°2 +  (n) H2°
                        C02 + OH" - » HC<>3~

     (2)  Reduced  forms  of sulfur  can be  biochemically  oxidized  to
          sulfuric acid;  and
                        H2S + 202


     (3)  Oxidation  of  ammonium releases hydrogen ions.

                  NH4+ + 202  - > NC-3- + 2H+ + H20

The pH of treated soil  is increased by the biochemical oxidation of organic
acids as follows  (Adams et al.,  1981).
               R - COOH + (n)02 -5> "iJ1 ~*(n) C°2
                                     103

-------
 5.2.2                            Dewatering
      Dewatering is a broad  term referring to  any  process that  reduces  the
water content  and, hence, the volume  of  a waste which increases  the  solids
content  of  the remaining waste.  The oldest,  simplest and most  economical
method of  dewatering a waste uses  shallow evaporation ponds.  However,  for
such  a  system to be  feasible,   adequate land  area  must  be  available  and
evaporation rates must  exceed precipitation rates  (Adams  et  al.,  1981).

      Evaporative  rates can  be   increased  by  placing  spray aerators  on  the
surface  of  the pond.   Spray aeration has the added advantages  of  increasing
waste decomposition  by exposing  the wastewater to  ultraviolet rays  present
in  sunlight and  encouraging  aerobic decomposition   using oxygen  adsorbed
during spraying.

      A wastewater can be signficantly dewatered through  freeze  crystaliza-
tion.  This process  is  used to  segregate a liquid  waste  stream  into  fresh-
water ice  cyrstals   and  a  concentrated  solution  of  the  remaining  heavy
metals,  cyanides  and organics.   The  ice  crystals can then  be  removed  by
mechanical  means   (Metry,  1980).   Freeze  crystalization  is  an  especially
attractive  dewatering  technique in  northern  sections  of the  U.S.  where
evaporative rates  are  low  and  the   cold   climate  provides   cost-free
freezing.

      Drying beds  are  shallow   impoundments   usually  equipped   with  sand
bottoms  and tile  drains.   Typically,  sludge  is poured over  the  sand to  a
depth of 20 to  30 cm.    Free drainage  out of  the tile  drains  occurs  for
several  days and  drying time ranges from weeks to  months, depending  on  the
weather  and sludge properties (Ettlich et al.,  1978).

      Filtration i,s the  mechanism used in several dewatering processes.   It
involves  the separation  of  liquids and  solids  by forcing liquids  through
porous membranes  (screen  or cloth)  or media as  in  the  drying beds  discussed
above.   Liquids are  forced through by pressure, vacuum, gravity  or  centri-
fugal force and the  dewatered solids  can then  be land  treated.

      Various processes  are  used to increase   the  ease or  extent to  which
sludge dewaters.   The  most  widely used of  these processes  involves  two
steps.   First,  a  chemical  conditioner  (such  as  lime,  ferric  chloride,
aluminum  chloride  or  a  variety of  organic  polymers)  is  added  to  the
wastewater  that causes  dissolved or suspended  solids  to clump  together into
suspended  particles.    Then  these suspended  particles  clump  together  into
larger particles which  either settle out  of solution or can be more  easily
removed by  filtration.
5.2.3                        Aerobic Degradation


     Several  aerobic  degradation  processes   are   used   to   pretreat   land
treated  wastes.    These  processes  can effectively  reduce  the  quantity  of

                                     104

-------
volatile  and highly  mobile organic  species  in  a  waste  stream.   Aerobic
processes  discussed  below  are  composting,  activated  sludge   and  aerated
lagooning.

     Composting  involves  the aerobic  degradation of a waste material placed
in small piles or  windrows so  that the heat produced by microbial action is
contained.   Maintenance  of an  abundant  supply  of  oxygen  in  the  compost
pile, coupled with elevated temperature and sufficient moisture, results in
a  degradation process which  is  much  more  rapid  than  that   which  would
otherwise  occur.   Pretreatment  by  composting can result  in a  product that
can  be  easily stored  until land  treated.   This  is a  particularly useful
approach  where  a  continuous  stream  of waste  cannot be  continuously land
treated due  to frozen  or  wet soil  conditions.

     The  Beltesville  method  of composting  uses  forced  aeration  through
windrows and has  been  used for  composting oily  wastes  (Epstein and Taffel,
1979; Texaco Inc.,  1979).   In these studies,  the  oily  waste is first mixed
with a bulking agent,  such as  rice hulls or wood chips, to  reduce the mois-
ture content to  40-60%.   Aeration  of  the mixed waste is maintained by draw-
ing  air  through a perforated pipe located under  the  waste pile  using an
exhaust fan.  The  waste pile  is covered with previously composted material
which acts as  an insulator  and  helps to  maintain  an elevated   temperature.
Air which  has  passed through  the  pile  is  filtered  through  another smaller
pile of  previously composted  waste  to  reduce  odors.   Epstein and Taffel
(1979) noted that  composting  of  sewage sludge  almost  completely degraded
the polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons.

     Activated sludge  uses  an aerobic microbial population that is  accli-
mated to the particular waste stream to  increase  the  rate  of  degradation.
The  acclimated  population is recycled  and  kept  in constant  contact  with
incoming  wastewater.    Activated  sludge  has been  extensively  applied  to
industrial wastewaters  for the degradation of organic wastewaters that  have
low heavy  metal  content.    Tucker  et  al.  (1975) demonstrated  that PCBs  can
be degraded  in the activated  sludge  process, but  others have found heavily
chlorinated  molecules  to   be  resistant to  microbial  degradation  by  this
method.   Use of  microorganisms  acclimated to these chlorinated waste  con-
stituents  may  improve efficiency  of  the  activated  sludge process for  pre-
treatment  of wastes containing these  types of resistant compounds.

     As with activated sludge,  aerated lagoons are used  for the treatment
of aqueous solutions with a low metals  content.   Aerobic lagooning is  cur-
rently  used  by  industry  in  temperate  climates  where sufficient  land  is
available.   This  method of  aerobic degradation is  land intensive and  slow
compared to  composting and  activated sludge  processes; however, it may  be
less expensive  and  it serves as   a  convenient  method for storing  wastes
until weather or other limiting conditions are suitable for the waste to  be
land treated.  A major drawback of aerated lagooning is that it presents  a
considerable  risk of  groundwater  contamination.    This  risk  has  prompted
regulatory requirements (discussed in Section 5.2.4) for  lagoons.
                                     105

-------
 5.2.4                       Anaerobic Degradation
     Anaerobic  degradation involves  microbes  that degrade  organics in  the
absence  of  oxygen.   These microbes use  metabolic pathways that differ  from
the  pathways  used by aerobic microbes  and  can,  therefore, more effectively
degrade  some organics  that  are  resistant  to  degradation in  the  aerobic
soils  of  a land treatment unit.   Two widely used methods  for this  type  of
degradation are  anaerobic lagooning and anaerobic digestion.

     Anaerobic  and  aerobic  lagooning  of  wastes  has  been widely used  for
pretreatment  and  storage  of  wastes to be land treated.  While the  technique
has  been  inexpensive, recent  regulatory requirements for lining, monitoring
and  closing these facilities will  increase  the  cost of lagooning  hazardous
waste.   Other disadvantages  associated with both  types of lagooning  include
the  following:

     (1)  wastes  often  require  retention  times  of  several  months  for
          effective  treatment;

     (2)  due to the long retention  times, large amounts  of  land  may
          be  required to  handle all the waste; and

     (3)  there  may  be  significant long-term liability associated  with
          lagoons  due  to  their potential  for  groundwater contamina-
          tion.

     Anaerobic  digestion  of  waste  uses  enclosed  tanks   to  anaerobically
degrade  waste under  controlled conditions.   Initially,  the  technique  is
capital  intensive;  however,  there  are  several  advantages   compared  to
anaerobic lagooning,  as follows:

     (1)  since  the  treatment  process  is  completely  enclosed,  there
          would  be few, if any,  long-term liabilities;

     (2)  retention   time for   waste,  although  dependent  on   waste
          composition,  may be  less  than 10 days  (Kugelman and Jeris,
          1981);

     (3)  short  retention times mean less waste  volume on hand at  any
          time  and consequently less land  is required  for treatment
          facilities; and

     (4)  useful  by-products,  such as methane and carbon  dioxide,  can
          be  obtained from the  process.
5.2.5                            Soil Mixing
     Several  industries  produce tarry  wastes  that may  be  too  sticky  or
viscous to be easily  applied to land.   Examples  of this physical state  are
coal tar  sludge  and adhesives waste.   Mixing of  these  wastes with soil  Is
difficult because  the  sticky wastes tend to ball-up or  stick  to the surface


                                     106

-------
of discing implements.   A treatment  that  eliminates most of these difficul-
ties is the premixing of soil  with the waste in a  pug mill.   Pug mills cut
up  the  sticky mass  as   it combines  with  the  soil, producing  a soil-waste
mixture that  can be  easily applied to  land.
5.2.6                          Size  Reduction
     Often  bulky materials  are  contaminated with  hazardous  waste  during
production  processes  or accidental  spills.   Examples of  contaminated  bulk
materials  are  pallets,  lumber and  other debris  saturated or  coated  with
hazardous materials.  A common approach to making these wastes suitable for
land treatment is to  grind or  pulverize the debris.
5.3                   WASTE CHARACTERIZATION PROTOCOL
     A waste characterization  protocol serves an important function to pre-
vent adverse  health, safety,  or  environmental effects  from  land treatment
of hazardous waste.   It  is  required for the following reasons:

     (1)  to evaluate the  feasibility of  using  land treatment  for a
          particular waste;

     (2)  to  define  waste  characteristics indicative  of  changes  in
          composition;
     (3)  to evaluate results  generated in pilot studies;
     (4)  to define  management and design criteria;

     (5)  to determine application,  rate,  and  capacity limiting con-
          stituents  (These  design parameters  are  further discussed in
          Chapter  7.);

     (6)  to determine if the treatment  medium is effectively render-
          ing  the  applied waste less nonhazardous; and

     (7)  to  effectively monitor  any environmental  impact   resulting
          from the HWLT  unit.

     To  satisfy  these  requirements,   the  applicant  needs  to  provide   an
acceptable  characterization of the waste.  Additionally, the permit writer
needs  to  be able  to  evaluate  the  results  of  the analyses  to determine  if
the  appropriate parameters  have  been  addressed  or  if  additional  analyses
are required.   This  section provides the information needed to evaluate  the
waste characterization phase of the design process for HWLT.

     Because  of the  complexity  involved in  both the  characterization  of
hazardous waste and  the  evaluation of the results  submitted  by the appli-
cant, a set of guidelines or  analytical  requirements are appropriate.   The
following  step-by-step  approach  to  waste  characterization  will  provide
guidance  to both  the permit  applicant and  permit  writer.   The following


                                     107

-------
sections  are designed  to  reduce  and  simplify  the  characterization  and
evaluation processes.
5.3.1                  Preliminary Waste  Evaluation
     There  are a  tremendous  number  of  industrial   process  wastes  which
contain a wide variety of  complex  chemical mixtures.   Initial indicators of
the probable composition of  a  particular waste include the following:

     (1)  previous analytical  data on waste constituents;
     (2)  feedstocks used  in the particular industrial process; and
     (3)  products and by-products resulting from production processes.

By examining  data  presented on waste streams, the analytical  requirements
for a  particular  waste  may  be sufficiently evaluated  by both  the permit
applicant  and  the  permit  writer  to  preclude any  extensive,  unwarranted
analyses.   One must  realize, however,  that there may be  toxic or recalci-
trant constituents present in  a given hazardous  waste  that  are  either new
or previously  unnoted.   Therefore,  all possible  means  need to  be  used to
thoroughly  characterize  the  constituents found in waste samples.


5.3.2                          Waste  Analysis


     The analytical  chemistry  associated with HWLT should include appropri-
ate analyses  of the waste  in conjunction  with  preliminary  soil  studies,
compound degradation determinations,  and  monitoring  needs  (Chapters 4, 7,
and 9).   Most of  the following  discussion  refers  primarily  to  a  general
approach to be used  for  analyzing  the waste itself.   Physical, chemical and
biological  waste analyses  are  discussed.


5.3.2.1  Sampling and Preparation


     In sampling hazardous waste  and otner media relevant to HWLT,  one  must
continually strive  to  ensure  personal  safety  while  correctly   collecting
representative  samples  that will  provide  an accurate  assessment  of the
sample constituents.  After  obtaining some background information about the
probable nature of  the waste  and  the associated dangers,  the analysis may
then proceed using  the  appropriate  safety  measures,  as  outlined   by  de  Vera
et al. (1980).  The  person sampling a hazardous material must  be  aware  that
it may  be   corrosive,  flammable,   explosive,  toxic or  capable  of releasing
toxic fumes.

     Since  hazardous waste may be composed of  a  diverse mixture  of  organic
and  inorganic components  present  in  a variety  of  waste  matrices  (i.e.,
liquids, sludges  and solids),  it  is necessary to  use specialized  sampling


                                     108

-------
equipment to ensure that  the  sample  is  representative of the waste in ques-
tion.  For instance,  the  Coliwasa sampler, which consists  of  a tube, shaft
and rubber stopper, may be  used  for  sampling  layered liquids:   after inser-
tion of the tube into  the liquid waste,  the  shaft  is used to pull the stop-
per into  place  and  retain the sample.   Other examples  of  appropriate sam-
plers that may  be  used for sampling  various  types  of wastes  are  listed  in
Table  5.4.    Additional  information on  sampling  equipment,  methods,  and
limitations can be found  in EPA  (1982a).
TABLE 5.4  SAMPLERS RECOMMENDED  FOR VARIOUS TYPES OF WASTE*


                               Waste Location
      Waste type                 or Container           Sampling Apparatus

Free flowing liquids         Drums, trucks,  tanks     Coliwasa
 and slurries                Tanks, bins              Weighted Bottle
                             Pits,  ponds,  lagoons     Dipper

Dry solids or wastes         Drums, sacks, waste      Thief, scoops, shovels
                             piles, trucks,  tanks
                             pits,  ponds,  lagoons

Sticky or moist solids       Drums, trucks,  tanks,    Trier
 and sludges                 sacks, waste  piles,
                             pits,  ponds,  lagoons

Hard or packed wastes        Drums, sacks, trucks     Auger

* EPA (1982a).
     It is very  important  that all sampling equipment be thoroughly  cleaned
and  free  of  contamination both prior  to use and  between samples.   Storage
containers  should be  similarly free of  contamination.   Plastic or  teflon
may  be used  for  samples to be  analyzed  for inorganic constituents.   Glass,
teflon  or stainless  steel may be  used  for  samples intended  for  organic
analysis.   Caution should be  observed  that  both the  sampler  and  storage
container  materials  are  nonreactive with the  waste.   Ample  room  in  the
sample container must be  left to  allow for expansion  of  water if  the sample
is to be  frozen  in  storage.

     To ensure that the analytical methods employed  in  the waste  character-
ization do not under  or over-estimate either the  potential impact  or treat-
ment effectiveness, representative samples must be obtained.  A representa-
tive sample  is  proportionate  with respect to  all constituents  in the  bulk
matrix.   The probability  of  obtaining a  representative sample  is enhanced
by compositing multiple samples.   These composites can  be homogenized prior
to subsampling for  subsequent analysis.  Table  5.5 may  be used  to  determine
the  number of samples to be  taken when  a waste is  sampled from multiple
containers.   These  numbers should  be considered a minimum requirement.   If
large variability is  encountered in the sample  analysis, additional  samples
may  be  required.   Similar  precautions must  be  taken  to ensure  that  the

                                     109

-------
 total waste  substrate has  been sampled.   Table  5.6 suggests  appropriate
 sampling points  to be  selected for  sampling  various  waste  containments.
 Descriptions of  detailed statistical  analyses for use  in sampling  can  be
 found in EPA (1982a).


 TABLE 5.5  HINIMIM NUMBER OF SAMPLES TO BE  SELECTED FROM MULTIPLE
            CONTAINERS*t
Number of
Containers
1 to 3
4 to 64
65 to 125
126 to 216
217 to 343
344 to 512
513 to 729
730 to 1000
1001 to 1331
Number of Samples
to be Composited
all
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Number of
Containers
1332 to 1728
1729 to 2197
2198 to 2744
2745 to 3375
3376 to 4096
4097 to 4913
4914 to 5832
5833 to 6859
6860 or over
Number of Samples
to be Composited
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
 *  ASTM D-270

 *  Numbering the  containers and using a table of random numbers  would give
   an unbiased  method for determining which should be  sampled.


      Following sampling operations,  all  samples  should  be  tightly  sealed
 and  stored  at  4°C (except, in some cases, soils).  Freezing  may be  required
 when organic constituents  are  expected to be  lost  through  volatilization.
 This may  be  easily  accomplished by  packaging  all  samples  in  dry  ice
 immediately   after   collection   if   other   refrigeration   methods   are
 unavailable.     Prior  arrangements  should  be  made  with   the  receiving
 laboratory  to  ensure sample integrity until the time  of analysis.


 5.3.2.2 Physical Analysis


      The physical characteristic  of  hazardous waste  that  is most  relevant
 to  land treatment  is  density.    Density determinations  are  required  to
 convert the volumes  of waste which will be treated into their  corresponding
 masses.  The mass measurements will then be used to determine  loading rates
 and  other application requirements (Section 7.5).

      The density of  a  liquid  waste may  be  determined by  weighing  a known
 volume  of the  waste.  A water  insoluble  viscous waste may be weighed  in a
 calibrated  flask containing a  known  volume and mass  of water.   The  water
 displaced Is equivalent to the volume  of waste material  added.  A  similar
 technique may  be  used for  the  analysis  of water soluble wastes  by replacing
water  with  a  nonsolubilizing  liquid  for  the  volumetric   displacement
measurement.   In this  case,  a correction must  be  made for  the density  of
 the  solvent used.

                                     110

-------
      TABLE 5.6  SAMPLING POINTS RECOMMENDED FOR MOST WASTE CONTAINMENTS
           Containment type
                            Sampling point
      Drum, bung on one end

      Drum, bung on side
      Barrel, fiberdrum, buckets,
       sacks, bags
      Vacuum truck and similar
       containers

K-     Pond, pit, lagoons
      Waste pile


      Storage tank
Withdraw  sample  from all depths through bung opening.

Lay drum  on  side with bung up.   Withdraw sample from all depths
through bung opening.

Withdraw  samples through the top of barrels, fiberdrums, buckets,
and similar  containers.   Withdraw samples through fill openings of
bags and  sacks.   Withdraw samples through the center of the contain-
ers and different points diagonally opposite the point of entry.

Withdraw  sample  through  open hatch.  Sample all other hatches.
Visually  inspect  the  area.   If there is evidence of differential
settling  of material  as  it  enter the pond, this area needs to be
estimated as a  percentage of the pond and sampled separately.
If the remaining  area is free of differential settling, divide sur-
face araa into  an imaginary surface, one sample at mid-depth or at
center, and one sample at the bottom should be taken per grid.
Repeat the sampling at each grid over the entire pond or site.  A
minimum of 5 grids should be sampled.

Withdraw  samples  through at least three different points near the
top of pile and points diagonally opposite the point of entry.

Sample all depths from the  top through the sampling hole.

-------
 5.3.2.3  Chemical  Analysis
      The  chemical characterization  of complex  mixtures  such  as hazardous
waste  consists  of chemically  specific analytical procedures  which  need to
be performed under a  strict  quality  control program by well-trained person-
nel.   Procedural  blanks defining background  contamination should be deter-
mined  for  all  analytical  techniques.   Maximum background  contamination
should not  exceed 5%  of the detector  response for any  compound or element
being  analyzed.   (For  instance,  if   the  concentration  of  a   constituent
results  in  95% full-scale  deflection  on  a recorder, the background  level
found  in the analytical blank  should not  exceed 4.5%  full-scale  deflec-
tion.)   The  procedural  blank should be taken  through the complete analyti-
cal  characterization,  including  all  steps  in  collection  and  storage,
extraction,  evaporative concentration, fractionation, and other procedures
that  are applied to  the sample.   A general  reference  for the  control of
blanks in trace organic analysis is  Giam and Wong (1972).

     The accuracy and precision  of  all detailed analytical methodology need
to be evaluated  by  no less than three  reproducible,  full procedural analy-
ses  of  reference  standards.     All  data   on procedural recovery  levels
(accuracy)  and  reproducibility  (precision) need  to  be  reported  as  a mean
plus  or  minus  the standard deviation.   Analytical data  should  be reliable
to at least  two  significant  figures or as  defined by the measuring devices
used.  Other quality  control and assurance guidelines may  be  found in EPA
(1982a).

     If  a  waste  contains  other  hazardous  constituents,  not   covered  in
either  the   following  general  chemical  characterization  protocol   or EPA
(1982a), it  is  the  responsibility of  the  permit  applicant  to determine an
appropriate  and  reliable  analytical   technique   for  their  determination.
This  may  be accomplished through  a  literature search or consultation with
regulatory officials  or an analytical  service.  All techniques need to meet
the quality control requirements of  EPA (1982a).

     The  following sections   are  designed  primarily to  provide  relevant
information  and  explanations  of  chemical   analytical  techniques applicable
to hazardous  waste and  land  treatment.   For  the permit  applicant,  it is
intended to provide some guidance  and  understanding of analytical chemistry
and  the  role it  plays  in  HWLT.   For  the permit  writer,  these sections
should provide aid in understanding  and evaluating the analytical data sub-
mitted by the permit  applicant.

     In  providing a  general  overview  of  the  analytical  chemistry, refer-
ences are provided  which describe  specific methods  which may  be  used for
analyzing waste  and  other  media relevant  to  HWLT.   The U.S.  EPA  in Test^
Methods  for Evaluating Solid Waste  (EPA,  1982a)  has   developed  detailed
methodologies which may be acceptable  by  the EPA as  methods  for analyzing
hazardous waste   and  used  by  the  EPA  in  conducting  regulatory investiga-
tions.  However,  many of the analytical methods described have not yet been
tested on actual  waste  samples.   Therefore, it is the. responsibility of the
individual laboratories  to test  all  specific analytical methodologies  under

                                     112

-------
strict quality  control and assurance  programs  to ensure that  the  analysis
is  providing  an  acceptable   chacterization   of  the  specific  waste  in
question.


5.3.2.3.1   Inorganic  Analysis.  The inorganic  chemical  characterization of
hazardous waste  and  other  samples  will cover  a diverse range  of  elements
and other inorganic  parameters.  Standard  techniques that may  be  used for
inorganic analyses are  presented in  the  following  sections  and  are  dis-
cussed in more detail  by  the EPA (1982a).


5.3.2.3.1.1  Elements.  present in the  waste, may include a large variety of
heavy metals  and nutrients.   Elemental analysis is  necessary  to determine
the numerical  values  needed  to  calculate  the  constituents that  limit the
land  treatment  process (Section  7.5).   The general  method  for determining
metals,  nutrients  and salts consists  of appropriate  sample digestion fol-
lowed  by atomic absorption (AA) spectrophotometry  or  inductively coupled
plasma  are  spectrometry  (ICP).  Specific  techniques may  be  found  in EPA
(1982a), EPA (1979c)  and  Black (1965).  Halides  may  be  determined by  vari-
ous  techniques  (EPA,  1979c  and 1982a;  Stout  and Johnson,  1965;  Brewer,
1965).   Boron  may be  determined by  colorimetric  techniques  (EPA,  1979c;
Wear, 1965).   Total  nitrogen may be analyzed  by a  Kjeldahl technique  (EPA,
1979a; Bremner,  1965).


5.3.2.3.1.2    Electrical  conductivity  (EC)  determination  is  necessary
because  it  provides  a numerical estimation of  soluble salts which may  limit
the treatment  process.  EC may be  directly determined  on a highly  aqueous
waste.   For organic  wastes an aqueous extract  may  be  analyzed,  and  with
highly viscous  or  solid wastes, a water-saturated  paste  may be  prepared and
the aqueous filtrate  analyzed for EC.   Specific  methods  applicable  to  waste
and other samples  may be found in EPA  (1979a)  and  Bower  and Wllcox  (1965).


5.3.2.3.1.3 .pH and  titratable acids and bases may be determined by various
methods. The  determination of hydrogen ion activity and  the  concentration
of  inorganic acids  and bases  is important  to  the  treatment   processes  of
HWLT  due to possible  adverse  effects  on soil  structure, soil microbes,  and
constituent mobility.  The measurements of  pH may  be made on  aqueous  waste
suspensions and  other  samples  according  to   procedures  outlined  in  EPA
(1979a)  and Peech  (1965).  Titratable  acids and bases may be  determined  on
aqueous  waste  suspensions according to EPA (1979c).   The use  of  indicators
to  determine  equivalence  points  may  result   in  erroneous  values  unless
caution  is  taken  to  ensure  that the titration is  performed  in  a  way  which
would be sensitive to  all  acid and base  strengths (Skoog and  West,  1979).
This  measurement  may also  determine   titratable strong  organic acids  and
bases.


5.3.2.3.1.4  Water may be  a limiting  constituent  in the land  treatment  of
certain wastes  and  so it is  necessary to estimate  the percent  water (wet

                                     113

-------
weight)  of  highly  aqueous  wastes.   Determinations  by such  techniques as
Karl  Fischer titrations  (Bassett  et  al.,  1978)  are unnecessary  because
water  content is  important  only when  it  is present  as an appreciable  com-
ponent of the waste.   In an organic waste,  water may be  present  as a  dis-
creet  layer and thus may  be  easily quantitated.   If  water is present in an
emulsion, salts may be added to  disrupt  the emulsion to determine the quan-
tity of  water.   If  water is the  carrier  solvent  for  a dissolved inorganic
waste, water concentration may  be  estimated as 100%.  For viscous inorganic
wastes,  in which water is present at a level  comparable  to the other inor-
ganic  constituents,  heavy metals  or  sludge-like materials  may  be  filtered
from the aqueous phase following precipitation with a known amount  of KOH.


5.3.2.3.2   Organic Analysis.    The determination of  organic constituents
present  in waste and other samples may be reported with respect to  the  fol-
lowing sample classes and constituents:

     (1)  Total organic matter  (TOM);

          (a)  Volatile organic  compounds;
          (b)  Extractable  organic  compounds  (acids,  bases, neutrals
               and water  solubles); and

     (2)  Residual  solids (RS).

The numerical concentrations  should be  reported on  a  wet weight basis  for
both gravimetric determination  of  each individual class and  specific  deter-
mination of each compound contained in each class.


5.3.2.3.2.1   Total  organic matter derived  from  this  determination  will
indicate  the  amount of organic  matter available  for microbial degradation
in HWLT.  The  percent  TOM (wet  weight)  may be  used  for  estimating  organic
carbon necessary to  calculate  the C:N  ratio.   The  percent TOM  will  be
numerically  equal  to  the sum  of the gravimetric  determinations  of  percen-
tage  of  volatiles  and  extractables  (acids,  bases,  neutrals,   and water
solubles).


5.3.2.3.2.1.1  Volatile  organic compounds  are  sample constituents  that are
amenable  to  either  purge and  trap or head  space  determinations  and  gener-
ally have boiling  points ranging  from less than 0°C  to  about 200°C.   This
upper  limit  is  not an  exact  cut-off  point,  but  techniques that  rely  on
evaporative-concentration steps may result  in appreciable  losses.   Example8
of typical organic  compounds which may be found as volatile  constituents in
hazardous wastes are given  in  Table 5.7.

     A gravimetric  estimation  of  the   concentration of  these  compounds
should be reported  as  percent wet  weight  for  calculating  total   organic
matter (TOM).  This may  be  accomplished by bubbling  air through a vigorous-
ly  stirred  aqueous sample.   The  percentage loss  in sample  weight may  be
used to  estimate percent  volatiles.  A highly viscous or  solid waste  may be
                                     114

-------
TABLE 5.7  PURGABLE ORGANIC COMPOUNDS.
  I.  Hydrocarbons

      A.  Alkanes (Bn)*~Ci-Cio

      B.  Alkenes (R-Rf)—Cj-

      C.  Alkynes (R-R")—

      D.  Aromatics (Ar)*—benzene, ethylbenzene, toluene, styrene

 II.  Compounds containing simple functional groups

      A.  Organic halides (R-X, Ar-X)*—chloroform, 2-dichlorobenzene,
          trichlorofluoromethane, tetrachloroethylene, trichloroethylene,
          vinyl chloride, vinylindene chloride

      B.  Alcohols (R-OH; OH-R-R-OH)—methanol, benzyl alcohol, ethylene
          glycol, dichloropropanol

      C.  Phenols (Ar-OH)—phenol, cresols, o-chlorophenol

      D.  Ethers (R-O-R', Ar-O-R1, C4H80)~ethyl ether, anisole,
          ethylene oxide, dioxan, tetrahydrofuran, vinyl  ether, allyl
          ether, bis(2-chloroethyl)ether

      E.  Sulfur-containing compounds

          1.  Mercaptans (R-SH)—methylmercaptan

          2.  Sulfides  (R-S-R', C^S)—thiophene, dimethyl  sulfide

          3.  Disulfides (R-SS-R')--diethyldisulfide, dipentyldash
                disulfide

          4.  Sulfoxides (R-SO-R1)--Dimethyl sulfoxide

          5. Alkyl hydrogen sulfates (R-0-S03H)—methyl sulfate

      F.  Amines

          1.  Alkyl  (R-NH2, RR'-NH, RR'R"-N)~methylamine,  triethylamine,
              benzylamine, ethylenediamine, N-nitrosoamine

          2.  Aromatic  (Ar-NH2, etc.)—aniline,  acetanilide,  benzidine

          3.  Heterocyclic (C5H5N)—pyridine,  picolines


                                —continued—


                                    115

-------
TABLE 5.7  (Continued)
III.  Compounds containing unsaturated  functional  groups

      A.  Aldehydes  (R-CHO, AR-CHO) — formaldehyde,  phenylacetaldehyde ,
          benzaldehyde , acrolein,  furfural,  chloroacetaldehyde ,
          paraldehyde

      B.  Ketones (R-CO-R') — acetone, methyl ethyl  ketone,  2-hexanone

      C.  Carboxylic acids (R-COOH) — C^-C^ carboxylic  acids

      D.  Esters (R-COO-R1 , AR-COO-R) — methylacetate,  ethyl formate,
          phenylacetate

      E.  Amides (R-CO-NHR1 )— acrylamide

      F.  Mtriles (R-CN, Ar-CN) — acetonitrile,  acrylonitrile , benzonitrile

* Hendrickson et al. (1970); Morrison and Boyd  (1975).

'  The following compound classes are not expected  due  to  their
   instabilities either in air and/or water:
       acid halides and anhydrides
       imines
       oximes
   R- alkyl groups, eg., 013, Cl^C^-, etc.
  Ar~ aromatic groups, eg., CgHtj-
   X- halogen, eg., Cl, Br, etc.
                                    116

-------
suspended  in a known weight  of previously boiled  water and similarly  ana-
lyzed.   If a 10 g sample is used (and suspended in perhaps  100 g  of  water),
an  accuracy to the nearest 0.1 g may be acceptable.

      The two  methods  recommended for  the  specific  determination of  indi-
vidual  volatile sample constituents  are  head  space analysis and  purge-and-
trap  techniques  (EPA,   1982a).   In  head  space  analysis,  the  sample  is
allowed  to equilibrate  at 90°C, and a sample of the head space gas is  with-
drawn with a  gas-tight  syringe (EPA, 1982a).   The  gaseous sample  is  then
analyzed by  gas-chromatography (GC)  and/or  GC-mass  spectrometry (GC-MS).
The major  limitations to  the  method appear to  be  variability in  detection
limits,  accuracy,  and precision caused by the equilibrium requirement.   For
instance,  detection  limits may  be  reduced  with  both  increasing  boiling
point  and  affinity of the compound for the sample matrix (EPA, 1982a).

      The alternate technique  using purge-and-trap methods appears  to be the
most  reliable  of  the two.    It  requires more  sophistication,  but  can  be
applied  to a greater number of sample  types  and a larger range of compound
volatility (EPA, 1982a).   The major  limitation is  that  only one analysis
may be  performed per sample  preparation.   Thus, if  analysis by several  GC
detectors  is required,  several samples may need to be prepared.

     A  simplified  example of  the  purge-and-trap  technique follows.    An
aliquot  of a liquid waste may  be  placed into an airtight  chamber which  is
connected  to a supply of inert gas and  an  adsorbent  trap.    The carrier gas
is  bubbled  through  the  waste  of room  temperature  and passes  out  of  the
chamber  through  an  adsorbent  specific  for  volatile organics.    Following
this  purge step, the adsorbent trap  may be flushed  for a few minutes  with
clean  carrier gas  to remove any residual water  and oxygen,  attached to the
injection  port of a GC or a GC-MS,  and heated to  desorb  the organics.   As
the carrier gas passes  through the  heated  trap,   the  volatiles  are trans-
ferred  onto the cooled  head  of the  analytical  GC column.   Following  heat
desorption,  the GC  is  temperature-programmed  to  facilitate resolution  of
all volatile compounds  collected  from the sample.

     A  variety  of  adsorbents  may  be  used  in  this  analysis  (EPA,  1982a;
Namiesnik  et al.,  1981;  Russell,  1975), but Tenax-GC (registered  trademark,
Enka N.V.,  the Netherlands) appears  to  be  the most widely used (Bellar and
Lichtenberg,  1979;  Dowty et al.,  1979).  It is a hydrophobic porous  polymer
which has  a high affinity for organic compounds.  Because of its  high  ther-
mal stability  (maximum  375°C), it  can  be  easily  cleaned   before   use  and
regenerated  after  use by heating and flushing with an inert gas.  However,
there are  some problems  with Tenax-GC due  to  its  instability under  certain
conditions  (Vick  et al.,  1977).    Other  general  information   concerning
Tenax-GC may be found In "Applied Science Laboratories Technical Bulletin
No. 24."

     Tenax-GC has been  shown  to  be  an effective  adsorbent for collection
and analysis of volatile hazardous hydrocarbons,  halogenated hydrocarbons,
aldehydes, ketones,  sulfur compounds, ethers,  esters  and nitrogen compounds
(Pellizzari  et  al.,  1976).  Technical descriptions  of usable techniques may
                                     117

-------
 be  found in Pellizzari (1982),  Reunanen  and  Kroneld (1982), Pellizarri  and
 Little  (1980),  EPA (1982a and  1979b),  Pellizzari  et al. (1978), Bellar  and
 Lichtenberg (1979),  and Dowty et al.  (1979).

      These  methods may be  used for a  variety  of  hazardous  wastes.   Soils
 may  be  analyzed by the procedure  for  solid wastes.  Air  samples for moni-
 toring  activities may  be  taken directly by  pulling a  known  volume  of  air
 through a similar adsorbent trap and  analyzing it following heat desorption
 (Brown  and  Purnell,  1979;  Pellizzari  et al.,  1976).

      To accurately analyze the  different classes  of volatile organics pre-
 sent  in samples,  different GC  detectors  may  be required.   A flame ioniza-
 tion  detector  (FID)   may  be  used for hydrocarbons,  a  flame   photometric
 detector (FPD)  for sulfur and/or  phosphorus-containing compounds,  an elec-
 tron  capture detector  (BCD)  for  halogenated hydrocarbons  and   phthalates,
 and  a nitrogen-phosphorus  detector (NPD)  for  nitrogen and/or   phosphorus-
 containing  compounds.   There are  several other GC  detectors  on the market
 available for analyzing different  classes of  organics.   The final confirma-
 tion, or even the complete analysis,  of volatiles  present in samples may  be
 determined  by  GC-MS computer techniques.   Some general references dealing
 with  organic mass spectrometry are Safe and Hutzinger (1973),   Middleditch
 et al.  (1981) and McLafferty  (1973).
5.3.2.3.2.1.2   Extractable organic compounds  are  organic constituents  that
are amenable to  evaporative-concentration techniques and may be analyzed  by
methods  based  on the classical method  of  isolation according to functional
group  acid-base  reactions.   Other  methods  have been  developed  for the
chromatographic  fractionation of  complex organic  mixtures  into individual
compound  classes (Miller,  1982;  Boduszynski et al.  1982a and  b;  Later  et
al. 1981; Crowley  et  al.,  1980;  Brocco et al., 1973), but the liquid-liquid
acid/base  extraction method  appears  to  be the  easiest and  least  instru-
mentally  intensive.   This technique  has been  used in  the  analysis  of   a
variety  of  complex organic mixtures  (Colgrove  and Svec,  1981),   including
fossil  fuels  (Buchanan,  1982;  Matsushita,  1979;  Novotny et  al.,  1981 and
1982) and environmental  samples  (Adams et al., 1982; Stuermer et al.,  1982;
Hoffman  and Wynder, 1977; Grabow et al.,  1981;  Lundi et  al.,  1977).   This
method is also  the  basic  technique  recommended by  the U.S. EPA  (EPA, 1982a;
Lin et  al.,  1979).   Fractions  derived from  this  analysis may be used  in
biological assays  and  other pilot studies (Grabow et al., 1981).

     The  liquid-liquid  acid/base extraction method is  based  on the  acidity
constants  (pl^s)  of  organic  compounds.    Compounds  characterized  by low
pKgS are acidic;  compounds with high  pKas  are basic.   If  a  complex  mix-
ture is  equilibrated with an aqueous  inorganic acid at  low pH  (<2), the
organic  bases  should protonate  to  become water  soluble positively-charged
cations, while  the  organic acids  remain unaffected and water insoluble  (and
thus extractable by an organic  solvent).   The  neutral  organics,  which are
not affected by either aqueous acids  or  bases,  will remain  in the  organic
solvent  phase  at  all  times.   Similarly,  if  an  aqueous inorganic base  at
high pH  (>12)  is  added  to a complex organic  mixture,  the  organic  acids
should deprotonate  to become  water  soluble negatively-charged anions,  while

                                     118

-------
the organic  bases  remain unaffected  and  water insoluble.   Thus by  selec-
tively  adjusting  the pH of the  aqueous  phase,  a. complex  mixture  may  be
separated Into  Its  acidic,  basic and  neutral  organic constituents.   Table
5.8 lists some common organic chemicals and  their  pKas.
TABLE 5.8  SCALE OF ACIDITIES*
Conjugate Acid                          pKg               Conjugate Base
R-NH3+
RR'-NH2+
RR'R"-NH+
Ar-OH
HCN
C5H5N-H+
Ar-NH3+
RCOOH
HCOOH +
2 , 4, 6-Trinltrophenol
10
10
9.1
5.2
4.6
4.5
3.7
1.0
0.4
R-NH2
RR'-NH
RR'R"-N
Ar-0~
CN~
C5H5N
Ar-NH2
RCOQ-
HCOO-
Ar2-NH
(N02)3-Ar-0~
* Hendrickson et al.  (1970).   Note:   the  most acidic compound is the con-
  jugate acid with the lowest  pKa  (i.e.,  2,4,6-trinitro-phenol).  Con-
  versely, the most basic  compound is the conjugate base with the highest
  pKa (i.e., alkyl amines).  Thus,  at  neutral pH, compounds with pKas J> 9
  9 should predominantly exist as  their conjugate acids, and compounds with
       j< 5 should predominantly exist as  their conjugate bases.
     Figure 5.3 outlines  the  steps  which may be taken in this initial class
separation scheme.   Table 5.9 lists  typical organic  compounds  that may  be
present  in  hazardous waste  and  other  samples which  are amenable  to  this
type of  separation.  Air  samples  collected on Florisil  (registered  trade-
mark, Floridin'Co. ), glass fiber filters, or polyur ethane foam may  be first
extracted with appropriate solvents  and then the  extract  nay be similarly
analyzed by the above procedures (EPA,  1980b; Adams et al., 1982; Cautreels
and van  Cauwenbergh,  1976).   Either  dlethylether  or dichloromethane may  be
used as  the  organic solvent in  the extraction procedures.   Dichloromethane
has been recommended  (EPA, 1982a) and  has the advantage that it is  denser
than water.    Thus,  it  can  be  removed  from  the  separatory  funnel in  the
extraction procedure  without having  to  remove  the aqueous  phase.   However,
it may be  prone to bumping in evaporative concentration procedures (Adams,
1982).   Ether, however, is more water  soluble, and extra  time is  required
in  the  extraction  procedure  to allow  the  phases  to  completely separate.
Either  solvent must  be  dried  with  an  hydrous   Na2SO^  prior  to  evapora-
tive  concentration.  For either  solvent,  a  few  grains  of  Na2SO^ in  the
evaporation-concentration flask should  facilitate boiling  and reduce bump-
ing  (Adams  et  al., 1982).   The  EPA  (1982a)  has  recommended the use  of
Kuderna -Danish evaporative  concentrators  equipped with  three-ball  Snyder
columns  for  concentrating  solvents.    For  the   higher molecular  weight

                                     119

-------
to
O
                                                                SAMPLE
                                                                   I
                                                         organic solvent plus
                                                             aqueous  acid
                                                                (pH<2)*
                                            aq.  phase
                                            (plus  sample  residue)   |	
                                           I
                                    organic  solvent
                                         (pH>12)
                                                org. phase
                             aq. phase
                          n-butanol
             org. phase
                      1
                 aq.  phase
               'ORGANIC BASES
org. phase
            evaporation

         [RESIDUAL  SOLIDS
   |WATER SOLUBLES
                                                    aqueous base
                                                       (PH>12)
       aq. phase
org. phase
       I
organic solvent
    (pH<2)
    |NEUTRALS|
                                                                    aq.  phase
                                                 org. phase
                               discard
             [ORGANIC ACIDS|
            Initial  acidic extraction may  lessen severity of  emulsions  (Mousa  and Whitlock,  1979).
          Figure  5.3.   Typical  acid-base  extraction  scheme  for  isolating  organic  chemical  classes.

-------
 TABLE  5.9   TYPICAL HAZARDOUS ORGANIC CONSTITUENTS AMENABLE  TO ACID-BASE
            EXTRACTION  TECHNIQUES
                    Extractable Neutral Organic Compounds
 1,2-Dichlorobenzene
 1,3-Dichlorobenzene
 1,4-Dichlorobenzene
 Hexachloroethane
 Hexachloropentadiene
 Hexachlorobenzene
 1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene
 bi s(2-Chloroethoxy)me thane
 Naphthalene
 2-Chloronaphthalene
 Isophorone
 Nitrobenzene
 2,4-Dinltrotoluene
 2,6-Dinitrotoluene
 4-BromophenyI phenyl  ether
 bis (2-Ethylhexyl)phthalate
 Di-n-octyl  phthalate
 Dimethyl phthalate
 Diethyl phthalate
 Di-n-butyl  phthalate
 Acenaphthylene
 Acenaphthene
 Butyl benzyl  phthalate
 Fluorene
 Fluoranthene
 Chrysene
 Pyrene
 Phenanthrene
 Anthracene
 Benzo(a)anthracene
 Benzo(b)fluoranthene
 Benzo(k)fluoranthene
 Benzo(a)pyrene
 lndeno(l,2,3-c,d)pyrene
 t)ibenzo(a ,h)anthracene
Benzo(g,h,i)perylene
4-Chlorophenyl phenyl ether
bis(2-Chloroethyl)ether
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
bis(2-Chloroi sopropyl)ether

Pesticides/PCB's

a-Endosulfan
g-Endodsulfan
Endosulfan sulfate
a-BHC
B-BHC
6-BHC
Y-BHC
Aldrin
Dieldrin
4,4'-DDE
4,4'ODD
4,4'DDT
Endrin
Endrin aldehyde
Heptachlor
Heptachlor epoxide
Chlordane
Toxaphene
Aroclor  1016
Aroclor  1221
Aroclor  1232
Aroclor  1242
Aroclor  1248
Aroclor  1254
Aroclor  1260
2,3,7,8-Tetrachlorodibenzo-p-
    dioxin  (TCDD)
                     Extractable Basic Organic Compounds
3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine
iienzidine
1,2-Diphenylhydrazine
^-Nitrosodiphenylamine
^-Nitrosodimethylamine
•^-Nitrosodi-n-propylamine
 Quinoline
 Isoquinoline
 Acridine
 Phenanthridine
 Benz[c]acridine
                                —continued—
                                      121

-------
TABLE 5.9  (continued)
                   Extractable Acidic Organic Compounds

Phenol                                   Abletic acid
2-Nltrophenol                            Dehydroabietlc acid
4-Nitrophenol                            Isopimaric add
2,4-Dinitrophenol                        Plmaric acid
4,6-Dinitro-o-cresol                     Oleic acid
Pentachlorophenol                        Linoleic acid
p-Chloro-m-cresol                        9,10-Epoxystearic acid
2-Chlorophenol                           9,10-M.chlorostearic  acid
2,4-Dichlorophenol                       Monochlorodehydroabietic acid
2,4,6-Trichlorophenol                    3,4,5-Trichloroguaiacol
2,4-Dimethylphenol                       Tetrachloroguaiacol
                                    122

-------
compounds,  this method should  provide  an easy,  efficient  and reproducible
method  for concentrating  solvents.   However,  some  researchers  (Adams  et
al.,  1982) have found  that for microgram quantities of some lower molecular
weight  extractables  (i.e., 2- and 3-ringed aza-aromatics), optimum recover-
ies in  the  concentration  step were achieved by using a vacuum rotary  evapo-
rator at  300C;  the  solvent receiving flask was immersed in an ice bath, and
the  condenser  was  insulated with glass wool  and aluminum  foil.    In any
case, samples for specific compound  determination should not  be evaporated
to  dryness as  this may  cause significant  losses  of  even high molecular
weight  compounds  such  as  benzo(a)pyrene (Bowers et al., 1981).

     For  each of  the following classes  isolated  by this  method, a separate
aliquot  of  the sample  extract  may  be  analyzed gravimetrically  for  use  in
determining total organic  matter.  In this  case,  the  solvent  may be  evapo-
rated to  dryness  at room  temperature.   To  minimize  losses,  the vaporation
should  be allowed to occur naturally without  externally  applied methods  to
increase  solvent  vaporization  (e.g.,   N£  blow-down,  heat,   etc.)   as  in
Bowers  et al.  (1981).

     The  following  sections describe specific  methods  which may be used  in
the analyses  of the various classes  obtained  from the acid-base fractiona-
tion.   Some  general references which may be useful are  McNair and Bonelli
(1968), Johnson and Stevenson  (1978),  Packer  (1975),  Holstein  and Severin
(1981), Hertz et  al.  (1980),  and  Bartle et al. (1979).

     Organic  Acids.   This  class of compounds  may  include  a variety of  car-
boxylic acids,  guaiacols,  and phenols (Claeys,  1979).   They frequently are
determined  following derivitization  (Francis  et  al.,  1978;  Shackelford and
Webb, 1979;  EPA,  1982a; Cautreels et al.,  1977).  With  diazomethane, the
relatively  non-volatile carboxylic  acids are  converted  into  esters  which
may be  determined by gas  chromatography.   Diazomethane  similarly converts
phenols into  their  corresponding  anisoles  (ethers).   Pentaflourobenzylbro-
mide converts phenols  into their  pentafluorobenzyl (PFB) derivatives.

     Whereas  carboxylic acids require derivitization  prior  to GC analysis,
phenols may be  determined  directly by GC (EPA, 1982a; Shackelford and  Webb,
1979; Mousa  and  Whitlock,  1979).   The  direct  determination  of  phenols
appears to  be preferable  because  of problems  encountered  with both  diazo-
methane and pentafluorobenzylbromide derivitization techniques (Shackelford
and Webb, 1979).  Guaiacols may be determined as in Knuutinen (1982).

     These  compounds may  be  characterized  by GC with either capillary  or
packed  columns.   For  packed-column GC,  the  polarity  of  these compounds
requires  the   use of  specially  deactivated  supports and  liquid  phases.
SP-12AOA  (manufactured  by  Supelco, Inc.,   Supelco  Park,  Bellefonte,  PA
16823)  has been  recommended  for use  (EPA,  1982a;  Shackelford  and   Webb,
1979).  Detection may be  accomplished  by either  flame ionization or  elec-
tron  capture, depending on  the  compounds being  determined.    GC-MS  may  be
used for  further  identification and/or  confirmation.

     Organic  Bases.   This  fraction  may  contain a  variety  of  nitrogen  con-
taining compounds including alkyl,  aromatic,  and  aza-heterocyclic amines.

                                     123

-------
These  compounds  may  be  directly  characterized by  GC with  either  FID or
nitrogen-specific  detection.   As  with  the organic acids,  either capillary
or  packed-column  gas chromatography  with  specially  deactivated  packing
materials may  be used.   For organic bases,  Supelco,  Inc.  also manufactures
a packing  material,  SP-2250 DB,  which  provides good  packed-column  resolu-
tion with  a minimum of  peak  tailing.  The  analysis  of this  class  of   com-
pounds should  be performed  soon  after isolation because they tend to decom-
pose and polymerize  with time (Tomkins and  Ho, 1982;  Worstell  and  Daniel,
1981; Worstell et  al.  1981).   Additional  GC-MS confirmation and identifica-
tion may be performed.

     Neutrals.  This  fraction  may be composed  of  a variety of organic  com-
pounds including aliphatic  and aromatic hydrocarbons, oxygenated and chlor-
inated hydrocarbons.   This  class may require  further fractionation depend-
ing  on  whether the  sample  is to  be analyzed  for either  hydrocarbons  and
more polar  compounds by flame ionization, flame  photometric,  or nitrogen-
phosphorus  detection GC,  or for  chlorinated hydrocarbons  and  phthalic  acid
esters by electron-capture  detection GC.

     For FID,  FPD  or NPD-GC  analysis,  an aliquot of  the  neutral  fraction
may be separated into aliphatics,  aromatics, and other semi-polar compounds
and  polar  compounds  by column chromatography.  Lin  et al. (1979)  used 5%
deactivated silica gel to separate neutral compounds  isolated from drinking
and waste treatment  water:  hexane eluted aliphatics; hexane/benzene eluted
aromatics;  dichloromethane  eluted phthalic and  fatty  acid  esters;  methanol
eluted  aldehydes,  alcohols,   and  hetones.    Anders  et  al.   (1975),  using
washed  alumina,  eluted  hydrocarbons with  pentane,  moderately  polar   com-
pounds with benzene, and more polar  compounds with  nethanol.   The polar
fraction was  then further  characterized  by  chromatography  on  silica  gel
using increasing ratios  of  ethyl ether in pentane.   Other researchers  have
used similar chromatographic methods for  separating this class of compounds
into its constituents (Giam et  al.,  1976;  Gritz  and  Shaw, 1977).   A  good
general  review  of  methods  applicable  for  this type  of   separation is
(Altgelt and Gouw, 1979).

     Since  esters  and other  hydrolyzable compounds  may be  present in the
aromatic and later fractions,  the sample  fractions may be  analyzed  prior to
and  following  alkaline hydrolysis.   (Hydrolyzable compounds  may not with-
stand the  original  acid-base  extraction  and  perhaps may  be  determined by
other procedures).   Alkaline  hydrolysis may  easily be accomplished  by plac-
ing a small sample aliquot  into  a tightly capped  vial containing 27, metha-
nolic KOH  and  heating on a steam bath.   After cooling, water  is  added to
solubilize  the resulting  carboxylic acids  and alcohols,  and  the   organic
phase is  brought  to  original  volume with solvent.   The  organic  phase is
then  reanalyzed.   The  hydrolyzable  compounds  are  thus  confirmed   through
their disappearance, and interference  in the  analysis  of  the aromatics is
removed.

     For BCD-sensitive  compounds, it may be  possible  to  reduce analytical
requirements  if  the previously   described  alumina/silica chromatographic
separations  can  be  co-adapted for  use  with  halogenated  hydrocarbons  and
phthalates   (Holden   and   Marsden,   1969;   Snyder  and   Reinert,    1971).

                                     124

-------
Additionally,  with  appropriate  technology,  it may be possible to simultane-
ously  detect  both  FID-  and BCD-sensitive  compounds  in  the GC  analysis
(Sodergren,  1978).

     However,  a separate  aliquot  of the neutral fraction may be  analyzed
for  halogenated hydrocarbons and phthalates.  (Some  of  these compounds may
not  withstand the original  acid-base  extraction and perhaps  may be  deter-
mined  by other  methods.)   This procedure  typically requires  the use  of
Florisil to  separate different  polarities  of   halogenated  compounds  and
phthalates  (EPA,  1980b,  1979b and  1982a).   If needed,  clean mercury  metal
may  be  shaken with  the various  fractions  to eliminate sulfur  interference.

     For compound confirmation  these samples also may be analyzed by  ECD-GC
prior to and  following alkaline hydrolysis.  In  this case, alkaline hydrol-
ysis saponifies  the phthalic acid  esters  and dehydrochlorinates many  of the
chlorinated organics.  Table 5.10  lists  compounds which  can be confirmed by
alkaline hydrolysis.   The experimental  conditions  must be  carefully  con-
trolled for obtaining reproducible  results.  Additional  GC-MS confirmation,
using selective  ion monitoring  (SIM) if  necessary,  may be performed.

     Water  Solubles.   This  class  of compounds may  consist of constituents
which  were  not  solvent   extractable  in  any of  the  previously  isolated
organic fractions.  The use of  n-butanol  as extracting solvent may  serve to
isolate this   class of  compounds  (Stubley   et  al.,  1979).    Since  further
characterization  of this   class may  be  difficult, results  of pilot studies
may be  used to determine  further analytical requirements.


5.3.2.3.2.2    Residual  solids may  be determined  by evaporating the  water
(110°C)  from  "theoriginalaqueous fraction Isolated  in  the  acid-base
extraction procedure  (Fig. 5.3).  Residual  solids  (RS)  may consist of both
inorganics  and  relatively non-degradable  forms of  carbon  such  as  coke,
charcoal, and graphite.   This value may  be used In  waste loading  calcula-
tions and for determining the rate  of waste solids buildup.    A  buildup of
solids  may increase the depth of the treatment zone.


5.3.2.4  Biological Analysis


     A  primary concern when  disposing  any  waste material  is the potential
for  adverse  health effects.   Toxic  effects resulting  from  improper  waste
disposal either may  be acute,  becoming  evident within  a short period  of
time, or they may be  chronic, becoming  evident only after several months or
years.   Before a hazardous  waste  is disposed in an HWLT  unit,  biological
analyses should  be  performed to determine  the potential for  adverse  health
effects.  The complex interactions  of  the  components of  a hazardous  waste
make it  impossible  to predict the  acute  or  chronic toxicity of any  waste by
chemical analysis alone.   A solution to this problem is  to use  a series  of
biological test  systems  that can  efficiently predict the  reduction  of the
acute and chronic  toxic characteristics  of the  waste.   Biological systems
                                    125

-------
TABLE 5.10  REACTONS  OF VARIOUS  COMPOUNDS TO ALKALINE HYDROLYSIS*
            Compound
          Chromatographic Appearance
               After Hydrolysis
Esters (phthalic and fatty  acid)
PCBs
Heptachlor
Aldrin
Lindane, other BHC isomers
Heptachlor epoxide
Dieldrin
Endrin
DDE
DDT
ODD
Chlordane
HCB
Mirex
Endosulfan I and II
Dicofol
Toxaphene
Alkylhalides
Nitriles
Amides
      Disappear
      Unchanged
      Unchanged (under mild conditions)
      Unchanged
      Disappear
      Unchanged (under mild conditions)
      Unchanged
      Unchanged
      Unchanged
      Disappears as DDE appears
      Disappears as DDE appears
      Unchanged
      Unchanged
      Unchanged (under mild conditions)
      Disappear
      Disappears
      Changed (other peaks appear)
      Disappear1
      Disappear
      Disappear
T
* EPA (1980c).
t Predicted according to reactions
typical of these compound types.
                                     126

-------
can be used to determine  the  toxiclty and treatability of the waste and to
monitor the environmental impact of land  treating the waste.
5.3.2.4.1  Acute Toxicity.   The  acute toxicity of a hazardous waste should
be evaluated with respect to plants and microbes  endemic  to  the  land treat-
ment  site.    This  evaluation will  Indicate the' effects on the immediate
environment of the  land  treatment  unit.   Obviously,  a waste which is  toxic
to microbes will not  be  degraded unless it is applied  at a rate that will
diminish  these  acute toxic  effects.   The  acute  toxicity of  a  waste with
respect  to  soil  bacteria  and  plants  can be  evaluated  in treatability
studies as  described in Chapter  7.    Specific methods  for   measuring  acute
toxicity are presented in Section  7.2.4.1.
5.3.2.4.2   Genetic toxicity.   Hazardous  wastes should  be  managed so  that
the  public  is protected from the  effects  of genotoxic  agents  in a  waste.
Genotoxic  compounds  in a  hazardous  waste should  be  monitored to minimize
the  accidental exposure  of workers  or the  general  public  to  mutagenic,
carcinogenic, or teratogenic agents, and to prevent transmission  of  related
genetic  defects  to future  generations.  Genetic toxicity may be  determined
using a  series  of  biological systems  which  predict  the potential of  waste
constituents  to cause  gene mutations  and other types  of genetic  damage.   A
list of  some  of  the prospective test  systems  and the genetic  events  which
they can detect is given in  Table  5.11.  These  are test  systems for  which a
standardized  protocol  has  been developed, and  the genetic events  detected
are  clearly understood.

     The test systems  used  to  detect  gene mutations  should  be  capable  of
detecting  frameshift  mutations,   base-pair  substitutions,  and  deletions.
The  systems  that  are  used  to  detect  other types  of   genetic  damage  should
exhibit  a  response to  compounds that  inhibit  DNA repair and  to  those that
cause various types  of chromosome  damage.   A minimum  of  two  systems should
be  selected  that  will respond to the  types   of  genetic  damage described
above  and which   can  incorporate  metabolic  activation into  the  testing
protocol.   All systems  should include provisions for solvent  control and
positive  controls  to  demonstrate  the  sensitivity of  the  test  systems and
the  functioning of the metabolic activation  system,  and to  act as an inter-
nal  control for the  biological  system.  Samples should be tested at a mini-
mum  of four equally  spaced exposure  levels,  all of which will yield between
10 and 100% survival.  Cell  survival should  be estimated by plating exposed
cells  on a  supplemented  minimal  medium.   The   data  from waste  analysis
should be  in  the form of mutation induction per  survivor  or  per surviving
fraction if the waste  is overly toxic.

     Typical  results from  mutagenicity testing using  the Salmonella/micro-
tome  assay (Ames  et al.,  1975) on  the subtractions  of a wood-preserving
bottom sediment  and the  liquid stream from  the  acetonitrile  purification
column are  presented in Figs.  5.4 and  5.5  (Donnelly   et al.,  1982).   These
tesults  demonstrate that  constituents  of  these wastes have  the  ability to
induce  point  mutations  in  bacteria;  such constituents  may   be  mutagenic,
carcinogenic, or teratogenic (Kada et  al., 1974).

                                     127

-------
     TABLE  5.11.   BIOLOGICAL SYSTEMS WHICH MAY BE USED TO DETECT GENETIC TOXICITY  OF  A HAZARDOUS  WASTE
                                           Genetic Event Detected
     Organism
                                       Other  Types  of    Metabolic
                      Gene Mutation    Genetic Damage    Activation
                                                References
10
oo
     PROKARYOTES
        Bacillus  subtilis
        Escherichia coli
Salmonella
  typhimurium
         Streptomyces
           coelicolor
                      Forward,
                        reverse
                      Forward,
                        reverse
Forward,
  reverse
                      Forward
     EUKARYOTES
        Aspergillus nidulans  Forward,
                                 reverse
                DNA repair
                DNA repair
                                               DNA repair
                DNA repair
                                       DNA repair,
                                        chromosome
                                        aberrations
Mammalian
Mammalian
  plant
Mammalian
  plant
Not
  Developed
                                 Mammalian
                                    plant
         Neurospora crassa
                      Forward
                Not developed     Mammalian
Felkner et al., 1979; Kada
  et al., 1974; Tanooka,  1977;
  Tanooka et al., 1978.

Green et al., 1976; Mohn  et
  al., 1974; Slater et al.,
  1971; Speck et al., 1978;
  Scott et al., 1978.

Ames et al., 1975; Plewa  and
  Gentile, 1976; Skopek et
  al., 1978.

Carere et al.,  1975.
              Bignami  et  al.,  1974;  Roper,
                 1971;  Scott  et  al.,  1978;
                 Scott  et  al.,  1980.

              DeSerres  and Mailing,  1971;
                 Ong, 1978; Tomlinson,  1980.
                                                  — continued  —

-------
      TABLE 5.11  (continued)
ro
vO
Genetic Event Detected
Organism
Saccharomyces
cervisiae
Schizosaccharomyces
pombe
PLANTS
Tradescantia sp.
Arabidopsis
thaliana
Hordeum vulgare
Pisum sativua
Triticum sp.
Glycine max

Gene Mutation
Forward
Forward
Forward
Chlorophyll
mutation
Chlorophyll
mutation
Chlorophyll
mutation
Morphological
mutation
Chlorophyll
mutation
Other Types of
Genetic Damage
Mitotic gene
conversion
Mitotic gene
conversion
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Metabolic
Activation
Mammalian
Mammalian
Plant
Plant
Plant
Plant
Plant
Plant
References
Brusick, 1972; Loprieno et
al., 1974; Mortimer and
Manney, 1971; Parry, 1977.
Brusick, 1972; Loprieno et
al., 1974; Mortimer and
Manney, 1971; Parry, 1977.
Nauman et al . , 1976;
Underbrink et al., 1973.
Redei, 1975.
Kumar and Chauham, 1979;
Nicoloff et al., 1979.
Ehrenburg, 1971.
Ehrenberg, 1971.
Vig, 1975.
                                                 — continued —

-------
TABLE 5.11  (continued)
Genetic Event Detected
Organism
Vicia faba
Alii urn cepa

INSECTS
Drosophila
melanogaster
Habrobracon sp.

Gene Mutation
Morphological
mutation
Morphological
mutation
Recessive
lethels
None
developed
MAMMALIAN CELLS IN CULTURE
Chinese hamster Forward,
ovaries reverse
V79 Chinese hamster
cells
Chinese hamster
lung cells
Human fibroblasts
Human lymphoblasts

Forward ,
reverse
Forward
Forward
Forward

Other Types of
Genetic Damage
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Non-
disjunction,
deletions
Dominant
lethels
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
DNA repair
DMA repair
— continued
Metabolic
Activation
Plant
Plant
Insect
Insect
Mammalian
Mammalian
Mammalian
Mammalian
Mammalian
—
References
Kihlman, 1977.
Marimuthu, et al . , 1970.
Wurgler and Vogel, 1977.
Von Borstel and Smith, 1977.
Neill et al., 1977; Seek
et al., 1980.
Artlett, 1977; Soderberg et
al., 1979.
Dean and Senner, 1977.
Jacobs and DeMars, 1977.
Thilly et al., 1976.


-------
TABLE 5.11  (continued)
Genetic Event Detected
Organism
L5178Y mouse
lymphoma cells
P388 mouse lymphoma
cells
Human peripheral
blood lymphocytes
Various organisms
Gene Mutation
Forward
Forward
Forward
None
developed
Other Types of
Genetic Damage
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Chromosome
aberrations
Sister
chromatid
exchange
Metabolic
Activation
Mammalian
Mammalian
Mammalian
Mammalian
References

Clive and Spector, 1975; Clive
et al., 1972; Clive, 1973.
Anderson, 1975.
Evans and O'Riordan,
Perry and Evans, 1975
and Wolff, 1976.

1975.
; Stretka

-------
co
h-
Dd
UJ
>
£100
CO

X
CD
0)
   50
    PENT  S


A-ACID

X - BASE

D- NEUTRAL
                        0.3
       0,5           0.7

          DOSE/pt  (mg)
1.0   2.5
    Figure 5.A.   Mutagenic  activity of acid, base, and neutral fraction of wood-
                 preserving bottom sediment as- measured with S.  typhimurium  TA 98
                 with metabolic  activation (Donnelly et al., 1982).

-------
   O
   10

a:  o
*   o
CO
00
0>
    CM
   o
   o-
 ACN WASTE

A  ACID
O  BASE
D  NEUTRAL
 4 METABOLIC
    ACTIVATION
Q2
    0.4
                         O-6
                             DOSE
   1.0
PLATE
5.0
                                                           ID
                                mg.
     Figure 5.5.   Mutagenic activity of liquid stream from the acetonitrile
                  purification  column as measured with S. typhimurium TA 98
                  with metabolic activation (Donnelly et al.,  1982).

-------
      The presence of genotoxic compounds in a waste  indicates  the  need for
 monitoring land  treatment  units using  biological  analysis when  genotoxic
 compounds are present in a waste stream.   Bioassays can also  be  performed
 at various stages  of the waste-site  interaction  studies to determine the
 reduction of  genotoxic effects along with the other  treatability  data col-
 lected.   The data obtained from biological analyses  of  waste-soil  mixtures
 can be  compared with  the toxicity  of the waste  alone  to determine  the
 degree of treatment (see Section 7.2.4).
 5.3.3          Summary of Waste Characterization Evaluation
      To  adequately address the needs  of  both the permit applicant  and  the
 permit  writer, a  standardized waste  evaluation  data processing  procedure
 should  be devised.  For  instance,  Table 5.12 gives  an example summary  of
 the  type of  information  (and  appropriate  section  references  to this  manual)
 needed  to fulfill  initial analytical requirements for an HWLT permit.   The
 preface  of this document references guidance documents  being prepared  by
 the  EPA  to help the applicant prepare a RCRA permit  application.   Ideally,
 all  permit applicants  and officials  would have  access  to a computerized
 data bank  containing  a  compilation  of  data  describing  standard  waste
 streams  and  analytical results derived from in-coming permit  applications.
 Thus, as analytical needs are evaluated  and fulfilled,  future  permit appli-
 cants and regulatory agencies would have  a continuous  up-date on toxic  or
 recalcitrant  compounds determined in  the  wastes  and analytical procedures
 acceptable for their determination.   This  should reduce the  necessity  for
 extensive analytical requirements  in  the  future,  as monitoring  could  be
 limited  to those  compounds either  found to  restrict rate, application  or
 capacity of  the HWLT unit, or to  adversely  affect environmental quality.
 5.3.4                    Final Evaluation  Process
     A critical  question  within the broad scope of waste  stream character-
istics is  whether all wastes  are  land treatable,  given the proper  design
and operation, or if  there are  any waste  streams which  should  be unequivoc-
ably prohibited  from  land treatment.   In view  of  this, one must be  cogni-
zant of  the acceptable treatment  processes for HWLT units:   degradation,
transformation and immobilization (EPA, 1982b).

     Few compounds remain unchanged when  incorporated  into  the  active  sur-
face horizons  of soils.   As  previously  established  (Section 4.1.3),  the
primary pathway  of  organic waste degradation  in  soils is biological,  sup-
plemented by chemical alteration and photodecomposition.   In contrast,  many
inorganic  waste  constituents  are  adsorbed,  complexed  or precipitated  to
innocuous forms within reasonable limits.  Any  given  waste can,  however,  be
unacceptable for land treatment if proposed soils  or  sites lack  the ability
to render the constituents less hazardous.   For example,  a  highly volatile
waste may  not  be adequately  treated in a coarse textured  soil,  or  the
application of an acidic waste  to an already acidic soil may present  a  high

                                     134

-------
TABLE 5.12  HAZARDOUS WASTE EVALUATION
  I.  Applicant's Name
 II.  Waste SIC Code or Description of Source Process
III.  Analytical Laboratory
      A.  Person Responsible foe Analyses
      B.  Quality Control Certification
 IV.  Analytical Results
      A,  Method of Collection and Storage (5.3.2.1)
      B.  Density and Method of Measurement (5.3.2.2)
      C.  Chemical Analyses
          1.  Brief Description of Analytical Methods
          2.  Recoveries & Reproducibilitiee of Methods
          3.  Inorganics (6.1 and 5.3.2.3.1)
              a.  Elements (5.3.2.3.1.1)
                  (1)  Metals (6.1.6)
                  (2)  Nutrients (6.1.2)
                       (a)  Nitrogen (N)
                       (b)  Phosphorus (P)
                       (c)  Sulphur (S)
                       (d)  Boron (B)
                  (3)  Salts (6.1.4)
                       (a)  Calcium (Ca)
                       (b)  Magnesium (Mg)
                       (c)  Potassium (K)
                       (d)  Sodium (Na)
                       (e)  Sulfate (SO^2)
                       (f)  Bicarbonate (C03~2)
                  (4)  Halides (6.1.5)
                       (a)  Flouride (F")
                       (b)  Chloride (Cl~)
                       (c)  Bromide (Br~)
                       (d)  Iodide (I~)
              b.  EC (5.3.2.3.1.2)
              c.  pH and Titratable Acids & Bases (5.3.2.3.1.3)
              d.  Water (6.1.1 and 5.3.2.3.1.4)
          4.  Organics (6.2, Table 6.53 and 5.3.2.3.2)
              a.  Total Organic Matter  (TOM)  (5.3.2.3.2.1)
              b.  Volatiles (5.3.2.3.2.1.1)
              c.  Extractables (5.3.2.3.2.1.2)
                  (1)  Organic Acids
                  (2)  Organic Bases
                  (3)  Neutrals
                  (4)  Water solubles
              d.  Residual Solids (RS)  (5.3.2.3.2.2)
      D.  Biological Analysis
          1.  Acute Toxicity (5.3.2.4.1 and 7.2.4)
          2.  Genetic Toxicity (5.3.2.4.2)
                                     135

-------
mobility  hazard  for toxic constituents.  In addition, some compounds,  such
as  hexachlorobenzene,  may not be altered within  a reasonable time by  soil
processes  or may  be mobile  and subject  to volatilization or leaching.

     Dilution  is  not  an  acceptable  primary  treatment  process  for   land
treatment.   Dilution  may  in  some  cases  serve  as  a  secondary mechanism
associated  with  degradation,  transformation  or  immobilization.   Volume
reduction  (i.e.,  evaporation of  water) is also not  acceptable as the  pri-
mary  treatment  process in  a land treatment system.   Although  evaporation
may  be an  important  mechanism, application  of   hazardous  waste  to   land
purely  for dewatering should, in  general,  be restricted  to  lined surface
impoundments which  are designed  with ground and surface water protection  in
mind.   In  an  acceptable  HWLT design, evaporative losses should,  therefore,
be  of  secondary  Importance   and  only  one  among  several   mechanisms
operating.

     In any  case,  one must be  hesitant  to  set  arbitrary  prohibitions  on
particular waste  streams until  their  unacceptability has  been  adequately
demonstrated.  Where  dilution  is functioning,  supportive to treatment, the
question of what  constitutes adequate dilution also  requires restraint  to
avoid setting arbitrary standards.

     Due to the  myriad of  components and  the  complexities associated with
possible interactions, chemical  analytical data may not adequately predict
acceptability  of land  treatment  for  a  waste liquid,  slurry  or sludge.
Acceptability is  perhaps  best  derived empirically.   Thus,  the final deci-
sion as to  the  acceptability of a waste  needs to be  based  on evaluations
derived from the  integrated results  of  waste  analysis, preliminary experi-
ments such as waste degradability,  sorption and  mobility  in  soils, toxic-
ity, mutagenicity,  and field  pilot  studies,  and the ultimate  design and
monitoring criteria relevant to  HWLT.   The following chapters are designed
to aid the evaluation  and decision processes  by addressing the integration
of these parameters.
                                    136

-------
                           CHAPTER 5 REFERENCES
Adams, C. E., Jr., D. L. Ford, and W. W. Eckenfelder, Jr. 1981. Development
of design and operational criteria for wastewater treatment. Enviro Press,
Inc. Nashville, Tennesee.

Adams, J. 1982. Unpublished results.

Adams, J., E. L. Atlas, and C. S. Giam. 1982. Ultratrace determination of
vapor-phase nitrogen heterocyclic bases in ambient air. Anal. Chem. 54:
1515-1518.

Altgelt, K. H. and T. H. Gouw (eds.) 1979. Chromatography in petroleum
analysis. Marcel Dekker, New York, New York. 500 p.

Ames, B. N., J. McCann, and E. Yamasaki. 1975. Methods for detecting car-
cinogens and mutagens with the Salmonella/mammalian microsome mutagenicty
test. Mutat.Res. 31:347.

Anders, D. E., F. G. Doolittle, and W. E. Robinson. 1975. Polar constitu-
ents isolated from Green River oil shale. Geochim. Cosmochim. Acta 39:
1423-1430.

Anderson, D. 1975. The  selection and induction of  5-iodo-2-deoxyuridine and
thymidine variants of P388 mouse lymphoma cells with agents which are used
for selection. Mutat. Res. 33:399.

Atlas, E. and C. S. Giam. 1981. Global  transport of  organic  pollutants:
ambient concentrations  in the remote marine  atmosphere.  Science 211:163-
165.

Arlett, C. F. 1977. Mutagenicity testing with V79  Chinese hamster  cells,  p.
175-191. In B. J. Kilbey, M. Legator, W. Nichols,  and  C. Ramel (ed.)  Hand-
book of mutagenlclty test procedures. Elsevier Biomedical Press, Amster-
dam.

Bartle, K. D., G. Collin, J. W. Stadelhofer, and M.  Zander.  1979.  Recent
advances in the analysis of coal-derived products. J.  Chem.  Tech.  Biotech-
nol. 29:531-551.

Bassett, J., R. C. Denney, G. H. Jeffery, and J. Mendham. 1978. Vogel's
textbook of quantitative inorganic  analysis. Longman,  London,  pp.  687-690.

Beek, B., G. Klein,  and G. Obe.  1980.  The fate of  chromosomal  aberrations
in a proliferating cell system. Biol.  Zentralbl. 99(l):73-84.

Bellar, T. A. and J. J. Lichtenberg.  1979.  Semiautomated headspace analysis
of drinking waters and  industrial waters  for purgable  volatile organic com-
pounds, pp.  108-129. In C. E. Van Hall (ed.) Measurement of organic pollu-
tants in water  and wastewater. American Society  for  Testing and Materials
ASTM  STP  686.


                                     137

-------
 Bigani, M.,  G. Morpurgo, R. Pagliani, A. Carare, G. Conte, and G.
 DiGuideppe.  1974. Non-disjunction and crossing over induced by pharmaceuti-
 cal drugs in Aspergillus nidulans. Mutat. Res. 26:159.

 Black, C. A. (ed.). 1965. Methods of soil analysis, part 2. Chemical and
 microbiological properties. Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr. No.  9. Madison,
 Wisconsin. 802 p.

 Boduszynski, M. M, R.  J. Hurtubise, and H. F. Silver. 1982a. Separation of
 solvent-refined coal into solvent derived fractions. Anal. Chem. 54:372-
 375.

 Boduszynski, M. M., R. J. Hurtubise, and H. F. Silver. 1982b.  Separation of
 solvent-refined coal into compaound-class fractions. Anal. Chem. 54:375-
 381.

 Booz-Allen and Hamilton, Inc.  and Putnam, Hayes and Bartlett,  Inc.  1980.
 Hazardous waste generation and commercial hazardous waste management
 capacity, an assessment. Prepared for the U.S. EPA. SW-894. U.S. Government
 Printing Office,  Washington, D.C.

 Bower, C. A. and  L. V. Wilcox. 1965. Soluble Salts, pp.  936-940. ^n C.  A.
 Black (ed.)  Methods of soil analysis,  part 2. Chemical and microbiological
 properties.  Am. Soc. Agron. Monogr. No.  9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

 Bowers,  W. D.,  M.  L. Parsons,  R.  E. Clement,  and F. W. Karasek.  1981.  Com-
 ponent loss  during evaporation-reconstitution of organic environmental
 samples  for  gas-chromatographic analysis.  J.  Chromatogr. 207:203-211.

 Bremner,  J.  M.  1965. Total nitrogen, pp.  1149-1178, In C. A. Black  (ed.)
 Methods  of soil analysis.  Part 2. Chemical  and microbiological properties.
 Am. Soc.  Agron. Monogr.  No.  9.  Madison, Wisconsin.

 Brewer,  R. F.  1965.  Fluorine,  pp. 1135-1148.  In C.  A.  Black Methods of  soil
 analysis,  part  2.  Chemical and microbiological properties. Am. Soc. Agron.
 Monogr.  No.  9.  Madison,  Wisconsin.

 Brocco,  D.,  A.  Cimmino,  and M.  Possanzini.  1973.  Determination of aza-
 heterocyclic compounds in  atmospheric  dust  by a combination of thin-layer
 and gas  chromatography.  J.  Chromatogr. 84:371-377.

 Brown, R. H. and C. J. Purnell. 1979.  Collection and analysis of trace
 organic  vapour  pollutants  in ambient atmospheres. The  performance of a
 Tenax-GC  adsorbent  tube. J. Chromatogr.  178:79-90.

 Brusick, D. J.  1972. Induction  of cyclohexamide resistant mutants in
 Saccharomyces cerevisiae with  N-methyl-N-nitro-N-nitrosoguanine  and
 ICR-170. J. Bacteriol. 109:1134.

Buchanan, M.  V. 1982. Mass spectral characterization of  nitrogen-containing
 compounds with  ammonia chemical ionization. Anal. Chem.  54:570-574.
                                     138

-------
Carere, A., G. Morpurgo, G. Cardamone, M. Bignami, F. Aulicino, G.
DiGuisepie, and C. Conti. 1975. Point mutations induced by pharamaceutical
drugs. Mutat. Res. 29:235.

Cautreels, W. and K. van Cauwenberghe. 1976. Extraction of organic com-
pounds from airborne particulate matter. Water, Air, Soil Pollut. 6:103-
110.

Cautreels, W., K. van Cauwenberghe, and L. A. Guzman. 1977. Comparison
between the organic fraction of suspended matter at a background and an
urban station. Sci. Tot. Environ. 8:79-88.

Claeys, R. C. 1979. Colloquium—the impact of the consent decree on analy-
tical chemistry in industry, pp. 20-21. In C. E. Van Hall (ed.) Measurement
of organic pollutants in water and wastewater. American Society for Testing
and Materials. ASTM STP 686.

Clive, D. W.  1973. Recent developments with the L5178Y TK heterozygote
mutagen assay system. Environ. Hlth. Perspec. 6:119.

Clive, D. W., W. G. Flamm, M. R. Machesko, and N. H. Bernheim. 1972.
Mutational assay system using the thymidine kinase  locus in mouse lymphoma
cells. Mutat. Res. 16:77.

Clive, D. W.  and J. F. S. Spector.  1975. Laboratory procedure  for assessing
specific locus mutations at the TK  locus in cultured L5178Y mouse lymphoma
cells. Mutat. Res. 31:17.

Colgrove, S.  G. and H. G. Svec. 1981. Liquid-liquid fractionation of  com-
plex mixtures of organic components. Anal. Chem.  53:1737-1742.

Crowley, R. J., S. Siggia, and P. C. Uden.  1980.  Class  separation and
characterization of shale oil by liquid  chromatography  and capillary  gas
chromatography. Anal. Chem. 52:1224.

Dean, B. J. and K. R. Senner.  1977.  Detection of  chemically  induced muta-
tion in Chinese hamsters. Mutat. Res. 46:403.

DeRenzo, D. J. 1978. Unit operations  for treatment  of  hazardous  industrial
wastes, pp.  1-920. Noyes Data  Corporation,  Park Ridge,  New Jersey.

DeSerres, F.  J. and H. V. Mailing.  1971. Measurement of recessive lethal
damage over the entire  genome  and at  two specific loci  in the  ad-3  region
of  a two component heterokaryon of  Neurosporacrassa. 2:311-341.  In  A.
Hollaender  (ed.)  Chemical mutagens, principles  and  methods for their  detec-
tion. Plenum  Press, New York.

de  Vera, E.  R.,  B. P. Summons, R. D.  Stephens,  and  D.  L.  Storm.   1980.
Samplers and  sampling procedures  for hazardous  waste streams.  Municipal
Environmental Research  Lab. Office  of Research and  Development,  EPA.
Cincinnati,  Ohio.  EPA 600/2-80-018. PB  80-1B5353.
                                     139

-------
 Donnelly, K.  C., K. W.  Brown,  and B.  R.  Scott.  1982.  The  use  of  bioassays
 to monitor  land treatment of hazardous waste. JLn M. D. Waters, S.  S.
 Sandhu,  J.  Lewtas, and  L. Clayton (eds.) The application  of short-term
 bloassays in  the analysis of complex  environmental mixtures.  Plenum Press
 (in  press).

 Dowty, B. J.,  S. R. Antoine, and J. L. Laseter. 1979. Quantitative and
 qualitative analysis of purgable organics by high resolution  gas chroma-
 tography and  flame ionization  detection, pp. 24-35. In C. E.  Van Hall (ed.)
 Measurement of organic  pollutants in  water and wastewater. American Society
 for  Testing and Materials. ASTM STP 686.

 Ehrenburg,  L.  1971. Higher plants. 2:365-386. In A. Hollaender (ed.) Chemi-
 cal  mutagens,  principles and methods  for their detection. Phenum Press, New
 York.

 EPA.  1979a. Development document for  effluent limitations, guidelines, and
 standards: leather, tanning and finishing point source category. EPA 440/1-
 79-016.

 EPA.  1979b. Guidelines  establishing test procedures for the analysis of
 pollutants, proposed regulations. Fed. Reg. Vol. 44.  No.  233. Dec. 3,
 1979.

 EPA.  1979c. Methods for chemical analysis of water and wastes. EPA
 600/4-79-020.  PB 297-686/8BE.

 EPA.  1980a. Treatability manual (5 volumes). Office of Research  and Devel-
 opment.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, EPA-600-8-80-042 a-e.

 EPA.  1980b. Analysis of pesticide residues in human and environmental sam-
 ples. EPA, Research. Triangle  Park, North Carolina. EPA 600/8-80-038.

 EPA.  1980c. Interim status standards  for owners and operators of hazardous
 waste treatment, storage, and  disposal facilities. Fed. Reg.  Vol.  45, No.
 98.  Book 2 of  3. May 19, 1980.

 EPA.  1980d. Subtitle C, Resource conservation and recovery act of  1976.
 Listing  of hazardous waste, background document. U.S. EPA Office of Solid
 Waste. Washington, D.C.

 EPA.  1982a. Test methods for evaluating solid waste:  physical/chemical
 methods. 2nd. ed. U.S. EPA. SW-846. July 1982.

 EPA.  1982b. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
 land disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol. 47, No. 143,  pp. 32274-
 32388. July 26, 1982.

Epstein, E. and W. Taffel. 1979. A study of rapid biodegradation of oily
wastes through composting. U.S. Dept. of Transportation.  U.S. Coast Guard
Report No. CG-D-83-79. 57 p.
                                     140

-------
Ettlich, U. F., D. J. Hinrichs, and T.  S. Lineck.  1978. Sludge handling and
conditioning. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, EPA 430/9-78-002,

Evans, H. J. and M. L. O'Riodan. 1975.  Human peripheral blood lymphocytes
for analysis of chromosome aberrations  in mutagen  tests. Hutat. Res.
31:135.

Felkner, I. C., K. M. Hoffman, and B. C. Wells.  1979. DNA - damaging and
mutagenic effect of 1,2 - Dimethylhydrazine on Bacillus subtilis repair-
deficient mutants. Mutat. Res. 28:31-40.

Florisil Properties Applications Bibliography. Floridin Co., 3 Penn Center,
Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania 15235.

Francis, A. J., E. D. Morgan, and C. F. Poole. 1978. Flophemesy derivatives
of alcohols, phenols, amines and carboxylic acids  and their use in gas
chromatography with electron-capture detection.  J. Chromatogr.
161:111-117.

Giam, C. S., H. S. Chan, and G. F. Neff. 1976. Distribution of n-parrafins
in selected marine benthic organisms. Bull. Environ. Contain. Toxicol.
16:37-43.

Giam. C. S. and M. K. Wong. 1972. Problems of background contamination in
the analysis of open ocean biota for chlorinated hydrocarbons. J.
Chromatogr. 72:283-292.

Grabow, W. 0. K., J. S. Burger, and C.  A. Hilner.  1981. Comparison of
liquid-liquid extraction and resin adsorption for  concentrating mutagens in
Ames Salmonella/microsome assays on water. Bull. Environ. Contam. Toxicol.
27:442-449.

Green, M. H. L., W. J. Muriel, and B. A. Bridges.  1976. Use of a simplified
fluctuation test to detect low levels of mutagens. Mutat. Res. 38:33.

Gritz, R. L. and D. G. Shaw. 1977. A comparison  of methods for hydrocarbon
analysis of marine biota. Bull. Environ. Contain. Toxicol. 17(4):408-415.

Hendrickaon, J. B., D. J. Cram, and G.  S. Hammond. 1970. Organic chemistry.
3rd. ed. McGraw-Hill Book Co., New York. 1279 p.

Herrick, E., C. J. A. King, R. P. O^iellette, and P. N. Cheremisinoff. 1979.
Unit process guide to organic chemical  industries, Vol. 1 of unit process
series. Ann Arbor Sci. Publ. Inc., Ann  Arbor, Michigan.

Hertz, H. S., J. M. Brown, S. N. Chesler, F. R.  Guenther, L. R. Hilpert, W.
E. May, R. M. Parris, and S. A. Wise. 1980. Determination of individual
organic compounds in shale oil. Anal. Chem. 52:1650-1657.

Hoffman, D. and E. L. Wynder. 1977. Organic particulate pollutants-chemical
analysis and bioassays for carcinogenecity. pp.  361-455, In A. C. Stern
(ed.) Air Pollution. Vol. II. 3rd ed. Academic Press, New York, New York.

                                    141

-------
Holden,  A. V.  and K. Marsden.  1969.  Single-stage  clean-up  of  animal  tisue
extracts for organochlorine  residue  analysis.  J.  Chromatogr.  44:481-492.

Holstein, W. and D. Severin.  1981. Liquid  chromatography of coal  oil
fractions. Anal. Chem.  53:2356-2358.

Jacobs,  L. and R. DeMars.  1977.  Chemical mutagenesis with  diploid human
fibroblasts. pp. 193-220.  In B.  J. Kilbey, M.  Legator, W.  Nichols and  C.
Ramel  (ed.) Handbook of mutagenicity test  procedures. Elsevier  Biomedical
Press, Amsterdam.

Johnson,  E. L. and R. Stevenson.  1978.  Basic liquid chromatography.  Varian
Associates, Inc. Palo Alto,  California.

Kada,  T., M. Morija, and Y.  Shirasu.  1974. Screening of pesticides for DNA
interactions by REC-assay  and  mutagenic testing and frameshift  mutagens
detected. Mutat. Res. 26:243.

Kihlman,  B. A. 1977. Root  tips of Vicia fava for  the study of the induction
of chromosomal aberrations,  pp.  389-410. ^n B. J. Kilbey,  M.  Legator,  W.
Nichols,  and C. Ramel (ed.)  Handbook of mutagenicity test  procedures.
Elsevier Biomedical Press, Amsterdam.

Knuutinen, J.  1982. Analysis of  chlorinated guaiacols in spent  bleach
liquor from a pulp mill. J.  Chromatogr. 248:289-295.

Kugelman, I. J. and J. S.  Jeris.  1981. Anaerobic  digestion, pp. 211-278. In
W. W. Eckenfelder, Jr. and C.  J.  Santhanam (eds.) Sludge treatment.  Marcel
Dekker,  Inc., New York, New  York.

Kumar, R. and S. Chauhan.  1979.  Frequency  and  spectrum of  chlorophyll  muta-
tions  in a 6 rowed barley  Hordeum vulgare. Indian J. Agri. Sci. 49(11):831-
834.

Later, D. W., M. L. Lee, K.  D. Bartle, R.  C. Kong, and D.  L.  Vassilaros.
1981.  Chemical class separation  and  characterization of organic compounds
in synthetic fuels. Anal.  Chem.  53:1612-1620.

Lin, D.  C. K., R. L. Foltz,  S. V. Lucas, B. A. Petersen, L. E.  Slivon, and
R. G. Melton.  1979. Glass  capillary  gas chromatographic-mass  spectrometric
analysis of organics in drinking water concentrates and advanced  waste
treatment water concentrates—II. pp. 68-84. In C. E. Van  Hall  (ed.)
American Society for Testing and Materials. ASTM STP 686.

Loehr, R. C., W. J. Jewell, J. D. Novak, W. W. Clarkson, and  G. S.
Friedman. 1979. Land application of wastes. Vol.  I. Van Hostrand  Reinhold
Co., New York, New York. 308 p.
                                     142

-------
 Loprleno,  N.,  R.  Barale,  C.  Bauer,  S.  Baroncelli,  G.  Bronzetti,  A,   Cammel-
 llni,  A.  Clnci,  G.  Corsl,  C.  Leporinl,  R.  Nleri, M. Mozzolini, and  C.
 Serra. 1974.  The  use of different test  systems  with yeasts  for the  evalua-
 tion of chemically  induced gene conversions  and gene  mutations.  Mutat.  Res.
 25:197.

 Lundi, G.,  J.  Gether,  N.  Gjos,  and  M.  B.  S.  Lande. 1977.  Organic raicropol-
 lutants in  precipitation  in  Norway. Atmos. Environ. 11:1007-1014.

 Marimuthu,  K.  M., A.  H. Sparrow,  and L. A. Schairer.  1970.  The cytological
 effects of  space  flight factors,  vibration,  clinostate, and radiation on
 root tip  cells of Tradescantia  and  Allium cepa. Radiation Res. 42:105.

 Matsushita, H. 1979.  Micro-analysis of  polynuclear aromatic hydrocarbons in
 petroleum.  Am. Chem.  Soc., Div.  Fuel Chem. 24:292-298.

 Metry,  A. A.  1980.  The handbook of  hazardous waste management. Technomic
 Publishing  Company.  Westport, Connecticut.

 McLafferty, F. W. 1973. Interpretation  of mass  spectra. W.  A. Benjamin,
 Inc.,  London*

 McNair, H.  M.  and E.  J. Bonelli.  1968.  Basic gas chromatography. Varlan
 Associate,  Inc.,  Palo Alto,  California.

 Middled!tch, B. S.,  S. R.  Missler,  and  H. B. Hines. 1981. Mass spectrometry
 of priority pollutants. Plenum  Press. New York, New York.

 Killer, R.  1982*  Hydrocarbon  class  fractlonatlon with bonded-phase  liquid
 chromatography. Anal. Chem. 54:1742-1746.

 Mohn,  G., J. Eltenberger,  and D.  B»  McGregor. 1974. Development  of  mutagen-
 icity  tests using Estherichla coll  K-12 as an indicator organism. Mutat.
 Res. 23:187.

 Morrison, R. T. and  R. N.  Boyd.  1975. Organic chemistry.  Allyn and  Bacon,
 Inc.,  Boston^  Massachusetts.

Mortimer, R. K. and T. R. Matitiey. 1971* Mutation induction,  in yeast.
 1:289-310. In  A. Hollaender (ed.) Chemical mutagens,  principles  and methods
 for  their deTection. Plenum Press,  New York.

Mousa,  J. J. and S. A. Whitlock.  1979. Analysis of phenols  in some  Indus-
 trial wastewaters. pp. 206-220. ^n  C. E. Van Hall  (ed.) Measurement of
 organic pollutants in water and wastewater. American  Society for Testing
 and Materials. ASTM  STP 686.

Namiesnik, J., L. Torres, E. Kozlowski, and J.  Mathieu. 1981. Evaluation of
the suitability of selected porous  polymers for preconcentration of vola-
tile organic compounds. J. Chromatogr. 208:239-252.
                                     143

-------
 Nauman,  C.  H.,  A.  H,  Sparrow,  and L.  A.  Schalrer,  1976.  Comparative effects
 of ionizing radiation and  two  gaseous chemical mutagens  on somatic mutation
 induction in one mutable and  two non-mutable clones  of Tradescantia.  Mutat.
 Res.  38:53-70.

 Neill, J.  P., P. A. Brimer, R.  Machanoff,  G. P. Hirseh,  and A.  W.  Hsie.
 1977. A  quantitative  assay of  mutation induction at  the  HGPRT locus in
 Chinese  hamster ovary cells: development and definition  of the  system.
 Mutat. Res.  45:91.

 Nicoloff,  H., K. I. Gecheff, and L.  Stoilov. 1979. Effects of caffeine on
 the frequencies and location of chemically induced chromatid aberrations  in
 barley.  Mutat.  Res. 70:193-201.

 Novotny,  M.  J.  W.  Strand,  S. L. Smith, D.  Wiesler, and F.  J. Schwende.
 1981.  Compositional  studies of coal  tar by capillary  gas  chromatography/
 mass  spectrometry. Fuel  60:213-220.

 Novotny,  M. , D.  Wiesler, and F. Merli. 1982. Capillary gas chromatography/
 mass spectrometry of  azaarenes  isolated  from crude coal  tar. Chroma-
 tographia  15:374-377.

 Ong, T.  N.  1978. Use  of  the spot,  plate  and suspension test systems for  the
 detection of the mutagenicity  of environmental agents  and  chemical carcino-
 gens in  Neurospora crassa. Mutat.  Res. 54:121-129.

 Packer,  K.  (ed.) 1975. Nanogen  index,  a  dictionary of  pesticides and  chemi-
 cal pollutants.  Nanogens International.  Freedom, California.

 Parry, J. M. 1977. The use of  yeast cultures for the detection  of  environ-
 mental mutagens  using a  fluctuation test.  Mutat. Res.  46:165.

 Peech, M. 1965.  Hydrogen-ion activity. Agron.  9:914-926.

 Pellizzari,  E.  D. 1982. Analysis for  organic vapor emissions near  indus-
 trial and chemical waste disposal  sites. Environ. Sci. Technol.  16:781-
 785.

 Pellizzari, E.  D., J. E. Bunch,  R. E.  Berkley,  and J.  McRae. 1976. Deter-
 mination of  trace hazardous organic vapor  pollutants in  ambient atmospheres
 by  gas chromatography/mass spectrometry/computer. Anal.  Chem. 48:802-806.

 Pellizzari, E.  D., N. P. Castillo, S.  Willis,  D. Smith,  and J.  T.  Bursey.
 1978. Identification of organic constituents in aqueous  effluents  from
 energy-related  processes. Am. Chem. Soc.,  Div.  Fuel Chem.  23:144-155.

 Pellizzari, E.  D. and L. Little.  1980. Collection and  analysis  of  purgable
organics emitted from wastewater  treatment  plants. EPA.  Cincinnati, Ohio.
EPA 600/2-80-017.

Perry, P. and H. J. Evans. 1975.  Cytological detection of  mutagen-carcino-
gen exposure by sister chromatid  exchange.  Nature (London).  258:121.

                                    144

-------
Plewa, M. J. and J. M. Gentile. 1976. The mutagenicity of atrazine:  a
maize-microbe bioassay. Mutat. Res. 38:287-292.

Redei, G. P. 1975. Arabadopsis as a genetic tool. Ann. Rev. Genet. 9:111-
125.

Reunanen, M. and R. Kroneld. 1982. Determination of volatile halocarbons in
raw and drinking water, human serum, and urine by election capture GC. J.
Chromatogr. Sci. 20:449-454.

Rice, R. G. and M. E. Browning. 1981. Ozone treatment of industrial waste-
water. Pollution Technology Review No. 84. pp. 31-35. Noyes Data Corpora-
tion. Park Ridge, New Jersey.

Russell, J. W. 1975. Analysis of air pollutants using sampling tubes and
gas chromatography. Environ. Sci. Technol. 9:1175-1178.

Safe, S. and 0. Hutzinger. 1973. Mass apectrometry of pesticides and pol-
lutants. CRC Press. Cleveland, Ohio.

Scott, B. R., E. Kafer, G. L. Dorn, and R. Stafford. 1980. Aspergillus
nidulans: systems and results of test for induction of mutation and mitotic
segregation. Mutat. Res. (in press)

Scott, B. R., A. H. Sparrow, S. S. Lamm, and L. Schairer.  1978. Plant meta-
bolic activation of EDB to a mutagen of greater potency. Mutat. Res.
49:203-212.

Shackelford, W. M. and R. G. Webb. 1979. Survey analysis of phenolic
compounds in industrial effluents by gas chromatography-mass spectrometry.
pp. 191-205. In C. E. Van Hall (ed.) Measurement of organic pollutants  in
water and wastewater. American Society for Testing and Materials. ASTM  STP
686.

Skoog, D, A. and D. M. West. 1979. Analytical  chemisty, 3rd ed. pp.
186-246. Holt, Rinehart and Winston, New York.

Skopek, T. R., J. L. Liber, J. J. Krowleski, and W. G. Thilly. 1978.  Quan-
titative forward mutation assay in Salmonella  typhimurium  using 8-azagua-
nine resistance as a genetic marker. Proc. Nat'l. Acad. Sci. 75:410.

Slater, E., M. D. Anderson, and H. S. Rosenkranz. 1971. Rapid detection of
mutagens and carcinogens. Cancer Res. 31:970.

Snyder, D. and R. Reinert. 1971. Rapid separation of polychlorinated
biphenyls from DDT and its analogues on silica gel. Bull.  Environ. Contam.
Toxicol. 6:385-387.

Soderberg, K., J. T. Mascarello, G. Breen, and I. E. Scheffler. 1979.
Respiration deficient Chinese hamster cell mutants genetic characteriza-
tion. Somatic Cell Genet. 5(2):225-240.
                                     145

-------
 Sodergren, A.  1978.  Simultaneous detection of halogenated  and other
 compounds by electron-caputre and flame-conizatlon detectors combined in
 series. J. Chromatogr.  160:271-276.

 Speck, W. T.,  R. M.  Santella, and H. S. Rosenkranz.  1978.  An evaluation of
 the prophage induction  (inductest) for the detection of potential carcino-
 gens. Mutat. Res. 54:101.

 Stetka, D. G.  and S. Wolff.  1976. Sister chromatid exchange as an assay for
 genetic damage Induced  by mutagen-carcinogens. Mutat. Res. 41:333.

 Stout, P. R. and C.  M.  Johnson. 1965. Chlorine and bromine, pp.  1124-1134.
 Ir± C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of soil analysis, part  2. Chemical  and
 microbial properties. Am. Soc. Agron. Madison, Wisconsin.

 Stubley, C., J. G. P. Stell, and D. W. Mathieson. 1979. Analysis of
 azanaphthalenes and  their enzyme oxidation products  by high-performance
 liquid chromatography,  infrared spectroscopy, and mass spectrometry. J.
 Chromatogr. 177:313-322.

 Stuermer, D. H., D.  J.  Ng, and C. J. Morris. 1982. Organic contaminants in
 groundwater near an  underground coal gasification site in  northeastern
 Wyoming. Environ. Sci.  Technol. 16:582-587.

 Tanooka, J. 1977. Development and applications of Bacillus subtillus test
 system for mutagens  involving DNA repair deficiency  and suppressible auxo-
 trophlc mutations. Mutat. Res. 48:367.

 Tanooka, H., N. Munakata, S. Kitahara. 1978. Mutation induction  with UV-
 and X-radiation in spores and vegetative cells of Bacillus Subtillis.
 Mutat. Res. 49:179-186.

 Texaco, Inc. 1979. Composting of oily sludges. Report to the Solid Waste
 Committee, Environ.  Affairs Dept. of the Am. Petroleum Institute. 22 p.

 Thllly, W. G., J. G. DeLuca, I. V. H. Hoppe, and B. W. Penmann.  1976.
 Mutation of human lymphoblasts by methylnitrosourea. Chem. Blol. Interact.
 15:33.

 Tucker, E. S., V. W. Saeger, and 0. Hicks. 1975. Activated sludge primary
 blodegradation of polychlorlnated biphenlys. Bull. Environ. Contam.
 Toxicol. 14(6):705-713.

 Underbrlnk, A. G., L. A. Schairer, and A. H. Sparrow. 1973. Tradescantia
 stamen hairs.  A radiobiological test system applicable to  chemical mutagen-
 esis. 3:171-207. In. A.  Hollaender (ed.) Chemical mutagens, principles and
methods for their detection. Plenum Press, New York.

Vlck, R. D., J. J. Richard, H. J. Svec, and G. A, Junk. 1977. Problems with
 Tenax-GC for environmental sampling. Chemosphere 6:303-308.
                                    146

-------
Vig, B. K. 1975. Soybean (Glycine max); a new test system for study of
genetic parameters as affected by environmental mutagens. Mutat. Res.
31:49-56.

Von Borstel, R. C. and R. H. Smith. 1977. Measuring dominant lethality in
Habrobracon. pp. 375-387. In B. J. Kilbey, M. Legator, W. Nichols and C.
Ramel (ed.) Handbook of mutagenicity testing procedures. Elsevier Biomed.
Press, Amsterdam.

Wear, J. I. 1965. Boron, pp. 1059-1063. In C. A. Black (ed.) Methods of
soil analysis, part 2. Chemical and microbial properties. Am.   Soc. Agron.
Madison, Wisconsin.

Worstell, J. H. and S. R. Daniel. 1981. Deposit formation in liquid fuels.
2. The effect of selected compounds on the storage stability of Jet A
turbine fuel. Fuel 60:481-484.

Worstell, J. H., S. R. Daniel, and G. Frauenhoff. 1981.  Deposit formation
in liquid fuels. 3. The effect of selected nitrogen compounds on diesel
fuel. Fuel 60:485-487.

Wurgler, F. E. and E. Vogel. 1977. Drosophila as  an assay system for
detecting genetic changes, pp. 335-373.  In B. J.  Kilbey, M.  Legator, W.
Nichols, and C. Ramel (ed.) Handbook of  mutagenicity  test procedures.
Elsevier Biomed. Press, Amsterdam.
                                     147

-------
 6.0                              CHAPTER SIX

                FATE  OF CONSTITUENTS  IN  THE SOIL ENVIRONMENT
     An  understanding  of  the behavior of  the  various  waste streams in the
 soil  environment at an HWLT unit may be  derived from  a  knowledge of the
 specific constituents  that compose the waste.   Chapter 5 provided general
 information  on the characterization  of  waste streams.   After determining
 the constituents  present  in the waste,  this chapter can be used  to gain a
 better understanding of the  fate of the wastes disposed  by  HWLT.

     Knowledge  about   the  specific components  expected to  be found  in a
 given waste  stream can be gained from  information  on  the  sources of the
 waste,  any pretreatment or  in-plant  process changes,  and  waste analyses.
 Although only hazardous constituents are regulated  by EPA,  there may be
 other waste  constituents,  not  listed as hazardous, that  are nevertheless
 significant.   Once waste  characterization (Section  5.3} has confirmed the
 presence of  a specific compound or element,  this chapter  will  serve as a
 source  of information  on  the environmental  fate,  toxicity and land  treat-
 ability  of individual  components of  the  waste.    Figure 6.1 indicates the
 topics  discussed and  the  organization of  the material presented  in this
 chapter.   Additional literature references are cited which  can be used when
 more detailed information  is desired.
6.1                       INORGANIC CONSTITUENTS
     Although  inorganic  chemical soil reactions have  been more  thoroughly
studied  than organic, comprehensive  information is  still limited  on  the
behavior of  some  inorganic  chemicals  in the heterogeneous chemical,  physi-
cal and  biological  matrix of the soil.  Agriculturally important  compounds
have received greater scrutiny than others.  For instance, metals  have  only
recently begun  to attract widespread  interest  as the use of land  treatment
for municipal wastes  has increased.   The information developed from  treat-
ing municipal  wastes  does not,  however,  address the  entire  range of  con-
stituents that  may  be present in hazardous industrial wastes.
6.1.1                              Water
     Water  is  practically ubiquitous in hazardous  waste  streams and  often
constitutes the largest waste  fraction.   In a land treatment system,  water
has several major functions.  As a carrier, water transports both dissolved
and particulate  matter through  both surface runoff  and  deep percolation.
Water  also controls  gas  exchange  between  the  soil and  the   atmosphere.
Thus, water may  be  beneficial by controlling  the  release rate of volatile
waste constituents.   For  example,  where aeration is  poor due  to high  soil
water content, biological decomposition of waste constituents is inhibited
                                     148

-------
       r
WASTE
     FATE OF WASTE
  CONSTITUENTS IN THE
      HWLT SYSTEM
      CHAPTER SIX
  ASSESS THE EXPECTED
 FATE OF THE INORGANIC
     CONSTITUENTS
     (SECTION 6.1)
  ASSESS THE EXPECTED
  FATE OF THE ORGANIC
     CONSTITUENTS
     (SECTION 6.2)
t
OTENTIAL
 SITI
                                WATER   §6.1.1
                            —[PLANT  NUTRIENTS  §6.1.2
                       ACIDS & BASES  §6.1.3
                       SALTS  §6.1.4
                                HALIDES   §6.1.5
                            I—I METALS   §6.1.6
                            —[ALIPHATIC HYDROCARBONS   §6.2.3.1
                            —| AROMATIC HYDROCARBONS   §6.2.3.2
                       ORGANIC ACIDS  §6.2.3.3
                                HALOGENATED ORGANICS   §6.2.3.4
                            1—[SURFACE ACTIVE AGENTS  §6.2.3.5
                                               CHARACTERIZATION OF THE
                                                  TREATMENT MEDIUM
                                                    CHAPTER FOUR
                                  _L
                      /WASTE-SITE INTERACTIONS \
                      V    CHAPTER SEVEN   J

Figure 6.1.   Constituent groups to be considered  when assissing the fate
             of wastes in the land treatment system.
                                  149

-------
 and  may be accompanied  by acute odor problems.   A lack  of  soil water  can
 also  inhibit  wast_ degradation.

      Since the application  of  waste may contribute  significant amounts  of
 water in  addition  to  precipitation  inputs,  a complete  hydrologic  balance
 including  the  water content  of  the waste must be developed.  Techniques  for
 calculating  the hydrologic  balance are  presented  in  Section  8.3.1;  these
 calculations  are  used to estimate  waste  storage  requirements,  waste  appli-
 cation  rates,  and  runoff retention and treatment needs.
6.1.2                          Plant Nutrients
     Many  of the  elements  essential  to  plant growth  may have detrimental
effects  when excessive  concentrations are  present in  soil.    Some  may  be
directly toxic  to plants, while  others  may induce  toxic  responses in  ani-
mals.  Further  problems may involve damage  to the soil physical properties
or  to  surface  water ecosystems.  Consequently,  plant  nutrients, present  in
significant  concentrations  in the  waste,  that   may  adversely  affect   the
environment  should be  considered in  determining  the  feasibility  of  land
treatment  and appropriate waste loading  rates.  This section deals with the
plant  essential  elements  not  classified  and discussed as metals or halides,
which  may  cause  problems  in  an HWLT  unit.
6.1.2.1  Nitrogen  (N)


     Land application  of  a waste high in nitrogen requires an understanding
of the various  forms  of  N contained  in  the  waste,  the transformations  that
occur  in  soils, and  the  rates  associated with  these transformations.  A
knowledge of  N  additions  to and  losses  from the disposal  site  can then  be
used to  calculate a  mass balance  equation  which is  used to  estimate  the
amount and rate of waste  loading.

     Wastes high  in  N have typically included  sewage  sludges, wastewaters,
and animal wastes.   Table 6.1 lists  the N content  of  several sewage  types
and Table 6.2 gives  the  N analysis  of  manure  samples.   Pharmaceutical  and
medicinal  chemicals   manufacturing  generate   wastes   high   in  ammonia,
organonitrogen and soluble inorganic salts.   In sewage and animal manure, N
is usually found as ammonium  or  nitrate.  Industrial wastes often contain N
in small quantities incorporated in aromatic compounds, such as pyridines.
                                    150

-------
TABLE 6.1   CHEMICAL  COMPOSITION OF  SEWAGE SLUDGES*1
Concentration"
. _ Cf\nff^^^nr,^• r*f
Component
Total N
NH4-N
N03-N
Number of
Samples
191
103
45
Range
0.1 - 17.
0.1 - 6.
0.1 - 0.

6
8
5
Median
3.3
0.1
0.1
Mean
3.9
0.7
0.1
Variability
85
171
158



* Sommers (1977).

t Data are  from  numerous  types  of  sludges (anaerobic, aerobic, activated,
  lagoon, etc.)  in  seven  states:   Wisconsin,  Michigan, New Hampshire, New
  Jersey, Illinois,  Minnesota,  Ohio.

^ Oven-dry  solids basis.

+ Standard  deviation as a percentage  of the mean.  Number of samples on
  which  this  is  based may not  be  the  same as for other columns.
TABLE  6.2   CHEMICAL ANALYSES OF MANURE SAMPLES TAKEN FROM 23 FEEDLOTS IN
            TEXAS**
Element
N 1.16
P 0.32
K 0.75
Na 0.29
Ca 0.81
Mg 0.32
Fe 0.09
Zn 0.005
H20 20.9
Range
(%)
- 1.96
- 0.85
- 2.35
- 1.43
- 1.75
- 0.66
- 0.55
- 0.012
- 54.5
Average
(%)
1.34
0.53
1.50
0.74
1.30
0.50
0.21
0.009
34.5
* Mathers et al.  (1973).

f All values based on wet weight.
     Precipitation adds  to  the N that reaches  the  surface  of the earth and
several  attempts  have been made  to quant it ate  this.   Additions  of  N from
precipitation  are greater  in  the  tropics  than in humid  temperate regions
                                     151

-------
and larger in humid  temperate  regions than in setniarid climates.  Table 6.3
lists N values  in  precipitation from various  locations.   A study by Gamble
and Fisher (1964)  revealed  that most of the N reaching  the earth is in the
NC>3 "and NH4+  forms.   Concentrations  of  N in  the  rain  resulting  from  a
thunderstorm  are shown  in  Fig. 6.2.   The  initial  concentrations  of  NC>3~
are 8 ppm  and  decrease sharply as  the  precipitation  cleanses  the  air  of  N
containing dust, eroded  soil,  and  incomplete combustion products.


TABLE 6.3  AMOUNTS OF  NITROGEN CONTRIBUTED BY PRECIPITATION*
Location
Harpenden, England
Garford, England
Flahult , Sweden
Groningen, Holland
Bloemfontein and Durban,
South Africa
Ottawa, Canada
Ithaca, N.Y.
Years
of
Record
28
3
1
—
2
10
11

Rainfall
(cm)
73.2
68.3
82.6
70.1
—
59.4
74.9
kg/ha/yr
Ammoniacal
Nitrogen
2.96
7.20
3.72
5.08
4.50
4.95
4.09

Nitrate
Nitrogen
1.49
2.16
1.46
1.64
1.56
2.42
0.77
* Lyon and BIzzell  (1934).


     Nitrogen  exists in waste,  soil and  the atmosphere  in several  forms.
Organic N, such  as  alkyl or aromatic amines,  is bound in carbon-containing
compounds  and   is   not  available  for  plant  uptake  or  leaching   until
transformed  to  inorganic  N by  microbial  decomposition.   Humus  and  crop
residues in the  soil contain organic N.

     Inorganic  N Is found  in  various  forms  such  as  ammonia,   ammonium,
nitrite, nitrate and molecular  nitrogen.  Ammonium (NH^+) can  be held  in
the soil on cation  exchange  sites  because of its positive charge.  Ammonium
is used by both  plants  and  microorganisms as  a  source  of N.  Ammonia (NH3>
exists as a gas,  and NH^"*"  may  be  converted  to  NH3  at  high pH values.
(NOj")  is  a  highly  mobile  anion  formed in soils  as an  intermediate  in
the nitrification process discussed in Section 6.1.2.1.3.   Nitrite is toxic
to plants  in small  quantities.    Nitrate (N03~)  is  a highly  mobile  anion
readily used by  plants  and  microorganisms.  Nitrates may be readily leached
from the  soil  and  may  present  a  health hazard.   (The  term N03~N is  read
nitrate-nitrogen and is not the  same  as N03 (10 mg/1  N03~N =   44.3  mg/1
N03).   Molecular nitrogen  (N2>  is a gas   comprising  nearly 80%  of  the
normal atmosphere.
                                     152

-------
                       .04  .08  .12   J6
                    Total   Rainfall  (inj
Figure  6.2.  Chemical composition of thundershower
            samples (Gamble and Fisher,  1964).
            Reprinted by the permission  of  the
            American Geophysical Union.
                           153

-------
     The  nitrogen cycle (Fig.  6.3)  is often  used  to illustrate  the addi-
tions and removals of  N from the soil system  and the subsequent changes in
form due  to the prevailing  soil environment.   In addition to the N added to
the soil  by wastes and  precipitation (discussed previously),  the nitrogen
cycle  is  affected by  the  processes  of  mineralization,  nitrogen  fixation,
nitrification,  plant  uptake,  denitrification,  volatilization, storage in
the soil, immobilization,  runoff, and leaching.   The amount of N added or
removed by  each of these mechanisms, the rate at which  they occur, and the
optimum soil conditions  for  each are discussed below.


6.1.2.1.1  Mineralization.   The process  of  mineralization involves the  con-
version of  the plant  unavailable organic forms  of  N  to  the available inor-
ganic state by microbial decomposition.   Mineralization includes the ammon-
ification  process  which  oxidizes  amines  into N02~  or   NC>3~.    Organic
N contained in wastes  is not  available for  plant uptake or subject to other
losses until mineralization  occurs.   Only a portion of the organic N in the
waste will  be  converted to  the available  inorganic  form  during  the first
year  after  application, and only  smaller  amounts will be  mineralized in
subsequent  years.

     Table  6.4  shows an estimated  decay series, or  fractional mineraliza-
tion,  for a given waste application.   The table  also  shows a ratio  of N
inputs  necessary   to  supply  a   constant  mineralization  rate.   The  table,
developed by Pratt et  al.  (1973), is  an  estimate of  decomposition based on
the type  of animal waste and amount  of weathering  the waste has undergone.
For example,  dry   corral manure  containing  2.5% N has an  estimated decay
series of 0.40, 0.25,  and  0.06  which means that at  any given application,
40% of the N applied will be  mineralized the first  year, 25% of the remain-
ing N will  become  available  the second year,  and 6% of the remaining N  will
be  mineralized  in  the  third  and  all subsequent  years.   If  22.5  metric
tons/ha of  this manure  (dry  weight basis) were applied, of  the 560 kg total
N, 224 kg would be mineralized  the first year, 63.75 kg the second,  12.4 kg
the third,  11.6 kg  the fourth,  10.9 the  fifth,   and  10.2 the  sixth  year
(Pratt et al.,  1973).   The ratios shown  in Table  6.4 are  useful  for esti-
mating the  amount  of N that  will be  available given a decay series.  In the
example above, 2.5 kg  of total  N must be added to  furnish  1 kg of  available
N the  first year.   If  manure  is  added  to the  same  field  next  year,  only
1.82 kg must be added  to provide 1 kg of  available N, and  so on.

     Research by  Minesley  et al.  (1972)  shows that considerable amounts of
organic N in sludge  and soil organic  matter  are mineralized during a grow-
ing season.   This research indicates  that about  25%  of  the  organic  N in
sludge  is mineralized  in  the  first  year of  application,  and  3-5%  of  the
organic N is converted  to inorganic  N during the next three years.

     Another decay series of  mineralization is given in Table 6.5 where the
values are  calculated  on the basis of having  3% of the remaining or resid-
ual organic N released  as available inorganic N during the second, third,
and fourth  growing  seasons.    For example, if  5 metric tons/ha  of  sludge
containing  3.5% (175 kg) of  organic  N were applied to a soil one year,  dur-
ing the following  growing  season, 0.9 kg/metric ton  of sludge would become

                                     154

-------
                         NH3
                     VOLATILIZATION
PLANTS
                                       SOIL
                                   yiROORGANISMS
GASEOUS LOSSES
                                                                                 t
                                                                           (denitrification)
                                                                                N03-
                                                                         LEACHING LOSSES
Figure 6.3.   Nitrogen cycle illustrating the fate of sludge nitrogen (Beaucharop and
             Moyer, 1974).

-------
TABLE 6.4  RATIO OF YEARLY  NITROGEN  INPUT TO ANNUAL NITROGEN MINERALIZATION RATE OF ORGANIC WASTES*t
Decay Series
Typical
Material*
                                                                    Time (years)
 1
10     15
20
0.90, 0.10, 0.05

0.75, 0.15, 0.10, 0.05


0.40, 0.25, 0.06


0.35, 0.15, 0.10, 0.05


0.20, 0.10, 0.05


0.35, 0.10, 0.05
Chicken manure

Fresh bovine
waste, 3.5% N

Dry corral
manure, 2.5% N

Dry corral
manure, 1.5% N

Dry corral
manure, 1.0% N

Liquid sludge,
2.5%
	N input/mineralization ratio	

1.11    1.10    1.09    1.09     1.08     1.06    1.05    1.04


1.33    1.27    1.23    1.22     1.20     1.15    1.11    1.06


2.50    1.82    1.74    1.58     1.54     1.29    1.16    1.09


2.86    2.06    1.83    1.82     1.72     1.40    1.23    1.13


5.00    3.00    2.90    2.44     2.17     1.38    1.13    1.04


2.86    2.33    2.19    2.03     1.90     1.45    1.22    1.11
* Pratt et al.  (1973).

t This ratio  is for a  constant  yearly mineralization rate for six decay series for various times
  after initial application.  The  ratio  equals  kilograms of N input required to mineralize 1 kg of N
  annually.
ii
* The N content is on  a  dry weight basis.

-------
available.   Therefore,  for  a 5 metric  ton/ha rate,  4.3  kg N/ha  would  be
mineralized  to  the  inorganic form  (Sommers  and Nelson, 1976).
TABLE 6.5  RELEASE  OF  PLANT-AVAILABLE NITROGEN DURING SLUDGE DECOMPOSITION
           IN  SOIL*
                                   Organic N Content of Sludge, %
   Years After         	
Sludge Application      2.0     2.5     3.0     3.5     4.0     4.5     5.0
kg residual
1
2
3
0.5
0.45
0.45
0.6
0.6
0.55
N release per metric ton
0.7
0.7
0.65
0.85
0.8
0.75
0.95
0.9
0.85
sludge added
1.1
1.05
1.0
1.2
1.15
1.1
* Sommers and Nelson  (1976).
     Microbial  degradation  of  complex  aromatic  compounds  containing  N
depends on  the  structure,  nature, and position  of  functional groups.  Gen-
eral results  of many  investigations  are  summarized as follows:  short chain
amines  are  more resistant  to mineralization  than those  of higher molecular
weight; unsaturated aliphatic amines tend  to  be more readily attacked than
saturates;  resistance to decomposition increases with the number of chlor-
ines in the aromatic ring;  and  branched compounds are  more resistant than
unbranched  compounds  (Goring et  al., 1975).


6.1.2.1.2   Fixation.   The  process  by which  atmospheric  nitrogen  (^)  is
converted to  available  inorganic N by bacteria is called nitrogen fixation;
it may  either be symbiotic  or  nonsymbiotic.   Symbiotic N  fixation is  the
conversion  of  N£  to  NH4+ by   Rhizobium   bacteria,  which live   in  root
nodules  of  leguminous  -plants.     Nonsymbiotic  fixation  involves   the
conversion  of  N by  free-living  bacteria,  Clostridium  and  Azotobacter.
Fixation  by  leguminous bacteria accounts for  the  great  majorityofN
fixation  (Brady,  1974).    Table  6.6 reports  the  N fixation  of  various
legumes in  kg/ha/yr.
                                    157

-------
 TABLE 6.6  NITROGEN FIXED BY VARIOUS LEGUMES*
Crop (kg/ha /yr) Crop (kg/ha/yr)
Alfalfa (Medicago sativa)
Sweet clover (Melilotus sp.)
Red clover (Trifolium
(pratense)
Alsike clover (Trifolium
hybridum)
281
188
169
158
Soybeans (Glyclne max)
Hairy vetch (Vicia villosa)
Field beans (Phaseolus
vulgarls)
Field peas (Pisum arvense)

118
76
65
53
* Lyon  and Bizzell  (1934).
     The  amount of  N fixed  by Rhizobium  depends  on  many  factors.   Soil
conditions  favorable  for  microbial  populations  include  good  aeration,
adequate  moisture,  and a  near neutral  pH.   A  high  N containing  waste  or
fertilizer  may  actually discourage  nodulation  and  thereby  reduce  fixation
(Fig.  6.4).    Therefore,   N  input   from  N-fixing  bacteria  is  of  minor
significance on land  receiving waste applications.

     The exact amount  of N fixed by nonsymbiotic bacteria in  soils is very
difficult to determine because other processes  involving N are taking place
simultaneously.   Experiments  in several  areas  of the U.S.  indicate that
20-60  kg  N/ha/yr  may be  fixed by  nonsymbiotic organisms  (Moore,  1966).
Table 6.7 lists amounts of N  fixed nonsymbiotically.


TABLE 6.7  NITROGEN GAINS ATTRIBUTED TO  NONSYMBIOTIC  FIXATION IN FIELD
           EXPERIMENTS*
Location
Utah
Missouri
California
California
United Kingdom
Australia
Nigeria
Michigan
Period
(years)
11
8
10
60
20
3
3
7
Description
Irrigated soil and manure
Bluegrass (Poa sp. ) sod
Lysimeter experiment
Pinus ponderosa stand
Monoculture tree stands
Solonized soil
Latosolic soil
Straw mulch
Nitrogen Gain
(kg/ha/yr)
49
114
54
63
58
25
90
56
* Moore (1966).
                                    158

-------
                160
                      20  40     30     120     160     200
                      RATE OF NITROGEN APPLICATION (mg/pot)
Figure 6.4. Influence of added inorganic nitrogen  on the total
            nitrogen in clover plants,  the proportion supplied
            by the fertilizer and that  fixed by  the  rhizobium
            organizations associated with the  clover roots.
            Increasing the rate of nitrogen application de-
            creased the amount of nitrogen fixed by  the organ-
            isms in this greenhouse experiment (Walker, 1956).
            Reprinted by permission of  the author.
                                   159

-------
6.1.2.1.3    Nitrification.    The  process   of  nitrification  involves  the
conversion of NH^ to NC>2~ by  Nitrosomonas  and  the  conversion  of N02~ to
NC>3~ by Nitrobacter  via  reactions that occur in rapid sequence and preclude
any  great accumulation  of  N03~.   These  nitrifying  organisms  are  auto-
trophic (obtaining energy  from oxidation or inorganic NH^"*" or N02~) in con-
trast  to  the heterotrophic organisms  involved in  the  mineralization proc-
ess.  These  organisms are  strictly aerobic  and can not survive in  saturated
soils.    The optimum  temperature  for  nitrification is  in  the  range  of
30-36°C (Downing  et al.,  1964).   Maximum oxidation  rates  for Nitrosomonas
are found  at pH  8.5-9.0 (Downing  et  al.,  1964)  and at pH  8.9  for Nitro-
bacter (Lees, 1951).   The activity of these bacteria  may  cease altogether
where  the  pH is  4.0-4.5 or  below.   Nitrification occurs  at  a  very rapid
rate under conditions  ideal  for  microbial  growth.   Daily  rates  of 7-12 kg
N/ha have been  found when  110 kg  ammonium  nitrate/ha were added (Broadbent
et al., 1957).

     The  nitrification  curves  for  most  soils are  sigmoid-like curves when
N03~ production is plotted against time.   A  typical nitrification pattern
is  shown   in Fig.  6.5.    The  NI^-N  concentration  decreases  sigmoidally
until it disappears.  The  N02~~ and NOj" concentrations   start  rising  from
the first day,  but by  the  fourth day,  the  concentration  of  NC^-N more
than  doubles that  of the  N03~N.   A  steady  state  is  reached  after  the
seventh day  when  the N02~N  concentration  approaches  zero  and  the
approaches total  nitrogen.
6.1.2.1.4  Plant Uptake.   Crop  uptake of N by harvestable crops  constitutes
a significant removal  of N.   Table  6.8 lists the N uptake for various  crops
in kg/ha.  Nitrogen is returned to  the  soil by  crop  residues (Table  6.9).
The  fraction  of total  N03~ in  the  soil  that  is assimilated  by the  roots
of growing plants  varies depending  on the depth  and  distribution of  root-
ing,  nitrogen  loading  rate,  moisture movement  through  the  root zone,  and
species  of plant.   In  general,  the  efficiency  of uptake is  not high,  and
grasses  tend  to be more efficient  than row  crops.   Excess  available N  in
the  soil does  not  cause  phytotoxicity,  yet  corn  silage and  other  grass
forages  that  contain   greater  than  0.25%  N03~N may  cause  animal   health
problems (Walsh et  al.,  1976).
                                     160

-------
    20
§   16
I   12
8
O    o
u


£
00
\ NO2-N




        Organic-N
                          345


                          Time (days)
        Figure 6.5.  Typical sigmoid pattern of nitrification

                     in soil (De Marco et al.,  1967).

                     Reprinted by permission of the American

                     Water Works Association.
                               161

-------
TABLE 6.8  REMOVAL OF NITROGEN FROM SOILS BY CROPS AND RESIDUES*^


                                      Annual Crop Yield     Nitrogen Uptake
     Crop                             (metric/tons/ha)         (kg/ha/yr)

Corn (Zea mays)                              9.4                 207
Soybeans (Glycine max)                       3.4                 288*
Grain sorghum (Sorghum bicolor)              9                   280

Peanuts (Archis hypogaea)                    2.8                 105
Cottonseed (Gossypium hirsutum)              2                    69
Wheat (Triticum aestivum)                    4.3                 140

Rice (Oryza sativa)                          6.7                  87
Oats (Arena sativa)                          3.6                 168
Barley (Hordeurn vulgare)                     5.4                 168

Corn silage (Zea mays)                      71.7                 224
Sugarbeets (Beta vulgaris)                  56                    24
Alfalfa (Medicago sativa)                   17.9                 504#

Alfalfa hay (Medicago sativa)               15.7                 372
Coastal bermuda hay                         21.3                 272
 (Cynodon dactylon)
Orchard grass (Dactylis glomerata)          13.4                 336

Bromegrass (Bromus sp.)                     11.2                 186
Tall fescue (Festuca arundinacea)            7.8                 151
Reed canary grass                           13.4                 493
 (Phalaria arundinacea)

Reed canary grass hay                       15.7                 189
 (Fhalaris arundinacea)
Bluegrass (Poa sp.)                          6.7                 224
Tomatoes (Lycopersicon esculentum)          44.8                  80

Lettuce (Lactuca sativa)                    28                    38
Carrots (Daucus carota)                     44.8                  65
Loblolly pine (Pimis taeda)             annual growth             10

* Hart (1974).

t Where only grain is removed, a significant proportion of  the  nutrients
  is left in the residues.
* While legumes can get most of their N from the air, if mineral nitrogen
  is available in the soil, legumes will use it at the expense  of fixing  N
  from the air.
                                     162

-------
 TABLE 6.9  THE NITROGEN RETURNED TO THE SOIL FROM  UNHARVESTED  OR UNGRAZED
            PARTS OF STUBBLE ABOVE THE GROUND*
                                           Nitrogen Returned  to  Soil
             Crop                                (kg/metric  ton)

        Corn (Zea mays)                                9

        Wheat (Triticum aestlvum)                      7

        Rye (Secale cereale)                           7

        Oats (Avena sativa)                            6

        Alfalfa (Medicago sativa)                     24


* McCalla  and  Army (1961).
 6.1.2.1.5    Denitrification.     The  microbial  process  whereby  N03~  is
 reduced  to  gaseous N compounds  such as nitrous  oxide  and elemental nitro-
 gen  is  termed denitrification.  This  reaction is facilitated by heterotro-
 phic, facultative  anaerobic bacteria living mainly in soil micropores where
 oxygen  is limited.  As a waste  is  applied on land,  the  rate and extent of
 denitrification is  likely  to be  governed by the organic  matter content,
 water content,  soil type, pH, and  temperature of the soil.   The degree of
 water saturation has a profound influence on the  rate  of denitrification.
 The  critical  moisture level is  about  60% of  the water  holding capacity of
 the  soil, below which practically no denitrification occurs, and above this
 level denitrification increases  rapidly with  increases in moisture content.
 The  amount  of N lost through denitrification  as a function of water  content
 (described  as percentage of  the water holding  capacity)  is illustrated in
 Fig. 6.6  (Bremner  and Shaw,  1958).

     The  rate of  denitrification  is  also greatly affected  by  the  pH and
 temperature of  the soil.    It  tends to be  very slow at pH below 5.0.   The
 rate increases  with increasing soil pH and Is very rapid  at pH 8-8.5.  The
 optimum  temperature for denitrification  is about 25°C.    The rate of deni-
 trification increases rapidly when  the temperature  is  increaed  from 2° to
 25°C.   Figure 6.7  illustrates the  effect  of  temperature  on N lost  as gas
 over time.

     Organic  matter content also affects  the  amount  and rate of denitrifi-
 cation.      Denitrification   of  N03~   by   heterotrophic  organisms  cannot
occur unless  the  substrate  contains  an  organic compound that  can  support
 the growth of the  organisms.   The  rate of denitrification for these materi-
als  varies  with their  resistance  to  decomposition by  soil  microorganisms
 (Table  6.10).   The  rate  is  most  rapid  with  cellulose  and  slowest  with
lignin and sawdust.
                                     163

-------
d?40
                                        10          14
                                      TIME (Days)
(8   20 21
Figure 6.6.   Effect of  soil water content on denitrification.  5 g.  samples
             of  soil 4  in 300 ml. Kjeldahi flasks were incubated at 25°  C.
             with 5 rag. N03~N (as KNO3> and 15 mg. C (as glucose) dissolved
             in  different volumes of water.  Water content of  soil  is
             expressed  on each graph as percentage of waterholding  capacity
             of  soil (Bremner and Shaw, 1958). Reprinted by permission of
             the Journal of Agricultural Science.

-------
100
                                16
                        TIME (Days)
   Figure 6.7. Effect of temperature on denitrification.
              5 g. samples of soil were incubated at
              various temperatures with 11 ml. water
              containing 5 mg. 1103.N (as KKO^) and 15
              mg.  C  (soil 1) or 25 mg. C (soil 6) as
              glucose (Brenner and Shaw, 1958).
              Reprinted by permission of the Journal
              of  Agricultural Science.
                            165

-------
TABLE 6.10   PERCENTAGE  OF  ADDED  NITROGEN LOST DURING INCUBATION OF WATER-
             LOGGED  SOIL WITH NITRATE AND DIFFERENT AMOUNTS OF ORGANIC
             MATERIALS AT 25°C*
Organic
Materials
Added
Lignin
Sawdust
Grass
Straw
Cellulose


4*
2
5
6
7
5

50 mg
12*
3
7
8
10
29

added
20*
6
8
11
12
83
N
Lost
(% of
100 mg
30*
8
9
13
14
90
4*
5
6
14
16
5
12*
6
9
27
28
37
added
added
20*
8
10
30
33
87
N03-N)
200 mg
30*
11
12
36
37
91
4*
7
9
27
20
5
12*
7
11
37
44
39
added
20*
9
16
49
56
88

30*
15
18
60
84
90
* Bremtier and Shaw  (1958).
* Length of incubation  period  in  days.
     Denitrif ication  can  be  a major source  of  N removal from  an HWLT unit
containing  a high  inorganic nitrogenous  waste or  an  organic  nitrogenous
waste  that  has  been mineralized.   Under the optimum  conditions  of neutral
to  alkaline pH,  high soil  water  or  small  pores filled  with water,  warm
temperatures,  and  the presence of   easily  decomposable  organic  matter,
almost  90%  of  the  N03~N  in  the  waste  can  be  converted  to  gaseous  N and
lost from the system  (Bremner and Shaw,  1958).
6.1.2.1.6  Volatilization.  Another  mechanism for N loss is volatilization.
Ammonium salts such as  (NH^)£C03   can  be  converted   to   gaseous  ammonia
      4- t^COj) when sludge  is  surface applied to coarsely textured alkaline
soils.   The  magnitude  of such losses  is highly variable,  depending on the
rate of waste application,  clay  content  of  the soil, soil pH, temperature,.
and  climatic conditions.    In  a greenhouse  study,  Mills  et  al.  (1974)
reported that when pH values  were above  7.2,  at least half of the N applied
to a fine  sandy loam was volatilized  as  NHg,  generally  within  two days of
the application.   In a  laboratory study,  Ryan and Keeney  (1975) reported
NHj volatilization  from a  surface  applied   wastewater   sludge  containing
950 mg/1 of  ammonium-nitrogen.   Volatilization values ranged from 11 to 60%
of the  applied  NI^-N.   The  greatest  losses   occurred  in low  clay content
soils with the  highest  application rate. Incorporating  the sludge into the
soil decreases  volatilization losses.
6.1.2.1.1  Storage in  Soil.   Both the organic  and  inorganic soil fractions
have  the ability  to  fix NH^"*" in  forms  unavailable  to  plants  or  even
microorganisms.    Clay  minerals  with  a  2:1  type  structure  have  this
capacity, with clays of the  vermicullte  group having the greatest capacity,
                                     166

-------
followed by illite  and  montmorillonite.  Ammonium ions  fixed  into  the cry-
stal lattice of the clay do  not  exchange  readily with other cations and are
not  accessible to  nitrifying bacteria  (Nommik,  1965).   The quantity  of
NH4+ fixed  depends on  the  kind  and amount  of  clay  present.    Figure 6.8
illustrates the  amount of  NH^"*" fixed  by three  soils  receiving five con-
secutive  applications  of  a  100  mg/1  solution of  NH4+-N.    The  Aiken
clay,  primarily  kaolinite,  fixed  no  NH^  and  the Columbia  and  Sacra-
mento  soils containing vermiculite and  montmorillonite  were  capable  of
     fixation  (Broadbent et  al.,  1957).
     Like  other  cations  in  the  waste,  Nfy"1"  can  be  adsorbed  onto  the
negatively charged  clay  and organic matter colloids  in  soil.   Retention in
this  exchangeable form  is temporary,  and NIty"1" may  become  nitrified  when
oxygen and nitrifying bacteria are  available.


6.1.2.1.8   Immobilization.  The  process of immobilization  is the opposite
of mineralization;  it  is the  process  by which inorganic N  is converted to
an unavailable  organic  form.   This  requires  an  energy source  for  micro-
organisms  such  as  decomposable organic matter with a carbon to N ratio
greater  than 30  to  1.   This  condition may exist with certain industrial
wastes or  cannery wastes  and  some crop residues, straws or  pine needles.
In a  study  of  immobilization  of  fertilizer N, only  2.1 kg/ha was immobil-
ized during  the first 47 days  after fertilization with  328  kg/ha.  As soil
temperature  increased  above 22°C,  the  rate  increased to an  additional 60
kg/ha immobilized by day 107 (Kissel  et al., 1977).


6.1.2.1.9   Runoff.   At  an HWLT  unit  containing  a  nitrogenous  waste, the
runoff water may remove a significant  amount of  N, potentially polluting
adjacent waterways.  However  t a  well  designed  and managed  disposal  site
should have  minimum runoff  since  waste application  rates  would not exceed
soil  infiltration capacity.  Though surface runoff from HWLT units  is  col-
lected,  it may  be important to keep the runoff water of high  quality if the
facility has a discharge  permit.   Soil and cropping management  practices,
rate  of.  waste  application, and  the time  and  method  of  application  control
the amount  of  runoff.    Of  these factors,  a highly significant  correlation
between  N  loading rate  and its average concentration in  runoff water was
shown in a  linear regression  analysis  (Khaleel  et al.,  1980).  Application
of waste during winter  and on the  surface results In less  rapid  decomposi-
tion  and high  concentrations  of  N In runoff  water.   Reincorporation  of
plant material  into the soil  decreases N concentrations  in runoff  by  one-
third over  areas  where  all  plant  residues are  removed  at  harvest (Zwerman
et al. ,  1974).  Table 6.11 provides a summary of  N concentrations in runoff
from areas receiving animal waste.
                                     167

-------
                 NUMBER OF APPLICATIONS
Figure 6.8. Clay-fixed Nfi£ in three soils resulting from
            five applications of a solution containing
            100 mg/1 NHj-N, without intervening drying
            (Broadbent, 1976). Reprinted by permission of
            the Division of Agricultural Sciences, Univer-
            sity of California.
                        168

-------
 TABLE 6.11   TRANSPORT OF TOTAL NITROGEN IN RUNOFF WATER FROM PLOTS
             RECEIVING ANIMAL WASTE*
Location
Wisconsin
Alabama
Type of
Manure
Fresh dairy
liquid
Liquid dairy
Total N
Applied
120
95
5661
Total N
Runoff
12.7
3.6
13.8
Remarks
8 Plots, 10-
17% slope,
silt loam
12 Plots, 3.3%
Reference
Minshall et
al, (1970)
McCaskey et
             Dry dairy



N. Carolina  Swine
              lagoon

              effluent

New York     Dairy
                              3774
                              1782
                              7769
                              5179
                              2590

                              1344
                          al. (1971)
18.3
17.7
 7.5

23.4
                               478
18.4
9 Plots, 1-3%
slope,  sandy
loam, coastal
berrauda

24 Plots corn,
continuous
study
Khaleel et
al. (1980)
Klausner et
al. (1976)
* Total N » organic N+Nlfy-N + N03-N in  ppm.
6.1.2.1.10   Leaching.   Of all the losses of N  from an HWLT unit,  leaching
is  the  potentially  most serious.   Groundwater can become contaminated, and
drinking water  containing greater than  10  mg/1 nitrate-nitrogen may cause
human health problems.   Not  only  should high concentrations of N in  leach-
ate be  avoided, but also  large amounts  of leachate with a low concentration
of  N.   Methemoglobinemia, a reduction in  the  oxygen-carrying  capacity of
the blood,  can  develop  in infants when nitrate-nitrogen levels in  drinking
water are greater than  10 ppm (or greater than  45 ppm  nitrate).

     Most studies of N  leachate  agree that the  amount of  N in percolating
water  is site-dependent  and difficult to  extrapolate from  one  site to
another.    Parameters  that  have  the most  direct effect  on N  content in
leachate are N  application rate,  cropping  system, soil water content,  soil
texture, and climate.   A number  of  these  parameters  can  be controlled or
modified by  management  practices.

     A  study by Bielby  et al. (1973) investigates the quantity and concen-
tration of   N03~"  in percolates  from lysimeters  receiving  liquid  poultry
manure  over  three years.  Nitrogen removal by corn (Zea mays), plus that in
the leachate, accounts  for less than 25% of the amount applied to the soil.
The  average  concentration  of  N03~ in percolates   from   all  treatments
exceeded the drinking water  standard (10 ppm).
                                    169

-------
 6.1.2.2   Phosphorus  (P)
     Phosphorus  is a key  eutrophication element and may  be transported In
such  forms as adsorbed  phosphate and  soluble phosphate  by surface runoff
and  groundwater,  respectively.   Enrichment  of  lake  waters  and  sediments
with  high  P  concentrations  may  create  a   potential  for water  quality
impairment  and eventual  extinction  of  aquatic  life in  a  lake  or stream.
The  critical  level above  which eutrophication  may occur has been  set at
0.01 mg/1  of P.   This  level may be exceeded when surface  runoff  levels are
greater  than   10  kg/ha/yr  (Vollenweider,  1968).   Runoff  P concentrations
from well-managed agricultural lands  are typically less  than  0.1 kg/ha/yr
(Khaleel  et  al., 1980).    Municipal  wastewaters  generally  have  total  P
concentrations  ranging  from  1.0  to  40 mg/1  (Hunter  and Kotalik,   1976;
Bouwer  and Chaney, 1974;  Pound  and  Curtis, 1973),  while  concentrations of
less than  20 mg/1 are average  (Ryden  and Pratt,  1980).

     Phosphorus  concentrations in waste  streams  that range from  0.01 to 50
mg/1 P  pose little runoff  or  leachate  hazard.   However,  P concentrations
found in waste from rock phosphate  quarries,  fertilizers and pesticides are
high  enough  to   potentially  contaminate  runoff water  or  leach  into the
groundwater  beneath  a  soil  with  low  P  retention capacity.    Once the
waste-soil  parameters  of  P are  adequately assessed,  land treatment  of  P
laden  hazardous   wastes  may be  managed  to successfully  reduce  soluble  P
concentrations to the levels usually  found  in soil.

     The  soluble P concentration in  the unsaturated  zone of normal   soil
ranges between 3  and 0.03 mg/1 (Russel,  1973),  where the  lower value  is at
the  normal level of   groundwater  (Reddy et  al.,   1979).    Barber  et al.
(1963) report  that this  value  generally decreases  with depth in the   soil
profile.   Surface soil  layers  tend to have a  greater P  adsorption capacity
than lower  levels of the profile  (Fig.  6.9).

     Decomposition of  organic  wastes  and dissolution of  inorganic fertil-
izers provide  a  variety  of organic and  soluble  forms  of P  in  soil.    Phos-
phorus  may be present  in such forms  as soluble  orthophosphate,  condensed
phosphate,  tripolyphosphate, adsorbed phosphate  or  crystallized  phosphate,
thus, reflecting  the  chemical  composition of  the  source  and its  phosphorus
content.   Hydrolysis  and mineralization convert most of  the  condensed and
polyphosphate  forms to the  soluble  phosphate  ion which  is readily available
to  plants  and  soil  microorganisms.     Hence,   soluble   orthophosphate is
released from organic wastes and  soil  humus through weathering and mineral-
ization.   On  the  other  hand,  it  is  expected   that  organic compounds resis-
tant to  decomposition  will immobilize  P, especially when the carbon:phos-
phorus ratio exceeds 300:1.

     Given  sufficient time, net mineralization  will release P from organic
substrates  and this  solubilized  P  generally may  be  used  as a nutrient
source  by  microbial populations  degrading other  carbonaceous  substrates.
Degradation of organic P compounds accounts for  only 10-15% of the removal
                                     170

-------
                 P205  IN mg/IOOg SOIL
             100      200      300       400
500
10
20
§ 30
Z 40
H 50
Q.
Q 60
70
80
on
•
-
j |J
i
i
i
i
i
















	 NON- FLOODED SOIL
	 FLOODED SOIL






Figure  6.9.  Phosphate distribution with depth in non-
            flooded  soil and soil flooded with sewage
            water (Beek and de Haan,  1973). Reprinted
            by permission of the Canadian Society of
            Soil Science.
                     171

-------
efficiency; however,  microbes appear  to  be  highly efficient  in mobilizing
the  natural  P reservoir  in  soil.    Phosphorus  concentrations  in  soil  in
quantities greater  than  the  nutrient requirements for  growth  and  substrate
decomposition will  be attenuated  on  the  adsortion  sites in the soil profile
or  reduced by  dilution  in  the  groundwater.    Given  sufficient  retention
time, P  will  precipitate  as  iron,  aluminum  or  calcium  phosphate (Ballard
and Fiskell, 1974).  The iron and  aluminum oxides  and hydrous  oxides (e.g.,
hematite and gibbsite) are of primary importance  since they have  extremely
high absorptive capacities (Ryden  and Pratt,  1980).

     Retention  efficiency  of  the  soil  for  P is  related  to  the   soil  pH,
cation exchange capacity,  clay content and mineralogical  composition.   The
equilibrium  time  for  soil-phosphorus  interactions  is  influenced by  the
retention  time of the waste  in soil, which is dependent  on the soil infil-
tration  capacity and permeability.   The  presence of  organic anions and high
pH will  tend to decrease  P sorption  (Ryden  and  Syers  1975).   Subbarao and
Ellis (1977)  and  John  (1974)  report precipitation  of  calcium phosphates
following  liming usually control  the solubility  of P in acidic soils.

     Phosphorus released from point  sources  will move radially by diffusion
(Sawhney and Hill,  1975),  thus  increasing the  P  adsorption capacity through
additional underground  travel distance.   Retention  time may  be positively
influenced when  waste leachate is  slowed by the increased  tortuosity  or
some relatively impermeable  layer.   If  insufficient soil  volume  is avail-
able above the water  table,  the equilibration time  in shallow soil can be
drastically reduced and penetration  to groundwater is likely to occur.

     Phosphorus  supplied  in waste  applications  augmented over   time  may
saturate the P adsorption  capacity of the soil,  thus creating  the potential
for  extreme discharges  to the  groundwater.    Adriano et al.  (1975) showed
evidence of perched water table  contamination by P  from daily application
of  food  processing  waste  in  quantities  that exceed  the  adsorption maxima.
Lund et  al. (1976)  observed  that  coarsely textured  soil  is enriched with P
to  a depth of  3  meters  below sewage  disposal  ponds.   Since soil  has a
finite  capacity  to  fix P, attention  should be  directed  to  the   long-term
effect of  waste applications  containing  P on the adsorption mechanisms.

     The Langmuir isotherm has  been  used to  estimate the P adsorption maxi-
mum  of  several  soils (Table  6.12).   To  prepare a Langmuir isotherm test,
standard amounts  of soil  are  shaken wich  a known  concentration  of KH2P04
over a  dilution  range  of 0  to  100 mg/1 of  P.   When  the mass   of  the P
adsorbed per gram of  soil is  linear with the equilibrium concentration of
the  P remaining  in solution,  the sorption  maximum can  be calculated from
the  slope.  The Langmuir equation  is:
                         C/b  = C/Dmax + U/Kbnax)                      (6.1)

where
        C « equilibrium  P  concentration (Vg/ml);
        b » P adsorbed on  soil surface (yg/g soil);
            adsorption maximum of  the soil (Vg/g soil); and
        K - constant  related  to the bonding energy.

                                      172

-------
The  Langmulr  adsorption maximum  must  be  evaluated  with the  mineralogy,
since P retention is known to improve when aluminum and iron are present in
the soil.  Successive P  sorptions (Fig. 6.10) have been  found  to decrease
the  P  sorption capacities  of the soil (Sawhney and  Hill,  1975).   After
wetting and drying treatments, the P sorption capacity may be reestablished
in some  soils  such as the Merrimac  sandy  loam.   In the  Buxton  silty clay
loam the P sorption capacity  was  only  partially  reestablished.   Thus, P in
waste  leachate  in quantities  that exceed the  adsorption capacity  can be
expected to pass through the profile to groundwater.
TABLE 6.12  SUMMARY OF PHOSPHORUS ADSORPTION VALUES*
Compound
Location
Michigan
Florida
New Brunswick
No. of
Soil Samples
29-100
6
24
Notes
Average for 1 m depth
Average for 50 cm depth
Soils from upper B
Sorption Capacity
or b max.
mgP/100 g soil
1.81-49.0
nil - 28.0
227-1760
New Jersey

Maine
New York
Wisconsin
 17

 3
 2

 5

 31

240
  horizon

A, B and C horizons

From column tests
Average for 31 soils

A, B and C horizons
  and deeper

A, B and C horizons
0.165-355
  26-71
13.3-25.9
3.8-51.0
  12.0
 0.3-278

 2.5-20
* Tofflemire and Chen  (1977),
     Harvested  forage  crops  may be used to remove as  much as 50 to 60%  of
the  P  applied  (Russel,  1973),  however, annually  harvested crops  normally
remove  less  than 10% of the annual  P  application (Ryden and Pratt,  1980).
Furthermore, as the  application of P increases,  crop removal of  the element
decreases  (Ryden and Pratt, 1980).   Maximum  crop  removal is dependent  on
crops  having a  large  rooting  mass  such as various  grasses (Table  6.13).
Moreover,  studies have  shown that P  is  the  most  limiting  plant nutrient for
production of  legumes (Vallentine,  1971; Brady, 1974; Heath et  al.,  1978;
Chessmore,  1979).    A  grass-legume  mixture with legume species  dominating
may  be a  viable alternative to enhance P uptake in  many land  treatment
units.  Various herbaceous species may be clipped either  two or  three times
a year, thus allowing  significantly  greater P  removal.
                                     173

-------
Figure 6.10.  General Langmuir isotherms of Merrimac
             sandy loam and Buxton silt loam after
             successive P sorptions and following
             wetting and drying treatments for regen-
             eration of P sorption sites (Sawhney and
             Hill, 1975).  Reprinted by permission of
             the American Society of Agronomy, Inc.
                        174

-------
TABLE 6.13  REMOVAL OF PHOSPHORUS BY THE USUAL HARVESTED PORTION OF
            SELECTED CROPS
Crop Annual Crop Yield
(Metric tons /ha)
Corn (Zea mays)
Cotton (Gossypium hirsutum)
Lint and seed
Wheat (Triticum aestivum)
Rice (Oryza sativa)
Soybeans (Glycine max)
Grapes (Vitus sp.)
Tomatoes (Lycopersicon esculent urn)
Cabbage (Brassica oleracea)
Oranges (Citrus sp.)
Small grain, corn-hay
rotation
Reed canary grass
(Phalaris arundinacea)
Corn silage (Zea mays)
Poplar trees (Populus sp.)
Barley (Hordeum vulgare)-
sudan grass (Sorghum sudanense )
rotation for forages*
Johnson grass (Sorghum halepense)
Guinea grass (Pan! cum maximum)
Tall fescue (Festuca arundinacea)
11
A.I
5.2
7.8
3.0
27
90
78
60
	
	
— .

27
26
7.8
Phosphorus Uptake
(kg/ha/yr)
35
19
22
22
25
11
34
18
11
32
45
30-40
26-69
84-95
94
50
32
  Unpublished data for barley in the winter  followed  by Sudan grass  in the
  summer.  P.F. Pratt and S. Davis, University  of  California, and USDA-ARS,
  Riverside, California.
                                     175

-------
     Application  of P  from wastewater  may  be  described  as  either  a  low
application rate  system,  usually less than  10 mg/1  or a high rate applica-
tion  system,  consisting of  greater than  10 mg/1 (Ryden  and  Pratt,   1980).
Low rate  systems  use crop uptake  as  a sink for both  the  P and wastewaters
applied.   The  P rates  applied and  the crop yields  are  comparable to  those
attained  under good agronomic management  of intensive  cropland.   Movement
of P in this type  of system is generally  very  slow  since  the  P is retained
near  the   zone  of  incorporation.    The essential  features of  a  low  rate
system  are removal  of  a large  amount of  P by  a  forage   crop,  control of
surface runoff  to prevent erosion,  and  reduction of  P  concentrations  to  a
desirable  level  by using   a  long  pathway  of  highly  sorptive  materials
between the soil  surface and the  discharge point of  water into  surface or
groundwaters (Ryden  and  Pratt,  1980).

     High-rate  wastewater treatment  systems usually  have large  quantities
of water  moving through  the  soil  profile  and  the  quantities  of  P applied
are higher than those normally  used on intensively farmed  croplands.   Thus,
this system usually requires coarse gravelly  soils  which  can maintain high
infiltration rates  (Ryden and  Pratt, 1980).  Generally, a cycle of flooding
and drying is  used  to  maintain the  infiltration  capacity  of the system and
increase  the   P  sorption  capacity by  enhancing  the  oxidation-reduction
cycle.  Soils  with  a high  sand or  organic content  that  have  low contents
of iron and aluminum hydrous oxides associated with a low surface area are
most likely to  have  the  greatest leaching  of  P  (Syers and Williams,  1977).
Ryden and  Pratt (1980) report  P removal by harvested  crops, in a high rate
system, to be  insignificant  unless P concentrations are less than  1 mg/1.


6.1.2.3  Boron  (B)
     The  B  concentration in  rocks  varies from  10 ppm in  igneous rocks  to
100  ppm in  sandstones.    The average  soil  concentration of  B  is  10  ppm
(Bowen, 1966).   High levels  of B are  most  likely  to  occur in soil  derived
from marine sediments and  arid soils.   In  most  humid region  soils,  B  is
bound  in  the  form  of  tourmaline,  a  borosilicate that   releases  B  quite
slowly.  Most of  the  available  soil B is held by  the organic fraction  where
it is  tightly retained.   Boron  is  released as the organics decompose and  is
quite  subject to  leaching losses.   Some  B is adsorbed by  iron and aluminum
hydroxy compounds and clay minerals.   Finer textured  soils  retain  added  B
longer  than do  coarse, sandy soils.    Therefore,  less B can  be   applied  to
sandy  soil  than to  fine-textured  soil  (Tisdale and Nelson,  1975).    Boron
sorption  by clay minerals  and  iron  and aluminum oxides  is  pH  dependent,
with maximum sorption  in  the  pH  range 7-9.    The  amount  of  B adsorbed
depends on  the  surface area of  the clay  or  oxide  and  this sorption  is only
partially reversible, indicating  the  retention is by covalent bonding.

     Boron  is  frequently  deficient  in  acid  soils,   light-textured  sandy
soils, alkaline soils, and  soils  low in organic matter.  Boron availability
to plants  is decreased   by  liming, but  the  increase of  pH alone  is  not
sufficient  to  decrease  B  absorption.   Fox  (1968)  found that  both  high

                                     176

-------
levels of calcium and high pH values  reduced B uptake by cotton  by nearly
50%, but that high calcium concentrations or high pH studied separately had
little influence on reducing B uptake.

     Boron in plants is  involved  in protein synthesis,  nitrogen and carbo-
hydrate metabolism, root system development,  fruit  and  seed formation,  and
the regulation of plant  water  relations  (Brady, 1974).   The  symptoms  of  B
deficiency vary somewhat from one plant species to another.   Symptoms often
include dieback,  chlorotic  spotting of  leaves and necrosis  in fruits  and
roots (Bradford, 1966).

     The difference between  the  amount of  B  which  results  in deficiencies
and that which is toxic is very small.  Boron-sensitive plants can tolerate
between 0.5  and  1.0 ppm available B  in soils  while  boron-tolerant plants
usually show toxiclty  symptoms at  10 ppm  B  (Bingham,  1973).   Table 6.14
shows the  tolerance limits  of several plant  species  to boron.   The first
symptoms of  B  injury  are generally leaf-tip  yellowing,  followed  by a pro-
gressive necrosis of the leaf.  Leaching of B below the root  zone is recom-
mended in  the  case of moderate toxicity.   Moderate liming of  the  soil or
liberal application of nitrogen  fertilizers may be  beneficial  (Bradford,
1966).

     If B  can be  leached  from the  soil at  concentrations acceptable for
groundwater  discharge,  B may  be applied  continously in small amounts as
long as it  does  not accumulate to toxic levels.   No drinking water  stand-
ard  has  been  set  for human  consumption;   however,  water  used for  cattle
should contain less than 5 ppm B.
6.1.2.4  Sulfur  (S)
     The earth's  crust  contains  about 600 ppm S and soils have an average S
 content of  700 ppm (Tisdale  and  Nelson,  1975).  Since S is a constituent of
 some amino  acids,  it  is an important plant nutrient.  The widespread occur-
 rence  of  S  in  nature  ensures  that  it  will be  a common  industrial  waste
 product.  Wastes  from kraft mills,  sugar  refining,  petroleum refining,  and
 copper  and  iron extraction  all  contain  appreciable amounts  of  S (Overcash
 and Pal, 1979).

     Because of its anionic  nature and the solubility of most of its salts,
 leaching losses  of S can be quite  large.   Leaching is  greatest  when mono-
 valent  cations such as  potassium and sodium predominate and moderate leach-
 ing  occurs  where  calcium and  magnesium  predominate.   When  the soil  is
 acidic  and  appreciable  levels of exchangeable iron and  aluminum are pres-
 ent, S  leaching losses  are minimal (Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).

     Land application sites  where wastes  containing  large amounts of S are
 disposed  must be  well  drained.    The hydrogen  sulfide formed  in reducing
 conditions  is toxic  and has an  unpleasant  odor.   Since acid is  formed by
 oxidation  of S compounds, the  pH of  the  site must be monitored and regu-
 lated.   In  the  soil under  aerobic  conditions,  bacteria  oxidize  the more

                                     177

-------
     TABLE 6.14   CROP  TOLERANCE  LIMITS  FOR BORON IN SATURATION  EXTRACTS  OF  SOIL*1
     Tolerant
                                 Semltolerant
                                     Sensitive
     4.0 ppm B
                                 2.0 ppm B
                                     1.0 ppm B
oo
Athel (Tamarix aphylla)
Asparagus officinalis
Palm (Phoenix canariensis)
Date palm (P7 dactylifera)
Sugarbeet (Beta vulgaris)
Mangel (Beta vulgaris)
Garden beet (Beta vulgaris)
Alfalfa (Medicago sativa)
Gladiolus (Gladiolus sp.)
Broadbean (Vicia faba)
Onion (Allium cepa)
Turnip (Brassica rapa)
Cabbage (Brassica oleracea
 var. capitata)
Lettuce (Lactuca sativa)
Carrot (Daucus carota)
Sunflower (Hellanthus annus)
Potato (Solanum tuberosum)
Cotton, Acala and Pima
 (Gossypium sp.)
Tomato (Lycopersicon esculentum)
Sweetpea (Lathyrus odoratus)
Radish (Raphanus sativus)
Field pea (Pisum sativum)
Ragged-robin rose (Rosa sp.)
Olive (Plea europaea)
Barley (Hordeum vulgare)
Wheat (Triticum aestivum)
Corn (Zea mays)
Milo (Sorghum bicolor)
Oat (Avena sativa)
Zinnia (Zinnia elegans)
Pumpkin (Cucurbita spp.)
Bell Pepper (Capsicum annuum)
Sweet potato (Ipomoea batatas)
Lima bean (Phaseolus lunatus)
Pecan (Garya illnoensis)
Walnut, Black and Persian, or
 English (Juglans spp.)
Jerusalem artichoke
 (Hellanthus tuberosus)
Navy bean (Phaseolus vulgaris)
American elm (Ulmus americana)
Plum (Prunus domestica)
Pear (Pyrus communis)
Apple (Malus sylvestris)
Grape, Sultanina and Malaga
 (Vitus sp.)
Kodata fig (Ficus carica)
Persimmon (Diospyros virginiana)
Cherry (Prunus sp.)
Peach (Prunus persica)
Apricot (Prunus armeniaca)
Thornless blackberry (Rubus sp.)
Orange (Citrus sinensis)
Avocado (Persea americana)
Grapefruit (Citrus paradisi)
Lemon (Citris limon)
     2.0  ppm B
* Bresler et al.
                                  1.0 ppm B
                                     0.3 ppm B
                       (1982).
      t For  each group,  tolerant,  semitolerant ,  and sensitive,  the range of tolerable boron is indicated;
      tolerance  decreases  in descending order in each column.

-------
reduced forms of S  to  form sulfate which will decrease the pH.   In water-
logged  soils,  anaerobic  bacteria reduce  sulfides,  generating  hydrogen
sulfide.

     Some soils have the capacity of retain sulfates  in  an  adsorbed form.
At a given pH, adsorption  is least when  the  cation  adsorbed  on the clay is
potassium, moderate when the adsorbed  cation is  calcium,  and greatest when
the adsorbed cation is aluminum  (Tisdale and Nelson,  1975).   Adsorption by
clay minerals is ranked as kaolinlte
-------
mixed  with the soil,  then the  acidic  waste can  be  applied.   This  method
will prevent  the  solubilization and leaching of metals  in  the  soil.   Addi-
tion of acids  and bases  to the  soil can increase the  concentration of solu-
ble  salts in  the system.   For  a discussion  of  salts,  refer  to  Section
6.1.4.  Management  of  soil pH is discussed in Section 8.6.
6.1.4                               Salts
     By definition,  a salt is any substance  that  yields  ions upon dissolu-
tion other than hydrogen  ions or  hydroxyl ions.   For all practical purposes
in  agriculture and  land  treatment,  this definition  has been  narrowed to
include only  the  major dissolved solids  in  natural waters and  soils.   The
principal  ions involved are  calcium,  magnesium,  sodium,  potassium,  chlor-
ide, sulfate,  bicarbonate and occasionally nitrate.   Salts  occur naturally
in  many  soils and are  a  common  constituent  of  hazardous  and nonhazardous
wastes.   Salt inputs  to  the soil may occur from fertilizer applications,
precipitation, and  irrigation.  Typical  irrigation  practices may result in
annual salt applications  to  soil  which exceed 4000 kg/ha.  Table 6.15 lists
the salinity  classes  of water.

     The behavior of  salts  in soil and their influence  on plant growth has
been studied  by agricultural scientists for  many  years  and is  still the
topic  of  extensive  research.  The  U.S. Salinity Laboratory  Staff  (USDA,
1954)  and Bresler  et  al.  (1982) have  reviewed  various  aspects of  soil
salinity,  including  diagnosis  and  management   of  salt  affected  soils.
Salinity problems may result from the bulk osmotic  effects  of salts  on the
soil-plant system  and the individual  effects of  specific  ions, especially
sodium.
6.1.4.1  Salinity
     The concentration  of  salt  in water can be expressed  in terms of elec-
trical  conductivity  (EC),  total  dissolved  solids (TDS),  osmotic pressure,
percent salt by weight,  and  normality.   Electrical conductivity in mmhos/cm
is the  preferred  measurement for solutions of  common  salts or combinations
of salts.   The following  factors are  useful  for obtaining  an approximate
conversion of units.

             (0.35) x (EC mmhos/cm)  s Osmotic  pressure in bars
             (651) x (EC mmhos/cm) - TDS mg/1
             (10) x (EC  mmhos/cm) =*  Normality  meq/1
             (0.065) x  (EC mmhos/cm)  -  Percent salt by weight

     Measuring  the  concentration of  salts in  soil  first  requires  that an
aqueous soil extract be  obtained. Extracts taken from soils at field mois-
ture content will seldom provide a  sufficient quantity for  analysis.   On
the  other  hand,  exhaustive  leaching or extraction  at very  high moisture
contents will  yield  a   sample  that   is not  typical  of  the  soil solution


                                     180

-------
      TABLE 6.15  WATER CLASSES IN RELATION TO THEIR  SALT  CONCENTRATION*
        Class
         of
        Water
  Electrical
 Conductivity
   micromho
per on at 25°C
 Milligrams
 per liter
    Kilograms
per hectare-30 cm
             Comments
00
      Low
       salinity
       water
     Moderate
      salinity
       water
     High
      salinity
       water
     Very  high
      salinity
       water
     0-  400
     0-  250
       0-  800
   400-1,200
   250-  750
     800-2,200
 1,200-2,250
   750-1,450
   2,200-3,300
2,250-5,000
1,450-3,200
  3,300-9,600
These waters  can be  used  for  irrigat-
ing most crops with  a low probability
that salt problems will develop.   Some
leach is required, but this generally
occurs with normal irrigation prac-
tices.

These waters  can be  used  if a moderate
amount of leaching occurs.  Plants
with moderate salt tolerance  can be
grown in most instances without spe-
cial practices for salinity control.

These waters  should  not be used on
soils with restricted drain age.  Spe-
cial management  is required even with
adequate drainage.   Plants tolerant to
salinity should  be grown.  Excess
water must be applied for  leaching.

These waters  are  not suitable for
irrigation except under very  special
circumstances.  Adequate  drainage is
essential.  Only  very salt-tolerant
crops should  be grown.  Considerable
excess water  must be applied   for
leaching.
     * Bresler  et  al.  (1982).

-------
 because  of the effect of ion  exchange  and mineral dissolution.   As a com-
 promise,  soil saturation has  been selected for  obtaining  aqueous  extracts
 (USDA,  1954).   A sufficient  amount  of  solution can usually  be extracted
 with  vacuum from 200-300 grams of soil.  The concentration of salts in soil
 is,  therefore,  commonly expressed  as  the  EC  of  a  saturated  soil  paste
 extract.   The relationship  of  salt concentration in the soil to  the EC of a
 saturation extract is  influenced by  the moisture holding  capacity of the
 soil  as  illustrated in Fig.  6.11.  The  EC of  a saturation extract does not
 directly  reflect  the salinity  of the  soil  solution,  but  the  saturation
 extract  is the best practical  means to  obtain  such  a measurement.  Under a
 typical  irrigated crop system, the average salinity of the soil  solution is
 approximately twice the salinity of the saturation extract (Rhoades, 1974);
 however,  use of  the  saturation  extract  is  so  widely practiced  that  it is
 the  measure  best  correlated in  the  literature  to plant  growth responses,
 soil  structure,  and other observations of soil condition.

      In  the  absence  of  adequate  rainfall  or  irrigation  and  subsequent
 drainage,  applied or naturally  occurring salts  can  accumulate  on the soil
 surface and in upper  horizons  of the  soil.  Salt concentrations  in  the soil
 that  exceed  4 mmhos/cm  can  inhibit  growth  of  sensitive  plants  and  may
 retard  microbial activity.   Physical and  chemical   characteristics  of the
 soil  are  also affected by salt  accumulation.   Severe salt accumulation can
 be disastrous to a  land  treatment system and may require  costly  remedial
 action.   Furthermore, soluble salts  are relatively mobile  in  the soil and
 can  easily migrate  to ground  or surface  waters,  resulting  in pollution.
 Management  of salts  applied in  irrigation water or  waste  materials there-
 fore  requires that  salt accumulation be  controlled,  while  at the same time
 pollution  of  ground or  surface waters is prevented.

     Many   schemes  for  managing  salt   accumulation   and  migration assume
 steady  state conditions  and that applied  salts do  not  interact  with the
 soil  matrix.   Salts do, however,  interact  with the soil matrix.  They may
 be precipitated as  insoluble  compounds,  sorbed  by  soil colloids,  or dis-
 solved  in  the  soil solution.    The extent  of precipitation,  sorption and
 dissolution depends  upon the  salt  concentration  in  the  soil,  the  ionic
 species  present, soil  physical  and chemical  properties,  and  the moisture
 content  of the  soil.   Predicting  the  concentration  of  salts in  the soil
 solution  at any given  time  for  a  particular  soil is  therefore difficult.
 The  assumptions  of  steady   state and no  interactions may  be  valid  in an
 irrigated   crop  system,  but  is  not  applicable to many   land treatment
 systems,  especially those receiving  relatively heavy and  infrequent waste
 applications.   Understanding  soil and  salt  interactions  may,  and should,
 be quantified and included  in  the waste application rate design.

     Where  inadequate water  or poor  soil drainage prevent leaching  of salts
 from  the  treatment  zone or   the  plant  root zone, salts will concentrate in
 the soil  through evaporation.   The soil  surface behaves  like  a semi-per-
meable membrane  allowing soil  water to  enter  the atmosphere through evapo-
 ration while  leaving dissolved  salts at  or near the  soil  surface.   Once
 salts are  deposited  at  the  soil  surface in  this  manner,  additional  soil
water and  its dissolved salts  are driven to the surface  by osmotic forces
 in addition to  evaporative demand.  For this reason,  many saline soils will

                                     182

-------
      .75--
   S
                                    SATURATION
                                      PERCENTAGE
               2      4      I     I      »     12     14

                  EC OF SATURATION EXTRACT IN  MMHOS/CM
Figure 6.11.  Correlation of salt  concentration in the  soil  to the EC of
              saturation extracts  for various soil types  (USDA,  1954).
                                      183

-------
 appear  to  be moist, when  in  reality  there is  little  or no water  available
 for  plants  or waste decomposing microbes.

      Soil  salinity  inhibits  plant growth by  restricting plant  uptake  of
 water.   As  the osmotic  gradient  between the soil  solution and plant  roots
 increases,  the plant uptake  of water  and  nutrients  decreases.   This  same
 mechanism  may also  adversely  affect  the  growth of  soil microbes.    Crop
 sensitivity to salt damage varies  between different  species  and  varieties
 depending on the specific salts  present.   See Table  6.16 for general  crop
 response to soil  salinity and Table 6.17  for  the salt tolerance of  various
 crops.   For  specific  choice  of  the  proper  plant  species,  other  factors,
 such  as drought  tolerance and  regional  adaptation,  must  be considered.
 Additional  guidance  on  species  selection is provided  in Section 8.7.
TABLE 6.16   GENERAL CROP RESPONSE AS A FUNCTION OF ELECTRICAL  CONDUCTIVITY*


       EC  (mmhos/cm)              Degree of Problem

            0-2                    None

            2-4                    Slight to none

            4-8                    Many crops affected

            8-16                   Only tolerant crops yield well

      greater than  16             Only very tolerant crops yield well

* USDA (1954).
     Salts  that  accumulate  in  surface  soils  may be  reduced by  precipita-
tion, irrigation,  and  to  a small extent by crop uptake.  In  the  presence of
adequate  precipitation or irrigation,  the  salts  dissolve and are  then  car-
ried away in runoff  or are leached into the subsoil.   Leached salts  may be
transported back  to  the soil surface  as a result of  evaporation  if  subse-
quent precipitation  or irrigation does not occur.  If a  sufficient quantity
of  drainage  water passes  through  the  soil profile,  leached  salts may  be
carried  farther  into  the subsurface  and   may  intercept groundwater.   The
concentration and  quantity of salts present in drainage water and  that  re-
maining in the surface soil may be approximated  by  a mass balance approach
such as that proposed  by  Rhoades (1974).

     In  general,  management  of  the soil-plant system  to  prevent  damaging
salt accumulation  in surface soils includes the following:

     (1)  limiting  the  amount  of  salt  applied   to   the  soil  in
          irrigation water or waste;

     (2)  using salt tolerant crops;

     (3)  maintaining  a healthy vegetative cover or mulching;
     (4)  properly scheduling irrigation and  waste applications;  and

                                     184

-------
TABLE  6.17  THE RELATIVE PRODUCTIVITY OF PLANTS WITH INCREASING SALT
             CONCENTRATIONS IN THE ROOT ZONE*t

riant
SCKSITIfl:
Algeria* Ivy
(Medar* ea**rleaj*l*)
HtmamJ
(rr***a aalcli)
Apal.
(Hal** ayloaetrla)'
Apricot
(rr**** aranlaca)
A*»ca*a
(Paraea a*jarlea**>
•ee*
(rha*iol*a rall*ri.)
•laeklie'rry
(krtaa **..!
Boy***berry
(to*** ajTelm*)
•*rT*id tolly
(U*> cora.te>
CaFrot
(P**CM* canta)
Celery
(*»i»» |r.av*ol«M)*
Cr*p*fr«it
(dtraa far**!*!)
. - Heave* ly M.Tnn
QQ (lasll** eaoeetlc.)
.„ Hlalec** (tibiae**
roa*-*i**a*l*J
Levm (cttr** itaa*,)*
eac«le*t*a)'
Onion (Alllaai ceaa)
Oranfa
r»» ape.)'
PlMp.TiTi.lTa
(r.t]aa *ell«aln>a)
(Fr**a* daantlea)
Frm*
(rra*** 4oa»atlca)'
"rin.?£r.. t.blr.)+
la«*berry
(biboa 14.eoe)'
Dote
(tola lap.)
Strawberry
(Tt.mrla a*.)

1
too
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
too
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100


11
•1
«1
„
*o
11
n
n
•2
i«
«0
a?
m
K
11
w
«7
f4
fl
•1
tl
n
m
74
67


62
73
75
M
70
«2
67
5«
72
7S
(1
75
72
75
71
73
75
34
73
75
n
a
36
31
telatlte rri>a»ctl»lty. t at Selected K *eWca>

3S 0
55 3* II 0
45 23 0

43 25 4 0
44 21 0
44 22 0
34 14 0
51 44 30 II 10
65 41 32 16 0
61 47 34 20 70
5« 42 M 15 0
55 it 23 « 0
6} 4> 32 16 0
52 31 10 0
0
55 3* » 0

6* 60 50 40 30 20

0
n
X rr*a*ectvtty
decreeee par Sall«ltr
	 	 *aho/c» ThrohoU
II 19 2O 21 22 23 24 teereaee K
	 1.0
II 1.5
	 1.0
13 1.6
	 1.0
18. » 1.0
22.2 1.5
22.2 1.5
	 1.0
14.1 1.0
	 1.0
K.I l.«
	 1.0
	 1.0
1ft. 1 1.2
!!.» 1.7

	 1.2
IS. 2 1.5
	 1.0
	 1.0
	 1.0
	 1.0
33.3 1.0
                                        —continued—

-------
                  MIU 6.17  (coatIa*e4)
GO
/ۥ
riant
Stac Jaeale*
laaadaotaaa)
HoDEUTeu snsiTira:
Alfalfa
(Hedlcato aatlra)
Arborvlta*.
(TlMja erlciitaM)*
•ottukrah
(CallleteeOT
vlalaalle)1'
kivoad
(fenu •Icroahrlla
war. Jaaoalca)
•roadbaeaj (Mela faka)
CMlitlom
(Braaaica. oierae**)'
Cabbage
(Biaaalca olaraett*
var. Capitata)
Clorar. alalte, ladlea
T«d , ecTawtoTTv
(Trlfollaai afp.)
Con, fora|«
(Zjijej.)
Coca., grala. avcet
(laa MT.)
Coan/ea
(Tlgna. «a^»lc«Ut«)
Cncoa*cr
(CVacWll Utlvu)
Dodoaea (De4o«l<
viacoaa «ar«
Atroa«rp«r«a}
ria.
(*!.« ulUClMlaam)
Crape 
tettao
(Latcca aatlva)
(Ec«ro»ll» apa.)
(Uvaatearai
atrat^aaia)
miakaetoa
<0«n>ala a.l«)'
1

100

100

100


100

too
too

100

100


100

100

100
100

100


100

100
100
100

100

100
100

100
100
X Product Ivlty
•ecreaee par
	 MMlM/M


83

100

100


*4

»6
M

100

*8


a*

9*

M
*>

100


14

16
95
•1

n

91
100

•*
too

61

93

91


85

86
87

93

88


82

»1

84
76

94


86

84
86
81

82

78
92

Si
95

40

IS

• 1


77

76
77

IS

7*


70

W

72
61

81


77

72
76
72

72

65
63

74
80

18

78

72


68

63
67



49


58

T6

60
47

68


68

60
66
63

62

52
75

66


0

71

42


59

54
58



59


40

69

48
33

is


59

48
57
54

51

59
66

5<




64

52


50

43
48



50


34

61

36
It

41


SI

36
47
45

41

26
58

47




56

4)


41

32
3*



40


22

54

24
4

29


42

24
38
36

3O

13
4*

»




44

33


33

21
29



M


10

47

12
0

16


33

12
28
27

20

0
41

27




41 34 17 10 11

24




II 0
19 10 0



20 II 1 0


0

39 32 24 17 10

0


3 0


25 17 40

0
18 * 0
18 9 0

9 0


32 24 15 7 O

17 8 0




7.3

	


	

10.6
4.6

	

4.r


12.0

7.4

12.0
14.)

IJ.O


7.8

12.0
4.}
t.J

	

13.0
6.5

4.7
	
Salinity
Threshold
K

1.6

2.0

2.0


I.S

1.7
1.6

2.5

1.8


1.5

1.8

1.7
1.1

2.5


1.0

1.7
1.5
1.5

1.8

1.3
2.0

1.5
2.S

-------
TIM* ».U

Plant
Oleander
(Herlini oleander)*
'" .
(Plaua satlvua>)r
Peanut
(Areehle hypogaea)
Pepper
(Capslnei annul)
Potato
(SolaatM taberoauai)
Pyracantha
(Pyracantha braperl)
Radian
(ftaphainis salivas)
Uce. Paddy
(Orvta satlva)
Seebenla
(Seakaitta eialtata)
Spinach
(Spfnacla oleracca)
Squash
(Cueurfclta •asiaa)'
Sugarcane (Sacchanaa
off Iclnsrosi)
Sllrerberry
(Elaeagnus pungens)
Sveec potato
(iDouoea batataa)
Texas privet
tr? (Ugustru. lucid-)
l-u TOMCO (Lvcoperslron
••J eeculentu.)
Trefoil, tig
(Lots* ttllginolus)
Vetch, CoaMini
(Vlcla aatlva)
Vlburniai
(Vlburnu. spp.)
(lylosu sentlcosa)
HODEMTELT TOLERANT:
Alkali sacatoo
(Sporosolus
alroldes)'
Barley, forage
(Rordeuu vulgara)
Beet , garden
(seta vulgarta)
Broccoli
(Braaslcs oleracea
var. Capltata)

1
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
too
100
100
100
too
100
100
100
100


100
100
100
93
„
„
90
too
100
100
100
n
95
94
100
100
100
*0
94
100
too
100
100


tj
90
100
7»
M
JO
77
100
,5
92
90
92
17
M
13
95
17
100
73
II
100
100
M


tt
77
„
72
II
M
M
8*
15
74
7(
7J
75
IS
68
19
67
100
100
1*


7,
1*
51
to
72
51
7i
(1
77

II
62
tt
75
„
71
44
54
too
"
80


72
20
37
48
62
38
63
74
70

75
51
56
65
30
67
32
40
100
82
71
M
7
t5
0
23
36
53
Z5
51
67
62

69
50
40
tt
55
II
5«
20
27
93
73
tl
atlve
8
M

8
24
43
12
39
to
55

63
41
29
36
16
0
44
10
14
86
tt
52
Productivity, t at Selected EC nho/eu
• 10 II 12 13 It 15 It 17 18 19 20 21 !:
51 4t 37 3O 24

0
12 0
34 24 It 60
0
27 15 2 0
53 47 40 33 2* 19
47 39 32 24 17 9

57 51 45 3» 3t 28
32 23 13 It 0
11 7 0
26 16 7 0
36 2t It «0

33 22 11 0
0
0
79 72 65 38 51 tt 37 30 23 15 I
55 tt 31 2» 20 11 2 0
4) 34 25 It t 0
1 Product Ivlte
decreaae per
23 24 Increase
_
28. t
14.1
12.0
9.1
13.0
12.2
7.0
7.t
	
3.1
11.0
9.1
9.9
18.*
II. 1
13.2
13.3
7.0
9.0

Salinity
BC
2.0
2.3
3.2
1.3
1.7
2.0
1.2
3.0
2.3
2.0
2.5
1.7
l.f
1.3
2.0
2.3
2.3
3.0
1.4
1.5
t.O
4.0
2.8
                                                                                 —con t liraed—

-------
                 ntu i.i? («
00
00
lalattva Productivity.
naat
Oa«*r, Wnaaaj
rliimiffTil-it
<*»€»• aallTlaa)
•aaayaM
»
^ffiJZfc""'
caaaaatrlal
mil* COlaa iiiunaa)
Orchard araM
(laetTlU Iloaatatj)
(IkateTnnataa)'
(Ull. aaiaaaa)
^^eS!1
(loTtkaa Uealar)
toraaaa (Ojcla. au)
"l'"lLLa*lili-iallT
Trafali, Mrtafaac
(Utaa earaie»lata«
Ukaac
Vildrra, baardlaaa
(Orau trltleaUaa)
nuun,
Barlay. grata
(loraaaa vaUara)
gjjgjjatli-,
'SSStiffl
°(CMnl« atraataa)
Data
1

100
100

100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
too

100
100
100








17
100

100
100
100
100
100
»7
100
100
100
100
100
100

100
100
100








•1
100

100
100
100
100
too
51
100
100
100
100
100
n

100
100
M








M
M

n
100
100
100
100
14
100
100
100
100
100
•5

100
100
«2

100
100
100
100
100


•0
IS

•4
*0
»7
100
M
71
•0
100
too
tf
100
9i

100
100
It

100
100
100
100
«


74
"

tf
IS
n
100
IS
71
IS
»7
100
M
•0
M

n
100
•0

100
100
100
100
n


tf
47
100
M

n
90

M

n
»7
M
to
n

00
n
74

100
ft
100
100
It


u
M
77
71

"


to

11
10
71
40
71

70
M
M

100
n
100
n
It


57
4*
52
71

(7


51

74
IS
70
20
71

to
7f
12

«5
17

tl
•2


51
40
27
tl

St


47

t7
00
tl
0
t«

50
71
54

to
M

II
71
II

44
11
0
tl

11


41

„
75
St

ts

40
M
SO

IS
74

n
75
Zat
11

40
22

57

44


IS

52
90
SO

tl

10
57
44

00
47

71
71
lalac
11

M
11

51

M


It

44

41

St

20
SO
«

75
tl

71
M
*a< 1
14

It
4

47

»


22

M

M

12

10
43
11

70
54

17
44
I
It 14 17 II l< 10 II It 11 14

11 17 11 tO
0

41 M 11 23 20

21 14 t 0


U 10 4 0

» 21 14 6 0

If 22 15 1 0

41 41 M 33 10

0
3f It 21 14 7
» TO 14 1 2

45 tO 55 50 45 40 IS It 25 20
41 42 15 2t 22 It 10 3 0

(2 57 52 47 41 M 31 2« 21 It
M 57 51 49 4t 42 3t 15 31 21
aaJe/ea*"

5.1
t.l
—
5.3

7.6
—
—
1.2
	
7.4
—
—
10.0
4.1

10.0
7.1
t.O

5.0
6.4
	
5.2
l.t
!•! Inter
•c

1.9
4.0
7.0
l.f
4.2
4.6
6.5
4.0
1.3
—
5.6
4.5
4.1
5.0
2.1

5.0
t.O
2.7

1.0
t.f
1.5
7.7
4.0

-------
               tout 1.17   (eauleeaa:)
00
IO
•eletlve Proaactlvity . Z at Selected EC aaho/cai eeereaee fir
Pint 1 I
aatal fl~
(Cariaaa araallflace)'
•oeeaarr Uulaarlaaa
lecevooelir"
(leta yalgaria)
MMacgraee, ereotee'
(Acranrraa eeaertenaj)
Uheetgraee. fairway
(Agrapjtue crietatev.)
tfheacfraaa. tali
(Agraarraa aleaaataa)
Vilarya. alcal
(Uraoa iniiitit)

• Iraaler at at. (IM1).
f fait MMeaeraeiae la ehjiaa aa tl



100
100
M

100

too
100

M electrlcet



»3
100
a4

100

100
100


100

13 75
100 100
M U

100 100

100 100
100



a

U
M II 12
U 71 74

*7 fO M

M M I*


11 12 1) 14 11 It 17 II U 20 21 22 21 24 lacraaaa
	

	
74 71 t5 5t 51 47 41 >3 n 24 It 12 t 0 5.»
70 it tl SI 54 30 44 42 X 14 10 24 22 II 4.0

76 6* U 33 »i 41 14 21 21 14 7 0 *.»

•5 « 77 7) M 44 (0 34 32 47 41 N 11 11 4.2
	

Salinity
Ibreatola
re
t.o

4.5
7.0
1.5

7.3

7.5
	

aratal aoll e»tracta (BC>.
               ' Taklal  olaaa an aatlmtaa  taaej  a« tha EC  for  a  relatlva  ji*H tl m imt rlale1 radactlaaa far alallar craaa «• K Increm*.

               •*• Tka lever aart af ta. ylelJ  one  »apraac»»e aara  aeraatatteall; to the aaalclau; ~lr Ilaear aita are aam.

               • Taale4  >alaaa an taM*  oa car~ aac< felMe arallaala  la tt»  lltaraMra.

               •* TaklaJ Talaea are  tllll aa  taraa  aata »o'"t". araeactlritr aropa (Baralf tonraa ten for the leaer 301 aroeactloltr.

-------
      (5)  prudent  leaching  of  salts  below  the  root  zone  through
          irrigation.

In  addition,  migration  of  unacceptable  quantities of  salts to  ground or
surface waters may be  controlled  by:

      (1)  using soil erosion  and  runoff control practices;
      (2)  avoiding locations  with  shallow unconfined aquifers;

      (3)  limiting  the amount  of  applied  salt  through  optimum waste
          application  rates  in conjunction with soil,  soil  water, and
          groundwater  monitoring;  and

      (4)  using effective irrigation  practices.

Where salts are anticipated  to be a  problem  in a given  waste,  choice of a
site  having at least moderately well  drained  soils is essential to maintain
the  usefulness  of the  land  treatment  unit.   In  soils where a  high water
table causes  continued capillary rise  of  salts,  subsurface  drainage  (e.g.,
drain tile  or ditches) can  be installed  to  lower the water  table  and  the
associated capillary fringe.

     Aside from  these  general  guidelines, there is no  reliable  and widely
available means  to quantify  acceptable salt  loading  rates  and  management
practices.  The approach described by  the Salinity  Laboratory Staff  (USDA,
1954) is  inappropriate to the  case  of intentional  salt  applications,  and,
even  if  it  were  modified to  better  fit the  given case, the  method  is  too
simplistic  to reliably yield  results  that are  accurate  enough  for  design
purposes.   Therefore,  it is  recommended  that this  simplistic approach  not
be patently applied to  all situations.   Some, more complex, computer  models
which show  promise are in  developmental   or  modification  stages  (Dutt et
al.,  1972; Franklin, personal  communication).  These models, however, would
require considerable alteration to apply  generally  and in a land treatment
context.  Based on the current lack  of a definitive  solution to the prob-
lem,  salt  management   questions  in  a  land  treatment   system  should be
referred  to  a soil scientist having  specific experience  regarding  saline
and  sodic soils.   Other  useful  information can be  found  in  a  book by
Bresler and McNeal (1982).
6.1.4.2  Sodicity
     Sodium,  as  a constituent  of  soluble salts  contained  in applied waste
or irrigation  water,  deteriorates soil structure and exhibits direct toxic
effects on  sensitive  crops.  When soluble salts  accumulate in the surface
soil, sodium  salts  may be preferentially  concentrated in the soil solution
because of  their  higher solubility in  comparison to the corresponding  cal-
cium, magnesium,  or  potassium  salts.    Sodium  ions are,  therefore,  more
available for  plant uptake  and  to  compete in cation exchange reactions  with
soil colloids.  Sodic  effects on soils  and crops can be minimized by  limit-
                                     190

-------
Ing  the  amount of  applied  sodium and  by maintaining  a favorable  balance
between sodium ions and other basic  cations  in  the  soil  solution.

     Sodium  affects soil structure  by dispersing  flocculated organic  and
inorganic  soil  colloids.   Dispersion occurs  when sodium ions are  adsorbed
to clay surfaces  and  colloidal  organic matter  causing individual  particles
to repel one  another.   In addition, sodium  ions  can hydrolyze water  mole-
cules resulting in  elevated  soil pH and dissolution of  soil  organic matter
that holds soil aggregates  together (Taylor  and  Ashcroft,  1972).  As  soil
aggregates are  collapsed by raindrop  impact  and  tillage, the  infiltration
capacity  and hydraulic  conductivity of  the soil  decrease  significantly.
Air and water entry into  soil  is then restricted so runoff  increases,  soil
erosion increases,  plants die, and oxidative  waste  degradation processes in
the  soil  are  slowed.   Sodium  affected soils  can be  reclaimed  by  adding
various soil amendments  and intensively managing  the  site.  Reclamation
efforts, however, can  be costly and are  often  ineffective.   The  threshold
sodium  concentration  of  the soil solution  that results  in  dispersion of
soil colloids is  influenced  by several  factors  including the following:

     (1)   the  relative  concentration of sodium to  calcium  and magne-
           sium  is commonly  expressed  as the  sodium adsorption  ratio
           (SAR)   where   concentrations   are  expressed   in   normality
           (meq/1)
                               /[Cal + [Mg
     (2)  the salinity of  the  soil  solution;

     (3)  physical and chemical  soil  properties;

     (4)  cropping and tillage practices;  and

     (5)  irrigation and waste application methods.

Prediction of a  threshold  value  in terms  of  sodium application to the soil
is therefore  difficult.   The  USDA  (1954)  states that  soil  sodicity occurs
when  the 'percentage  of exchangeable sodium exceeds  15  or  the  SAR  of a
saturated soil  paste  extract exceeds 12.   Other  researchers, however, have
observed  decreased infiltration rates  when SAR values  are as  low  as 5
(Miyamoto,  1979).   Permeability is  also   decreased  when  the exchangeable
sodium percentage  (ESP)  increases.   Figure 6.12  illustrates that  hydraulic
conductivity  is  decreased  by over 50% when the ESP is raised from 5 to 10%.
As with  soil salinity, management schemes  for predicting  and controlling
sodicity  have been developed  for irrigated  agriculture and  assume steady
state conditions.  To  the  extent that these schemes apply to land treatment
systems,  the  general  approach  assumes that the SAR should be maintained at
or  preferably  below  12.    Management  to  achieve  this   objective  would
logically fall into one of the following approaches:

     (1)  waste  pretreatment or  addition of calcium or magnesium salts
          to  maintain  the  SAR  of the  waste below the critical level;
                                     191

-------
vO
ro
                                        10           20          30          40
                                         PERCENT  EXCHANGEABLE SODIUM
              Figure 6.12.
Effect of increasing ESP upon hydraulic conductivity
(Martin et al., 1964).  Reprinted by permission of
the Soil Science Society of America.

-------
     (2)  calcium  or  magnesium  salts  (e.g.,  gypsum)  amendements  to
          soils;

     (3)  applications of waste to larger areas of  land; and
     (4)  allow  SAR  to exceed  critical levels,  then take  corrective
          action (the least attractive  alternative).

Details  of  these  approaches  can be  found  in  Overcash  and  Pal  (1979).
Sodium  affected soils  can  be diagnosed  by  the   occurrence  of  decreased
infiltration   rates,    low  aggregate   stability,   elevated   levels    of
exchangeable sodium, and elevated soil  pH.

     The phytotoxicity of  sodium  to  various crops  is listed  in  Table 6.18.
Sodium toxicity  can occur  through direct plant uptake of sodium and  through
nutrient imbalance caused  by an unfavorable calcium  to sodium  ratio (USDA,
1954).
TABLE 6.18  SODIUM TOLERANCE OF  VARIOUS  CROPS*
Tolerance Range
        Crop
Extremely Sensitive
(Exchangeable Na - 2-10%)
Sensitive
(Exchangeable Na -  10-20%)
Moderatley Tolerant
(Exchangeable Na -  20-40%
Tolerant
(Exchangeable Na -  40-60%)
Most Tolerant
(Exchangeable Na exceeds  60%)
Deciduous fruits
Nuts
Citrus
Avocado (Persea americana)

Beans (Phaseolus spp.)

Clover (Trifolium spp.)
Oats (Avena fatua)
Tall fescue (Festuca arundinacea)
Rice (Oryza sativa)
Dal11s grass  (Paspalum dilatatum)

Wheat (Triticum aestivum)
Cotton (Gossypium hirsutum)
Alfalfa (Medicago" sativa)
Barley (Hordcum vulgare)
Tomatoes  (Lycop'ersicon esculentum)
Beets (Beta vulgaris)

Crested wheatgrass  (Agropyron desertorum)
Fairway wheatgrass  (Agropyron cristatum)
Tall wheatgraas (Agropyron elongatum)
Rhodesgrass (Chloris gayana)
* Pearson (1960).
                                     193

-------
 6.1.5
Halides
      The  halides  are  the  stable  anlons  of  the highly  reactive  halogens,
 fluorine  (F),  chlorine (Cl), bromine (Br) and iodine (I).  Although  halides
 occur naturally in soils, overloading a land treatment facility  with wastes
 high  in  halides  poses a toxic threat  to soil  microbes, cover crops  and
 grazing animals.   Chloride,  iodide,  and  probably fluoride  are  essential
 nutrients to  animals,  however, only chloride  is  essential to plants.   Each
 of  the halides is  discussed below with  respect  to its  sources  in  wastes,
 background  levels, mobility in soils,  and plant and  animal  toxiclty.   The
 fate  of halogenated organic compounds is discussed in Section 6.2.3.4.
6.1.5.1  Fluoride
     Fluoride  is present  in many  industrial  wastes  including  the  process
wastes  from the  production of  phosphatic fertilizers,  hydrogen  fluoride,
and  fluorinated  hydrocarbons   and  in  certain  petroleum  refinery  waste
streams.   Fluorides  occur naturally in  soils  at  levels ranging from 30-990
ppm  (Table  6.19).
TABLE 6.19   TYPICAL  TOTAL HALIDE LEVELS IN DRY SOIL
                     PPM (Dry Weight)
Halide
Bromide
Chloride
Fluoride
Iodide
(Mean)
10
100
200
240
345
5
2.83
(Range)
(2-100)
(10-40)

(30-300)
(70-990)
(2.5-3.9)*
(0.1-10)
Reference
Bowen (1966)
Martin (1966a)
Bowen (1966)
Bowen (1966)
Brewer (1966a)
Gilpin and Johnson
Bowen (1966)
Aston and Brazier
Martin (1966b)



(1980)
(1979)
* Iodide deficient  soils.
     The  mobility of  fluoride in  soil  depends  on  the percentage  of  the
total fluoride  that  is water soluble.   Fluoride  solubility is dependent  on
the kind  and relative  quantity  of  cations  present  in  the  soils that  have
formed  salts with the  fluoride  ion (F~).   Sodium salts  of fluoride  (NaF)
are quite  soluble and result in  high  soluble fluoride  levels  in soils  low
in  calcium.    Calcium  salts of  fluoride  (CaF2)  are  relatively Insoluble
                                     194

-------
and serve  to  limit the amount  of fluoride taken  up  by plants or  leached
from the soil.

     Fluoride is not an essential nutrient to plants but may  be  essential
for animals; however, soluble fluorides  are readily taken up  by  plants  at
levels that may  be toxic  to grazing animals.   The upper level of  chronic
lifetime dietary exposure  of  fluoride  (dry  weight  concentration  in  the
diet) that will not result in a loss of production for cattle is 40  ppm and
for  swine,  150  ppm  (National  Academy  of  Sciences,  1980).    Chronic
fluorosis, a disease in grazing  animals  caused  by excess dietary fluoride,
has  reportedly  resulted  from  industrial  contamination of  pastures  and
underground water sources.  Fluorosis can occur in grazing animals from the
consumption of water containing  15 ppm fluoride (Lee,  1975)  or forage con-
taining 50 ppm fluoride (Brewer, 1966).

     Phytotoxic  concentrations  of fluoride based  on plant  tissue  content
and irrigation water  fluoride  content are  given  in Table 6.20.  A tissue
concentration of only 18 ppm  (dry weight) was  toxic  to elm,  a  sensitive
plant (Adams  et  al.,  1957), yet, buckwheat survived  tissue  concentrations
of 990-2450 ppm  fluoride  (Hurd-Karrer, 1950).  Tissue concentrations toxic
to various crops have been determined (Brewer,  1966a).

     While  liming  a soil will  temporarily decrease both plant uptake and
leaching of fluoride, the loading capacity allowed for fluoride  in a land
treatment  unit  should take into account that  liming  will  cease following
closure.  Soils with high cation exchange  capacities (CEC) that are high in
calcium  and low in  sodium have a higher  long-term  loading  capacity for
fluoride than soils with lower  CECs or  higher sodium content.   Leachate
concentrations of  fluoride  should not exceed the EPA drinking water  stand-
ard.  The EPA drinking water standard (Table  6.21)  is  dependent on  climatic
conditions  because the  amount   of  water  (and  consequently the  amount of
fluoride) ingested is primarily  influenced by air  temperature.  The ration-
ale behind  limiting the  leachate concentration of fluoride to  the  drinking
water standard  is  that  groundwater  is  a  primary  source of  drinking water
and since  groundwater is  likely to remain  in the same climatic  zone  (with
respect to where it may be  used as drinking water) a graduated standard is
a reasonable guide for leachate  quality.
6.1.5.2  Chloride  (Cl)
     Chlorides  occur  to some extent in all  waste  streams either as a  pro-
duction by-product  (i.e.,  chlorinated  hydrocarbon  production wastes, chlor-
ine gas production, etc.)  or as  a contaminant in the water  source used.   A
typical value for chloride  in soil is 100 ppm  (Table  6.19).  Chloride  is
very soluble  and  will move with  leachate water.
                                     195

-------
TABLE 6.20  PHYTOTOXICITY OF HALIDES FROM ACCUMULATION  IN PLANT TISSUE AND
            APPLICATIONS TO SOIL

Halide
Fluoride
Chloride
Bromide
Iodide
Tissue
Plant
Buckwheat (Fagopyrum
e s culentum)
Elm (Ulmus sp . )
Apple (Malus sp.)
Alfalfa (Medicago
sativa)
Cabbage (Brassica
oleraceal
Citrus seedling
(Citrus sp.)
Tomato (Lycopersicon
es culentum)
Buckwheat (Fagopyrum
es culentum)
Content
Toxic Level
in Tissue
(ppm dry wt.
2450-990
18
0.24%
0.27%
0.1%
0.17%
8.05
8.75%
Soil Applied in Irrigation Water (IW) or
Halide
Fluoride
Chloride
Bromide
Iodide
Plant
Tomato (Lycopersicon
esculentum)
Red Maple seedlings
(Acer rubrum)
Pea (Pisium sativum)
Oats (Avena sativa)
Bean (Phaseolus
vulgarig)
Cabbage (Brassica
oleracea)
Tomato (Lycopersicon
esculentum)
Buckwheat (Fagopyrum
esculentum)
Toxic Level
(ppm)
100 (IW)
380 (IW)
9 (IW)
120 (IW)
38 (WS)
83 (WS)
5 (WS)
5 (WS)

)* Reference
Hurd-Karrer (1950)
Adams et al. (1957)
Dilley et al. (1958)
Eaton (1942)
Martin (1966a)
Martin et al. (1956)
Newton and Toth (1952)
Newton and Toth (1952)
Water Soluble (WS)
Reference
McKee and Wolf (1963)
Maftoun and Sheilbany
(1979)
Eaton (1966)
Eaton (1966)
Stelmach (1958)
Stelmach (1958)
Newton and Toth (1952)
Newton and Toth (1952)
* Unless otherwise noted.
t Possible Cl-salt effect on toxlcity.

                                    196

-------
TABLE 6.21  EPA DRINKING WATER STANDARD FOR FLUORIDE*
Annual average of maximum dally
air temperatures (Degrees C)t                        Fluoride maximum (mg/1)

         12 and below                                          2.4
         12.1 to 14.6                                          2.2
         14.7 to 17.6                                          2.0
         17.7 to 21.4                                          1.8
         21.5 to 26.2                                          1.6
         26.3 to 32.5                                          1.4

* EPA (1976a).

' Based on temperature  data obtained for a minimum of 5 years.


     When soils are carefully managed to  avoid  leachate  generation, chlor-
ide concentrations  in  the soil  may  increase rapidly.   To  avoid  chloride
buildup in soils, the  amount applied in wastes  and  irrigation water should
be balanced with the amount removed by cover  crops  and leached through the
soil profile.

     Chloride  is  an essential element  to both  plants  and animals.   Al-
though, plants  readily take up  chloride,  animals are  generally unaffected
by concentrations  in forage.  Phytotoxicity generally occurs  before plant
concentrations  reach levels  that  would  adversely affect  grazing  animals.
Phytotoxic  levels  of chloride with respect  to  its  concentration  in plant
tissue and irrigation water are  given in Table 6.20.

     Plant  removal  of  chlorides  can be  increased by  regularly harvesting
the stalk and  leafy portion of the  cover  crop.   Corn  plants  remove only 3
kg/ha/yr of chloride when harvested as  corn; however, when  the same  crop is
harvested for  silage over 35 kg/ha/yr  of chloride  is  removed  (Kardos et
al.,  1974)..  The  concentration  of chloride  in soil  solutions associated
with yield reductions  in various crops have  been  determined (Van Beekom et
al., 1953; Van Dam,  1955; Embleton et al., 1978).

     Loading  rate  considerations  for  chloride should  include  the amount
removed by plant uptake and the amount  lost in leachate while keeping the
concentration  in  the soil below the phytotoxic level.   Additionally, the
leachate concentration should not  exceed  the EPA drinking water   standard
for chloride of 250 mg/1.
6.1.5.3  Bromide
     Bromide  is present  in several  industrial wastes  including synthetic
organic dyes, mixed  petrochemical wastes, photographic supplies, production
wastes, Pharmaceuticals  and inorganic chemicals.   Hydrogen bromide is pro-
duced  for use  as a soil  fumigant  in  agriculture.    Naturally occurring

                                     197

-------
 bromide concentrations in soil range from 2-100 ppm (Table 6.19).  In addi-
 tion to the bromide  ion,  other forms of  this  element that  occur naturally
 in soils,  though at  smaller  concentrations,  are brornate  (Br03~)  and bromic
 acid.   Most bromide salts (CaBr, MgBr, NaBr and KBr)  are  sufficiently solu-
 ble  to be  readily leachable  in water  percolating through  soils.   Conse-
 quently, most  of the bromide found in soils is organically combined.

      Bromide is not  an  essential  nutrient to  plants  or animals.   Although
 bromide is  strongly  concentrated  by  plants,  reports  of toxicity  to animals
 are  scarce.   Table 6.20  lists bromide concentrations  that are  phytotoxic
 with respect  to plant  tissue  content  and  the water  soluble   content  in
 soils.   The upper  level  of  chronic lifetime  dietary  exposure   of  bromide
 (dry weight concentration  in the  diet) that will  not result  in  a  loss  of
 production  for cattle and  swine  is 200 ppm  (National Academy of Sciences,
 1980).   Loading rates  for  bromide  should  include  consideration  of  plant
 uptake  and  leachate losses to  maintain  the  concentration  in the  soil  below
 phytotoxic  levels.
 6.1.5.4   Iodide
      Iodide  is present in several  industrial  wastes including  those  gener-
ated  by the pharmaceutical  industry and  the  analytical chemical  industry.
Iodides  naturally occur in  soils  at levels ranging from 0.1-10 ppm  (Table
6.19).   It is  only  slightly water  soluble  (0.001 m) and  is  thought  to  be
retained  in soil by forming complexes with organic matter and possibly  by
being  fixed with soil  phosphates and sulfates (Whitehead,  1975).

      Iodide  is  not  essential  for  plant  growth,  but  it   is  an  essential
nutrient  for  animals.   Soluble  iodide in wastes will  be  readily taken up  by
plants  and animals  consuming  large quantities  of iodide-rich forage  may
ingest  toxic  levels.  Phytotoxic  concentrations  of iodide  in plant  tissues
and of water  soluble iodide  in  soils are given in Table  6.20.   It  should  be
noted  that toxic responses  may be  partially  a  result  of  excess   salts  not
iodide.   The upper  levels  of  chronic  lifetime  dietary  exposure   of  iodide
(dry  weight concentration in the  diet) that  will not result  in  a loss  of
production for  cattle  is  50 ppm  and swine,  400  ppm  (National Academy  of
Sciences,  1980),

     Loading  rate calculations  for  the  land  treatment of wastes  containing
iodide should  include  iodide taken  up by  plants  and leached, from the soil
to maintain the  concentration in the soil below phytotoxic  levels.
6.1.6                              Metals
     The  metallic components  of waste  are  found in  a. variety  of  forms.
Metals  may be  solid phase  insoluble precipitates,  sorbed  or chelated  by
organic matter  or  oxides,  sorbed on exchange sites of waste  constituents  or
soil  colloids,  or in  the soil  solution.   If  an element  is essentially

                                     198

-------
insoluble at usual  soil pH ranges  (5.5-8.0) then the metal  has a low con-
centration in the soil solution and cannot  be absorbed by plants or leached
at an appreciable rate.  If  the metal  is strongly sorbed or chelated, even
though it is not precipitated, it will have low plant uptake and low leach-
ing potential.   If  the metal  is  weakly  sorbed and  soluble, then  it   is
available  for  plant  uptake  or  transport  by leaching  or  runoff.   When
present  in  this  soluble form metals  may  accumulate in plants to excess.
Little specific information on metal immobilization  is available so treata-
bility tests should be  designed to  determine  the mobility of  a given metal
in a given waste-site environment (Chapter  7).

     Although many HWLT units will  not  use plants as a part of the ongoing
management  plan,  plant uptake of metals is  discussed  extensively in this
section  since closure  of  sites  generally requires a vegetative cover (EPA,
1982).   Metals  may be  applied in  excess  of  the phytotoxic level if they
continue to be immobilized in the treatment zone.  However,  since  a vegeta-
tive cover will be necessary  at closure  (unless hazardous constituents show
no increase over background),  highly  contaminated soils may need  to  be  re-
moved  and  disposed  in another  hazardous waste  facility.    This  could
increase the  cost  associated with  disposal and  make consideration of more
land and lower loading  rates  a viable option.

     Plants do not  accumulate metals  in a  consistent proportional  relation-
ship to  soil concentrations.  Thus, predictions  of  the  plant concentrations
of a  metal resulting  from growing on  metal containing  soil  is  extremely
difficult.  Due  to the variability of  soil properties and  conditions,  and
plant  species, lists  are given for each metal,  when available,  to provide
the broadest range  of  operating conditions.

     The  reaction  of  plants  to metals  in  the  growth  media depends  on
whether  or  not the  element is  plant essential.   The upper half of Fig.  6.13
shows  the  response of  plants to an essential nutrient.  At low concentra-
tions  the  metal,is deficient; at higher concentrations of  the element   the
plant  reaches  optimum  growth and additional  metal  concentrations  have
little  effect;  at  very high  concentrations  the  metal will  become  toxic.
The  response  of  plants  to  nonessential   metals,  in  which  no  deficiency
results, is shown  in the lower half of  Fig. 6.13.

     Most  positively  charged metals  remain in  the  treatment zone  under
aerated  conditions  where they are  immobilized, either  temporarily or some-
what permanently,  by  the properties of  the soil  itself.   The mechanisms of
metal  retention by soil are described in Section 4.1.2.1 and  include chemi-
sorptlon and  electrostatic bonding.  Chemical sorption is  a more permanent
type of  metal retention than electrostatic sorption and is primarily due to
the  mineralogy  of  the soil.    Electrostatic  bonding,  or  ion  exchange,
increases  as  the  CEC  of  the  soil  increases and  is reversible.   A direct
comparison between CEC and the sorption capacity of the  soil is not possi-
ble, however, since competition between ions in the waste or  present in  the
native  soil will  influence the quantity of metal ions sorbed  by the soil.

     A variety of mathematical  relationships  has  been  used  to quantify
sorption of metals  to soils.   These  models,  generally  called  isotherms,

                                     199

-------
 100-1—
ft
*
3
ui
 so-
           DEFICIENT
                 SEVERELY
                 LIMITING
               | NO GROWTH
                             OPTIMUM
                                            LUXURY]
                                CONSUMPTION
                                                 TOXIC
                                                               LETHAL
               CONCENTRATION OF NUTRIENT-
100-
 50-
            NON - ESSENTIAL UPTAKE
                                                    TOXIC
                                                               LETHAL
              CONCENTRATION  OF NONESSENTIAL ELEMENTS -
 Figure  6.13.  Schematic diagram  of the yield response
                to an  essential but  toxic element  (top
                diagram)  and a nonessential toxic  element
                (bottom diagram),
                              200

-------
include the linear, Freundlich, Langmuir,  two-surface  Langmuir  and various
kinetic sorption isotherms.  The models provide a reasonably good basis for
interpolation of metal  sorption and  are  extensively  reviewed by Travis and
Etnier  (1981)  who  include numerous  references  for a variety  of metals.
Bohn et al.  (1979) discuss isotherm  theory in detail.   Sorption isotherm
experiments may  be included as part of laboratory  analysis  for treatment
demonstration of metal immobilization.

     The partitioning of metals between various chemical forms is a dynamic
process, regulated  by  equilibrium reactions.  The initial  behavior of the
metal after addition  to the soil largely  depends  on the form  in which it
was added, which in turn, depends on its source.  A complex set of chemical
reactions, physical and  chemical  characteristics of  the soil, and a number
of biological processes  acting within  the  soil govern  the ultimate fate of
metallic elements.

     This section discusses the sources of metal enrichment to the environ-
ment as well as background soil and plant concentrations.  The soil chemis-
try of  each metal including solubility, metal  species and  soil  conditions
governing the  predominant  form of  the metal  are  presented.   Following a
review of metal chemistry, the fate of each metal in the soil, whether bio-
accumulated, sorbed by  soil or waste constituents,  or  transported, is dis-
cussed.   Finally,  recommendations  for  metal loading  are  given based on
accumulation in the soil and plant  and animal toxicity.  These recommenda-
tions are generally based on  the accumulation of  the  element  within the
upper  15  cm (6  in) of  soil,  or "plow  layer," which is estimated  to be
2 x 10° Ib/acre  or 2.2  x  10"  kg/ha.   In  developing  the recommendations,
consideration was  given to the 20-year Irrigation  standards developed by
the  National  Academy  of  Sciences  and  National Academy   of  Engineering
(1972)  which  are  based on the   tolerance  of  sensitive plants,  to metal
chemistry, and to  other sources  of information on  plant and animal  toxic-
ity.  There are more  data  available on plant  and  animal toxicity to metal
concentrations in the soil than on  the ability of the  soil to  immobilize  a
given element.  Consequently,  treatability studies are generally needed to
determine if adequate immobilization of metals is occurring  in  a  given  soil
since the factors affecting immobilization  are very  site-specific.


6.1.6.1  Aluminum (Al)
     Hazardous  wastes  containing Al  include  paper  coating  pretreatment
sludge  and  deinking sludge.   It is one  of the most  abundant elements  in
soils, occuring at an average concentration of  71,000  ppm.

     Aluminum exists in many forms in soil.  There are several  Al  oxide  and
hydroxide minerals  including A1(OH)3  (amorphous, bayerite,  and  gibbsite)
and A100H (diaspora  and boehmite) (Lindsay, 1979).   In soils with pH less
than  5.0,  exchangeable  Al is  found as  the trivalent ion  (Bohn et al.,
1979).   In  an  alkaline medium,  Al  is present as  (ADOH^*".   Aluminum  in
soil  may be  precipitated as  Al phosphates;  this  reaction removes  plant
essential phosphate  from  the  soil  solution.   Where  the  NaOH:Al ratio  is

                                     201

-------
greater  than  3:0,  polymerization of Al and  hydroxide  ions may lead  to  the
formation of  crystalline Al hydroxide  minerals  (Hsu,  1977).

     The  most soluble  form  of  Al  found in most soils  is  A1(OH>3  (amor-
phous) and  other Al oxides are somewhat less soluble.   At pH 4.06,  96  ppm
soluble Al  may be  found in a particular soil solution,  yet  when  the  pH is
raised to 7.23, the Al concentration  in the same soil solution  is  reduced
to zero (Pratt, 1966a).  Aluminum is highly  unstable  in  the  normal pH range
of soils and  readily oxidizes  to Al34  (Lindsay,  1979).

     There  is no evidence  that Al  is  essential  to plants.   Sensitivity to
Al varies widely and some  plants may be harmed by low  concentrations of  the
element  in  the  growing media  (Table  6.22).  Very  sensitive plants  whose
growth  is   depressed  by soil  concentrations of   2  ppm  Al  include  barley
(Hordeum  vulgare),  beet   (Beta  vulgaris),  lettuce  (Lactuca  sativa)  and
timothy  (Phleum  pratense).   Tolerant plants  depressed  by  14  ppm Al  are
corn (Zea mays), redtop (Agrostis gigantea)  and  turnip  (Brassica rapa).   An
interesting Al indicator plant is the  hydrangea which  produces  blue flowers
if Al  is available  in the  growth  medium  and  pink  flowers  if  Al is  not
available (Pratt,  1966a).

     There  are some accumulator plants that can tolerate large  amounts of
Al.   Accumulator   plants  that  transport Al to  above-ground parts  include
club  moss,   sweetleaf  (Symplocos  tinctoria),   Australian  silk  oak,  and
hickory  (Juncus  sp.).   Aluminum  concentrations  of  3.0-30  ppm have  been
reported for  ash (Fraxinus sp.)  and hickory  (Pratt,  1966a).

     Loehr  at al.  (1979b)  state that  Al poses  relatively little  hazard to
animals.   Cattle   and  sheep  can tolerate  dietary levels of  1000  ppm  Al.
Poultry, considered  sensitive  to the  element,  can tolerate  dietary levels
of 200 ppm  Al (National Academy  of  Sciences, 1980).

     Aluminum levels in sludge seldom  limit  application  rates,  particularly
if the pH  is  maintained above  5.5  and the  soil  is  well aerated  (Loehr et
al., 1979b).  With proper pH  management,  large  amounts  of  Al may  be land
applied.
6.1.6.2  AntimonyjSb)
     The major  producers of  hazardous wastes  containing Sb are  the paint
formulation  Industry,   textile   mills,   and  organic  chemical  producers.
Concentrations  of  Sb  range  from  0.5-5 ppm  in  coal  and  30-107  ppo  in
petroleum,  and  urban  air  contains  0.05-0.06 ppm  Sb  (Overcash  and  Pal,
1979).   The average  concentration  of Sb  in  plants  is 0.06  ppm  and  the
average range of Sb in dry  soils  is  2-10 ppm (Bowen,  1966).

     Naturally occurring forms of Sb include Sb sulfides (stibinite) and Sb
oxides  (cervanite  and vale tit inite).   Antimony  in  soils usually  occurs  as
Sb3+ or Sb5"*" and is very strongly precipitated  as  Sb2<>3 or Sb20s (Overcash
and Pal, 1979).

                                     202

-------
     TABLE  6.22  PLANT RESPONSE TO ALUMINUM IN SOIL AND  SOLUTION  CULTURE
to
o
Al
Concentration
(ppm)
1-2
1-2
2-5
2-8

2-8
4

6-8
6

7

14
12



13

20

20
25

32-80

Media
Solution
Solution
Solution
Solution

Solution
Soil

Solution
Solution

Solution

Solution
Solution



Solution

Solution

Sand
Acid soil

Solution

Species
Barley (Hordeum vulgare)
Sorghum (Sorghum bi color)
Corn (Zea mays)
Kentucky bluegrass
(Poa pratensis)
Yellow foxtail
Sugar beet
(Beta vulgaris)
Rye (Secale cereale)
Wheat (Triticum aestivum)

Cabbage
(Brassica oleracea)
Turnip (Brassica rapa)
Lovegrass (Eragrostis
secundiflora) &
tall fescue (Festuca
arundinacea )
Pea (Pisum sativum)

Potato (Solanum
tuberosum)
Potato (S. tuberosum)
Cotton (Gossypium
hirsutum)
Colonial bentgrass
(Agrostis fenuis)
Effect
50% yield reduction
50% yield reduction
50% yield reduction
20% yield reduction

20% yield reduction
Significant root
growth reduction
31% yield reduction
Tolerant

No response

No response
Serious injury



Reduced growth

No response

Depressed growth
Damage

20% yield reduction

Reference
Pratt (1966a)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.

Ibid.
Keser et al. (1975)

Pratt (1966a)
Ker ridge et al.
(1971)
Pratt (1966a)

Ibid.
Fleming et al.
(1974)


Klimashevsky et al.
(1972)
Pratt (1966a)

Lee (1971a)
Velly (1974)

Pratt (1966a)

                                                  —continued-

-------
TABLE 6.22  (continued)
Al
Concentration
(ppm)
32-80
60
100 kg/ha
120-130
2000
Media
Solution
Solution
Glacial
till soil
(pH 6.5)
Acid soil
Solution
Species
Red top (Agrostis
gigantea)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Barley (H. vulgare)
Maize (Zea mays)
Peach seedlings
(Prunus persica)
Effect
20% Yield reduction
Chlorosis of leaves
Significant yield
reduction
Damage
Severe toxicity
Reference
Ibid.
Cruz et al. (1967)
Hutchinson and
Hunter (1979)
Velly (1974)
Edwards et al.
(1976)

-------
     Very high concentrations of Sb may present a hazard to plants and ani-
mals, though little information is  available.   A concentration of 4 ppm Sb
in culture solution has  been shown to produce  a  toxic response in cabbage
(Brassica oleracea) plants  (Kara  et  al.,  1977).   Bowen  (1966) points out
that Sb in industrial smoke may cause lung disease.
6.1.6.3  Arsenic (As)
     Arsenic is  contained in wastes from  the  production of certain herbi-
cides,  fungicides,  pesticides,  veterinary  Pharmaceuticals and  wood pre-
servatives.  Arsenic  levels  in municipal sewage are variable, ranging from
1-18  ppm  (Loehr  et al.,  1979a).   In  addition,  industries manufacturing
glass,  enamels,  ceramics, oil cloth,  linoleum,  electrical semiconductors
and photoconductors use  As.   The element  is  also  used to  manufacture pig-
ments, fireworks and certain types  of  alloys  (Page,  1974).

     In  soils,  the total As  concentration normally  ranges from  1-50 ppm,
though  it  does  not generally  exceed  10  ppm.   Soils  producing plants con-
taining As  at levels  toxic  to mammals are  found  in parts  of Argentina  and
New Zealand (Bowen, 1966).

     Research involving  application of As  compounds  to  agricultural  soil-
plant  systems  has  dealt  primarily with  an  anions  arsenate  (AsO^3)  and
arsenite (AsC>3~3).    Arsenate  is  an  oxidized  degradation  product from
organoarsenic defoliants and  pesticides.  Arsenite may be  formed both bio-
logically  and  abiotically  under  moderately  reduced  conditions  (Woolson,
1977).  The reduced state of As  (arsenite) is  4 to 10 times more soluble in
soils   than  the  oxidized   arsenate  and,  consequently,   more   prone   to
leaching.

     Cycling of  As in the  environment is  dominated  by  sorption  to  soils,
leaching and volatilization  (Fig. 6.14).  The most  important mechanism  for
attenuation  is  sorption  by  soil  colloids  (Murrman  and  Koutz,  1972).
Arsenic movement  in soils may be  reduced  by  sorption  to,  or  precipitation
by,  iron (Fe) and aluminum  (Al)  oxides or  calcium.   The  amount  of  As
sorbed  by  the  soil increases  as  pH and clay,  Al, and Fe  content increase
(Jacobs  et al., 1970).   Movement  of  As in  aquatic  systems often results
from As  sorption to sediments  containing  Fe  or Al  (Woolson,  1977)*   Wind
borne particles may also carry sorbed  As.   Reduction of Fe in  flooded soils
may  resolubillze  As  from   ferric  arsenate  or   arsenite  to  arsine   or
methylarsines (Deuel  and Swoboda,  1972).

     Reduction of  As  compounds under  saturated conditions  can  result in As
volatilization.   Some As may be  reduced to  As3'  and then lost as arsine, a
toxic gas  (Keaton and Kardos,  1940).   In a  study by Woolson  (1977),  how-
ever, only  1-2%  of  arsenate  applied at a rate  of  10  ppm  was volatilized as
dimethyl arsine  [(0113)2AsH]  after 160 days.   High organic matter content,
warm  temperatures and  adequate moisture  are  the conditions  conducive  to
microbial  and fungal  growth.  These  conditions may cause  the  reduction of

                                     20$

-------
                   INSOLUBLE ARSENICALS
                               (INSOLUBLE ARSENICALS I
SEDIMENTS
Figure 6.14.
              Cyclical nature of arsenic metabolism
              in different environmental compartments
              (Woolson, 1977). Reprinted by  permission
              of the National Institute of Environmental
              Health Sciences.
                          206

-------
 As and can drive the reaction toward methylation and subsequent volatiliza-
 tion of As.   Reducing conditions  may also  lead  to an  increase in  As  as
 arsenite which increases  the leaching potential of the element.

      Biomagnification through the  food chain  does  not  occur with the arse-
 nicals.    Lower  members  of  the  aquatic food  chain  contain the  highest  As
 residues (Woolson,  1977);  typically brown algae contain about 30 ppm As and
 mollusks contain about 0.005 ppm As  (Bowen,  1966).   In plants,  the  As con-
 centration  varies   between  0.01-1.0 ppm.    Even  plants   grown in  soils
 contaminated with As  do  not show  higher  concentrations of As  than plants
 grown on  uncontaminated  soil.   The toxicity  of  As  limits plant  growth
 before large amounts of As  are absorbed and translocated (Liebig, 1966).

      There is no evidence that As  is essential for  plant  growth.   Arsenic
 accumulates   in  much  larger  amounts  in  plant  roots  than  in  the  tops.
 Arsenic  in  soils  is most toxic  to plants at  the seedling stage where  it
 limits germination and reduces viability.  The  concentration of  As  that is
 toxic to plants was  determined  to  be  greater  than 10 ppm  by the  National
 Academy  of  Sciences  and  National  Academy  of Engineering  (1972).   Initial
 symptoms of  As toxicity include  wilting  followed by reduction  of  root and
 top growth (Liebig,  1966).

      Arsenic at  1 ppm in nutrient  solution reduces  root and  top growth of
 cowpeas  (Vigna unguiculata) and concentrations  of  soluble  As as  low as 0.5
 ppm  in  nutrient  solution  produce  an  80%   yield  reduction in  tomatoes
 (Lycoperslcon esculentum).   Sudan  grass  (Sorghum  sudanense),  considered to
 be  quite   tolerant,   does   not   show  growth  reduction   until   the  As
 concentration in the soil reaches  12 ppm  (National Academy of Sciences and
 National Academy of Engineering, 1972).   Table 6.23 lists  the response of
 various  crops to As  levels  in soil  and solution culture, and  it  indicates  a
 wide response to As  depending on the plant species.

      The toxicity of As  to animals  results  from its  interaction  with the
 sulhydryl groups or  SH radicals of  some  enzymes (Turner, 1965).   The  inor-
 ganic forms  of As are much  more toxic than the  organic forms  which  are more
 rapidly  eliminated by animals.  Frost (1967) states  that a  dietary level of
 10 ppm As will  be  toxic  to any  animal.   There is  little  evidence  that As
 compounds  are carcinogenic in experimental animals (Milner,  1969) although
 studies  indicate that human* subjects  chronically exposed  to As compounds
 have  a significantly increased incidence  of cancer (Yen, 1973).

      The  greatest  danger  from As to livestock is in drinking water where As
 is  present as inorganic oxides.    An upper limit  of  0.2 ppm As  is recom-
mended for livestock drinking water.   A concentration  of  0.05  ppm is the
upper  allowable  limit for  As  in  water  intended  for  human  consumption
 (National  Academy of  Sciences  and National  Academy of Engineering,  1972).

     A review by Overcash  and  Pal (1979) indicates  that  As is toxic  to
plants at  soil  application  rates  between  200  and  1000  kg/ha.    However,
Table  6.23 indicates  that  some plant  species  may  be affected by less than
 100 ppm  As in the soil.   A soil accumulation  of  between  100 and  300 ppm
appears acceptable for most  land  treatment  units.

                                     207

-------
     TABLE 6.23  PLANT  RESPONSE TO ARSENIC IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
          As
     Concentration
         (ppm)
             Media
                      Species
      Effect
      Reference
to
o
CO
         2-26
           8
85


100


100

450
           Soil
           Sand
          50          Clay  loam

          80          Silt  loam
                      Soil


                      Soil

                      Soil
              Potatoes (Solanum
               tuberosum)

              Rye (Secale cereale)
                         Horse bean  (Vicia  faba)

                         Maize (Zea  mays)
Loamy sand    Blueberry
              Reed canary grass
               (Phalaris arundinacea)

              Apple (Malus sp.) trees

              Apple (Malus ap.) trees
None


Translocated to
 shoots and leaves

Decreased growth

Toxic


Plant injury


No effect


Decreased size

Zero growth
Steevens et al. (1972)


Chrenekova E. (1973)


Chrenekova C. (1977)

Jacobs and Keeney
 (1970)

Anastasia and Render
 (1973)

Hess and Blanchar
 (1977)

Benson et al. (1978)

Benson et al. (1978)

-------
6.1.6.4  Barium (Ba)
     Barium is found in waste  streams  from a large number of manufacturing
plants in  quantities  that seldom  exceed  the normal  levels  found in  soil.
Normal  background  levels for  soil  range  from  100-3000  ppm  Ba  (Bowen,
1966).

     Although Ba is not essential  to plant growth, soluble salts  of Ba  are
found in  the  accumulator  plant Aragalus  lamberti.  Barium accumulation  in
plants is unusual except when the Ba concentration exceeds calcium (Ca)  and
magnesium (Mg) concentrations in the soil, a  condition which may occur when
sulfate is  depleted.   Liming generally restores a favorable Ca:Ba  balance
in soil (Vanselow,  1966a).   All the soluble  salts of Ba, which  exclude  Ba
sulfate,  are  highly toxic  to  man  when  taken  by  mouth.  There  is  little
information  available  on  which  to  base  a  Ba  loading  rate  for  HWLT
facilities.
6.1.6.5  Beryllium (Be)
     Beryllium may  be  found in waste  streams from smelting  industries  and
atomic energy projects.   The major source of  Be in the environment  is  the
combustion  of  fossil fuels  (Tepper,  1972).   Soil  concentrations  generally
range from  0.1 to 40 ppm, with  the  average around 6 ppm.

     Beryllium reacts  similarly to aluminum.  It undergoes  isomorphic sub-
stitution as well as cation  exchange  reactions.   It is strongly immobilized
in  soils  by sorption.    It  is  present  in  the  soil  solution  as Be^"*"  and
it may displace divalent  cations  already on sorption  sites.   It is  readily
precipitated by liming.

     Beryllium becomes hazardous when found in  soil  solutions  or  ground-
water  supplies.   It may  be taken  up by  plants at  levels  that  result  in
yield reduction; phytotoxicity  of Be is caused  by  the inhibition of enzyme
activity  (Williams  and  LeRiche,   1968).    The   growth  inhibiting  effects
usually recognized  in  higher plants are reduced as the pH  is  raised above
6.0, and it has  been proposed that  the  decreased toxicity  is  caused by Be
precipitation at high  pH  levels  (Romney and  Childress, 1965).  The response
of plants to Be applied to  soil is  given in  Table 6.24 which indicated that
40  ppm  Be  in soil  did not  cause a yield  decrease in neutral  pH soils  but
substantially decreased  plant  yields  in quartz  soils.   Table  6.25 illus-
trates that a very  soluble  Be salt  will decrease plant yields substantially
when present in soil concentrations of 20  ppm.
                                     209

-------
TABLE 6.24  YIELDS OF GRASS AND  KALE  WITH LEVELS  OF BERYLLIUM IN QUARTZ AND
            SOIL*


Soil pH
Lincolnshire 7.5


Hertfordshire 7.5


Quartz t



Soluble Be
Added (ppm)
0
0.4
40.0
0
0.4
40.0
0
0.4
40.0
Mean
Fresh
Grass
13.3
17.2
19.9
21.3
31.0
25.0
6.4
7.9
0.1
Yield of
Matter (G)
Kale
36.0
46.0
42.8
44.8
55.6
57.0
2.8
1.8
0.1
* Williams and LaRiche  (1968).

t Not available.


TABLE 6.25  YIELD OF BEANS GROWN ON VINA SOIL TREATED WITH BERYLLIUM SALTS
            DIFFERING IN  SOLUBILITY*
Be Applied to
Form
BeO



(Be05) 00 2 5H20



BeS04 4H20



Be(N03)2 3H20



Soil SnliiMHtv nf Re Salt
ppm g/100 ml Cold Water
2.3 x ID'5
0
10
20
Insoluble
0
10
20
42.5
0
10
20
Very soluble
0
10
20
Yield Dry Plant
Tops (g)

8.76
8.72
8.64

8.68
8.36
8.30

8.81
7.03
5.92

8.31
6.09
2.97
* Roaney and Childress  (1965).

                                     210

-------
Beryllium is a suspected  carcinogen.   Experimental data indicate Be causes
cancer in animals and epidemiological studies report a significant increase
in respiratory cancers among Be workers (Reeves and Vorwald, 1967; Mancuso,
1970).

     Recommendations  established in  the  National  Academy of  Science and
National Academy of Engineering  (1972) Water Quality Criteria limit irriga-
tion over the short-term  to  water containing 0.50  ppm  Be; water for  long-
term irrigation is  limited  to  0.20 ppm.   The use  of  irrigation water con-
taining the  upper  limit of  the  acceptable  Be  concentration recommended by
the National Academy of Sciences and National Academy of Engineering (1972)
is equivalent to an accumulation of 50 ppm  Be in the soil. Table  6.24  shows
that soil concentrations of  40 ppm  do  not cause a decrease in plant yields
if applied  to a neutral  pH soil.   Thus,  a comparison  of  the  irrigation
water  standard  and the  phytotoxic limit  appears   to provide  a  reasonable
estimate of  the acceptable cumulative soil  Be level of  50  ppm.
6.1.6.6  Cadmium (Cd)
     Cadmium is  used  in the production of Cd-nickel batteries,  as  pigments
for  plastics  and enamels, as  a fumiclde, and  in electroplating and  metal
coatings  (EPA,  1980a).   Wastes containing significant  levels  of Cd include
paint formulating  and textile wastes.  The estimated  mean  Cd  concentration
of soil is 0.06  ppm,  ranging  from  0.01-0.7 ppm (Siegel, 1974).

     The  soil chemistry  of  Cd  is,  to a great  extent,  controlled by  pH.
Under acidic conditions Cd solubility increases and very little sorption of
Cd  by  soil  colloids,   hydrous oxides,   and   organic matter   takes  place
(Anderson  and  Nilsson,   1974).    Street   et  al.  (1977) found  a  100-fold
increase  in Cd  sorption  for each unit increase in pH.

     Solid  phase  control of  Cd by  precipitation  has been reported  under
high pH conditions.   Figure 6.15 illustrates  that  the formation of Cd(OH)4
controls  the  equilibrium concentration of Cd at high pH values.  Precipita-
tion of  Cd  with  carbonates  (CdC03)  and phosphates  (Cd3(P04)2) may regu-
late Cd concentration in the  soil  solution at  low  pH  values.   Under reduc-
ing  conditions,  such  as poorly drained soils,  the  precipitation of Cd sul-
fide may  occur.  Since this  compound is  relatively stable  and slowly oxi-
dized, a  lag  occurs between the formation of Cd sulfide and the release of
Cd to the soil  solution.

     Cadmium  may also be sorbed by organic matter in the soil as soluble or
insoluble organometa.llic complexes or by sorption to hydrous oxides of iron
and  manganese (Peterson  and  Alloway, 1979).   Evidence  suggests that these
sorption  mechanisms may be the  primary  source of Cd  removal  from the soil
solution  except at very high Cd levels.   Column studies by Emmerich et al.
(1982)  show  that  no leaching  of  Cd occurred  from  sewge sludge amended
soils,  all  of which  had  CEC  values between 5  and  15.  Of  the 25.5 ppm Cd
applied  to  the  Ramona  soil,  24.7  ppm or 97%  of the  Cd was recovered from
                                      211

-------
1.0

0.9

0.8

0.7


0.6


0.5


0.4

0.3

0.2


0.1


0.0 -

 -10
             Cd
               4- +
                                   Cd(OHi4
                          H+   CdlOHlg
                           CdlOHlo
            1
-8
•6         -4
 log  [OH]
-2
              6
             8          10
                 pH
                       12
            14
   Figure 6.15.  Distribution of molecular and ionic species of
                 divalent cadmium at different pH values (Fuller,
                 1977).
                             212

-------
the columns.   Y.et,  as the equilibrium  between sorbed Cd and  soil  solution
Cd changes, some sorbed Cd may  be  released  to  the  soil solution.

     Land  treatment of Cd containing  waste  can affect microbial  populations
as well  as plant and animal  life.   Microorganisms exhibit  varying degrees
of tolerance  or intolerance  toward  Cd.  Williams  and Wollum (1981)  found
that 5 ppm Cd in the growing media  retards Actinomycete and  soil  bacteria
growth,  but  at concentrations greater  than 5  ppm,  the  microorganisms
exhibited  a tolerant response  and the tolerant  population attained  domi-
nance  in  the  cultures.    Borges  and Wollum  (1981)  reported  Khizobium
japonicum  strains  associated  with   soybean   (Glycine  max)  plants  showed
tolerance  to  Cd and  that  after  time, R., japonuim  strains  develop the abil-
ity to accomodate the element.

     The long-term  availability of Cd  to plants is related  to several soil
properties, the presence  of  other  ions in the soil solution,  and the plant
species.   Soil  organic matter,  bydrous oxides, redox  potential,  and pH (the
dominant factor) influence  the  concentration of Cd in the  soil  solution as
well as its availability  to plants.   Liming reduces Cd uptake by plants and
increases  Cd  sorption by  soil  (CAST,  1976),  while  acidification  releases
the Cd bound  in hydrous  oxides.  High  organic matter in soil reduces plant
uptake of  the element (White  and Chaney,  1980).

     Cadmium  absorbed by  plant  roots is slowly translocated to the leaf and
stem.  The  metabolic  processes  responsible  for Cd absorption are influenced
by temperature  (Schaeffer et al.,  1975;  Haghiri, 1974)  and other minerals
in the nutritive solution (Cunningham et al., 1975;  Miller et  al.,  1977).
Chaney (1974) proposed  that zinc-cadmium interactions reduce the amount of
Cd taken up by  plants when the concentration  of Cd  is  less  than IT, of the
zinc (Zn)  content in  the  sludge.   This is due to  the competition of  Zn and
Cd for -SH groups of  proteins and enzymes in  plants.  Since the content of
Zn and Cd  taken up  by plants  is not  always  related  to the  concentration in
waste, the  principle  of  the Zn-Cd interrelationship  should not  be the  sole
basis for  determining loading rates.   Calcium has  been shown to depress Cd
content  in plants  because these divalent cations  compete for adsorption by
roots.

     Crops  differ  markedly in  their  Cd accumulation,  tolerance  and  trans-
location.   The  foliar Cd concentrations  associated with phytotoxicity  vary
in different  crops  from 5 to  700 ppm,  dry weight  (Chaney et al., 1981) yet
the phytotoxicity of  Cd does  not  limit Cd in crops to acceptable limits for
animal consumption.   Soil additions  of Cd at a rate  of 4.5 kg/ha/yr  for two
consecutive years raised  the  Cd content of  corn (Zea mays)  leaves  from  0.15
to 0.71 ppm,  while  the increase was  less significant to grain (Overcash and
Pal, 1979).   Cadmium additions  ranging from 11 to 7640 ppm  in soil resulted
in reduced yields  of various  forage crops (Table  6,26).   Melsted  (1973)
suggested  a tolerance limit  of  3 ppm Cd  in  agronomic crops.  The  influence
of Cd concentration on the  growth of various plants  is given  in Table 6.27.
The  yield  and  Cd  concentration in  the leaves  of  bennudagrass  grown In
sewage sludge containing Cd are given in Table 6.28.   Recently, Cd  toler-
ance has been found in grasses  in some populations from Germany  and  Belgium
(Peterson  and Alloway, 1979).   Tomato (Lycopersicon  esculentum) and  cabbage

                                      213

-------
 (Brassica  oleracea)  are  considered Cd tolerant and soybean (Glycine max) is
 considered rather  sensitive.
TABLE  6.26   CADMIUM ADDITION TO A CALCAREOUS SOIL ASSOCIATED WITH A 50%
             YIELD  REDUCTION  OF  FIELD  AND VEGETABLE CROPS*


                                                     Cd Addition rate
                                                    reducing yield 50%
                     Crop                                  mg/kg

       Soybean  (Glycine max)                                  11
       Sweet  corn (Zea may s)                                  35
       Upland rice  (Oryza sativa)                             36
       Sudan  grass  (Sorghum sudanense)                       58
       Field  bean (Phaseolus  sp.)                             65
       Wheat  (Triticum aestivum)                              80
       Turnip (Brassica rapa)                                100
       White  clover  (Trifolium sp.)                          120
       Alfalfa  (Medicago sativa)                             145
       Swiss  chard  (Beta vulgaris  var. Cicla)               320
       Tall fescue  (Festuca arundinacea)                     320
       Bermudagrass  (Cynodon  dactylon)                      400
       Paddy  rice (Oryza sativa)                           7,640

* Page et al.  (1972).
     Cadmium  can be quite  toxic to aquatic  organisms, even  in  concentra-
tions  of  less than  1  ppm  Cd in water;  therefore,  runoff  or movement  of
particles containing Cd into  water  must  be  avoided.   Coombs  (1979) reviewed
the  Cd content  in  fish,  marine  mammals,  invertebrates,  and  plankton  and
determined  the toxic  levels  of  Cd for  each species.   Experimental  data
indicate that  Cd  causes  cancer in  animals  (Lucis  et al., 1972).   However,
there have not been any large scale epidemiological  studies  to show signif-
icant association between occupational exposure  to Cd and cancer  in workers
(Sunderman, 1977).  Acceptable Cd levels for crops used  for  animal feed  or
human consumption have not  been  established although adverse health effects
from  prolonged consumption of  food grown  on   Cd  enriched   soils is  well
documented (Tsuchiya,  1978; Friberg et al.,  1974).

     The National Academy of  Sciences and  National Academy  of Engineering
(1972) and Dowdy et al.  (1976)  suggest  maximum cumulative  applications  of
Cd should not  exceed  3 mg/kg or 10 ppm  when added  in sewage  sludge.   EPA
cumulative  criteria have  adjusted  application  levels  to  5  kg/ha Cd  for
soils with a  pH less   than  6.5 and  for  soils with  a pH greater  than  6.5,
                                     214

-------
      TABLE 6.27  PLANT RESPONSE TO CADMIUM IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
           Cd
      Concent rat ion
          (ppm)
              Media
                       Species
                                   Effect
                          Reference
N)
l-«
Ln
 1
 1

 2

3-5
10
25
25
30

50
50

65

100

100
600
Solution
Soil

Rooting
 medium
Soil
Sand

Solution

Soil
Soil
Soil
Soil

Soil
Soil
 (pH 7.3)
Solution

Sandy
 soil
Soil
Yolo silt
 loam
Purple nutsedge
Pin oak  (Quercus
 palustris)
Honeylocust
 (Gleditsia triacanthos)
Soybean  (Glycine max)
Soybean  (G. max)

Rice (Orzya sativa)
 seedlings
Wheat (Triticum aestivum)
Beans (Phaseolus aureus)
Maize (Zea mays)
(Rudbecki hirta)

Oats (Avena sativa)
Soybean  (G_. max)

Cotton (Gossypium
 hirsutum)
Little bluestern
 (Schizachyrium scoparium)
White pine (Pinus strobus)
Cotton (G. hirsutum)
Growth reduction
Chlorosis
Reduced root
 growth

Depressed growth
Severe growth
 reduction
Growth redution

Reduced growth
Growth inhibition
Depressed growth
25% germination
 reduction
Chlorsis
Relatively
 resistant
Yield reduction

Tolerant

Reduced yield
15% yield reduc-
 tion
                                                                                    Quimby  et al.  (1979)
                                                                                    Russo and Brennan  (1979)
                                                                                    Lamoreaux et al. (1978)
Miller et al. (1976)
Chaney et al. (1977)

Saito and Takahashi
 (1978)
Keul et al. (1979)
Jain (1978)
Hassett et al. (1976)
Miles and Parker (1979)

Kloke and Schenke (1979)
Boggess et al. (1978)

Rehab and Wallace
 (1978d)
Miles and Parker (1979)

Kelly et al. (1979)
Rehab and Wallace
 (1978e)

-------
ON
     TABLE 6.28   CADMIUM CONTENT OF BERMUDAGRASS ON THREE SOILS WITH DIFFERENT APPLICATIONS OF  SEWAGE
                  SLUDGE
Sludge applied
per hectare,
metric tons
80
80
80
80
80
80
80
Cd added per
gram of soil
mg
0.40
0.59
1.08
1.56
2.05
3.03
4.00

PH
6.6
6.7
6.8
6.8
6.8
6.8
6.7
Domino Soil
Cd per gram of
dry matter, mg
0.41
0.40
0.78
0.85
1.30
2.64
3.56

PH
5.6
5.4
5.4
5.5
5.5
5.6
5.5
Harford Soil
Cd per gram of
dry matter , mg
0.44
0.49
1.60
1.73
2.95
4.00
3.52

PH
5.6
5.4
5.1
5.2
5.4
5.3
5.1
Redding Soil
Cd per gram
dry matter,
1.55
2.94
5.68
4.65
4.02
6.60
8.72

of
mg







     *  Page  (1974).

-------
maximum  cumulative  amounts  of  Cd  are  allowed  to  increase  with  GEC
(5 meq/100  g,  5  kg/ha;  5-15  meq/100  g,  10 kg/ha;  and  >15 meq/100  g,
20 kg/ha) (EPA, 1982).  It is recommended that the level of Cd in wastes be
reduced to  below  15-20  mg Cd/kg waste by pretreatment  if  at all possible.
This  review indicates soil microbial  populations can be  affected  by soil
concentrations of 5 ppm, but plant populations exhibit a high  tolerance for
the element.  Therefore,  the basis  for  Cd loading should not be phytotoxic
response but  the  ability  of  the soil to  immobilize  Cd.   Liming  the soil
supplies carbonates and calcium ions which help  immobilize Cd.  Liming also
serves  to   maintain  an  equilibrium  between  the soluble  and precipitated
forms of Cd in soil, thus  reducing the hazard of  Cd mobilization.


6.1.6.7  Cesium (Cs)
     Cesium metals are used in research  on  thermoionic  power  conversion  and
ion  propulsion.   Cesium-137  contamination may  occur  by  nuclear  fallout.
Cesium-137 is a beta emitter with a half  life  of  33  years.  Soil  concentra-
tions range from 0.3-25 ppm Cs, with  an  average of 6 ppm (Bowen,  1966).

     Although Cs is  retained  in field crops  and  grasses over  long  periods
of time,  phytotoxic  levels  have  not  been reported.   One explanation  of  Cs
tolerance may be that  potassium  (K) provides protection against  plant con-
tamination  by  Cs since the  two monovalent cations   may  compete for  plant
absorption  (Konstantinov  et  al.,  1974).   Cesium uptake  in  plants increases
with nitrogen fertilization, possibly reflecting  exchangeable Cs concentra-
tions  in soil.   Fertilization  with  phosphorus  and  potassium  decreases  Cs
concentrations  in most  plants.   Weaver  et  al. (1981)  found  that  kale
(Brassica campestris) accumulated more Cs-137  in  the early  stages of growth
than after  four weeks of growth.  The average  concentration of Cs in plants
is 0.2  ppm, and  pytotoxicity would not  be  expected  in Cs  amended  soils if
adequate K  is available.
6.1.6.8  Chromium  (Cr)
     The  sources of Cr  in waste  streams  are from  its  use as  a corrosion
inhibitor and  from  dyeing and tanning industries.   Chromium is  used in the
manufacture  of  refractory bricks  to line  metallurgical  furnaces,  chrome
steels  and  alloys, and  in plating  operations.   Other  uses of  Cr  include
topical  antiseptics  and  astringents,  defoliants   for   certain  crops  and
photographic  emulsions  (Page,  1974).   Chromium is  widely distributed in
soils, water,  and biological  materials.   The range  of Cr in native soils is
1-1000  ppm with an average  concentration  of  100  ppm  Cr (Bowen,  1966).
Soils derived  from  serpentine rocks are  very high in Cr and nickel.

     The Cr in most industrial wastes is present in the +6 oxidation state
as  chromate (CrO^"^) or  as dichromate (C^Oy"^).  In  this  +6  or hexavalent
form, Cr is toxic and  quite mobile in soil*  Under  acid conditions there is
a  conversion   from  chromate to dichromate.   Soluble  salts  of Cr,  such as

                                     217

-------
sulfate  and  nitrate, are  more toxic  than insoluble  salts  of  Cr  such  as
oxides and phosphates.  This toxicity becomes more  important  as  the  acidity
of the soil is increased (Aubert and Pinta,  1977).   Overcash  and Pal  (1979)
State that in  an  aerobic  acid soil, hexavalent  Cr  is quickly converted  to
the less toxic trivalent Cr  or chromic,  which is quite immobile; they  con-
sider the trivalent form to be relatively  inert  in  soils.  The oxidation  of
trivalent to  hexavalent Cr  has  not been  documented in  field  studies but
does  warrant  further  consideration because  of  the extreme  toxicity and
mobility of the hexavalent form.

     Downward  transport of  Cr will be more  rapid in coarse-textured  soils
than  in  fine  textured  soils  because  of  the  larger pores,  less clay and
faster  downward   movement  of  water.     Chromium (III)  forms precipitates
readily  with  carbonates,  hydroxides  and  sulfides  and  would likely be  a
means of  reducing leaching  (Murrmann  and Koutz,  1972).   These precipita-
tion  reactions  are also favored  by a pH>6.   Data  from  Wentink and  Edzel
(1972) show that  these  different soils  were  capable of almost  100%  reten-
tion of Cr(III).

     Chromium has been shown  to  be  toxic to plants  and animals, and  recent
studies Indicate  it may also  be  toxic  to soil microorganisms.   Ross  et al.
(1981) found that levels as  low as 7.5  ppm in  the  growth media were  toxic
to gram  negative  bacteria  including Pseudomonas and Nocardia.   This  indi-
cates that soil microbial  transformations such  as nitrification and  hydro-
carbon  degradation  may be   adversely   affected by Cr.    Rudolfs  (1950)
reviewed the literature on metals  in  sewage sludge  and recommended  a 5 ppm
limit for Cr+6 in sewage  sludge which is  land  treated.   Mutations  in  bac-
terial  populations  have   also  been  observed   in   bacteria  grown  in  the
presence of Cr+6  (Petrilli and De Flora,  1977).

     Many investigators have  found  that  Cr is toxic to plants.   Bichromate
is apparently more phytotoxic  than  chromate  (Pratt,  1966b)  and that  both  of
these tetravalent forms are more  toxic than  the trivalent  state  (Hewitt,
1953).   Application  of  75  ppm  Cr to  soil  is  not  toxic  to  sweet-orange
(Citrus  slnensis) seedlings,  but  additions  of  150  ppm Cr are  toxic.   In
sand  cultures,  5 ppm Cr  as  chromate ion  was toxic to tobacco (Nicotiana
tabacum) and  10  ppm was toxic to  corn  (Zea mays)  (Pratt,  1966b).   Plants
affected by Cr  toxicity are  stunted and frequently  have  narrow, discolored
and necrotic leaves  (Hunter  and Vergnano,  1953).

     There is  some  indication that Cr is  accumulated in plant  roots.   The
influence of plant Cr concentration on  plant growth is given in Table 6.29
which indicates that some plants experience  decreased yield at soil concen-
trations as low as 0.5 ppm Cr. These data  indicate  that  the phytotoxic con-
centration is  greater  than 10 ppm.  Soane and  Saunder (1959) found  the  Cr
content  of  tobacco roots  to  be  twenty   times higher than  In  the  leaves  of
plants showing symptoms of Cr  toxicity.   They found only  slightly higher  Cr
levels  in  the leaves of  plants showing toxic   symptoms  than in leaves  of
healthy  plants.   Therefore,  translocation of  Cr from roots to the plant
tops  apparently is  not  a  serious problem.   This does not, however,  elimi-
nate Cr  as a toxic element since it has  a definite  toxic  effect  on roots.
                                     218

-------
     TABLE  6.29  PLANT RESPONSE TO CHROMIUM IN  SOIL  AND  SOLUTION CULTURE
to
Amount of
Cr (ppm)
.01


0.5

4.8
5.2

10
10
10
25
30-60
52


55

100-200


128-640
150

400

300-500
Media
Silt soil


Solution

Sand
Solution

Pot experiments
Solution
Soil
Pot experiments
Solution
Pot experiments


Sandy loam

Yolo loam


Sand & peat
Soil

Submerged soil

Soil
Species
Fescue (Festuca
clatior) & alfalfa
(Medicago sativa)
Soybean (Glycine
max)
Mustard
Cotton (Gossypium
hirsutum)
Mustard
Oat (Avena sativa)
Soybean (G. max)
Mustard
Soybean (G. max)
Potato (Solatium
tuberosum)
seedlings
Rye ( Secale
cereale)
Bush bean
(Phaseolus
limensis)
Mustard
Sweet orange
(Citrus sinensis)
Rice (Oryza sativa)

Rice (0. sativa)

Effect
No increase in
plant Cr

Reduced yield

Decreased yield
83% yield reduction

Toxic
Iron clorosis
Reduced yield
Toxic
Toxic
Threshold of
toxicity

No increase in
plant Cr
Decreased yield


Reduced yield
Toxic

Slight yield
reduction
No effect
Reference
Stucky & Newman (1977)


Turner and Rust (1971)

Gemmell (1972)
Rehab and Wallace (1978b)

Andrziewski (1971)
Hewitt (1953)
Turner and Rust (1971)
Andrziewski (1971)
Turner and Rust (1971)
Mukherji and Roy (1977)


Kelling et al. (1977)

Wallace et al. (1976)


Gemmell (1972)
Pratt (1966b)

Kamada and Doki (1977)

Silva and Beghi (1979)

-------
     Chromium is essential for  glucose metabolism in animals  and  its  activ-
ity  is  closely  tied  to that  of  insulin  (Scott,  1972).   Although  Cr  is
highly toxic  to  many  invertebrates, it  is  only moderately toxic  to  higher
animals, and  most  mammals  can  tolerate  up  to  1000  ppm  Cr in their  diets.
In animals,  however,  experimental data  have  shown conclusively that Cr  in
the hexavalent form can cause cancer (Hernberg, 1977).   The predilection  of
workers in  Cr plants  to respiratory cancer has been thoroughly  documented
in several studies and has been reviewed by Enterline (1974).

     The use  of  irrigation water containing the upper limit  of  the  accept-
able concentration of Cr recommended  by the  National  Academy of Sciences
and National Academy of Engineering (1972)  is  equivalent to an accumulation
of 1000 ppm Cr in  the soil.  Information obtained from this study indicates
that the  phytotoxic  level  of Cr in soil is  highly variable, depending  on
the soil type and  plant species,  but can be as  low as 25 ppm.   Therefore, a
more suitable criteria  on which to base loading rates  would  be  the  amount
of Cr Immobilized  by  the soil  as determined  from demonstration  of  treat-
ability tests.
6.1.6.9  Cobalt (Co)
     Cobalt is used  in the production  of  high grade steel,  alloys,  super-
alloys  and  magnetic alloys.   It is  also  used in  smaller quantities  as  a
drier  in  paints, varnishes,  enamels  and  inks.   Compounds  of  Co  are  also
used in the manufacture of  pigments and glass  (Page,  1974).   The concentra-
tion of Co  in  soils  ranges from 1-40 ppm  with an average of 8  ppm (Aubert
and Pinta,  1977).  Extensive  areas  can be  found where the Co level in soil
Is deficient for animal health  (Bowen,  1966).

     The  availability  of Co  is  primarily  regulated  by  pH  and  is  usually
found  in  soils as Co2*.   At low pH It  Is  oxidized to  Co** and often found
associated  with  iron  (Ermolenko,  1972).   Adsorption  of Co 2+on soil  col-
loids  is  high between  pH  6  and  7 (Leeper,  1978),  whereas leaching and plant
uptake  of Co  are enhanced  by  a lower  pH.   Cobalt  sorbed on soil exchange
sites  is  held more  strongly  than the  common  cations and  can   revert  to  a
more strongly sorbed form over  time  (Banerjee et al.,  1953).   Soils  natur-
ally rich In Co have a high pH  (Aubert  and Pinta,  1977).  If Co is added to
soils  containing lime, precipitation  of Co with  carbonates  can be expected
(Tiller and Hodgson, 1960).

     Cobalt is water soluble when in  the form  of  chloride, nitrate and sul-
fate salts.  At a pH of  7,  Co is  50-80% soluble when it is  associated with
cations such as  ammonium, magnesium,  calcium,  sodium and  potassium.   At pH
8.5 Co becomes  less soluble  and  cobaltous  phosphate,  a compound  which is
relatively  insoluble  in water, may regulate solubility (Young,  1948).   In
soils, Co is bound by  organic matter  and  Is very strongly  sorbed or  copre-
clpitated with manganese  oxides  (Leeper, 1978).

     There  is no evidence that  Co  is  essential for the  growth  and develop-
ment of higher plants.   It  is, however, required  for  the symbiotic fixation

                                    220

-------
of  nitrogen by  nodulating  bacteria  associated  with  legumes  (Abmed  and
Evans,  1960 &  1961; Delwiche  et  al., 1961; Reisenauer,  1960).    Excessive
amounts of  Co  can be toxic  to  plants.  Symptoms of  Co toxicity vary with
species but  are  frequently  described as  resembling that of iron  deficiency
(Vanselow,  1966b).   In  solution cultures,  Co  concentrations  as  low as  0.1
ppm produce  toxic  effects  in crop plants.   Cobalt  applications  to soil  of
0.2 ppm had no  effect  on  bean  (Fhaseolus  sp.) growth in a  study  by  dos
Santos  et  al.  (1979).    In greenhouse  experiments,  Fujlmoto  and Sherman
(1950)  found Sudan  grass (Sorghum sudanense) to be unaffected by  an appli-
cation  rate equivalent  to  224  kg/ha which  resulted  in  a Co  content   in
plants  of 3-6 ppm.   Phytotoxicity from soil Co occurs  in plants  containing
50-100  ppm  and foliar  symptoms  are  apparent  at  these  levels  (Hunter  and
Vergnano, 1953).

     A  recent study Indicates  that  plants  grown  in a Co contaminated soil
overlain by  uncontamlnated soil will accumulate large concentrations of  the
metal as  shown  in  Fig.  6.16 (Pinkerton, 1982).   This appears  to be due to
healthy vigorously  growing  roots  encountering  the  elevated  soil  Co   as
opposed to  having to develop  in  the high Co  soil.   This research Implies
that proper  mixing  of the Co waste and the soil is essential  to  preventing
excessive plant accumulation of Co.

     Most  plants growing  in  soils  with native  Co  concentrations  do  not
accumulate Co and values exceeding  1 ppm are rare.    Yet when  growing  In Co
enriched  media,  these  same species may accumulate  the  element and show
yield reductions  (Table  6.30).   Yamagata and Murakami  (1958)  found 600  ppm
Co in alder  (Alnus sp.) leaves,  while white oak (Quercus alba),  chestnut,
saxifrage and dogwood (Cornus  florida) growing in the same  area  had  2-5  ppm
Co in  leaf  ash.   Swamp  blackgum (Nyssa sylvatica) has also been found to
contain a higher concentration of Co than grasses growing in  the same area
(Vanselow,  1966b).   Blackgum  is  such a  good  indicator of  Co status in a
soil  that  Kubota et  al.  (1960)  consider an  area  to  be  Co  deficient  for
grazing animals when the concentration of Co in blackgum trees is less than
5 ppm;  this method  may be used  to  indicate  soils  suitable  for  amendment
with Co-rich waste.  The level  of  Co in  cucumbers  (Cumcumis sativus)  and
tomatoes " (Lycopersicon  esculentum)  is  increased  by  increasing  the  Co
additions in nutrient  solution (Coic  and  Lesaint,  1978), yet  applications
of 0.5-2 kg  Co/ha had no effect  on the Co  concentration of  the metal  in  red
clover  (Trifolium pretense) hay  (Krotkikh  and  Repnikov, 1976).
                                     221

-------
     800-
     TOO-
     600.
Is™
°E    J
K  5 400'
CJ

<
a!
g  300-


0> 2°°J

   100-


    0

                          u

                                                      u
           MO LAVEH
                        3 CM
6 CM
9 CM
             UNCONTAMINATED SOIL LAYER THICKNESS
       Figure 6.16.  Cobalt  concentrations  in tall feacue grown
                    •in Marietta and Norwood soils at 400 rag  Co
                    kg"1  (added as Co(N03)2 • 6H20) with vary-
                    ing layer thicknesses of uncontaminated soil
                    overlying the cobalt amended soil
                    (Pinkerton, 1982).
                                222

-------
TABLE 6.30  PLANT RESPONSE TO COBALT IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
     Co
Concentration
(ppm)
5
25
40
100
400
Media
Solution
Soil
Soil
Soil
Solution
Species
Cabbage
(Brassica
oleracea)
Corn seedlings
(Zea mays)
Oats (Avena
sativa)
General
White bean
(Phaseolus sp.)

Effect
50% yield
reduction
Top injury
Toxic
Threshold
toxiclty
34% yield
reduction
Reference
Kara et al.
(1976)
Young (1979)
Young (1979)
Allaway (1968)
Rauser (1978)
     Cobalt is required by  animals  because it is the central atom  in  vita-
min Bj2  (Rickles et  al.,   1948).   Although  vitamin B12  is  synthesized by
microorganisms in the  ruminant  gut, Co must  still  be supplied in  the diet
(Sauchelli,  1969).    Since  Co  is  essential  for  ruminants,  pasture  plants
deficient  in  it  cause a dietary deficiency of Co which  is  the cause  of  a
progressive  emaciation of  ruminants  (McKenzie,  1975).    Areas  where  Co
deficiency in animals was observed  had forage which  contained less  than 2.5
ppm Co.  Extremely high Co  levels  in forage  can also result  in toxicity to
grazing  animals; however,   Co  toxicity  in  livestock has  not been  reported
under field conditions.  The National Academy of Science  (1980) established
100 ppm  Co in plant dry matter  as  the acute level for ruminants.

     The  use of irrigation water  that  contains the  upper  limit of  the
acceptable  concentration of  Co  recommended  by  the National Academy  of
Sciences  and National Academy  of  Engineering  (1972) is  equivalent  to an
accumulation  of  500  ppm  Co in the upper 15 cm  of soil.   However  plant
toxicity results at soil concentrations  well  below this value,  depending on
plant species.   Animal health is affected by  plants  containing 100 ppm Co.,
therefore  loading  rates  should be  based on  soil concentrations  which pro-
duce  plants  with  Co  concentrations  less  than   100 ppm.   A  conservative
value for  cumulative  Co  of  200 ppm in the soil  is  suggested  to  immobilize
the element as well as to avoid excess plant  uptake.
                                     223

-------
 6.1.6.10   Copper  (Cu)


     Significant  amounts of Cu are  produced  in wastes from  textile  mills,
 cosmetics  manufacturing, and  sludge from  hardboard  production.   Soil  Cu
 contents range  from 2-100 ppm with an  average around  30 ppm  (Bowen,  1966).

     The abundance  of  Cu enrichment  to  the  environment  has prompted  studies
 of  the behavior  of the element  in relation to soil  properties.    Copper
 retention  in  soils is  dependent on  pH;  sorption  of Cu  increases  with
 increasing pH.  In  kaolinitic soils  where clay surfaces have  a net negative
 charge  with  increasing pH, the amount  of  Cu  desorbed  increased as  the  pH
 was  lowered  from  6  to  2 (Kishk and  Hassan, 1973).   The lack  of  adsorption
 of Cu  at  a low pH  may be  due  to competition from  Mg 2+  Fe  ^+ H+ and  Al^"*"
 for  sorption sites.  Soils selected to  represent  a broad range  of  mineral
 and  organic  contents were found to have  a specific  adsorption maximum at  pH
 5.5  of  between 340  and  5780 ppm  Cu in  soil  (McLaren and Crawford,  1973).
 Land treated  Cu waste  should be  limed  if necessary to maintain a pH  of 6.5
 or greater to  ensure  the  predominance  of  insoluble forms  of Cu,  Cu(OH)2
 and  Cu(OH)-j  (Hodgson et  al., 1966 and Younts  and Patterson,  1964).

     Soil  organic matter forms very  stable  complexes  with Cu.   Carboxyl and
 phenolic groups are important  in the  organic  complexing  of  Cu in  soils
 (Lewis  and Broadbent,  1961).  Sorption  of  Cu  to  organic  matter occurs  at
 relatively high rates  when  the  concentrations of iron  and manganese  oxides
 in  the soil  are  low.    There  is some  evidence that Cu bound  to  organic
 matter  is  not  readily available to plants  (Purvis  and  MacKenzie,  1973).
 Organic matter  may  provide  nonspecific sorption sites  for Cu;  however, the
 loss of organic matter through  decomposition causes  a  significant decrease
 in this retention mechanism.

     Clay  mineralogy  also  plays  a  significant role  in  determining  the
 amount  of Cu  sorbed.    Experiments   have   shown  that  Cu^+  is   sorbed
 appreciably  by quartz  and  even more  strongly  by  clays.   The  adsorption
 capacity of  clays increases  in  the  order kaloninte to  illite  to  montmoril-
 lonite (Krauskopf,  1972).  The strength  of  Cu sorption  of soil constituents
 are  in the following order:

     manganese  oxides  <  organic matter < iron oxides  <  clay minerals.

A  column   study by   Emmerich  et  al. (1982)  Indicated  that  Cu  applied  as
 sewage sludge to  a  concentration  of 512 ppm  essentialy did not  move below
 the  zone of  incorporation  and  that   94%  of  that applied was  recovered  from
 the  soil.  This soil had a pH between 5.2  and 6.7  and  a  CEC of  4.4  to 9.7
meq/100 g.  Soil  components which  are  less  significant  in Cu  attenuation
 include  free  phosphates,   iron  salts,   and  clay-size   alumlnosilicate
minerals.

     Cation  exchange  capacity  is a soil  property  indirectly  related  to
mineralogy which may influence metal loading.  Overcash and  Pal (1979)  have
suggested  that  loading rates based  on CEC only  be  used as  a  suggestion  of
the  buffering capacity of the soil and critical cumulative limits have  been

                                    224

-------
adjusted to soil CEC  (0-5 meq/100 g,  125 kg/ha; 5-15 meq/100 g,  250 kg/ha;
15 meq/100 g, 500 kg/ha).

     Since  the  normal Cu  concentration in plants  (4 to  15  ppm) is  lower
than Cu  levels  found  in most soils, the soil  Cu content appears  to  be  the
most important  factor in controlling  plant levels of Cu.   Management prac-
tices  must  be  developed  considering  the  chemistry  of  Cu  in  soils  and  Cu
toxicity to plants and animals.   The data  of Gupta  (1979)  indicate that  the
toxic  range of  Cu in  the leaves  of  plants  is greater than  20  ppm, depending
on species.   The influence  of  soil and  solution culture  concentration  on
plant  growth are given in Table  6.31,  and  indicates  a soil concentration of
over 80 ppm is  necessary before  most plant growth is adversely  affected.

     Copper is  essential to the  metabolic processes common  to  decomposing
bacteria,  plants and animals.    Small  quantities   of  Cu   activate  enzymes
required  in  respiration,   redox-type  reactions  and   protein  synthesis.
Copper has  been shown to be magnified within  the  food chain  and moderate
levels of  Cu  ingested by ruminants may be poisonous unless  the  effect  is
alleviated  through   proper  diet  supplements  of   molybdenum  or  sulfate
(Kubota, 1977).

     Several  researchers have reported a decrease  in  plant Cu  when large
amounts of organic matter are present.  Goodman and Gemmell (1978) reported
successful  reclamation of  Cu smelter  wastes   treated  with pulverized  fly
ash, sewage sludge or domestic refuse.  In a greenhouse experiment, Maclean
and Dekker (1978) eliminated the toxic effects  of Cu on corn (Zea mays) by
applying sewage sludge.  Kornegay et  al.  (1976) found that additions of hog
manure containing  1719 ppm Cu did  not  affect  the Cu content  in grain when
compared to  grain from  control   experiments.   Purvis  and  MacKenzie (1973)
found  that  the  organic form of  Cu  was not readily  taken  up  by plants when
Cu-laden municipal compost  was   applied  to soil  at rates  from  50  to  100
metric tons sludge/ha.

     A study  by Mitchell et al.  (1978) evaluated Cu uptake  by crops grown
in acidic  and  alkaline soils (Table 6.32  and  Table  6.33).   In this study,
wheat  and  grain growing in  an  acid soil  showed the greatest  amount of Cu
accumulation.   Copper may be strongly chelated in plant roots;  consequent-
ly, root concentrations  are  usually greater than leaf concentrations.
                                      225

-------
     TABLE  6.31  PLANT RESPONSE TO  COPPER IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
ISJ
N3
Amount of
Cu (ppm)
.03
1
10
26
30
50-115
91
100
100
130
150
400
400
Media
Solution
Solution
Soil
Sand
Solution
Soil of
mining area
Soil
Soil
Rooting media
Soil
Soil
Soil
Yolo loam
Yolo loam
Species
Andropogon scoparius
Horse bean (Vicia faba)
Barley (Hordeum vulgare)
Barley (H. vulgare); pea
(Pisim sp.)
Coffee
Anthoxanthum odoratum
Corn (Zea mays)
Barley (H. vulgare)
Barley (H. vulgare)
Green alder
(Alnus americana)
Barley (H. vulgare)
Black spruce
(Picea mariana)
Cotton (Gossypium
hirsutum)
Cotton (£. hirsutum)
Effect
Root damage
Growth
inhibited
Stunted growth
Inhibition of
shoot growth
Toxicity
threshold
None
Decreased root
weight
Reduced yield
Stunted growth
Seedling damage
Accumulated 21
ppm in leaves
Growth decrease
Leaf yields
reduced by 35%
Leaf yields
reduced by 53%
Reference
Ehinger and Parker
(1979)
Sekerka (1977)
Toivonen and Hofstra
(1979)
Blaschke (1977)
Andrade et al. (1976)
Karataglis (1978)
Klein et al. (1979)
Davis (1979)
Toivonen and Hofstra
(1979)
Fessenden & Sutherland
(1979)
Davis (1979)
Fessenden & 'Sutherland
(1979)
Rehab & Wallace (1978a)
Rehab & Wallace (1978a)

-------
TABLE 6.32  COPPER CONCENTRATION  IN  PLANT  TISSUE  IN RELATION TO COPPER
            ADDITION IN AN ACID SOIL (REDDING  FINE  SANDY LOAM)*
Cu
Concentration
(ppm)
5

5

5
80
80
320

320

640

640

* Mitchell et

Plant
Portion
Shoots

Leaves

Grain
Shoots
Leaves
Shoots

Grain

Shoots

Grain

al. (1978).



Plant
Crop Concentration
Lettuce (Lactuca
sativa)
Wheat (Triticum
aestivum)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Lettuce (L. sativa)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Lettuce (L. sativa)

Wheat (T_. aestivum)

Lettuce (L. sativa)

Wheat (T_. aestivum)


TABLE 6.33 COPPER CONCENTRATION IN PLANT TISSUE
ADDITION IN A
Cu
Concentration
(ppm)
5

5

5
80
80
160

160
320


320

640


Plant
Portion
Shoots

Leaves

Grain
Shoots
Leaves
Leaves

Grain
Leaves


Grain

Grain

CALCAREOUS SOIL (DOMINO


6.8

10.7

7.3
8.9
10.7
10.7

12.3

18.3

33.0


IN RELATION TO
SILT LOAM)*

Plant
Crop Concentration
Lettuce
(Lactuca sativa)
Wheat (Triticum
aestivum)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Lettuce (L. sativa)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Lettuce (Ij. sativa)

Wheat (T. aestivum)
Wheat (JC. aestivum)


Wheat (T_. aestivum)

Wheat (T_. aestivum)

6.4

10.7

6.7
7.9
14.8
8.2

7.9
15.4


9.1

9.2



Effect
None

None

None
None
None
60% yield
reduction
20% yield
reduction
90% yield
reduction
95% yield
reduction

COPPER



Effect
None

None

None
None
None
30% yield
reduction
None
Significant
yield
reduction
20% yield
reduction
40% yield
reduction
* Mitchell et al.  (1978).
                                     227

-------
      In  summary,  the controlling factor  In  the prevention of toxic  levels
of  Cu in water,  plants and animals is the level  of  Cu  in the soil.  While
Cu  tolerance in plants  can  be explained  by certain mineral  interactions,
the  ultimate sites  for  adsorption  of Cu  in  the environment  remain  the
organic  and  inorganic  colloid fractions in  soil.   The  National Academy of
Sciences  and  National  Academy  of  Engineering  (1972)  recommend  a  soil
accumulation  of  250  ppm Cu in the upper 15  cm  of  soil.   Tables 6.31,  6.32
and 6.33  indicate that  the phytotoxic  concentration of Cu ranges from about
70  to 640 ppm Cu in  the soil for most  plants.   A conservative recommenda-
tion  of  250 ppm is given for  Cu  concentration in soil.    However,  if  treat-
ability  tests show  immobilization at higher levels  without toxicity,  then
loading  rates could  be  increased.
6.1.6.11  Gallium (Ga)
     Gallium concentration in soil is commonly low, averaging 30 ppm  (Kirk-
ham, 1979), except where it occurs in coal, oil, and bauxite ore.   Since Ga
is  sorbed by aluminum  (Al)  in  soil,  Ga  concentrations  are likely  to be
higher in  sandy  acidic  soils  with dominant Al mineralogy.   Disposal of Ga
present in waste streams of smelter  or coal processing  plants depends on
the degree of Ga retention in soils with dominant Al mineralogy.
6.1.6.12  Gold (Au)
     Gold is rarely found in waste  streams  of any industry because it is a
precious metal.   Since  pure Au is quite dense  (19  g/cm^), it is  frequent-
ly  concentrated  in  deposits  called placers.    In Mexico  and Australia,
placers are concentrated  by wind;  as the lighter minerals are eroded away,
the Au  remains  in the deposit  (Flint  and  Skinner,  1977).   The average Au
concentration in  igneous  and sedimentary rocks is  4  ppb.  Gold concentra-
tions in  fresh  water  are normally  less  than 0.06 ppb, and  Au  is  found in
sea water at 0.011 ppb as
     Gold is not essential to plants  or  animals.   Bo wen (1966) ranks Au as
scarcely toxic which  means  that toxic effects rarely  appear except in the
absence of  a related essential  nutrient,  or at  osmotic pressures greater
than one  atmosphere.    Overcash and  Pal  (1979)   list  Au as  a heavy metal
which  reacts with cell  membranes to  alter  their  permeability and affect
other properties.  The Au concentration  in land  plants ranges  from 0.3-0.8
ppb.  The horsetail, Equisetum, is said to accumulate Au.

     The isotope Au-198  is  commonly used  in  medicine.   In  mammals,  Au in
the colloidal form can accumulate  in  the  liver.   The typical Au concentra-
tion in mammalian livers is 0.23 ppb.  The mollusc, Unio marvcus , was found
to  contain  0.3-3.0 ppb  Au  in  its shell  and  4.0-40 ppb  Au  in  its  flesh
(Bo wen, 1966).   It is  expected that  any  Au present  in a  waste  would be
recovered before land treatment.
                                    228

-------
6.1.6.13   Lead  (Pb)
     The  primary source of Pb in hazardous waste is from the manufacture of
Pb-acid  storage batteries  and  gasoline  additives (tetraethyl Pb).   Tetra-
ethyl  Pb production  alone consumes  approximately 264,000  tons of  Pb per
year in  the  U.S. (Fishbein, 1978).  Lead is also used in the manufacture of
ammunition,  caulking compounds,  solders,  pigments,  paints,  herbicides and
insecticides (Page,  1974).  The Pb content of sewage sludge averages 0.17%.
In  coal,  Pb  content  may range from 2-20 ppm (Overcash and Pal, 1979).

     A Pb concentration of about 10 ppm is average for surface soils.  Some
soil   types,  however,  can have  a much higher  concentration.    In soils
derived  from quartz  mica schist, the Pb content may be 80 ppm.  The  concen-
tration  in  soil derived from black shale may  reach  200 ppm Pb (Barltrop et
al., 1974).

     Lead is  present in  soils  as Pb2"*" which may  precipitate  as  Pb sul-
fates, hydroxides and  carbonates.   Figure 6.17  illustrates  the various Pb
compounds present according to soil  pH.  Below  pH of  6,  PbS04  (anglesite)
is  dominant  and PbC03 is  most  stable at pH values above  7.   The hydroxide
Pb(OH)2  controls  solubility around  pH 8,  and  lead phosphates, of which
there  are  many  forms,  may  control Pb2*  solubility  at intermediate  pH
values.   Solubility  studies with molybdenum  (Mo)  show  that PbMo04  is  a
reaction  product and  will govern Mo concentrations in the soil solution.

     The  availability of Pb in  soils is related  to  moisture content, soil
pH, organic  matter,  and the concentration of calcium and phosphates.  Under
waterlogged  conditions, naturally occurring Pb  becomes  reduced  and   mobile.
Organometallic complexes may be  formed  with organic matter  and these soil
organic  chelates are of  low  solubility.  Increasing pH and  calcium (Ca2"1")
ions diminish the capacity of plants  to  absorb  Pb,  as  Ca2+ ions   compete
with the Pb2*  for  exchange sites  on the soil  and  root  surfaces   (Fuller,
1977).

     The  Pb  adsorption capacity  of  Illinois  soils has  been  found  to reach
several  thousand kilograms per  hectare (CAST,  1976).    In  another  study,
only 3 ppm  soluble Pb was  found  three days  after 6,720 kg  Pb/ha was added
to  the soil  (Brewer,  1966b).  Lead  is adsorbed  most  strongly from  aqueous
solutions to calcium  bentonlte  (Ermolenko, 1972).

     Lead is not an  essential  element for plant growth.   It is,   however,
taken  up by  plants  in the Pb2+  form.   The amount  taken up decreases  as
the  pH,   cation  exchange  capacity,   and  available phosphorus of the soil
increase.  Under conditions of high  pH, CEC and available  phosphorous, Pb
becomes  less soluble  and  is more strongly  adsorbed  (CAST,  1976).   This
insolubilization takes  time and  Pb added in small increments over long time
periods  is less  available  to plants  than  high concentrations added over a
short  period  of  time  (Overcash  and Pal,  1979).

     Lead toxicity to  plants is  uncommon (Table  6.34).    Symptoms  of  Pb
toxicity  are found only  in plants grown on acid soils.  In  solution cul-


                                     229

-------
0.0 -
 -12
-10
-8        -6       -4
       log [OHJ
-2
                      6
                     8
                    PH
                    10
 12
14
  Figure 6.17.   Distribution  of molecular and ionic species of
                divalent lead at different pH values (Fuller,
                1977).
                          230

-------
      TABLE 6.34  PLANT RESPONSE TO LEAD IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
     Pb
Concentration
    (ppm)
                       Media
                              Species
                                            Effect
                                            Reference
to
OJ
  0.4

  3.6
  5.0

 21.0
 50.0
 66.0

 100.0
 200.0

1000.0

1000.0

1500.0

1500.0

2500.0
3775.0
Soil

Soil
Solution

Solution
Solution
Soil

Solution
Sand

Acid Soil

Soil

Soil pH 5.9

Solution

Sand
Sandy clay
Eggplant  (Solanum
 melongena)
Corn (Zea mays)
Corn (JZ.  mays)

Sphagnum  fimbriatum
Lettuce (Lactuca  sativa)
Loblolly  pine (Pinus
 taeda) & autumn  olive
Soybean (Glycine  max)
Oats (Avena sativa)

Plantain  (Musa
 paradisiaca)
Red clover (Trifolium
 pratense)
Corn (Zea mays)

Ryegrass  (Secale
 cereale)
Glyceria maxima
Corn (Z^. mays) &
 soybeans (Glycine max)
                                                             None

                                                             None
                                                             Reduced root
                                                             growth
                                                             None
                                                             None
                                                             None

                                                             None
                                                             Impaired
                                                             growth
                                                             None

                                                             None

                                                             None

                                                             None

                                                             Chlorosis
                                                             None
Watanbe and Nakamura
 (1972)
Sung and Young (1977)
Malone et al. (1978)

Simola (1977)
John (1977)
Rolfe & Bazzar (1975)

Malone et al. (1978)
Kovda et al. (1979)

Dikjshoorn et al. (1979)

Horak (1979)

Baunhard and Welch
 (1972)
Jones et al. (1973)

Raghi-Atri (1978)
Sung and Young (1977)

-------
ture, root growth of sheep fescue  Is  retarded  by  30 ppm and stopped by 100
ppm  Pb.   Lead  content  In  plants grown  on  soil with  a  high  Pb  level
increases  only  slightly  over  that  of plants grown  on soil of  average Pb
content.   Clover  tops  (Trifolium sp.) show an  increase of  7.55 ppm, while
kale  (Brassica  campestris)  and lettuce  (Lactuca  sativa)  leaves  show an
increase of less than  1 ppm.   The  Pb  taken up  by  plants is rarely translo-
cated  since  it becomes  chelated in  the  roots.   Tops of  barley (Hordeum
vulgare) grown  on a soil  extremely high  in Pb contained 3 ppm while the
roots contained 1,475 ppm Pb (Brewer, 1966b).   Translocation of Pb to grain
is less than translocation  to vegetative  parts  (Schaeffer  et  al., 1979).
Applied  sewage  sludge containing  360  ppm Pb  resulted in  no  significant
increase in Pb content of corn  leaves and grain (Keefer et al., 1979).

     Lead  poisoning  is  quite   serious  and a  major human  health concern.
Perlstein and Attala (1966) estimate  that 600,000 children each year in the
U.S. suffer from Pb poisoning.  Of these, 6,000 have permanent neurological
damage  and 200 die.  One source of elevated Pb in  children may be contact
with Pb-containing dust (Vostal et al., 1974).  In fact, soil Pb content in
excess  of  10,000 ppm  may  result in  an  increase  in Pb absorption even by
children who do  not  ingest the contaminated soil  (Barltrop et  al., 1974).
Where high  levels of  lead  are allowed  to accumulate, children  should be
prevented from entering the site throughout the post-closure period.

     Cattle and sheep are more  resistant to Pb  toxicity than horses.  There
is, however, some tendency for cattle to accumulate Pb in  tissues,  and Pb
can  be  transferred  to milk  in concentrations  that  are  toxic  to  humans
(National Academy of Sciences  and National Academy  of Engineering, 1972).
Based on human  health  considerations, the maximum  allowable  Pb content in
domestic animals  is  30 ppm  (National Academy  of Science,  1980).   Cattle
ingest  large amounts of  soil when  grazing  and may  consume  up  to ten times
as much Pb from  soil as  from forage.   Lead poisoning  has  been reported in
cattle  grazing in Derbyshire,  England,  where  the  soil is  naturally high in
the element (Barltrop et al.,  1974).

     The use  of  irrigation  water  that contains  the upper  limit  of the
acceptable concentration of  Pb as  recommended by  the National Academy of
Sciences and  National  Academy of  Engineering  (1972)  is equivalent  to an
accumulation of 1,000  ppm  of lead  in  the upper 15 cm  of  soil.   Table  6.34
indicates  Pb  is generally  not toxic  to  plants  and  the  element  does not
readily translocate  to leaves  or  seeds.   Growth of  root  crops  should be
avoided and grazing  animals  should be  excluded from  the site  to avoid Pb
toxicity to animals  and  humans.   If  demonstration of treatability experi-
ments verify immobilization of  Pb at  high concentrations, 1000 ppm total Pb
could be safely allowed to accumulate in the soil without phytotoxicity.
6.1.6.14  Lithium (Li)
     Lithium normally  occurs in saline  and alkaline  soils  and is usually
associated with carbonates  in  soils  derived from calcareous parent materi-
als.  The average Li content of soils is 20 ppm.  Because the concentration

                                     232

-------
of total and  soluble  Li  is not related to  depth  in the profile, clay  con-
tent  or  organic  carbon  content (Shukla  and Prasad,  1973;  Gupta  et  al.,
1974), it  is  expected that Li  is  not fixed selectively  in soil except  by
precipitation after liming.

     The usual Li concentration in plants  and animals  is  low,  but  levels  of
1,000 ppm in  plant tissues, which  are sometimes reached in plants  grown  on
mineral enriched soils, do not  appear to be very  phytotoxic.   The  data  pro-
vided by  the present  review  indicate  that the  toxic range  of  Li in  the
leaves of  plants varies  from  80  to  700  ppm depending  on species  (Table
6.35).  At  low levels in a nutritive solution, Li  stimulates  phosphorylase
activity in  tuber storage of  beets  (Beta  yulgaris),  while growth in  corn
(Zea mays),  wheat (Triticum aestivum) and fescue (Festuca sp.) is limited
as a  result  of Li substitution for Na in  cellular functions.  Tables  6.35
and 6.36 list plant  concentrations of Li  and  crop responses  to  those  con-
centrations,  respectively.   Lithium poses  little  threat to the  food  chain
since it is only slightly  toxic to animals.
TABLE 6.35  THE INFLUENCE OF LEAF LITHIUM CONCENTRATION ON PLANTS
     Li
Concentration
    (ppm)       of plant    Species            Effect         Reference
Portion
of plant   Species
26
45
80
220
600
700
Leaf
Leaf
Leaf
Leaf
Leaf
Leaf
Mean of 200
Cotton
(GoBsypium
hirsutum)
Tomato
(Lycopersicon
esculentum)
Bean
(Phaseolus
sp.)
Bean
(Phaseolus
sp.)
Cabbage
(Brassica
oleracea)
None
None
Threshold
of toxicity
Yield
reduction
Severe
50% Yield
reduction
Romney et al.
(1975)
Rahab & Wallace
(1978c)
Wallihan et al.
(1978)
Wallace et al.
(1977)
Wallace et al.
(1977)
Kara et al.
(1977)
                                     233

-------
TABLE 6.36  THE INFLUENCE OF SOLUTION CULTURE AND SOIL CONCENTRATION OF
            LITHIUM ON PLANT GROWTH AND YIELD
Amount of
Li (ppm)
2
Media
Solution
Species
Tomato
Effect
Toxiclty
Reference
Wallihan, et al.
     8


    50


    50



   100
   587


  1000
             Sand
Solution
Loam
Yolo loam
Soil
Loam
Loam
 (Lycoperslcon
 esculentum)
Wheat (Triticum
 aestivum)

Barley (Hordeum
 vulgare)

Bean (Phaseolus
 sp.)
Cotton
 (GossypiuTa
 hirautum?

Wheat
 (T_. aestivum)

Barley
 (Hu vulgare)

Cotton
 (£. hirsutum)

Barley
 (H. vulgare)
                                                            (1978)
                              No influence
No seedlings    Gupta (1974)


Severe injury   Wallace et al.
                 (1977)
None
Rehab & Wallace
 (1978c)
No influence    Gupta (1974)
None


Severe
Wallace et al.
 (1977)
Wallace et al.
 (1977)
     The  use  of  irrigation water  that  contains  the upper  limit  of the
acceptable concentration  of Li as  recommended  by the National  Academy of
Sciences  and  National Academy  of Engineering  (1972) is equivalent  to an
accumulation of  250 ppm of  Li  in  the  upper 15  cm  of soil.   Information
in Tables 6.35 and  6.36 indicates that  the phytotoxic level  of  Li in soil
ranges from 50  to 1000 ppm.  An  acceptable estimate for cumulative Li in
the soil  appears  to  be  250  ppm.  However,  if treatabillty  tests show that
higher concentrations are immobilized without toxicity,  then loading rates
could be increased.
6.1.6.15  Manganese (Mn)


     The  major  sources  of  Mn  bearing  wastes  are  the   iron  and  steel
industries.    Other  sources  of   Mn  include  disinfectants,  paint  and
fertilizers (Page,  1974).   Manganese dioxide  is found in  wastes  from the
production of alkaline batteries, glass, paints and drying  industries.
                                    234

-------
     Concentrations  of Mn in mineral  soils  range from 20-3000  ppm,  though
600 ppm is  average  (Lindsay,  1979).  When Mn is released  from primary rocks
by weathering,  secondary minerals such  as pyrolusite (Mn02>  and  manganite
[MnO(OH)] are formed.  The most  common forms  of  Mn  found in soil are  the
divalent cation  (Mn2+) which  is soluble, mobile, and easily  available,  and
the  tetravalent  cation  (Mn*+)  which   is  practically   insoluble,   non-
mobile,  and  unavailable  (Aubert and  Pinta, 1977).   The  trivalent  cation
Mn^+, as Ma2°3»  is unstable  in solution.   The tetravalent  cation  usually
appears in  well  oxidized  soils  at a very  low pH.   Under  reduced conditions
found  in water  saturated  soils,  Mn^+  is  the  stable compound,  and  this
divalent ion  is  adsorbed to  clay minerals and organic matter.  In strongly
oxidized  environments,  the  most  stable  compound  is  the  tetravalent  Mn
dioxide,
     Manganese  availability  is high  in  acid  soils  and  Mn2+  solubility
decreases  100-fold  for each unit  increase  in pH.   (Lindsay,  1972)  At  pH
values of  5.0 or less, Mn  is rendered  very  soluble  and excessive Mn accumu-
lation in  plants can result.   At pH values of 8 or  above,  precipitation  of
Mn(OH)2 results in Mn  removal  from the soil solution.

     Reduced  conditions  in  the soil  increase  Mn  solubility  and  produce
Mn2+ in  solution.    Oxidation  of  Mn  occurs  at  a  low  redox potential  in
an  alkaline  solution  (Krauskopf,  1972).     Under  oxidizing  conditions,
several Mn compounds  may  be  formed  including  (MnSi)203,  BaMn(II),  MnOOH,
and the stable product of  complete oxidation,  pyrolusite (Mn02>.

     When  the  pH  of the soil  is  greater  than 7, manganese  (Mn2+) Is ren-
dered  less available  by  adsorption onto  organic matter  colloids.   Thus,
soils of high  pH with  large  organic matter reserves  are particularly prone
to Mn deficiency.   However,  the affinity of  Mn^"*" for synthetic chelates  is
comparatively low, and chelated Mn^+   can  be  easily  exchanged  by  Zn^+ or
Ca  .

     Interactions of Mn with other elements have been noted in soil adsorp-
tion and plant uptake.  The  formation of manganese  oxides  in soils appears
to regulate the levels of  cobalt (Co)  in soil solution  and hence Co cobalt
availability to plants.  Bowen (1966)  reported  that  plant  uptake of Mn was
greater in the absence of  calcium  and  that  Mn adsorption was reduced In the
presence of iron, copper,  sodium,  and  potassium.

     Concentrations  of Mn  in plant leaves  generally range  from 15-150 ppm.
The suggested  maximum concentration value  for  plants is  given  at 300 ppm
(Melsted,  1973),  however   the  data of  the National  Research Council (1973)
indicate that  the toxic range  of Mn in leaves is  500 to 2,000 ppm, depend-
ing on plant  species.   Vaccinium  myrtillus plants  appear  healthy when the
foliage contains  as  high  as 2431  ppm  Mn and Lupinus  luteus and Ornlthopus
satlvus are  both Mn tolerant  (Lohris, 1960).   Young plants  are generally
rich  in  Mn and  the element  can  be translocated to  meristematic tissues.
Tables  6.37  and  6.38  list  various   Mn  concentrations  in  the  soil  that
produce toxic  symptoms in  plants.
                                     235

-------
TABLE 6.37   THE  INFLUENCE  OF  LEAF MANGANESE CONCENTRATION ON PLANTS*
Plant
Concentration
(ppm)
15-84
49-150
70-131
160
173-999
207-1340
300-500
400-500
770-1000
993-1130
1000
1000-3000
3170
4000-11,000
Media
Solution
Solution
Solution
Field
Solution
Soil
Soil
Field
Solution
Pots
Soil
Soil
Soil
Soil
Portion
of Plant
Leaves
Roots
Tops
Leaves
Leaves
Whole plant
Leaves
Tops
Tops
Whole plant
Leaves
Tops
Roots
Leaves
Species
Soybeans
(Glycine max)
Soybeans
(G. max)
Lespedeza
(Lespedeza sp.)
Tobacco
(Nicotiana tabacum)
Soybeans
(G. max)
Bean
(Phaseolus sp.)
Orange
(Citrus sp.)
Lespedeza
(Lespedeza sp.)
Barley
(Hordeutn vulgare)
Tobacco
(N. tabacum)
Orange
(Citrus sp.)
Bean
(Phaseolus sp.)
Tobacco
(N. tabacum)
Tobacco
(N. tabacum)
Effect
None
Toxic
None
None
Toxic
None
None
Toxic
Toxic
Toxic
Toxic
Toxic
Toxic
Toxic
* Chapman (1966)


     Manganese  is absorbed  by plants  is  the  divalent cation  Mn^"*",   Its
essential functions  in plants  include the  activation of  numerous  enzymes
concerned with  carbohydrate  metabolism, phosphorylation reactions,  and the
citric  acid cycle.   Magnesium,  calcium  and  iron  depress Mn  uptake  in  a
variety of  plant  species  (Moore,  1972).

     Manganese  toxicity  in young plants  is  indicated by  brown  spotting on
leaves.   One to  four  grams of Mn  per milllliter  of solution  may  depress
yields  of   lespedeza  (Lespedeza  sp.),  soybeans  (Glycine  max)  and  barley
(Hordeum  vulgare)  (Labanauskas,  1966).    The  threshold   of  toxicity  for
tomato (Lycopersicon esculentum)  plants grown in soil was  observed  at a Mn
concentration of  450 ppm  (Jones and Fox,  1978).
                                     236

-------
     TABLE 6.38   PLANT RESPONSE TO MANGANESE IN SOIL AND SOLUTION CULTURE
     Amount  of
     Mn  (ppm)
            Media
Species
Effect
                                                  Reference
i-o
10
  2.1       Solution     Legume

  4-64      Solution     Weeping  lovegrass
                           (Eragrostlg  curvula)
                           &  fescue  (Festuca sp.)
   5        Solution     Jacoine  (Pinus  banksiana)
                           &  black spruce (Picea
                           mariana)
   5        Solution     Soybean  (Glycine max)
  15        Solution     Soybean  (G. max)
  20        Sand         Groundnut  (Apios americana)
  30        Solution     Satsuma  orange
                           (Citrus reticulata)
  40        Sand         Macroptilium
                           atropurpureum
  65        Acid  soil    Soybean  (G. max)
 130        Soil         Subterranean  clover
                           (Trifolium subterraneom)
140-200     Soil         Barley (Hordeum vulgare)
 200        Soil         Tobacco  (Nicotiana
                           tabacum)
 250        Soil         Watermelon (Cucumis sp.)
 450        Soil         Tomatoes (Lycoperisicon
                           esculentum)
1400        Soil         Kidney bean (Phaseolus
                           vulgare)
3000        Soil         Peppers  (Capsicum  sp.)
5000        Soil         Eggplant (Solanum  ntelongena)
                           & melons  (Cucumis sp.)
                                                               Toxicity
                                                                threshold
                                                               No effect
                               Toxic
                               No effect

                               Toxic
                               No effect
                               Reduced yield
                               Chlorosis

                               No effect

                               Toxicity
                               Toxic

                               Yield decreased
                               Reduced yield

                               Toxic
                               Toxicity
                                threshold
                               Toxic

                               Toxic
                               Toxic
                   Helyar (1978)

                   Fleming et al. (1974)


                   Lafond & Laflamme (1970)
                   Lafond & Laflamme (1970)

                   Brown & Jones (1977)
                   Heenan & Carter (1976)
                   Benac (1976)
                   Otsuka and Morizaki (1969)

                   Button et al. (1978)

                   Franco & Dobereiner (1971)
                   Simon et al. (1974)

                   Prausse et al. (1972)
                   Link (1979)

                   Gomi & Oyagi (1972)
                   Jones and Fox (1978)

                   Gomi & Oyagi (1972)

                   Gomi & Oyagi (1972)
                   Gomi & Oyagi (1972)

-------
     Manganese  is  an essential  element  in animal  nutrition for reproduc-
tion, growth  and skeletal formation.  Maximum  tolerable levels in animals
are  cattle,  1000 ppm; sheep, 1000  ppm;  swine,  400 ppm;  and poultry, 2000
ppm  (National Academy of  Science, 1980).

     In  summary, the  maintenance of certain conditions  in  the soil can be
used to  prevent  environmental  contamination from land treating of Mn bear-
ing wastes.  Manganese  sorption  is  enhanced by organic matter colloids and
precipitation of Mn is  enhanced  by  carbonates,  silicates and hydroxides at
high pH  values.  The  maintenance of a pH of greater  than 6.5 is essential
to reducing Mn  solubility.   The  use of  irrigation  water that contains the
upper limit  of the acceptable  concentration of  Mn as  recommended  by the
National Academy of Sciences and National Academy of Engineering (1972) is
equivalent to  an accumulation of  1,000  ppm of  Mn in  the  upper 15  cm of
soil.  Information obtained  from Jones and Fox  (1978)  and  Tables 6.37 and
6.38 indicate that the  phytotoxic level  of  Mn  in soil is generally greater
than 500 ppm.
6.1.6.16  Mercury (Hg)
     Mercury  has become  widely recognized  as one  of the  most hazardous
elements to human health.   The potential for Hg contamination exists where
disposal  practices  create  conditions conducive  for  conversion of  Hg  to
toxic forms.

     Mercury  enters land  treatment  facilities  from  electrical apparatus
manufacturing, electrolytic production of chlorine and caustic  soda, phar-
maceuticals, paints, plastics, paper products  and Hg batteries.  Mercury  is
used as a catalyst  in the manufacture of  vinyl chloride and urethane.   More
than 40% of pesticides  containing  metal   contain Hg.   Burning oil and  coal
increases atmospheric Hg which eventually falls to the earth  and enters the
soil  (Page,  1974).   Mineral  soils in  the U.S.  usually  contain  between
0.01-.3 ppm Hg;  the average concentration is 0.03 ppm  (Lindsay,  1979).

     Transformations in the  soil and the forms of  Hg  resulting from these
reactions regulate  the environmental impact of land application  of mercuri-
cal waste.  Figure  6.18 illustrates these conversions and the cycling of  Hg
in the  soil.   Mercury moves very  slowly through soils  under field  condi-
tions.  Divalent Hg is  rapidly  and strongly  complexed by covalent  bonding
to sulfur-containing organic compounds and inorganic particles.  These  par-
ticles bind as much as 62% of  the  Hg  in  surface soils (Walters  and  Wolery,
1974).   Mercury,  as Hg2+,  is  also  bound to  exchange  sites  of   clays,
hydrous oxides of iron and  manganese,  and fine sands (Reimers and Krenkel,
1974).   Sorption of Hg by  soil organic  matter  approaches 100% of  the  Hg
added to  an  aqueous solution  and  exceeds sorption  of a variety  of other
metal elements (Kerndorff and Schnitzer,  1980).
                                     238

-------
                       BACTERIAL OXIDATION
                       PLANKTON
                       PLANTS
                       INORGANIC
                       REACTIONS
                                                   MERCURIC KM,
                                                   CHELATEO CATIONS t ANIONS
                                                   SIMPLE COMPLEXES.
                                                   OXIDES SULPHIDES
                                                         Hgllll
                 BACTERIAL REDUCTION
              FUNGI
           PLANTS
        INORGANIC REACTIONS
       SUNLIGHT
     ELEMENTAL MERCURY
     AS VAPOUR LIQUID
     OR DISSOLUTE
HglOl
JBACTERIA_
SUNLIGHT"
u>
\o
              .REDUCTION
        FUNGI
          PLANTS
             BACTERIAL OXIDATION
             PLANTS
             INORGANIC REACTIONS
       DISPROPORTIONATE AND
         ELECTRON EXCHANGE
                                                 BACTERIAL SYNTHESIS
                                                 CHELATION
                                                                BACTERIA,
                                                                CONVERSION BY
                                                                ORGANIC OXIDANTS
ORGANO-MERCURY
   COMPOUNDS

R,R'=ALKYL, ARYL,
   MERCAPTO,
   PROTEIN, «tc.

X= MONOVALENT ANION
   EG. HALIDE, ACETATE.
   •to.
                                                   BACTERIAL SYNTHESIS
                                                   CHELATION
                                                   ORGANIC OXIDANTS
                                                        Hglll
                    MERCUROUS ION,
                    CHELATED CATIONS ANIONS.
                    SIMPLE COMPLEXES
       2Hg'l =HfllOI + H, III!
                 Figure  6.18.
 The cycle of  mercury  interconversions in nature (Jonasson
 and Boyle,  1971).  Reprinted by  permission of the Royal
 Society of  Canada.

-------
     Removal of Hg  by  adsorption  to clay colloids appears  to  be pH depen-
dent and proportional to the respective CEC value of  the  clay.   A study by
Griffin  and Shimp  (1978)  indicates  that 20  to 30% of  the observed  Hg
removal  is  due to  adsorption  by  clay, and that  Hg removal from  the  soil
solution is  favored by alkaline  conditions.   The  amount  of  Hg2+ removed
from solution  by  a given clay at  a specific  pH can be determined  as  fol-
lows:

                             c  a  (Ci - CEq)VF                        (  3)
                              R        W

where

     CR  « amount of Hg~*"2 removed in mg/g clay;
     Cj  = initial Hg concentration in ppm;
     Cgq * equilibrium Hg concentration in ppm;
     VF  = total solution volume after pH adjustments in mis;
     W   = weight of clay in gms.

About two-thirds of the Hg removed  by  clay is  organic Hg, Fig. 6.19 illus-
trates this removal.

     Precipitation  of  Hg  complexes is  a means  of removing  Hg  from the
leaching fraction.  At  pH  values  above 7, precipitates of Hg(OH>2, HgS04,
HgN03, and Hg(NH3>4 predominate and are very  insoluble.   Insoluble HgS and
HgCl3 can occur at all pH ranges (Lindsay, 1979).

     Organic mercurials  associated with  soil  organic matter or  the well-
defined  compounds  such as phenyl-,  alkyl-,  and methoxyethyl  mercury  com-
pounds  used as  fungicides  may  be  degraded   to  the  metallic  form,  Hg°.
This reaction is common in soil when coliform bacteria, or  Pseudomonas spp.
are present.  This is a detoxication process which produces metallic Hg and
hydrocarbon  degradation   products;   however,   the   metallic  Hg   may  be
volatilized.

     Microbial and  biochemical  reactions  are not only capable  of breaking
the link between Hg and carbon in organic mercurials; they may also mediate
the formation of such links.  Elemental Hg can be converted to methyl mer-
cury by Methanobacterium omilianskii  and  also  some  strains of Clostridium.
These  anaerobic  microbes  are  responsible for the  formation of  toxic  Hg
forms, methyl  and  dimethyl Hg.   Both  methyl  and dimethyl  Hg  are volatile
and soluble in water,  although  dimethyl  Hg is less  soluble and  more vola-
tile.  The formation of methyl Hg occurs primarily under acidic conditions,
while dimethyl Hg is produced at a near  neutral  pH  (Lagerwerff,  1972).  In
addition to being volatile and soluble, methylated forms of Hg are the most
toxic.  Methylation of mercury by microbial  transformation can  be reduced
when nitrate  concentrations in  the  soil are  above 250  ppm nitrogen  as
KN03 (Barker, 1941).
                                    240

-------
   0.7
   0.6-
   0.5-
   0.4-
S  0.3
i  0.2
   0.1
   0.0
                 TOTAL Hg REMOVED

                  FROM LEACHATE
                          TOTAL Hg REMOVED BY CLAY
              20
3.0
4.0
5.0

PH
6.0
7.0
8.0
      Figure 6.19.  Removal  of  various forms of mercury  from
                    DuPage landfill leachate solutions by
                    kaolinite,  plotted as a function of  pH
                    at 25° C (Griffin and Shimp, 1978).
                                   241

-------
     Methylation  of  mercury  can  also  occur  by  a  monoenzymatic  process
involving  vitamin  Bj^ or  one of  its analogs,  such  as  methylcobalamine,
when CH3 is  transferred  from cobalt  (Co^+) to Hg^+ as shown below:
                    CH3             CH3Hg  +  CH4 + 2Co2+

                    1             /
                   2Co3+ + Hg° ->

                                               2Co2+
Another method  of  methylation is facilitated by the fungi Neurospora crassa
which can make  this  conversion aerobically without the mediation of vitamin
B12  (Lagerwerff, 1972).

     Plant  content of Hg  ranges from 0.001  to 0.01  ppm in  plant  leaves.
Mercury is  a nonessential plant  element  and is taken up by  plants  in the
form of  CH-jHg, Hg°,  and  Hg^+.    The   Hg  enters  through   the  roots  or
by diffusion of gaseous Hg°  through the  stomata.   Aquatic plants  such as
brown  algae tend  to accumulate  Hg  relative  to  its  concentration  in sea
water and contain  levels as  high as 0.03  ppm (Bowen,  1966).  As  a result,
Hg bioconcentration  presents a  greater  hazard  in aquatic food  chains than
in terrestrial  food  chains (Chaney,  1973).

     The most serious  contamination  of Hg  in the  aquatic food chain occurs
where Hg exists as methyl mercury.   The Hg poisoning in Japan resulted from
discharges  of Hg containing waste from a plastics  factory at concentrations
between 1.6 and 3.6  ppb.  Local  concentrations  of Hg were:   plankton, 3,5
to 19 ppm;  bottom  muds,  22 to 59 ppm Hg;  and shellfish,  30  to 102 ppm mer-
cury on a dry weight basis (Irukayama, 1966).

     No  specific  concentration  of  Hg has been  shown  to  be  phytotoxic.
Applications of 25-37  kg/ha  Hg did  not  reduce  yields of wheat,  oats, bar-
ley, clover or  timothy (Overcash and  Pal,  1979).   The  concentration of Hg
in soil that is toxic  to plants  was  determined  to  be greater than 10 ppm by
Van  Loon  (1974).   Foliar treatment  of rice in  Japan  has caused  Hg concen-
trations  as high  as 200 ppb compared with 10  ppb  in rice  from untreated
fields.   Mercury  levels in  tomatoes after  application  of a  Hg  containing
sludge  on an alkaline soil   were as  high as  12.2 ppm  (Van Loon,  1974).
Table 6.39  lists  the effect  of  Hg on various  plant  species  and indicates
that phytotoxicity does  not result from  growth  in  high Hg media.
                                     242

-------
TABLE 6.39  THE  INFLUENCE 0¥ MERCWi OH PLANT GRCWTH. AND YIELD
Amount
of Hg
(ppm)
.05
10
10
25
to 250
j>
CO
445
Media
Loamy
sand
Soil
Solution
Sand
Sand
Soil
Species
Spring wheat
(Triticum aestivum)
Alfalfa (Medicago sativa) ,
rape (Brassica sp.),
wheat (Triticum aestivum)
Pisum sativum
Oat (Avena sativa)
Oat (A. sativa)
Bentgrass (Agrostis sp.)
Effect
Shoots accumulated
5.5 ppm
No effect
Toxic
No effect
Reduced yield
No toxic effect
Reference
Findenegg & Havnold (1972)
Gracey & Stewart (1977)
Beauford et al. (1977)
Kovda et al. (1979)
Sorteberg (1978)
Estes et al. (1973)

-------
      Reactions with  selenium  (Se)  and cadmium  can decrease  Hg toxicity.
 Methyl Hg readily complexes with Se  and when present in equimolar amounts,
 Se readily detoxifies  methyl Hg.   Dietary  Se  protects against  the toxic
 effects of Hg in both rats and quail  (El-Begearmi,  1973).   It is interest-
 ing to note that fish taken from Miniraata  Bay in Japan had high concentra-
 tions  of methyl Hg but comparatively low concentrations of Se, with  a molar
 ratio  of Se:methyl Hg of  about  1:10.   Cadmium also  seems  to  react  with Hg
 and has been shown to reduce  Hg  toxicity  in  humans  and animals  (Perry and
 Yunice, 1965).

      In summary, the possibility of methyl  mercury reaching the food chain
 will  regulate land treatment  waste loading.  Uptake of Hg by plant roots
 can be minimized by maintaining a soil pH above 6.5.  Mercury will precipi-
 tate  as a carbonate or hydroxide at this pH, therefore, maintaining  soil pH
 is a  valuable  mechanism for  attenuating  mercury.   Adsorption  of  Hg onto
 organic matter colloids occurs most  readily at  a low pH.   Mercury   is more
 mobile in soils if It is organically complexed  than if  it  is  adsorbed onto
 clays.

     Wastes  containing some Se can also alleviate the hazard of Hg toxicity
 in animals.   Application of a waste containing  both elements  would  be less
 likely to create  toxicity problems  than  a waste  that contains only  Hg.
 Sulfur in the  waste  can also  help to attentuate  Hg by  precipitating  HgS
 which  is very insoluble.   Chaney (1974) recommends  that  wastes  containing
 greater than  10 mg/kg Hg not  be land applied since extremely low concentra-
 tions  of Hg  are  allowed for  drinking water.   Alternate  disposal   methods
 waste  containing Hg at  these  levels should be considered.
6.1.6.17  Molybdenum (Mo)
     The  largest  single  use  of Mo is  in the production of steel and alloys.
It  Is  also  used in the  production  of pigments, filaments,  lamps  and elec-
tronic tubes, and is  used  in small  amounts in fertilizers and as a catalyst
(Page, 1974).   Soils  typically have a median Mo concentration of 2 ppm with
a  range  of  0.2 ppm to  5 ppm  (Lindsay,  1979).   Shale and  granite  are the
major rocks  contributing Mo  to soils  (Goldschmidt, 1954).

     At  soil pH  values  above  5, Mo  is  generally  found as  the  molybdate
anion, MoC>42~.    At low  pH  values  (2-4.5)  Mo is  strongly  sorbed  by  soil
colloids  and organic  matter.   However, plants high in Mo are often produced
on  organic  soils, Indicating  that  organic matter  is  not a major  means  of
rendering Mo unavailable.   Sorption  of  Mo  by soil  colloids  or  iron  a***
aluminum  oxide  coatings  on  soil  colloids  appears  to be more  effective  in
rendering Mo unavailable for plant uptake.   Reisenauer  et  al.   (1962) and
Jones (1957) suggest  that  sorption  of Mo  by iron and aluminum oxides may be
due to the  formation  of  relatively insoluble  ferric and aluminum molybdate
precipitation at  this low pH.   Since Mo  behaves  as an  anion at  pH values
above 2, kaolinite which has  a high anion exchange capacity, has been shown
to sorb more Mo than  montmorillonite  (Jones, 1957).
                                     244

-------
     Soil water relationships and  their  impact  on  oxidation-reduction rela-
tionships also  regulate Mo solubility.   Kubota et al.  (1963)  demonstrated
this relationship  by growing alsike  clover on  two  Nevada soils  that  con-
tained significant  concentrations  of  Mo.   Each  soil  was held at  two mois-
ture levels.  One was a wet treatment  with the  water  table maintained 18 cm
below the soil surface; another was a  dry treatment  in which the soil water
potential was allowed to  decrease  to  -10 to -15 bars  before  watering.   The
clover grown  in  the wet soil contained  greater  than 20 ppm Mo,  while  that
grown in the  drier  regime  contained 10 ppm Mo.   Therefore, it seems reason-
able to suggest  that pH measurements  alone do  not assure  a  correlation to
Mo  solubility,  and  that  some soil redox potential  measurements  should be
made.

     Molybdenum  is  an  essential  plant micronutrient  which is  required in
amounts ranging from 50 to 100 g/ha for  agronomic crops (Murphy and Walsh,
1972), and less than 1  ppm in the  dry  matter (Stout  and Meagher, 1948).  It
is  absorbed  into the plant as the molybdate  anion  (MoO^-) and is trans-
ported to the leaves where it accumulates.  The most important functions of
Mo  in plants  is as  a component of nitrate  reductase  and nltrogenase, which
are enzymes associated  with nitrogen metabolism (Schneider, 1976).  Because
nitrogenase occurs  in  bacteria living in the roots  of legumes, leguminous
plants contain  higher  amounts of  Ho   than  other plants  (Vlek  and Lindsay,
1977), and sweetclover  (Melilotus offininalis  and M.  alba) has  been termed
an  accumulator plant.

     Plants that  accumulate unusually high concentrations of Mo are gener-
ally found on high  organic matter, alkaline, and poorly drained soils.  The
element can  accumulate  in  plants  to  high  concentrations  without  toxicity.
Allaway (1975) found plants that  contain over 1000 ppm Mo  and show no  symp-
toms of toxicity.   Molybdenum generally accumulates  in  the roots  and leaves
and little enters  the  seeds.   Table  6.40 lists concentrations  of Mo  found
in  crops from growth media containing Mo  and the  data indicate that Mo can
accumulate  in plants  to  concentrations  well  above  that  contained  in the
soil*

     Interactions  between  Mo and other  elements may  also  influence the
availability  of the element for  plant  uptake.  The  presence  of  sulfate
reduces the plant availability of Mo,  while the presence  of  ample  phosphate
has  the  opposite  effect  (Stout  et al.,   1951).   Phosphate  increases the
capacity  of  subterranean  clover  (Trifolium subterraneum)  to take up  Mo  by
displacing Mo sorbed to soil colloids.   Sulfate  ions  have a similar  ionic
radius  and  charge  as  molybdate  ions  and  compete for  the same  absorption
sites on  the root.  Manganese  decreases  Mo solubility  and  thus uptake  by
plants, by holding  Mo in an insoluble form  (Mulder, 1954).

     Consumption  of high Mo plants by animals may lead  to  a  condition  known
as  molybdenosis,  "teart" and  "peat scours."  Five ppm Mo in forage  is con-
sidered to be the approximate upper limit tolerated by cattle.   Teart pas-
ture grasses  usually contain 20  ppm Mo  and less  than  10 ppm copper  (Cu).
All cattle are  susceptible  to molybdenosis,   but  milking  cows  and  young
stock are the most  susceptible.   Sheep  are much less  affected  and  horses
are not affected  at all  (Cunningham,  1950).  The high levels  of Mo  in the


                                     245

-------
TABLE 6.40  PLANT CONCENTRATION  OF  MOLYBDENUM FROM GROWING IN MOLYBDENUM AMENDED SOIL
Mo
Concentration
in the Media
(ppm)
1
2
3
4
5
6
6.5
13
15
25
26
Media
Soil
Organic soil
Soil
Alkaline soil
Alkaline soil
Organic soil
Clay
Soil
Soil
Soil
Soil
Calcareous
clay loam
Clay
Clay
Clay
Sandy loam
Species
Grass
White clover
(Trifolium repens)
Legume
Clover Trifolium sp.)
Rhodes grass
(Chlorls gayana)
White clover
(T. repens)
Cotton
(Gossypium hirsutum)
Alfalfa
(Medicago sativa)
Bromegrass (Bromus ap.)
Orchardgrass
(Dactylis glomerata)
Legume
Bermudagrass
(Cynodon dactylon)
Bermudagrass
(C. dactylon)
Cotton (G. hirsutum)
Cotton (G. hirsutum)
Bermudagrass
(C. dactylon)
Mo
Concentration
in Leaves
(ppm)
3.0
6.5
21.0
123.0
17.0
13.7
. 320.0
2.0
1-3.5
2-7
79.0
177.0
349.0
900.0
1350.0
449.0
Reference
Kubota (1977)
Mulder (1954)
Kubota (1977)
Barshad (1948)
Ibid.
Mulder (1954)
Joham (1953)
Gutenmann et al. (1979)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Kubota (1977)
Smith (1982)
Ibid.
Joham (1953)
Ibid.
Smith (1982)

-------
digestive tract  of  ruminants depresses Cu  solubility,  an essential micro-
nutrient, thus Mo toxicity is associated with Cu deficiency.  The  condition
can be  successfully treated  by  adding Cu  to the  diet to  create a Cu:Mo
ratio in  the diet  of  the animal of  2:1  or  greater.    Symptoms  of molyb-
denosis in ruminants include  severe  diarrhea,  loss of appetite and, in  the
severest cases, death.

     The amount of Mo which  can  be safely  added  to the soil depends on  the
soil mineralogy, pH, the hydrological balance, the  crops  to  be grown, other
elements present,  and the intended  use of  the  soil.    It  is  evident that
additions of Mo  are less  likely  to cause toxicity  problems  if  the soil  is
acidic  and well drained.   Establishing vegetation with leguminous plants
should  be  avoided.   Care  must be taken  to assure that  leachate does  not
contain excessive amounts of Mo.   If  Mo is  allowed to  leach from  the  soil,
as would occur under alkaline  conditions,  the loading rate  of Mo  should  be
adjusted accordingly.

     The  use of  irrigation water  that contains   the  upper limit  of  the
acceptable concentration  of Mo  as  recommended by  the National Academy  of
Sciences and National Academy of Engineering (1972) is equivalent to  an  ac-
cumulation of 10 ppm of Mo in the upper 15  cm of  soil.  This recommendation
is based on  the  assumption  that  plants will accumulate Mo from the soil on
a 1:1 relationship,  an assumption not  always  shown to be accurate.   Since
the relationship between  soil  concentrations of Mo and  plant uptake  of  the
element is difficult  to  predict, pilot studies are the only accurate  means
to acquire this  data.   An estimate  of  acceptable Mo  accumulation is  given
as 5 ppm Mo  in the  soil to keep  plant concentrations  at 10 ppm or less.
6.1.6.18  Nickel (Ni)
     The  primary uses  of Ni  are  for  the  production  of stainless  steel
alloys  and  electroplating.  It  is  also used  in the production  of storage
batteries,  magnets,  electrical contacts,  spark  plugs and machinery.   Com-
pounds  of Ni are used as  pigments  in paints,  lacquers,  cellulose compounds,
and cosmetics  (Page, 1974).

     The average Ni  content  in the  earth's crust is 100 ppm.   In soils, the
typical range  of  Ni is   5-500  ppm  (Lindsay,  1979).    Soil derived  from
serpentine  may contain  as much as  5,000 ppm Ni (Vanselow, 1966c).

     Nickel in  soil associates with  0~*  and  OH~ ligands and  is  pre-
cipitated as Ni hydroxyoxides  at alkaline pH.  In an aerobic system, Ni may
be  reduced  to  lower  oxidation  states.    Nickel present  in  the  lower
oxidation state  tends  to  precipitate as  NI carbonate and Ni sulfide (Bohn
et al., 1979).

     Nickel sorption by soils  has  been  measured as a function of soil prop-
erties  and  competitive  cations.   Korte  et al.  (1975)  leached  Ni from  10
soils and correlated the  amount of  metal eluted to various soil  properties.
The percentage of  clay  and  the  CEC values were  insignificant  to Ni reten-

                                     247

-------
 tion.   The amount of  iron  and manganese oxides  in  the soil was  positively
 correlated to Ni sorption.   The magnitude of sorption  of  three  cations  to  a
 calcium bentonite was shown  to  be  silvercopper>zinc>
 cadmium>zinc (Biddappa et  al.,  1981).  A  column study  by Emmerich et  al.
 (1982) indicated that when 211 ppm Ni  was  added as sewage  sludge, 94% of
 the Ni  added  was recovered  from the  column indicating  essentially no Ni
 leached below the depth  of  Incorporation.    Organic  matter has  the  ability
 to hold Ni at levels up to 2000  ppm (Leeper, 1978);  maximum sorption of Ni
 by soils  is  often  near  500  ppm (Biddappa  et  al.,   1981).   However, other
 studies show Ni sorption is decreased in the presence  of  a strong chelating
 agent  such as EDTA,  and suggest  Ni  mobility would be enhanced when  present
 with naturally occurring complexing agents such as sewage  sludge  (Bowman et
 al., 1981).

     The  effects  on  nitrification  and  carbon  mineralization  of  adding
 10-1000 ppm Ni  to  a  sandy  soil were  studied  by Giashuddin  and  Cornfield
 (1978).    These  researchers   found  that high   levels  of  the  element  may
 decrease both processes  by 35 to 68%.   This result  may  imply that high Ni
 concentrations  in an  organic waste may inhibit  the  decomposition  of  the
 waste  by reducing these  processes.

     Total Ni  content  in soil is not a  good  measure  of the availability of
 the  element;  exchangeable Ni  is  more  closely correlated  to  the Ni  content
 of  plants.   Nickel  is  not essential to  plants  and in many species produces
 toxic  effects.   Normally the Ni  content of  plant  material is about  0.1-1.0
 ppm  of the dry matter.  Toxic  limits  of Ni are considered to  be 50 ppm in
 the  plant  tissue (CAST,  1976).    The early   stages  of  Ni  toxicity  are
 expressed  by  stunting  in the  affected  plant.

     Liming  the soil can greatly reduce the extent of Ni  toxicity.   Yet, in
 some cases,  plants continue to absorb  high amounts of Ni after liming.  The
 effect of  lime  on Ni toxicity is related to more than just the elevated pH,
 as  illustrated in  a  case  where a  small  increase in  pH  from 5.7  to  6.5
 resulted  in  a  substantial  reduction in Ni  toxicity.   Apparently,  calcium
 provided  by  liming  is  antagonistic  to  Ni  uptake  by  plants (Leeper, 1978).
 Potassium  application  also reduces  Ni  toxicity;  the  application of phos-
 phate  fertilizers results in  increased  toxic symptoms  (Mengel  and Kirkby,
 1978).

     When  corn (Zea mays)  was  grown  on a  silt  loam  soil amended  with a
sludge  containing 20 ppm Ni,  a slight  increase  in plant uptake was observed
as the  loading  rate  was  increased from 0  to 6.7x10^ kg/haj  however, there
was no  significant increase  in the Ni  content in corn grown on a  sandy loam
amended  with  6.7x10^ kg/ha of  sludge  containing  14,150  ppm Ni  was  a less
soluble  form.   Although  Ni  was  more concentrated in the  second  sludge, it
was less soluble  and consequently less  available  to  plants (Keefer et al.,
 1979).    Mitchell et al. (1978) studied  Ni toxicity  to  lettuce (Lactuca
sativa) and wheat (Triticum aestivum)  plants in an acidic and alkaline soil
 (Tables  6.41  and  6.42).   Nickel uptake and  toxicity was  found  to be  much
greater  in the acidic soil.   Solution  and soil  concentrations   of  Ni  and
                                     248

-------
the  response  in  plants  associated  with each  concentration are  given in
Table 6.43 which shows a varied response depending on the plant species.
TABLE 6.41  NICKEL CONCENTRATION IN PLANT TISSUE IN RELATION TO NICKEL
            ADDITION IN A CALCAREOUS SOIL (DOMINO SILT LOAM)*
Tissue
Concentration Plant Concentration
Ni (mg/kg) Portion Crop (mg/kg) Effect
5
5
5
80
80
320
320
640
640
Shoots Lettuce
(Lactuca sativa)
Leaves Wheat
(Triticum aestivum)
Grain Wheat
(T_. aestivum)
Shoots Lettuce
(L. sativa)
Grain Wheat
(T_. aestivum)
Shoots Lettuce
(L. sativa)
Grain Wheat
(T. aestivum)
Shoots Lettuce
(L. sativa)
Grain Wheat
(T_. aestivum)
6.0 None
3.2 None
<1.0 None
23 20% yield
reduction
<1.0 15% yield
reduction
61 35% yield
reduction
26 25% yield
reduction
166 95% yield
reduction
50 65% yield
reduction
 * Mitchell et al. (1978).
                                      249

-------
TABLE 6.42  NICKEL CONCENTRATION IN PLANT TISSUE IN RELATION TO NICKEL
            ADDITION IN AN ACID SOIL  (REDDING FINE SANDY LOAM)*
Concentration Plant
Ni (mg/kg) Portion
5
5
5
80
80
80
320
320
640
Shoots
Leaves
Grain
Shoots
Leaves
Grain
Shoots
Grain
Shoots
Crop
Lettuce
(Lactuca sativa)
Wheat
(Triticum aestivum)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
Lettuce
(L. sativa)
Wheat
(T. aestivum)
Wheat
(T. aestivum)
Lettuce
(L. satlva)
Wheat
(T. aestivum)
Lettuce
(L. sativa)
Tissue
Concentration
(mg/kg) Effect
6.6
2.6
1.7
241
46
64
960
247
1,150
None
None
None
25% yield
reduction
Significant
yield
reduction
20% yield
reduction
90% yield
reduction
90% yield
reduction
95% yield
reduction
* Mitchell et al. (1978).


TABLE 6.43  THE INFLUENCE OF SOLUTION CULTURE AND SOIL  CONCENTRATION OF
            NICKEL ON PLANT GROWTH AND YIELD
Amount
of Nickel
(mg/kg)
.8 kg/ha
2.5
10
28
28
100
Media
Soil &
sludge
Solution
Soil
Soil &
sludge
Soil &
sludge
Solution
Species
Fescuegrass
(Festuca sp.)
Tomato
(Lycopersicon
esculentum)
Plantain
(Solanum
paradisiaca)
Ryegrass
(Secale
cereale)
Barley
(Hordeum
vulgare)
Cotton
(Gossypium
hirsutum)
Effect
7 ppm Ni
in grass
Yield
reduction
Contained
2.5 ppm Ni
Contained
3.1 ppm NI
Contained
3.9 ppm Ni
90% reduction
in plant mass
Reference
King (1981)
Foroughi et al.
(1976)
Dikjshoorn et al.
(1979)
Davis (1979)
Davis (1979)
Rehab and Wallace
(1978e)
                                     250

-------
     Grasses  growing  around  Ni  smelting  complexes  have  been  shown  to
develop  a  tolerance for high  concentrations of  Ni in  the  growing media,
that  is, they  express no  phytotoxic symptoms  or  yield  reductions  as  a
result of the element.   These  grass species are  10 times  more tolerant of
Ni than  plants  growing on  a normal soil  and have developed this  tolerance
because  selection pressure was high.   Attempts  are being made to  use  these
metal  tolerant  strains  to revegetate  metal contaminated soils,  but  few
tolerant crops are now available commercially.  Wild (1970) found  Ni accum-
ulators  with foliar  Ni over 2000 ppm and Ni tolerant  excluder plants with
low foliar Ni at the same Ni rich  site.   Where  available it seems wiser to
introduce excluder  type  tolerant species and strains  to eliminate risk to
the food chain.   "Merlin"  red  fescue and  the  grass Deschampsia  cespitosa
are considered to be Ni  tolerant  (Cox and Hutchinson,  1980; Chaney et al.,
1981).

     There is a possibility that Ni,  in  trace amounts, has a  role in  human
nutrition.   However, there is also  a  strong  possibility  that Ni  is carcino-
genic.   Numerous investigations have  shown Ni to  be carcinogenic  to animals
when  administered  by   intramuscular,  intravenous  or  respiratory routes
(Sundernam and  Donnelly,  1965).   Occupational exposure to Ni  compounds  has
been shown to significantly increase  the  incidence of  lung and nasal cancer
in  workmen  (Sunderman and Mastromalleo,  1975).    In small  mammals,  the
LD5Q  of  most  forms of  nickel  is  from 100  to  1000 mg/kg  body weight.
Ni(CO)4  is extremely toxic  (Bowen,  1966).

     The use of  irrigation water  that  contains   the  upper  limit  of  the
acceptable  concentration of Ni  as  recommended by the National Academy of
Sciences and National Academy  of  Engineering  (1972) is  equivalent   to an
accumulation of 100 ppm of  Ni in  the upper  15  cm of  soil.    Information
obtained from Mitchell et al. (1978)  and  Tables  6.41-6.43  indicate that  the
phytotoxic  level  of  Ni  in  soil  ranges  from  50 to  200  ppm.    A  soil
accumulation of  100  ppm Ni appears to be acceptable based on  phytotoxicity
and microbial  toxicity.   However,  if demonstration of treatability  tests
indicate that higher concentrations of Ni can be  safely immobilized without
either plant'or microbial toxicity, loading rates could be increased.


6.1.6.19  Palladium  (Pd)
     Palladium  is a  by-product  of  platinum  extraction.    It  is  used  in
limited quantities in the manufacture  of  electrical contacts,  dental alloys
and  jewelry.    In 1975  the  American  automobile  industry began installing
catalytic  converters  containing  Pd.   Various  industries  use  Pd  catalysts
(Wiester,  1975).  The average  annual  loss of Pd to the environment  is 7,596
kg; much of it  as innocuous  metal or  alloys.

     Palladium  has  varying  effects  on  plant and  animal  life.   Palladium
chloride (PdCl2)  in solution  at  less  than  3  ppm stimulates the growth of
Kentucky bluegrass, yet  at concentrations above 3 ppm toxic effects appear.
Concentrations  of 10 ppm or  greater are  highly toxic.   The  element  was
detected in the bluegrass roots but not  in the tops  (Smith et al., 1978).

                                     251

-------
Palladium  (II)  ions are  extremely  toxic to  microorganisms.   Palladium  is
carcinogenic  to  mice  and rats,  however,  rabbits show  no  ill effects  from
dietary  Pd.    Aquatic life  forms,  particularly  microflora  and  fish, may
suffer ill  effects  from the  discharge  of Pd  (II)  compounds by  refineries
and small electroplaters  (Smith  et al.,  1978).  Palladium  toxicity  to  lower
life forms suggests that  losses  to the environment  should  be  monitored.
6.1.6.20  Radium (Ra)
     Radium-226 is  a  radioactive  contaminant of soil and water which  often
appears in uranium  processing wastewaters.   Commercial uses  of Ra  includes
manufacture of  luminous  paints and radiotherapy.  The lithosphere  contains
1.8 x 1013 g Ra and ocean water contains  about  10~13  g/1.

     Radium  is highly  mobile  in coarsely  textured  soils  and  creates  a
potential for  polluting  water.   The  attenuation of Ra is positively corre-
lated with  the alkalinity of  the  soil  solution and  the  retention time  in
soil, which  are governed by  the  exchangeable  calcium  content  of  the  soil
solution  and  the  soil pore  size distribution,  respectively (Nathwani  and
Phillips, 1978).  Liming increases Ra retention in  soil by  the  formation of
an  insoluble  calcium-beryllium  complex with Ra.   The  release of  organic
acids may increase  the  mobility of Ra in  the soil solution.   The  bound
forms of  Ra are  arranged in  the order:    acid-soluble>exchangeable>water
soluble (Taskayev et al., 1977).   Although  the forms of Ra  have  been  shown
to vary with depth, Ra should  be  tightly  bound  in limed soil by the effects
of pH and CEC  on Ra fixation.

     Radium should  be  prevented from reaching the food  chain  since  it  is
severely  animal toxic  and carcinogenic because of  its radioactivity.   Due
to  its  chemical similarities  to  calcium, Ra  can  concentrate  in  the  bone
where alpha radiation can breakdown  red blood  cell  production.   Radium must
be  applied so that  the leachate  does  not  exceed  20  pCi/day  (National
Academy of Sciences and  National  Academy of Engineering, 1972).   While the
soil may have  the capacity  to retain large  amounts of Ra,  the  loading rate
must be controlled  to  prevent the Ra concentration in plants  and  leachate
water from reaching unacceptable  levels.
6.1.6.21  Rubidium (Rb)
     Rubidium  concentrations range  from 50  to  500  ppm  in mineral  soils,
with an average  soil  concentration of  10 ppm.   Rubidium is  typically  con-
tained in superphosphate fertilizers  at 5 ppm and in coal  at  15  ppm (Lisk,
1972).

     Most of the information about Rb in soils  is  derived from plant uptake
studies of  potassium.   Potassium  and Rb ions,  both monovalent  cations  in
the soil solution, are apparently  taken up  by the  same  mechanism in plants.
The quantity of  Rb absorbed is  controlled  by pH.   Rubidium  adsorption  by

                                     252

-------
barley  roots  is  greater at  pH  5.7  than  at 4.1  (Rains  et  al.,  1964).
Rubidium has a toxic effect  on  plants in potassium deficient  soils  due to
increased Rb uptake and blockage of calcium uptake (Richards, 1941).

     Average Rb  levels  in  plants  range  from  1-10  ppm  in the  Gratninae,
Leguminosae and Compositae plant  families  (Borovik-Romanova,  1944).   Alten
and GoItwick (1933) observed a  reduction in tobacco yield when plants were
grown in soil containing 80 ppm Rb.   Rubidium is  rarely phytotoxic in soil
that contains sufficient potassium for good plant growth.


6.1.6.22  Selenium (Se)
     Selenium is used  by the glass, electronics,  steel,  rubber and photo-
graphic industries  (Page,  1974).   Selenium concentrations  in  sludges from
sixteen U.S.  cities ranged from 1.7 to  8.7 ppm (Furr et al.,  1976).   Fly
ash from  coal burning power  plants  can be quite  rich in  Se  when western
coals are burned (Furr et  al.,  1977).   The average  concentration  of Se in
soils of the U.S.   is between 0.1 and 2 ppm (Aubert and Pinta,  1977).

     Host Se in the soil occurs in the fora of selenites (+4) and selenates
(+6)  of  sodium and calcium,  while  some occur  as slightly  soluble basic
salts of iron.  Selenium has  six electrons  in its  outer shell  (making it a
metalloid) and upon addition  of two  more electrons,  Se is transformed into
a  negative  bivalent ion.   These anions may  combine  with metals  to form
selenides.   Selenides formed with  mercury,   copper  and cadmium  are very
insoluble.

     Selenium in soil is least  soluble  under  acid conditions, which Is  the
reverse of most other metals  with the exception of  Mo.   Ferric hydroxides
in acidic soils provide an important mechanism of  Se precipitation  by form-
ing an  insoluble ferric  oxide  selenite.   Under  reducing  conditions that
occur in  water saturated  soils,  Se  is converted  to the  elemental form.
This  conversion  provides a mechanism  for attenuation  since  selenate,   the
form which is taken up by  plants, occurs only under well aerated,  alkaline
conditions.   Figure 6.20 illustrates forms  of Se at  various  redox poten-
tials.

     Selenium is closely related to  sulfate-sulfur both  chemically  and bio-
logically.  Both have six electrons  in their  outer shell and both ions have
an affinity for the same carrier sites for plant uptake.  The incorporation
of Se into  amino  acids analagous  to that of  sulfur  has  been observed in a
number of  plant species  (Petersen  and & Butler,  1962).   It  is theorized
that  Se  toxicity to  plants  may  be a  result of  interference  with sulfur
metabolism.

     Little evidence exists  to  suggest  that Se is an essential element  for
plants, yet plants  can serve  as carriers of Se to  animals for whom the  ele-
ment  is  essential.   Plants  will  translocate selenate  only under  aerated
alkaline conditions.  Plants  containing  above 5  ppm  Se  are  considered to be
accumulator plants  since 0.02-2.0 ppm  is  the normal range  of Se  in plant

                                     253

-------
+ 1.2
+ 1.0
+0.8
+0.6
+0.4
+0.2
-0.2
-0.4
-0.6

         HSeO
    I
S4
                 \
 ASSUMED BOUNDARY
    OF NORMAL
SURFACE CONDITIONS
                               PH
    Figure  6.20. Forms of selenium at various redox potentials.
                (Fuller, 1977).
                          254

-------
 leaves.   A suggested maximum concentration  value of Se in  plants  is  given
 at 3-10  ppm to avoid animal health problems (Melsted, 1973).

      Plant species  that have  been  identified  as  accumulator  plants  are
 given in Table 6.44.  It has  been suggested that  these  accumulator plants
 have the ability  to  synthesize amino acids containing Se,  thus preventing
 toxicity to the plant (Butler  and Petersen, 1967).
 TABLE 6.44  SELENIUM ACCUMULATOR PLANTS
            Plant Genus                                     Se (ppm)

       Primary accumulators:
         Zylorhiza                                         1400-3490
         Stanelya                                          1200-2490
         Oonoposis                                         1400-4800
         Astragalus                                        1000-15,000
       Secondary accumulators:
         Grindelia                                             38
         Atriplex                                              50
         Gutierrezia                                           60
         As tor                                                 70
      Excess concentrations of  Se  in plants result  in stunting and chloro-
 sis.   The  metal  can be partially  accumulated  in growing  points  in seeds.
 Watkinson and Dixon  (1979) observed plant leaf  concentrations of 2500 ppm
 in ryegrass (Secale cereale)  and a reduced growth rate when the Se applica-
 tion  rate was  10  kg/ha.   Wheat (Triticum aestivum) grown in  a sandy soil
 was tolerant to Se applied as  sodium selenate,  and phosphorus additions  of
 50 ppm increased  tolerance  (Singh and Singh,  1978).   The data of Allaway
 (1968) indicates  that the toxic range of Se in the  leaves  of plants is from
 50 to 100 ppm depending on species.

      Selenium is  an element for which both deficient  and toxic levels exist
 in animals.  Selenium as an essential  element  is part of the  enzyme gluta-
 thione peroxidase which is necessary for metabolic  functions in animals and
 is required in concentrations of 0.05-1  ppm in  the diet.  Deficiency of  Se
 results in the "white  muscle  disease" of lambs,  calves,  chickens and cat-
 tle.   This condition gives rise to  muscular dystrophy and loss of hair and
 feathers.   The deficiency can be  corrected  by  the addition  of  Se  In the
 diet  at  concentrations  of 0.1-1 ppm.  Soils that are deficient in Se can  be
 found in  the  humid Pacific Northwest and the  northeastern U.S.

      Impacts  of Se on aquatic animal species have  been noted  at concentra-
 tions  of  0.8 mg/1.   Selenium toxicity  to Daphnia magna,  Hyallela azteca,
and fathead minnows was  reported  by  Halter  (1980) where  the  LC^Q  value,
or the concentration which was  lethal to 50% of  the population, was  .34  to
 1.0 mg/1.   Toxicity  increased with increasing concentration up to 20  mg/1,


                                     255

-------
 at  which  100%  mortality  was  exhibited.   Runoff  containing  Se would  be
 expected  to  severely  impact  aquatic life.

     At concentrations  in  excess  of 5 ppm in the diet  of  animals,  there is
 a  danger  of  Se toxicity.   The condition is  known  as  "alkali  disease,"  so
 named  because  alkaline soils  have  the highest concentrations  of available
 Se.  Animals that are affected by  alkali  disease eat  well  but  lose weight
 and  vitality and  eventually die.    Lesions, lameness  and  organ degeneration
 result  from  this  condition.   The  minimum  lethal dose of  Se in cattle  is
 documented as  6-8 ppm  in  the diet after  100  days  of feeding Se  at  this
 level.  Acute toxicity  results when animals graze on  plants that accumulate
 Se.    These  animals  develop  "blind  staggers"  which  is  characterized  by
 emaciation,  anorexia, paralysis  of the throat  and  tongue,  and  staggering
 (Allaway,  1968).

     When  land  treating a waste  high  in  Se, the quality  of  leachate  and
 runoff water from the site and the  accumulation  of  Se in  plants  should be
 considered.  If proper  precautions  are used,  Se additions  to soils  need not
 pose environmental problems.   Selenium  can  be  concentrated in plants  in
 concentrations greater  than  that  in the soil solution, so  food chain crops
 should be  avoided and grazing animals excluded from  the  site.   Maintenance
 of  low pH values  to  avoid Se solubility  seems  impractical as  almost  all
 other metals are  solubilized  at low pH values.   The use of irrigation water
 that contains  the upper  limit of  the  acceptable  concentration  of Se  as
 recommended  by  the National  Academy  of  Sciences and  National  Academy  of
 Engineering  (1972) is equivalent  to an accumulation of 10  ppm  of Se in the
 upper  15  cm  of  soil.   However, if  studies  indicate Se is  adequately immo-
 bilized by the  soil  so that  leaching does not  occur  and  plant  concentra-
 tions  of  the element  remain  below  10 ppm,  phytotoxic limits would allow
 greater application rates  of Se.
6.1.6.23  Silver (Ag)


     Silver  is  found in  waste streams  of  a  diverse  group  of  industries,
including photographic, electroplating,  and  mirror manufacturing.  However,
with the  increase  in the price of  Ag,  reduction  of  the element  in  waste
streams is  expected.   Berrow  and  Webber (1972)  observed Ag waste amended
soils  often contained 5  to  150 ppm Ag.  These  concentrations are far  in
excess  of Ag concentrations  normally found  in  soils, indicating  that  the
soil has a  great capacity for retaining Ag  from waste streams.   Silver  is
held on the exchange sites of  soil  and precipitated  with the  common  soil
anions, chloride,  sulfate and carbonates.   The  solubility of most Ag  com-
pounds  is  greater  in acid  soil,  but   even  under  acidic conditions  high
conditions  high  concentrations of  soluble  Ag are not  taken up  by plants
(Aldrich et  al., 1955).   However,  leaching concentrations  of  .05 mg/1  must
be maintained for drinking water standards.
                                     256

-------
6.1.6.24  Strontium (Sr)
     Strontium  in  soil naturally  occurs as  two  principal ores,  celestite
(SrS(>4)  and   strontianite  (SrC(>3),  which   are  often   associated   with
calcium and  barium minerals.   The  sulfate  and carbonate  forms of  Sr  are
only  slightly  soluble  in  water,   and   it  is  thought  that  carbonates  or
sulfates supplied  in  fertilizer improve the  retention  of  Sr in soil.   On
the other hand, calcium  (Ca) has been shown  to increase Sr movement in soil
columns because Ca reacts  similarly to  Sr in  soil and plants  (Essington and
Nishita, 1966).

     Strontium  is  indiscriminately taken up  by higher plants from soil and
has no nutritional value to plants.  Strontium is able to partially replace
Ca in  plant  tissues  and  this form  of  Sr has  a low toxicity.   However, the
artificial isotopes,  SR-89 and  SR-90 are extremely hazardous.   Consumption
of forage containing  these isotopes  can result in the  incorporation of Sr
in bones and  teeth by  replacing Ca.  Abbazov  et  al.  (1978) report that the
uptake of strontium-90 by plants  is inversely related  to  the exchangeable
Ca content of soils.   Strontium levels  exceeding 17,000 ppm are  common in
the elm  (Vanselow, 1966d).   In view of the  broad  range  of  the  Sr  to Ca
ratio  found   in plants,  liming  may have  little  effect  on Sr  uptake  from
soils  (Martin et al.,  1958).

     With the advent  of  atomic  testing, the  contamination of  soil with Sr
originating from atmospheric  fallout has become a concern.   Strontium-90 is
the fission element that is most readily absorbed  by plant tissue.   Exten-
sive harvesting of grasses has  been  shown to reduce  Sr-90 in soil  (Haghiri
and Himes, 1974),  although this is a very slow  process.   Some researchers
have  claimed  that  Ca and  organic  matter  applications  lower  Sr-89  uptake
from agricultural  soils  (Mistry and Bhujbal,  1973;  1974).   It  is  not  clear
whether the  applied  Ca  reduces uptake  through precipitation mechanisms or
through substitution  for Sr  in  plant tissues.   It  is known that pH effects
in neutral  and alkaline  soils   are minimal,  but  these  effects may  become
significant in soils  with  low Ca content.

     It is  difficult  to suggest a management plan  for treatment of  Sr-90
contaminated  soil  because  Sr  uptake by plants  or  leaching from soil is
poorly understood.   Strontium exhibited little mobility as  a  result of
leaching  from  the  soil of  a  20-year  old   abandoned  strip  mine  (Lawrey,
1979).  Strontium-90  is  the most hazardous  of the  fission products  to  mam-
mals.  Because of  its toxicity  and the lack  of  information  on Sr  attenua-
tion in soils,  the loading rate for wastes  containing Sr  should be  equiva-
lent to the  loading rate for uranium.
6.1.6.25  Thallium (Tl)
     Thallium occurs in the waste  streams of diverse Industries,  including
fertilizer  and pesticide manufacturing,  sulfur and iron refining,  and cad-
                                     257

-------
mium  and  zinc processing.   Thallium is  transported in  wastewaters and  is
fixed in  the  monovalent form in soils  over a broad pH range.   Thallium  in
sulfur  ore  is probably in the form  of  Tl  sulfate  under  low pH conditions.
Acidic  effluents may  contain ligands  (e.g.,  chlorine   and  organics)  that
stabilize  the  thallic  state  and  favor  oxidation of   Tl  ions  to  11203.
While Tl+3 can  be  formed  in  acidic  soils  under  highly  oxidized  condi-
tions,  it is  more  often fixed in basic soils on  hydrous  iron oxides.   Sol-
uble Tl"1", on  the other hand, is  removed by  precipitation with common  soil
anions  to form  sulfides,  iodides  or chlorides.

     Phytotoxic  levels of  Tl, in excess  of 2 ppm,  occur  in highly  mineral-
ized soils.   Because of the  similarity of  Tl chemistry  to the group  I  ele-
ments,  there  are possible interactions with  soil and  plant alkali  minerals
which are  likely to occur.   An imbalance  between Tl  and  potassium  (K)  on
soil  exchange sites can  impair plant  enzymes  responsible  for respiration
and protein synthesis  by the  substitution of Tl for K.   Antimitotic effects
attributed  to  contamination  may  occur  equally  in plants  as  well  as  in
animals.

     Plant tolerance to Tl in soil  was  observed by Spencer  (1937) when  high
concentrations  of  calcium (Ca),  aluminum  (Al)  and K were  present.   As  a
result,  the assimilative  capacity  for Tl may be  increased when Ca,  K or  Al
are present.
6.1.6.26  Tin (Sn)
     Tin  in  waste streams  originates  primarily  from  the production  of  tin
cans; it  is  also used  in the production  of  many alloys  such as brass  and
bronze.   Tin  is used  for  galvanizing metals   and  for  producing  roofing
materials, pipe,  tubing,  solder, collapsible  tubes,  and foil  (Page,  1974).
In addition,  Sn is a  component  of superphosphate which typically  contains
3.2 - 4.1 ppm Sn.

     Tin  is  concentrated  in  the  nickel-iron core of  the earth  and  appears
in the highest  concentrations in igneous rocks.   The range  of  Sn in soil is
between 2 and  200 ppm, while  10  ppm  is considered to  be the  average  value
(Bowen, 1966).   Casserite  (Sn02), the principal Sn  mineral,  is found  in
the veins of granitic  rocks.

     As a member of group  IV, the chemical  properties  of  Sn most  closely
resemble  those  of  lead, germanium and  silicon.   The  numerous  sulfate salts
of Sn  are very  insoluble as  are other forms of  Sn  in  soil; thus,  their
impact on vegetation yield  and uptake  is  slight  (Romney et al.,  1975).   At
a lower pH, increased  uptake of  Sn occurs  as a result of  increased  solubil-
ity.    The translocation  of  Sn  by plants  is  reduced by  low  solubility  in
soil.   Millman  (1957) found that  Sn  concentrations   in  plants  were  not
related to  the  concentration  in the  soil.   For   soil pH near neutral,  500
ppm Sn  had  no  effect  on crops  and did not  increase  foliar  Sn.   Several
studies show little uptake  of Sn by plants even  when soil Sn  was quite high
(Millman, 1957;  Peterson  et al.,  1976).

                                     258

-------
      Since  there  Is  no substantial evidence that Sn is beneficial or detri-
mental  to plants  and since there are no documented cases of animal toxicity
due  to  consumption  of  Sn-containlng plants,  loading of  a  waste containing
Sn  should  pose little  environmental hazard.   The  insolubility of Sn  at  a
neutral to  alkaline pH  range  prevents  plant  uptake  and subsequent  food
chain contamination.
6.1.6.27   Titanium  (Ti)


     Titanium  is  not  a trace element by  nature  and Is found  in  most  rocks
of  the  earth's  crust  In  high concentrations (Aubert and  Pinta,  1977).   The
average content of  TI  In  seventy  Australian soils is  0.6%t tropical Queens-
land soil contains  3.4%  (Stace  et al.,  1968),  tropical Hawaiian  soil  15%
(Sherman,  1952),  and  up  to 252  Is  found in some  laterltic  soils  (Pratt,
1966c).   The average  Ti  concentration in the soil  solution  is estimated to
be  0.03 ppm.
     Soil  Ti is a  tetravalent cation, usually  present as TiC^.   All  six
common mineral  forms  of Ti02  (Button,  1977)  are studied for  their extreme
stability  in soil  environments.   Titanium movement  In soil  is very  slow,
and  thus  is used  as  a measurement  of the extent  of  chemical  weathering.
Even old, acidic, and  highly weathered tropical soils  have a  Ti content in
the soil solution which is  near 0.03 ppm.  The  absolute Tt content is high
because  as  other minerals  have weathered  the highly  stable  Ti(>2 is  left
behind.    Titanium  in  soils  may  be  considered essentially  immobile  and
insoluble.

     Titanium is rated as slightly plant toxic  (Bowen,1966).   The toxicity
is believed  to  be due  to  the highly  insoluble nature of TI phosphates which
may possibly tie up essential phosphorus.  The  average value in  dry plant
tissue is  1 ppm (Bowen,  1966).   Titanium is  so Insoluble that no natural
uptake of toxic amounts has been reported.   Similarly,  there  are  no  repor-
ted values  for  toxic or lethal doses  of Ti  In plants or animals.

     The only  suggested management  for high  Ti wastes is  to  maintain an
aerobic environment  to ensure  rapid  conversion  to  TK^.   The  presence of
25% TI In  tropical soils  (Pratt,  1966c) suggests  that high  loading  rates
would not  pose  an environmental hazard.   Laboratory studies  indicate that
Ti may form very insoluble complexes with  phosphate.   Where TI wastes  are
to be applied,  the  addition of phosphorus  could be used to immobilize  any
Ti and phosphate fertilization to  maintain  plant health may be necessary.


6.1.6.28  Tungsten  (W)


     The  tungsten  concentration  in  the  earth's crust  Is  relatively  low,
Shales contain  1,8 ppm W,  sandstones, 1.6  ppm, and  limestones,   0.6  ppm.
Soils have  an average W  concentration of 1  ppm (Bowen, 1966).   Radioiso-

                                     259

-------
topes of W are the principal  source  of  radioactivity from many of the nuc-
lear cratering tests.

     The usual W content of land plants  is  about 0.07 ppm  (Bowen,  1966).
Plants grown on ejecta from cratering tests concentrate very high levels of
radioactive W  through their  roots  (Bell  and  Sneed,  1970).    Tungsten  is
moderately toxic  to  plants, with the effects  appearing  at 1-100 ppm  W in
nutrient solution depending on plant species (Bowen, 1966).

     Wilson and  Cline (1966)  studied  plant uptake  of W  in  soils.   They
found that W was taken up  readily  by  barley  (Hordeum vulgare) .   Tungsten
uptake was  55  times greater  from a slightly   alkaline,  fine,  sandy  loam
than from  a  medium  acid forest  soil.   Tungsten  is probably taken up  by
plants as
     There has  been no physiological  need for W  demonstrated  in animals,
and  it  is slightly toxic  to animals.   The I&SQ,  or  dose of  the element
which is lethal to 50% of the animal species, for small mammals is 100-1000
mg/kg body weight (Bowen,  1966).   The  element  is  readily absorbed by sheep
and swine and concentrated in kidney,  bone,  brain, and other tissues (Bell
and Sneed, 1970).

     Tungsten is chemically similar to molybdenum (Mo) , therefore its solu-
bility  curves  and other  reactions in  soil should  resemble those  of  Mo.
Tungsten does not  pose animal health  risks as does Mo  however,  therefore
loading rates for W could be higher than those for Mo.


6.1.6.29  Uranium (U)
     Concentrations of total U in soils range  from 0.9  to 9 ppm with 1 ppm
as the mean value (Bowen, 1966).  Uranium concentrations are also expressed
as pica  Curies  per  gram (pCi/g), thus  U.S.  soils contain  from  1.1 to 3.3
pCi/g of U  (Russell and Smith,  1966).   There appears to  be more  U in the
upper portion  of soil profiles.   This U  occurs  naturally as pitchblende
(U3<3g) and  is  found  in Colorado and  Utah, and  in smaller  amounts else-
where in the U.S.

     Wastes generated by U  and  phosphate mining may contain very high con-
centrations of U  and  their disposal represents a problem of long  duration
as the half-life  of U is 4.4  X 109 years.  Alpha and  gamma radiation are
associated with this element.

     Uranium is  strongly  sorbed and retained  by  the soil when  present in
the +4 oxidation  state  and  may be bound with  organic matter  and clay col-
loids.  Uranium  concentrations  of 100 ppm in  water were almost completely
adsorbed  on several  of  the  soils  studied by Yamamoto  et  al.,   (1973).
Changes  in  pH  values had  little or no effect on adsorption.   However,  U
present in the +6 oxidation state is highly mobile, so care should  be taken
to land apply U water or waste only when it will  remain reduced, such as on
highly organic soils.

                                     260

-------
      Plant uptake of U  from soils naturally  high In this element  provides
 the only data available  on plant accumulation.   Because very high  concen-
 trations of U In plants are not phytotoxlc, plants containing large  amounts
 of U nay provide  a  food chain link  to animals.  Yet  plant  uptake of D is
 usually rather low since D is so strongly fixed in surface soils.

      Uranium and its salts are highly  toxic to animals.  Dermatitis,  kidney
 damage, acute necrotic arterial lesions, and death have been reported after
 exposure to  concentrations exceeding  0.02mg/kg of  body  weight.   The EPA
 guidelines for Uranium Surface Mining Discharge (PRL 923-7 Part 440 Subpart
 E) set  the average  surface discharge  level of  10 pCl/g total  and 3 pCl/1
 dissolved, with daily maximum levels at 30 pCi/1 total and  10 pCl/1 dis-
 solved.

      Hastes containing U should be applied to the soil at  a rate that pre-
 vents leaching of D  to  unacceptable levels.  Uranium  is  strongly adsorbed
 in soils  that  are high  in organic matter, however,  U may  be  mobile when
 oxidized.   Disposal of  these  wastes should follow guidelines  set forth by
 the Nuclear Regulatory Commission and the EPA.


 6.1.6.30  Vanadium (V)
      The  major industrial uses  of V  are  in steels  and  nonferrous alloys.
Compounds of V  are  also used  a* industrial  catalysts*  driers  in paints,
developers  in photography, mordants  in textiles, and  in the production of
glasses and  ceramics.   In sewage sludge the total concentration of V varies
from 20-400  ppm  (Page.  1974).

      Vanadium is widely distributed in nature.   The  average content in the
earth's crust is ISO ppm.  Soils contain 20-500  ppm  V with an average con-
centration of 100 ppm  (Bowen,  1966).

      In soils, V can be  incorporated  into clay minerals  and Is associated
with aluminum (Al) oxides.   Vanadium in soils may be present as a divalent
cation  or an oxidized  anion  (Barker  and Chesnin,  1975).   Vanadium may be
bound to  soil organic matter  or organic  constituents  of  waste  and  also
bound to  Al  and  iron oxide  coatings on organic molecules.

      Vanadium is ubiquitous  in  plants.  The V content of  62 plant materials
surveyed  ranged  from 0.27 to 4.2 ppm with  an average  of about 1 pom (Pratt,
1966d) and a survey  by  Allaway  (1968)  Indicates a range of 0.1 to 10.0 ppm.
Root  nodules of  legumes contain 3-4 ppm V and some researchers  feet that V
may  be  interchangeable  with molybdenum as a catalyst in  nitrogen fixation.
Although  V  has  not  been proven to be  essential to  higher plants, it  is
required  for photosynthesis  in  green  algae  (Arnon,  1958).  In addition, low
concentrations  of  V  increased  the   yield  of  lettuce  (Lactuca  satiya).
asparagus (Asparagus offlcinalls), barley  (Hordeum vulgare). and  corn  (Zea
mays) (Pratt, I966d).
                                     261

-------
     Vanadium  accumulations  in plants  appear  to  vary from  species  to  spe-
cies.  Calcium vanadate in solution  culture  was  shown to be  toxic to barley
at a  concentration of 10 ppm,  and when  the  V was  added  as V  chloride,  a
concentration  of  1 ppm  produced  a  toxic  response.    Yet,  rice  seedlings
showed increased growth when  150 ppm V oxide was applied  as ammonium msta-
vanadate.  Toxic symptoms  appeared when V oxide  was  applied at  a level of
500 ppm,  and  a concentration  of  1,000 ppm killed  the  rice plants  (Pratt,
1966d).   The  data  of  Allaway (1968) indicate  that  the toxic level  of  V in
the leaves of  plants  is above  10 ppm, depending on  species.   However,  some
studies involving application  of  sewage sludge and  fly ash containing V did
not result in  any  change  in the  plant  concentration of the  element (Furr,
1977; Chaney et al.,  1978).

     When  V  is  present  in  the  diet  at  10-20 ppm  it has  been shown to
depress growth in  chickens  (Barker and Chesnin,  1975).    In mammals,  V may
have a  role  in preventing tooth  decay.  The  element is not very  toxic to
humans and the main  route of  toxic  contact is  through  inhalation  of  V in
dust (Overcash and Pal, 1979).
6.1.6.31  Yttrium (Y)


     Concentrations of Y in  rocks  range  from 33 ppm in igneous rocks to 4.3
ppm in  limestones  (Bowen, 1966).   Soils contain  3-80  ppm Y  (Bohn  et  al.,
1979).  In  soil, Y,  like the  other  transition metals,  associates  with 0^"
and OH~ ligands and  tends  to  precipitate  as  hydroxyoxides   (Bohn  et  al.,
1979).

     Yttrium is not an essential  element for plant growth.   It is found in
dry tissue of angiosperms at  a concentration of less  than 0.6 ppm.   Gymno-
sperms  contain  only 0.24 ppm  or less.  Ferns usually contain  about 0.77 ppm
Y and have  been reported  to be  capable  of  accumulating  this metal  (Bowen,
1966).

     Yttrium is only  moderately toxic to animals.  For  small mammals, the
LD50 of Y is 100-1000 rag/kg  body  weight  (Bowen, 1966).


6.1.6.32  Zinc  (Zn)
     Zinc  wastes  originate  primarily  from  the  production  of  brass  and
bronze alloys  and the production  of  galvanized metals  for pipes, utensils
and buildings.   Other products  containing Zn include  insecticides,  fungi-
cides, glues, rubber,  inks and  glass  (Page,  1974).

     Most U.S.  soils  contain between 10-300  ppm Zn, with  50  ppm being the
average value  (Bohn et al.,  1979).   Surface soils generally contain more
Zn than subsurface horizons.   Zinc ia abundant where  sphalerite and sul-
fides occur as  parent  materials  for soil  (Murrman and Koutz,  1972).

                                     262

-------
      Zinc In the soil can exl*t aa  a precipitated salt. It can be adsorbed
on  exchange sites of  clay or organic  colloids,  or it  can be Incorporated
Into  the crystalline clay lattice.   Zinc can be  fixed  in clay minerals  by
isomorphic  substitution  where  Zn2"*"  replaces  aluminum   (Al^*"),  iron
(Fe2, are  highly soluble  and  will not
persist in soils  for  any length  of  time.  Zinc sulfate, which  la formed
under reducing conditions, is relatively insoluble when  compared  to  other
cine  salts.

      The  predominant Zn species in  solutions with  a pH less than  7.7   is
Zn2+, while  ZnOff1" predominates  at   a pH greater than  7.7.   Figure 6.21
illustrates  the forms of  Zn that occur at  various  pH  values.   The  rela-
tively  Insoluble  Zn(OH)2 predominates at  a soil  pH  between 9 and 11,
whereas Zn(OH)3*- and Zn(0tf)42~ predominate at  a  soil  pU greater  than 11.
The  complexes,  ZnS<>4  and Zn(OH)2*   control  equilibrium  Zn  concentrations
in soil at a  low pH  and  high  pH, respectively (Lindsay,  1972).

      Zinc  interacts  with the plant uptake and absorption of  other elements
in soils.  For  example,  high levels  of  phosphorus (P) induce Zn deficiency
in plants by  lowering  the  activity of Zn through precipitation of Zn}( 1*04)2
(Olsen,  1972).   Furthermore,  Zn uptake is decreased when copper  is  present
by  competition  for  the same plant  carrier site.    Similar  effects   of
decreased  Zn uptake are  caused by  Iron, manganese,  magnesium,  calculm,
strontium  and  barium.   On  the  other hand,  dietary Zn may decrease the
toxicity of cadmium  in animals.

     The  normal range  of Zn in leave*  of various plants  is  15-150 ppm and
the maximum  suggested concentration  in plants is 300  ppm to  avoid phyto-
toxiclty (Melsted, 1973).  Zinc  is an essential  plant element necessary for


                                     263

-------
0.0-
  -10
6
8
10
                              PH
12
                                                             14
  Figure 6,21.  Distribution of molecular and ionic species
                of divalent zinc at different pH values
                (Fuller, 1977).
                           264

-------
hormone  formulation,  protein synthesis,  and  seed  and  grain  saturation.
Table 6.45 lists plant response  to  various  concentrations  of  Zn.

     Toxic  levels  of  Zn occur  in areas  near Zn  ore  deposits  and  spoil
heaps.  Some plant species,  however,  tolerate Zn levels of between  600  and
7800  ppm.    Agrostis tenuls  (bentgrass),  Armeria  helleri,  and  Phaseolua
vulgaris  (bean)  have been  shown to accumulate as  much as  1000 ppm Zn  in
their leaves (Wainwright and Woolhouse,  1975).

     Zinc  is  an essential  element for  animals.    Animals that  have  a  Zn
deficiency are unable to grow healthy  skin;  poultry  produce frizzy,  brittle
feathers;  domestic  animals develop dull scraggly fur;  and humans  develop
scaly skin.  In  addition,  animals with  a Zn deficiency heal slowly.  How-
ever, the element may become  toxic  to  microorganisms  such  as  Pseudomonas, a
hydrocarbon degrader, at soil concentrations of 500  mg/kg.

     Animals are  generally protected  from Zn poisoning in the  food  chain
since high  concentrations  of Zn  are  phytotoxlc.   Levels  of dietary Zn  of
500 ppra  or more have little  adverse  effect  on animals (Underwood,  1971).
The National Academy of  Science  (1980) recommends maximum  tolerable  levels
of dietary  Zn  as follows:   cattle,  500 ppm; sheep,  300  ppm; swine,  1000
ppm; poultry,  1000 ppm.   Aquatic animals are more  sensitive to  cine, how-
ever;  the  96  hour 1059  for   fathead minnows   exposed  to   Zn(II)   was
2.6 ppm  and that  for  rainbow   trout  is  14.6 ppb  (Broderius  and  Smith,
1979).

     Loading rates of Zn bearing wastes  can be  estimated using  a Zn equiva-
lent.  However,  the  use of  a Zn equivalent  la  often unsatisfactory  since
the equation developed by Chumbley  (1971) neglects  any toxic  effects due to
elements other than  Zn, nickel (Ni) and  copper  (Cu).   The  concentrations of
Cu, Zn and Nl (In ppm) in the waste are  weighted In  terms  of  Zn to give  the
zinc equivalence (Z.E.):

               Z.E.  ppm - Zn2* ppm +  ZCu2*  ppm + 8 Ni2* ppm

     If proper  precautions  are  used,  Zn .iddltions  to  soils  need not  pose
environmental problems since Zn is  rendered insoluble  in soils  where the pH
values are maintained  above 6.5.  Plants  rarely  accumulate Zn  levels  that
would be toxic to gracing animals,  although Zn can accumulate  in plants  to
high levels before becoming phytotoxlc.  The use  of Irrigation  water  con-
taining  the  upper limit of  the  acceptable concentration  of  Zn as  recom-
mended by  the  National Academy  of  Sciences  and National  Academy of Engi-
neering  (1972)  is  equivalent to an accumulation of  500 ppm  of Zn in  the
upper 15 cm of soil.   Information In  this review indicates that  the phyto-
toxic level of Zn in soil ranges  from 500 to 2000 ppm.  If the  element  can
be immobilized in soils  and excessive plant  uptake avoided,  concentrations
over  500  ppm Zn  can be  land treated.   This  concentration  (500 ppm)  Is
suggested as a conservative cumulative level.
                                     265

-------
     TABLE 6.45   PLANT  RESPONSE  TO  ZINC  IN  SOIL
  Zn soil
concentration
   (ppm)
                      Species
                       Comment
                       Plant
                       Response
                       Reference
N>
          2-4

          2-6


          2.7

          3-5

          11

         27-49
          40


         49-237


          89

         140
Wheat (Trtticum
 aestivum)
Corn (Zea mays)
 & Oats (Avena
 sativa)
Wheat (T. aestivum)
 & Oats (A. sativa)
Corn (Z. mays)

Rye (Secale cereale)
Rice (Orzya sativa)
Rye (£. cereale)
 & Wheat
 (T^. aestivum)
Wheat (T. aestivum)

Alfalfa (Medieago
 sativa) & fescue
 (Festuca sp.)
Control soil was
 Zn deficient
 (ZnS04)
Highly alkaline
 soils (ZnS04)
Counteracted root
 fungi (ZnS04)
Soil

Sewage sludge
 limed to pH 6.8
 rye grown from
 seed immediately
 after spreading
Loam soil pH 9.2
 sewage sludge
 limed to pH 6.8
Rye grown from
 seed, 7 weeks
 prior to planting
As ZnP04, Zn(N03)2,
 Zn(C03)2
Sewage sludge
Decreased yield
 in acid soils
Yield increase,
 earlier maturation

Reduced Zn defi-
  ciency die back
Superior growth
 relative to control
Toxic, plant leaf
 level 81 ppm
Little yield
 reduction rela-
 tive to control
Slight yield
 reduction

Little yield
 reduction

No effect on yield

Yield increase
 due to additional
 macronutrients
                                                                                      Teakle and Thomas
                                                                                       (1939)
                                                                                      Barnette  and Camp
                                                                                       (1936)

                                                                                      Millikan  (1946)

                                                                                      Millikan  (1938)

                                                                                      Takkar and Mann
                                                                                       (1978)
                                                                                      Lagerwerff et al.
                                                                                       (1977)
                                                                                      Brar and Sekhou
                                                                                       (1979)

                                                                                      Lagerwerff ef al.
                                                                                       (1977)

                                                                                      Voelcker (1913)

                                                                                      Stucky and Newman
                                                                                       (1977)
                                                   -continued-

-------
     TABLE 6.45   (continued)
       Zn soil
     concentration
        (ppm)
               Species
                       Comment
                       Plant
                       Response
                                                                                    Reference
NJ
156-313



  179

  223

248-971

  300


  300


  313

  480

  500


  500


  500
                      Oats (Avena sativa)
                       Zn from ore  roast-
                        ing stack gases
                      Wheat (T.  aestivum)    Loamy soil pH 6.7
Cowpeas
 (Vigna unguiculata)
Corn (Z. mays)

Sorghum
 (Sorghum bicolor)

Barley
 (Hordeum vulgare)

Corn (2J. mays)

Lettuce
 CL. sativa)
Corn (Z. mays)
                      Wheat  (T.  aestivum)
                      Beans
                       (Phaseolus sp.)
Norfolk fine
 sand (ZnS04>
Sewage sludge

Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentration
 in tops, 697 ppm
Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentration
 in tops, 910 ppm
Norfolk fine sand
 (ZnS04)
Clay soil pH 6.5

Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentration
 in tops, 738 ppm
Alkalai soil, Zn
 concent r at ion
 in tops, 909 ppm
Alkalai soil,
 Zn concentration
 in tops, 235 ppm
Good yields rela-
 tive to control
 when crop nutrient
 added
Promoted growth

Toxic effect above
 this level
No yield effect

47% yield reduction
                                                                    42% yield reduction
                                                                    Toxic effect above
                                                                     this level
                                                                    No effect

                                                                    45% yield reduction
                                               45% yield  reduction
                                              Not  significant
                                              Lundegardh (1927)
Tokuoka and Gyo,
  (1940)
Gall (1936)

Clapp et al.
 (1976)
Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Gall (1936)

MacLean and
 Dekker (1978)
Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)
                                                  —continued—

-------
      TABLE 6.45  (continued)
        Zn soil
      concentrat ion
         (ppm)       Species
                                        Comment
                                               Plant
                                               Response
                                              Reference
to

00
          500
          500
          500
          500
    500

535.7 (14
exchangeable)
    620.5

    640
          640

          893

          925
               Alfalfa (M. sativa)
Spinach
 (Spinacia oleracea)

Potato
 (Solanum tuberosum)

Sugarbeet
 (Beta vulgaris)

Tomato (Lvcopersicon
 esculentum)
Wheat (T. aestivum)

Corn (j£. mays) &
 wheat (J_. aestivum)
Lettuce (L. sativa)
               Wheat (T. aestivum)

               Rice (0. sativa)  &
                wheat  (T_.  aestivum)
               Corn (Z. mays)
Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentration
 in tops, 345 ppm
Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentraion
 in tops, 945 ppm
Alkalai soil,
 Zn concentration
 in tops, 336 ppm
Alkalai soil, Zn
 concentration
 in tops, 1076 ppm
Alkalai soil, Zn

Foundry waste,
 (pH 7.3)
Acid & alkaline
 soils
Applied to acid
 soil with sewage
 sludge
Applied to cal-
 careous soil
                        Alkaline  soil
22% yield reduction


40% yield reduction


Not significant


40% yield reduction


26% yield

Good yields

No effect evident

50% yield reduction


70% yield reduction

Toxic action
 evident
No effect
Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)

Boawn and
 Rasmussen (1971)
Khowles (1945)

Chesnin (1967)

Mitchell et al.
 (1978)

Mitchell et al.
 (1978)
Tokuoka and Gyo
 (1940)
Murphy and Walsh
 (1972)
                                                    -continued—

-------
     TABLE 6.45   (continued)
       Zn soil
     concentration
         (ppm)
               Species
                       Comment
                       Plant
                       Response
                       Reference
to
  1161


  1200


  1500

  2000

2143-3571

  3839
Grass


Chard
 (Beta vulgaris
 var. Cicla)
Tomatoes
 (L,. esculentum)
Rice (0. sativa)

Oats (A. sativa)

Vegetable crops
                                             Galvanized metal
                                              contamination
                                              (ZnO)
Grown on paddy soil

(ZnO) silt loam
 neutral pH
Naturally occuring
 high Zn peat
Toxic response


No toxicity


Damage

No toxic symptoms

No adverse effect

Nonproductive soil
Meijer and
 Goldenwaagen
 (1940)
Chaney et al.
 (1982)

Patterson (1971)

Ito and limura
 (1976)
Lott (1938)

Staker (1942)

-------
 6.1.6.33  Zirconium  (Zr)
     Zirconium  is  not a major constituent  of  most materials usually asso-
ciated with pollution of soil  and  air.   The Zr concentration in superphos-
phate fertilizer  is typically 50 ppm and  the  range in coal  is  from 7-250
ppm.  Sewage  sludge usually contains 0.001-0.009% Zr.  The average concen-
tration  of  Zr in  urban  air is 0.004g  per cubic meter  (Overcash  and Pal,
1979).   The  principal  Zr  mineral  in  nature  is  zircon (ZrSiO^)  which is
very common in  rocks,  sediments and soils  (Hutton,  1977).   Sandstones are
particularly  high  in Zr with  a concentration of  220 ppm.   Igneous rocks
contain  165 ppm Zr; shales,  160  ppm Zr;  and  limestones,  19 ppm  Zr.  The
average  concentration of Zr  in soil is  300 ppm.   The immobility  of the
element  in  soils  makes it useful  as an indicator of  the  amount  of  parent
material that has weathered  to produce a given volume  of soil (Bonn et al.,
1979).

     There is no evidence that  Zr  is essential for the growth of plants or
microorganisms.  It  is moderately  toxic  to plants.  The symptoms of  toxic-
ity appear  at concentrations of 1-100 ppm in  nutrient solution,  depending
upon plant species  (Bowen,  1966).   It is  less  toxic to microorganisms than
nickel, but more toxic than  thallium (Overcash and Pal, 1979).

     Zirconium is not an essential  element for animals and can be slightly
toxic.   Its LDjQ  for small mammals is 100-1000  mg/kg body weight.  The
element does not, however, accumulate in plants to a level toxic to animals
feeding on the plants (Pratt, 1966e).
6.1.6.34  Metal Interpretations


    There is a growing consensus in  studies  on the fate of metals in soils
that the toxic effect  of  a trace metal  is determined predominantly by its
chemical form (Florence, 1977, Allen  et  al.,  1980).   When a metal waste is
land treated, soil  characteristics  such  as  pH, redox potential, and miner-
alogy,  as  well  as  the source of  the metal  present in  the  waste stream,
determine the solubility and thus the speciation of  the metal.   Identifying
the metal form will  also establish  the  expected behavior, thus  fate of the
metal once  it is  land  treated.  Sections 6.1.6.1-6.1.6.33 provide informa-
tion on the toxicity  of  particular metal forms  to  microorganisms, plants
and animals, as well as the expected  fate of  each metal.

     In the preceding  discussion on Individual metals, emphasis was placed
on soil properties  that control  the solubility and plant availability of  a
metal.  Of  these  properties, pH  is  probably  the most important.  The solu-
bility  of most metal salts decreases as soil pH  increases  as indicated by
the  data  summarized  in  (Fig.  6.22).   With  the  exceptions  of antimony,
molybdenum,  tungsten  and   selenium, which   increase  in solubility  with
increasing  pH,  the  normal recommendation for  land  treatment  units  is to
maintain the pH above  6.5.  This is  a valuable approach when the predomi-
nant metals decrease in solubility  at neutral to  high pH values.  However,


                                     270

-------
                                                8
                             PH
10
Figure 6.22.   Solubilities of  some metal  species at various
              pH values.
                           271

-------
for  a  soil  receiving a  waste or  combination of  wastes  containing  both
metals that  require a high  and low pH, the appropriate pH  will  need to be
carefully determined and maintained to prevent problems.  If the pH must be
maintained below  6.5, the  amounts  of metals applied may need  to  be  less
than the acceptable levels  suggested under each metal section.

     It is well known that  normally acid soils require repeated  lime appli-
cations to keep the pH near neutral.   While it is  expected that pH values
will be properly  adjusted and maintained  during  operation  and closure, it
is likely that following  closure,  the pH will  slowly decrease to the value
of  the native  soil.   Therefore,  it  is possible  that  some  insoluble or
sorbed metals will later  return in the  soil solution.   Little  information
is available on the release of precipitated metals, but when evaluating the
long-term impact  of land  treatment on a normally  acidic  soil, this possi-
bility should be  considered.

     There is  little  evidence that,  upon  the  addition of  sludge to soil,
significant  amounts of metals are permanently held on  the cation exchange
sites  by  physical sorption or electrostatic attraction.   The soil cation
exchange capacity (CEC)  has also  been shown to make little difference in
the  amount  of metal  which  is  taken  up by  crops   (Hinesly  et al., 1982).
Most of the metal inactivation in  the  soil is probably a  result  of chemical
or specific  sorption, precipitation and,  to a  lesser extent, reversion to
less  available mineral  forms,  particularly when  a  soil  is  calcareous.
Chaney (personal  communication) suggests that the only reason  for consider-
ing CEC is to limit the amounts  of metals  applied  to normally acidic soils
that have a  CEC below 5  meq/100 g since such  soils would likely revert to
the original pft shortly after  Liming  is discontinued•  Consideration of CEC
as a measure of the buffering capacity more closely related to  the  surface
area of a soil, rather  than as a guide  to  loading  capacity, is the appro-
priate approach.

     The  maximum  and  normal  concentrations  of metals  found  in  soil are
given  in Table 6.46.  One must be  cautious, however, about using the upper
limit  of the normal range of  metal concentrations  in soil  as  an acceptable
loading rate.  These  ranges often  include  soils that  contain naturally  high
concentrations of metals  resulting in toxicity to all but adapted plants.

     Table  6.A7  is   compiled from  the National  Academy  of  Science and
National Academy  of Engineering  (1972) irrigation quality standards, sewage
sludge  loading rates developed  by Dowdy  et  al.  (1976),  and an extensive
review of the literature.   National Academy of Science  and  National  Academy
of Engineering  (1972) recommendations are  primarily based on concentrations
of metals which can  adversely affect  sensitive vegetation.   The irrigation
standards assume  a 57.2 cm  depth of water  applied  for 20  years on fine  tex-
tured  soil.  Recommendations  given by Dowdy et al.  (1976) limit  application
based  on the soil CEC.  The final  column in Table 6.47  ie compiled  from the
literature review in  this document and is  based on  microbial and plant  tox-
icity  limits,  animal  health  considerations,  and  soil  chemistry which
reflects  the  ability  of  tVie  soil  to  Ltnmoblliae  the.  metal elements.
Although immobilization was considered in  developing these  recommendations,
there  is  little  information  in the   literature  on which  to base  loading

                                     272

-------
TABLE 6.46  TRACE ELEMENT CONTENT OF SOILS*
Element
Ag
Al
As
Au
B
Ba
Be
Br
Cd
Cl
Co
Cr
Cs
Cu
F
Ga
Hg
I
La
Common Range
(ppm)
0.01-5
10,000-300,000
1-50

2-100
100-3,000
0.1-40
1-10
0.01-0.7
20-900
1-40
1-1,000
0.3-25
2-100
10-4,000
0.4-300
0.01-0.3
0.1-40
1-5,000
Average
.05
71,000
5
<1
10
430
6
5
.06
100
8
100
6
30
200
30
.03
5
30
Element
LI
Mg
Mn
Mo
Ni
Pb
Ra
Rb
Sb
Se
Sn
Sr
U
V
W
Y
Zn
Zr

Common Range
(ppm)
5-200
600-6,000
20-3,000
0.2-5
5-500
2-200
8 X 10~5
50-500
2-10
0.1-2
2-200
50-1,000
0.9-9
20-500

25-250
10-300
60-2,000

Average
20
5,000
600
2
40
10

10

.3
10
200
1
100
1
50
50
300

* Lindsay (1979).
                                     273

-------
rates and treatability studies may  indicate  that  higher levels are accept-
able in a given  situation.   As  is true of any  general guideline developed
to encompass  a  large variety of  locations and  conditions,  these suggested
metal accumulations could be either increased or decreased depending on the
results of  the  treatment demonstration or the  suitability  of a particular
site.
TABLE 6.47  SUMMARY OF SUGGESTED MAXIMUM METAL ACCUMULATIONS WHERE
            MATERIALS WILL BE LEFT IN PLACE AT CLOSURE*


                                                                 Soil
                                                            Concentrations
                                                           Based on Current
          Sewage Sludge       Calculated Acceptable         Literature and
          Loading Rates*       Soil Concentrations*           Experience"1"
Element   (mg/kg soil)     (mg/kg soil)   (kg/15 cm-ha)         (mg/kg)
As
Be
Cd
Co
Cr
Cu
Li
Mn
MO
Ni
Pb
Se
V
Zn


10


250



100
1000


500
500
50
3
500
1000
250
250
1000
3
100
1000
3
500
500
1100
110
7
1100
2200
560
560
2200
7
220
2200
7
1100
1100
300
50
3
200
1000
250
250
1000
5
100
1000
5
500
500
* If materials will be removed at closure and  plants will  not  be  used as  a
  part of the operational management plan, metals may  be allowed  to
  accumulate above these levels as long  as treatability tests  show that
  metals will be immobilized at higher levels  and that other treatment
  processes will not be adversely affected.
^ Dowdy et al. (1976); for  use only when soil  CEO15 meq/100 g, pH>6.5.
' National Academy of Science and National Academy  of  Engineering (1972)
  for 20 year irrigation application.
+ See individual metal discussions for basis of  these  recommendations;
  if metal tolerant plants  will be used  to establish a vegetative cover at
  closure, higher levels may be acceptable if  treatability tests  support  a
  higher level.


     To better understand the Impact of  metals on the  environment, the ele-
ments are  combined into  three  groups.   Of primary  importance  are  metals
which  are established  carcinogens including  arsenic,  chromium   (as  chro-

                                    274

-------
mate),  beryllium and nickel  (Norseth,  1977).   The  second  group  includes
metals  such as  cadmium,  molybdenum,  selenium and perhaps nickel and  cobalt
that are taken  up  by plants in sufficient  quantities to be transmitted up
the  food  chain.   Interestingly enough,  molybdenum  and  selenium  are  also
metals  that  leach  from the soil at  elevated pH  levels  if soil properties
permit  downward movement of  solutes.    Leaching  of  metals  below  the  root
zone  depends  on  soil physical  and chemical  properties, climate  and  the
presence or absence  of  soil horizons of low permeability.  Downward  trans-
port  of metals is generally  more rapid in coarse-textured  soils  than in
clays because  larger pores  allow faster  movement  of  soil water.   However,
clay soils with cracks  have a fairly  high leaching potential.  Similarly,
transport is greater in high rainfall  areas.   Though coarse  textured  sur-
face horizons allow  greater apparent leaching,  an  underlying horizon  of low
permeability,  such  as  an  argillic or  petrocalcic, will  impede  further
downward movement.   If  the  system  can  be managed to  allow leaching  at  con-
centrations  that are acceptable to  the  receiving  aquifet,  the buildup of
these  metals  may  be avoided,  thus minimizing contamination  of  the  food
chain.  The concentration of metals  leaching to aquifers should meet  drink-
ing water standards;  Table  6.48  lists  the water quality criteria  of  inter-
est.

     The third  group of metals includes  those  metals  that are  excluded from
the  food  chain since they  are  toxic to  plants at concentrations  that are
less  than levels  toxic to animals.    Common   concentrations  of metals  in
plants  and phytotoxic levels  are given  in  Table  6.49.   The upper  level of
chronic lifetime diet  exposure  for cattle and  swine  are  given  in Table
6.50.   A  comparison of  these  data  reveals  that phytotoxicity  would  be
expected  to  protect  the food chain  from arsenic, copper, nickel  and zinc.
However, some  plants take up cobalt and  mercury  in concentrations that may
cause  an  adverse impact on animals  consuming  forage containing these ele-
ments.  Cadmium, molybdenum and selenium are  not  toxic  to plants  at fairly
high  concentrations  and  are,  consequently, accumulated in plants in  concen-
trations  that  are  toxic  to  animals.

     There  is   a wide range  of  tolerance  among  plants for  heavy metals.
Certain species can  withstand much greater metal concentrations in the soil
than  others.    Tolerant  plants  are  often  found  around  outcrops  of metal-
bearing geological deposits,  on spoils  from mining activities, or on  areas
where  the  soil has been contaminated  due to the activities of man.   Heavy
metal  tolerance may  be  achieved by exclusion  of  the  metal at  the root sur-
face  or by chelation inside the plant  root (Giordano and Mays,  1977).

     While metals  are taken up by  plants, it   is  generally  not possible to
use  plants to  significantly decrease the metal content  of soils.  Plant up-
take  typically amounts  to less  than one percent of the metal  content in the
soil  and  thus  several hundred years  of growth and removal  would  be needed
to  result in   a  significant reduction  of  the metal  content  of  the soil
(Chancy,  1974).    However,  there  are  certain  species that  concentrate
selenium,  nickel,  zinc, copper  and  cobalt.    These plants  have internal
mechanisms that prevent the metals  from reaching the sites of  toxic action
in the  plant.   If  these plants  are grown and harvested,  they  could possibly
decrease  metal  concentrations  to acceptable  levels  in  a reasonable  time.
Table  6.51 lists several plant  genera that have exhibited hyperaccumulation

                                     275

-------
TABLE 6.48  WATER QUALITY CRITERIA FOR HUMANS AND ANIMALS*
                           Standards & Criteria for
                            Drinking Water in mg/1
                             EPA
                 NAS/NAE
            Quality Criteria
            for Drinking Water
             for Farm Animals
                 in mg/1
Common Parameters
  PH
Total dissolved solids
Common Ions
Chloride
Flouride
Nitrate (as N)

Metals
1.4-2.4
10
                  5-9
250

 10
                                     3000
Arsenic
Aluminum
Barium
Boron
Cadmium
Chromium
Cobalt
Copper
Cyanide
Iron
Lead
Mercury
Molybdenum
Selenium
Silver
Vanadium
Zinc
0.05

1

0.01
0.05




0.05

.002
0.01
0.05


0.1

1

0.01
0.05

1
0.2
0.3
0.05


0.01


5
0.2
5

5
0.05
1
1
0.5


0.1
0.01

0.05

0.1
25
* EPA (1976); National Academy of Sciences and National Academy of Engi-
  neering (1972).
                                    276

-------
TABLE 6.49  NORMAL RANGE AND TOXIC CONCENTRATION OF TRACE ELEMENTS IN
            PLANTS
        Concentrations of Elements in Plant Leaves (ppm Dry Weight)

Element         Range*           Toxic                  Source
As
B
Ba
Be
Cd
Co
Cr
Cu
F
Fe
Hg
I
Pb
Li
Mn
Mo
Nl
Se
V
Zn
0.01-1.0
5-30
10-100
1-40
0.2-0.8
0.01-0.30
0.1-1.0
4-15
2-20
20-300
0.001-0.01
0.1-0.5
0.1-5.0
0.2-1.0
15-150
1-100
0.1-1.0
0.02-2.0
0.1-10.0
15-150
>10
>75
—
>40
5-700*
200
10-20
>20
20-1500
—
>10
>10
Low plant
uptake t
50-700
500-2000
>1000
50-200
50-100
>10
500
National Academy of Sciences
and National Academy of
Engineering
Allaway (1968)

Williams and LeRiche (1968)

Pinkerton (1982)
Table 6.29
Gupta (1979)
Table 6.20

VanLoon (1974)
Newton and Toth (1952)
Table 6.34
Table 6.36 and Table 6.37
National Research Council
(1973)
Joham (1953) and Smith
(1982)
Tables 6.41, 6.42 and 6.43
Allaway (1968)
Allaway (1968)
Boawn and Rasmus sen (1971)
* Melsted  (1973);  Bowen (1966);  Swaine (1955); Allaway (1968).
t Chaney,  personal communication.
Note:  Toxicity  is defined by a  25% reduction in yield.
                                     277

-------
TABLE 6.50  THE UPPER LEVEL OF  CHRONIC  DIETARY  EXPOSURES  TO
            ELEMENTS WITHOUT LOSS OF PRODUCTION*
Element
Al
As
Ba
Bs
B
Br
Cd
Ca
Cr as Cl
Cr as oxide
Co
Cu
F
I
Fe
Pb
Mg
Mn
Hg
Mo
Ni
P
K
Se
Si
Ag
Sr
S
W
V
Zn
Cattle
(ppm)*
1,000
50
20#
400#
150
200
0.5
20,000
1,000*
3,000#
10
100
40
50
1,000
30
5,000
1,000
2
10
50
10,000
30,000
2f
2,000

2,000
4,000
20#
50
500
Swine
(ppm)t
200
50
20
400#
150#
200
0.5
10,000
1,000*
3,000#
10
250
150
400
3,000
30
3,000#
400
2
20
100#
15,000
20,000
2
__
100#
3,000
__
20#
10*
1,000
* National Academy of Sciences (1980).
t Concentrations in the diet on a dry weight  basis  unless
  Indicated otherwise.
* Concentration supported by limited data only.
                             278

-------
TABLE 6.51  HYPERACCUMULATOR PLANTS
Plant Species
Highest Metal
Concentration
  Recorded
   (mg/kg)
                                                         Reference
Mint family (Labitae)
  Aeolanthus biformifolius

  Haumanias trum homblel
  H. robertii
Legume family (Leguminosae)
  Crotalaria cobalticola
  Vigna dolomitica
Figwort family (Scrophularlceae)
  Aleetra welwltschil

  Buchnera henriquesii
  Llndernia damblonii
Crucifer family (Cruciferae)
  Alyssum alpestre^

  A. corsicum

  A, masmenaeum
  A_. syriacum
  A. murale
   2820 Co

   2010 Co
  10200 Cu,
   1960 Cu
   3000 Co
   3000 Co
   1590 Co

   352 Cu,
   1510 Co

   100 Co
   3640 Ni

  13000 Ni

  15000 Ni
   6200 Ni
   7000 Ni
                                                         Malaisse et al,
                                                           (1979)
                                                         Ibid.
                                                         Brooks (1977)
                                                         Brooks (1977)
                                                         Brooks et al.
                                                          (1980)
                                                         Brooks et al.
                                                          (1980)
                                                         Ibid.
                                                         Malaisse et al.
                                                          (1979)
                                                         Brooks and Radford
                                                           (1978)
                                                         Brooks et al.
                                                           (1979)
                                                         Ibid.
                                                         Ibid.
                                                         Brooks and Radford
                                                           (1978)
Homallaceae
  Homalium austrocale donicum

  H. fraocii

  H. guillianli

Nod violet family (Hybanthua)
  Hybanthus austrocaledoniaum
  II. floribundus           ""
  Psychatria doyarrei
                                       1805 Ni

                                      14500 Ni

                                       6920 Ni
                                      13700 Ni
                                      14000 Ni
                                      34000 Ni
                                   -continued-

                                    279
                     Brooks et al.
                      (1979)
                     Brooks et al.
                      (1977)
                     Ibid.
                     Ibid.
                     Ibid.
                     Brooks et al.
                      (1979)

-------
TABLE 6.51  (continued)
                                    Highest Metal
                                    Concentation
                                      Recorded
Plant Species
Milk vetch family (Astragulus)
Astragalus beathii
A. crotalaria
A. osterhoutii
A. racemosa
(mg/kg)
3100 Se
2000 Se
2600 Se
15000 Se
Reference
Beath et al.
(1941a)
Trelease and
(1949)
Beath et al.
(1941a)
Beath et al.

Beath
  Atriplex confertifolia

  Catilleja chromosa
  Oonopsis condensata
  Stanleya pinnata
  Xylorrhiza parryi

  Achillea millefolium

  Betula grandulosa
  Eguiseturn arvense

  Linaria vulgaris
  Lobelia inflata
  Populus grandidentata
  Trifolium pratense
  Viola sagittate
 1700 Se

 1800 Se
 4800 Se
 1200 Se
 1400 Se

 4100 Zn

22400 Zn
 7000 Zn

 4500 Zn
 4400 Zn
 2000 Zn
 1300 Zn
 3500 Zn
 (1941b)

Trelease and Beath
 (1949)
Ibid.
Beath (1949)
Ibid.
Trelease and Beath
 (1949)
Robinson et al.
 (1947)
Warren (1972)
Robinson et al.
 (1947)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
                                    280

-------
of a particular metal.   Although commercial propagation of these  plants  is
increasing, their availability at the  present  time  is  limited.

     Caution should be exercised when  evaluating plant toxicity data gener-
ated from  experiments  where  large amounts of metal containing  sludges  were
applied at one time to simulate  long-term loading.  The metals  may be bound
by the organic fraction  of the waste and may not be released for  plant up-
take until the  organic matter degrades.   If  it  is  desirable to  test metal
availability from single large  applications,  it is best to use waste  that
has aged naturally or  has been aged  by composting.

     Many  industrial wastewater  treatment sludges,  particularly  those  from
the petroleum industry,  have  metal concentrations lower than  those normally
found in sewage sludge.   However, the use of specific  catalysts  or chemi-
cals in certain processes  may result  in much higher  concentrations  of one
or a few metals.  If these metals limit land  application,  perhaps the waste
stream contributing the  metal could be  isolated  and  the metal  disposed by
some other means, or an  alternate catalyst or chemical  could be found that
would allow the reduction  of the limiting metal.   In  many  instances,  such
reductions have allowed  the  economical land treatment  of wastes which would
otherwise not be acceptable.

     Table 6.52 lists  acceptable levels  of metals  for which less  data are
available.  This list  is based  on limited understanding of  the behavior of
these metals  in the soil and should be  used  only  as   a preliminary guide.
If a waste which  contains excessive levels of these  metals  is to  be  dis-
posed, it  is  advisable to conduct laboratory or field  tests  to supplement
the limited information  on their behavior available in the literature.

TABLE 6.52  SUGGESTED  METAL  LOADINGS FOR METALS  WITH LESS WELL-DEFINED
            INFORMATION
Element
Ag
Au-
Ba
Bi
Cs
Fr
Ge
Hf
Hg
Ir
In
La
Nb
Os
Pd
Pt
Rb
TOTAL
kg/ha-30 cm
400
4,000
2,000
2,000
4,000
4,000
2,000
4,000
40
40
2,000
2,000
2,000
40
2,000
4,000
1,000
Element
Re
Rh
Ru
Sb
Sc
Si
Sn
Sr
Ta
Tc
Te
Th
Ti
Tl
W
Y
Zr
TOTAL
kg/ha-30 cm
4,000
2,000
4,000
1,000
2,000
4,000
4,000
40
4,000
4,000
2,000
2,000
4,000
1,000
40
2,000
4,000
                                     281

-------
     The  inclusion of  the long  list of metals  given here  should not  be
 taken  to  mean  that  any  waste  should be  analyzed for  all these  metals.
 Wastes may be analyzed  only  for  the  metals  that are known to be included in
 the  plant  processes,  or that  are an  expected contaminant  during storage.

     There is  little evidence  that  the  rate  a  metal is  added to a  soil
 influences its  ultimate availability  to  plants.   Thus,  the  total  acccept-
 able metal loading may  be done  in a single application  if  other  constitu-
 ents  of  the waste are  not limiting or  the  applications may  be  stretched
 over a  10 or 20-year period.   The  net  result would  be  similar levels  of
 available  metals  once the summation of the  periodic application equals the
 amount that had been  applied  in  a single  application.
6.2                         ORGANIC  CONSTITUENTS
     To  determine the  suitability of  a waste  for land  treatment,  it  is
essential  to understand  the  probable  fates  of  the  organic  constituents
in  the land  treatment  system.   Organic constituents are  frequently part of
a complex  mixture of hazardous and nonhazardous  organic  and inorganic com-
pounds.   To simplify  the  determination  of  which organic  constituents  may
limit the  capacity or  rate  of  waste application, it is helpful  to know the
feedstocks  and  industrial unit  processes that  are  involved in  generating
the waste.

     Individual  wastes are  generated by  a combination  of  feedstocks  and
catalysts  reacting in  definable  unit  processes to give predictable products
and by-products.   Often, enough can be determined from this readily avail-
able information  to  predict the predominant hazardous  organic  constituents
in  a waste.   Once  these  constituents  are  determined,   options  can  be
explored for in-plant  process  controls  and waste pretreatment (Section 5.2)
that may either  increase  the loading rate  and capacity or  reduce the land
area required for  an HWLT  unit.   In addition, knowledge  of the  predominant
organic  constituents in a waste  greatly reduces the  analyses necessary in
waste characterization and  site monitoring.   In  the following  sections,
hazardous  organic constituents  are  defined and  the  fate  of  these  waste
constituents  are discussed  in terms of  fate  mechanisms  and  the  fate  of
organic constituent  classes.
6.2.1                 Hazardous  Organic  Constituents
     Understanding the probable  fate  of  land treated hazardous organic con-
stituents  is  simplified  if  their  basic  physicochemical  properties  are
known. These  include  such properties  as  water solubility,  vapor  pressure,
molecular  weight,  octanol/water  partition  coefficient,  boiling point  and
melting point.  These values are  given in Table 6.53 for the 361 commercial
chemical products or  manufacturing intermediates that have  been identified
by the EPA as either  an  "acute  hazardous waste" or  a  "toxic waste"  if they
are discarded or intended  to be  discarded.

                                     282

-------
      TABLE 6.53   PROPERTIES OF HAZARDOUS CONSTITUENTS
to
oo
Hazardous Constituents
Acetaldehyde
Acetone
Aeetonltrlle
3-(alpka-«cetonylbsiilyl|-4-
hydroiyeousarln snd salts
Acetopbenone
2-Acetylamiso(luore«e
Acttyl chloride

l-Acetyl-2-thloures
Acroleln
Acrylamld*
Acrylic acid
Acrylonltrile
Aldrln
Allyl alcohol
Alumlnisi phosphide
hydro-*- (hydroiymethyl 1-1-
metho*y-S-methylcarbamate
aI lilt' ,,
misclbls Isl**."
mlsclbls 73.500 UlOlJ-"
slightly soluble 0.025 lit*"*'"
mlsctble







soluble
a ec
soluble 35,000 Iil80-"
1.0
slightly soluble 2300tl*'ppb
slightly soluble 21>l*'pptaf2S*C


insoluble . ..
practically 0.0*11 Ulo''"
Irtstolublc
slightly solubls 1,280 S25-C 1st*2'21
slightly soluble lg In 2,447g»H-c Isl*1'"
In hot HO, lg In !*7gSI»OfC
Vapor Pressure
(Torrl*
740(20 "C
40US34.5-C
74S2O*C


1P15'C

1S0020*C


2I5«20*C
l.tf*4.S-C
3.2«20*C
10*r22**C
2.3I«IO"'S20-C
10S10.5-C









1934. 8*C





0.1*20 -C
55.2*25*0


Melting point
f,7tOT»rr*
-12
-15.4
-46


20.5

-112


-BC.8S
14.5
13
-*3.5
1*4
-12*







IS*
decomposes

-(.3

decomposes (315
315(subllmesl



-it
162
5.5
-14.1
122-128

Boiling Point
•C,7t«Torr'
20.1
St. 2
m.e


202.0

50.9


51.0
12S(2STorr
142
77.5
57







1*0(1 2Torr
eiplodes*430

184



13*

214
43S sublimes
•0
It*. 7
400*740Torr

CAS
4
75-07-0
•7-64-1
75-05-S


98-86-2

75-3S-5


107-02-8

79-10-7
107-13-1
30*002
107-18-t
20859-73-8







88-89-1
t2-53-3

7778-35-4
1127-51-3
1132-21-4

U4I8-23-9
225-51-4
98-87-3
5*-55-3
71-41-2
98-05-9
108-98-5
9J-87-5


-------
OtouHkMi OnMitlmt*
OM.oUlpyr~.
•emocrleMorUt
0»n-Ill MtkM*
UalZ-cklaratkrll (tlwr
•.•VM*(2-cklorotttqrll
2-«a|*tkTl«»lM
U>|2-ckloral>oprDp]Tll *th«r
•lilckloraMtkrll *tkw
•la|2-*th*l*n»l) ffetlwUt*
•rfMfMeafeana
vroMOMtbaiM
4-iiu»>i|ifciliyl pkmyl •**•*•
fxwelmm
2-*»tiuu»lp«ro»ia»
OJ CalelOi chrOBata

Carbon 4lMlf 14*
Carbonfl Claorldw
CMoral
QiloraaiMell
cklordana l.t«ck. 1

OUonaeitaUahrJa
p-CB>loroan 1 1 1 »•
CklorobniMW

OilorobMivllvt*
l-lp-CkloroMoWTl 1-5-
••Uwrr-2-MtkrllxtoI*-
l-*c*tle «cla
Cklorod IbmBVBVtliMM
l-dilocv-2. 3-*pMir V*»V***
2-Oilon>tkrl «l«Tl *tk«r

CklOTMUMfW
Cklorofora
•Mt« 1
M22
M21
M24
M25

Ml*
M27
Ml*
M2I

Ml*
MM
r*ll
vu*
Mil
m*
Mil
ml
m2
Mil
M14
MIS
MM

Mil
P*24
M17

MM


Ml*
M4*
0*41
M41

M41
M44
«:»

1.3**15.5-C
i.im


1.12*
•.MS
1. (31*41 -C
l.tTit-WC


•.*lll«p.«r.)


1.2*1
I.I1**-I14*C
1.51

4.4)7

1.1*
1.21
1.11






1.17*1
1.M25

(.MM
1.4*
•btonlar n«t«r *ol«klllti> Oet«ol/»t«r Vapor n^nure
Mifkt
2S2.1
IIS. 4*
4.01
171.1
141.02

2*1. 2
171.07
I14.M
1*1.1
1M.«*
M.M
1*1. •
1*4. 4S
M.l
74.12
1*2.2
151.1
>2
7*. 14
44.01
147.4
1*4.1
4*». I

7*. 5
127.*
111.54

125


142. S4

•2.52
1*4.55

42.5*
lit. 4
Onlltatln
pr*ctl<;«Ur
TwolMd*
liuolvbl*
J^fSJ."

prtfetlcall}'
laMMdlot*!}'
•lan«t lit*ol«bl«




v«ry 4ol«bl«




v«rr oolvbl*



wcr ool«bl*
«n<*nt«lT
ooMbU



•olvbl*

nUtlnly kl«k
•olvblllty
ollfktlr *ol«kl>
PPN* Partition coef. (Torn*
4.**]* 1«1*"'** 7. 3»«1*"*P»
MS-C . ..
iMl*4'"
I1.M*«2S*C llloJ'J* <*.lf20-C
1*.2*O I*!*1'" *.71f;0*C

I.TM 111*1'** 0.05«20-C
12,M*t22*C 111*"*'" 30f22'C
• .4-1.W2S-C l.l*5'1 2«l«'7fl«-C
t -
5***2*>C 111*, ' 142*(2**C
111*'*™ *.*015020*C

•*.N*(25*C 111**'" *.5»25-C


2, 2**«25I« *
*
K.M* 111*, .. OOHS-C
1*,***«2**C IllOJl'J- fS4.3*C
4I*(2S*C 111*2'** .*15«2**C




1,(S««2**C 111*2'"

, ,. M14.4-C
15.00* 111*1'™ *.75*20-C

1.1«2S*C 111*, „ ,1*0
I.2M 111*1'" SB.5S20-C
IMltlne taint Ootlltif Point
•C.7**H>rr' •c.7«OTtorr*
174.5
-S-C
12*1
-44.0

-.7
-41.5
-S«
-54
-93.4
11.72
171
-7».»

AtconpoOT*>lM
-110.1
-114
-57.5

1*7. 0-104. OICllI
l*3.*-l*5.*(TraM)
-14.1
72.5
-45




M

-57.1
-70.1

-151.)
-43.5

111
2t70
21*. 1
170

1»
1*4
J««.5*5Tort
13*
4.*
11*. 14

117.7


44.5
(41
•7.0

175»2Torr

M. 0-100.1
21*. 5
112

140*0. *O41V}rr


215

117.5
10*0740

-11.37
41.7
CAS
4
50-32-0
12042-40-1
7444-41-7
111-51-1
111-44-4

.00-40-1
542-10-1
117-01-7
5M-11-2
74-4)-»
101-55-3

71-34-3

4*440-22-4
75-15-*

75-47-«

12»t-OI-4

1*7-20-0
104-47-0
100-50-7

4755-72-0


55-50-7

110-75-0

75-01-4
47-44-3

-------
                 (.S3
                                                                                                                      nrtltlo* co»f.
                                                                                                                                         (Tocrl*
                                                                                                                                                              ••ItlMf  Point
                                                                                                                                                               •C.TOHlcr*
                                                                                                                                                                        •all li>«  rolnt
                                                                                                                                                                         •C.7(0»rr«
                                                                                                                                                                CAS
                                                                                                                                                                 I
           Cklorowtkyl Mtkyl *tkK

           2-Oloroii»pktk«l«ii«
l-lo-aaomfknyll	
4-Cklor»-a-tol»lc»l»«

)-Olocot>roelo«Urll«
•Ipka-aloratalMM

Canxr cynUte
ro
OO
Ul
           Crotaiultekydo
           Cmylle acid
           CwMfM
           C]TMl«M
                    eklorU*
CyclohMMOiM

2-Cjxlok.iyl-4.4-JUltiulilil.ill
Cyelof4n*f4ual*>

BOO  IP.P'I
           U-n-tatTl rhthUit*
            .2-BlcfcloctMMW«t
            . »-M«fclo»m«
m*
MSI
MS2
MSI
MM
MSS
HO*
Mil
r*»
rui
MM

MST

r*)4
MM
MSI
MM

•4W1
                                           MM
                                Mf*
                                M7»
                                Mil
                                MT2
                                MT1
                                                     *.»7(v«r.l
                                                       .ll(lt>S*C
                                                       .MKflCC
                                                       .114
                                            .15)
                                            .U4-1.MI
                                            .MIH>.*r.)
                                             •19

                                            .7*

                                           0.44S
          2.44*flS*C

            1724J25-C
           .M4(1S*C
           .447
           .3*7
                                                                         M.41
                                                                         M.S2
                                                                         1(2. «
                                                                         lll.M
(f.S
124. M
11*. M
115.41
M-1M
1M.1S
7*.*f
104.7)
120.1*

Sl.M
1*5. »
(1.40
04.1(

M.1S

2(4.1)
Ml.l
SM.(
)2*

354.5
27*. 2
270. M

M2
204.24
234.4
147.00
lit
270.34
147.01
147.01
147.01
253.12
•llfktly

l»«oll«  S.S «*«25-C
                                                                          •llfktlT lollbU
                                                                                 iMVllbU  *.M05«2S*C
                                                                          	       DtlS-C
                                                                          •llfktly »>l»bU  145M5-C
                                                                                lr nl.4>U  11S(2S*C
                                                                                 tmol«4>U  7»«25-C
                                                                                 Inol.bl*  4»22-C
                                                                                           •.(17t»*Clc.le.)
                                                                                           2.2>lfC(e>lc.)
).202**C

3IMfM*C
10*f».4-C
1410(20 *C
77(2*-C
                                                                                                                                      11. Ill*  *3»-C
                                                                                                                                      15H0.5-C

                                                                                                                                      I7.4»30-C
                                                                                           1.M1S-C
                                                                                           2.2I(2S*C
                                                                                           I.14M5-C
                                                                                                                                                     (1
                                                                                                                                                     1.4
                                                                                                                    -SI
                                                                                                                    -4)
                                                                                                                    254
                                                                                                                          (c.lc.l
                                                                                                                                                     11-15
                                                                                                                                                     -74.0
                                                                                                                                                     10.0-)I.5
                                                                           -34.4
                                                                           52
                                                                           -4.S
                                                                           (.S

                                                                           -45.0
                                                                                                                                                               41-4S
                                                                                                                                                               ««c.
                                                                                                                                                               Ill
                                                                                                                                                               2I-M
                                                                                                                                                               27*
                         *.)

                         -)S
                         -17.*
                         -14.7
                         53.1
                         1)1
                                                                                                            2M
                                                                                                            175.4
                                                                                                                                                          btfori •.Itino
1M
111-203
152

-21.0
(1.1
D.I
M.7

115.4
                                                                                                                                                                                     IIS
                                                                                                                                                                                     ISOtrrorr
                                                                                                110-122074tTorr
                                                                                                IN
                                                                                                1)1.4

                                                                                                MO
                                                                                                1M.S
                                                                                                17)
                                                                                                174
                                                                  11-54-7
                                                                  »5-57-«
542-74-7
100-44-7
210-01-1
544-12-3

1)10-77-3
4170-30-3

98-B2-4
S7-U-S
2074-07-5
504-40-3
504-77-4
110-12-7

100-14-1
                                                                                                                                                                                             20130-01-3
                                                                                                                                                                                             72541
                   124-44-1
                   44-12-0

                   74-»5-3
                   04-74-2

                   541-73-1
                   104-44-7
                   11-14-1

-------














10
as>
<3\
















tlaaardoOT CoutltiMti
1.4-Dlcbloro-2-Mt«M
Picblerodl (loomwtkm
l.l-Dlcfcloro
1, l-Olcblonxtkylan*
1. 2-tram-Dickloratkylwia
Dlckloroawtkan*
2, 4-Dlcblocoffccnol
2, (-DlcblorOfMnol
2. 4-DlehloropknioiT
•otic acid (2.4-O)
MckloropheiirlaroliM
1 . 3-DlchloroprovvfM

Dialdrla
DlatkylarvlM
1, 2-Oi«tkly»nJr«il»«
imt* 1
M74
0*75
U*7(
0*77
0*78
0*7*
IWM
a**l
U082
N35

DM3
0(14

0*15
r*37
r*It
MM
0,*-01«tbjl-«-<2-l«tbjltklol«t»yll
•at»r of pkoarkecotfclole ael« P*39
o.o-DUtkyl-«-«>etkyl «t*r of
pkoapfcorodlfcblolc acid
DtetkyI phtfcalata

0. a-otetkyl-o- 1 2-pyra«l»y 1 1-
ptKMphorotkloata
0.0-OUtkly |ikmj>o»te thrlbmt«ly

kl«fcly >ol»bl«
klfhly •ol»bl»
kl*kly CDlabU
liwolKbl*


.lTOt l~ol*l.


•Ugktly Mlibl*

j




vodwstaly
Hlxbl*

• iKlbl*
iMOllibl*
iMBlXbl*

mi"

288*20 *C
5.500
1.700
20.000*25 *C
«.*«
0.27»
(20I25*C

2.700f25-C
2!7M(Cl«->
2.8*0|Trw»)
0.25125-C


25troo> tnp.


l.t(Of32C. (Torrl-
I |E
Ml*;,! 4.3*Of20*C
«!*, , Ufl«20>C
RIO *lf20*C
Iiej'1* 200tl4*C
• IB* ,. 380M2-C
»1«, 1 fl.J1020-C(c«lc.)
•1C2-* 1851. S-C
"*0*'«I 0.4HWC

•'•l'»S 42»20-C
•1* 25a20*C

•0* 1.7(>10'1a20*C


1 0.00018t20-C

] 22
lilt*'" 0.05»7«-C









Imla^J'jJ- 1300»20t
*



Iteltlnf Point
1-3
-1>0
-**.*•
-35.3*
-122.53
45
<•-(*
141

-180


15.





-40.5



1(9-172

-82
50

137-138
-92.19
114-117
122-123

Boiling Point
•C, 7*OTorr»
15*
'29
57.21
13.47
37(101. 3)
-------
           TMU (.S3   (eoatlaaa*!
00
1
aaxardoaa Qiaatltaaata
alpha .alpka-maatkTl
Dlaetarlcarbaaorl calorUa
1 . l-Ma*thyihT*ra.laa
lIl-Olaatbyl-l-laataTltalol-
2-aataaoaa-O-Haatkrlaalaol-
earboarlloala»
Maatkrlal troaaaalaa
alpfca.alpka-Maatklrphaaatarl-
2v4-0lNetarlphaaol
Maatarl aktbalata
Diaatalr aaltata
4,*-Dlaltro-o-craaol aad aalta
2.4-Bialtrophaaol
2.4-Haltrotolaaaa

OI-«-octrl pataalata
Iv4-41o.aaa
l,2-dipaaa4rlar*railaa
MvropTlaalaa
Dl-a~proprlaltnaaBljM
2. 4-Mthlablacat
gmlo.alfaa

y- — . .
Itbrl aeatata
•Uqrl aerylata
«tarl cra-l*» __._
SSlaaa5laal2lDr*^"""t*
tthvaalfllaa
•tbylaao aeMa

UkTl atkar
ttaylM tbat I flata
rarrle cyaaloa
rlaoraataaaa
Utaraoal
aa.ti 1
MM
M»7
MM
MM
M45
•I*
r*4»

•1*1
•Ml
t»47

•1*1
MM
•1*7
MM
•1M
•11*
•111
M«*

Pt5l
•111
Mil
r*52
•114
P*S1
JJ^
MIS
Ml*
•117
Mlt
•11»
•1I»

l««/ei3l*
l.*S
l.«7*«2**C
*.7*2(2S*C
*.*724«2**C
l.M5*2**C
•.*MS*2**C
l!lJ22(2*-C
14* l.H3*2«-C
1.52KI5-C
1.1*1
*.»7*tii*c
*.*i2«n.*
*7.1
117.2
55-54
I..7

34.4
11*

3*7
CAK
1
57-U-7
540-7J-I
42-75-»
1.5-479
I31-1I-]
531-521
51-21-5
121-14-2
tOt-20-2
117-.IO-0
.1 122-44-7
H2-M-7
C21-C4-7
115-29-7

72-20-B
KI-71-t

1*7-15-3
151-54-4
75-21-*

4*-29-7

373*7-45-4
2OC-44-0

-------
         ruut (.si  (eo«l«Mdi
                   OMMtltXMiU
                                                                                  OMllUtlrt
                                                                                                OOl«»llltT
                                                                                                                                    Vapor Fr«aaur«
                                                                                                                              Coal.    (Torr)'
                                                                                                                                                          HaltlHf Point
                                                                                                                                                                                              CAS
                                                                                                                                                                                               I
rlaocoaoclc acid aodi»» aalt
rl«orotrlekloraa»tbaaa
roraaldabrda
ramie acid
00
00
akptacMor

iKtaehlorobatad l«n

•nacnloroerelobuan
Hataebloroeyelopmtadlaiia
•aiachlonetbai
I.I.J.4.10.10H
                       auahydra-
•aiacholoi ptupam
IhuaUqrltctraplioaphata

•yiKucfante acid
nplxvfloacle acid

•ydrota* calflda
•ydtoirdl
IndamUi
         Iroa Daatraa
         laobvty] alcohol
         laocyanle  acid
         laoaalrola ITr
•111
•in
•in
•lit
•us
                                         •11T
                                         VII*
                                         DIM
                                         Hill
                                         0111
                                         r*u
•us
HIM
0117
•1M
•in
MM
•141
                                                   1. Mf-WC
                                          I.4(4*17.1-C
                                          *.015f-20-C
                                          1.21*

                                          0.94
                                          I.Kir:
                                                   l.t4«N-c(«.*r.l
          1.1*1IHS*C
          •.(•7lni.fr. I
                                                   |»|>.gr.|
                                                   l.U««/l*«*C
                                                                       70.9
                                                                       117. II
                                                                       M.*
M.2
171
201.70
2(1. 74

291
271
211.74
                                                              4M.9

                                                              240.0
                                                              Ml.4
                                                              II. OS
                                                              27
                                                              19.91
                                                              14.0*
                                          	                U*.»
                                                              27«.14
                                          2.279*C             141.95
                                                              U*,M*
                                          *.7IM25*C(K>.fT.|  74.1
                                          1.140CC            4J.O1
                                                              1(2.2
                                                                                  •Ixlbte
                                                                                  •tMlbl*
                                                                         •taoct
                                                                         •Unit l»olX>U
                                                                                                    •.OMtH-C
                                                                                                    *.*19
                                                                                                    l.(JU5-C
                                                                                                    ».7*<25*C
                                                                                           27.3
                                                                                           SO
•>10,


4llo!
                                                                                                                               *2J-C
           •laclbla
           •laelbla
           •iMlbla
                                                                                       •olabl*
                                                                                      Mlr «
                                                                                  ImolvkU
                                                                                                                     Ult
                                                                                                                     ,.„
                                                                                                               i'-M-
                                                                                                               0.01
               0.00*25-C
               *.4*»*C
               14.4I25*C
               40**4*>C
               4M*25*C
                                                              u"***io-c

                                                             12.2*2S*C
                                                                                                                   11
                                                                                                                   -111
                                                                                                                                                            1.1

                                                                                                                                                            -05.«
9I-M
227-2M
-11

117-151
1*9
                                                                                                                                                            1H-K7
II
-11.2
-01.1

-«S.5
192

-«!4

-IN

*.2
                                                                                                           24.1

                                                                                                           IM.O
                                                                                                                                                                                  11.1*
                                                                                                                                                                                  1(1.7
                                                                                                                                         122-121
                                                                                                                                         21S
                                                                                                                                         111
                                                                                                                                        ll«»77TTnrc
111.1

19*54

-«*.4


42.5

1*1.1
21.1
251
                                                                                (2-74-1
                                                                                75-19-4
                                                                                SO-40-0
                                                                                (4-10-C
                   7(-44-(
                   110-74-1
                   07-iO-l

                   119-04 -(
                   119-05-7
                   119-01-0
                   77-47-4
                   (7-71-1
102-4)1-2
74-90-0
                                                                                7701-0(-4

                                                                                191-J5-S
                                                                                74-00-4
                                                                                9«4-((-4
                                                                                70-01-1
                                                                                »24-H-»

-------
TMLC (.51  (conlinoxll
taiardoM
•aiardooa CbMtltiaMU Haatt I
lapona
l*alocarpln«
Lead acvtat*

Laad >obae*tat«
Halale ankydrld*
llalale nydra«ln«
Malononltrlle

II* «CT
'
Mvrcwry fnlatinat*
Hatkncrylonltrlla
ItethMatklol
Hethanol
Nethapyrllxna
rO 2-Hetkylailrldlna
rn Hathyl diloroearbonata
"7; 3-*»thylcholanthr«na
*** 4.4>-a»thylena-bla-|2-
ckloroanlllnal
Itetbylethyl tetonc(im)
Hetkylctkyl Intone peroildvtl}
Hetkrllaobvtyl totoiM
Hetkyl vetbacrylat*
carbofiylloxlBC
•Htttkyl-ll'-iiltro-oi-

Hetkyl parathlofi
Netbrltklonraell
Maphtl»al«n«
0142
•141
V144
D14I
0144]
0147
0140

0150
0151

V4)C3
0151
O154
D155
Tttt
rM7
015(
O157
DIM
OlSt
DIM
01(1
POM
01(2
NT*

D1O
r»7i
01(4
01(5
Oenalty


1.55
(. *-7.3
*.714,».,r.,
1.04*al4*C

11.54«*p.9r. )

4.42tBf>.9r.|
O.M5
•.•(•»2>*C
0.71*5<>p.«r.)
1 JMt.H'C
1.221
1.21
•.••5(q>..r.)
• .174
•.Oait2S-C(ap.9r.)
•.tl((«p.ir.|



1.351
1.1(2
Holtciilar
Htl«kt
4»».7
411. (
17*. 15
•11.5*
>0.0(
112.1
((.1

2M.(1

114.7
(7.0*
40.10
12.04
1(1.4
10. 10
M.50
2(1.1
2(7.2
72.1
W.I
4(
1M.K
1*0.11
1*0.1

147. 1
2(1
Ml. 2
120.1*
Katar Kolabllltr Octaaol/llator Vapor Poaann
Owllutln PTfl* Partition COef. (Torn*


•oltibl*

».rr aol»bl< 111.000010-c 1>10~*-U 1H4-C
aoMCwbat aolabla . ..
•taclbla lllO

alnoat Inaolabla l».2pf*»5-C o.0012a20-C
01.1ppb«10«C
aalubl* In tot *,o
* 1«10"" (5025-C
illgktly aolabla C1520WC
In hot «,0 . ,,
• laclbla' lllt^j, - lOOajl-c
klfhly aol«bl« 10, 000-50, 00* 2 5«tO~5»J5-C
ItiaollbU
*try aoltlbl* 100,OM«25'C 1 71.2V20-C
alUbtly aelabl* 4*.(f25*c
• lUhtlr aolabl* 1»,000»J5-C 1 1(»0-C
alight lr aol«bl« >20 lilO*'74 2I«20-C


•
• lightly aolabla 55-M025*C 02 O.»7>10 *20-C
•lightly aolabla 14.4*25-C
IKltlng Point
•C, 7(OTorr«
daeoapow

75, anhydrova 200
1,014
53
M.5

-10. 07

••plofea
-121.1
-»7.0
70-7*
in
-05.*
-•(.75
-20.4
-•4.7
-5»



30
KP. 55
Boiling Point
•C.7MTorr'
C



2*2
220

15t-J50f20Torr


•0.1
•4.*i

71.4
lOOOOOTbrr
7*. 57
•7.0
1K.I5
1*1.1



217.4
CAR
1




100-11-S
IO*-77-3

743«-*7-«


74-JJ-l
«7-5*-l
K75Z-75-5
75-55-0
5<-4*-5
101-14-4
(0-34-4

00-.2-.



«-2,-3

-------
                                                                                         mur lolikllttr
to

O
                                                                      Ikiltkt
                                                                                 OMllt«tl»
                                                                                                                 OctMVl/K>t
         •Ickcl c«bo«rl
         Htetel ey«M*
         •Jlcotln ««d »1U
         •Uric mid*
        Hltr
        Kltr
        •JltroTNi p«ro*l*>
        p-HUroplmiol
        2-MltropcopHW
        N-4HtnModl-»-batrl«iin
         5-Hltro-e-tolwldlM
         Ol.yl  alcatel
         2 «ol«« •
7-OubleTGlol2.

F«rM« i»
                               hot ««t«r
                                                                                          4WIWC
                                                                                          1IU7-C
                                                                                          J.J*14«-C
                                                                                                       Htltlii* rout
                                                                                                        •C.TDTtton*
                                                                                                                                      "oiil-i Poiit
                                                                                                                                       -C.TMTttrr-
                                                                                                                   I*
                                                                                                                   lll.S
                                                                                                                   141.5
                                                                                                                   ].*
                                                                                                                   -*. 3
                                                                                                                   -III
                                                                                     11
                                                                                     111-114
                                                                                                                                                               •ttrti to BukillB*)
                                                                                                                                                                        1M. I
                                                                                                                                                                        IDi.l
                                                                                                247.3
                                                                                                -t51.lt

                                                                                                111.1
                                                                                                111
                                                                                                21
                                                                                                -191.11
                               •al«bl«
                               •UtktlT nlibl*
                                                           IM.Itl
                                                           I4H5-C
                                                           1.11$
                                                                  4),4M
                                                                  1S4.M
                                                             1.74H1I 9t»*C
                                                                                      11.*
                                                                                      175
                                                                                                                                                                                 III

                                                                                                                                                                                 11
                                                                                                                                                                                 U7-Ul«T«r
                                                                                                 114.4

                                                                                                 177
                                                                                                                                                              CAS
                                                                                                                                                               1
                                                                                                                                                           1JO-15-I4
                                                                                                                                                           U4-12-1
                                                                                                                                                           *•-»-]
                                                                                                                                                           1*102-44-0
                                                                                                                                                           120)3-41-7
                                                                                                                                                  •»-«-€
                                                                                                                                                  Hl-44-7

-------
TMU (.51  «XMtll»Md>
          GonctltiMfiU
                                                             MtlfM
                                                                        ouilutln
                                                                                •»t*r (olifellltr
                                                                                                        Oetmol/lhtor
                                                                                                        Mrtltlp* Cnl.
                                                                                                                               rr»»r
                                                                                                                           ITorr)'
                                                                                                                                                                   •oitint romt
                                                                                                                                                                    •C.TMttori*
                                                                                                                                               CAS

                                                                                                                                                1
FwitacfclorottbM*

PcfltaeklorMltnbMwiic
FhMptoratktolc acid. t.t-
•BltoiMaU*
rtafflmofm BBlfld*
FhtUlIc i  -  - ''
1-PlCOlln*
1.1-rmpMwdtol
1.1-rnfBM Ballon*
rroplaltrll*
MOCClHOl
teccfcnlfi
*Bfnl*
MlmtOM Mid
Illnc eyBKld*

lodlB*. eyBwld*

MrontlB* «tlfld*

1. 2, «, 5-ntrKXJloroMnii
DIM
MM
0115
am
MIT
•ill

Ntl
rni
mi
                               MM
                               •Itl
                               •in
                               MM
                               MM
                               Mil
                               MM
                               Mil
                               MM
                               M»7
                               Mil
                               MM
                               MM
                               MIT
                               MM
                                         l.«7JH5-C
                                         ».»?•
                                         l.Tll*2I*C
                                         1.1
                                         1.15*
                                         1.17
                                              */lM*C
l|>p.tr.)
«15-C
                                         t.*S*15
                                         1.51 «fC
                                         •.flltll-C
                                         I. 71»1
                                         l.«715
Zll.l
1M.15
115

m.ii
M. II
                                                             151.1
                                                             H*.4
                                                             M.*l
                                                             14. M
                              111.14
                              141.11
                              11.13
                              (1.11

                              n.i

                              1U.1
                              55.••
                              51.11
                             S«.l
                             71.11
                             1M.M
                                         1.IM*
                                         1.M4I1J-C
                                         1.IMWC

                                         l.fl
                                         l.MC
                                         l.l7t!S*C
                                         l.lSttlfC
                                                !l*COp.«r.l
                                                             111.11
                                                             111.1
                                                             1(1.11
                                                             III.M
                II1.M
                «.*!

                1(5.1
                lit. 7
                111.41
                215.»
                                                                                          5M
                                                                                          14«n*C
                                                                                          l.44tlfC
                                                                        • lljhtlr «ol»bl«   Mtroo.
           •lifktlr tol»bl«
           •ollbll
           •ol«t>l>
                                                                              t olxbl*
                                                                              !»•
                                                                                                          1
                                                                                                          1.14
                                                                                                                         *.MII4(»>C
                                                                                                                         IIMCII'C
                                                                                                                         1 »••«->•€
                                                                                                                        24i»2tt:
                                                                                                                        ll.(«2l*C
                                                                                                                        14(2*-C
                                                                                                                        1-417-C
                                                                                                                                                 -15.1
                                                                                                                                                 141
                                                                                                                                                 154
1)1.1
-71
(14.5
                                                                                                                          in
                                                                                                                       in-ill
                                                                                                                          in
                                                                                                                          1*1.75

                                                                                                                          155-175


                                                                                                                          Ill-Illf».<

                                                                                                                          -17.5
                                                                                                                                                                      tit (HkllB
                                                                                                                                                                      11*
                                    t«l  I7-K-5
                                        I1-U-*
                                        5O4-SV9
                                                                                                                                                                                         75-44-5
                                                                                                                                                                                         7MJ-51-I
15-44-*
m-M-i
151-5 •-•
                                                                                                                                            57-S5-*

                                                                                                                                            1*7-11-*
                                                                                                                                            1*7-11-1
                                                                                                                                            1*7-11-7
                                                                                                                                            110-K-l
                                                                                                                                            1M-51-4
                                                                                                                                                                                        ST-14-9
                                                                                                                                                                                        tS-»4-)

-------
(.S3

•rardoM CbMtltvnti
1,1. l,2-T»tr«eklul mtkiM
1.1,2, 2-l»tr«ekUco«lk«««
l*tr*efeloco*tlMiM
IvtradiloromtlMiw

2, ), 4 , (-TW tnckloroptenal
l*trMtkyl Ind
YttrMtbyl pyropkoantete

T«Ct«iiltiu«ilkiiii
Tlulltc oxldi

TfcMlltMi earfaOMt*
Thalllo cblorUt
TnaltlHi nitrate

YtMlllM •Vlfftt*
to Tiiliinmnaln'i
VO TkloMfilcattwrnUt
tO Thtowu

Tolo*M

Tallinn) !«•!••
o-TolnldliM krdroeMorU*

ItotmkviM
Tr IbrOnOMtkMM

1, l.l-Trle4UaiwtlMM
1, 1, 2-Tr IcklonctlMM
Trleklaco«tk«i»
TrlckloroflmoMtkMn
Tr lcbloco..tk...tlilol
2.4, »-Trlc*lompk«liiil
2. 4. t-TrlcMoiupktuul


•otic «cld(2.4,5-T|

•Mte 1
•2U<
•2**
•211
• 211

•212
P1H
nil
•213
nil
nil
•214
•219
•7.14
•211
ni4
PUS
•21*
P114
•211
nil
02N

•221
•221
022)
•224
•225

•224
•221
•22*
riu
Bin
•2)1


•2)2
Bmlt* 1
!*•>/«•'••
1~5»53 .«r.)


l.(5**l*"C
1.2M
*.*l*2
l.(5>tl)*C
*.(SV21*C
1.4*
T.ll
7.1*
S.5I

(.77


1.4*5

*.•*«

1.447

1.22
l.W*
2.14*

1.3)2
1. 4*4*11. 2-C

1.47««3-C<«p.«r.l
1.475«25-C
(Ip.Cr.l

1.4*2

W1,M
147.'»
145.1)
15). *2

2)2.*
123.5
2*». 2
72.1
1N.M
45».7I
2(3.41
44*. 7*
2)*.*
244.4
2*).)
1*4.14
75.2*

7(. 1

*2.11

122.17
14)>il
174.14
41)
252.75

111.41
111.41
1)1.34
1)7.4

1*7. 4(
1*7.4*


235.5
IMter lolBbllltT Oct.«ol/H»t«r
(kwlltatlra mi* nrtltlcM Cg*I.
•Il9ktlr >ol>bl* 2(N '«"J'n
• ll*ktlr MUM* 2>W I«I*,I:
111*, „
•ii«ktir Boiifci* i5*-2M(2**c im, :;
•llfktly •olebli 1**>«2S*C 1«1«J , -
****5 0*
• IXMt lMel»bl< I*i0
ln«ol«bl«
•iMlbU 1 ...
•liclbl* 111**'**












• ll*ktl>7 >ol«bU 47*-5)4.*(25*C 1«14, !'-
1«1**'"
v«ry aolvbl*


•laaat Iwallbl* .4-4.3 *2> , ,.
•ll«ktl|> Mlvbl* ,(1((1S*C 1«1*'
,l**t]**C 2 j
•lllfctlj lolibl* 2M Ul«|'iJ
•ll*ktlr »ol.bl. ,1***»>C lil*,f:
• lllktl; •olvbl* ,!•• l»l*'*"
2 72
.iitktir Miobi* IM i«i*J ,;-
•llfktly MlDbl* *MI23*C 1»1*?-J!-
1«U

• lltktl/ (nl«bl« 22lf25*C 4
V«por Pre»ar«
rr*
12*
144.2
121
74.54

221
1*4-202 ld*eo»po«

44-45
125.7

*

72*
41*

(4»eoBpo»e« )


(deconpose*)

lie. 4

2*1

251
d«CO*poB* • > 1 2tt
145.5

74.1
113.77
•7
23.*

251
244.5



CAf.
1
4)0-20-4
7»-)4-5
117-11-4
54-21-5

S«-W-2
el)

!<>»-•! 9
505-14-8
12451-21-7


13453-32-2





42-54-4

104-HR-)




0001-15-2
75-25-2

71-55-4
7»-00-5
75-01-*
75-4»-4

»5-«-4
44-04-2


»)-74-5

-------
            TABLE 4.53   (eontlmiadl
NJ
VO
U)

•aEardoua Cowtltaenta
2.«.t-Trl«*lotoptmie«7-
proplexle acidl2. 4. 5-TCrw»
1 1. >« SI-Trlnllrobaajwtia
Trla(2v ) Jllll U*m'HI|T 1 1
phoaphaM
Trypan blw
Oracll auatant
Orathan*
Vanadle acid, atannloa) aalt
Vanadlv» pmtt»ld«(Di«itl
IP-I
line cyanide
line pnoaphtd*
•Onlvaa otncrvlM notedi at
•aiardooi
•ait* 1

am
U2J4


aiM
•JJ7
u»*
P11V
ri2»
""*
rui
•123
2t*C anUaa
o.n.Ut~ 1
l««Vc«"l*


l.MI
-



9. TCC2

1.3S7tl**C
•.H«lS>C(ap.«r.)
I.HMflS'Clap.ar.)
4.55H3-C
oth.rvl« ..tad.
•alaealar IUt«r Bolvelllty Octinol/Hjtcr Vapor Pre»iirt
Nllaht Oulltatlo m* Paztltlon Co«C. *

Ka,3 allahtly aolafela . ._
111.11 alj«ktly aotobl* 1» lil«I>J

«»7.7 ». 02«r»»25 1:
Kl.» aolubl.

>V9.1 10f-T7. 8*C

lll.M
!••.> all^htly aolabl* 175i25*C !•!•," 10t^2. l-C
1M.1 illiktly aolabl* lit lite, " loul.j-c
1M.1 allfhtly aolflbU 1» lilf'* " 10*27. 3*C
]». 10

Halting Point
•C. HOTorr*

1$2
172

5.5


49

CM
-47. »
13-14
421

Molting foint CAS
•C,7»»Torr' |


dvcoMpoacs 99-15-4




114

decoapoacfl*] 750
144.4 95-47-S
I3» HO-1S-3
138 1B6-4J-J
557-21-1
1.108 51810-10-0


-------
      Commercial  chemical  products or manufacturing intermediates that have
 been  identified  as  acutely  hazardous have  been assigned  three digit numbers
 preceded  by  the  letter  "P"  (i.e.,  P003 for acrolein).  An  acutely hazardous
 waste is  defined by the EPA (1980b)  as having at  least one of the following
 characteristics:

      (1)   it has been found to  be  fatal  to humans  in low doses;

      (2)   in the absence  of data on human toxicity it  has been shown
           in studies to have  an oral LD^g  toxicity to rats  of less
           than 50 mg/kg;
      (3)   it has an  inhalation I^Q  toxicity to rats  of  less than
           2 mg/1;
      (4)   it  has  a dermal LD^Q  toxicity  to  rabbits  of  less than
           200 mg/kg; or
      (5)   it is  otherwise capable  of causing or significantly contrib-
           uting  to  an increase  in  serious  irreversible or  incapacitat-
           ing reversible Illness.

      Commercial  chemical products  or manufacturing intermediates that have
 been  identified  as  toxic have been assigned  three  digit  numbers  preceded by
 the letter "U" (i.e., U0222 for benzo(a)pyrene).   A toxic waste is defined
 by  the EPA  as  having  been  shown  In  scientific  studies to  have toxic,
 carcinogenic,  mutagenlc or teratogenic  effects  on humans  or  other  life
 forms  (EPA, 1980b).

      Physlcochemical properties  listed in  Table 6.53 were  compiled  from the
 EPA background  documents on the Identification  and listing  of hazardous
 waste  (Dawson  et  al.,   1980;   Sax,  1979).   The   table  is  largely  self-
 explanatory  (i.e.,  highly  water soluble  compounds  may  be  leachable,  and
 compounds  with  high vapor  pressures  may  be lost  through volatilization),
 with  the   possible  exception of  the octanol/water  partition coefficient.
 This  is  defined by  Dawson  et al. (1980)  as "the  ratio of  the chemical's
 concentration  in octanol  to that  in water  when  an  aqueous  solution is
 intimately mixed with octanol and allowed  to separate." Dawson goes on to
 say  that  this   value   reflects  the  bloaccumulative potential, which  he
 defines as the ratio of  the concentration of  the compound  in  an aquatic
 organism  to  the concentration  of  the compound in the  water to which the
 organism  is  exposed.   The  octanol/water partition coefficient  may also be
 used  to  estimate the distribution  coefficient  (K^) for organic constitu-
 ents  in a  soil/water system  (Karickoff et  al., 1979) as  follows:


                        [Kdli -  6.3 x 10~7  foc [Kow]i                 (6.4)

where

     foc - fraction of  organic  carbon in the soil  (g of  organic
           carbon per g dry soil);
     KgW » octanol/water partition coefficient; and
       I = solute index.

                                     294

-------
     It is important  to  understand the fate of hazardous organic constitu-
ents  because of  their potential  impact on  human health  should  they be
released  from the treatment unit.   Consequently,  it  would  be  helpful to
have a means  of obtaining  available  data on the human health impact of the
hazardous  constituents in  a land  treated waste.   Table  6.53  lists the
Chemical  Abstract Service  (CAS) Registry  numbers which  are  the  primary
listing mechanism for a  variety of  computerized  data  searching  services
such as the  Dialog computerized listing  of Chemical  Abstract and  Environ-
mental Mutagen Information Center (Oak Ridge, Tennessee).  These  data  bases
are continuously  updated and can therefore  be  extremely useful where  more
information is needed  on specific waste  constituents.
6.2.2            Fate Mechanisms for Organic Constituents
     To  be  considered suitable for  land  treatment,  all major organic  com-
ponents  of  a  waste  applied to soil  must  degrade  at  reasonable rates under
acceptable  application  rates and conditions.   A  reasonable rate of  degra-
dation is a rate rapid enough  that degradation, rather  than volatilization,
leaching or runoff, is the controlling  loss mechanism within the HWLT unit.
The allowable degree  of loss by volatilization, leaching  and runoff  depends
on the types  of compounds  involved.   Air and water leaving  the site  should
meet current  air  and water  quality  standards.   Organic waste  constituents
that are recalcitrant under  land  treatment  conditions may limit  the  life of
a facility  even though  they may  be  present in relatively  small  concentra-
tions.

     There  are  five  primary mechanisms  for  the   removal  of organic waste
constituents  from  a treatment site:   degradation, volatilization,  runoff,
leaching, and plant absorption.  Each  of  these  mechanisms is examined in
the following discussions.
6.2.2.1  Degradation


     Degradation is  the  loss  of organic constituents  from  soil  by chemical
change induced by either  soil microorganisms,  photolysis,  or reactions cat-
alyzed by  soil.   While  the nonbiological  sources  of chemical change  can
play  an  important  role  in degradation,  the  primary  mechanism of  organic
chemical degradation in soil is biological.

     While  degradation of organic constituents  over time may appear  to be
exponential, it  is  actually made up  of  distinct components  that  will vary
in Importance with  climatic conditions,  soil  type (Edwards, 1973), and sub-
strate properties.   If the approximate half-life of a constituent is  known
for a given soil-climate  regime,  it  is  possible to estimate the  amount of
the constituent  that will  accumulate due to  repeated applications of  the
constituent  to the  treatment soil.   For instance, if  5,000 kg/ha/year of a
one year  half-life  constituent is  applied  to  soil,  there  will  still  be
2,500  kg/ha  left   in   the soil  when  the  second  5,000  kg  is   applied.


                                     295

-------
Consequently, the amount of  the substance  in  the  soil  immediately  after  the
2nd,  3rd,  4th,  5th,  6th and  7th  yearly application would be  approximately
7,500,  8,750,  9,315, 9,688,  9,844  and  9,922 kg/ha.   For substances with
half-lives of no more than one year, and assuming that  the substance  is  not
toxic  to  soil microbes at  the maximum  accumulated  concentration, no more
than  twice the amount  applied  yearly should  accumulate in soil  (Edwards,
1973; Burnside, 1974).  More  generally, .the accumulation of an organic con-
stituent can be held at twice the amount placed in the  soil in one applica-
tion  so  long  as the applications are  separated by  the  time  length  of  one
half-life  of the constituent.  Degradation of  approximately 99% of the sub-
stance  should  be  attained within 10  years  of the  last waste  application
(Table 6.54).   After a 30 year post-closure  period, an  initial concentra-
tion  in  the  soil  of 0.5% or 10,000 kg/ha should  have  been  reduced  to  0.5
ppb or approximately  1  gm/ha.  Methods for evaluating  the degradation rate
or half-life  of organic constituents  in a waste  are  discussed in Section
7.2.1.2.
TABLE 6.54.  PERCENT DEGRADATION AFTER  10,  20 AND 30  YEARS  FOR ORGANIC
             CONSTITUENTS WITH VARIOUS  HALF-LIVES IN  SOIL
                                Percentage  of  Substance  Degraded
Half-Life In Soil
3 months
6 months
1 year
2 years
3 years
4 years
5 years
10 years
20 years
30 years
After 10 Years
100
99.9999
99.90
96.88
89.56
81.25
75.0
50.0
25.0
16.6
After 20 Years

100
99.9999
99.90
98.96
96.88
93.75
75.0
50.0
33.3
After 30 Years


100
99.9999
99.90
99.39
98.44
87.5
62.5
50.0
     Both  the  rate and  extent  of  biodegradation of waste  in soil  depend
primarily on the  chemical  structure of the Individual  organic  constituents
in the waste.   Other factors that  affect biodegradation include  the waste
loading rate and  the degree to which  the  waste  and soil are  mixed.  If,  for
instance, an oily waste  is  applied  too frequently or at too  high  a loading
rate, anaerobic conditions may prevail  in the soil and  decrease biodegrada-
tion.  If toxic organic  constituents  are  applied at  too high a rate,  either
microbial  numbers may  be   reduced  or  a  soil  may  even become  sterilized
(Buddin,  1914).    Adequate mixing  of  waste  with  soil tends  to  decrease
localized concentrations of  toxic waste components while it  increases  both
soil aeration and the area of contact  between soil microbes  and the waste.

     Soil  factors that  affect  biodegradation  include   texture,  structure,
temperature, moisture  content,  oxygen  level, nutrient  status, pH, and  the


                                     296

-------
 kind and number of microbes present.   In  a  study that evaluated the effect
 of soil texture on  biodegradation of  refinery  and  petrochemical  wastes,  a
 sandy clay soil consistently degraded more waste than a sandy loam soil and
 two clay soils (Brown et al.,  1981).  The low degradation rate exhibited by
 the clay  soils was  at  least partly  due to  anaerobic  conditions  (excess
 water and  low oxygen levels) that developed in these soils.   This condition
 might be  overcome  with time  if  the waste  applied were  to impart  a  more
 aggregated structure  to the  soils  allowing better drainage and a higher
 rate of oxygen transfer into the  soil.

      Soil  pH strongly influences  biodegradation rate, presumably by  affect-
 ing the availablity of  nutrients  to the  soil microbes.   Dibble  and Bartha
 (1979)  noted a significantly higher biodegradation  rate  for oily  sludge at
 soil pH of 7.0 to  7.8 than at  pH  5  to  6.  In general,  however,  the  availa-
 bility  of  most nutrients is optimal in the pH  range  of  6 to 7.  The  most
 common method of Increasing soil pH to near 7  is the  application of agri-
 cultural lime.  Management  of  soil pH is  discussed "in Section 8.6.

      Soil  temperature  for  optimal  degradation  of  oily sludge  has  been
 reported  to  be above  20°C  but  below  40°C  (Dibble  and  Bartha,   1979).
 Another study  found that  the biodegradation  rate  for   petrochemical  and
 refinery wastes doubled  when soil temperatures  increased  from 10°C to 30°C,
 but decreased slightly when temperatures  increased from 30°C to 40°C (Brown
 et al.,  1981).

      Soil  moisture  content  for optium biodegradation varies  with soil type,
 soil  temperature,  waste type, and waste  application rate.    Consequently,
 the optium moisture level  needs  to  be  determined on  a case-by-case basis*
 However, very dry  or  saturated  soils  have  been reported to  exhibit  lower
 biodegradation rates than moist  soils  (Brown et  al.,  1981).  As  a  general
 rule, a  soil  water content that  supports  plant growth will  also  encourage
microblal  degradation of waste (Huddleston,  1979).

      The nutrient  statue of a soil-waste mixture  depends  on both  the pres-
ence  and availability of  the  necessary elements.   Adding  nitrogen ferti-
 lizer to soils where oily wastes  had been applied increased biodegradation
by 50%  in  one study  (Kincaroion,  1972), but the  increase  in biodegradatloo
was  substantially less in  similar studies  (Brown et al*, 1981; Raymond  et
al.   1976).   nitrogen additions  have the greatest effect  on degradation of
wastes  that  are readily degradable  but are  nitrogen  deficient.   For  more
slowly  degradable  organic  wastes,  lower  levels  of  nitrogen are  necessary
for optimal biodegradation (Huddleston,  1979).   The  amount of  carbon  in
 relation to  the  amount of  nitrogen  needed to optimize  degradation (the  C:N
ratio)  may be as  low as 10:1 or as high as  150:1 (Brown  et al.,   1981).
Care must  be  taken  when  applying  nitrogen fertilizer  to  avoid an  excess  of
nitrogen which could  contribute to  the  leaching of nitrates.   Fertilization
with  potassium or  phosphorus is  usually not necessary  unless the  receiving
soil  has a deficiency or large amounts of  wastes  deficient in these  ele-
ments are  land  applied.

     Both  kind and  number  of  soil microbes determine which  and how  much of
the organic  constituents degrade  in soil.   In  native, undisturbed  soil,  a

                                     297

-------
large variety  of  microbes are  present.   After  application of  waste,  the
microbes that cannot assimilate the carbon sources present in the waste are
rapidly depleted,  while microbes that  can use  these  carbon sources tend to
flourish.  In this manner, the microbial population of the soil is automat-
ically optimized  for the applied  waste.   In  some  cases, there may  be an
initially low degradation rate  as  the  number of microbes  that  can use the
waste  as a  food  source multiply.    Several  studies  report  substantial
increases in total numbers of bacteria soon  after addition of hydrocarbons
to soils  (Dotson  et  al., 1971;  Jobson et al.,  1974).   The  two genera of
hydrocarbon-utilizing bacteria most often found  to  contribute to biodegra-
dation of oily wastes are Pseudomonas and Arthrobacter (Jensen, 1975).
6.2.2.2  Volatilization
     Volatilization is the loss of a compound to the atmosphere.  Two stud-
ies note  that  soil,  as compared  to  water, decreased volatilization by an
order of magnitude (Wilson et al., 1981).  Factors affecting volatilization
include  the properties of  the  specific  compound  (vapor  pressure, water
solubility, and  Henry's  Law Constant),  the  soil (air-filled  porosity and
temperature), interactions between  the waste and soil  (application method
and degree  of mixing), and atmospheric conditions (wind velocity, air tem-
perature,  and  relative  humidity).    One  study  found  that   the   highest
emission rate of volatile organic components  of waste occurred within min-
utes of application and decreased substantially within one hour  (Wetherold
et al., 1981).

     Compounds of most  concern with regard to  their potential volatiliza-
tion Include both those that  are persistent,  toxic, and/or weakly adsorbed
to soil  and those  that exhibit  either low water solubility  or high vapor
pressure.   Organic constituents  with high vapor pressures are more  readily
volatilized from soil.  Compounds that are not  soluble in water  tend to be
available  for  volatilization  longer  because  they  are  less  likely to be
removed in  leachate  or runoff water.   Persistent organic constituents may
similarly be more of  a volatilization  problem because they tend  to  be pre-
sent in  the soil longer.   In  addition, organic  compounds  are more easily
volatilized if they are less  strongly  adsorbed  by soil.  Finally, the tox-
icity of the compound is of concern  since  the more  toxic  an organic  consti-
tuent,  the  larger  the environmental impact  per  unit  of material volatil-
ized.

     In  a  study of  volatilization  of  oily  industrial  sludges  from land
treatment,  the amount of the total weight  of  the  sludges  volatilized within
the  first  30  minutes after  waste  application ranged  from  0.01  to 3.2%
(Wetherold  et al., 1981).  In this  same study,  emissions were measured for
oily sludges that were  subsurface injected at  two  depths.   When the waste
was  injected to a  depth  of 7.5  cm,   the emissions were  relatively high
because the sludge bubbled  to the surface.   Sludge  injected  to a depth of
15 cm produced no detectable  emissions, and  no  sludge appeared on the sur-
face.
                                    298

-------
     Reduction of waste volume through volatilization is not  an  acceptable
treatment process for organic chemicals.  However,  it can  be  a substantial
loss mechanism.   For  instance,  Schwendinger  (1968)  noted  that 41, 37  and
36% of a light oil volatilized from  soil within 7 weeks when oil  applica-
tion rates were 25, 63 and  100 ml  oil/kg soil, respectively.   In  nine  out
of ten cases,  more  oil was  lost by  volatilization  than by biodegradation
(Schwendinger, 1968).  Methods for evaluating  volatilization  of  waste  com-
ponents from soil are discussed in Section 7.2.3.
6.2.2.3  Runoff
     Runoff is  that portion  of precipitation that  does not  infiltrate  a
soil, but rather moves overland toward  stream channels or, in the  case of
HWLT units, to retention ponds.   HWLT units should  be  designed to  collect
all runoff from the  active  portion of the facility  because  this water may
be contaminated with various  constituents of  the  waste.  Methods  for the
retention and treatment of runoff are discussed in Section 8.3.3-8.3.5 Fac-
tors affecting the loss of organic constituents by runoff include watershed
properties, organic constituent  properties,  waste-soil  interactions,  and
precipitation parameters.

     The watershed of an HWLT unit is the area of land that drains into the
retention ponds.  Since run-on,  or surface  drainage water from outside the
unit must be diverted, runoff will only be generated  from the active por-
tion.  The amount of  the organic constituents  removed in runoff is closely
tied  to how  much  runoff  is  generated.    Although  organic   constituents
removed in this manner will  largely be those  that  are water soluble, some
may be removed through adsorption to  suspended solids in the  runoff water.
Edwards (1973) suggested that insoluble organics that strongly sorb to soil
particles could be  transported  off-site on  soil particles in  runoff water.
Since  the  amount  of  suspended  solids  increases  as  the  rate  of runoff
increases, removal of organic constituents adsorbed  to these solids is also
expected to increase  as the  rate increases.   The organic constituents that
are  adsorbed  to suspended  solids vary  with  the  nature of  the suspended
solid and may be considerably different from the constituents  dissolved in
the runoff water.

     Waste-soil interactions  that  affect the amount  of organic constituents
released to  runoff water are waste loading rate,  application timing, and
application method.  A larger portion of the organic waste constituents can
be expected  in runoff water  as  the  loading  rate is  increased beyond the
adsorption capacity  of the  soil.  Application timing can also increase the
organic  constituents in runoff particularly  when  a  large  application of
waste is made just  prior  to a heavy rainstorm, or  when a large portion of
the yearly waste produced is  applied  to a soil during a rainy  season.  The
release of  organic constituents  to runoff  can be substantially reduced by
subsurface injection.
                                    299

-------
6.2.2.A  Leaching
     Leaching  of  organic chemicals from  surface soil to  groundwater  is a
potential problem  wherever  these chemicals are  improperly disposed.   Some
of  the  most  widely used organic chemicals, halogenated  and nonhalogenated
solvents, have been  found both in  groundwater in the U.S.  and  to a lesser
extent  in the other industrialized  countries  (Table  6.55).    Though the
source  of these  constituents is not  known,  most of  the  synthetic organic
compounds found  in  groundwater  are quite volatile,  inferring  that  these
compounds were probably  leaking  from buried wastes  rather  than wastes
applied  to soil.   If the volatile and slowly degradable  halogenated sol-
vents were land treated, the major loss mechanism would probably be volati-
lization rather than leaching.   However,  neither volatilization nor leach-
ing  is  considered an acceptable loss mechanism for  these toxic organlcs.
Wastes containing chlorinated solvents should  undergo a dehalogenation pre-
treatment before they are considered  land treatable.   With a properly man-
aged HWLT unit, numerous  studies have shown  that at  least the nonhalogen-
ated hydrocarbons  can be  completely  degraded before they leach  from the
soil.  Methods for evaluating the constituent  mobility are given in Section
7.2.2 and techniques  for the  collection  and  treatment of leachate are dis-
cussed in Section 8.3.6.

     Effective land  treatment  of  readily leachable  organics  requires  an
understanding  of  the soil and  organic constituent properties  that affect
compound leachability.   Following  are discussions  of these properties and
how they effect the  leachability of organic constituents.
6.2.2.4.1   Soil  Properties that  Affect  Leaching.   Soil  properties that
influence  the  leaching of  organic  constituents of land  treated waste are
texture, structure, horlzonation,  amount  and type of  clay present, organic
matter content, cation exchange capacity  (CEC), and pH.  Relative influence
of the soil properties can vary with waste composition, application method,
loading rate,  and  climatic  conditions.   While  there  are  no simple methods
for  predicting the  rate at which a particular organic  constituent will
leach, an  understanding  of  how soil properties influence leaching can aid
in site  selection and soil management.    Determination of the leachability
of individual  hazardous  organic  constituents should be determined by pilot
studies  (Chapter  7).   Discussions  of  how  the  soil  properties  affect
leaching of organic constltutents follow.

     Soil  texture  and structure  have been shown to have substantial influ-
ence on  the leachability of organic  constituents  (Brown  and Deuel, 1982;
Brown et al.,  1982a).  Leaching  can be  substantial from sandy soils due to
their low  CEC,  low clay  content, low organic  matter  content, and relative
high number of large  pores and resultant high permeability.  Clay soils can
limit  leaching due  to their  high CEC,  high  clay content,  high organic
matter content, and high number of  small  intraaggregate pores and resultant
low permeability.  For instance,  in one study where industrial wastes were
applied to four soils and leachate  was  collected  in field lysimeters, sandy
soil allowed the  greatest amount  of organic constituent leaching (Brown et

                                    300

-------
TABLE 6.55  TWO CLASSES OF SYNTHETIC ORGANIC CONSTITUENTS WIDELY FOUND  IN
            GROUNDWATER*
                                               Highest Level Detected
                                                   in Groundwater
                                                       (pg/1)
Organic Constituent
USA*
Netherlands*
                               HYDROCARBONS
Cyclohexane
Benzene
Toluene
Xylenes
Ethyl benzene
Isopropyl benzene
540
330
6,400
300
2,000
290
30
100
300
1,000
300
300
                         HALOGENATED HYDROCARBONS
Chloroform
Dichloromethane
Carbon tetrachlorlde
Dibromochloromethane
1 , 1-Dichloroethane
1 , 2-Dichloroethane
1,1, 1-Trichloroethane
Dichloroethylenes
Trichloroethylene
Tetrachloroethylene
^^^_^^^^^B^B^^H^HO«M^H^^HKH^M^^HHBIIIM«l»W^^^^^^M^BI^^^^«MB^H^H
490
3,000
400
55
400
11,330
5,440
860
35,000
1,500
10
3,000
30
0.3
10
3
3,000
10
1,000
30
  This list represents some examples  of  compounds  in two classes  of
  organic compounds that have been found several times  in groundwater and
  is in no way a comprehensive list of  the  leachable constituents in those
  organic constituent classes.

1" Burmaster-and Harris (1982); Dyksen and Hess  (1982).

# Zoeteman et al. (1981).
                                     301

-------
 al.,  1982a).   In another study, deep soil cores were  taken from five HWLT
 units  to examine  the depth  of  penetration  of  land-applied hydrocarbons
 (Table  6.56).   An  HWLT unit with a sandy loam  soil  (site E) that  received
 large amounts  of oily  waste allowed hydrocarbons  to move 180-240 cm in one
 year.   Another HWLT unit with  a clay soil (site A) had not allowed detect-
 able  quantities  of hydrocarbons to penetrate  below the treatment zone (top
 18  cm)  after  two years of operation.  The  potential benefits of horizona-
 tion  can be seen in site  B, where a clay subsoil  seems  to have minimized
 the depth to which hydrocarbons  penetrated into that soil.

     While  soil  texture  can be  used  to  estimate  the  distribution  of pore
 sizes  in sandy  soils, the  pore  size distribution in  clay soils  can be
 greatly affected by clay  particles clumping  into  larger aggregate struc-
 tures.   These aggregates  tend  to  allow the  formation  of larger  pores
 between aggregates, while  they contain many  small  internal or intraaggre-
 gate  pores.   When  liquid  waste is applied by  either spray  irrigation or
 overland  flow  to   structured  clay  soil,  organic  constituents  may  move
 through the  large  interaggregate pores without being  appreciably  adsorbed
 by  the  majority of the  soil surface  present in  the  intraaggregate pores
 (Helling, 1971;  Davidson and Chang,  1972).   However, if organic  constit-
 uents are dewatered first  and  then incorporated into a soil surface, water
 later percolating through the interaggregate  pores may not  have enough res-
 idence  time  to desorb organic constituents adsorbed on  the intraaggregate
 surfaces.   Dekkers and Barbera  (1977)  found that  leachability  of  organic
 constituents  Incorporated  into soil decreased  as  the soil aggregate size
 increased.

     Both amount  and   type  of  clay present  in  a  soil have  been  found to
 affect  the  mobility of pesticides  (Helling,  1971).   Mobility  of  nonionic
 pesticides was found to  be  inversely related to clay  content.   Soils high
 in montmorillonitic clays  were  found  to  inhibit the  movement  of  cationic
 pesticides.    Anionic  or acidic  pesticides  were relatively more  mobile in
 montmorillonitic soils,  suggesting possible  negative  adsorption.   Acidic
 pesticide mobility was found to be inversely  related to nonmontmorillonitic
 clay content.

     Several studies have  noted that the movement  of  organic chemicals in
 soil  is inversely related  to  the organic  matter  content of  the  soil
 (Helling, 1971; Filonow et  al.,  1976;  Roberts and  Valocchi, 1981; Miles et
 al.,  1981;  Nathwani and Phillips,  197;).   Helling  (1971) found  that the
 retardation of organic chemical movement through  soils   was  highly corre-
 lated to the  adsorption of these organic chemicals  by the native  soil
 organic matter.

     Cation exchange capacity  (CEC),  the  capacity of  soil to adsorb posi-
 tively  charged compounds,  decreases the  mobility of cationic  and nonionic
organic  constituents  and it may  increase the mobility  of anionic  organic
constituents (Helling, 1971).  CEC can be thought of as the capacity of the
negatively charged  soil  to attract  and  hold  positively  charged  compounds
such  as cationic organic  constituents.   The correlation  between  CEC and
reduced mobility of nonionic compounds is probably due to the component of
the CEC represented by native soil  organic matter.   Organic matter  has the


                                    302

-------
      TABLE 6.56  DEPTH OF HYDROCARBON PENETRATION AT FIVE REFINERY IAND TREATMENT UNITS*
Site
A
B
C
D
E
Soil Type
Clay
Loamy surface
with clay subsoil
Sandy clay loam
Sandy clay loam
Sandy loam
Depth of
Hydrocarbon
Penetration
(cm)
Less than in
untreated
area
23
30
91
180-240
Waste Types
Applied*
1,3,8
2,7
1,3,4,6
1,3,6
1-6
Time Between
Last Waste
Application
and Sampling
(Months)
4
16
3
11
<1
Approximate
Application
Rate
(M3/Ha/Yr#)
30
1-4% oil
( one time
application)
25
( one time
application)
54
7000
Length
of
Operation
(Years )
2
6
4
6
1
o
u>
        Brown and Deuel (1982).


        Waste types applied were:  (1) API separator sludge; (2) DAF sludge; (3) Tank bottoms; (4) Filter

        clays; (5) ETP sludge; (6) Slop oil emulsion; (7) Treatment pond sludge; and (8) Leaded sludge.
        Unless otherwise noted.

-------
capacity  to adsorb  catlonic,  nonionic  and anionlc  organic  constituents.
The increased mobility,  or  negative  adsorption,  of anionic organics is due
to  the  electrical repulsion between  the negatively  charged  clay minerals
and the anionic organic constituents.

     Soil  pH has been  found to  be  an  important parameter  affecting the
mobility of organic acids.  Helling (1971) noted  that as soil pH increased,
the mobility of acidic organic constituents increased.  Organic acids exist
in  soil as anions when the soil  pH  is greater than  the  dissociation con-
stant (pKfl)  of  the compounds.   As anions,  these compounds  exhibit nega-
tive adsorption and are increasingly mobile in clay soils.


6.2.2.4.2   Organic  Constituent  Properties that Affect Leaching.   The main
properties  of  organic  constituents  that  affect   their  leaching  in soils
include water solubility,  concentration, strength of adsorption,  sign and
magnitude  of  charge,  and  persistence.   Additional  organic class-specific
information is given in Section 6.2.3.

     Only  when soil  is  saturated with  oils or solvents will  these fluids
flow in  liquid  phase (Davis  et al. ,  1972).   In a  properly  managed HWLT
unit, the  percolating liquid will be water, and the concentration of organ-
ic constituents in the leachate will  be limited  to the  water solubility of
the constituent  (Evans,  1980).    However,  many land  treated  organics, and
especially  their  organic  acid  decomposition  by-products, have  unlimited
water solubility.   Consequently,  land treatment  units  should,  if  at all
possible,   be maintained at  water  contents  at or  below field  capacity.  In
climatic regions  of seasonally  high  rainfall, an  effort  should be made to
apply wastes only during  dry  seasons.  Where  this is not  possible, under-
drainage may  be  a workable  alternative.  Leachate  collection systems are
discussed  in Section 8.3.6.

     Generally,   the  higher  the  organic constituent concentration  in  an
applied waste, the  higher  the  concentration of  these constituents  in the
leachate.   Where  substantial quantities  of leachate are  generated, waste
loading  rates should  not  exceed the  adsorption capacity  of  the soil.
Adsorption capacity can be considered as the concentration of a constituent
in  soil above which  an  unacceptably high  concentration  of the constituent
will enter leachate generated on-site.  Ideally,  pilot tests should be con-
ducted to  assure that the adsorption capacity of  the  soil for specific haz-
ardous organic constituents will not be exceeded  at the planned waste load-
ing rates  (Chapter 7).   For cationic  organic constituents, either increas-
ing valence, or number of positive charges per molecule,  will increase the
adsorption capacity of the  constituent.   For anionic organic constituents,
the reverse is usually true.  That is,  the stronger the  negative charge on
a compound,  the  stronger will  be the  negative  adsorption and  hence, the
greater  rate of  leaching  for   the   compound.    As   discussed in  Section
6.2.2 .A.I,  by maintaining  the  soil  pH  below the pKa  of  anionic organic
species, the leachability of  these species can be minimized.   Care should
be taken that the pH is not lowered to a point that will decrease degrada-
tion rates or increase  leachability of  heavy  metals  or  other constituents
to be immobilized in the treatment zone.


                                   304

-------
     Persistance  of  organic  constituents  increases  the  likelihood  that
these compounds will be leached by increasing the period of time over which
they are exposed to percolating water.  Laboratory  or field  studies  can be
designed to determine  if  the half-life of  an organic constitutent  is  too
long to allow it  to be  degraded  before it leaches  from  the  treatment zone
(Chapter 7).  It may be necessary  to  pretreat certain waste  streams  before
land treatment  if the waste  contains hazardous organic constituents that
are both readily leachable and persistent in the soil environment.

     Leaching of  trace level organlcs  from a rapid infiltration facility
constructed in loamy sand was evaluated in a study by Tomson et al. (1981).
By comparing the  concentration of  various organics in the effluent  and in
the groundwater underlying  the  site,  it was  possible to evaluate leaching
in terms of removal efficiency for various  organic  compound  classes.  Most
classes of  compounds  had  90-100%  removal  efficiencies, with  low removal
achieved for chloroalkanes, alkylphenols, alkanes,  phthalates,  and amides.
Overall removal efficiency for organics was  92%.   However,  most HWLT units
are not  designed for  rapid infiltration,  in part due  to  the incomplete
treatment usually exhibited by these facilities.   In addition,  the loamy
sand soil  at  the site would provide  little attenuation  of  the applied
organics.

     HWLT  units  should not  be designed  for  rapid infiltration  of  the
applied wastes when this would result in significant leaching of  hazardous
constituents.  When waste  loading  rates are designed to optimize  retention
of organics in  the  zone of incorporation (top 30  cm  of soil), degradation
efficiencies of well over 99% can  be  achieved (Table 6.54).
6.2.2.5  Plant Uptake
     The  ability  of  higher plants to  absorb  and translocate organic mole-
cules has been recognized  for over 70  years.  However, only within  the past
thirty  years  has  this  phenomenon received  much attention,  mostly during
trials  for possible systemic pesticides.  Furthermore, until  the  relatively
recent  advent  of  radioactive  labeling techniques  studying  the  uptake  of
organic compounds  was  extremely difficult.   Recent studies have  shown that
plant uptake  of toxic  organic  compounds may both  pose environmental risk
and  potentially threaten  the  quality of human food.   Plewa  (1978)  has
reviewed  recent  studies  indicating   that  various  chemicals  absorbed   by
plants  may  become mutagenic,  or  that  their   mutagenic  activity  may  be
enhanced  through  metabolic  processes  within  the  plant.    Numerous toxic
organics, including  PCBs,  hexachlorobenzene, dimethylnitrosamlne,  2,4,5-T,
and others, have been  observed  to be  taken up by plant roots  (Table 6.57).
However,  insufficient  data currently  exist  to  predict the plant uptake  of
particular  compounds   or   groups  of  compounds.    Also,   the  data  are
insufficient  to describe  specific mechanisms  of  uptake  and factors  that
influence  uptake.    Empirical  testing  may,  therefore,   be  required  to
evaluate  the absorption,  translocation  and  persistence  of  toxic  organic
compounds in higher plants.
                                    305

-------
TABLE 6.57  ORGANIC CONSTITUENTS ABSORBED BY PLANT ROOTS
Organic Constituent
  Class and Name                       References
Organic Nitrogen Compounds

      -Alanine
      -Alanine
     Arginine
     Asparaglne
     Aspartic Acid
     Cystine
     Glutamic Acid
     Glycine
     Histidine
     Hydroxyproline
     Isolecucine
     Leucine
     Lysine
     Methionine
     Phenylalanine
     Proline
     Serine
     Threonine
     Tryptophane
     Tyrosine
     Valine
     Glutamine
     a-Amino-n-butyric acid
     Norleucine
     Oxime, a-keto-glutaric acid
     Oxime, oxalacetic acid
     Oxime, pyruvic acid
     Casein hydrozolate
     Cysteine
     Peptone
     Urea
     Dimethyl nitrosamine
     Cyanide
     EDTA
     EGTA
     DTPA
     Chloine Sulfate
     Indole acetic Acid
     Indole butyric Acid
     Indole proprionic Acid
Nissen (1974); Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Nissen (1974); Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Nissen (1974); Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Nissen (1974); Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Nissen (1974); Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ghosh & Burris (1950)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Dean-Raymond and Alexander  (1976)
Wallace et al. (1981)—applied  as
1*C sodium cyanide; possible absorp-
tion as organic cyanide complex.
Hill-Cottingham and Lloyd-Jones
(1965)—compounds applied as metal
chelates.
Nissen (1974)
Bollard (1960)
Ibid.
Ibid.
                                 continued —
                                     306

-------
TABLE 6.57  (continued)
Organic Constituent
References
Organic Dyes

     Methylene Blue
     Malachite Green
     Light Green
     Orange 1 (a-Naphthol)
     Toluidine Blue
     Soluble Indigo
     Aurantia
     Indigo Red

Derivatives of Aromatic Hydrocarbons

     Napthalene acetic acid
     Phenyl acetic acid
     Phenyl proprionic acid
     Di-(2-ethylhexyl)phthalate
     Glucose
     3-0-methyl glucose
     Sucrose
     Fructose

Antibiotics

     Streptomycin
     Clorotetracycline
     Griseofulvin
     Penicillin
     Chloramphenico1
     Cycloheximide
     Oxytetracycline

Organic Sulfur Compounds

     Sulfanilamide
     Sulfacetamide
     Sulfaguanidine
     Sulfapyridine
     Sulfadiazine
     Sulfathiazole
     4,4' -Diamitiodiphenyl-sulf one
Kolosov (1962).
root functions.
Dyes used to study
Bollard (1960)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Kloskowski et al. (1981)

Nissen (1974)
Bollard  (1960)
Bollard  (1960)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
                               — continued —
                                      307

-------
TABLE 6.57  (continued)
Organic Constituent
References
Organic Sulfur Compounds (continued)

     N-Dodecylbenzene-sulfonate
     p-Chlorphenyl-methyl-sulfide
     p-Chlophenyl-methyl-sulfoxide
     p-Chlorphenyl-methyl-sulfone
Kloskowski (1981)
Guenzi et al. (1981)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Organochlorine Compounds (excluding pesticides)
     Dichlorobiphenyl
     Trichlorobiphenyl

     Tetrachlorobiphenyl
     Pentachlorobiphenyl

     4-Chloroaniline
     Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
     Chloroalkylene-9
     Trichloroethylene
     Hexachlorobenzene

     Pentachloronitrobenzene
     Pentachloroaniline
Insecticides
     Bis(dimethylamino)fluoro-
       phosphine oxide
     Sodium fluoroacetate
     Schradan
     Paraoxon
     Parathion
     Diethyl chlorovinyl phosphate
     Dimethyl-carboxomethoxy-
       propenyl-phosphate
     Demeton
     Diethyl-diethylaminoethyl-
       thiophosphate
     Aldrin
     Dieldrin
     Kepone
     Heptachlor
     Chlordane
Moza et al. (1979)
Moza et al. (1979); Kloskowki et al,
(1981)
Moza et al. (1979)
Kloskowski et al. (1981); Weber &
Mrozek, 1979
Kloskowski et al. (1981)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Kloskowski et al. (1981); Smelt
(1981)
Smelt (1981)
Dejonckheere et al. (1981)
Bollard (1960)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.

Ibid.
Ibid.

Ibid.
Kloskowski et al.  (1981)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Plewa (1978)
Ibid.
                              — continued —
                                     308

-------
TABLE 6.57  (continued)
Organic Constituent
References
Fungicides
     Benomyl
     N-( trichloromethyl-thio)-4-
       cyclohexane-1-dicarboximide
     Thiabendazole
     Pentachloronitrobenzene
Herbicides
     Picloram
     Methabenz thiazuron
     2,4-D
     2 4 5 -T
     £ ,H , J, J.
     Amino-triazole
     Propham
     Monuron
     Trichloroacetic acid
     Ammonium sulfamate
     Maleic hydrazide
     3-hydroxy-l,2,4-triazole
     Chlorbis(ethylamino)triazine
     Simazine
     Atrazine
     Linuron
     Lenacil
     Aziprotryne
     S-ethyl-dipropyl-thio-
       carbamate
     N,N-dialyl-1-2,2-dichloro-
       acetamide (herbicide
       antedote)
     Hydroxyatrazine (nonphyto-
       toxic atrazine)
     Cyanazine
     Procyazine
     Eradiacane
     Metolachlor
Hock et al. (1970)

Stipes & Oderwald (1971)
Ibid.
Smelt (1981)
0'Donovan and Vanden Born (1981)
Fuhr & Mittelstaedt (1981)
Bollard (1960)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Walker (1971); Shone et al. (1972)
Walker (1971); Shone et al. (1972)
Walker (1971); Shone et al. (1972)
Walker (1971); Shone et al. (1972)
Walker (1971); Shone et al. (1972)

Gray & Joo  (1978)
Ibid.

Shone et al.  (1972)
Plewa (1978)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
                                     309

-------
      Evidence  collected thus far indicates  that  plants may absorb  organic
 acids,   organic  bases,  and  both  polar  and  nonpolar  neutral   organic
 compounds.  Absorption  by  roots  is  believed  to  be  a passive  mechanism which
 is  influenced  by  the rate  of  transpiration and  soil moisture  conditions
 (Walker,  1971).  Absorption is  also influenced by  conditions  in the  root
 zone  and  soil  properties.   Weber and Mrozek (1979)  observed that  additions
 of  activiated  carbon to a sandy soil inhibited the uptake of PCBs  by  soy-
 beans (Glycine max)  and fescue  (Festuca  clatior).   Hock et al.  (1970) noted
 that  absorption of the  fungicide benomyl by American Elm  (Ulmus  americana)
 seedlings  was   1.5 to 2.5  times greater  from  sand  culture  than from  silt
 loam  soil,  and 2  to 6  times greater  than from a  soil,  peat,  and  perlite
 mixture.   Soil applied surfactants were observed  by  Stipes  and Oderwald
 (1971)  to  enhance the  absorption of three fungicides  by  elm  trees   in  the
 field.  Nlssen (1974),  in  a  discussion of plant absorption mechanisms,  sug-
 gested  that  the absorption of  choline sulfate  and perhaps other  compounds
 was mediated by bacterial  activity  in the rhizosphere.

      Once an organic molecule is absorbed by a  plant,  the  compound may per-
 sist, or be metabolized  or removed  by some other mechanism.  PCB  absorption
 by  pine trees  in a  three  year  study by  Moza et  al. (1979) indicated  that
 these compounds were not readily degraded by the plants.  Dean-Raymond  and
 Alexander  (1976)  showed that both  spinach  (Spinacia oleracea)  and  lettuce
 (Lactuca  sativa)  readily absorbed labeled   dimethylnitrosamine   to   the
 leaves, but  the chemical  disappeared over time.    Rovira  and Davey  (1971)
 noted that foliar applied  agricultural chemicals were  often  exuded by roots
 into  the soil.   Factors  which influence  the metabolism of  organic  chemicals
 in  plants  include plant species, part of the plant  in which the chemical
 locates,  maturity of  the plant  and the plant environment  (Rouchaud  and
 Meyer,  1982).

      Further  research  is  needed to define both  the  mechanisms  of  plant
 absorption of  organics  from  soil  and the fate of these compounds once  they
 are absorbed.   Virtually no information exists  regarding either  phytotoxic-
 ity  or  plant  bioaccumulation  which might  threaten the human  food  chain.
 Information is  needed both to identify accumulator  and  nonaccumulator plant
 species and  the compounds that  are selectively absorbed.  Until adequate
 research  data  are available,  food  chain crops grown  on HWLT  units  that
 receive toxic  organics  should be closely scrutinized  for  plant  absorption
 of toxic chemicals.
6.2.3                   Organic Constituent Classes


     Land treatability of  organic  constituents often follows a predictable
pattern for similar compound  types.   For instance, where all other proper-
ties are  constant,  the soil  half-life of aromatic  hydrocarbons increases
with the  number  of  aromatic rings.   Since it is  beyond  the scope  of  this
document to address the fate  of each organic compound in soil, the follow-
ing sections  discuss  organic waste  constituents  based  on their  functional
groups or other  chemical  similarities.  Where data are available, examples
of representative constituents within  each group  are used to illustrate the


                                    310

-------
trend of land  treatability  of that group.   Specific information given  on
the  degradation  of  organic  constituents  in  soil  is  based  partially  on
extrapolation from studies of compounds in other aerobic systems.
6.2.3.1  Aliphatic Hydrocarbons
     Aliphatic hydrocarbons are open chain  or  cyclic  compounds  that resem-
ble the  open chain compounds.   Included in this  chemical family  are  the
alkanes, alkenes,  alkynes, and  their  cyclic  analogs  (Morrison and  Boyd,
1975).   While  only a few  are  listed  as hazardous  (Table  6.53),  aliphatic
compounds can be the rate limiting constituents in many oily wastes genera-
ted by the organic  chemical,  petroleum  refining,  and  petroleum re-refining
industries.  In  addition,  a wide variety of industries  generate aliphatic
solvent wastes.  Animal  and plant processing generates wastes  high in ali-
phatic compounds,  but  these waste streams  are  not  usually considered haz-
ardous.

     A large portion of the wastes that are currently land treated are oily
wastes.  These wastes generally range from  1 to 40% oil by weight.  Oils in
these  wastes are  generally  composed  of  three  main organic  constituent
classes:     aliphatics   (10-80%),  aromatics   (5-50%),  and  miscellaneous
(5-50%).   If  aliphatics  and aromatics  contain the  pentane  and benzene
extractable  constituents,   respectively,  the  miscellaneous compounds  are
usually  those  extractable with  polar  solvents  such as  dichloromethane.
Examples of  the names  assigned to the  constituents  in  the miscellaneous
include  asphaltenes, resins, heterocycles,  and  polar organics.

     Degradation of aliphatic  hydrocarbons in soil   depends  on  molecular
weight,  vapor pressure, water solubility, number of double bonds,  degree of
branching, and whether  the compound  is  in  an  open  chain or cyclic config-
uration.   Perry  and Cerniglia (1973) ranked aliphatic and aromatic hydro-
carbons  from  most  to  least  biodegradable  as  follows:    straight-chain
alkanes  (Ci2~G18) > gases  ^-fy)   >   straight-chain   alkanes   (€5-09)  >
branched alkanes (up to Cj^)  > straight-chain  alkenes  (C3-Cu) > branched
alkenes  >  aromatics >  cycloalkanes.    Microbial degradation  of  straight-
chain  alkanes  proceeds faster  than with branched   alkanes  of  the same
molecular weight (Humphrey,  1967).   Degradation rate decreases with  either
the number and size  of  alkyl  groups  or  the number of double bonds present.
Straight or  branched open chain aliphatics degrade much more  rapidly than
their  cyclic  analogs.     Degradation  of  straight  chain  aliphatics also
decreases with  the addition of a benzene  group.   Microbial degradation of
alkanes  to  carbon  dioxide and  water   begins at  a  terminal  carbon and
initially  produces the corresponding organic  acid  (Morrill et al.,  1982).
Other  degradation   by-products  of alkanes  include ketones,  aldehydes and
alcohols, all of which  are readily degradable  in aerobic  soil.

     Cycloalkane and its derivatives are  remarkably less  degradable in soil
than  other  aliphatic   hydrocarbons.    Haider  et   al.  (1981)  obtained no
                                    311

-------
significant biodegradation  of  cyclohexane after the compound was incubated
in  a moist loess  soil  for 10 weeks  (see Section  6.2.3.4.1,  Table 6.60).
Even the  penta- and hexa-chlorinated cycloalkanes appeared to biodegrade in
soil to a greater  extent than  cycloalkane.

      Moucawi  et  al.  (1981) compared the  biodegradation  rates  of saturated
and  unsaturated  hydrocarbons  in  soil.    Four  soils  were amended  with
2,000 tng/kg   of  an   alkane  (octadecane)  and  the  corresponding  alkene
(1-octadecene).   While the percent of  the added  substrate that degraded
varied between soils  (16.4-32.3% degradation in 4 weeks), the amount of the
alkane and alkene  that biodegraded  in a given  soil  was essentially the same
In  the  same  study, the effect of chain  length  on  n-alkane biodegradation.
was  evaluated.   Six  soils were  amended  with 2,000  rag/kg  of  C-19 (nona-
decane),   C-22  (docosane),  C-28   (octacosane)  and  C-32   (dotriacontane)
alkanes and percent degradation  for the compounds after 4 weeks  incubation
in  the soils  ranged from 7.5 to  54.0%,  4.6  to  50.6%,  1.3 to 39.1%, and 0.6
to  43.3%,  respectively.  The authors noted a clear  difference in  the degra-
dation rates  between  acid  and non-acid  soils.  Decomposition  of both the
short  and long  chain  alkanes was  consistently greater  in  the non-acid
soils.

     Decomposition of oily  wastes  high  in aliphatics  can be accelerated by
maintenance of optimal soil moisture, temperature,  waste loading  and nutri-
ent  levels (Brown et  al.,  1981).   The  relative influence of each factor on
decomposition varies  from waste  to waste.  Generally speaking, wastes high
in  aliphatic hydrocarbons  are  both  nitrogen  and  phosphorus   deficient.
Kincannon  (1972) found  that the  addition  of nitrogen and phosphorus ferti-
lizers  could  double  the decomposition of  certain  oily wastes.   Nitrogen
additions  have increased the decomposition rate of straight chain alkanes
(Jobson et al., 1974) and waxy cake (Gydin  and Syratt,  1975).   Fedorak and
Westlake  (1981) incubated crude  oil in  a  soil  enriched culture for 27 days
with  and without nitrogen and  phosphorus  nutrient additions.  They obtained
essentially complete  degradation of the  n-alkane fraction  and substantial
degradation of the branched alkanes with  nutrient additions, but  noted only
slight degradation of these constituents  when  nutrients were not  added.

     While aliphatic  hydrocarbons are usually degraded  rapidly  in  a well
managed  land  treatment  unit, there may be  a  long-term  accumulation  of
recalcitrant  decomposition  by-products.   Kincannon (1972)  determined that
one  major by-product  of oil  decomposition  is naphthenic acid,  which may
degrade slowly in soil (Overcash and Pal, 1979).

     Volatilization can be  a significant loss mechanism for low molecular
weight aliphatics.   Wetherold et al.  (1981)  examined  air  emissions from
simulated  land  treatment  units  where  hexane  and  several  aliphatic  rich
(oily) sludges were applied to the soil.   Results  obtained  from the study
include the following:

     (1)  volatility of the material applied to  the soil was the most
          significant factor affecting emission levels;
                                     312

-------
     (2)  emission rates increased with increasing ambient  air humid-
          ity, soil temperature and soil moisture;
     (3)  emission rates were  highest in  the  first  30 minutes  after
          waste application; and
     (4)  emission rates decreased with depth  of  subsurface injection
          of the waste, with a 7.5-10 cm and  15 cm depth  of injection
          yielding  high and  undetectable emission  levels,  respec-
          tively.

     Volatile aliphatic  hydrocarbons  (vapor pressure  greater than  1)  are
readily assimilated by soils at  low application rates.  However, at appli-
cation rates above the critical  soil  dose  level,  volatile compounds tempo-
rarily decrease the number and type of microorganisms present (Table 6.58).
In either case, where volatile aliphatic hydrocarbons  are surface applied,
the dominant  loss  mechanism is  volatilization.   In  addition, the  rate of
volatilization of  nonpolar  organic chemicals  (such  as  aliphatic hydrocar-
bons) would increase with the water content of the soil.    This  may be due
to displacement  of  the  adsorbed nonpolar  chemicals  from  the soil surfaces
by water (Spencer and Farmer, 1980).


TABLE 6.58  CRITICAL SOIL DOSE LEVEL (CSDL) FOR FOUR ALIPHATIC SOLVENTS*
Aliphatic
Solvent
Heptane
Cyclohexane
Hexane
Pentane
mm H20 @
25°C
	
99
144
509
psi @
80°F
0.9
2.0
3.3
	
lime L
-------
depth of hydrocarbon penetration  (Table 6.56).  The least depth of penetra-
tion was  obtained in a clay  textured  soil followed by a soil  with  a near
surface clay subsoil.  As might be expected, hydrocarbons penetrated to the
greatest depth in the soil with the coarsest texture.

     Although  plants are  known  to  produce and  translocate unsubstituted
aliphatic compounds, no references  could  be found in literature concerning
the absorption of aliphatic compounds  from  soil.


6.2.3.2  Aromatic Hydrocarbons


     Aromatic  hydrocarbons are  cyclic  compounds  having multiple  double
bonds and  include both mono- and polyaromatic  hydrocarbons.  Monoaromatic
compounds  are  benzene and  substituted benzenes  such as  nitrobenzene and
ethylbenzene.   Polyaromatic  hydrocarbons  are  composed of  multiple  fused
benzene rings and include compounds such as naphthalene (2 fused rings) and
anthracene  (3  fused rings).   Chlorinated  aromatic  compounds are discussed
in Section 6.2.3.4.

     Aromatic  compounds  are  usually  present   in oily  wastes  and  wastes
generated by petroleum refineries,  organic chemical  plants, rubber indus-
tries, coking plants,  and  nearly  all  waste streams associated with combus-
tion processes.  These compounds  are typically present in native soils as a
result  of  open  air refuse  burning,  vehicle   exhaust,  volcanoes  and the
effects of  geologic processes  on plant  residues (Groenewegen  and Stolp,
1981; Overcash and  Pal, 1979).   The accumulation of polyaromatic hydrocar-
bons in a  treatment  soil  is  particularly  important because  these compounds
may  be both  carcinogenic  and  resistent  to  degradation  (Brown  et  al.,
1982b).

     At very low  dose  levels,  the decomposition rate of aromatic compounds
depends more  on  substance  characteristics  than  on  the   precise  dosage
(Medvedev  and  Davidov, 1981).    Furthermore, while  general  trends  in the
decomposition  rate  of aromatics  can  be  related to  substance properties,
there are  nearly  always  exceptions.   One general trend  observed for aro-
matic compounds is that the higher  the number  of fused rings in the struc-
ture, the slower  its decomposition  rate (Cansfield and Racz, 1978).   While
aromatic  compounds  with  five or  more  fused rings  are not  used  as  a sole
carbon  source  by  microbes,   there  is  evidence  that  these  compounds are
slowly  co-metabolized  in  the  presence  of   other  organic  substrates
(Groenewegen and Stolp, 1981).

     Another general trend with respect to decomposition rates of aromatic
compounds  in land treatment  soils is  that  the  higher the water solubility
of the compound,  the more  rapidly it  degrades  in soil.   As stated before,
there are  exceptions to nearly  every  rule governing  the decomposition of
aromatic  compounds.   For instance,   the relatively insoluble  compound
anthracene (75 mg/1) was  found  in one  study (Groenewegen and Stolp,  1981)
to degrade  more  rapidly than  the more soluble  compound  fluoranthene (265
mg/1).


                                    314

-------
     In a  soil  enriched  culture,  the aromatic constituents  of  a crude oil
were found to degrade  in  the  following order:   naphthalene  ~ 2-methylnaph-
thalene >  1-methylnaphthalene > dimethylnaphthalenes a  dibenzothiophene »
phenanthrene  >  C3~naphthalene8  >  methylphenanthrenes   >  C2~phenanthrenes
(Fedorak  and  Westlake, 1981).   Parent  aromatic  compounds  were generally
more readily degraded than their alkyl substituted counterparts.

     A number  of studies  have noted  short-term  accumulation  of  aromatic
hydrocarbons after land  treatment  of oily wastes.   This is  apparently due
to  the formation  of  aromatic hydrocarbons  as  by-products of aliphatic
hydrocarbon decomposition (Kincannon, 1972).  In a well managed  land treat-
ment unit, most of  the  rapidly degradable aliphatic hydrocarbons  of oily
wastes will decompose  within  a few  months after application.   After that
point, aromatic hydrocarbons  should decrease  at  a  faster rate since they
will no longer  be added to the soil as decomposition by-products.

     Several of the  lower molecular  weight aromatic hydrocarbons have been
reported  in   large   concentrations  as  organic constituents  contaminating
groundwater (Table 6.55).   In addition,  several  polyaromatic hydrocarbons
(such  as  benzo(a)pyrene)  have been found  at  low  concentrations in ground-
water  (Zoeteman et al., 1981).  While several of the polyaromatic hydrocar-
bons are naturally occurring pyrolysis by-products,  the  fact that they have
been  found in  groundwater  contaminated  by improperly  disposed synthetic
organic  compounds indicates   their  potential  for  leaching if they   are
improperly disposed.

     No references were found to indicate  the plant  absorption  of unsubsti-
tuted  aromatic  hydrocarbons.   However, plant  absorption has been found to
occur  with carboxylic acid derivatives of  aromatics  (Bollard,  1960)  and
halogenated aromatic compounds (Kloskowski et al.,  1981)  (See Table 6.57).
6.2.3.3  Organic Acids
     Organic  acids are  organic constituents  with phenolic  or carboxylic
acid functional groups.   Where the pH of a  soil  is above the  dissociation
constant of  an organic acid,  the  acid  will exhibit  a  net negative  charge
and, consequently have little  adsorption to  soil and  high  water solubility.
These factors  combine  to  make  organic acids relatively volatile,  leachable
and able to  enter  runoff  water.   Organic acids  are components of numerous
hazardous wastes,  but the  primary source in  land treatment  soil will be
from the  biodegradation by-products  of  the other  organics  present  in the
waste  treated  soil.    Chlorinated  organic  acids,  including chlorinated
phenols, are discussed in Section  6.2.3.4.

     Degradation of  organic acids in soil  can be relatively rapid under
favorable environmental conditions.   Too high a  loading  rate of  acids can
sufficiently lower the soil pH so  that biodegradation is inhibited.   Martin
and Haider  (1976)  showed  that several  carboxylic acids  would degrade as
rapidly as glucose in a sandy  soil  (Table  6.59).   Higher molecular  weight
carboxylic acids may  degrade more slowly.   Moucawi et  al. (1981) compared

                                     315

-------
 the percent  degradation  of 2  long  chain,   saturated  fatty  acids  (C-18
 stearic acid  and  C-28 montanlc  acid) after these acids were incubated  in  2
 microbially  active and  2  acid  soils  for 4 weeks.  Stearic acid  underwent
 substantial  degradation in  the  microbially active  soils   (23.6-31.2%)  but
 little  degradation in  the  acid  soils  (3.9-5.1%).   The  longer chain  acid
 underwent  very  little degradation in all 4 soils (0-2.1%).  An unsaturated
 C-18 fatty acid (Oleic acid) underwent substantial degradation  in both the
 acid (23.4-24.8%)  and microbially active  soils (33.0-41.4%).


 TABLE 6.59 DECOMPOSITION  OF THREE CARBOXYLIC  ACIDS AND GLUCOSE IN SANDY
            SOIL*


                                                % Decomposition
Organic Constituent^               After  7 days               After  84  days
Acetic acid
Pyruvic acid
Succinic acid
Glucose
52-76
47-83
52-89
75
71-87
70-93
71-95
87
 * Martin and Haider  (1976).

 * All organics applied to the soil at  1000 ppm.


     Phenolic acids  are also rapidly degraded in soil at  low  concentrations
 but can cause a lag  phase of low microbial degradation at higher  concentra-
 tions.   Scott et  al.  (1982)  evaluated  the  curves representing  cumulative
 adsorbed and  microbially degraded phenol  with two  soils in  a batch  test
 using a 1:5 soil to  solution concentration and continuous shaking.  At  con-
 centrations <10~^M phenol  the  curves had  the following  three  character-
 istic phases:

     (1)  there  was  an  initial  lag  phase  whose  length  (of  time)
          increased with increasing phenol concentration;

     (2)  next, there  was  an exponential  growth phase whose rate of
          growth decreased with increasing phenol  concentration;  and

     (3)  finally, there was a  stationary  phase  where essentially all
          the phenol that was not adsorbed had been degraded.

     In another experiment, repeated  applications  of phenols to soil first
 increased and then decreased the rate  at which phenol was biodegraded (Med-
vedev et al., 1981).   The initial decomposition rate increase was thought
 to be due to rapid multiplication of the phenol-decomposing microorganisms,
and the subsequent decrease, due to a gradual accumulation of toxic meta-
bolic by-products  or  the  proliferation of  another microbe that  fed on
phenol-decomposing bacteria.  Haider  et  al.  (1981) studied the degradation
in soil  of phenol,  benzole acid, and their chlorinated  derivatives  (See
Section 6.2.3.4.1, Table 6.60).


                                    316

-------
     Four phenolic  acids  (p-hydroxybenzoic, ferulic, caffeic  and vanillic
acids) were found to  be quickly  metabolized when 5 mg of  the  compound was
incorporated  into  each  gram  of  soil  (5,000  ppm).    After  4  weeks  of
incubation,  both  extractable  phenols  and  soil  respiration  rates  had
returned to levels  near that  of  the control soil  (Sparling  et al.,  1981).
In  another study   that  examined  respiration  after soil  amendment  with
phenolic acids,  the soil respiration rate  decreased substantially  by the
fourth week of the study (Haider and Martin, 1975).  However, less than 60%
of carbon-14 labelled  caffeic  acid had evolved as  carbon  dioxide (CC^) in
4 weeks and less  than 70% had evolved in 12 weeks.  This  indicates  that a
decrease in the respiration rate  is  not  necessarily an  indication that all
of the phenolic acids have been degraded.

     Some phenolic  compounds have  been found to be relatively resistent to
biodegradation because  they readily  undergo polymerization reactions and
the higher molecular weight polymers  are  only  slowly degraded.  Martin and
Haider (1979)  incubated  two carbon-14 labelled phenols  that  readily poly-
merize (coumaryl  alcohol  and pyrocatechol)  in moist sandy  loam and found
that  only  42% and  24%, respectively,  of the  ring carbons had  evolved as
C0£'   When the pyrocatechol  was linked  into  model humic  acid-type poly-
mers,  evolution  of carbon-14  from five  soils ranged  from 2-9%  after 12
weeks.  When coumaryl alcohol was  incorporated into a model lignin, evolu-
tion  of  carbon-14 from five  soils ranged  from  7-14%  after 12 weeks.   In
both cases where the  phenols were  linked into model polymers,  the addition
of an  easily  biodegradable  carbon source to the  treatment  soil had little
effect on the  biodegradation  rate of the phenols  as measured  by carbon-14
evolution.

     Leaching  and  runoff  of organic  acids   can  be substantial  due  to  the
high water solubility of these compounds.   If the pH of  the soil  is  greater
than  the  pKa  of an organic acid, mobility of the acid will  be increased
in clay soils (Section 6.2.2.4.1).

     No information was  found on  vapor  loss  of organic acids  from  soil.
Judging from  the vapor pressure  of these  compounds,  low  molecular weight
carboxylic acids  may undergo  substantial volatilization,  while  the  vapor
loss of phenolic compounds would be somewhat less.

     Plant uptake of organic acids has been  shown  in several studies (Table
6.57).  Bollard  (1960) showed that  several carboxylic  acid derivatives of
aromatic hydrocarbons  can be  taken up by plants.   Ghosh and Burris  (1950)
found  plants can take up several amino acids.
6.2.3.4  Halogenated Qrganics
     Halogenated organics  contain  one or more halogen atoms (Cl, F, Br,  or
I) somewhere  in their molecular structure.   Chlorinated organics  comprise
the  vast majority  of halogenated  organics  found  in  wastes.    A  notable
exception is  the group of brominated biphenyls,  which until recently  were
widely  used  as flame  retardants.   Halogenated  organics can  be  further


                                     317

-------
broken down  into  aliphatics,  aromatics,  and arenes (molecules that contain
both aromatic and aliphatic parts).

     Most  of the  interest in the  past  few years  has  been directed toward
chlorinated  aromatics such as chlorinated biphenyls (PCB), chlorinated ben-
zenes and  their phenolic metabolic by-products.   Little quantitative data
are available on  such  critical  areas  as the soil half-life, volatilization
or  leaching rates  from soil,  or the  ability of  plants to  absorb these
compounds.   Land treatment of halogenated organics should  be avoided unless
preliminary  studies have assured that biodegradation (not  volatilization or
leaching)  will  be  essentially the only  loss  mechanism for these hazardous
constituents.   In  addition,  preliminary studies  should  determine the soil
half-life  of the  halogenated constituents  for  the following reasons:   (1)
to  ensure  that  the loading  rate  schedule  does not cause accumulation of
these  compounds  to the  point  that  the   concentration  is  toxic   to  the
microbial  population  or  that   the  adsorption  capacity  of  the  soil  is
exceeded  causing leaching  or  volatilization  to  become  significant  loss
mechanisms;  and  (2)  to  ensure that  the  degree of  degradation  required
for  closure is achievable  within the  operational life  span of  the  HWLT
unit.

     Many  of the halogenated  organics can  not  be expected to be satisfac-
torily degraded within the 10-30  year  life span of  HWLT units.   The low
degradability,  high leachability  and high volatility of  the halogenated
solvents  make   these  compounds  especially  unsuitable  for  land  treatment.
Wastes  containing  these compounds  should either  undergo  some  type  of
dehalogenation  pretreatment or be  disposed  in some other manner.

     Halogenated organics  span  the range   of leachability,  volatility and
degradability.  At  one end of  this  range  are  some of  the  most  toxic and
persistant  compounds  made by man.   Many  of  the  light  weight chlorinated
hydrocarbons are among the most prevalent synthetic organic chemicals found
in  groundwater  (Table 6.55).   For these   reasons, wastes containing even
low  concentrations  of  halogenated organics  may  require  a dehalogenation
pretreatment prior to land treatment of the waste.  Wastes that may contain
halogenated  hydrocarbons include  textiles,  petrochemical, wood preserving,
agricultural, and pharmaceutical wastes.   Halogenated  organics may also be
found in the wastes of industries  that use  halogenated solvents.

     Degradation of halogenated organics in soil  has been  documented.  How-
ever, the  range in  degradation  rates for   these  compounds may be  anywhere
from rapid to extremely slow.  As with all organic chemicals,  the slower
the degradation rate, the more likely it is that  the compound would be lost
by  volatilizing,  leaching  or entering  runoff water  rather  than   through
biodegradation.

     Chlorinated hydrocarbon  insecticides  are among the  most resistant to
biodegradation  of all  pesticides (Edwards, 1973).   Soil half-life of many
of the early chlorinated pesticides are  measured in years rather than days
or weeks.   With further research, it was   discovered  that factors  such as
position  of halogens  on a  ring  structure could significantly  alter its
degradation  rate (Kearney, 1967).  Isomers  of the  same chlorinated  compound


                                    318

-------
have been  found  to  have order  of  magnitude differences in  soil  half-life
(Stewart and Cairns, 1974).  Another problem that has been encountered with
chlorinated organica is that  the terminal  residue  or metabolic by-products
may  be either  more toxic  (Kiigemagi  et  al.,  1958)  or  more  persistent
(Smelt, 1981) than the parent compound.
6.2.3.4.1  Chlorinated Benzene Derivatives.   Chlorinated aromatics are,  as
a  group,  less degradable,  volatile and  leachable  than  their  chlorinated
aliphatic counterparts.  In many cases, however, the lower degradation rate
makes  leaching,  volatilization,  runoff  or  plant  uptake  significant  loss
mechanisms.  Following are discussions of chlorinated benzenes (hexachloro-
benzene,   pentachlorobenzene,   trichlorobenzenes,   dichlorobenzenes,   and
chlorobenzene),  and  brominated  and  chlorinated  biphenyls,  along  with
several derivatives  and  metabolic by-products of the  chlorinated aromatic
compounds.

     Hexachlorobenzene  (HCB)  has  been found  to be both a  by-product  of
numerous industrial processes and a contaminant in a variety of chlorinated
solvents and  pesticides (Farmer  et al.,  1980).   Beck and  Hansen (1974)
found HCB, quintozene (PCNB), and pentachlorothioanisol  (PCTA) to have soil
half-lives (in days)  of  approximately 969-2089  (calculated),  213-699, and
194-345, respectively.   These  three compounds  follow  the general trend in
that the less chlorinated  otherwise similar compounds  are, the more biode-
gradable they are likely to be.  While the water solubility and vapor pres-
sure of these compounds are relatively low,  their extreme  persistence makes
both leaching and volatilization potential  loss  mechanisms.

     Another  problem encountered  with HCB  and  its  derivatives  has  been
their  absorption  and translocation in  plants.   Since  these compounds are
relatively immobile  in  soil (Overcash and  Pal,  1979),  they may be present
near the soil surface for  centuries and, consequently,  accessable  to plant
roots.    Smelt  (1981)  found  several studies  that  documented  the  plant
absorption of both HCB  and PCNB.   The ratio of crop to soil concentration
was as  high as 29:1  for HCB and 27:1 for PCNB.   Plants that were  found to
accumulate  higher  concentrations  of  the  chlorinated  organics  than was
present  in the  soil included  lettuce  (Lactuca sativa),  carrots (Daucus
garota),  grasses,   parsley  (Petroselinum  crispum),    radishes   (Raphanus
sativus), potatoes (Solanum tuberosum) and  tulip (fulipa sp.) bulbs.

     HCB and  its  derivatives could pose a  hazard  to  grazing animals long
after closure of a land  treatment unit.   Consequently,  there is a  need for
HWLT operators to monitor  incoming wastes to be  sure that  untreated chlori-
nated wastes  are  detected  and rejected  before they pass  through  the  front
gates.  It should  also be  noted that in  soils where HCB  is present,  there
may also be several HCB metabolites.   Smelt (1981)  examined  soil  plots that
had  previously  been  treated  with  compounds containing HCB  and found the
following related  compounds:   quintozene (PCNB), pentachlorobenzene  (QCB),
pentachloroaniline  (PCA),   and  pentachlorothioanisol (PCTA).   Since  plant
absorption has been  shown  to occur for  HCB and PCNB,  the potential  exists
for  metabolites  of  these  compounds  to  be either  absorbed by  plants or
formed  in the plant  as metabolic  by-products of HCB or  PCNB.  PCA has been


                                    319

-------
found in lettuce (Lactuca sativa) leaves (Dejonckheere et al., 1981) but it
could not  be  determined if it entered  lettuce  from the soil  or formed in
the plant from decomposition of the PCNB that was also in the plant tissue.
Dejonckheere et al.  (1981)  pointed out that these  compounds,  if they were
consumed by grazing  animals would  either  concentrate in fatty tissue (HCB)
or be passed into the milk of dairy cows (PCNB and PGA.).

     Trichlorobenzenes  (TCB) are constituents of  both textile-dying wastes
and  transformer  fluids containing  polychlorinated biphenyls  (EPA,  1976).
Two TCBs (1,2,3- and  1,2,4-TCB) were  found to  biodegrade very slowly (0.35
and 1.00 nmol/day/20  gms  soil,  respectively) when these compounds were in-
cubated in a  sandy loam  soil  at  concentrations  of  50 yg TCB per  gram of
soil  (Marinucci  and  Bartha, 1979).   Neither fertilizer  additions  nor the
addition of other microbial substrates appeared to increase TCB  biodegrada-
tion rates.

     Since anaerobic conditions are  known  to  increase  the  rate  of  some
dechlorination reactions  but  may  suppress aromatic ring  cleavage,  weekly
alterations of anaerobic and aerobic soil  conditions were studied to see if
TCB biodegradatlon  could be  increased.    The  authors assumed  that,  since
this  cycling  of  soil  conditions  failed   to  increase  biodegradation,  the
kinetics of TCB  mineralization suggested  rate-limiting initial reactions.
The only factor found to increase TCB biodegradation was increased tempera-
ture  (28°C or  above).  Maximum biodegradation  rate for  the  compounds was
obtained at TCB concentrations between  10-25 yg per gram  of  soil and this
rate was found to markedly decrease above  that concentration range.

     A mixture of  dichlorobetizene  has been  shown to degrade  in soil much
slower  than  benzene,   chlorobenzene,  or   a mixture  of  trichlorobenzenes
(Haider et  al.,  1981).   After incubation in  a  moist  loess  soil  for 10
weeks, only 6.3% of  the original 20 ppm carbon-14 labeled dichlorobenzenes
had evolved as carbon dioxide.   This translates  into  a soil  half-life for
these compounds of roughly 2 years.  With  a  2 year half-life  it would take
approximately 14 years  to  achieve  99% degradation.  By contrast, the tri-
chlorobenzenes were  33% biodegraded after 10  weeks.   At  this  degradation
rate, 99%  degradation of the  trichlorobenzenes  could be  achieved  in less
than 3 years,   Chlorobenzene was degraded  somewhat slower than the trichlo-
robenzenes but at four  times the degradation  rate for the dichlorobenzenes
(Table 6.60).   While these rates  of degradation are somewhat  lower than
those reported elsewhere, the  trends  in the  data  indicate there are signi-
ficant  exceptions to  the  general  rule  that   "the  less  chlorinated  an
organic, the more degradable it is."
                                    320

-------
TABLE 6.60  DEGRADATION OF CHLORINATED BENZENES,  PHENOLS,  BENZOIC ACIDS AND
            CYCLOHEXANES AND THEIR PARENT COMPOUNDS*'


Compounds                  3 days   1 week   2 weeks    5  weeks    10 weeks

Benzene                      7.5     24       37          44           47
Chlorobenzene               16.2     18.3     20          25           27
Dichlorobenzenes             0.1      1.1      1.2        1.7          6.3
Trichlorobenzenes            3.6     20.3     22          30           33

Phenol                      45.5     48       52          60           65
2-Chlorophenol               7.5     13       14.7       21           25
4-Chlorophenol              15.4     22.2     24          31           35
Dichlorophenols              1.4     31.4     35          43           48
Trichlorophenols             1.6     35       38          47           51

Benzole acid                40       44       49          57           63
3-Chlorobenzoic acid        21       28       32          38           59
Cyclohexane
y-Hexachlorocyclohexane
y-Pentachlorocyclohexane
<0.02
0.05
0.01
0.1
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.7
0.8
0.3
1.8
2.3
0.3
2.6
3.5
* Haider et al. (1981).

* Degradation was measured by the release of marked C02 from the
  carbon-14 labeled organic compounds.  Values given in the table are sum
  values in % of added radioactivity.


     Metabolic  by-products  of   chlorinated benzenes  include  chlorinated
phenols  and  carboxylic acids.   Degradation of  phenol,  benzole  acid,  and
some of  their  chlorinated  derivatives  are given in Table  6.60.   While the
chlorinated derivatives  of these  acids are generally less  degradable in
soil than their nonchlorinated  counterparts,  they  are usually more degrad-
able than their parent chlorinated benzene derivatives.

     Baker and Mayfield  (1980)  studied the degradation of  phenol  and its
chlorinated derivatives in aerobic, anaerobic, sterile and non-sterile  soil
(Table 6.61).   Phenol, o-chlorophenol, p-chlorophenol, 2,4-dichlorophenol,
2,6-dichlorophenol, and  2,4,6-trlchlorophenol  were biodegraded  rapidly in
the aerobic soil,  while  m-chlorophenol, 3,4-dichlorophenol, 2,4,5-trichlo-
rophenol, and pentachlorophenol were degraded more slowly.  The most slowly
degraded compounds under aerobic conditions were 3,4,5-trichlorophenol and
2,3,4,5-tetrachlorophenol.   While  nonbiological  degradation occurred in
both the aerobic  and  anaerobic  soil,  no biological degradation  of any of
the chlorophenols was indicated  for the anaerobic soils.
6.2.3.4.2  Halogenated Biphenyls.  Halogenated biphenyls are no longer pro-
duced in  the U.S., but  the extreme  recalcitrance of  these  compounds and
their past widespread  use in chemical  industries  indicates that they will


                                    321

-------
     TABLE 6.61  AEROBIC AND ANAEROBIC DEGRADATION OF PHENOL AND US CHLORINATED DERIVATIVES  IN  SOIL*
to
Aerobic Degradation
Non-sterile

Compounds
Phenol
o-chlorophenol
m-chlorophenol
p-chlorophenol
2 ,4-dichlorophenol
2 , 6-dichlorophenol
3 , 4-dichlorophenol
2,4, 6-tr ichlorophenol
2,4, 5-trichlorophenol
3,4, 5-trichlorophenol
2,3,4, 5-tetrachlorophenol
Pentachlorophenol

Days
5.00
1.50
160.00
20.00
40.00
0.75
160.00
3.00
160.00
160.00
160.00
160.00
Z
Degraded
100
100
87
83
81
100
88
95
72
17
31
80
Sterile

Days
40
40
160
20
40
40
160
80
160
160
160
160
%
Degraded
15
67
31
5
31
55
21
27
9
0
-1
20
Anaerobic Degradation
Non-sterile

Days
40
80
160
40
80
80
160
80
80
80
80
160
%
Degraded
20
78
37
13
62
82
-4
28
8
-2
5
7
Sterile

Days
40
80
160
40
80
80
160
80
80
80
80
160
%
Degraded
7
82
15
17
59
81
-3
25
5
4
7
5
      *  Baker and Mayfield (1980).

-------
be  an  important  concern of  the waste  disposal  community  for  at  least
several decades.   Polychlorinated  biphenyls (PCB) are still  in  widespread
use In  transformers and  capacitors  around the  world (Griffin and  Chian,
1980).    Polybrominated  biphenyls  (PBB)  were produced  for  use  as  flame
retardants in business machines, electrical housings, and textiles (Griffin
and Chou, 1982).

     Degradation of PCBs has been found to be affected by the nature of the
chlorine  (Cl)  substituents  as  follows (Morrill  et  al., 1982; Kensuke  et
al., 1978):

     (1)  degradation  decreased as   amount  of   Cl  substitution  in-
          creased;

     (2)  PCBs with two Cl atoms in  the  ortho  position on one or both
          rings had very low degradability; and

     (3)  PCBs with only one  chlorinated  ring  degraded  more rapidly
          than PCBs with  a  similar  number of  Cl atoms but  with these
          divided between the two rings.

     In many cases, the mono-, di-, and tri-chlorinated biphenyls have been
found  to  be  degradable by   mixed   microbial  populations   (Furukawa  and
Matsumura, 1976; Metcalf  et al., 1975).   Most  reports on the degradability
of  tetra-,  penta-,  and  hexachlorobiphenyls  indicate  that  these compounds
degrade  extremely  slowly in  most  environments  (Metcalf   et  al.,  1975;
Nissen, 1981).

     Nissen  (1981)  investigated  the  degradability of Arochlor 1254 (a mix-
ture of PCBs with from 4 to  7 chlorine substituents) in moist,  warm soil
with nutrients added.   No biodegradation was  evident after  60  days  of
incubation in the soil.  Moein et al.  (1975)  returned to the site of a two
year old spill of Archlor 1254 on soil and found that  no perceptable degra-
dation of  the  PCBs  had occurred over that time  period.   In another study,
Iwata et  al. (1973) found  that the  lower  chlorinated biphenyls exhibited
significant  degradation in 12 months  on five California  soils.

     A study by Wallnofer et  al. (1981) indicated that PCBs were absorbed
by  the  lipid  rich epidermal  cells   on  carrots   (Daucus  carota) and  to  a
lesser extent by radish (Raphanus sativus) roots.  Moza  et  al. (1976), how-
ever,  found a  phenolic metabolic  by-product of 2,2'-dichlorobiphenyl in
carrot leaves.  Mrozek et al.  (1982)  demonstrated that salt  marsh cordgrass
has the capacity  to accumulate PCBs above the level of these compounds in
the soil.   PCBs were  taken up by  the plant  from sand  and an organic mud
soil.  Furthermore, the PCBs were translocated throughout the plant.  While
PCBs are strongly adsorbed by  organic matter in  soils, they have been found
to be largely  associated with the  partially decomposed plant litter rather
than humic substances (Scharpenseel  et  al.,   1978).   These plant remnants
are readily  taken  up  by soil  fauna thereby providing  a means for the PCBs
to enter the food chain.  Several other  studies  that noted  the plant uptake
of various chlorinated biphenyls are  listed in Table  6.57.
                                     323

-------
     Polybrominated  biphenyls  (PBB) were found  to  be  strongly adsorbed by
 soils  and  not  leached  by water by Griffin and Chou  (1982).   Similar results
 were obtained  by Filonow et al.  (1976).   Jacobs et al.  (1976) found that
 FBBs were  only very slowly degradable  In  soil  and taken up in very small
 quantities by  plants.  From  all available  data it would  appear  that PBB
 contaminated  soil will pose little threat  to groundwater  or crop purity,
 with the possible  exception of  root crops.   There is,  however, no informa-
 tion  available  concerning the  toxicity,  degradability,  leachability  or
 ability for plants to  take up metabolites of PBB  (Getty et  al., 1977).


 6.2.3.5  Surface-active Agents
     Surface-active  agents  (surfactants)  are  organic compounds  with two
distinct parts to  each molecule.   One part is hydrophilic or water soluble
(such  as  a sulfonate, sulfate,  quarternary amine  or  polyoxyethylene) and
the  other  part  is  hydrophobic or water-insoluble  (such as an aliphatic or
aromatic group)  (Huddleston  and Allred,  1967).  It  is  the  presence of  these
two  different  groups on the  same  molecule that causes  these molecules to
concentrate at surfaces  or interfaces.   The presence of these molecules at
interfaces reduces the surface tension of  liquids.   Surfactants are common-
ly found  in  industrial wastes as  a  result of their use  in various indus-
tries  as  detergents,  wetting  agents,  penetrants, emulsifiers  spreading
agents  and dispersants.    Industries  that use  large quantities  of surfac-
tants  include  textile,  cosmetic,  pharmaceutical,  metal,  paint,  leather,
paper,  rubber, and agricultural  chemical industries.  The three main  types
of surfactants produced  are  cationics,  nonlonics  and anionics.  These sur-
factants accounted for 6,  28 and 65%, respectively,  of the total surfactant
production in the U.S. in  1978 (Land and Johnson,  1979).

     Most  cationic surfactants  are salts  of  either a  quarternary ammonium
or an  amine group  (with  an aromatic or aliphatic  side chain) and either  a
halogen or hydroxide.  Many  of  these  surfactants  can cause problems due to
their strong antimicrobial action.

     Nonionic surfactants  are so named because  they  do not ionize in water.
Two main types are alkyl polyoxyethylenes  and alkylphenol  polyoxyethylenes.
The former has been  found  to be readily biodegradable, but decreasingly so
as the  polyoxyethylene  chain is lengthened  (Huddleston and Allred, 1967).
Half-life  of  an  alkyl  polyoxyethylene  surfactant  in  a  moist  (28%  1^0)
sandy loam soil was found  to be approximately 60,  90,  120 and  160 days when
the surfactant was applied at 250, 1,000,  5,000 and  10,000 ppm, respective-
ly (Valoras et al.,  1976).  Although the  study did not extend long enough
to achieve  50% degradation  of  higher  dosage levels  extrapolation  of the
data indicated that when applied to  this soil at  20,000 ppm, the half-life
of the surfactant may have approached 1 year.

     Anionic surfactants are negatively charged ions when  in  solution.  The
three major forms  are alkyl  sulfates,  alkylbenzene sulfonates and carboxy-
lates.   Alkylbenzene  sulfonates  are the most  widely used surfactants,
accounting for 35% of  all surfactants produced in the U.S.  in  1978  (Land


                                    324

-------
and  Johnson,  1979).   Most widely  used  surfactants of  this  type  are  the
linear alkyl benzenes (LAS), which are composed of a benzene ring with both
a  sulfonate and  a roughly  linear  alkyl  chain attached.   Major  factors
influencing  the biodegradation rate  for the LAS  type surfactants  are  as
follows (Huddleston and Allred, 1967).

     (1)  the position  of the sulfonate  group  relative to the alkyl
          chain;

     (2)  the  alkyl  chain length  and  point  of   attachment   of  the
          benzene ring; and

     (3)  the  degree  of   branching  along  the  length  of  the alkyl
          chain.

     Another  type of  alkylbenzene  sulfonate  called ABS  is  a  mixture  of
branched  chain  isomers  of sodium dodecylbenzene sulfonate.  While  LAS and
ABS have  both been found to inhibit nitrification activities, LAS is appar-
ently  biodegraded  more quickly  in  soil  (Vandoni and  Goldberg,  1981).
Neither of these surfactants is likely to volatilize from the soil surface,
but both  can be mobile in  soils when they are  in an ionic state.  There is
some evidence that these and other surfactants may increase the leachabili-
ty of  other organic  constituents and  some microorganisms  under saturated
flow conditions.   A  discussion  of  the  effects of  anionic  surfactants  on
plants has been published  by Overcash and Pal (1979).

     Surfactants  can  have  strong  influences on the  chemical,  physical and
biological properties of a soil.   If the hydrophilic  portion  of a surfac-
tant adsorbs  to soil particles,  the hydrophobic portion would extend out-
wards, imparting to soil particles a hydrophobic surface.  Under these con-
ditions,  the saturated  flow  (flow due  to gravity)  increases while  the
unsaturated  flow  (flow due to capillary forces) decreases  (Sebastian!  et
al., 1981).   Luzzati (1981)  found  that  applying  the  equivalent  of 3,200
kg/ha of  nonionic and anionic surfactants  to  test  plots slightly improved
soil structure  but  substantially  inhibited soil enzyme activity.   Vandoni
and Goldberg  (1981) found  that anionic  surfactants  significantly inhibited
nitrification (metabolism  of  ammonium in soil) while  nonionic surfactants
seemed  to slightly stimulate  nitrification.    Letey et al.  (1975) showed
that infiltration rates were increased  with  soil  application  of  nonionic
surfactants.  Aggregation, aeration and  water holding capacity of a soil
can  be  increased by  surfactant  applications  to  soil  (Batyuk  and Samoch-
valenko,  1981).   However,  Cardinal!  and Stoppini  (1981)  found that while
anionic surfactant  dosages of 16-80 ppm  improved the  structural stability
of some  soils,  at  dosages over 400  ppm the  structural stability  of  the
soils always  significantly decreased.   When calculating  the  loading rates
for biodegradable surfactants, both the  half-life  and effect on soil prop-
erties of these constituents should be carefully considered.
                                     325

-------
                           CHAPTER 6 REFERENCES
Abbazov, M.A., I. D. Dergunov, and R. Mlkulin. 1978. Effect of soil
properties on the accumulation of strontium-90 and cesium-137 in crops.
Soviet Soil Sci. 10(l):52-56.

Adams, D. F., J. W. Hendrix, and H. G. Applegate. 1957. Relation among
exposure periods, foliar burn, and fluorine content of plants exposed to
hydrogen fluoride. J. Agr. Food Chem. 5:108-116.

Adriano, D. C., L. T. Novak, A. E. Erickson, A. R. Wolcott, and B. G.
Ellis. 1975. Effect of long term land disposal by spray irrigation of food
processing wastes on some chemical properties of the soil and subsurface
water. J. Environ. Qual. 4:242-248.

Ahmed, S. and H. J. Evans. 1960. Cobalt: a micronutrient element for the
growth of soybean plants under symbiotic conditions. Soil Sci. 90:205-210.

Ahmed, S. and H, J. Evans. 1961. The essentiality of cobalt for soybean
plants grown under bymbiotic conditions. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A.
47:24-36.

Aldrich, D. G., J. R. Buchanan, and G. R. Bradford. 1955.  Effect of soil
acidification on vegetative growth and leaf composition of lemon trees in
pot culture. Soil Sci. 79:427-439.

Allaway, W. H. 1968. Agronomic controls over the environmental cycling of
trace elements. Adv. Agron. 20:235-271.

Allaway, W. H. 1975. Soil and plant aspects of cycling of chromium,
molybdenum and selenium. In_ T. C. Hutchinson (ed.) Proc. of International
Conference on Heavy Metals in the Environment, Vol. 1. Toronto, Canada.

Allen, H. E., R. H. Hall, and T. D. Brisbin. 1980. Metal Speciation.
Effects on aquatic toxicity. Environ. Sci. Technol. 14:441-443.

Alten, F. and R. Goltwick. 1933. A contribution to the question of the
substitution of Rb and Cs for K in plant nutrition. Ernahr Planze.
29:393-399.

Anastasia, F. B. and W. J. Render. 1973. The influence of soil arsenic on
the growth of lowbush blueberries. J. Environ. Qual. 2:335-337.

Anderson, A. and K. 0. Nilsson. 1974. Ambio 3:198-200.

Andrziewski, M. 1971.  Effect of chromium application on yields of several
plant species and on the chromium content of soil.  Rocznik Nauk
Rolniczych. Agricultural College, Pozlon, Poland.
                                    326

-------
Arnon, D. I. 1958. The role of micronutrients in plant nutrition with
special reference to photosynthesis and nitrogen assimilation, pp. 1-32. In
C. A. Lamb, 0. E. Bently, and J. M. Beate (ed.) Trace elements.  Academic
Press, New York.

Aston, S. R. and P. H. Brazier. 1979. Endemic goitre, the factors
controlling iodine deficiency in soils. The science of the total
environment. 11:99-104.

Aubert, H. and M. Pinta. 1977. Trace elements in soils. Elsevier Sci. Publ.
Co., New York. 395 p.

Baker, M. D. and C. I. Mayfield. 1980. Microbial and non-biological
decomposition of chlorophenols and phenol in soil. Water, Air and Soil
Pollution 13:411-424.

Ballard, R. and J. G. A. Fiskell. 1974. Phosphorus retention in coastal
plain forest soils: I.  Relationship to soil properties. Soil Sci. Soc. Am.
J. 38:250-255.

Banerjee, D. K., R. H. Bray, and S. W. Melated. 1953. Some aspects of the
chemistry of cobalt in soils. Soil Sci. 75:421-431.

Barber, S. A., J. M. Walker, and E. M. Vasey. 1963. Principles of ion
movement through the soil to the plant root. pp. 121-124. Trans. Joint
Meeting, Comm. IV and V. Intern. Soc. Soil Sci., New Zealand, 1962.

Barker, D. E. and L. Chesnin. 1975. Chemical monitoring of soils for
environmental quality and animals and human health. Adv. Agron. 27:306-374.

Barker, H. A. 1941. Studies on methane fermentation. V. J. Biol. Chen.
127:153-167.

Barltrop, D., C. D. Strehlow, I. Thornton, and S. S. Webb. 1974.
Significance of high soil lead concentrations for childhood lead burdens.
Environ. Health Perspec. 7:75-82.

Barnette, R. M. and J. P. Camp. 1936. Chlorosis in corn plants and other
field crop plants. Fla. Agr. Exp. Sta. Ann. Rep. 45.

Barshad, I. 1948. Molybdenum content of pasture plants in relation to
toxicity to cattle. Soil Science 66:187-195.

Bartlett, R. and B. James. 1979. Behavior of chromium in soils:  III.
Oxidation. J. Environ. Qual. 8:31-34.

Batyuk, V. P. and S. K. Samochvalenko. 1981. The influence of surface-
active substances on the water-physical characteristics of soil and  the
physiological-biochemical characteristics of plants, pp. 407-418. In_ M. R.
Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic organic chemicals in
soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.
                                     327

-------
Baumhard, G. R. and L. F. Welch. 1972. Lead uptake and corn growth with
soil applied lead. J. Environ. Qual. l(l):92-94.

Beath, 0. A. 1949. Economic potential and botanic limitations of some
selenium bearing plants. Wyoming Agr. Exp. Sta. Bull. 360.

Beath, 0. A., C. S. Gilbert, and H. F. Eppson. 1941a. The use of indicator
plants in locating seleniferous areas in the western United States. I.
General. Am. J. Bot. 26:257.

Beath, 0. A., C. S. Gilbert, and H. F. Eppson. 1941b. The use of indicator
plants in locating seleniferous areas of the western United States. II.
Correlation. Am. J. Bot. 28:887.

Beauchamp, E. G. and J. Moyer. 1974. Nitrogen transformation and uptake. In
Proc. of Sludge Handling and Disposal Seminar, Ontario Ministry of the
Environment. Toronto, Ontario.

Beauford, W., J. Barber, and A. R. Barringer. 1977. Uptake and distribution
of mercury within higher plants.  Physiologia Plantarium 39:261-265.

Beck. J. and K. E. Hansen. 1974. The degradation of quintozene, penta-
chlorobenzene, hexachlorobenzene, and pentachloroaniline in soil. Pestic.
Sci. 5:41-48.

Bell, M. C. and N. N. Sneed. 1970. Metabolism of tungsten by sheep and
swine, pp. 70-71 In C. F. Mills (ed.) Trace elements metabolism in animals.
E and S Livingston, Edinburgh.

Benac, R. 1976. Effect of the manganese concentration in the nutrient
solution on groundnuts. Oleagineaux 31:539-543.

Benson, N. R., R. P. Covey, and W. Hagland. 1978. The apple replant problem
in Washington state. J. Amer. Soc. Hort. Sci. 103:156-158.

Bernstein, L. 1974. Crop growth and salinity Jta J. Van Schilfgaarde (ed.)
Drainage for agriculture. Am. Soc. Agron. Madison, Wisconsin.

Berrow, M. L. and J. Webber. 1972. Trace elements in sewage sludges. J.
Sci. Food Agr. 23:93.

Biddappa, C. C., M. Chino, and K. Kumazawa. 1981. Adsorption, desorption,
potential and selective distribution of heavy metals in selected soils of
Japan. J. Environ. Sci. Health L.

Bielby, D. G., M. H. Miller, and L. R. Webber 1973.  Nitrate content of
percolates from manured lysimeters. J. Soil and Water Cons. 28(3):124-126.

Bingham, F. T. 1973. Boron in cultivated soils and irrigation waters, pp.
130-143. ^n Trace elements in the environment. Am. Chem. Soc., Washington,
D.C.
                                    328

-------
Bingham, F. T. 1979. Bioavailability of Cd to food crops in relation to
heavy metal content of sludge amended soil. Environ. Health Perspec.
28:3943.

Blaschke, H. 1977. The influence of increased copper supply on some crop
plants and their root development. Zeitschrift fur Ackerund Pflanzenbau
144:222-229.

Boawn, L. C. and P. E. Rasmussen. 1971. Crop response to excessive Zn
fertilization of an alkaline soil. Agron. J. 63: 874-876.

Boggess, S. F., S. Willavize, and D. E. Koeppe. 1978. Differential response
of soybean varieties to soil cadmium. Agron. J. 70(5):756-760.

Bonn, H. L., B. L. McNeal, and G. A. O'Connor. 1979. Soil chemistry. John
Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York. 329 p.

Bollard, E. G. 1960. Transport in the xylem. Ann. Rev. Plant Physiology
11:141-166.

Borges, A. C. and A. G. Wollum. 1981. Effect of cadmium on symbiotic
soybean plants. J. Environ. Qual. 10:216-221.

Borovik-Romonova, T. F. 1944. The content of Rb in Plants. Dokl. Aka. Nauk.
SSR 44:313-16.

Bouwer, H. and R. L. Chaney. 1974. Land treatment of wastewater. Adv.
Agron. 26:133-76.

Bowen, H. J. M. 1966. Trace elements in biochemistry. Academic Press, New
York. 241 p.

Bowman, R. S., M. E. Essington, and G. A. O'Connor. 1981. Soil sorption of
nickel:  influence of solution composition.  Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J.
45:860-865.

Bradford, G. R., 1966. Boron, p. 33. In Chapman, H. D. (ed.), Diagnostic
criteria for plants and soils. University of Calif., Div. Agr. Sci.
Riverside, California.

Brady, N. C. 1974. The nature and properties of soils. 8th ed.  MacMillan
Publ. Co., Inc., New York. 639 p.

Brar, M. S. and G. S. Sekhon. 1979. Effect of applied zinc and iron on the
growth of rice. Riso 28(2):125-131.

Bremner, J. M. and K. Shaw. 1958. Denitrification in soils II.  Factors
affecting denitrification. J. Agr. Sci. 51(l):22-52.

Bresler, E., B. L. McNeal, and D. L. Carter. 1982. Saline and sodic soils.
Springer-Verlag Inc., New York, New York. 236 p.
                                     329

-------
Brewer, R. F. 1966a. Fluorine. In H. D. Chapman (ed.) Diagnostic criteria
for plants and soils. University of California, Riverside.

Brewer, R. F. 1966b. Lead. pp. 213-217, In H. D. Chapman  (ed.) Diagnostic
criteria for plants and soils. University of California,  Riverside.

Broadbent, F. E., K. B. Tyler, and G. N. Hill. 1957. Nitrification of
ammonical fertilizers in some California soils. Hilgardia 27:247-267.

Broderius, S. and L. Smith. 1979. Lethal and sublethal effects of binary
mixtures of cyanide and hexavalent chromium, zinc or ammonia to the fathead
minnow and rainbow trout. J. Kish. Res. Board Can. 36:164.

Brooks, R. R. 1977. Copper and cobalt uptake by Haumaniastrum species.
Plant and Soil 48:541-544.

Brooks, R. R., J. Lee, R. D. Reeves, and T. Jaffre. 1977. Detection
of nickeliferous rocks by analysis of herbarium specimens of indicator
plants. J. of Geochem. Exploration 7:49-57.

Brooks, R. R., R. S. Morrison, R. D. Reeves, T. R. Dudley, and Y. Akman.
1979. Hyperaccumulation of nickel by Alyssum Linnaeus (Cruciferae). Proc.
R. Soc. Lond., B 203:387-403.

Brooks, R. R. and C. C. Radford. 1978. Nickel accumulation by European
species of the genus Alyssum. Proc. R. Soc. Lond., B 200:217-224.

Brooks, R. R., R. D. Reeves, R. S. Morrison, and F. Malaisse. 1980.
Hyperaccumulation of copper and cobalt—a review. Bull. Soc. Roy. Bot.
Belg. 113:166-172.

Brown, J. C. and W. E. Jones. 1977. Manganese and iron toxicities dependent
on soybean variety. Comm. in Soil Sci. and Plant Analysis 8:1-15.

Brown, K. W. and L. E. Deuel, Jr. 1982. Evaluation of subsurface landfarm
contamination after long-term use. Final Report of a Cooperative Study  for
the American Petroleum Institute and the U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency. 116 p.

Brown, K. W., L. E. Deuel, Jr. and J. C  Thomas. 1982a. Soil disposal of
API pit wastes. Final Report of a Study for the Environmental Protection
Agency (Grant No. R805474013). 209 p.

Brown, K. W., K. C. Donnelly, and B. Scott. 1982b. The fate of mutagenic
compounds when hazardous wastes are land treated, pp. 383-397. jn David W.
Shultz (ed.) Proceedings at the Eighth Annual Research Symposium at Ft.
Mitchell, Kentucky. EPA-600-9-82-002b.
                                     330

-------
Brown, K. W., K. C. Donnelly, J.  C. Thomas, and L.  E. Deuel, Jr.  1981.
Factors influencing the biodegradation of API  separator  sludges applied  to
soils, pp. 188-199. In Proceedings of the Seventh Annual Research Symposium
at Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, March 16-18. U.S. EPA. Cincinnati,  Ohio.
EPA-600/9-81-002B.

Buddin, W. 1914. Partial sterilization of soil by volatile  and nonvolatile
antiseptics. J. Agric. Sci. 6:417-451.

Burmaster, D. E. and R. H. Harris. 1982. Groundwater  contamination:   an
emerging threat. Technology Review 35(5):50-62.

Burnside, 0. V. 1974. Prevention  and detoxification of pesticide  residues
in soils, pp. 387-412. In W. D. Guenzi.  (ed.)  Pesticides in soil  and water.
Soil Sci. Soc. of Amer., Inc. Madison, Wisconsin.

Butler, G. W. and P. J. Peterson. 1967.  Uptake and  metabolism of  inorganic
forms of selenium-75 by Spiradela oligorrhiza. Australian J. Biol. Sci.
20:77-86.

Cansfield, P. E. and G. R. Racz.  1978. Degradation  of hydrocarbon sludges
in the soil. Canadian Jour, of Soil Sci. 58:339-345.

Cardinal!, A. and Z. Stoppini. 1981. Detergent polluted  waters  and
hydrologic characteristics of agrarian soils.  II. Research  on  Structural
Stability, pp. 419-433. JEn M. R.  Overcash (ed.) Decomposition  of  toxic and
nontoxic organic chemicals in soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ.,  Inc. Ann
Arbor, Michigan.

CAST. 1976. Applications of sewage sludge to  cropland: appraisal  of
potential hazards of the heavy metals to plants and animals. Office of
Water Program Operations, EPA. Washington,  D.  C.  Report  No. 64.  EPA
420/19-76-013.

CAST. 1980. Residual effects of sewage sludge on  the  cadmium and  zinc
content of crops. Prepared by a Task Force  for the  Council  for Agriculture
Science Technology. CAST Report No. 83.  250 Memorial  Union. Ames, Iowa.

Chaney, R. L. 1973. Crop and food chain  effects of  toxic elements in
sludges and effluents, pp. 129-141 In Recycling municipal  sludges and
effluents on land.  National Assoc. State Univ. and Land-Grant  Colleges.
Washington, D.C.

Chaney, R. L. 1974. Recommendations for  management  of potentially toxic
elements in agriculture and municipal wastes,  pp. 97-120. _In Factors
involved in land application of agricultural  and  municipal  wastes. USDA.
Beltsville, Maryland.
                                     331

-------
 Chaney, R. L., D. D. Kaufman, S. B. H. Jornick, J. F. Parr, L. J.  Sikora,
 W.  D. Surge, P. B. March, G. B. Willson, and R. H. Fisher. 1981.  Review of
 information relevant to land treatment of hazardous wastes. Solid  and
 Hazardous Waste Research Divison, Office of Research and Development. US.
 EPA.  Draft.

 Chaney, R. L., G. S. Stoewsand, A. K. Furr, C. A. Bache, and D. J. Lisk.
 1978. Elemental content of tissue of guinea pigs fed swiss chard growth on
 muncipal sewage sludge—amended soil. J. Agr. Food Chem. 26:994-997.

 Chaney, W. R., R. C. Strickland, and R. J. Lamoreaux. 1977. Phytotoxicity
 of cadmium inhibited by lime. Plant and Soil 47(1):275-278.

 Chao, T. T.,  M. E. Harward, and S. C. Fang. 1963. Cationic effects on
 sulfate adsorption by soils. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 27:35-38.

 Chapman, H. D. (ed.) 1966. Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. Univ.
 of California, Division of Agr. Sci. Riverside, California, p. 484.

 Chesnin, L. 1967. Corn, soybeans, and other great plains crops. Micronutr.
 Manual Farm Tech. 23(6).

 Chessmore, R. A.  1979.  Profitable pasture management. Interstate Printers
 and Publishers, Inc.,  Danville,  Illinois. 424 p.

 Chrenekova, C.  1977. Dynamics of arsenic compounds in soil Rostlinna Vyroba
 23:1021-1030.

 Chrenekova, E.  1973. Intensity of toxic effects of arsenate ion in relation
 to method  of  application.  Pol nohospodarstvo 19:921-929.

 Chumbley,  C.  G. 1971.  Permissible levels of toxic metals in sewage used on
 agricultural  land.  A.D.A.S.  Advisory Paper 10.  p. 12.

 Clapp,  C.  E., R.  H.  Dowdy,  and W.  E.  Larcon. 1976.  Unpublished data. Agr.
 Res.  Ser.,  USDA.  St. Paul,  Minnesota.

 Coic, Y. and  C.  Lesaint. 1978.  Microelement levels in tomatoes and
 cucumbers  grown in soilless  culture.  Supplementation with solutions of
 microelements essential for  man. Comptes Rendus des Seances de 1'Academic
 d'Agriculture de  France 64(10):787- 792.

 Coombs,  T.  D.  1979.  Cadmium  in aquatic organisms, pp. 93-139.  In The
 chemistry,  biochemistry and  biology of cadmium.  Elsevier.  New York.

 Cox, R. M.  and  T.  C. Hutchinson. 1980. Multiple metal tolerances in the
 grass Deschampsia cespitosa  from the Sudbury smelting area. New Phytol.
 84:631-647.

Cruz, A. D.,  H. P. Haag and  J. R.  Sarruge.  1967. Effect  of aluminum on
wheat (Triticum vulgare v. Piratini)  grown in nutrient  solution. Anals.
Esc. Sup. Agric.  Luiz Queiroz  24:107-117,


                                     332

-------
Cunningham, J. D., D. R. Kenney, and J. A. Ryan. 1975. Yield and metal
composition of corn and rye grown on sewage sludge-amended soil. J.
Environ. Qual. 4:448-454.

Cunningham, J. J. 1950. Copper and molybdenum in relation to diseases of
cattle and sheep in New Zealand. La Copper metabolism, A Symposium on
Animal, Plant, and Soil Relationships. John Hopkins Press. New York.

Davidson, J. M. and R. K. Chang. 1972. Transport of Picloram in relation to
soil physical conditions and pore-water velocity. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc.
36:257-261.

Davis, J. B., V. E. Farmer, R. E. Kreider, A. E. Straub, and K. M. Reese.
1972. The migration of petroleum products in soil and groundwater:  princi-
ples and countermeasures. American Petroleum Institute Publication No.
4149. Washington, D.C.

Davis, R. D. 1979. Uptake of copper, nickel and zinc by crops growing in
contaminated soils. J. Sci. Food Agric. 30:937-947.

Dawson, G. W., C. J. English, and S. E. Petty. 1980. Physical and chemical
properties of hazardous waste constituents. Attachment 1, Appendix B in
background document (RCRA subtitle C) identification and listing of
hazardous waste. Office of Solid Waste, EPA. May 2, 1980.

Dean-Raymond, D. and M. Alexander. 1976. Plant uptake and leaching of
dimethylnitrosamine. Nature 262:394-396.

Dejonckheere, W., W. Steurbaut, and R. H. Kips. 1981. Problems  caused by
quintozene and hexachlorobenzene residues in lettuce and chicory
cultivator. II. pp. 3-13. In M. R. Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic
and nontoxic organic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ., Inc. Ann
Arbor, Michigan.

Dekkers, W. A. and F. Barbera. 1977. Effect of aggregate size on leaching
of herbicides in soil columns. Water Research 17:315-39.

Delahay, P., M. Pourbaix, and P. Van Rysselberghe. 1952. Diagrammes
d'equilibre potential-pH de quelques elements.  Compt. Rend., Reunion
Comite Thermodynam. Cinet Electtrochim 1951:15-29.

Delwiche, C. C., C. M. Johnson, and H. M. Reisenauer. 1961. Influence of
cobalt on nitrogen fixation by Medicago. Plant Physiol. 36:73-78.

DeMarco, J., J. Jurbiel, J. M. Symons, and G. G. Robeck. 1967.  Influence of
environmental factors on the nitrogen cycle in water. J. Am. Water Works.
Assn. 59(2):580-592.

Deuel, L. E. and A. R. Swoboda. 1972. Arsenic solubility in a reduced
environment. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Pro. 36:276-278.
                                     333

-------
 Dibble,  J.  T.  and R.  Bartha.  1979.  Effect of environmental parameters on
 biodegradation of oil.sludge.  Applied Environ.  Microbiol.  37:729-738.

 Dijkshoorn,  W.,  L. W.  van Broekhoven, and J. E. M.  Lampe.  1979.  Phytoxicity
 of zinc,  nickel,  cadmium, lead,  copper,  and chromium in three  pasture plant
 species.  Neth.  J. Agric. Sci.   27:241-253.

 dos Santos,  A.  B., C.  Viera, E.  G.  Loures,  J. M.  Braga, and J.  T.  L.
 Thiebalt. 1979.  The response at  Phaseolus vulgaris  beans to molybdenum and
 cobalt in soils  from Vicosa dn Paula Candido, Minas Gerias. Revista Ceres
 26(143):92-101.

 Dotson,  G. K.,  R.  B. Dean, B.  A.  Kenner,  and W. B.  Cooke.  1971.   Land-
 spreading, a conserving  and non-polluting method of disposing  of oily
 wastes.  Proc.  of  the 5th Int.  Water Pollution Conference Vol.  1, Sec. II.
 36/1-36/15.

 Dowdy, R. H.,  R.  E. Larson, and  E.  Epstein. 1976. Sewage sludge  and
 effluent  use in agriculture, ^n  Land application of waste  materials.  Soil
 Conservation Society of  America.  Ankeny,  Iowa.

 Downing, A.  L., H.  A.  Painter, and  C.  Knowles.  1964.  Nitrification in the
 activated sludge  process. Journal and Proc. of  the  Inst. of Sewage
 Purification,  Part 2.

 Dyksen, J. E.  and  A. F.  Hess,  III.  1982.  Alternatives for  controlling
 organics  in  groundwater  supplies.   J.  Amer.  Water Works Assoc.  74(8):394-
 403.

 Dutt, G. R., R. W.  Terkeltouk, and  R.  S.  Rauschkolb.  1972.  Prediction of
 gypsum and leaching requirements  for sodium-affected soils.  Soil Science
 114(2):93-103.

 Eaton, F. M. 1942.  Toxicity and  accumulation of chloride and sulfate  salts
 in  plants. J. Agr. Res.  64:357-359.

 Eaton, F. M. 1966.  Chlorine, pp.  98-135.  Ill H.  D. Chapman  (ed.)  Diagnostic
 criteria for plants and  soils.  University  of California,  Riverside.

 Edwards, C. A. 1973. Persistent pesticides  in the environment. Critical
 Reviews in Environmental Control, Vol. 1, No. 1. CRC  Press,  Cleveland,
 Ohio.

Edwards, J.  H., B. D. Morton, and H.  C. Kirkpatrick.  1976.  Aluminum
 toxicity symptoms  in peach seedlings.  J.  Am. Soc. Hort.  Sci. 101:139-142.

Ehinger, L.  H. and G. R. Parker.  1979. Tolerance of Andopogon scoparius to
copper and zinc. New Phytologist  83:175-180.

El-Bergearmi, M. M. 1973. Attempts  to  quantitate the  protective  effect of
Se against mercury toxicity using Japanese  quail. Fed.  Proc. 32:886.
                                     334

-------
Embleton, T. W., W. W. Jones, and R. G. Platt. 1978. Tissue and soil
analyses as an index of yield. University of California. Riverside,
California.

Emmerich, W. E., L. J. Jund, A. L. Page, and A. C. Chang. 1982. Movement of
heavy metals in sewage sludge-treated soils. J. Environ. Qual. 11:174-181.

Enterline, P. E. 1974. Respiratory cancer among chromate workers. J. Occup.
Med. 16:523-526.

EPA. 1976a. National Interim Primary Drinking Water Regulations. EPA
570/9-76-003.

EPA. 1976b. Study of the distribution and fate of polychlorinated biphenyls
and benzenes after a spill of transformer fluid. EPA No. 904-9-76-D14. U.S.
EPA. Washington, D.C.

EPA. 1980a. Subtitle C resource and conservation recovery act of 1976.
Listing of hazardous waste, background document for RCRA, section 261.31
and 261.32. Office of Solid Waste, Washington, D.C.

EPA. 1980b. Interim status standards for owners and operators of hazardous
waste treatment, storage, and disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol.
45, No. 98, pp. 33154-33259.

EPA. 1982. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities.  Federal Register Vol. 47, No. 143, pp. 32274-
32388.  July 26, 1982.

Ermolenko, N. F. 1972. Trace elements and colloids in soils. Jerusalem:
Israel Program for Scientific Translation. National Technical Information
Service. Washington, D.C.

Essington, E. H. and H. Nishita. 1966. Effect of chelates on the movement
of fission products through soil columns. Plant and Soil 24:1-23.

Estes, G. 0., W. E. Knoop, and F. D. Houghton. 1973. Soil-plant response to
surface applied mercury.  J. Environ. Qual. 2:451-452.

Evans, G. E. 1980. The mobility of water soluble organic compounds in soils
from the land application of petroleum waste sludge. M.S. Thesis. Texas A&M
University. College Station, Texas.

Farmer, W. J., M. Yang, J. Letey, and W. F. Spencer. 1980. Land disposal of
hexachlorobenzene wastes: controlling vapor movement in soil. EPA/600-7-80-
119. U.S. EPA. Cincinnati, Ohio.

Fedorak, P. M. and D. W. S. Westlake. 1981. Degradation of aromatics and
saturates in crude oil by soil enrichments. Water, Air and Soil Pollution,
16:367-375.
                                     335

-------
Filonow, A. B., L. W. Jacobs, and M. M. Mortland.  1976. Fate of polybromi-
nated biphenyls (PBB's) in soils. Retention of hexabromobiphenyl in four
Michigan soils. J. Agric. Food. Chem. 24(6):1201-1204.

Findenegg, G. R, and E. Havnold. 1972. Uptake of mercury by spring wheat
from different soils. Bodenkultur (Austria) 23:252-255.

Fishbein, L.  1978. Sources of synthetic mutagens.  p. 257-348. _In_W. G.
Flamm and M.  A. Mehlman (ed.) Advances in modern toxicology. Mutagenesis
Vol. 5.

Fleming, A. L., J, W. Schwartz, and C. D. Foy. 1974. Chemical factors
controlling the adaptation of weeping lovegrass and tall fescue to acid
mine spoils.  Agron. J. 6(6}:715-19.

Flint, R. F.  and B. J. Skinner. 1977. Physical Geology. 2nd ed. John Wiley
and Sons, New York. 679 p.

Florence, T.  M. 1977. Trace metal species in fresh waters. Water Res.
11:681-687.

Foroughi, M., G. Hoffman, K. Teicher, afld F. Venter. 1976. The effect of
increasing levels of cadmium, chromium, and nickel on tomatoes in nutrient
solution. Stand and Leistung Agrikulturchemischer  und Agrar biologischer
Forschung XXX. Kongressband (1975) Landwlrt schastlicke Forschung.
Sonderhest 32(l):37-48.

Fox, R. H. 1968. The effect of calcium and pH on boron uptake from high
concentrations of boron by cotton and alfalfa. Soil Sci. 106:435-439.

Franco, A. A. and J. Dobereiner. 1971. Effect of Mn toxicity on soybean
Rhizobium symbiosis in an acid soil. Pesquisa Agropecuaria Brasileria
6:57-66.

Franklin, W.  X. Unpublished information.

Friberg, L., M. Plscator, G. Nordberg, and T. Kjellstrom. 1974. Cadmium in
the environment. 2nd Ed. CRC Press, Cleveland, OH.

Frost, D. V.  1967. Arsenicals in biology—retrospect and prospect. Fed.
Proc. 26(1):194-208.

Fuhr, F. and W. Mittelstaedt. 1981. The behavior of methabenzthiazuron in
soil and plants after application of methabenzthiazuron [Benzene Ring-U-
1 C] on spring wheat under field conditions during the year of
application and subsequent cultivation, pp. 125-134. In H. R. Overcash
(ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic organic  compounds in soils. Ann
Arbor Sci.  Publ.,  Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Fujimoto, G.  and G. D. Sherman. 1950. Cobalt content of typical soils and
plants of the Hawaiian Islands. Agron. J. 42:577-581.
                                    336

-------
Fuller, W. H. 1977. Movement of selected metals, asbestos and cyanide in
soil: applications to waste disposal problems. EPA 600/2-77-020. PB
266-905.

Furr, A. K. , A. W. Lawrence, S. C. Tong, M. C. Grandolfo, R. A. Hofstader,
C. A. Bache, W. H. Gutenmann, and D. J. Lisk. 1976. Multi-element and
chlorinated hydrocarbon analyses of municipal sewage sludges of American
cities. Envir. Sci. Technol. 10:683-687.

Furr, A. K. , T. F. Parkinson, R. A. Hinrichs , D. R. VanCampen, G. A. Bache,
W. H. Gutenmann, L. E. St John, I. S. Pakkala, and D. J. Lisk. 1977.
National Survey of elements and radioactivity in fly ashes. Environ. Sci.
Technol. 11:1194-1201

Furukawa K. and F. Matsumura. 1976. Microbial metabolism of polychlorinated
biphenyls. J. Agric. Food. Chem. 24(2) :251-256.

Gall, 0. E. 1936. Zinc sulfate studies in the soil. Citrus Ind.
Gamble, A. W. and D. W. Fisher. 1964. Occurrence of sulfate and nitrate in
rainfall. J. Geophysical Res. 69(20) :4203-4210.

Gemmell, R. P. 1972. Use of waste materials for revegetation of chromate
smelter waste. Nature (London) 240:569-571.

Getty, S. M. , D. E. Rickett, and A.  L. Trapp.  1977. Polybrominated biphenyl
(PBB) toxicosis: an environmental accident. CRC Critical Reviews in
Environmental Control. 7(4): 309-323.

Ghosh, B. P. and R. H. Burris. 1950. Utilization of nitrogenous compounds
by plants. Soil Science 70(3): 187-203.

Giashuddin, M. and A. H. Cornfield.  1978. Incubation study on effects of
adding varying levels of nickel on nitrogen and carbon mineralization in
soil. Environ. Poll. 15:231-234.

Gilpin, L. and A. H. Johnson. 1980.  Fluorine in agricultural soils of
southeastern Pennsylvania. Soil Sci. Soc. Am.  J. 44(2):255-258.

Giordano, P. M. and D. A. Mays. 1977. Effect of land disposal applications
of municipal wastes on crop yields and heavy metal uptake. National
Fertilizer Development Center, Tennessee Valley Authority. Muscle Shoals,
Alabama. EPA 600/12-77-014. PB 266-649/3BE.

Goldschmidt. V. M. 1954. Geochemistry. Clairdon Press, Oxford, United
Kingdom.

Goodman, G. T. and R. P. Gemmell. 1978. The maintenance of grassland on
smelter wastes in the lower Swansee  Valley II. Copper smelter waste. J.
Appl. Ecol. 15:875-883.
                                     337

-------
 Goml,  K.  and  T.  Oyagi.  1972.  Manganese nutrition of  vegetable crops.
 Bulletin,  Faculty  of Agriculture,  Miyazaki  University 19:493-503.

 Goring, C.  A., D.  A. Laskowski,  J. W.  Hamaker,  and R.  W. Meikle.  1975.
 Principles  of pesticide degradation  in soil.  p.  135-172. Jin R.  Hague  and V.
 H.  Freed  (eds.)  Environmental dynamics of pesticides.  Plenum Press, New
 York.

 Gracey, H.  I. and  J. W. B.  Stewart.  1977. The fate of applied mercury in
 soil.  pp.  97-103.  In Proc.  Int.  Conf.  Land  for  Waste Management,  Ottawa,
 Can.  1973.  Dept. Environ./Nat. Research Council.

 Gray,  R. A. and  G. K. Joo.  1978. Site  of uptake  and  action  of thiocarbonate
 herbicides  and herbicide antidotes in  corn  seedlings,  pp. 67-84.  In F.  M.
 Pallos and  J. E. Casidia (eds.)  Chemistry and Action of Herbicide Anti-
 dotes. Academic  Press, New  York.

 Griffin, R. A. and E. S. K. Chian. 1980. Attenuation of water-soluble
 polychlorinated  biphenyls by  earth materials. EPA No.  600/2-80-027. U.S.
 EPA.  Cincinnati, Ohio.

 Griffin, R. A. and S. F. J. Chou.  1982.  Attenuation  of polybrominated
 biphenyls and hexachlorobenzene  by earth materials.  U.S. EPA.  Cincinnati,
 Ohio.  PB 82-107558.

 Griffin, R. A. and N. F. Shimp.  1978.  Attenuation of pollutant in municipal
 landfill leachate  by clay minerals.  EPA 600/2-78-157.  PB 287-140.

 Groenewegen,  D.  and H. Stolp.  1981.  Microbial breakdown of  polycyclic aro-
 matic  hydrocarbons, pp. 233-240. In  M.  R. Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of
 toxic  and nontoxic organic  compounds in  soils. Ann Arbor Science  Publ.,
 Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

 Guenzi, W.  D., W.  E. Beard, R. A. Bowman, and S.  R.  Olsen.  1981.  Plant
 uptake and growth  responses from p-chlorophenyl methyl sulfide,—sulfoxide,
 and—sulf one  in  soil. J. of Env. Quality 1.0(4): 532-536.

 Gudin, C. and W. J. Syratt. 1975. Biological  aspects of land rehabilitation
 following hydrocarbon contamination. Environ. Poll.  8(2):107-112.

 Gupta, I. C.  1974. Lithium  tolerance of  wheat, barley, rice,  and  grain at
 germination and seedling stage.  Indian J. Agr. Res.  8:103-107.

 Gupta, I. C., S. V. Singh, and G. P. Bhargava.  1974.  Distribution of
 lithium in some salt affected soil profiles.  J.  Indian Soc.  Soil  Sci.
 22:88-89.

Gupta, U. C.  1979. Copper in  agricultural crops,  pp.  255-288.  In  J. 0.
Nriagv (ed.) Copper in the environment.  John  Wiley and Sons,  Inc.  New
York.
                                     338

-------
Gutenmann, W. H., I. S. Pakkala, D. J. Churey, W. C. Kelly, and D. J. Lisk.
1979. Arsenic, boron, molybdenum and selenium in successive cuttings of
forage crops field grown on fly ash amended soil. J. Agric. Food Chem.
27:1393-1395.

Haghiri, F. 1974. Plant uptake of cadmium as influenced by cation exchange
capacity, organic matter, zinc and soil temperature. J. Environ. Qual.
3:180-183.

Haghiri, F. and F. L. Himes. 1974. Removal of radiostrontium by leaching
runoff and plant uptake as influenced by soil and crop management
practices. Dept. of Agronomy, Ohio Agricultural Research and Development
Center. Wooster, Ohio. Bull. 1072, 1453.

Halter, M. 1980. Selenium toxicity to Daphnia magna, Hyallea azteca amd
fathead minnow in hard water. Bull. Environ. Contain. Toxicol 24:102.

Haider, K., G. Jagnow, R. Kohnen, and S. U. Lira. 1981. Degradation of
chlorinated benzenes, phenols, and cyclohexane derivatives by benzene  and
phenol-utilizing soil bacteria under aerobic conditions. XXIII. pp.
207-223. In M. R. Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic
organic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Haider, K. and J. P. Martin. 1975. Decomposition of specifically  carbon-14
labelled benzoic and cinnamic acid derivatives in soil. Soil Sci.  Soc. Am.
Proc. 39(4):657-662.

Kara, T., Y.  Sonada, and I. lawi.  1976. Growth response of cabbage plants
to transitional elements under water culture conditions. II. Cobalt,
nickel, copper, zinc, and molybdenum. Soil Sci.  Plant  Nutr. 22:317-325.

Kara, T., Y.  Sonoda, and I. lawi.  1977. Growth response of cabbage plants
to arsenic and antimony under water culture conditions. Soil Sci.  Plant
Nutr. 23(2):253-255.

Hart, R. H.  1974. Crop selection  and management. Iii Factors involved in
land application of  agricultural  and municipal wastes. Agr. Res.  Ser.,
USDA. Washington, D.C.

Hassett, J.  J., J.  E. Miller, and D.  E. Koepe.  1976.  Interaction of lead
and cadmium  on maize root growth  and uptake of  lead and cadmium by roots.
Environ. Poll.  11(4):297-302.

Heath,  M.  E., D.  S.  Metcalfe, and R.  F. Barnes.  1978.  Forages:  the science
of grassland agriculture  (3rd ed.).  Iowa  State  Univ.  Press, Ames, Iowa.
755 p.

Helling,  C.  S.  1971. Pesticide  mobility in soil III.  Influence of soil
properties.  Soil  Sci.  Soc.  Am.  Proc.  35(5):743-748.
                                     339

-------
 Helyar,  K.  R.  1978.  Effects  of  aluminum and manganese toxicities  on legume
 growth,  pp.  207-231.  Mineral nutrition of  legumes  in tropical  and
 subtropical  soils.   Proc.  of a  workshop held at  CS1RO.  Cunningham Lab.
 Brisbane, Australia.

 Hernberg, S.  1977. Cancer  and metal  exposure,  pp.  147-157.  In  H.  H. Hiatt,
 J.  D.  Watson,  and J.  A.  Winston (eds.) Origins of  human cancer. Book A.
 Incidence of  cancer  in humans.  Cold  Spring Harbor  Laboratory.

 Hess,  R. E. and  R. W. Blanchar.  1977.  Arsenic  determination and As, Pb and
 Cu  content of  Missouri soils. Research Bulletin  No.  1020 University of
 Missouri.

 Hewitt,  E. J.  1953.  Metal  interrelationships in  plant nutrition.  I. Effects
 of  some  metal  toxicities on  sugar  beet,  tomato,  oat,  potato, and  marrowstern
 kale grown in  sand culture.  J.  Exptl.  Botany (London) 4:59-64.

 Hill-Cottingham,  P.  G. and C. P. Lloyd-Jones.  1965.  The behavior  of iron
 chelating agents  with plants. J. Exp.  Botany 16:233-242.

 Hinesly, T. D., R. L. Jones,  and E.  L.  Ziegler.  1972.  Effects  on  corn by
 applications of heated anaerobically digested  sludge.  Compost  Sci.
 13(4):26-30.

 Hinesly, T. D., K. E. Redborg,  E.  L. Ziegler,  and  J.  D.  Alexander.  1982.
 Effect of soil cation exchange  capacity  on the uptake of cadmium  by corn.
 Soil Sci. Am. J.  46:490-497.

 Hock, W. K., L. R. Schreiber, and  B. R.  Roberts. 1970.  Factors affecting
 uptake concentration  and persistence of  benomyl  in american elm seedlings.
 Phytopathology 60(11):1619-1622.

 Hodgson, J. P., W. L. Lindsay,  and J.  F. Trierweiler.  1966.  Micronutrient
 cation complexing in  soil  solution II.  Soil  Sci. Soc. Am. Proc.
 30:723-726.

 Horak, 0. 1979. Investigations  on  lead uptake  by plants.  Bodenkultur
 30:120-126.

 Hsu, Pa Ho. 1977. Aluminum hydroxides  and  oxyhydroxides,  pp. 99-143. li± J.
 B. Dixon and S. B. Weed  (eds.) Minerals  in the soil  environment.  Soil Sci.
 Soc. Amer., Madison, Wis.

Huddleston, R. L. 1979.  Solid-waste  disposal:  landfarming.  Chemical
Engineering, Feb. 26. pp.  119-124.

Huddleston,  R. L. and R. C. Allred.  1967.  Surface-active  agents:  biodegrad-
ability of detergents, pp. 343-370.  In A.  D. McLaren  and  G.  H. Peterson
 (eds.) Soil Biochemistry, Vol.  1.  Marcel Dekker, Inc. New York, New York.

Humphrey, A. E. 1967. A  critical review of hydrocarbon  fermentations and
their industrial utilization. Biotech. Bioeng. 9:3-24.

                                     340

-------
Hunter, J. V. and T. H. Kotalik. 1976. Chemical and biological quality of
treated sewage effluents, pp. 6-25. JEn W. E. Sopper and L. T. Kardos (eds.)
Recycling treated municipal wastewater and sludge through forest and
cropland. Penn. State Univ. Press, Univ. Park, Pennsylvania.

Hunter, J. G. and 0. Vergnano. 1953. Trace element toxicities in oat
plants. Anal. Appl. Biol. 40:761-777.

Hurd-Karrer, A. M. 1950. Comparative fluorine uptake by plants in turned
and unturned soil. Soil Sci. 70:153-159.

Hutchinson, F. E. and A. S. Hunter. 1970. Exchangeable Al levels in two
soils as related to lime treatment and growth of six crop species. Agron.
J. 62:702-04.

Button, E. M., W. T. Williams, and C. S. Andrews. 1978. Differential
tolerance to manganese introduced and breed lines of Macroptilium
atropurpureum. Aust. J. Agric. Res. 29:67-79.

Button, J. T. 1977. Titanium and zirconium minerals, pp. 673-688. In J. B.
Dixon and S. B. Weed (eds.) Minerals in soil environments. Soil Sci. Soc.
Am. Madison, Wisconsin.

Irukayama, K. 1966. The pollution of Minamata Bay and Minamata disease.
Third International Conference on Water Pollution Research. Section 3,
Paper 8. 13 p.

Ito, B. and K. limura. 1976. Absorption of zinc and cadmium by rice plants,
and their influence on plant growth 1. Effect of zinc. J. Sci. Soil Manure.
Japan. 47(2):21-24.

Iwata, Y., W. E. Westlake, and F. A. Gunther. 1973. Varying persistence of
polychlorinated biphenyls in six California soils under laboratory
conditions. Bull. Environ. Contain, and Toxicol. 9:204.

Jacobs, L. W., S. F. J. Chou, and J. M. Tiedje. 1976. Fate of polybromi-
nated biphenyls (PBBs) in soils:  persistence and plant uptake. J.  Agric.
Food Chem. 24:1198-1201.

Jacobs, L. W. and D. R. Keeney. 1970. Arsenic-phosphorus interactions of
corn. Commun. Soil Sci. PI. Analysis 1:85-93.

Jacobs, L. W., J. K. Syers, and D. R. Keeney. 1970. Arsenic adsorption by
soils. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 34:750-753.

Jain, V. K. 1978. Studies on the effects of cadmium on the growth pattern
of Phaseolus aureus varieties. Journal of the Indian Botanical Society
57(Suppl.):84.

Jensen, V. 1975. Bacterial flora of soil after application of oily waste.
OIkos 26(2):152-158.
                                     341

-------
Jobson, A., M. Mclaughlin, F. D. Cook, and D. W. S. Westlake.  1974. Effects
of amendments on the microbial utilization of oil applied to soil. Applied
Microbiology 27(1):166-171.

Joham, H. E. 1953. Accumulation and distribution of molybdenum in the
cotton plant. Plant Physiol. 28:275-280.

John, M. K. 1974. Wastewater renovation through soil percolation. Water,
Air, and Soil Pollution 3:3-10.

John, M. K. 1977. Varietal response to lead by lettuce. Water, Air, and
Soil Pollution. 8(2):133-144.

Jonasson, I. R. and R. W. Boyle. 1971. Geochemistry of mercury, pp. 5-21.
Jin Mercury in man's environment. Proc. Roy. Soc. Can. Symp., Ottawa,
Canada. February 15, 1971.

Jones, J. P. and R. L. Fox. 1978. Phosphorus nutrition of plants influenced
by manganese and aluminum uptake from an Oxisol. Soil. Sci.
126(4):230-236.

Jones, L. H. P. 1957. The solubility of molybdenum in simplified systems
and aqueous soil suspensions. J. Soil Sci. 8:313-327.

Jones, L. P. H., C. R. Clement, and M. J. Hopper. 1973. Lead uptake from
solution by perennial ryegrass and its transport from roots to shoots.
Plant and Soil 38:403-414.

Kamada, K. and K. Doki. 1977. Movement of Cr in submerged soil and growth
of rice plants. 2. Effect of two different soils and the addition of Fe
(II) on injury caused by Cr (IV).  J. Sci. Soil Manure. (Japan).
48(ll-12):457-465.

Karataglis, S. S. 1978. Studies on heavy metal tolerance in populations of
Anthoxanthum odoratum. Berichte der Deutclien Botanischen Gesellschaft
91:205-216.

Kardos, L. T., W. E. Sopper, E. A. Meyers, R. R. Parizek, and  J. B.
Nesbitt.  1974. Renovation of secondary effluent for use as a  water
resource. EPA 660/2-74-016. PB 234-176/6BA.

Karickoff, S. W., D. S. Brown, and T. A. Scott. 1979. Sorption of hydro-
phobic pollutants on natural sediments. Water Res. 13:241-248.

Kearney, P. C. 1967. Influence of physiochemical properties of
biodegradability of phenylcarbonate herbicides. J. Agr. Food Chem.
15:568-571.

Keaton, C. M. and L. T. Kardos. 1940. Oxidation-reduction potentials of
arsenate-arsenite systems in sand and soil medium. Soil Sci. 50:189-207.
                                     342

-------
Keefer, F. F., R. N. Singh, D. J. Horvath, and A. R. Khawaja. 1979. Heavy
metal availability to plants from sludge application. Compost Sci./Land
Utilization (May/June 1979).  p. 31-34.

Kelling, K. A., D. R. Keeney, L. M. Walsh, and J. A. Ryan. 1977. A field
study of the  agricultural use of sewage sludge. III. Effect on uptake and
extractability of sludge borne metals. J. Environ. Qual. 4(6):352-358.

Kelly, J. M., G. R. Parker, and W. W. McFee. 1979. Heavy metal accumulation
and growth of seedlings of five forest species as influenced by soil
cadmium level. J. Environ. Qual. 8(3):361-364.

Kensuke, F.,  K. Tonomura, and A. Kamebayashi. 1978. Effect of chlorine sub-
stitution on  the biodgradability of polychlorinated biphenyls. Applied
Environ. Microblol. 35:223-227.

Kerndorff, H. and M. Schnitzer. 1980. Sorption of metals on humic acid.
Geochimica at Cosmo Chimica Acta 44:1701-1708.

Kerridge, P.  C., M. D. Dawson, and D. P. Moore. 1971. Separation of degrees
of tolerance  in wheat. Agro. J. 63(4):586-591.

Keser, M., B. F. Neubauer, and F. E. Hutchinson. 1975. Influence of
aluminum ions on developmental morphology of sugarbeet roots. Agr. J.
67(1):84-88.

Keul, M., R.  Andrei, G. Lazar-Keul, and R. Vintila. 1979. Accumulation and
effect of lead and cadmium on wheat (Triticum vulgare) and maize (Zea
mays). Studii si Cercetari de Biologie, Biologie Vegetala 31(1) '.W^.

Khaleel, R.,  K. R. Reddy, and M. R. Overcash. 1980. Transport of potential
pollutants in runoff water from land areas receiving animal waste: a
review. Water Res. 14:421-436.

Kiigemagi, U., H. E. Morrison, J. E. Roberts, and W. B. Bollen. 1958.
Biological and chemical studies on the decline of soil insecticides. J.
Econ. Entomology 51:198-204.

Kincannon, C. B. 1972. Oily waste disposal by soil cultivation  process.
EPA-R2-72-110, Washington, D.C.

King. L. D. 1981. Swine manure lagoon sludge and municipal sewage sludge on
growth, nitrogen recovery and heavy metal content of fescuegrass. J.
Environ. Qual. 10:465-472.

Kirkham, M. B. 1979. Trace elements, pp. 571-575. In R. W. Fairbridge and
C. W. Finkl,  Jr. (eds). The encyclopedia of soil science. I. Dowden,
Hutchinson, and Ross, Inc. Stroudsburg, Pennsylvania.

Kishk, F. M.  and M. N. Hassan. 1973. Sorption and desorption of copper by
and from clay minerals. Plant and Soil 39:497-505.
                                     343

-------
 Kissel, D.  E.,  S. J.  Smith, W. L.  Hargrove, and  D. W.  Dillow.  1977.
 Immobilization  of fertilizer nitrate applied  to  a swelling  clay  soil  in  the
 field. Soil  Sci. Soc. Am. J. Vol.  41:346-349.

 Klausner, S. D., P. J.  Zwerman,  and D.  R.  Coote. 1976. Design  parameters
 for the land application of dairy  manure.  Environmental Research
 Laboratory,  Office of Research and Development,  U.S. EPA, Athens,  Georgia.
 EPA-600/2-76-187.

 Klein, H., V. E. Jensch, and H.  J. lager.  1979.  Heavy metal uptake by maize
 plants from  soil contaminated with zinc, cadmium and copper oxide.
 Angewandte Botanik 53:19-30.

 Klimashevsky, E. L., Y. A. Markova, M.  L.  Bernatzkaya, and  A.  S. Malysheva.
 1972. Physiological responses to aluminum  toxicity in  the root zone of pea
 varieties. Agrochimia 16:487-96.

 Kloke, A. and H. D. Schenke. 1979. The  influence of cadmium in soil on
 the yield of various plant species and  their  cadmium content.  Zeitshrift
 fur Pflanzenernahrung und Bodenkunde 142(2):131-136.

 Kloskowski, R., I. Scheunert, W. Klein, and F. Korte.  1981.  Laboratory
 screening of distribution, conversion,  and mineralization of chemicals in
 the soil-plant-system and comparison to outdoor  experimental data.
 Chemosphere  10(10):1089-1100.

 Knowles, F.  1945. The poisoning  of plants  by  zinc. Agri. Prog.   20:16-19.

 Kolosov, I.  I.  1962. Absorptive  activity of root systems of plants. English
 translation by  Indian Scientific Documentation Centre, New  Delhi,  India.

 Konstantinov, G., D. Kovachev, A.  Penchev, I. Ermolaev, and M. Mirchev.
 1974. Effect of fertilizer application  on  137-cesium accumulation  in
 lucerne grown on a leached chernozem. Pochvoznanie: Agrokhimiya  9:34-38.

 Kornegay, E. T., J. D. Hedges, D.  C. Martens, and C. Y. Kramer.  1976.
 Effect of soil  and plant mineral levels following application  of manures of
 different copper contents. Plant and Soil  45:151-162.

 Korte, N. E., J. Skogg, E. E. Niebla, and W.  H.  Fuller. 1975. A  baseline
 study on tract metal elution from  diverse  soil types. Water, Air and  Soil
 Pollution 5:149-156.

 Kortkikh, T. A. and A. D. Repnikov. 1976.  Enrichment of red clover hay with
 cobalt applied at different rate and by different methods.  Trudy,  Permskiy
 Sel'skokhozyaistvennyi Institue  120:25-29.

Kovda, V. A., B. N. Zolotareva, and I.  T.  Skripnichenko. 1979. The
biological reaction of plants to heavy metals in the substrate.  Doklady
Akademii Nauk SSSR 247(3):766-768.
                                    344

-------
Krauskopf, K. B. 1972. Geochemistry of mlcroutrients. pp. 7-40. In
Mlcronutrients in agriculture. Soil Sci. Soc. Am.

Kubota, J. 1977. Molybdenum status of U.S. soils and plants, pp. 557-579.
l£ W. R. Chappell and K. K. Peterson (eds.) Molybdenum in the environment.
Vol 2. Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York.

Kubota, J., V. A. Lazar, and K. C. Beeson. 1960. The study of cobalt status
of soils in Arkansas and Louisiana, using the black gum as the indicator
plant. Soil Sci. Am. Proc. 24:527-528.

Kubota, J., E. R. Lemon, and W. H. Allaway. 1963. The effect of soil
moisture upon uptake of molybdenum, copper and cobalt by alsike clover.
Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 27:679-683.

Labanauskas, C. K. 1966. Manganese, pp. 264-285. lr± H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside, Division of Agricultural Sciences.

Lafond, A. and V. Laflamme. 1970. Relative concentrations of iron and
manganese: a factor affecting jack pine regeneration and black spruce
succession, pp. 305-312. JEn C. T. Youngberg and C. B. Davey (eds.) Proc.
Third N. Am. Forest Soils. Conf. North Carolina State U. Press.

Lagerwerff, J. V. 1972. Lead, mercury, cadmium as environmental
contaminants, pp. 593-636. In J. J. Mortvedt, P. M. Giordano and W. L.
Lindsay (eds.) Micronutrients in agriculture. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Madison,
Wisconsin.

Lagerwerff, J. V., G. T. Strickland, R. P. Milberg, and D. L. Brower.  1977.
Effects of incubation and liming on yield and heavy metal uptake by rye
from sewage sludged soil. J. Environ. Qual. 6(4):427-430.

Lamoreaux, R. J., R. C. Strickland, and W. R. Chaney. 1978. The plastochron
index as applied to a cadmium toxicity study. Environ. Poll.
16(4):311-317.

Land, E. and L. Johnson. 1979. Surface active agents, pp. 237-276. In
Synthetic Organic Chemicals. U.S. International Trade Commission
Publication No. 1001 U.S. Govt. Printing Office, Washington, D.C.

Lawrey, J. D. 1979. Boron, strontium, and barium accumulation in selected
plants and loss during leaf litter decomposition in areas influenced by
coal strip mining. Can. J. Bot. 57(8):933-940.

Lee, C. R. 1971. Influence of aluminum on plant growth and mineral
nutrition in potatoes. Agron. J. 63(4):604-608.

Lee, H. L. 1975. Trace elements in animal production, pp. 39-54. Ir± D. J.
D. Nicholas and A. R. Egam (eds.) Trace elements in soil-plant-animal
systems.  Academic Press, Inc., New York.
                                     345

-------
 Leeper,  G.  W.  1978.  Managing the heavy metals on the land.  Marcel  Dekker,
 Inc.,  New York.

 Lees,  H.  1951.  Isolation of  nitrifying organisms from soils.  Nature.
 167:(335).

 Letey, J.,  J.  F.  Osborn,  and N.  Valoras.  1975.  Soil  water  repellency  and
 the  use  of  non-ionic surfactants.  Contribution  No. 154,  California Water
 Research Center,  Riverside,  California.

 Lewis, T. E. and  F.  E.  Broadbent.  1961. Soil  organic matter complexes:   4.
 Nature and  properties of  exchange  sites.  Soil Sci. 91:341-8.

 Liebig,  G.  F.  1966.  Arsenic,  pp.  13-23. jLn_ H. D.  Chapman (ed.)  Diagnostic
 criteria  for plants  and soils.   University of California, Riverside.

 Lindsay, W. L.  1972.  Inorganic phase equilibria of micronutrients  in  soils.
 pp.  41-57.  In Micronutrients  in  Agriculture.  Soil Sci.  Soc. Am.

 Lindsay, W. L.  1979.  Chemical equilibria  in soils. John  Wiley and  Sons,  New
 York.  449 p.

 Link,  L. A. 1979. Critical pH for  the  expression of  manganese toxicity on
 burley tobacco and the  effect of liming on growth. Tobacco  International
 181:50-52.

 Lisk,  D. J. 1972. Trace metals in  soils,  plants, and animals. Adv.  Agron.
 24:267-325.

 Loehr, R. C., W.  J.  Jewell, J. D.  Novak,  W. W.  Clarkson, and  G.  S.
 Friedman. 1979a.  Land application  of wastes.  Vol. I.  Van Nostrand  Reinhold
 Co., New York. 308 p.

 Loehr, R. C., W.  J.  Jewell, J. D.  Novak,  W. W.  Clarkson, and  G.  S.
 Friedman. 1979b.  Land application  of wastes.  Vol. II. Van Nostrand  Reinhold
 Co., New York. 431 p.

 Lohris, M. P. 1960.  Effect of magnesium and calcium  supply  on the  uptake of
 manganese by various  crop plants.  Plant Soil  12:339-376.

 Lott,  W. L. 1938. The relation of  hydrogen ion  concentration  to  the
 availability of zinc  in soil. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 3:115-121.

 Lucls, 0. J., R.  Lucis, and K. Aterman. 1972. Tumorigenesis by cadmium.
 Oncology 26:53-67.

Lund,  L.  J., A. L. Page, and C. 0. Nelson. 1976. Nitrogen and phosphorus
levels in soils beneath sewage disposal ponds.  J. Environ.  Qual. 5:26-30.

Lundegardh,  H.  1927. The importance in the development of plants of the
quanitites of zinc and lead added  to the  soil from smoke gases. Meddel.
Centalanst.  Forsoksv. Jordbruksomsad (Sweden) 326:14.


                                     346

-------
Luzzati, A. 1981. The effects of surfactants on plants. III.  Field
experiments with potatoes, pp. 389-394. _In_ M. R. Overcash (ed.)
Decomposition of toxic and non toxic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Sci.
Publ. Co., Ann Arbor, Michigan 455 p.

Lyon, T. L. and J. A. Bizzell. 1934. A comparison of several legumes with
respect to nitrogen secretion. J. Am. Soc. Agron.  26:651-656.

Maclean, A. J. and A. J. Dekker. 1978. Availability of zinc, copper and
nickel to plants grown in sewage-treated soils. Can. J. Soil Sci.
58:381-389.

Maftoun, M. and B. Sheibany. 1979. Effect of fluorine content of irrigation
water on the growth of four plant species in relation to soil salinity.
Trop. Agr. 56(3):213-218.

Malaisse, F., J. Gregoire, R. R. Brooks, R. S. Morrison, and R. D. Reeves.
1978. Aeolanthus biformifolius:  a hyperaccumulator of copper. Science
199:887-888.

Malone, C. P., R. J. Miller, and D. E. Koeppe.  1978. Root growth in corn
and soybeans:  effects of cadmium and lead on lateral root initiation.
Canadian J. Botany 56:277-281.

Mancuso, T. F. 1970. Relation of duration of employment and prior
respiratory illness to respiratory cancer among beryllium workers. Environ.
Res. 3:251-275.

Marinucci, A. C. and R.  Bartha.  1979.  Biodegradation of 1,2,3- and  1,2,4-
trichlorobenzene in soil and liquid enrichment  culture. Applied  and
Environ. Microbiol. 38(5):811-817.

Martin, J. P. 1966a. Bromine, pp. 62-64. ^n H.  D.  Chapman  (ed.)  Diagnostic
criteria for  plants and  soils. Division of Agricultural Sciences,
University of California, Riverside.

Martin, J. P. 1966b. Iodine, pp. 200-202. In H.  D.  Chapman  (ed.)  Diagnostic
criteria for  plants and  soils. Division of Agricultural Sciences,
University of California, Riverside.

Martin, J. P. and K. Haider.  1976.  Decomposition of specifically carbon-
labelled ferulic acid  free  and linked  into model  humic acid  type polymers.
Soil Sci.  Soc. Am. Jour.  40(3):377-379.

Martin, J. P. and K. Haider.  1979.  Biodegradation of  ^C-labelled model
and  cornstalk lignins,  phenols,  model  phenolase humic  polymers and fungal
melanins as influenced by a readily available  carbon source  and  soil.
Applied and Environ. Microbiol.  38:(2):283-289.

Martin, J. P., G. K. Helmkomp,  and  J.  0.  Ervin. 1956.  Effect of  bromide
from a soil  fumigant and from CaBr2 on the  growth and chemical
composition of citrus  plants.  Soil  Sci.  Soc.  Am.  Proc. 20:209-212.


                                     347

-------
Martin, J. P., J. J. Richards, and P. F. Pratt. 1964. Relationship of
exchangeable Na percentage at different soil pH levels to hydraulic
conductivity. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 28:620-622.

Martin, R. P., P. Newbould, and R. S. Russell. 1958. Discrimination between
strontium and calcium in plant and soils. Radioisotope Sci. Res.
International Conference Proc. Paris, 1957. 4:173-190.

Mathers, A. C., B. A. Stewart, J. D. Thomas, and B. J. Blair.  1973. Effects
of cattle feedlot manures on crop yields and soil conditions.  Agr. Res.
Ser. USDA. Bushland, Texas. Tech. Report 11.

McCalla, T. M. and T. J. Army. 1961. Stubble mulch farming. Adv. Agron.
13:125-196.

McCaskey, T. A., G. H. Rollins, and J. A. Little. 1971. Water  quality of
runoff from grassland applied with liquid, semiliquid and dairy dry waste.
pp. 44-47. ln_ Livestock waste management and pollution abatement. ASAE
Proc. 271.

McKee, J. E. and H. W. Wolf. 1963. Water Quality Criteria. State Water
Quality Publication, No. 3-1. California.

McKenzie, R. M. 1975. The mineralogy and chemistry of soil cobalt, pp.
83-93. Li D. J. D. Nicholas and A. R. Egan (eds.) Trace Elements in
soil-plant-animal systems. Academic Press, Inc., New York.

McLaren, R. G. and D. V. Crawford. 1973. Studies on soil copper II. The
specific adsorption of copper by soils. J. Soil Sci. 24:443-452.

Medvedev, V. A. and V. D. Davidov. 1981. The transformation of various coke
industry products in chernozem soil. pp. 245-254. In M. R. Overcash (ed.)
Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic organic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor
Science Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Medvedev, V. A, V. D. Davidov, and S. G. Mavrodii. 1981. Decomposition of
high doses of phenol and indole by a chernozem soil. pp. 201-205. Ln M. R.
Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic organic compounds in
soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Meijer, C. and M. A. J. Goldewaagen. 1940. A case of zinc poisoning due to
galvanized from sheeting. Landbouwk. Tkidschr. 52:17-19.

Melsted, S. W. 1973. Soil-plant relationships p. 121-129. l£ Proc.
recycling municipal sludges and effluents on land. Proceedings from
conference in Champaign, Illinois. EPA, Washington, D.C.

Mengel, S. K. and E. A. Kirkby. 1978. Principles of plant nutrition.
International Potash Institute, Bern.
                                     348

-------
Metcalf, R., J. R. Sanborn, P. Lu, and D. Nye. 1975. Laboratory model
ecosystem studies of the degradation and fate of radiolabeled tri-, tetra-,
and penta-chlorobiphenyl compared to DDE. Archives of Environ. Contam. and
Toxicology. 3(2):151-165.

Miles, J. R. W., B. T. Bowman, and C. R. Harris. 1981. Adsorption,
desorption, soil mobility and aqueous persistence of fensulfothion and its
sulfide and sulfone metabolites. J. Env. Sci. Health B16(3):309-324.

Miles, L. J. and G. R. Parker. 1979. The effect of soil-added cadmium on
several plant species. J. Environ. Qual. 8(2):229-232.

Miller, J. E., J. J. Hassett, and D. E. Koeppe. 1976. Uptake of cadmium by
soybeans as influenced by soil cation exchange capacity, pH, and available
phosphorus. J. Environ. Qual. 5(2):157-160.

Miller, J. E., J. J. Hassett, and D. E. Koeppe. 1977. Interaction of lead
and cadmium on metal uptake and growth of corn plants. J. Environ. Qual.
6:18-20.

Millikan, C. R. 1938. A preliminary note on the relation of zinc to disease
in cereals. J. Dept. Agr. Victoria. 36:409-416.

Millikan, C. R. 1946. Zinc deficiency in flax. J. Dept. Agr. Victoria.
44:69-88.

Millman, A. P. 1957. Biogeochemical investigations in areas of copper-tin
mineralization in southwest England. Geochim. Commochim. Acta. 12:85-93.

Mills, H. A., A. V. Barker, and D. N. Maynard. 1974. Ammonia volatilization
from soil. Agron. J. 66:355-358.

Milner, J. E. 1969. The effect of ingested arsenic on methylcholanthre
induced skin tumors in mice. Arch. Environ. Health 18:7-11.

Minshall, N. E., S. A. Witzel, and M. S. Nichols. 1970. Stream enrichment
from farm operations. Am. Soc. Civil Eng. J.  Sanitary Eng. Div.
96(SA2):513-524.

Mistry, K. B. and B. M. Bhujbal.  1974. Effect of calcium and organic matter
addition on the uptake or radiostrontium and  radium  by plants from Indian
soils. Agrochemlca  18:173-183.

Mitchell, G. A., F. T. Bingham, and A. L. Page. 1978. Yield and metal
composition of lettuce and wheat  grown on soils amended with sewage sludge
enriched with cadmium, copper, nickel, and zinc. J.  Environ. Qual.
7(2):165-171.

Miyamoto, S. 1979.  Fundamentals of salt management:   recent development  and
challenges, pp. 181-202. In Proceedings of the interamerican conference  on
salinity and water management technology. Texas A&M  University Research
Center, El Paso, Texas. December  1979.


                                     349

-------
 Moeln,  G.  J.,  A.  J.  Smith,  Jr.,  and  P.  L.  Stewart.  1976.  Follow up  study  of
 distribution and  fate  of  PCB's and benzenes  in  soil  and groundwater samples
 after an  accidental  spill of  transformer  fluid,  pp.  368-372.  In Proceedings
 of  1976 National  Conference on Control  of  Hazardous  Material  Spills.
 Rockville, Maryland.

 Moore,  A.  W. 1966. Non-symbiotic nitrogen  fixation  in  soil  and  soil-plant
 systems.  Soils  and Fertilizers 29:113-128.

 Moore,  D.  P. 1972. Mechanisms of micronutrient  uptake  by  plants,  pp.
 171-198.  Iii J.  J. Mortvedt, P. M. Giordano and W. L. Lindsay  (eds.)
 Micronutrients  in agriculture. Soil  Sci.  Soc. Am., Madison, Wis.

 Morrill,  L. G., B. C.  Mahilum, and S. H. Mohluddin.  1982. Organic compounds
 in  soil:  sorptlon, degradation and persistence.  Ann  Arbor Science Publ.
 Inc. Ann  Arbor, Michigan.

 Morrison,  R. T. and R. N. Boyd.  1975. Organic chemistry.  Allyn  and  Bacon,
 Inc., Boston.

 Moucawi J., E.  Fustec, P. Jambu,  A.  Amblfs,  and  R. Jacquesy.  1981.
 Biooxidation of added  and natural hydrocarbons  in soils:  effects of  iron.
 Soil Biol. Biochem. 13:335-342.

 Moza, P.,  I. Weisgerber,  and W.  Klein.  1976. Fate of 2,2'-dichlorodiphenyl-
 l^C in  carrots, sugarbeets  and soil  under outdoor conditions. J.  Agric.
 Food Chem. 24(4):881-885.

 Moza, P.  N., I. Scheunert,  W. Klein, and F.  Korte.  1979.  Long-term  uptake
 of  lower  chlorinated biphenyls and their conversion  products  by spruce
 trees from soil treated with sewage  sludge.  Chemosphere 6:373-375.

 Mrozek, E. Jr., E. D.  Seneca and L.  L.  Hobbs. 1982.  Polychlorinated
 biphenyl  uptake and translation  by Spartina  Alterniflora  Loisel.  Water, Air
 and Soil  Pollution. 17:3-15.

 Mukherji,  S. and  B. K. Roy. 1977. Toxic effects  of chromium on  germinating
 seedlings and potato tuber  slices. Biochemie and Physiologic  der Pfanzen.
 171(3):235-238.

Mulder, E. G. 1954. Mo in relation to growth of  higher plants and
microorganisms. Plant  and Soil 5:368-415.

Murphy, L. S. and L. M. Walsh. 1972. Correction  of micronutrient
deficiencies with fertilizers, pp. 347-381.  In J. J. Mortvedt,  P. M.
Giordano  and W. L. Lindsay  (eds.) Micronutrients in  Agriculture.  Soil Sci.
 Soc. Am., Madison, Wis.

Murrmann, R. P. and F. R. Kountz. 1972. Role of  soil chemical processes in
reclamation of wastewater applied to land. pp. 48-74.  In  Wastewater
management by disposal on land.  Spec. Rept.  No.  171. U.S. Army  Cold Regions
Research and Engineering Lab, Hanover,  New Hampshire.

                                     350

-------
Nathwani, J. S. and C. R. Phillips. 1977. Adsorption-desorption of selected
hydrocarbons in crude oil on soils. Chemosphere 6(4):157-162.

Nathwani, J. S. and C. R. Phillips. 1978. Rates of leaching for radium from
contaminated soils: an experimental investigation of radium bearing soils
from Port Hope, Ontario. Water, Air and Soil Pollution 9:453-465.

National Academy of Sciences. 1980. Mineral tolerance of domestic animals.
By Subcommitte on Animal Nutrition, Board on Agriculture and Renewable
Resources. Commission on Natural Resources., National Research Council.
Washington, D.C.

National Academy of Sciences and National Academy of Engineering. 1972.
Water quality and criteria. A report of the Committee on Water Quality
Criteria, Environmental Studies Board. EPA R3-73-033. March, 1973.
PB 236-199/6BA.

National Research Council. 1973. Medical and biological effects of
environmental pollutants, manganese. National Academy of Sciences.
Washington, D.C. p. 1-191.

Newton, H. P. and S. J. Toth. 1952. Response of crop plants to I and Br.
Soil Sci. 72:127-134.

Nissen, P. 1974. Uptake mechanisms: inorganic and organic. Ann. Rev. of
Plant Physiology 25:53-79.

Nissen, T. V. 1981. Stability of PCB in the soil. VIII. pp. 79-87. In M.  R.
Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic organic compounds in
soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Nommik, H. 1965. Ammonium fixation and other reactions involving a
nonenzymatic immobilization of mineral nitrogen in soil. pp. 198-258. In
Soil Nitrogen. Am. Soc. Agron. Madison, Wisconsin.

Norseth, T. 1977. Industrial viewpoints on cancer caused by metals as an
occupational disease, pp. 159-167. Ill H. H. Hiatt, J. D. Watson, and J. A.
Winsten (eds.) Origins of human cancer. Book A. Incidence of cancer in
humans. Colo. Spring Harbor Laboratory.

O'Donovan. J. T. and W. H. Vanden Born. 1981. A microauto radiographic
study of l^C-labelled picloram distribution in soybean following
uptake. Canadian Jour, of Botany 59(19):1928-1931.

Olsen, S. R. 1972. Micronutrient interactions, p. 243-264. In
Micronutrients in agriculture Ed. Soil Sci. Soc. Amer. Inc., Madison,
Wisconsin.

Otsuka, K. and T. Morizaki. 1969. Aluminum and manganese toxicities of
plants. J. Sci. Soil and Manure (Japan) 40:250-254.
                                     351

-------
Overcash, M. R. and D. Pal. 1979. Design of land treatment systems for
Industrial wastes—theory and practice. Ann Arbor Science. Ann Arbor,
Michigan.

Page, A. L. 1974. Fate and effects of trace elements in sewage sludge when
applied to agricultural lands. National Environ. Res. Center. Cincinnati,
Ohio. EPA 670/2-74-005. PB 231-171/OBA.

Page, A. L., F. T. Bingham, and C. Nelson. 1972. Cadmium adsorption and
growth of various plant species as influenced by solution cadmium
concentration. J. Environ. Qual. 1:288-291.

Paivoke, A. 1979. The effects of lead and arsenate on the growth and acid
phosphatase activity of pea seedlings. Annales Botanici Fennici 16:18-27.

Patterson, J. B. E. 1971. Metal toxicities arising from industry, pp.
193-207. Jin Trace elements in soils and crops. Great Brit. Ministry of
Agric., Fisheries, and Food Tech. Bull. 21. Her Majesty's Stationery
Office, London.

Pearson, G. A. 1960. Tolerance of crops to exchangeable sodium. USDA
Agriculture Information Bulletin No. 216. Washington, D.C.

Perlstein, M. A. and R. Attala. 1966. Neurological sequelae of plumbism  in
children. Clin. Pediatr. 5:292.

Perry, H. M. and A. Yunice. 1965. Acute pressor effects of intraarterial
cadmium and mercuric ions in anesthesized rats. Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol. Med.
120:805.

Perry, J. J. and C. E. Cerniglia. 1973. Studies on the degradation of
petroleum hydrocarbons by filamentous fungi. In D. G. Ahearn and S. P.
Meyers (eds.) Microbial degradation of oil pollutants. Center for Wetland
Resources, Louisiana State University, Baton Rouge, Louisiana.

Peterson P. J. and B. J. Alloway. 1979. Cadmium in soils and vegetation.
pp. 45-92. In M. Webb (ed.) the chemistry, biochemistry and biology of
cadmium.  Elsevier/North Holland Biomedical Press. Amsterdam.

Peterson, P. J. and G. W. Butler. 1962. The uptake and assimilation of
selenite by higher plants. Aust. J. Biol. Sci.  15:126-146.

Peterson, P. J., M. A. S. Burton, M. Gregson, S. M. Nye, and E. K. Porter.
1976. Tin in plants and surface waters in Malaysian ecosystems. Trace
Subst. Environ. Health 10:123-132.

Petrilli, F. L. and S. DeFlora. 1977. Toxicity and mutagenicity of
hexavalent chromium on Salmonella typhimurium. Appl. Environ. Microbiol.
33:805-809.
                                     352

-------
Pinkerton, B. W. 1982. Plant accumulation of cobalt from soils with
artificially elevated cobalt levels. Ph.D. Dissertation. Texas A&M Univ.,
Univ. Microfilms. College Station, Texas.

Plewa, M. J. 1978. Activiation of chemicals into mutagens by green plants:
a preliminary discussion. Environ. Health Perspec. 27:45-50.

Plice, M. J. 1948. Some effects of crude petroleum on soil fertility. Soil
Science Soc. of Am. Proc. 13:413-416.

Pound, C. E. and R. W. Curtis. 1973. Characteristics of municipal
effluents,  pp. 49-61. In Recycling municipal sludges and effluents on
land. Nat. Assoc. State Univ. and Land Grant Colleges. Washington, D.C.

Pratt, P. F. 1966a. Aluminum, pp. 3-12. In H. D .Chapman (ed.) Diagnostic
criteria for plants and soils. University of California, Riverside.

Pratt, P. F. 1966b. Chromium, pp. 136-141. In. H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Pratt, P. F. 1966c. Titanium, pp. 448-449. l£ H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Pratt, P. F. 1966d. Vanadium, pp. 480-483. In H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Pratt, P. F. 1966e. Zirconium, pp. 400. Ir± H. D. Chapman, Diagnostic
criteria for plants and soils. University of California, Riverside.

Pratt, P. F., F. E. Broadbent, and J. P. Martin. 1973.  Using  organic wastes
as nitrogen fertilizers. Calif. Agr. 27(6):10-13.

Pratt, P. F. and S. Davis. Unpublished data. University of  California  and
USDA-ARS, Riverside,  California.

Prausse, A., K. Schmidt, and W. Bergmann. 1972.  Excess Mn  in Thuringian
acid soils and its effect on the yield and quality of  potatoes and spring
barley. Archiv fur Bodenfruchtbarkeit und Pflanzen produktion 16:483-494.

Purvis, D. and E. J.  MacKenzie. 1973. Effects of application  of municipal
compost on uptake of  copper, zinc, and boron by garden vegetables. Plant
and Soil 35:361-371.

Quimby, P. C., Jr., K. E. Frick, R.  D. Wauchope, and S. H.  Kay.  1979.
Effects of cadmium on two biocontrol insects and their host weeds. Bull.
Environ. Contam. Toxicol. 22(3):371-378.

Raghi-Atri, F.  1978.  Influence of heavy metals  in  the  substate on Glyceria
maxima. Blei Angewandte Botanik 52:185-192.


                                     353

-------
 Rains,  D. W., W.  E.  Schmid,  and R.  Epstein.  1964.  Adsorption of  cations by
 roots.  Effects of hydrogen ions and essential  role of  calcium. Plant
 Phsyiol. 39:274-278.

 Rauser, W. E. 1978.  Early effects of  phytotoxlc  burdens  of  cadmium, cobalt,
 nickel, and  zinc  in  white beans. Can.  J.  Bot.  56:1744-1749.

 Raymond, R.  L., J. P. Hudson,  and V. W. Jamison.  1976. Oil  degradation in
 soil. Applied Environ. Microbiol. 31(4) :522-535.

 Reddy, K. R., R.  Khaleel, M. R. Overcash,  and  P. W. Westerman. 1979.
 Phosphorous  - a potential nonpoint  source  pollution problem in the land
 areas receiving long-term application  of wastes. Iii Best management
 practices for agriculture and  silviculture. Ann  Arbor  Science, Inc.,  Ann
 Arbor, Michigan.

 Reeves, A. L. and A. J. Vorwald. 1967.  Beryllium carcinogeneais.  II.
 Pulmonary deposition and clearance  of  inhaled  beryllium  sulfate  in the rat.
 Cancer Res.  27:446-451.

 Rehab, F. I. and  A. Wallace. 1978a. Excess trace element effects  on cotton.
 2. Copper, zinc,  cobalt and manganese  in Yolo  loam soil. Comm. Soil Sci.
 Plant Anal.  9:519-527.

 Rehab, F. I. and  A. Wallace. 1978b. Excess trace metal effect on  cotton: 3.
 Chromium and lithium in solution culture.  Comm.  Soil Sci. Plant Anal.
 9:637-644.

 Rehab, F. I. and  A. Wallace. L978c. Excess trace metal effects on cotton:
 4. Chromium  and lithium In Yolo loam soil. Comm. Soil  Sci.  Plant  Anal.
 9:645-651.

 Rehab, F. I. and  A. Wallace. 1978d. Excess trace metal effects on cotton:
 5. Nickel and cadmium in solution culture. Comm.   Soil Sci.  Plant Anal.
 9:771-778.

 Rehab, F. I. and  A. Wallace. 1978e. Excess trace metal effects on cotton:
 6. Nickel and cadmium in Yolo  loam  soil. Comm. Soil Sci. Plant Anal.
 9:779-784.

Reimers, R.  S. and P. A. Krenkel. 1974. Sediment sorption phenomena.  CRC
 Critical Rev. Environ. Control 4:265.

Reisenauer, H. M. 1960. Cobalt in nitrogen fixation in a legume.  Nature
 186:375-376.

Reisenauer, H. M., A. A. Tabikh, and P. R. Stout.  1962.  Molybdenum
reactions with soils and the hydrous oxides of iron, aluminum and titanium.
 Soil Sci.  Soc.  Am. Proc. 26:23-27.
                                     354

-------
Rhodes, J. D. 1974. Drainage for salinity control. Ill J. Van Schilfgaarde
(ed.) Drainage for agriculture. ASA No. 17 Am. Soc. of Agron. Madison,
Wisconsin.

Richards, F. J. 1941. Physiological studies in plant nutrient.  Ann. Bot.
(N.S.) 5:263-296.

Rickles, E. L., N. G. Brink, F. R. Koniuszy, I. R. Wood, and K. Folkers.
1948. Crystalline vitamin B12. Science 107:396-397.

Roberts, P. V. and A. J. Valocchi. 1981. Principles of Organic Contaminant
Behavior During Artificial Recharge. The Science of the Total Environment
21:161-172.

Robinson, W. 0., H. W. Lakin, and L. E. Reichen. 1947. Zinc content of
plants on Friedensville zinc slime ponds in relation to biochemical
prospecting. Econ. Geol. 42:572-583.

Rolfe, G. T. and F. A. Bazzar. 1975. Effect of lead contamination on
transpiration and photosynthesis of loblolly pine and autumn olive. Forest
Sci. 21:33-35.

Romney, E. tt. and J. D. Childress. 1965. Effects of beryllium in plants and
soil. Soil Sci. 100:210-217.

Romney, E. M., A. Wallace, and G. V. Alexander. 1975. Response of bush bean
and barley to tin applied to soil and to solution culture. Plant and  Soil
42:585-589.

Ross, D. S., R. E. Sjogren, and R. J. Bartlett. 1981. Behavior of chromium
in soils:  IV Toxicity to microorganisms. J. Environ. Qual.  10:145-148.

Rouchaud, J. and J. A. Meyer. 1982. New trends in the studies about the
metabolism of pesticides in plants. Residue Reviews 82:1-35.

Rovira, A.-D. and C. B. Davey. 1971. Biology of the rhizosphere. l£ E. W.
Carson (ed.) The plant root and its environment. University  Press of  Vir-
ginia, Charlottesville, Virginia.

Rudolfs, W. (ed.). 1950. Review of literature on toxic materials affecting
sewage treatment processes, streams and B.O.D. determinations. Sew. Ind.
Wastes 22:1157-1191.

Russell, E. W. 1973. Soil conditions and plant growth,  10th  ed. Longman
Group Limited, London. 849 p.

Russell, R. S. and K. A. Smith. 1966. Naturally occurring  radioactive
substances: the uranium and thorium series. l£ R. S. Russell  and K. A.
Smith (eds.) Radioactivity and human diet.  Pergamon Press,  Oxford.
                                     355

-------
Russo, F. and E. Brennan. 1979. Phytotoxlcity and distribution of cadmium
in pin oak seedlings determined by mode of entry. Forest Science
25(2):328-332.

Ryan, J. A. and D. R. Keeney. 1975. Ammonia volatilization from surface
applied waste water sludge. J. Water Poll. Control Fed. 47:386-393.

Ryden, J. C. and P. F. Pratt. 1980. Phosphorus removal from wastewater
applied to land. Hilgardia 48:1-36.

Ryden, J. C. and J. K. Syers. 1975. Use of tephra for the removal of
dissolved inorganic phosphate from sewage effluent. New Zeal. J. Sci.
18:3-16.

Saito, Y. and K. Takahashi. 1975. Studies in heavy metal pollution in
agricultural land. 4. Cadmium adsorption and translocation in rice
seedlings as affected by the nutritional status and co-existence of the
other heavy metal. Bull. Shikoku Agr. Exp. Sta. No. 31:111-131.

Sauchelli, V. 1969. Trace elements in agriculture. Van Nostrand Reinhold
Co., New York. 248 p.

Sawhney, B. L. and D. E. Hill. 1975. Phosphate sorption characteristics of
soils treated with domestic waste water. J. Environ. Qual. 4:342-346.

Sax, N. I. 1979. Dangerous properties of industrial materials.  Van
Nostrand Reinhold Co., New York.

Schaeffer, C. C., A. M. Decker, and R. L. Chancy. 1975. Effects of soil
temperature and sludge application on the heavy metal content of corn.
Agron. Abstr. (In Press).

Schaeffer, C. C., A. M. Decker, R. L. Chaney, and L. W. Douglass. 1979.
Soil temperature and sewage sludge effects on metals in crop tissue and
soils. J. Environ. Qual. 8(4)-.455-459.

Scharpenseel. H. W., B. K. G. Theng and S. Stephan. 1978. Polychlorinated
biphenyls (1^C) in soils: adsorption, infiltration, translocation and
decomposition. Chapter 50. ^n_ W. E. Krumbein (ed.) Environmental biogeo-
chemistry and geomicrobiology, Vol. 2: The terrestrial environment. Ann
Arbor Science Publ. Inc., Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Schneider, P. W. 1976. The chemistry and biological nitrogen fixation, pp.
197-204. ^n H. Sigel (ed.) Metal ions in biological systems. John Wiley and
Sons, N.Y.

Schwendinger, R. B. 1968. Reclamation of soil contaminated with oil. J.
Institute Petrol. 54:182-192.

Scott, M. L. 1972. Trace elements in animal nutrient, pp. 555-592. Iti J, J.
Mortvedt, P. M. Giordano, and W. L. Lindsay (eds.) Micronutrients in
agriculture. Soil Scl. Soc. Am. Inc., Madison, Wisconsin.

                                     356

-------
Scott, H. D., D. C. Wolf, and T. L. Lavy. 1982. Apparent adsorption and
microbial degradation of phenol by soil. J. Env. Qual. 11(1):107-112.

Sebastian!, L. A., A. Borgioli, and A. D. Simonetti. 1981. Behavior of
synthetic detergents in the soil. Movement of hard detergents in the soil.
pp. 333-347. Ln M. R. Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of toxic and nontoxic
organic chemicals in soils.

Sekerka, V. 1977. Influence of copper on growth and mitotic activity on the
cells in the apical meristems of the horse bean (Vicia faba L.). Acta
Facultis Rerum Naterallium Universitis Comenianae, Physiologia Plantarum
14:1-16.

Sherman, 6. D. 1952. The titanium content of Hawaiian soils and its
significance. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 16:15-18.

Shone, M. G. T., D. T. Clarkson, J. Sanderson, and A. V. Wood.  1972. A com-
parison of the uptake of some organic molecules and ions in higher plants.
pp. 571-583. In W. P. Anderson (ed.) Ion Transport in Plants. Academic
Press, New York.

Shukla, V. C. and K. G. Prasad.  1973. Forms and distribution of lithium,
boron, and fluorine in some chernozem soils of Haryana. Indian  J. Hort.
Sci.  43:934-937.

Siegel, F. R. 1974. Applied geochemistry. Wiley & Sons, New York.

Silva, S. and B. Beghi. 1979. The use of chromium containing organic
manures in rice fields. Riso 28(2):105-113.

Siraola, L. K. 1977. The tolerance of Sphagnum  fimbriatum  towards lead and
cadmium. Annales Botanic! Fennia 14:1-5.

Simon, A., F. W. Cradock, and A. W. Hudson.  1974. The development of
manganese toxicity in pasture legumes under  extreme climatic conditions.
Plant and Soil 41:129-140.

Singh, M. and N. Singh. 1978. Selenium  toxicity on  plants  and  its
detoxification by phosphorus. Soil  Sci.  125(5):255-262.

Smelt, J. H.  1981. Behavior of  quintozene  and  hexachlorobenzene in  the  soil
and their absorption in crops, pp.3-14.  In M.  R. Overcash (ed.)
Decomposition of toxic and  nontoxic organic  compounds in  soils. Ann Arbor
Science Publ., Inc., Ann Arbor,  Michigan.

Smith, C. 1982. The  Influence of anions  on soil sorption  and plant  uptake
of molybdenum. M.S.  Thesis. Texas  A&M Univ., Univ.  Microfilms,  College
Station, Texas.

Smith, I. C., B. L.  Carson, and T.  L. Ferguson. 1978. Trace  metals in the
environment, vol. 4  -  palladium and osmium.  Ann Arbor Sci. Publ.  Ann Arbor,
Michigan.


                                     357

-------
 Sparling, G. P.,  B. G.  Ord, and  D. Vaughan.  1981.  Changes  in microbial
 biomass and activity  in soils  amended with phenolic acids.  Soil  Biol.
 Biochem.  13:455-460.

 Spencer,  W. F.  and W. J. Farmer.  1980. Assessment  of  the vapor behavior of
 toxic organic chemicals, pp. 143-161. Jji Rizwanul  Haque (ed.) Dynamics,
 exposure, and hazard  assessment  of toxic chemicals. Ann Arbor Science
 Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor,  Michigan.

 Soane, B. D. and  D. H.  Saunders.  1959. Nickel and  chromium toxicity of
 serpentine soils  in southern Rhodesia. Soil  Sci. 88:322-330.

 Sommers,  L. E.  1977.  Chemical  composition of sewages  and analysis of their
 potential use as  fertilizers.  J.  Environ. Qual. 6(2)-.225-232.

 Sommers,  L. E.  and D. W. Nelson.  1976. Analyses and their  interpretation
 for sludge application  to agricultural land. pp. 3.1-3.7.  In B.  D. Knezek
 and R. H. Miller  (eds.) Application of sludges and wastewaters on
 agricultural land; a planning  educational guide. N. Ctr. Reg. Res. Pub.
 235. Ohio Agr.  Res. Division Ctr. Reg. Bull. 1090. Wooster, Ohio.

 Sorteberg, A. 1978. Effects of some heavy metals on oats in pot  experiments
 with three different soil types.  J. Sci. Ag. Soc.  Finland  50:317-334.

 Spencer,  E. L.  1937. Renching  of  tobacco and thallium toxicity.  Am. J. Bot.
 24:16-24.

 Stace, H. C. T.,  G. D.  Hubble, R. Brewer, K. H. Northcote,  J. R. Sleeman,
 M. J. Mulcahy,  and E. G. Hallsworth. 1968. A handbook of Australian soils.
 Rellim Technical  Publications. Adelaide, South Australia.

 Staker, E. V. 1942. Progress report on the control of Zn toxicity in peat
 soils. Soil Sci.  Soc. Am. Proc.  7:387-392.

 Steevens, D. R.,  L. M. Walsh,  and D. R. Keeney. 1972. Arsenic residues in
 soil and  potatoes from Wisconsin  potato fields. Pesticides  Monitoring J.
 6:89-90.

 Stelmach, Z. 1958. Bromine retention in some soils and uptake of bromine by
 plants after soil fumigation.  Soil Sci. 88:61-66.

 Stewart, D. K.  R. and K. G. Cairns. 1974. Endosulfan  persistence in soil
 and uptake by potato tubers. J. Agr. Food Chem., Vol. 22.  pp. 984-986.

 Stipes, R. J. and D. R. Oderwald. 1971. Dutch elm  disease:  control with
 soil-injected fungicides and surfactants. (Abstract)  Phytopathology 61(8):
 913.

 Stout, P. R. and W. R. Meagher.  1948. Studies of Mo nutrition of plants
with radioactive molybdenum. Science 108:471-473.
                                     358

-------
Stout, P. R.,  W. R. Meagher, G. A. Pearson, and C. M. Johnson.  1951.
Molybdenum nutrition in croplands. Plant and Soil 3:51-87.

Stover, R. L., L. E. Sommera, and D. T. Silviera. 1976. Evaluation of
metals in wastewater sludge. J. Water Poll. Control Fed. 48:2165-2175.

Street, J. J., W. L. Lindsay and B. R. Sabey. 1977. J. Environ. Qual.
6:72-77.

Stucky, D. J.  and T. S. Newman. 1977. Effect of dried anaerobically
digested sewage sludge on yield and element accumulation in tall fescue and
alfalfa. J. Environ. Qual. 6(3):271-273.

Subbarao, Y. V. and R. Ellis. 1977. Determination of kinetics of phosphorus
mineralizaiton in soils under oxidizing conditions. Ada, Oklahoma. EPA
600/2-77-180.  PB 272-594/3BE.

Sunderman, F.  W. 1977. Metal carcinogenesis. pp. 257-296. ^n R. A. Goyer
and M. A. Hehlman (eds.) Toxicology of trace elements. John Wiley and Sons,
New York.

Sunderman, F.  W. and A. J. Donnelly. 1965. Studies of nickel
carcinogenesis. Metastasizing pulmonary tumors in rats induced by
inhalation of nickel carbonyl. Amer. J. Path. 46:1027-1041.

Sunderman, F.  W. and E. Mastromatteo.  1975. Nickel carcinogenesis. In F. W.
Sunderman, F.  Coulston, G. L. Eichorn, J.  A. Fellows,  E. Mastromatteo, H.
T. Reno, and M. H.  Sanuitz (eds.) Nickel.  National Academy of  Sciences,
Washington, D.C.

Sung, M. W. and H.  J. Young. 1977. Effects of various  anions  on  absorption
and toxicity of lead in plants. Korean J.  Botany 20:7-14.

Swaine, D. J.  1955. Trace element content  of soils.  Commonwealth Bur. Soil
Sci. Tech. Comm. No. 48. Herald Printing,  York,  England.

Takkar, P. N. and M. S. Mann.  1978. Toxic  levels of  soil and  plant zinc  for
maize and wheat. Plant and Soil 49(3):667-669.

Taskayev, A. I., V. Y. Ovchevov,  R. M. Neksakhin,  and  1. I. Shok Tomora.
1977. Uptake of Ra^26 by plants and changes  in  its state in the
soil-plant  top-litterfall system.  Soviet Soil  Sci.  9:79-85.

Taylor,  S. A. and G. L. Ashcroft.  1972. Physical edaphology.  W.  H. Freeman
and Co., San Francisco, California.

Teakle, L. J. H. and I. Thomas. 1939.  Recent experiments with 'minor'
elements in Western Australia. IV.  The effect  of 'minor* elements  on growth
of wheat in other parts of  the state.  J. Dept.  Agr.  W. Australia
16:143-147.

Tepper, L.  B.  1972. Beryllium. CRC critial reviews in toxicology 1:235.


                                     359

-------
Tiller, K. G.  and J.  R. Hodgson.  1960.  The  specific  sorption of  cobalt  and
zinc by layer  silicates.  Clays  and  Clay Min.  11:393-403.

Tisdale,  S. L. and W. L.  Nelson.  1975.  Soil fertility  and  fertilizers.  3rd
ed. MacMillan  Publ. Co.,  New  York.

Tofflemire, T. J. and M.  Chen.  1977.  Phosphate  removal by  sands  and  soils.
p.  154. Iii R.  C. Loehr  (ed.)  Land as  a  waste  management alternative.  Proc.
of  the 1976 Cornell Agricultural Waste  Management  Conf. Ann  Arbor  Science
Publ. Inc., Ann Arbor,  Michigan.

Toivonen, P. M. A. and  G. Hofstra.  1979.  The  interaction of  copper and
sulfur dioxide in plant injury.  Canad.  J.  Plant.  Sci.  59:475-479.

Tokuoka,  M. and S. Gyo. 1940. The effect of zinc on  the growth of  wheat. J.
Sci. Soil Manure, Nippon  14:587-596.

Tomson, M. B., J. Dauchy, S.  Hutchins,  C. Curran,  C. J. Cook, and  C.  H.
Ward. 1981. Groundwater contamination by trace  level organics from a rapid
infiltration site. Water Research 15:1109-1116.

Travis, C. C. and E. L. Etnier. 1981. A survey  of  sorption relationships
for reactive solutes in soil. J. Environ. Qual. 10:8-17.

Trelease, S. F. and 0. A. Beath. 1949.  Selenium. Published by authors.  New
York.

Tsuchiya, K. 1978. Cadmium studies  in Japan:  A review. Elsevier/North-
Holland Biomedical Press, N.Y.

Turner, M. A. and R. H. Rust. 1971. Effects of  chromium on growth  and
mineral nutrition of soya beans. Soil Sci.  Soc. Am.  Proc. 35:755-758.

Turner, W. W. (ed.) 1965. Drugs and poisons.  Jurisprudence Publishers,  Inc.
Rochester, New York.

Underwood, E. J. 1971. Trace  elements in human  and animal  nutrition.  3rd
ed. Academic Press, New York.

USDA. 1954. Diagnosis and improvement of saline and  alkali soils.  L.  A.
Richards  (ed.) USDA Handbook  No. 60.  Washington, D.C.

Vallentine, J. F. 1971. Range development and improvements.  Brigham  Young
Univ. Press. Provo, Utah. 516 p.

Valoras N., J. Letey, J. P. Martin, and  J.  Osborn. 1976. Degradation of a
nonionic surfactant in soils  and peat.  Soil Sci. Soc.  Am.  Jour.
40(l):60-63.

Van Beekom, C. W. C., C. van  den Berg,  T. A.  deBoer, W. H. van den Mulen,
B.  Verhoeven, J.  J. Westerhof, and  A.  J.  Zuvr. 1953.  Reclaiming  land
flooded with salt water. Neth. J. Agr.  Sci. 1(3):153-163,  l(4):225-244.


                                     360

-------
Van Dam, J. G. C. 1955 Examination of soils and crops after the innundation
of February 1953. Neth. J. Agr. Sci. 2:242-253.

Vandoni M. V. and F. L. Goldberg. 1981. Synthetic detergents behavior in
agricultural soil. Chapter 41. ^n. M. R. Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of
toxic and nontoxic organic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Science Publ.,
Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Van Loon, J. C. 1974. Mercury contamination of vegetation due to the
application of sewage sludge as a fertilizer. Environ. Letters 6:211-218.

Vanselow, A. P. 1966a. Barium pp. 142-156. fri H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Vanselow, A. P. 1966b. Cobalt, pp. 142-156. In H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Vanselow, A. P. 1966c. Nickel, pp. 302-309. In H. D. Chapman (ed.)
Diagnostic criteria for plants and soils. University of California,
Riverside.

Vanselow, A. P. 1966d. Strontium, p. 763. Ill H. D. Chapman  (ed.) Diagnostic
criteria for plants and soils. University of California, Riverside.

Velly, J. 1974. Observations on the acidification of some  soils  in
Madagascar. Agronomie Tropicale 29(12):1248-1262.

Vlek, P. L. G. and W. L. Lindsay. 1977. Molybdenum contamination in
Colorado pastures. Ill W. R. Chappell and K. K.  Peterson (eds.) Molybdenum
in the environment. Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York.

Voelcker, J. A. 1913. Pot culture experiments.  J. Royal Agr. Soc.  (England)
74:411-422.

Vollanweider, R. H. 1968. Scientific fundamentals of the eutrophication of
lakes and flowing waters, with particular reference  to nitrogen  and
phosphorus as factors in eutrophication. OED,  DAS/CS  1-68-27.  p. 159.

Vostal, J. J., E. Taves, J. W. Sayre,  and E.  Charney.  1974. Lead analysis
of house dust: a method for the detection of  another  source of lead
exposure in inner city children. Environ. Health Perpect.  7:91-97.

Wainwright, S. J. and H. W. Woolhouse. 1975.  Physiological mechanisms  of
heavy metal tolerance in plants, pp. 231-257.  In M.  J. Chadwick  and  G.  T.
Goodman (eds.). The ecology of resource  degradation  and renewal. Blackwell,
Oxford.

Walker, A.  1971. Effects of soil moisture content  on the availability  of
soil applied herbicides to plants.  Pesticide  Science 2:56-59.
                                     361

-------
Walker, T. W. 1956. Fate of labeled nitrate and ammonium nitrogen when
applied to grass and clover grown separately and together. Soil Science
81:339-352.

Wallace, A., E. M. Romney, J. W. Cha, and F. M. Chaudhry.  1977. Lithium
toxicity in plants. Comm. Soil Sci. Plant Anal. 8:773-780.

Wallace, A., E. M. Romney. R. T. Mueller, Sr., and S. M. Soufi. 1981. Plant
uptake and transport of ^Am. soil Science 132(1): 114-119.

Wallace, A., S. M. Soufi, J. W. Cha, and E. M. Romney. 1976. Some effects
of Cr toxicity on bush bean plants grown in soil. Plant and Soil.
2(44):471-473.

Wallihan, E. F., R. G. Sharpless, and W. L. Printy.  1978.  Cumulative toxic
effects of boron, lithium, and sodium in water used  for hydroponic
production of tomatoes. J. Am. Soc. Hort. Sci. 103:14-16.

Wallnofer, P., M. Koniger, and G. Engelhardt. 1981.  The behavior of
xenobiotic chlorinated hydrocarbons (HCB and PCBs) in cultivated plants.
XI. pp. 99-109. _In M. R.  Overcash (ed.) Decomposition of  toxic and non-
toxic organic compounds in soils. Ann Arbor Science  Publ., Inc. Ann Arbor,
Michigan.

Walsh, L. M., M. E. Sumner, and R. B. Corey. 1976. Consideration of soils
for accepting plant nutrients and potentially toxic  nonessential elements.
pp. 22-45. In Land application of waste materials. Soil Conser. Soc. Am.

Walsh, T., M. Neenan, and L. B. O'Moore. 1953. High  Mo levels in herbage on
acid soils. Nature 171:1120.

Walters, L. T. and T. J. Wolery. 1974. Transfer of heavy metals pollutants
from Lake Erie bottom sediment to the overlying water. Ohio State Univ.
Columbus, Ohio.

Warren, H. V. 1972. Biogeochemistry in Canada. Endeavor 31:46-49.

Watanbe, T. and H. Nakamura. 1972. Lead absorbed by  eggplant from soil and
its translocation. Agricultural Chemical Inspection  Sta. Bull. No.
12:105-106.

Watkinson, J. H. and G. M. Dixon. 1979. Effect of applied  selenate on
ryegrass and on larvae of soldier fly, Inopus rubriceps Macquart. New
Zealand J. Exptl. Agr. 7(3):321-325.

Weaver, C. M., N. D. Harris, and L. R. Fox. 1981. Accumulation of Sr and Cs
by kale as a function of age of plant. J. Environ. Qual. 10-95-98.

Weber, J. B. and E. Mrozek, Jr. 1979. Polychlorinated biphenyls:
phytotoxicity, absorption and translocation by plants and  inactivation by
activated carbon. Bull. Environ. Contam. Toxicol. 23:412-417.
                                     362

-------
Wentinik, G. R. and J. E. Etzel. 1972. Removal of metal ions by soil. J.
Water Poll. Control Fed. 44:1561-1574.

Wetherold, R. G., D. D. Rosebrook, and E. W. Cunningham. 1981. Assessment
of hydrocarbon emissions from land treatment of oily sludges, pp. 213-233.
Ln David Shultz (ed.) Proceedings of the Seventh Annual Research Symposium
at Philadelphia, Pennsylvania. EPA-600-9-81-002b.

White, M. C. and R. L. Chaney. 1980. Zinc, cadmium and manganese uptake by
soybean from two zinc and cadmium-amended coastal plains soils. Soil Scl.
Soc. Am. J. 44:308-313.

Whitehead, D. C. 1975. Uptake by perennial ryegrass of iodide, elemental
iodine, and iodate added to soil as influenced by various amendments. J.
Sci. Food Agric. 26:361-367.

Wieeter, M. J. 1975. Cardiovascular actions of palladium compounds in the
unanesthesized rat. Environ. Health Perspect.  12:41-44.

Williams, R. J. B. and H. H. LeRiche. 1968. The effect of traces of
beryllium on the growth of kale, grass and mustard. Plant and Soil
29:317-326.

Williams, S. E. and A. G. Wollum. Effect of cadmium on soil  bacteria and
actinomycetes. J. Environ. Qual. 10:142-144.

Wilson, D. 0. and J. F. Cline, 1966. Removal of plutonlum-239,
tungsten-185, and lead-210 from soils. Nature 209:941-942.

Wilson, J. T., C. G. Enfield, W. J. Dunlap, R. L.  Cosby, D.  A. Foster,  and
L. B. Baskin. 1981. Transport and fate of selected organic  pollutants in  a
sandy soil. J. Env. Qual. 10(4):501-506.

Woolson, E. A. 1977. Fate of arsenicals in different environmental
substrates. Environ. Health Perspect. 19:73-81.

Yamagata, N. and Y. Murakami. 1958. A cobalt accumulator plant,  Clethra
barbinervis. Nature 181:1808-1809.

Yamamoto, T., E. Yonoki, M. Yamakawa, and M. Shimizu.  1973.  Studies  on
environmental contamination by uranium: 2. Adsorption  of uranium on  soil
and its desorption. J. Radlat. Res.  14:219-224.

Yeh, S. 1973. Skin cancer in chronic arsenicalism. Human Path. 4:469-485.

Young, R. A.  1948. Some factors affecting  the solubility of cobalt.  Soil
Sci. Soc. Amer. Proc.  13:122-126.

Young, R. S.  1979. Cobalt in plants, pp. 50-80.  In R.  S. Young (ed.)
Biology and biochemistry. Academic  Press, New York.
                                     363

-------
Younts, S. E. and R. P. Patterson. 1964. Copper-lime interactions in field
experiments with wheat yield and chemical composition data. Agron. J.
56:229-232.

Zoeteman, R. C. J., E. De Greef, and F. J. J. Brinkman. 1981. Persistency
of organic contaminants in groundwater-lessons from soil pollution inci-
dents in the Netherlands. The Science of the Total Environment 21:187-202.

Zwerman, P. J., Klausner, S. D., and D. F. Ellis. 1974. Land disposal
parameters for dairy manure, pp. 211-221. In Processing and management of
agricultural wastes. Proc. Cornell Agricultural Waste Management
Conference. Rochester, New York.
                                    364

-------
7.0                            CHAPTER SEVEN

      PRELIMINARY TESTS AND PILOT STUDIES ON WASTE-SITE INTERACTIONS
     The study of waste-site  interactions  is  the  key to demonstrating that
land treatment of a given waste at  a  specific site  will render the applied
waste less hazardous or  nonhazardous  by  degradation, transformation and/or
immobilization of hazardous constituents  (Appendix  B).   These interactions
also determine  the potential  for off-site  contamination.    To  understand
waste-site interactions, information gathered during the individual assess-
ments of site, soil and wastes must be integrated and used to plan prelimi-
nary tests and pilot studies  that will provide data on the  interaction of
system components.   Laboratory,  greenhouse and field studies provide more
valuable information than  theoretical models because of the  wide range of
complex variables involved.

     In the flow chart presented  in Chapter  2 (Fig. 2.1),  Chapter 7 is in-
dicated as a decision point in the  evaluation and design process for HWLT.
In many ways information gained from the testing procedure outlined in this
chapter is the key to decision-making for both the  permit evaluator and the
facility designer.   This chapter  discusses a  set of preliminary tests and
pilot studies used to determine whether  a particular HWLT system will meet
the  goal  of  rendering the  applied  wastes less hazardous  or nonhazardous.
The permit writer must decide whether a unit meets  this goal  after evaluat-
ing  test  results  and other information  submitted by the permit  applicant.
During the design of an  HWLT  unit, results  from  testing discussed in this
chapter will  be  used to predict  whether  the goal  of HWLT will  be met and
will form the basis for many operational and management decisions.

     The  topics  to be discussed  in this  chapter  are  illustrated in Fig.
7.1.   Sections  7.2  through  7.4  describe  a comprehensive experimental
approach  that  considers   all of   the   important   treatment   parameters,
environmental hazards,  and  potential contaminant migration  pathways.  The
currently available  battery  of  tests, listed  in  Table 7.1, outlines one
possible experimental framework  that would provide the data to  understand
the treatment processes  at  a  given  HWLT  system.   As new and  more  efficient
tests  are developed,  it  is   expected  that  new   testing  procedures will
replace those listed in  the table.   All  tests conducted should include an
experimental design  based on  statistical principles so that  useful results
are  obtained.   Section  7.5 discusses the  interpretation  of test results.
Results from preliminary testing  are used  to  establish  the following:

     (1)  the  ultimate  fate   of  the  hazardous  constituents  of the
          waste;

     (2)  the identity of  the waste fraction that  controls the  yearly
          loading rate,  referred  to as  the  rate  limiting constituent
          (RLC);

     (3)  the Identity of the  waste constituent that limits  the  amount
          of waste that  can be applied  in a single dose, referred  to
          as the application  limiting  constituent (ALC);


                                     365

-------
            r
 WASTE
f
OTENTIAL
  SITE
                             WASTE-SITE
                             INTERACTIONS
                             CHAPTER SEVEN
                     USE AVAILABLE INFORMATION
                       TO HELP DETERMINE THE
                      PRELIMINARY TESTS NEEDED
                             (SECTION 7.1)
   USE  LABORATORY STUDIES^X
  TO  CHARACTERIZE THE  FATE   }
     OF  APPLIED WASTES      /
        (SECTION 7.2)       J
                           /USE GREENHOUSE STUDIES
                           /TO DETERMINE THE EFFECT OF
                           I    HWLT ON PLANT GROWTH
                           V      (SECTION 7.3)
                  /USE FIELD PILOT STUDIES  TON
                 /CHARACTERIZE WASTE-SITE INTERACA
                  TIONS, NOT DETERMINED BY LABORA-
                 V     TORY OR GREENHOUSE TESTS   /
                  V.	(SECTION 7.4)    ^
              r
        DID THE  RESULTS OF  THE ABOVE
      TESTS SHOW THAT TREATMENT WILL
(   OCCUR IN THE  GIVEN HWLT  UNIT?   IF YES,
V     DETERMINE  MANAGEMENT  CRITERIA
 N.            (SECTION 7.5)
                         DESIGN AND OPERATION
                            CHAPTER EIGHT
Figure 7.1.  Topics to be addressed to evaluate waste-site
             interactions for HWLT systems.
                                  366

-------
     (4)  the identity  of the waste  fraction that  limits the  total
          quantity  of  waste  that can  be  treated  at  a  given  site,
          referred to as the capacity limiting constituent (CLC);

     (5)  the criteria for management;

     (6)  the  parameters   that   should  be  monitored   to   indicate
          contaminant migration into  groundwater, surface water,  air,
          and cover crops; and
     (7)  the land area required to treat a given quantity of waste.

A discussion  of  the basis  for  labeling a  given  waste fraction  as either
rate, application, or capacity limiting is included in Section 7.5.
TABLE 7.1  CONSIDERATIONS IN A COMPREHENSIVE TESTING PROGRAM FOR EVALUATING
           WASTE-SITE INTERACTIONS.
 Waste-Site
Interactions
         Test Method
 Manual
Reference
Degradation of waste

Accumulation in soil
  of nondegradables
Leaching hazards
Volatilization
  hazards
Acute toxicity
Chronic toxicity
Plant uptake
Pretreatment
      Respirometry                             7.2.1.1
      Field studies by soil testing            7.4.1
      Waste analysis (inorganics)              5.3.2.3.1
      Respirometry (organics)                  7.2.1.1
      Soil thin layer chromatography           7.2.2.1
      Soil leaching columns                    7.2.2.2
      Field soil leachate testing              7.4.2
      Environmental chamber                    7.2.3
      Field air testing                        7.4.4
      Respirometry (soil biota)                7.2.1.1
      Beckman Microtox1" System                 7.2.4.1.1
      Greenhouse studies (plants)              7.3.2
      Microbiological mutagenicity assays      5.3.2.4
      Greenhouse studies                       7.3
      Assessment of processes generating       5.2
        waste
7.1
REVIEW OF AVAILABLE INFORMATION
     Although  pilot  studies  are often needed  to  supplement  existing data or
to  answer  questions posed  by  unique situations,  a  review  of  pertinent
literature  and available data  from  similar HWLT units may reduce  the  need
                                     367

-------
 for extensive  demonstration  studies.   From this  review valuable  information
 may be  found on soils,  waste characteristics,  and general  data for  predict-
 ing the fate of waste constituents.  This information may alert  the  permit
 reviewer and the facility designer to potential problems with recalcitrant
 or  toxic compounds and provide data  for  assessing the potential of  a  par-
 ticular waste  to be  land treated.   A thorough review of the  literature  and
 other  available  information, such as monitoring data,  may considerably
 reduce   the  amount  of  testing required  and  will provide  guidelines  for
 developing  an  experimental design  that will  adequately address  waste-site
 interactions for the particular HWLT  unit.
 7.2                          LABORATORY  STUDIES
     A series  of  laboratory studies should be initiated as the first  phase
of  the waste-site interaction assessment.  The major advantages of  labora-
tory or bench  scale  studies  are  that  one  may  better  standardize the  method-
ology  and have better  control over  the  important  parameters.  Laboratory
techniques  also act  as  rapid screening techniques by allowing the investi-
gator to  look  at  extremes and  individual  treatment effects within a  reason-
able time frame.   However,   some extrapolations  to  field conditions may  be
difficult since bench scale studies involve small, disturbed  systems  which
cannot easily  account for time series of events.  Therefore,  although some
definite  conclusions can  be  drawn  from laboratory  results, field  plot
and/or field  lysimeter  studies are usually necessary  to verify laboratory
results and extrapolations  to determine  the  treatability  of  a waste.  The
following suggestions for conducting  a comprehensive laboratory evaluation
are  intended  as   a  general  guide and  should  be  adapted  to the  given
situation.
7.2.1                          Degradability
     The complex nature  of a hazardous waste  makes  it necessary to  deter-
mine  the degradation  rate  of  waste  constituents  in a  laboratory  study
rather  than  through theoretical models.   The half-life  of specific  waste
constituents  cannot be  applied to  the waste  as a  whole because  of  the
synergistic, additive, or  antagonistic  effects of various waste-soil  inter-
actions  which may  significantly  alter the  overall  degradation  rate.   In
circumstances where  an  equivalent  waste has been handled at an  equivalent
HWLT unit, full-scale laboratory studies  may not be necessary.   Laboratory
studies  can  be used  to define waste  loading rates,  and  to  determine  if
reactions in the soil are  producing an acceptable degradation rate for  the
hazardous organic waste constituents.

     Before land applying  any waste material,  it is  necessary to determine
to what  extent the  soil  may be  loaded with  the  waste before the microbial
activity of  the soil  is  inhibited  to the  extent that  waste degradation
falls below acceptable levels.  Land treatment of hazardous waste should be
designed to utilize the diverse microbial population of the soil  to enhance


                                     368

-------
the  rate  of waste  degradation.    When  environmental parameters  are main-
tained at optimum conditions  for  microbial  activity, efficient use is made
of the land treatment site  and the environmental  impact  is minimized.  The
environmental parameters which can most easily be adjusted at the HWLT unit
include application rate and  frequency,  and the  rate of  addition of nutri-
ents.  To adjust these parameters to optimal levels, waste degradation must
be monitored,  and  the  effects of the  various  parameters  on degradation
evaluated.  An  evaluation  of waste degradation  should include the estima-
tion of  microbial  populations, the monitoring of microbial  activity,  and
the measurement of waste decomposition products.

     The soil respirometer  method  which  is  discussed in  detail in the fol-
lowing sections is one of the available methods for  evaluating the degrada-
tion  of  a  complex  waste-soil mixture.    Use  of  the  soil  respirometer
requires  only  a limited amount of laboratory equipment.   It is  a method
that can be quickly set up  in most laboratories and  can be used to evaluate
a large number of parameters.  While it  does  not provide a means for trac-
ing  the  degradation  of  the  individual  components  of  a  complex mixture,
unless coupled with chemical  analysis, it  is  a relatively simple and inex-
pensive method  for evaluating  the effect  of environmental  parameters  on
waste degradation in  soil.   Other methods which have been used to measure
respiration  from  organic   material include   infrared   gas  analysis,  gas
chromatography, and the Gilson  respirometer (Van Cleve  et  al.,  1979),   In
addition, Osborne  et al.  (1980)  discuss  a method  for  studying microbial
activity in Intact soil cores.
7.2.1.1  Soil Respirometry
     One method  to  evaluate  environmental parameters before field  applica-
tion  of waste  is  to  monitor carbon  dioxide  (CC^)  evolution  from waste
amended soils in a  soil  respirometer.   The soil respirometer consists of a.
temperature  controlled  incubation  chamber containing  a series  of sealed
flasks  into  which  various treatments  of waste  and soil are  placed (Fig.
7.2).   The respirometer  is an apparatus which allows temperature and mois-
ture to be kept  at  a constant level while  other  parameters, such  as waste
application  rate and frequency,  are varied.   A  stream  of  humidified CC^-
free air is  passed  through the flasks  and  the  evolved  CC>2  from the flasks
is collected  in  columns  containing 0.1N NaOH.  The air stream is  purified
in a scrubber system consisting of a pump and a series of flasks:   one con-
tains  concentrated  ^804;   two  parallel  flasks   contain  AN  NaOH; and a
pair of flasks  in  series contain C02-free water.   The two  flasks of 4N
NaOH are placed parallel  so  that the air stream may be switched to a fresh
solution without interrupting the  flow  of  air.   Between  the  scrubber  and
each flask is a manifold which distributes the air  to  the flasks  through
equal  length  capillary tubes, thus providing  an  equal  flow rate  for each
flask.  Each  incubation  chamber should  include  two empty flasks which serve
to monitor  impurities in the air  stream.   The air  leaving each  flask is
passed  through a 12 mm coarse  Pyrex gas  dispersion tube which  is  positioned
near  the  bottom of  a  25 x  250 mm culture tube  containing 50  ml of C02~
free 0.1N NaOH.  The NaOH solutions are replaced  approximately three times

                                     369

-------
                                                  AIR FLOW-
                 VALVE
TRAP    CONC. H2SO^  TRAP
                                                   AN NaOH
                                           TRAP
H20
TRAP
                                              SCRUBBER SYSTEM
u>
vj
O
AIR FROM THE
    SCRUBBER SYSTEM
          COPPER COIL CONNECTED TO
         WATER- BATH  FOR TEMPERATURE
          CONTROL 	
                                SOIL AND WASTE
                                   INCUBATION CHAMBER
                                        0.IN NaOH  COLUMNS
                        Figure 7.2.  Schematic diagram of  respirometer.

-------
a week,  depending  on CC>2 evolution,  and are  titrated  with l.ON NCI  fol-
lowing  precipitation of  evolved  C02 with  3N  BaCl2  (Stotzky,  1965)  to
phenolphthalein end-point.   The  amount  of CC>2  evolved can be  determined
(Section 7.2.1.1.2.4).

     The  rate  of  C02 evolution  is  used  as  an  indication  of  microbial
activity and relative waste  decomposition  (Stotzky,  1965).  Upon termina-
tion of  the experiment, subsamples  may be  taken from each  flask  to deter-
mine the residual hydrocarbon content (Section 5.3.2.3.2), and for an esti-
mation  of  the microbial  population  (Section  7.2.4.1.1).   The  data  from
these tests  can  provide guidance  on the appropriate application rate and
frequency to use,  the optimum rate of nutrient  addition, and the  rate of
waste degradation  in different  soil types or at  different  temperatures.
Careful  study  of  these  parameters before field  application  can  prevent an
accidental overload of the system and unnecessary additions of nutrients.
7.2.1.1.1   Sample  Collection.   Each  hazardous  waste stream  may  possess a
variety of compounds that are toxic or recalcitrant, and a unique ratio and
concentration  of mineral  nutrients.   Therefore,  to  begin  a  laboratory
degradation study representative samples of the waste and soil must be col-
lected.  Soil collected from the  field  for the respiration study should be
maintained at field capacity (about 1/3 bar moisture tension)  and stored at
room  temperature under  a  fixed  relative  humidity to  preserve  the soil
microorganisms.  Soil collected where water content is above  field capacity
should be  air  dried to reach field  capacity,  and  soil  which is collected
below field capacity should be  wetted with distilled water to field  capac-
ity.  Since many wastes  will  require a diverse  range  of microorganisms to
degrade waste constituents, care  must be  taken in the handling and storage
of soil samples.  The  collection  of  a truly representative waste sample is
also critical to obtaining  valid data from  the  laboratory.    Although few,
if any,  waste  streams  exist as  homogeneous mixtures or have uniform com-
position.   Over time, there  are methods  of  obtaining  representative sam-
ples; a more complete discussion of waste  and soil  sampling  is presented in
Section 5.3.2.1  and Chapter 9, respectively.
7.2.1.1.2   Experimental  Procedure.   The respiration experiment is  begun  by
equilibrating the respiration chamber  (Fig.  7.2)  to  the  desired temperature
and starting  the  scrubber system at least  24  hours  before adding  the  soil
to  the  flasks.   Two days  prior to waste addition,  the  soil is brought  to
the desired moisture content by air  drying  or  wetting with distilled water.
A soil  sample equivalent  to 100 g  of dry soil is  placed on a glass  plate
and crushed to  reduce  the largest aggregates to approximately 1/2  cm.  The
crushed  and weighed soil sample is  placed  into  a preweighed 500 ml Erlen-
meyer flask,  which is then connected  to the C02~free air stream and  to  a
column containing 0.1N NaOH.  The  flow of air  through  the chamber  should  be
adjusted so that  neither  stimulation  of microbial activity nor  inhibition
occurs.   A flow  rate  of  20 ml per minute  of CC^-free  air  per  100 gm  of
soil  appears  to provide  an  adequate supply of  oxygen while not  affecting
the rate of respiration.  After the soil has been  placed in the  respiro-
meter  and  allowed  to  equilibrate  for  at  least two  days, a  20-40  gram

                                     371

-------
 subsample  of soil is  removed  from the  flask  and  placed  in an  evaporating
 dish.   The  desired  amount of  waste  is  then  mixed  with the  soil.   After
 mixing,  the  waste-soil subsample  is  mixed with  the  total soil  sample  from
 the  flask  and  the mixture is  returned to the flask and then put  back  in the
 respirometer.   This  mixing procedure may  also  be  used to  add  water, or  to
 reapply  the  waste during  the  respiration experiment.
 7.2.1.1.2.1   Soil  moisture is a parameter  which may be difficult  to  adjust
 in  the  field.  All HWLT units  have runoff collection  systems and some  may
 have  leachate recycling  pumps  or  irrigation systems  that can  be used  to
 increase  the  moisture  content of dry soil.  The optimum range  of  soil  mois-
 ture  for  microbial activity appears to  be  between the wilting point  (about
 15  bars moisture  tension)  and field capacity (1/3 bars moisture  tension) of
 the  soil.  This  range of  moisture is  also  optimum  for  waste  degradation
 since  excess  moisture  reduces  available  oxygen  and  most   organics  are
 degraded  by  an oxidative  pathway.   In  a  laboratory,  flasks containing  the
 soil-waste mixture should  be removed  and weighed  periodically so that  the
 moisture  content  of the soil can  be  adjusted.   If  the moisture  content of
 the  soil  becomes  substantially above  field  capacity  or  below the wilting
 point,  the rate  of degradation  may be  significantly  altered,  and the  data
 should  be interpreted  with caution.
7.2.1.1.2.2  The  temperature of the initial respiration studies may  be  con-
ducted  at 20*5°C.This allows  the experiment  to  be carried  out at  room
temperature without  requiring temperature control, and provides information
on waste  treatability.   For warmer climates, additional degradation  experi-
ments may  be performed  at  30°C are appropriate.  When studying waste degra-
dation  in  a cold  climate the respirometer  temperature may need to be  regu-
lated  to  as  low  as  5°C.    Studies  at different  temperatures provide  addi-
tional  information that can  be useful in  determining seasonal application
rates and  frequencies.
7.2.1.1.2.3   Nutrient additions may help  stimulate biodegradation.   Carbon
is used  by most  bacteria  as an energy  source  and  is present in most  wastes
at  much  greater  concentrations  than  nitrogen.    The  addition  of  large
amounts  of carbon  to  the  soil  will stimulate excess bacterial  growth,  which
will cause nitrogen to  be  depleted unless nutrient additions are made.  The
optimum  carbon:nitrogen:phosphorus (C:N:P) ratio in a waste-soil mixture is
about  50:2:1.    However,  this  ratio  should  be used  only as  a guide,  and
optimum  fertilizer rates  for   individual  HWLT  units  should  be determined
along  with  other  site-specific parameters.   The  timing  of  nutrient  addi-
tions  is important to  waste  degradation.   In some  cases it  may be  more
effective to  add nutrients after  waste degradation has  begun  and  the more
susceptible  substrates  have already been utilized by  the microorganisms.
In addition to mineral  nutrients,  lime may be required to  maintain the soil
pH between 6.5 and 8.5.
                                     372

-------
7.2.1.1.2.4   Titration  of  the  NaOH solutions  are used  to determine  the
amount  of   C02   evolved  to  indicate  the   rate   of   waste  degradation.
Approximately  three  times  per  week  the  NaOH  solutions  are  replaced  to
determine  the  amount  of (X>2  absorbed  from  the air  passing  through  each
treatment flask.  The  frequency  of  sampling  and  titration may be reduced or
increased  as the  rate  of  CC>2  evolution  requires.    If  it is  determined
that the NaOH solution is nearing  saturation,  the sampling frequency should
be  increased,  and  if  the  volume of  acid  required  to  titrate  the  treated
sample is almost  equal to  that  required  to  titrate the  blank  samples,  the
sampling frequency  should be  decreased.

     The  accumulated  C02  is  determined  by  titrating  the NaOH  solution
with  l.ON  HC1  following  precipitation  of  evolved  C02  with  3N  BaCl2
(Stotzky,  1965).    All  titrations  are  carried   to  a  phenolphthalein  end-
point.    The  amount  of  C02  evolved   is   determined  by  the  following
equation:

                              (B  -  V)NE - mg  C02                       (7.1)

where

     B = average  volume  of HC1 required  to titrate the NaOH from blank
         treatments;
     V = volume   required  to  titrate  the   NaOH  from  the   specific
         treatment;
     N = the normality of  the acid; and
     E = the equivalent  weight of  the carbon dioxide.

Each  time  the  NaOH  solutions are  replaced,  the spent  solutions  should  be
titrated and the  amount  of evolved  carbon dioxide determined.
7.2.1.1.2.5   Application rate  and frequency  are  interdependent and  depend
on  climatic  conditions,  including  temperature  and  rainfall   variations.
Optimum  degradation rates are  often  achieved  when small waste  applications
are made  at  frequent intervals.   A laboratory study  may  be used  to  deter-
mine  the  application rate and  frequency  that  yields the most rapid  rate  of
waste  decomposition in a given period of time at  a  constant  temperature  and
moisture.  It  is  easiest to determine the optimum application rate and  then
to  evaluate  the  application  frequency.   Experimental   application  rate
should be  varied  over a 100-fold  range,  using a minimum of  four treatments
with  different application rates.   One  additional flask containing  soil  to
which  no waste has  been applied  should  be  used  as  a control.   All  treat-
ments  are  conducted in duplicate  so that the  results  can be  properly evalu-
ated.  Once  the optimum application rate is determined  for.a specific waste
stream,  the  application frequency can  be  evaluated,  using a minimum  of
three  alternate schedules.   For  example, if  it  is  determined   in  the  rate
study  that the best compromise between efficiency of  land  use and  biodegra-
dation is achieved when the  waste is applied  at  a  rate of  5%  (wt/wt),  the
frequency study  would  then  evaluate  the  degradation rate  of four  1.25%
applications,  two 2.5% applications, and one  5% application during the same
time   period.   Chemical  and  biological  analyses of  the  treatments,  when


                                      373

-------
 evaluated with  the  cumulative CC>2  data,  will  indicate the treatment  rate
 and  frequency that provide the most efficient degradation  rate.
 7.2.1.2   Data Analysis
      The  data provided  by  a laboratory  respiration experiment may  be  used
 to  evaluate the potential  of  a  waste to be  adequately treated in  the  land
 treatment  system and to determine  the  half-life of the organic fraction of
 the  waste.   Half-life is defined as  the  time required for a  50%  disappear-
 ance of applied carbon.   The decision process for  determining if  a  waste is
 amenable  to land treatment  is outlined in Fig.  7.3.   The  first  step in  this
 process is  to determine how the waste will  affect microbial activity  when
 mixed with  the  soil.  If waste application inhibits microbial activity,  the
 following  options  are available  to improve the  treatability  of  the  waste:

      (1)   reducing waste application rates;

      (2)  pretreating a hydrophobic  waste  by drying  or  mixing with  a
          bulking  agent  to   improve the  penetration of oxygen into  the
          soil;
      (3)  pretreating the  waste  by  chemical,  physical,  or  biological
          means  (Section 5.2) to reduce its  toxicity;  and

      (4)  making in-plant  process changes to alter  the waste.

 If  these  options fail and  the soil microorganisms  cannot alter  the  nature
 of  the waste,  it  will  not  be   adequately   treated  in the  land treatment
 system.

      If,  after  mixing  the   waste  and  soil  elevated  microbial  activity  is
 observed  the waste is land  treatable and the  optimum parameters for waste
 degradation should be determined.   If the waste  is  to be  applied  at  tem-
 peratures which  vary by  more than  10°C  from  the temperature  of the initial
 respirometer study  (20*5°C),  the  half-life  of   the waste  at  the other
 temperatures should  be  determined.   Chemical  and biological  analyses  of
 treated soils from  the  respirometer  flasks  after  incubation indicate  the
 effect  of  land  treatment  on  the  hazardous  waste  constituents.    If these
 analyses  indicate  that  a waste  is  rendered  less hazardous by incorporation
 into  the   soil,  half-life   calculations  (yr)  from laboratory application
 rates  (kg/ha) may be used to  determine acceptable   yearly  waste   loading
 rates.

     The  initial waste  loading  rate  is determined  by calculating  the  time
 required  to  degrade 50%  of  the  applied  waste  constituents.   Half-life
determinations  can be made  for  the organic  fraction  of  the  waste  and  for
each  subfraction  (acid, base,  and neutral).    While  chemical analysis  can
define decomposition rates   of specific waste fractions  and  hazardous  con-
 stituents,   the  only means  of   evaluating   a   reduction  in  the  hazardous
characteristics  of a waste  is  through biological analysis (Sections 5.3.2.4
                                     374

-------
          Respiration Study
           Soil + Waste
                                                 NO
   When waste and soil are mixed
   does the soil evolve CO2.  and
   does extraction of incubated
   soil reveal reduced hydrocarbon
   content?
               YES
DETERMINE:

1. application rate for maximum
   •icrobial activity;

2. optimum ratio of mineral
   nutrients Cor waste
   decomposition;

3. optimum application
   frequency;

4. impact  of temperature on
   degradation.
                   I
                                                                         Will  respiration occur at
                                                                         reduced  application rate?
                                                             | t NO
                                                  Is waste excluding oxygen
                                                  from soil, can amendment  to
                                                  waste stimulate respiration?
                                                                                      NO
                                    VES
Can pretreatment of waste
reduce toxicity?
   Does  chemical and biological analysis
   of  treated soil reveal a reduction in
   hazardous waste characteristics?
                                                             NO
   Does chenical and biological analysis
   of  treated soil reveal attenuation of
   hazardous waste characteristics?
                   I
YES
         WASTE IS LAUD TRRATABLE I
                           ^
       Figure  7.3.
 The  information  needed  to  determine if  a waste may be
 land  treated.

-------
and  7.2.4)  or  through  a previous  knowledge of  the  degradation  pathways,
by-products, and toxicities of waste  conponents.


7.2.1.2.1   Degradation  Rate.   In most  laboratory  studies the  waste  is
incubated for  a period  of six months.   After the laboratory experiment  is
terminated, the rate  of  degradation  for  the  organic  fraction of  the  waste
should be determined  by  two  methods.   The  first  method uses the  following
equation:

                                 (C02w-C02s)0.27
                           Dt « 	                        (7.2)


where

       Dt » fraction of total carbon  degraded over  time;
     COya = cumulative C02 evolved  by waste amended soil;
     C028 =• cumulative C02 evolved  by unamended soil; and
       Ca » carbon applied.

The  second  method  used  to determine  the rate of  degradation requires  the
extraction  of  the  organic fraction from  the  soil (Section  5.3.2.3.2).  The
percent of organic degradation is determined  as follows:

                                 ao~^t'ro~t's-'                           f-i  <*\
                           to	
                                    °ao
where
     Dto * fraction of organic carbon  degraded  over  time;
     Cao = the amount of carbon applied  in  the  organic  fraction of the
           waste;
     Cro - the amount of residual  carbon in the organic fraction of
           waste amended soil; and
     Cs  * the amount of organic carbon  which can  be extracted from
           unamended soil.

To  determine  the degradation rate of individual  organic subtractions  the
following equation is used:
                                                                       (7.4)
                             wo.         r*
                                        fli

where

     Dti - fraction of carbon degraded  in subfraction i;
     Cai - carbon applied from subfraction  i  in  the  waste;
     Cri - carbon residual in subfraction i in waste amended soil;  and
           the amount of carbon present in  an unamended soil from
           subfraction i.
                                    376

-------
The  clarity  of separation  of  all  subtractions  should  be  verified by  gas
chromatography.
7.2.1.2.2  Half-life Determination.   The  half -life  of  the waste may then be
calculated for the waste as  follows:

                                       0.50
where

        t = time in days  that  the  waste was  degraded to generate the
            data used  in  equations 7.2-7.4;
     t\/2 - half-life  of  waste organics in soil (days); and
       Dt = fraction of carbon degraded in t days.

An  optional  method that  may  be  used  to  calculate half-lives  is  to  plot
cumulative percent carbon  degraded as  a  function  of  time  on a  semi-log
scale  graph.   The point  in time  where  50%  of  the  waste has  been  degraded
may then be read directly.

     Of the half-lives determined  by  the  above methods,  the  longest half-
life should be used as the  half-life  for the organic fraction of the waste.
This half -life  is then used  to  calculate  the  initial loading rate which
will produce maximum microbial activity in  the  soil.   Because of  the great
number of  variables influencing  waste  biodegradation  in soil, it  will be
difficult  to  predict  the  rate of degradation  of  wastes  in  the  field by
using  an equation.  The preceding  equations  use zero order kinetics and are
designed  to   make  the most   efficient  use  of the land  treatment  area.
Laskowski  et  al.  (1980)  suggests  that the  degradation process  for rela-
tively poorly sorbed  chemicals appears  to  follow  zero order  kinetics at
high application  rates.    Data resulting  from both  laboratory  and field
studies are compared  in  Section  7.5.3.1.4;  this comparison  indicates   that
variables not  accounted   for in laboratory  studies  may result  in  an over-
estimation of the  actual  waste half-life.

     In most  cases the rate of degradation of  the  individual subtractions
will vary.   In  any  case,  the fraction that degrades  at  the  slowest   rate
controls waste  loading rates.   The waste  should be applied at  a  rate  that
will stimulate  microbial activity while  not reaching toxic  levels of any
specific fraction.  The  degradation of  the more resistant  fractions   will
occur  after the  preferred substrate has been degraded.  Gas chromotography
can be used to  scan the waste after  degradation in soil  to  determine   if a
specific compound  is  degrading at  a  slower rate than  the  calculated half-
life of the other  waste  fractions.  If  such a  compound is identified,  then
the half-life of  the compound  should be used to adjust loading rates.   The
half-life of  the most  resistant fraction  or compound  will restrict  loading
rates  if the  compound  is  mobile in the  soil or will remain at an unaccept-
able concentration far beyond  the  time when waste applications cease.
                                     377

-------
7.2.1.2.3  Consideration  for Field Studies of Degradation.   These  calcula-
tions  are  used to  provide  guidance for  establishing  design loading  rates
and developing appropriate field studies.  Once  the  first waste application
has been made, waste  degradation in the  field  pilot study should  be  moni-
tored by periodic soil sampling and subsequent  analysis  for  hydrocarbon and
subtraction content (Section  7.4.1).  Half-lives  determined  from experimen-
tal  field  data  generally  provide a  more  realistic  evaluation  of  waste
decomposition  rates.  However,  the amount of information required  from the
results of field studies  depends on laboratory  study results.  If,  from the
laboratory  study,   it  is  determined  that all  waste  fractions degrade  at
equal rates and there is  no  specific  compound which is  less  susceptible to
degradation than  the  organic fraction  as a whole,  then the soil  sampling
need only monitor the  removal of the total  organics.  However,  if  a parti-
cular compound or fraction is evidently  resistant to degradation,  then this
particular compound or fraction should  be  monitored  in the  field.


7.2.2                      Sorption and  Mobility


     The potential  for organic contamination of  surface  runoff  and  leachate
from land treatment sites depends  on the erosion  potential  of the  soil, the
concentration  of  water soluble  constituents  in  the waste,  the  adsorptive
capacity of the soil, the kinetics of soil water  movement,  and  the  degrada-
bility of  the  potentially mobile waste  constituents and their  degradation
products.  Proper erosion control  and runoff water treatment  practices will
effectively eliminate  the runoff hazard  to  surface  waters.  Degradability
is discussed in Section 7.2.1 and  the results of  waste  degradation experi-
ments should be integrated with  the mobility findings.  Therefore,  a suit-
able method  for  evaluating  mobility  should account for waste  solubility,
adsorption,  and  soil water  kinetics.   Transport mechanisms or  potential
leachability may  be assessed by soil  thin-layer chromatography and column
leaching techniques.   Where a hazardous waste  constituent is  demonstrated
to be leachable and only  slowly degradable,  field studies  will  be  necessary
to determine  the leachate  concentrations of  the mobile  constituents  for
establishing  the maximum safe  waste   loading  rate  (Section  7.5.3.1.2).
Since the mobility  of degradates is often important, laboratory studies may
include analyses of aged  waste-soil mixtures.

     Several modes  of transport can be  described  for the movement  of hazar-
dous organic  compounds  through the soil.   As  a  continuous  phase,  oil can
move as  a  fluid  governed by  the  same parameters as  those which  determine
soil water movement. Alternatively, water soluble or miscible compounds can
be transported by soil water.  A small  amount of  movement  might also occur
by diffusion,  however, diffusion  would  not  occur  at  a  level that  would
cause  a  leaching  hazard.    Sorption  and/or  degradation   account   for  the
attenuation of  leachable  hazardous  constituents.   Adsorption  capacity is
directly related to soil  colloidal  content and  chemical nature  of  the waste
constituents  (Bailey  et  al.  1968; Castro and Belser,  1966;  Youngson and
Goring, 1962).  Soil  organic matter is  perhaps moat responsible for adsorp
tion of nonionic  compounds,  while  polar constituents  which  are potentially

                                    378

-------
 solubilized in water may have a greater affinity to the mineral  fraction  of
 soil.    Precipitation to less  soluble forms and  complexation also  immobi-
 lize and thus attenuate, some waste constituents.

      The primary  objective of a  laboratory leaching  study  is to evaluate
 leaching potential rather  than to assess  actual  mobility of  a given com-
 pound  in soil.   A disturbed soil  can be  tested to  indicate extremes, but
 the  kinetics  of  water  and solute movement  in a  bench  scale  test  do not
 ordinarily  approximate  field  conditions,  where precipitation is intermit-
 tent and the  intact  soil profile  retains  its  unique physical characteris-
 tics.   Soils chosen for  leaching  studies  should be sampled from each hori-
 zon  in the  zone of aeration where  adequate microbial populations are ordi-
 narily present for waste degradation.   By testing for the mobility of waste
 constituents  in  the lower soil  horizons,  one can  establish  whether the
 rapid  movement of a waste constituent through a less  adsorptive   surface
 soil may be  impeded  by  a  more adsorptive  subsoil  to the extent  that the
 soil biota  can adequately decompose the compound(s).   Once an organic com-
 pound  has leached below the  zone of  abundant  microbial  activity, however,
 it has  been shown that degradative attenuation is  extremely  slow (Duffy et
 al.  1977; Van Der Linden and  Thijsse,  1965).


 7.2.2.1   Soil Thin-layer Chromatography


     The  relative mobility  of  organic  fraction  components may be determined
 by the technique  of  Helling  and Turner  (1968) and Helling   (1971).   This
 technique is  similar  to conventional  preparative  thin-layer  chromatography
 (TLC) except  that soil  is used as  the stationary phase  rather than materi-
als  such as silica gel  or  alumina.   Mobility  of  a given  substance  can  be
expressed  by  a  relative measure,  RF, which  describes  the   distance  tra-
versed  by  a  compound  divided  by  the distance  traversed by  the  wetting
front.   The  following  description outlines the  important aspects  of  the
procedure:

     (1)  'Soil materials  used are  those passing through a 500 mm sieve
          for  sandy  clays and coarser textured  soils,  or  250 Urn sieve
          for  fine loams  and  clay  soils.
     (2)  Plates  are air-dried  before  use.   A smooth,  moderately fluid
          slurry  is made of water and sieved soil  material and spread
          on  clean glass plates to uniform thicknesses of 500-750 ym
          for  fine textured  soils, and 750-1000  ym  for  the  coarser
          textured soils.
     (3)  A  horizontal   line  is etched  11.5 cm above  the the  base.
          Samples  are  spotted at  1.5  cm,  providing  a total  leaching
          distance of 10  cm.
     (4)  The  atmosphere  of  the   developing  chamber  is  allowed  to
          saturate and equilibrate  prior to  plate development.
     (5)  Plates are developed in a vertical  position  in  approximately
          0.5 cm water.   The bottom 1  cm may be covered with  a filter

                                    379

-------
          paper strip  to  reduce soil sloughing and maintain  the  soil-
          water contact.   Development continues until water  has  risen
          to the scribed  line at  11.5  cm.
     (6)  Movement  is  determined by  either  radioautograms for  radio-
          active materials or  scraping  and eluting  segments of  soil
          from the  10  cm  development distance.  Scraped  materials can
          be  easily eluted  with small  volumes  of  solvent  by  using
          capillary pipettes as elution  columns.
     (7)  Rp values are computed  and  correlated to  soil  properties.

Some drawbacks of soil TLC include  the following:

     (1)  soil particles  are oriented  in two dimensions;
     (2)  waste-soil  contact is  maximized,  most  closely  simulating
          intraaggregate  flow and negating the attenuating effects  of
          soil aggregation; and
     (3)  flow is  rapid  and  closer  to  steady  state conditions  thus
          minimizing adsorption-desorption kinetics effects.

Soil TLG  is  a useful  rapid  screening technique, but where  waste constit-
uents  are mobile  as  indicated  by Rp  values, soil column leaching  and
field  pilot  studies will  better  quantify mobility.   Soil column leaching
and  field  pilot  studies  will  provide more  accurate  predictive  data  since
conditions of these  studies  more  closely  resemble  conditions in  the actual
land treatment system.


7.2.2.2  Column Leaching
     Column leaching is an approximation  of  mobility under saturated condi-
tions.   It, like  the soil  TLC method  provides  a relative  index of  the
potential  for  leaching.   The  choice of  soils  to  be  tested should be  the
same as  that  used  for  soil  TLC.   At a  minimum,  duplicate columns  and  a
control  should  be used for  each waste/soil mixture  listed.   The  general
procedure is as follows:

     (1)  Glass columns  (2-3 cm  I.D.)  are  filled  with 20  cm  air-dry
          soil previously ground and  passed  through a 2 mm mesh sieve.
          Columns should be  constructed  of glass or  other nonreactive
          material which does not interfere  with the analyses.
     (2)  Columns are  filled slowly  with soil  and  tamped to a  bulk
          density approximating that in  the  field to  reduce  solution
          movement  by  direct  channel transport and  to  more  closely
          resemble field conditions.
     (3)  Applications of waste are made by mixing waste  with  a small
          amount  of  soil and  applying the  mix  to  the soil  surface.
          Alternatively,  the organic fraction  of  the waste  may  be
                                     380

-------
          applied  in a minimum amount of  solvent to  the top  of  the
          soil  in  the  column.

     (4)  Glass wool or a  filter  pad  is placed on the soil surface and
          leaching is  begun by adding at  least one  column  volume of
          water at a controlled rate  no faster than 1 ml/min.

     (5)  Effluents  are  analyzed  along  with  the  soil   extruded  and
          segmented at 2 cm intervals to  evaluate depth of penetration
          as  a function  of  the  effective  volume  partitioned.   The
          volume partitioned can be assumed to  be  the volume of water
          retained by  the  soil at field  capacity.    Thus an effluent
          volume equal to  the  volume of  water  retained  at 1/3 atmos-
          phere soil moisture  tension approximates 1 pore volume.

     (6)   Concentrations  of materials  in effluent are  determined  and
          plotted  against  cumulative  drainage  volume.

A  soil  column offers  a better  approximation  to  a natural system than does
soil TLC since  the column  provides  a  larger soil volume, larger aggregates,
and a more  random  particle  orientation.   Soil  column  leaching  tests, how-
ever, lack  the methodological  standardization  of soil TLC.

     The potential leaching hazard of  a given  waste in  a particular soil
can be  estimated from  consideration of  the following:

     (1)  the mobility of  waste constituents  relative to water;
     (2)  the  concentrations of constituents  observed  in the leachate
          and soil;

     (3)  the degradability of  mobile compounds;

     (4)  the flux and depth of soil  solution  percolate as observed in
          the field water  balance;  and

     (5)  the  toxicity  of  mobile  waste  constituents  as  determined
          using bioassay  techniques (Section  5.3.2.4).

Field  pilot  studies   may   be   needed  to  correlate  and   verify laboratory
results.   They are particularly  important when  laboratory  data  reveal  a
substantial leaching hazard.


7.2.3                          Volatilization
     Volatilization  is  mostly  important  for  those  compounds  with vapor
pressures  greater   than  ICT^m/Hg  at  room  temperature  (Weber,   1972).
Environmental variables  affecting volatility are soil moisture,  adsorption,
wind speed,  turbulence,  temperature  and  time (Farmer  et  al., 1972;  Hlice,
1948).  One mechanism of volatilization is evaporative transfer  from a  free
liquid  surface.   The potential  of  this mechanism  is  roughly equivalent  to
the purgable  and easily volatilized  fractions; however,  the  impact  should
be lessened  greatly upon waste-soil  mixing.  An  assessment of  volatiliza-


                                      381

-------
 tion should include this  aspect  of attenuation.  Within  a soil,  chemicals
 are not at a free liquid surface and vaporization is dependent upon distri-
 bution between air, water and solid surfaces.

      Volatilization of waste  constituents  or degradates may  be determined
 empirically by measuring  vapor  losses from a known  soil  surface  following
 waste application.  Laboratory investigations using  a  sealed, flow-through
 system should consider the following:

      (1)  the  effects of  application  technique  and  waste  loading
           rates;

      (2)  several soil moisture  contents,  including dry and wet soil;

      (3)  several temperatures,  including  the maximum expected surface
           soil temperature;

      (4)  variations in air  flow;  and

      (5)  changes in  volatilized  fraction composition  and flux  with
           time.

 Generally,  an air stream is  passed over the soil surface  and  through  solid
 sorbents such as  Tenax-GC or florisil  and  analyzed according to  Section
 5.3.2.3.2.   Results are computed  in both  concentration (mass/m^)  and flux
 terms (mass/nrV surface area).
 7.2.4                             Toxicity
      Treatability  tests  may include a determination of the  levels  at  which
 the  waste  becomes  toxic  to  plants  or  microbes  and/or  causes  genetic damage.
 These tests  provide an  additional  qualitative  measure  of  treatability.
 During the operation of  a land treatment unit, and after closure,  the bio-
 logical  tests may  also be used  to  monitor  environmental samples  to  evaluate
 waste degradation  and to ensure environmental protection.   In  addition  to
 the  tests  described  here  and in Section 5.3.2.4,  the procedure  of  Brown  et
 al.  (1979)  may be  used to evaluate aquatic toxicity prior to the release  of
 runoff or  leachate water  from the  site.  All samples  collected for  biologi-
 cal  analysis  should  be  frozen as  described in Section 5.3.2.1  and samples
 should be  processed  as soon  as is  possible after  collection.


 7.2.4.1  Acute Toxicity


     Before a hazardous waste is land applied, it is  a good idea to deter-
mine if the waste  will be  acutely  toxic to indigenous plants  and microbes.
Microbial  toxicity is particularly important when degradation  is one of the
objectives  of  treatment.   Methods for  evaluating toxicity are discussed
below and  toxicity testing  can  generally be combined  with any other waste-
site interaction study.
                                     382

-------
7.2.4.1.1    Microbial toxicity.   The mlcrobial  toxicity of  a waste-soil
mixture  can be  evaluated using  information  obtained from  a pour  plate
method which enumerates total viable heterotrophs and hydrocarbon utilizing
microorganisms.  This  involves  collecting  soil samples for microbial anal-
ysis before  waste  application  and  following incubation with  the  waste in
the respirometer.   One gram of a  soil  sample is placed in 99 ml  of phos-
phate buffer and mixed on a  magnetic stirrer  for  fifteen  minutes.  Subse-
quent dilutions are made  by  adding 1 ml of  the previous dilution  to 99 ml
of the buffer. Samples should be assayed  on four different media to deter-
mine the  total number of  soil  microorganisms.   Total viable heterotrophs
are enumerated using soil  extract  agar  (Odu and Adeoye, 1969) with 10 mg/1
of Amphoteracin B.  The  presence  of soil  fungi  is  determined using potato
dextrose agar (Difco)  or  soil extract agar with 30 mg/1 of rose bengal and
streptomycin.  Hydrocarbon utilizing bacteria and fungi may be detected by
replacing the carbon source  used in soil  extract agar with 6.25 g/1 silica
gel oil as  suggested  by  Baruah  et  al. (1967).  The  silica gel oil is pre-
pared for each waste stream  by  combining 5.0 g of the waste with  1.25 g of
fumed silica gel (Cab-o-sil, Cabot  Corporation).

     In order to retard spreading of mobile  organisms,  0.5 ml  of each dilu-
tion should be added to 2.5 ml  of soft agar  (0.75% agar), mixed on a vortex
mixer, and  poured  onto the hard agar surface.   Plates are incubated for  a
minimum of two weeks at the  temperature at which  the  soil  waste mixture was
incubated.   All estimations of viability should  be  assayed   in quadrupli-
cate.

     A second method for  evaluating microbial  toxicity developed by Beckman
Instruments, Inc.  is currently  being tested by the EPA to determine if the
procedure  can be  used as a rapid  screening  tool for assessing  the  land
treatability  of  a specific  hazardous  waste  and  as  a method to  determine
loading rates.  The Beckman  Microtox™ system measures the  light output  of  a
suspension of marine luminescent bacteria  before  and after a  sample of  haz-
ardous waste  is  added.  A reduction in  light output  reflects  a deteriora-
tion in the  health of  the organisms which signifies the presence  of  toxi-
cants in the waste (Beckman  Instruments,  Inc., 1982).

     Using  these,  or  other,  methods the acute toxic  effects  of  land treat-
ing a hazardous waste  on  endemic microorganisms  can be assessed.   By deter-
mining the  immediate effects of the waste  on soil microorganisms,  knowledge
is obtained which  can  aid in the determination of the maximum initial  load-
ing rate and in the evaluation  of  the respiration data (Section 7.2.1.2).


7.2.4.1.2   Phytotoxicity.   The phytotoxicity of  a  hazardous waste may  be
evaluated  in  a greenhouse study (Section  7.3) for the types  of vegetation
anticipated at the land  treatment  unit.   The greenhouse study should evalu-
ate the  toxic  effects  of  the waste at  various stages  of  growth,  including
germination,  root extension,   and  establishment.   Root  extension may  be
determined  for a water extract  of  the waste which has been degraded by soil
bacteria using  the procedures  of Edwards and  Ross-Todd (1980).  Plant bio-
concentration  for chronic toxicity to  humans via  the food  chain may  be
measured by  analyzing  an extract from plants grown in waste amended soil in

                                     383

-------
a  biological test  system.   Plant  activation of  nonmutagenic  agents into
mutagens has  been  demonstrated  by  Plewa and Gentile (1976), Benign!  et al.
(1979), Reichhart  et  al.  (1980), Matijesevic et al. (i960), Higashi  et al.
(1981), and Wildeman  et al. (1980).
7.2.4.2  Genetic Toxicity
     The  genetic toxicity  of  a waste-soil  mixture can  be  measured using
selected  bioassays  and following the same protocols  used to determine the
genetic  toxicity of  the  waste itself  (Section  5.3.2.4.2).    It  may be
desirable  to  separate the  organic  extract of the  waste into subfractions
(Section  5.3) for determining genetic toxicity.  Bioassays of samples taken
from  the  treated waste-soil mixture  at different  time periods  and  from
different  waste application rates  can be  compared  to bioassays  of  the
untreated  waste.   The  reduction   in  hazardous  characteristics  following
treatment  provides a qualitative measure of treatment.
7.3                         GREENHOUSE STUDIES
     Greenhouse studies are  designed to observe the effects of waste addi-
tions on plant emergence and growth.   Moreover, they can be used to assess
the acute and residual  toxicity  of the wastes to determine optimum loading
rates.   Greenhouse experiments may  also  aid  in selecting application  fre-
quencies and site management practices.

     In  many  cases,  the  concentration of  one or  more constituents  in a
waste, rather than the  bulk  application rate, may control plant responses.
Therefore,  research should  include a  characterization  of  which waste  com-
pounds are  phytotoxic and  a  determination of  the  residence  times of these
compounds  in  soils.   When  short-term growth  Inhibition is  caused  by a
rapidly  degradable  phytotoxin,  the quantity  of waste  which can be applied
in a single application is limited.  A more resistant substance in the  same
waste may  potentially accumulate to toxic  concentrations  If  the long-term
loading  of  this  substance  exceeds  the rate of degradation.   Thus, green-
house studies  of  plant responses  should be  designed  to  assess  the acute
toxicity of freshly applied  waste  and the toxicities and  degradation rates
of resistant compounds.
7.3.1                     Experimental Procedure
     One general approach to assessing plant toxicity in the greenhouse  in-
volves planting a given  species  in pots  containing soil mixed with  varying
quantities of waste.   The  choice of plant species  should  be based  on site
characteristics and  the  species which will  probably be  used to  establish
the permanent vegetative cover as  discussed In Section 8.7.  Control plant-
Ings receiving  no  waste must  be included, and  all pots  should be  ferti-

                                     384

-------
lized, watered and carefully maintained to ensure that the results observed
are related to the waste  additions.   Allen et al. (1976) is  a  good refer-
ence  on the  proper  care and  management of  greenhouse pot  experiments.
Since the toxicity effects are greatest before the fresh waste has begun to
decompose, the emergence and growth tests should consist of only one plant-
harvest cycle of  short  duration (30-45 days).   In practice,  management at
an HWLT unit is not striving for maximum yields; therefore, a waste concen-
tration is considered to be toxic when yields are reduced to levels between
50 and 75% of the control yields.  The toxic concentration of the waste or
waste fraction in soil is termed the "critical concentration" (


7.3.2                        Acute Phytoxicity


     Using the procedures of  7.3.1,  fresh wastes are applied  to  soil in a
range of concentrations in order to determine the critical concentration of
the waste.  This Ccr±t  value  may  be  used  in  conjunction with  half-life
(ti/2) determined from  respirometer  experiments  to establish loading rates
(kg/ha/yr) based on the total organic  fraction.   If  all of the organics in
the waste degrade at relatively the same rate, the loading rate established
in this  manner will be  valid for design purposes;  however,  most complex
organic mixtures found in hazardous waste streams do not degrade uniformly.
If a  loading rate  derived  from  the organic  fraction  half-life  is  used,
there  is  likely  to  be an  accumulation of  resistant  organic constituents
with  half-lives  longer than  the  half-life of the total organic fraction.
Regardless  of the  portion of  the  organic  fraction  which  is  ultimately
established as the rate  limiting  constituent (RLC),  expressed in kg/ha/yr,
the loading rate determined from the acute toxicity and degradation rate of
a fresh waste may still qualify the  total organic fraction as the applica-
tion limiting constituent (ALC), expressed in kg/ha/application.
7.3.3                     Residuals Phytotoxicity
     Some particularly resistant  organics,  if they are not toxic, may  pose
no special problems  if they  accumulate in soils.   If these resistant  com-
pounds are toxic when present in  large enough concentrations, then they may
limit the loading rate,  rather  than total organic fraction.  Gas chromato-
graphic (GC) analyses of applied  waste or wastes  incubated  in respirometers
can quantitatively establish the  half-lives of individual compounds and can
lead  to  qualitative determinations  of resistant  compounds by  such tech-
niques as GC-mass  spectrometry (GC-MS).  Phytotoxicity  of  these compounds
in a waste-soil environment can be determined by  spiking the raw waste  with
various concentrations of the pure compound or compounds, and repeating the
greenhouse study using the new mixtures.

     Spiking simulates the accumulation of  the compound in the land  treat-
ment  system  after  repeated waste applications,  at the rate established  by
the  organic  fraction degradation rate.   The concentration  which elicits
toxic responses by plants is the  Ccrit  value  for  that compound.   Two  pos-
sible scenarios are as follows:

                                     385

-------
      (1)  First, establish  an economical design  life (in  years)  for
           the   unit.     If   the  Ccrit  value   for  the   resistant
           compound would not  be  reached  during  this  design  life after
           applying waste  at  the rate established  using the  organic
           fraction degradation rate, then no hazard is posed.

      (2)  If the Ccrit  value  is  reached before  the  design life  is
           attained, or if no specific unit life is specified, then the
           resistant  toxic  compound  is  the  RLC   for   the  organic
           fraction.

      Therefore, greenhouse  toxicity data can be  used in conjunction with
 respirometer waste degradation  data  to  establish safe  HWLT unit  loading
 rates (Section 7.5.3.1.4).
 7.4                         FIELD PILOT STUDIES
      Field pilot studies  are  intended to  verify  laboratory results,  dis-
 cover any  unforeseen  methodological or  potential environmental  problems,
 and investigate  interactions  which cannot  be adequately  assessed in  the
 laboratory.  Field testing  is  the closest approximation to  actual operat-
 ing conditions,  and all  aspects of the  waste-site  system can be  observed as
 an integrated system.    In  addition  to  verifying  of  laboratory  results,
 field studies  may function as  follows:

      (1)   to evaluate  possible odor or  vapor  problems;

      (2)   to  provide  information  on  the  physical problems  associated
           with distribution and  soil  incorporation of  a  particular
           waste;

      (3)   to  evaluate  the possibility  of  applying greater amounts  of
           waste  than would appear possible from the available data or
           from greenhouse, respirometer or  column  studies;

      (4)   to evaluate  the  runoff  water  quality;

      (5)   to  provide  information  on  the  length of  time required  for
           the   runoff   water   quality   to  become   acceptable   for
           uncontrolled release;

      (6)   to  evaluate  the  fate  and  mobility  of  a  specific organic
           constituent  or  combination of constituents for which  little
           data are  available; and

      (7)   to evaluate  the compatibility  of a new waste  applied to a
           site previously used  for a different waste.

     Field  pilot studies  should  be  kept  small  and facilities  should be
available  to retain runoff just as  they  would be for  a fully  operational
HWLT  system.   The EPA. permit  regulations  contain  certain requirements  for
conducting demonstration studies  (EPA,  1982).   Typically, plots should  not
be  greater than  500 m2,  although there may  occasionally be justification
                                     386

-------
for larger areas where  special  equipment for waste application or incorpo-
ration activities requires additional  space.   While field tests often pro-
vide much better data  than laboratory or greenhouse  tests,  they are often
more costly to  conduct.   Also,  fewer  variables,  such as application rate,
frequency or  alternate  treatments,  can  be  tested.    Furthermore,  uncon-
trolled variables,  such as temperature,  rainfall and wind, make  the data
more difficult to interpret.

     Application rates  to be used  in pilot  studies  must be based  on the
best available  information and  be  developed in accordance with appropriate
procedures.  If one of  the objectives  is to test the feasibility of appli-
cation rates greater than those that were  indicated  by the laboratory and
greenhouse information,  it  is often advisable  to  select waste application
rates of 2, A and  possibly  8  times the optimal  rate.   Precautions must be
taken,  however, to  protect  groundwater  from  mobile  waste  constituents
loaded onto the soil.
7.4.1                           Degradation


     Degradation of  organic  waste materials in  the  field should be evalu-
ated by  determining  the residual  concentration of  these  materials in the
treatment zone.  The soil should be analyzed for the hazardous constituents
and  perhaps  for general classes  of organics,  including  total  organics as
suggested in Section 5.3.2.3.2.   Sampling  procedures should be the same as
for  functioning  HWLT units.   Samples should be  taken on  a  schedule that
allows maximum sampling during the  period of maximum degradation.   Typical-
ly,  a geometric  sampling schedule of  0,  1, 2, 4, 8,  16,  etc.   weeks after
application is appropriate.


7.4.2                            Leachate
     Leachate  water  should be  collected  from below  the  treatment zone as
will  be  done when monitoring  an operating HWLT  unit.    Samples  should be
collected  at  sufficiently frequent  intervals to be  representative  of the
water leaching below the normal  root zone depth.  Typical  leachate sampling
depths are 1  to 1.5 m below the  soil  surface.   This  ensures an adequate
zone  of  aerated  soil for decomposition and  plant uptake.   Any waste  con-
stituents  moving  below the 1 to  1.5 m depth will usually continue  to the
water  table since  oxygen  availability,  microbial  populations  and  plant
uptake decrease markedly below  this  depth.


7.4.3                             Runoff


     Runoff water should be collected and analyzed  if these  data  are needed
to evaluate  treatability or the  potential  for release.   The water may  be
collected  from retention  areas  if this method is appropriate  for  the  site.


                                    387

-------
 If  several  treatment  rates  or  options  are  being  tested,  it  may be  necessary
 to  have  different retention areas for each treatment or to install  devices
 that  will collect representative  samples as  they flow  from  each plot before
 they  reach  the retention basin.   Runoff  water  should  be  analyzed  for  the
 constituents   to   be   included in  the  discharge   permit,   the  hazardous
 constituents  of  the waste,  and for the biological activity  of the  water.
 7.4.4                     Odor  and Volatilization
      If  the objective of the  test is to  evaluate  odor problems,  periodic
 field evaluations  should be made by an  odor  panel  as described in  Section
 8.4.2.   Panel observations should  be  scheduled  at  frequent intervals  fol-
 lowing waste  application and mixing activities.   Again, a  geometric sampl-
 ing  schedule  may be appropriate.  If the  pilot  test  is  to provide  data  on
 volatilization,  the gases  emanating  from the surface  should  be  collected
 and  periodically sampled.   A more detailed discussion of volatilization  is
 provided  in Section 7.2.3
7.4.5                 Plant Establishment and Uptake
     If the objective of the test  is  to evaluate  revegetation potential  and
plant uptake, it may be  desirable  to  plant several species and to  try both
seeds  and sprigs  for  species that  can be  planted either way.    Planting
should  not be  initiated until  the  waste  has  been repeatedly  mixed  and
allowed  to degrade.   If  initial plantings  fail,  the  species  should  be
replanted  after further mixing and adjustment of  nutrients  and  soil pH.   If
water  is  the  limiting factor during  germination and emergence,  it may  be
desirable  to mulch and irrigate  the  site  to assist establishment.   If bio-
accumulation  is  a  concern,  plants  should  be  harvested and  analyzed  for
accumulated waste constituents.
7.5                      INTERPRETATION OF RESULTS
     Waste-soil interaction studies generate a variety of data  that  must  be
carefully Interpreted  to  determine treatment  feasibility, acceptable waste
loads,  special  management needs,  and  monitoring criteria.   Since  experi-
ments  should have  been conducted  using the  bulk waste,  synergistic and
antagonistic  effects  have  been  considered over  the  short-term  and for
mobile  or degradable species.  However,  the effect  of long-term accumula-
tion of  some waste constituents, especially metals,  cannot  be established
from such condensed investigations.  Additionally,  only scant information
exists  regarding  the joint  toxic effects of several accumulated compounds
or elements.   In  any  case,  the interpretation  of  results  from literature
review, experimental work and/or operational experience may safely consider
each important waste constituent independently.
                                     388

-------
7.5.1                  Feasibility and Loading Rates


     Treatment feasibility and loading rates are closely related and can be
tentatively ascertained  from data generated  from  tests described  in  Sec-
tions  7.2  through  7.4.    Practically any  hazardous  waste may  be  land
treated,  although allowable  waste application rates  may  require excessive
land area commitments.  Consequently, feasibility is essentially an econom-
ic decision based  on allowable loading rates.   The loading  rates,  on the
other  hand, are established by  calculating  the acceptable  rates  for  each
waste constituent and adopting the most restrictive value.

     A central  concept  to  the  understanding of waste  loading rates is the
way in which  waste  constituents  behave  in the given  land  treatment unit.
Basically,  the behavior of any given  constituent at a given site will fall
within one  of the following categories:

     (1)  the constituent  is  readily degradable or mobile  and  can be
          applied  to  soil at  such  a  rate  that  the  concentration
          approaches some steady  state value;
     (2)  the constituent  is  very rapidly lost from  the  soil system,
          but  overloading  in  a  single  application  may cause  acute
          hazards to human health or the environment; or
     (3)  the constituent is not  degraded  appreciably or is  relatively
          immobile and  thus, successive waste applications  will cause
          the concentration in soil to increase.

     The waste fraction that controls seasonal loading rates  (Case  1 above)
is referred to as the  rate  limiting  constituent  (RLC).    Once  the RLC is
determined, the land  area  required  to treat  the given  waste can be deter-
mined  simply  by dividing  yearly  waste receipts (kg/yr)  by the acceptable
waste loading rate (kg/ha/yr) based on the RLC.

     In Case  2  above,  where  a constituent limits the amount of waste that
may be applied in  a single dose,  yet the  constituent is  either rapidly
decomposed, lost from  the  system, or  immobilized,  it is labeled the appli-
cation limiting constituent (ALC).   The  ALC sets  the minimum  number of
applications  that can  be  safely made  during a  given  waste  application
season (see Section 3.3.3  for  discussion  of  waste  application season).  If
the waste contains an ALC, then the minimum number  of applications  per year
is found  by dividing  the  waste loading rate  determined  using the RLC (kg/
ha/yr) by the waste  application  limit basis on the ALC (kg/ha/application)
and rounding to the next higher integer.   In  some cases, the  ALC may be the
same as the RLC.

     The final parameter (Case 3  above) needed for  determining waste appli-
cation constraints  is  what  is  termed the  capacity  limiting constituent
(CLC).  This  fraction  of  the  waste  is a conservative, accumulating  species
and sets  the  upper boundary  for the  total  quantity of waste  that may be
treated at  a  given  site (kg  waste/ha).  For  a waste  that contains a  large
                                     389

-------
concentration of a given metal, this metal may be both the CLC and the RLC.
However,  many  industrial wastes  have a  low metals  content so  that some
organic  compound,  water,  or other constituent may  control  the application
rate while  a metal may be  the CLC.   The CLC controls  the  maximum  design
life of  the land  treatment  unit  unless  some arbitrarily shorter  life is
chosen.  Maximum design life  is found by  dividing the CLC controlled waste
loading  capacity (LCAPCLC)  expressed  in kg/ha by the design  loading rate
(LR) based on the RLC and expressed in kg/ha/yr.   Section 7.5.4 more  clear-
ly defines this relationship.


7.5.2            Management Needs and Monitoring Criteria


     During  the  course of  the pilot  studies which  include the necessary
treatment demonstration tests  (EPA,  1982),  conditions that  influence waste
treatment are defined and waste consituents  that present a significant risk
to  the  treatment  process  or  the environment  are  identified.   Special
management needs  identified during  pilot studies may  include application
techniques and  timing,  pH  control,  fertility control,  and  soil aeration.
Further  evidence gained from the treatment demonstration will dictate which
of the waste constituents  should be  monitored and will  determine  how the
operational  program may  be  streamlined  or  simplified.   All  hazardous
constituents  (Appendix  B)   of  the  waste  must   be  monitored  unless  key
constituents can be  demonstrated  to indicate  the  success of the treatment
processes.  These indicators are termed principle hazardous  constituents or
PHCs (EPA, 1982).  PHCs to  be monitored should definitely include sampling
and analysis for the constituents that have  been indicated as the ALC, RLC,
and CLC.   Chemical analyses  and  the  less specific  toxicity bioassays are
appropriate analytical approaches to monitoring.


7.5.3    Calculating Waste Loads Based on Individual  Constituents


     As  previously noted,   results  of pilot  studies  are  interpreted con-
sidering each waste constituent independently.  The following sections deal
with the methods and considerations involved when the entire range of waste
constituents are evaluated for the design of  the HWLT units.  Some elements
and compounds  are  discussed specifically  while others are  addressed by
classes  according  to their  similar behavior.   The  constituents  are dis-
cussed in  order  from most  concern to least  concern  for the  treatment of
hazardous constituents.   For example,  organics  are  discussed  first since
the organic  fraction of the  waste is often the main reason  for choosing
HWLT.   Where hazardous  organics are land treated,  waste loading should be
designed so  that degradation  is maximized.   Sample calculations for  deter-
mining waste loading are presented in Appendix E.


7.5.3.1  Organics


     Most hazardous waste streams  that are  land  treated contain a sizeable
organic  fraction   and  degradation  of organics  is  usually  the principal


                                     390

-------
objective for  land treating wastes.   The  range  of possible  hazards  from
waste organics can be generally  categorized as  the acute or chronic toxic-
ity to soil  biota, plants  and  animals,  or  the immediate  danger  of  fire or
explosion.   The potential  pathways  for  loss of organics  that  must  be  con-
sidered include volatilization, leaching, runoff and degradation.  Although
the pathways are  interrelated, they  are acted on  by  different  mechanisms
and should  be considered  separately.   Waste  application rates, both per
application  (ALC) and per  year  (RLC), are established  by adopting the  most
restrictive  rate  calculated froa the four  pathways; each of which further
discussed below.  Plant uptake should also  be considered if vegetation will
be used as a part of  the  ongoing management plan.   Figure 7.4 illustrates
the format for assessing organics.
7.5.3.1.1  Volatilization.  Volatility experiments can yield information on
vapor concentrations in the atmosphere above  a soil,  as  a function of soil
moisture,  temperature,  surface  roughness, wind  speed,   temperature  lapse
rate, waste  loading  rate,  or  application technique.   The acceptable appli-
cation  rate  under a given  set of management  and  environmental conditions
may be established using air quality standards, mutagenicity assays, and/or
information  on concentrations  that may cause combustion.  If an appreciable
quantity of  the  waste  is volatile  and hazardous, the quantities  of waste
per application  may  be  limited and  the  volatile constituent  would be the
ALC.  The  interpretation  of  test  results  in  this  case would specify suit-
able waste application techniques and timing.


7.5.3.1.2  Leaching.   If  laboratory leaching  tests  show the potential for
significant  movement of some constituents  or their metabolites, field lysi-
meters or leachate samplers beneath an undisturbed soil  profile may be used
to establish safe waste loading rates.  For a  mobile hazardous organic com-
pound,  loading rates should be controlled to  avoid  statistically  signifi-
cant increases of  the compound in leachate water  or  soil below the treat-
ment  zone.   Both  the  mobility  and degradability  of an organic  compound
influence  the  degree  of  hazard  from  leaching.   For  instance,  where   a
compound is  highly mobile,  but rapidly degradable in soil, calculations of
application  limits should  be  made on a  single application basis to reduce
the leaching hazard, and the compound is,  therefore, a potential ALC.  More
stable  constituents  that  could potentially leach in the system may limit
applications on  a yearly basis and may be  the  RLC.


7.5.3.1.3  Runoff.   Since runoff water must be collected and either treated
or reapplied,  hazards  from waste constituents in the runoff  do not exert
any  control  on  the  application rate.   For  waste  fractions which may be
eroded by  surface  water,  the  emphasis with respect  to  runoff  is to recom-
mend management  practices  that will minimize erosive waste transport.  The
degree  of  management required is,  therefore,  a function of  the degree of
hazard presented by  mobile  waste  components.   In many cases,  the increased
management intensity will be more  than  compensated  by  decreases in runoff
water treatment  requirements.
                                     391

-------
LO
^O
ro
                  »olatlllty
Aaeeea cooceetratlone In
  «lr
    1.  Uat aoll
    2.  ftrr aott
for a range of loading
  rat** ond tee»erat«rea.
                       _>ar» with air
               tnalltjr otaadarda for
               and flro/*Rploaton
               ••cord.
            2. Otroolc-wtagaalcltjr.
        «nd an liable
   appllcntloa tcchnl«w«
   •nd ttadng.
2.  Calculate •mime) nnfe
   mat* lead per
                                        f«r • ring* of le«4t^ rit«
                                        field Irslaettrs «r UrrcL
                            1.  Ae«t«-4rlMklii(. trcl-
                               fBCl«« (MWEBl MM
                                              T<*t t« «A1
                                              t !(•#•«(• «r«
                                                                     FI«U flmtm
                                                                     I. Afrly «
                                                                     2. MB with voll
                                                                                                2.
                                                                                                3.
                                                                                               ever
                                                                                  C«lcul«t* lulf-
                                                                                  llf« ol *«tract•
                                                                                  •bl* orgMlc*
                                                                                       C02 wi»-
                                                            tarnanaail 'a par application and o per year loading
                                                            rate by chooalag the loveat valnea Iron the above
                                                                                                              Calculate lo**-
                                                                                                              tata (par £•»)
                                                                                                              b«a«4 «• hall-
                                                                                                              Ill., pfcyto-
                                                                                                              t«xlcit]pt and
                                                                                                              tnlcltr to
                                                                                                                                   fhytot&alclty
                                                                                                                                Cr«*nbow*« or growth
                                                                                                                                       nd (laid
                                                                                                                    of loading cataa.
Catobllah thc«ikold
l*««la for tb* d«(r«i
of aceaptabl* ylald
rodwctloa.
                         Figure  7.4.    A  comprehensive testing  format  for  assessing  the  interactions
                                               of organic  waste  constituents with  soil.

-------
7.5.3.1.4    Degradability.    Degradation  of  organics may  be  the  major
objective for land treating a waste;  consequently,  pilot  studies emphasize
the characterization of this mechanism by which  organics  are lost  from the
HWLT  system.    Degradability  greenhouse   and/or   field  studies  should
establish  the  following  three  facts  about  the  behavior  of  the  waste
organics in the given land treatment system:

     (1)  the quantity of waste that  can be  applied to a  unit of soil
          in a  single  application  to achieve the best  overall system
          performance;

     (2)  the half-lives (tj/2) of tne tullc organics, organic subfrac-
          tions, or specific organic constituents, leading to a deter-
          mination of  the constituents that  are  a)  most resistant  and
          b) present in significant concentrations in the waste; and

     (3)  the threshold concentrations in  soil  at  which  these resis-
          tant fractions cause unacceptable  toxicity to either plants
          or, more importantly, waste degrading  soil microorganisms.

     Given these data, a long-term waste loading rate can be calculated for
the  waste  based  on  the  organic  fraction  that  is  found to  be  the most
restrictive.  The half-lives for several oily wastes, as determined  either
by residual  carbon  analysis  or by monitoring  CC>2  evolution, are presented
in Table 7.2.  The results obviously  depend  on the  type of oily waste, the
application  rate, and,  in some cases, the  method  of  analysis.   The half-
lives, which range from 125-600 days, indicate the need for determinations
on the particular waste proposed for  land  treatment.  The treatment  demon-
stration should include tests to determine the half-life of  the waste under
conditions as near as possible to those expected in  the field.  The degrad-
ability of  the  organic fraction of a waste may cause  that  fraction to  be
the RLC.   In addition, toxicity results may further classify some organic
fractions  as the ALC.   It  should  be  noted  that   two  entirely  different
organic fractions or constituents in  the waste may  function  respectively  as
the RLC and  the ALC.

     The choice of an  appropriate  half-life is critical to  the analysis  of
degradability.   Depending  on  waste characteristics, one  of  three  t^/2
values may be chosen.  If degradation is shown to be fairly  uniform  for all
classes of organics  in the  waste,  the t^/2  of tne  solvent extractables can
be used.   If a  given class  of compounds which constitutes a  large  portion
of the waste is particularly  resistant to decomposition, the  tj/2 ^or  that
class can  be used.   Finally,  if  a specific compound  is  present in  a  high
concentration and is only slowly degradable,  the tj/2  for  that compound can
be used.

     In all  three cases,  "large" or  "high"  concentrations  of  constituents
do not indicate  merely a  quantitative ranking or comparison.   Instead, the
comparison  also considers the  relative  toxicities  of  the  constituents  to
decomposer organisms  and, in  some  cases,  plants.   To  sustain  long-term use
of a land  treatment  unit, buildup  to unacceptably  high levels of  constitu-
ents that  are toxic  to decomposer  organisms should  be  avoided.  Otherwise,
the  system may fall  short  of  the  treatment  objective.   Where  integrated


                                     393

-------
TABLE 7.2  SOIL HALF-LIFE OF SEVERAL OILY WASTES AS DETERMINED BY VARIOUS METHODS
Application
Waste Rate (%)
Dissolved Air
Flotation
Dissolved Air
Flotation
Dissolved Air
Flotation
API-Separator
(refinery)
API-Separat or
(refinery)
API-Separator
(petrochemical )
API-Separator
(petrochemical)
Crankcase oil
Oil sludge
Oil sludge
10
20
9
5
5
5
5
10
5
5
Half-life
(days)
261
372
125
130
143
600
264
237
570
356
Method of Determination
CO 2 evolution
C02 evolution
Residual carbon (field)
Q>2 evolution
Residual carbon (lab)
C02 evolution
Residual carbon (lab)
Residual carbon (lab)
C02 evolution
Residual carbon (lab)
Reference
Brown (unpublished
Ibid.
Ibid.
data)


Brown, Deuel, & Thomas (1982)
Ibid.
Ibid.
Ibid.
Raymond , Hudson , &
(1976)
Dibble and Bartha
Ibid.



Jamison
(1979)


-------
cover  crop management  Is  included  in the  operating plan,  phytotoxicity
should also be determined.  The phytotoxicity threshold is considered to be
the concentration of the waste  or  constituents  that reduce plant yields to
about 50%  of  controls.   Yield reductions greater than this  are an indica-
tion  that  management  to  provide  a protective  crop cover  will  be  quite
difficult.

     Two  types  of  management  plans  are  described which  represent  the
extremes of management  for HWLT units.  In the  first  case,  the management
plan includes  a  temporary  plant cover over the  active  treatment area,  and
in  the  second  case,  a vegetative cover  is  not   established until  the
initiation of  closure  activities (see Section 8.7  for  guidance on vegeta-
tive  management  options).   Loading  rate  calculations  for  the  two  plans
would be as follows:

     (1)  When vegetation is  a  part of ongoing  management plan, toxic
          organics, exhibiting either microbial or plant toxicity, may
          limit  the  loading  rate.   Assuming that  loading  rates  are
          relatively constant so that the designed area is adequate to
          handle each year's  waste  production,  the  following equation
          applies:

                                 */2 c
                                                                      (7.6)
                            yr      tl/2

     where

             Cyr = the rate of application of the compound or fraction
                   of interest to soil (kg/ha/yr);
          Ccrit  = tne critical concentration of the compound or
                   fraction in soil at which unacceptable microbial
                   toxicity or plant yield reduction occurs (kg/ha);
                   and
            tl/2 ™ half-life (yr)

     The loading rate is then calculated as follows:


                                                                      (7.7)
     where
          LR » loading rate (kg/ha/yr); and
          Cw • concentration of the compound or fraction of
               interest in the bulk waste (kg/kg).
                                     395

-------
           If  ti/2 is  less  than one year, then the year's loading rate
           should  be applied in more than one application.  To calcu-
           late  the number  of applications let l/tj/2 equal the small-
           est  t|/2 and use the following equation:

                                  NA = l/ti/2                          (7.8)


     where

           NA =  number of  applications /year.

     (2)   When  a  vegetated surface is desired  only after site closure
           begins,  then applications of waste may  exceed the phytotox-
           icity threshold  value.  The only  constraints would  be that
           the microbial toxicity threshold not  be  exceeded and that a
           final vegetative cover can be  established after a given num-
           ber   of years following the beginning of closure.  Calcula-
           tions are as follow:

                           cmax " Ccrit  2                      (7.9)

     where
           Cmax  =  t*ie  maximum allowable concentration of the compound
                  fraction  of interest applied  to the soil (kg/ha);
              n  =  number  of  years  between final waste application and
                  crop establishment (yr); and
           ti/2  -  half -life  (yr).
     After  Cjjgjj  is  determined, loading rates  are  calculated by apply-
     ing  equations  7.6  and  7.7 substituting C^^ for Ccrit in equation
     7.6.   For wastes with  very short half -lives,  the  resulting load-
     ing  rate may appear  to be excessive; however, assuming that other
     factors  are  held  constant,  a  high  Cmax merely indicates that
     organics will  not  be limiting.   The  calculated C^x should not be
     interpreted  literally  in  such  cases.   Before  such  high  rates of
     application  are reached,  some  other  parameter  Is  likely  to  be
     limiting;  this  possibility  will  need  to  be  evaluated.    For
     instance, degradation  of waste organics  may  be inhibited at much
     lower  levels than  CmaK due to wetness  and  the  resulting loss  of
     soil aeration.
7.5.3.2  Water


     Most land  treatable  wastes have a high water  content,  and even fairly
viscous sludge may  contain  greater than 75% water.   Therefore, particularly
in humid  regions,  waste  water may  be  the RLC.   Using  the climatological
data  on   precipitation  and   evapotranspiration  and   soil  permeability


                                     396

-------
information from Section 4.1.1.5,  a water  balance  model may  be  developed  as
discussed in Section 8.3.

     The two keys  to properly  using  the water balance models for  the  given
site are  first, determining  the  waste application  season  (Section  3.3.3)
and, second,  deciding  on  a water management  scheme  (Section  8.3).   The
waste  application  season depends  on  whether  cover  crops are  to be  grown
during, or only after,  active  treatment.   Determination  of the  waste  appli-
cation season is essentially  the  same  for  both options except  that where  no
cover crop will be grown during the active life  of the HWLT  unit,  phytoxic-
ity need not be considered.   The waste can accumulate with  little degrada-
tion of organics but  without  presenting a phytotoxicity,  leaching, volati-
lization, or runoff  hazard,  then  the  waste  application  season  is  based  on
the period  of  time  when water  may be  readily applied.    If  accumulation
leads  to  phytotoxicity or environmental hazards,  then the  season  is  based
on  the  time that  degradation effectively begins  and  ends, generally when
soil temperature  is  >5°C and  soil moisture can be  maintained  at  or  below
field capacity.  The water  balance model can  be integrated  over the  appli-
cation  season  to yield the  depth of  water  (l^O) that  may be  applied  per
year to maintain the  average  soil moisture content  at field capacity.  The
waste  analysis  shows  the  percent water  by  volume  and  the waste  density
(kg/liter).   Therefore,  the  waste  loading   rate on  the  basis  of  water
content is:
                             LR =__JL_X p                           (7.10)
where

        LR » loading  rate  (kg/ha/yr);
             volumetric  1^0 loading rate (1/ha/yr), noting that I cm
             depth  -  105 1/ha;
     FHoO  ™ fraction of waste  constituted by water; 1/1 and;
          P - waste  density (kg/1).

Field  capacity, defined  elsewhere (7.2.1.1.2.1),  is  chosen  because  it  is
the  optimum  soil moisture  content for organics  degradation  and decreasing
the  likelihood  of pollutant leaching.
7.5.3.3 Metals
     Metals  management  strives  to  permanently  sorb the  applied elements
within  the  soil so that no  toxicity hazard results.   Some elements  (e.g.,
molybdenum  and selenium)  may  cause  environmental  damage  through leaching
since  these  elements  occur  as  anions  in  the soil  system.    Leaching  of
mobile  anions should be considered  in a manner  similar to halide leaching
(7.5.3.7).    Toxicity assessment should  account  for  phytotoxicity,  food
chain  effects, and direct  ingestion of  soil  by  grazing  animals.   Section
                                     397

-------
 6.1.6 provides background  information on metals  and  suggests maximum  con-
 centrations  that may be safely  added to soils.   These amounts  are  cumula-
 tive  totals  for those metals for which no significant  movement occurs.   The
 capacity of  a given soil to immobilize  a particular element  can  vary  some-
 what  from the limits suggested  in the tables  in Section 6.1.6;  therefore,
 in all cases,  the  associated  discussions and  literature references  should
 be consulted.   At  this  stage,   one  must have  consciously  decided  upon  a
 general  management plan in  order to  choose whether metal limits  should  be
 based on phytotoxicity  or  toxicity  to  decomposer  organisms.   Many  metals
 are  essentially  untested  at  high concentrations  in  the  soil  environment
 simply because,  historically,  there  have  been no  major  cases where  these
 metals have  contaminated the soil.   However,  the increasing uses  for  vari-
 ous  elements in  industry indicates  that some  land  treated  wastes may  con-
 tain  high concentrations of metals.   Therefore,  a data  base  is  needed  on
 many  elements  both from the standpoint  of  basic research and  from observed
 interactions in natural  systems.

      Accumulation of  metals will  often  be  the  factor  that  controls  the
 total amount of waste that may  be  treated per  unit area.  Therefore,  even
 if another  waste constituent limits  loading  rates,  a metallic element  fre-
 quently  is  the capacity limiting  constituent.   To compare metals  to  deter-
 mine  the element potentially  limiting total waste  applications  (potential
 CLC),  one can simply calculate  the following  ratio for  each  metal  in  the
 waste:

 Metal loading  ratio  = Metal loading  capacity (mg metal/kg soil)      (7>u)
                      Metal content of the waste residual solids
                                    (mg metal/kg RS)

 Metal loading  capacity  is  determined for  each  metal from Section  6.1.6  and
 Table 6.46.    The residual   solids  (RS)   determination  is found  in  Section
 5.3.2.3.2.2.   If  the  ratio  is  in all  cases less than or equal  to  1,  then no
 metal will  ever  limit the  useful life of  the  land treatment  unit.    Where
 one or more  of  the  ratios are  greater than 1, then  the metal  with the  larg-
 est ratio is  the  potential  CLC.

      All  of  the  allowable metal  load may  be  applied during  any  chosen  time
 frame  (e.g., a  single  application;  continuously for  ten years;  or  incre-
 mentally  over  a twenty  year period,  etc.).   However,  other constituents  in
 the waste may  limit  the  rate at  which the waste is  applied.
7.5.3.4  Nitrogen
     The  following estimates  of  nitrogen  (N)  additions and  losses from  a
land  treatment unit  (Table 7.3),  are used  to  calculate  a  nitrogen  mass
balance equation.   Actual  values  for a  given  site can  be  estimated  using
the guidance given in Section  6.1.2.1.
                                    398

-------
TABLE 7.3  NITROGEN MASS BALANCE
     Inputs
                                     Removals
   Total N in waste
   N in precipitation
   N fixation
   Mineralization
   Nitrification
                                     Denitrification
                                     Volatilization of ammonia
                                     N storage in soil
                                     Leaching
                                     Runoff
                                     Crop uptake
                                     Immobilization
Inputs  of  nitrogen  must equal  nitrogen  removals  to  maintain  acceptable
levels of nitrates in runoff or leachate.

     The  comprehensive  equation  presented  below  includes  a  number   of
factors in the mass balance calculation.   The depth of  waste application  is
computed by  taking  the  sum of  the N  involved  in crop  uptake,  leaching,
volatilization,  and  denitrification,  subtracting the N from rainfall, and
then  dividing by  the N concentration of  the  waste.   When  using this
equation,  estimates   of  denitrification  and volatilization must  also   be
made.  The equation is written as  follows:
LR - 105  1Q (C + V + D) + (LdXLc) -  (Pd)(Pc)

                     I +  1  (M)(0)
                                                                    (7.12)
where

     LR - waste loading rate  (kg/ha/yr);
     C « crop uptake of N  (kg/ha/yr);
     V - volatilization (kg/ha/yr);
     D - denitrification (kg/ha/yr);
     L(j • depth of leachate (cm/yr);
     Lc • solute (N) concentration  in  leachate  (mg/1);
     P
-------
 standard  for NC^-N.   If the  land  treatment unit  does not harvest  a crop
 from  the  active site, the plant  uptake term is  removed  from the equation.
 For comparison  purposes, nitrogen may qualify as the RLC.
7.5.3.5  Phosphorus
     Phosphorus  (P)  is  effectively  retained  in  soil  as  are  the  metals,
except  that  the  soil has  a  taore easily  determined  finite P  adsorption
capacity.   This adsorption  capacity can be estimated from Langmuir isotherm
data.  The  calculations  must  include  the horizontal area (ha), depth to the
water table (cm),  and the previous treatment  of  the soil at  the  site.   It
is  expected that  complete renovation  occurs  in the root zone,  or within a
depth of 2 m (Beek and  de  Haan,  1973).   Although the effect  of  organic
matter and  long-term precipitation reactions  on  the P adsorption potential
are  not  well understood,  the profile  distribution of  aluminum,  iron,  and
calcium  may greatly influence sorption capacity.   It is therefore necessary
to  calculate  the total permissible waste load as  a function of the sorption
capacity of each  soil horizon.   The  loading capacity  can  be  calculated as
follows:

                         LCAP  - 10 E diPCb^ - Pex)                  (7.13)


where

     LCAP = loading capacity  (kg P/ha);
       di - thickness of the  i tntioi:izQtvi)
         P = bulk density of  soil (g/cm3);
     bmax = apparent sorption capacity estimated  from Langmuir
            isotherm (ug/g);  and
      Pex = HaHC03~extractable phosphorus reported on a dry weight
            basis  (Ug/g).

Total phosphorus  application  is the   sum of  the  values for  all  horizons.
This total  permissible   load  may be divided at the discretion  of  the  site
manager  who must  consider  the life  of both  the  industrial  plant  and  the
disposal  site.   Once this  calculated  capacity is  reached,  applied  P  may
leach without attenuation to shallow  grovmdwateT,  consequently, phosphorus
may  be the  CLC.
7.5.3.6  Inorganic Acids, Bases  and Salts
     The  accumulation  of  salts  and  the  associated  soil  physical  and
chemical  problems,  are  primary management   concerns  when  land  treating
acide,  bases,  and  salts  or  other  wastes  having  significant  incidental
concentrations  of  these constituents.  Excessive  applications  of acidic or
basic wastes  may necessitate, mitigation  of   tae  adverse  affects  on soil.
                                    400

-------
For example, lime may be used  to  control  soil  pH where waste acids are land
treated.

     In any case, no broadly satisfactory method has  yet been developed for
quantifying salt behavior  in soil so that waste loading rates can be deter-
mined.   Consequently,  management of salts must consider two  broad cases.
In the  first  case,  water inputs  or  soil  drainage are  inadequate  and salts
are conserved  and  accumulate  in  the surface  soil.    Salts  would  therefore
behave  as a CLC, where  limits  are determined  based on toxicity to plants or
waste decomposer organisms.  See  Section  6.1.4 for methods of salt measure-
ment and salt  tolerance  of variuos crops.  Total  waste loads (kg/ha) would
be based on  the  given  management plan.   In the second  case,  adequate site
drainage is present or  can be  artifically provided,  salt  can be  an RLC and
some type of model  would be needed  to calculate loading rates with ground-
water quality  criteria  serving as the limits  for  leachate quality.  Since,
as stated  in Section 6.1.4, no satisfactory model is currently available,
consultation  with  a soil  scientist  having salt  management  experience is
recommended.   Where a  sodium   imbalance  in the waste  could  threaten soil
structure and  cause  associated problems,  the  waste loading rate will still
be  controlled by  salt  content,  but  additional  salinity may  result from
amendments added to control  the cation balance.
7.5.3.7  Halides
     A halide  may qualify as the  RLC  because loading  rates  should be con-
trolled  to maintain  acceptable  groundwater  quality  and these  anions will
leach readily  from the  soil.  Calculations  are  similar in many respects  to
those for  the  nitrogen  model.   Determinations  may be  modified  to account
for precipitation into  less  soluble forms, such as CaF2«

     Two  halide  management   cases are  possible,  depending  on  the   site.
Where water  inputs or soil drainage are not adequate to remove these  anions
by leaching, concentrations  of  available halides will build up in  soil.   In
this case, assuming salt buildup does  not physically damage the soil  struc-
ture, the  halide  can behave as a CLC,  with  limits  based on  toxicity  to
plants or  microbes (see Section 6.1.5).   Calculations  would be the same  as
for metals.  In  the second  case, conditions would be favorable for leaching
to occur and the given  halide would be a potential RLC.  A halide  will have
little interaction with the  soil matrix and should therefore leach readily.
Additionally,  it is assumed  that repeated waste applications will  allow  the
system  to  be  approximated  by a steady  state  solution, and  the  following
equation can be  used:

                                 (Ld)(Lc) x  105
                           LR =   d   ?	                        (7.14)
                                     401

-------
where

     LR = waste  loading  rate  (kg/ha/yr);
     Lj = depth  of  leachate  (cm/yr);
     LC = solute (halide)  concentration in leachate (mg/1); and
      I = concentration  of halide  in  the  waste (mg/1 on a wet weight
          basis).

The  Lc  term  should be  chosen based  on  water quality  standards  or  other
criteria (see Section  6.1.5).
7.5.4   Design Criteria  for  Waste  Application and Required Land Area
     Following  the  independent  consideration  of  each  waste  constituent
which  may cause  an environmental  hazard,  a comparison  must  be made  to
determine the most  limiting constituents.  For  a given waste  and site, the
procedure for  identifying  the ALC  and RLC is straightforward  once loading
rates and capacities have  been  established for each component  of the waste.
Information should  be  organized  into  a tabular format similar  to Table 7.4,
where each waste  constituent and  its associated waste loading  rate  (based
on the wet weight  of waste) are entered in appropriate columns.   Among the
waste  components   entered  under  each category,  the  component   having  the
smallest  calculated rate  is chosen  as  the  limiting  constituent (ALC  or
RLC).   After  the  most limiting constituents  are  identified,   the  final
TABLE 7.4  WASTE CONSTITUENTS  TO  BE  COMPARED IN DETERMINING THE
           APPLICATION AND RATE LIMITING CONSTITUENTS*
Constituent
Organics
- Volatiization
- Leaching
- Degradation
Water
Nitrogen
Inorganic Acids ,
Bases , and Salts
Halides
Potential
ALCt
X
X
X

X
X



Potential
RLC
X

X
X
X
X

X
X
* The actual comparison should  be  tabulated similarly,  but using calculated
  loading rates in place of  the X's.   The  lowest value  under each category
  corresponds to the respective limiting  constituent.
* Depending upon prevailing  site conditions,  the ALC may vary seasonally.
                                   402

-------
decisions on  the  required land  area  (eq.  7.15) and  the  minimum number  of
applications  per  year  (eq.   7.16)  are made  using  the  following  calcula-
tions :
                                 PR                                   (7.15)
where
                              LRRLC
         A » required  treatment  area  (ha);
        PR - waste  (wet weight)  production  rate (kg/yr);  and
             waste  loading  rate  based on the  RLC (kg/ha/yr).
If the value calculated  for A is  greater  than the area available for treat-
ment,  then land  treatment  cannot  accommodate all  of the  waste which  is
being produced.
                               NA=—^                             (7.16)


where

        NA » number  of  applications  per year and is equal to the
             smallest integer  greater than or equal to the actual value
             calculated;
             waste loading  rate  based on the RLC (kg/ha/yr); and
        AL - application  limit based on the ALC (kg/ha/application).

     The  land  treatment unit life and  concomitant  choice of a  CLC are not
predicted  in  such a straightforward manner.  Three  classes of  potentially
conservative  constituents  have  been  identified,  metals,  phosphorus  and
inorganic  acids,  bases,  and  salts.    By calculating  a  unit life  based on
each,  the design unit  life and  CLC can be  chosen to be  that  constituent
which  is  the most restrictive.   Phosphorus  is  redistributed throughout the
treatment  zone while   salts,  if  conserved,  tend  to  accumulate  near  the
surface and thus  can be described using the following equation:

                                   LCAPpc
                              UL  - —	—                             (7.17)
                                   LRRLC
where
         UL  -  unit  life (yr);
     LCAPps  *  waste loading capacity beyond which the CLC will exceed
               allowable accumulations (kg/ha); and
               waste loading rate based on the RLC (kg/ha/yr).
                                     403

-------
     Metals,  by contrast,  are practically  immobile  and  are  mixed  in  the
waste  with a heterogeneous matrix  of  water,  degradable organics,  mobile
constituents  and  nondegradable residual  solids (see Section  5.3.2.3.2.2).
Waste  application is therefore not  merely the addition  of a pure element to
soil.   The residual solids  fraction (RS) adds  to  the  original  soil mass.
Wastes  containing high  RS concentrations can significantly  raise the level
of the  land treatment unit  as  well  as limit  the amount  of soil which can be
used to dilute  the waste.   As  mentioned  under Metals  in Section 7.5.3.3, if
the  concentration of  a given  metal in  the RS  of  a waste is  less  than  the
maximum allowable concentration  in soil, then  the  given  metal cannot limit
waste  application.  The metal  with the  largest  ratio greater  than one from
eq. 7.11 is the possible  CLC and unit life is determined as follows:

     (1)   determine the  concentration (ca) of  the  metal in the waste
           residual solids  (mg/kg);

     (2)   calculate  the   residual  solids   loading  rate  from  the
           equation;

                        x (weight  fraction of residual
                                 solids  in waste) -  x 1Q_5       (?
              a
              3                    PBRS
     where

            za = volumetric waste  loading rate  on a residual solids
                 basis (cm/yr);
          PBRS " bulk density  of residual solids, assumed to be the
                 same as  that  of the  soil after tillage and settling
                 (kg/1);  and
          1Q~5 = conversion factor from 1/ha to cm;

     (3)  choose a  tillage or waste-soil mixing method  and determine
          the "plow" depth (zp) in cm;
     (4)  from  the  background soil  analysis,   obtain the  background
          concentration (mg/kg) of the  given metal (CpO);
     (5)  from reference  to the specific metal  in Chapter 6, determine
          the  maximum  allowable  soil  concentration  (cpn)  of  that
          metal (mg/kg);
     (6)  using these  quantities,  solve  for n  in  the  following equa-
          tion  (Chapra,  unpublished  paper)  where  n  is the  number  of
          applications which  result  in  the  concentration of  the  sur-
          face layer being cpn:


                               n B IE ln cp° "  Ca                    (
                                    za     cpn " ca
                                     404

-------
     (7)  the corresponding unit life  is:

                                    UL = nta                        (7.20)

     where

          ta = time between applications.

     The  equation idealizes  the  process  of  application  and  plowing as  a
continuous process.  To do this, a number  of  assumptions  must  be  made.

     (1)  Assume  that sludge  is  applied  at  equal  intervals,  ta  in
          length.

     (2)  Assume  that the sludge always has  the same concentration ca.

     (3)  Assume  that  the  sludge is always  applied at a thickness  of
          za-
     (4)  Assume  complete  mixing  of  the  surface  layer  to  depth  zp
          due to  plowing.

     (5)  Assume  that  the   plowed   soil   and   the  sludge  have  equal
          porosity.
     (6)  The annually  applied waste degrades  and  dries  approximately
          down to residual solids.

     A design unit life (years) is  then  chosen from among salts,  phosphorus
and metals.  The  shortest life of the  three  is the desired value.  For many
waste constituents,  inadequate information is  available  to  properly assess
loading rates.   Pilot  experiments  and basic research are suggested in this
document  so  that an understanding  of  the fate of various  constituents in
soil  can  begin  to be  developed.    Where  land  treatment  is proposed  for  a
waste  constituent about  which only  scant  knowledge  is available,  pilot
studies should  be conducted  to evaluate  that  constituent,  and  the loading
rate for  such  a  constituent should  be conservative  to provide  a margin of
safety.
                                     405

-------
                            CHAPTER  7 REFERENCES
 Allen,  S.  E.,  G.  L.  Terman, and  L. B.  Clements.  1976. Greenhouse  techniques
 for  soil-plant-fertilizer  research. TVA. Muscle  Shoals, Alabama.  TVA  Bull.
 TE-104.

 Bailey, G. W.,  T. L. White, and  T. Rothberg.  1968. Adsorption  of  organic
 herbicides by montmorillonite; role of pH and chemical character  of adsorb-
 ate.  Soil  Sci.  Soc.  Am. Proc. 32:222-234.

 Baruah, J. N.,  Y. Alroy, and R.  L. Mateles.  1967. The incorporation of
 liquid  hydrocarbons  into Agar media. Appl. Microbiol. 15(4):96l.

 Beckman Instruments, Inc.  1982.  Beckman Microtox® system operation manual.

 Beek, J. and F. A. M. de Haan. 1973. Phosphorus  removal by  soil in relation
 to waste disposal. Proc. of the  International Conference on Land  for  Waste
 Management. Ottawa,  Canada, Oct.  1973.

 Benigni, R., M. Bignami, I. Camoni, A. Carere, G. Conti, R. lachetta, G.
 Morpurgo, and V. A.  Ortali. 1979. A new in vitro method for testing plant
 metabolism in mutagenicity studies. Jour, of Toxicology and Environ.  Health
 5:809-819.

 Brown, K. W., D. C.  Anderson, S.  G. Jones, L. E. Deuel, and J. D. Price.
 1979. The relative toxicity of four pesticides in tap water from  flooded
 rice paddies. Itit. J. Environ. Studies.  14:49-54.

 Brown, K. W., L. E. Deuel, and J. C. Thomas.  1982. Final report on soil
 disposal of API pit wastes. U.S.  EPA Grant No. R 805474013. Cincinnati,
 Ohio.

 Castro, C. E. and N. 0. Belser.  1966. Hydrolysis of cis- and trans-dichlo-
 ropropene in wet soil. J. Agr. Food Chem. 14:69-70.

 Chapra, S. C. A simple model for  predicting concentrations of  conservative
 contaminants at land treatment sites. Unpublished paper.

 Dibble, J. T. and R. Bartha. 1979. Effect of environmental parameters on
 biodegradation of oil sludge. Appl. Environ. Microbiol. 37:729-738.

 Duffy, J.J. , M.F. Mohtadi, and E. Peake. 1977. Subsurface persistence of
 crude oil spilled on land and its transport in groundwater. pp. 475-478 In
 J. 0. Ludwigson (ed.) Proc. 1977  Oil Spill Conference. New Orleans,
 Louisiana. 8-10 March, 1977. Am.  Pet. Inst. Washington, D.C.

Edwards, N. T. and B. M. Ross-Todd. 1980. An improved bioassay technique
used in solid waste leachate phytotoxicity research. Environ. Exper. Bot.
 20:31-38.
                                    406

-------
EPA. 1982. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities. Part 264. Federal Register Vol. 47, No.  143.  pp.
32274-32388. July 26, 1982.

Farmer, W. J., K. Ique, W. F. Spenser, and J. P. Martin. 1972. Volatility
of organochlorine insecticides from soil: effect of concentration,  tempera-
ture, air flow rate, and vapor pressure. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc.  36:443-
447.

Helling, C. S. 1971. Pesticide mobility in soils I. Parameters of  thin-
layer chromatography. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 35:735-737.

Helling, C. S. and B. C. Turner. 1968. Pesticide mobility:  determination
by soil thin-layer chromatography. Science 162:  562-563.

Hlgashi, K., K. Nakashima, Y. Karasaki, M. Fukunaga, and Y. Mizuguchi.
1981. Activiation of benzo(a)pyrene by microsomes of higher plant  tissues
and their mutagenicity. Biochemistry International 2(4):373-380.

Laskowski, D. A., C. A. I. Goring, P. J. McCall, and R. L. Swann.  1980.
Terrestrial environmental risk analysis for chemicals. R. A. Conway (ed.).
Van Nostrand Reinhold Company, New York.

Matijesevic, Z., Z. Erceg, R. Denic, V. Bacun, and M. Alacenic. 1980.
Mutagenicity of herbicide cyanazine plant activation bioassay. Mut. Res.
74(3):212.

Odu, C. T. I. and K. B. Adeoye. 1969. Heterotrophic nitrification in soils
- a preliminary investigation. Soil Biol. Biochem. 2:41-45.

Osborne, G. J., N. J. Poole, and E. Drew. 1980. A method for studying
microbial activity in intact soil cores. J. Soil Sci. 31:685-687.

Plewa, M. J. and J. M. Gentile. 1976. The mutagenicity of atrazine: a
maize-microbe bioassay. Mutat. Res. 38:287-292.

Plice, M. J. 1948. Some effects of crude petroleum on soil fertility.  Soil
Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 43:413-416.

Raymond, R. L., J. 0. Hudson, and W. W. Jamison. 1976. Oil degradation in
soil. App. Environ. Microbiol. 31:522-535.

Reichhart, D., J. P. Salaun, I. Benveniste, and F. Durst. 1980. Time course
of induction of cytochrome P-450, NADPH-cytochrome c reductase, and
cinnamic acid hydroxylase by phenobarbital, ethanol, herbicides, and
manganese in higher plant microsomes. Plant Physlol. 66:600-604.

Stotzky, G. 1965. Microbial respiration, pp.  1550-1572.  In C. A. Black
(ed.) Methods of soil analysis part 2.  Chemical and microbiological proper-
ties. Am. Soc. Agron. Madison, Wisconsin.
                                     407

-------
Tomlinson, C. R. 1980. Effects of pH on the mutagenicity of sodium azide In
Meurospora crassa and Salmonella typhimurium. Mutat. Res. 70(2):179-192.

Van Cleve, K., P. I. Coyne, E. Goodwin, G. Johnson, and M. Kelley. 1979. A
comparison of four methods for measuring respiration in organic material.
Soil Biol. Biochem. 11:237-246.

Van Der Linden, A. C. and G. J. E. Thijsse. 1965. The mechanisms of micro-
bial oxidations of petroleum hydrocarbons. Adv. Enzymology 27:469-546.

Weber, J. B. 1972. Interaction of organic pesticides with particulate
matter in aquatic and soil: fate of organic pesticides in the aquatic
environment. Am. Chem. Soc. Washington, D.C. pp. 55-120.

Wildeman, A. G., I. A. Rasquinha, and R. N. Nazar. 1980. Effect of plant
metabolic activation on the mutagenicity of pesticides. Carcinogenesis,
AACR Abstracts 89:357.

Youngson, C. R. and C. A. I. Goring. 1962. Diffusion and nematode control
by 1,2 dibromoethane, and 1,2 dibromo-3-chloropropane. Soil Sci. 93;306.
                                    408

-------
8.0                            CHAPTER EIGHT

                    DESIGN AND OPERATION OF HWLT UNITS
     This chapter  discusses  the management concerns that are  important  to
the design and effective  operation  of an HWLT unit.   The  topics discussed
in this chapter (Fig. 8.1) pull together information that has been gathered
from  waste,  soil  and  site  characterizations  and from  pilot  studies  of
waste-soil interactions.   Since system interactions are very  site,  waste-
and soil-specific,  the  management plan should specify  how  the design cri-
teria  and  operational plan  address  site-specific factors  and anticipated
operational problems.  This chapter considers several options for operating
HWLT units in an  environmentally  sound manner under different general con-
ditions.  The  specific  design and management  approach will be established
on a case by case basis, however, since each individual unit will have dif-
ferent needs.  Permit writers and facility owners or operators should study
the principles discussed  in  this chapter  and  use those that  apply  to the
specific needs of the HWLT unit being  considered.
8.1                          DESIGN AND LAYOUT
     Actual design and  layout  depends on the  terrain,  the number and  type
of  wastes  being  treated,  and  the  area involved.   In  laying out  a  land
treatment  unit,  consideration should  be given  to minimizing  the need  to
construct  terraces  to divert water  from uphill watersheds.   Access roads
should be  laid out along the top  of  the grade or on ridges to provide  good
drainage and minimize traffic  problems during wet periods, particularly  if
waste is to be applied  continuously.   Disposal areas should be designed  so
the waste  can be easily and efficiently  spread by  irrigation,  by  surface  or
subsurface spreading  vehicles, or by graders or dozers after  it  is  dumped.
If  sludge  is to  be  dumped at one end  of an  area,  spread, and then  tilled,
plots should be shaped to allow uniform spreading  with  the available equip-
ment.  If  equipment will  become  contaminated during unloading or  mixing,  a
traffic pattern-should  be established and a wash area or  rack constructed
so  that  all equipment  can be  decontaminated before  leaving  the  confined
watershed  of the HWLT unit.  If equipment remains  on-site, a parking facil-
ity and possibly  a service area should be Included in  the design.

     If erosion  is  a potential hazard due  to  climate,  topography  or  soil
characteristics,  waste  should  be  applied  in  strips  across  the slope
parallel  to terraces or  on  the contour.   Contour  application  involves
alternating freshly treated  strips and vegetated  areas.   Once a  vegetative
cover is established  on  the  treated strips, applications  begin on the  pre-
viously  vegetated  buffer strips.    This  technique  serves to  reduce  the
potential  for  erosion and also provides vegetated areas  with better trac-
tion for equipment during inclement  weather.

     While many  land  treatment units are designed  to receive  only one  type
of  waste,  there  is no reason why  they cannot  be designed and  managed  to


                                     409

-------
                                  r
WASTE
OTENTIAL
 SITE
FACILITY DESIGN AND LAYOUT § 8.1

(LAND PREPARATION § 8.2

WATER CONTROL AND
MANAGMENT § 8.3

AIR EMISSION CONTROL § 8.4

EROSION CONTROL § 8.5

MANAGEMENT OF SOIL pH § 8.6

VEGETATION § 8.7

WASTE STORAGE §8.8

WASTE APPLICATION
TECHNIQUES § 8.9

SITE INSPECTION § 8.10

RECORDS AND REPORTING § 8.11
1 —
^•••B

-
-

^^M


                                       /WASTE-SOIL  INTERACTIONS
                                               CHAPTER SEVEN
                                          DESIGN AND OPERATION
                                               CHAPTER EIGHT
                                                     yes
                                              (FINAL SITE
                                              V  SELECTION

                                            HAVE THE FACTORS      N.
                                       / THAT EFFECT THE DESIGN    \
                                     W   AND OPERATION OF THE
                                       V     HWLT UNIT BEEN        /
                                       \ADEQUATELY CONSIDERED ?  /
1
1
MONITORING DESIGN
CHAPTER NINE
Figure 8.1  Topics to be considered for designing and managing an HWLT.
                                    410

-------
receive any number of wastes which would  be  rendered  less  hazardous in the
land treatment system.  If more  than  one  waste  is  to  be disposed, separate
plots can be used for each type; or,  it may  be  possible to dispose several
types  of  waste   simultaneously  on  one  plot,   if application  rates  are
designed  to  stay within  the constraints  of the  rate  (RLC)  and  capacity
limiting  constituents  (CLC)  of  the waste mixture  for  the  particular site.
In some cases, it may  be  beneficial  to codispose wastes containing differ-
ent  concentrations  of the  constituents  that limit  the application rate.
For  instance,  one waste may  contain nitrogen,   but  be low  in phosphorus,
zinc and  lead, while another waste  is deficient  in nitrogen  but contains
significant  concentrations  of  phosphorus,   zinc  and  lead.   It  should  be
possible  to  select  application  rates  for several wastes  that  achieve the
disposal objective without exceeding acceptable leachate concentrations and
without accumulating high levels of  the  constituents  involved.  Obviously,
a more detailed management and record keeping system is needed when several
wastes are codisposed.   There are other  instances where  codisposal may be
advantageous.   Certainly the  codisposal  of  acidic  and basic  wastes will
result in  neutralization  and can be  done provided excessive  salts do not
result.   For  such disposal,  it  is  often desirable to  first  dispose of the
basic  waste  and  then apply  the acidic  waste  to prevent the  release  of
immobilized waste constituents such as metals.

     When waste characteristics  are likely to change in the future,  or when
it may be  desirable  to use  the  land for  future disposal  of another waste,
the  site  should  not be fully loaded  with any  one constituent which would
prevent future addition  of  that particular  constituent.   For instance, if
there is the possibility  that the  CLC concentration of the waste may later
be reduced or that  another waste having  a different CLC  may  also be dis-
posed, it is desirable to cease  loading when only a fraction of  the  allow-
able capacity has accumulated.

     Although  the soil is an excellent medium  for deactivating and  decom-
posing waste materials,  there is the persistent danger at facilities where
a  variety of wastes  are  disposed that  incompatible wastes  could come in
contact with each other.  Problems can be  reduced  by thoroughly  incorporat-
ing  wastes that  would otherwise be  incompatible into the  soil  as soon as
they are  received,  since the soil  will greatly  buffer  the reactions that
take  place and  can  adsorb  evolved  heat  or gases.   The  greatest  dangers
occur when wastes come  into  contact  with each other in receiving  basins or
storage facilities.   There  have been several instances of deaths  resulting
from  incompatible wastes being  mixed together  at poorly  managed  disposal
facilities.   To  avoid such problems, incompatible wastes  should  be handled
separately and precautions should be  taken to ensure that  pumps  and spread-
ing  equipment are cleaned before being used  for a  different waste.

     When wastes  such  as  strong  acids, strong bases, cyanides,  ammonia  com-
pounds ,  chlorine  containing compounds, and  other  compounds that may  react
with each other  to generate  toxic  gases, or that may cause violent  reac-
tions , are received  the facility should  have a detailed  plan for  separate
handling  and the safeguards  necessary to prevent mixing.   One  source  of
information  on  the  compatibility  of binary  mixtures  of compounds is  A
Method for Determining the Compatibility  of Hazardous Wastes  (Hatayama  et


                                     All

-------
 al.,  1980).   This Is  a useful  guide  for predicting  possible  reactions
 resulting  from mixing  wastes,  but this  information does  not  necessarily
 apply  to  such mixtures  within the soil matrix.  Additionally, the  informa-
 tion does  not address  the  issues of constituent  concentrations or of  the
 heterogeneity or  complexity of most waste  streams.   Lab and field  testing
 may  be needed when knowledge about the  possible  reactions resulting  from
 mixing particular waste streams  is insufficient.    A list of incompatible
 wastes is given in Table 8.1  and  Fig. 8.2.


 8.1.1                    Single Plot Configuration
     Size  and  subdivision of the  land  treatment area  depend  on the  char-
acter of the waste involved, including  the waste constituents and their  be-
havior in  soils  (Chapter  6  and  7), the  soil characteristics, the amount of
waste to be disposed, the disposal schedule, and the climatic conditions of
the area.  Where applications  are made  only during one season  of the year
or, on only a few specific occasions, and the limiting  cumulative constitu-
ents are present in  low concentrations, it may  be  desirable to spread  the
waste uniformly  over all  the available  acreage (Fig. 8.3).   Such a configu-
ration can be used without subdividing  the land  treatment area  if soils  ar-s-
uniform, provided this procedure  does  not  interfere  with  establishing a
vegetative cover if one is desired.
8.1.2                 Progressive Plot Configuration
     A controlling  factor  in the layout of any HWLT  unit  is the amount  of
runoff to be  collected  and options available for disposal of runoff water.
Options  for  runoff  are  discussed in  Section 8.3.5 and  include on-site
disposal by evaporation and/or reapplication, use of  a wastewater  treatment
plant prior to release, and  use  of a  retention pond to allow settlement  of
solids  and  analysis  prior  to  release.    In  climates where  significant
volumes of runoff water will be  generated, it is particularly important  to
minimize  the  acreage from which  runoff  is generated  if  on-site disposal
will be used.

     For some wastes that  are high in metals and contain low concentrations
of nitrogen and  toxic or  mobile  constituents,  it  may be  possible to  load
the soil to capacity in a  short  time.   Subsequent waste applications would
then need to  be  diverted  to new areas.   This situation  calls  for several
small plots  rather than  a  single large  area  (Fig.  8.4).   Following the
final application  on a  particular plot,  the  closure plan  is implemented
on the  treated  cell so  that runoff  water  quality will  be  improved  as
quickly as possible.
                                    412

-------
TABLE 8.1  POTENTIALLY INCOMPATIBLE WASTES*
The mixture of a Group A waste with a Group B waste may have the potential
consequence as noted.
           Group 1-A

Acetylene sludge
Alkaline caustic liquids
Alkaline cleaner
Alkaline corrosive liquids
Alkaline corrosive battery fluid
Caustic wastewater
Lime sludge and other corrosive
  alkalines
Lime wastewater
Lime and water
Spent caustic
                           Group 1-B
                  Acid sludge
                  Acid and water
                  Battery acid
                  Chemical cleaners
                  Electrolyte, acid
                  Etching acid liquid or solvent
                  Liquid cleaning compounds
                  Pickling liquor and other
                    corrosive acids
                  Sludge acid
                  Spent acid
                  Spent mixed acid
                  Spent sulfuric acid
Potential consequences;  Heat generation, violent reaction.
           Group 2-A
Asbestos waste and other toxic wastes
Beryllium wastes
Unrinsed pesticide containers
Waste pesticides
Potential consequences;
                           Group 2-B
                  Cleaning solvents
                  Data processing liquid
                  Obsolete explosives
                  Petroleum waste
                  Refinery waste
                  Retrograde explosives
                  Solvents
                  Waste oil and other flammable
                    and explosive wastes

Release of toxic substances in case of fire or
explosion.
           Group 3-A
Aluminum
Beryllium
Calcium
Lithium
Magnesium
Potassium
Sodium
Zinc powder and other reactive metals
  and metal hydrides
                           Group 3-B
                  Any waste in Group in  1-A or  1-B
         	  -^ —	—

Potential consequences;  Fire or expolsion;  generation  of  flammable
                         hydrogen gas.
                               —continued—
                                    413

-------
TABLE 8.1   (continued)
           Group 4-A                                Group  4-B

Alcohols                                   Any concentrated waste  in
Water                                        Groups 1-A or 1-B
                                           Calcium
                                           Lithium
                                           Metal hydrides
                                           Potassium
                                           Sodium
                                           S02C12, SOC12,  PC12,
                                             CH3SiCl3,  and other water-
                                             reactive wastes
Potential consequences;  Fire, explosion or heat generation; generation  of
                         flammable or toxic gases.

           Group 5-A                                Group  5-B

Alcohols                                   Concentrated Group 1-A  or  1-B
Aldehydes                                    wastes
Halogenated hydrocarbons                   Group 3-A wastes
Nitrated hydrocarbons and other
  reactive organic compounds and solvents
Unsaturated hydrocarbons

Potential consequences:  Generation of toxic hydrogen cyanide or hydrogen
                         sulfide gas.
           Group 7-A                                Group  7-B

Chlorates and other strong                 Acetic acid  and other organic
  oxidizers                                  acids
Chlorine                                   Concentrated mineral acids
Chlorites                                  Group 2-B wastes
Chromic acid                               Group 3-A wastes
Hypochlorites                              Group 5-A wastes and other
Nitrates                                     flammable  and combustible
Nitric acid, fuming                          wastes
Perchlorates
Permanganatesfuming
Peroxides

Potential consequences;  Fire, explosion or violent reaction.


* Cheremisinoff et al. (1979).
                                     414

-------
                         HAZARDOUS WAST1 COMPATIBILITY CHART
                    UACTTV
                                             CT
                                          CT
                                                           HC
                ••< (Mn OfMic MMn
                       . Tub
                                          1
     n .
                                           CT
                                               CT
                                                           "t *
                                                                    "OT-V

                                                                '0 II II  I)
                                —continued—
Figure 8,2.     Hazardous waste compatibility  (Hatayama et  al.,  1980)
                                   415

-------
                     HAZARDOUS WASTE COMPATIBILITY CHART (Continued)
                                          r
                                          c
                                         CT
                                         Cf
                                          I
H**i fmrttw<**

Fwv

iMunMMWrf «nn n.n

T«« |M pTMnlMM
14























"»


DO
14

II

























W01
19


14





















"f


• M
1*



11


ii
'V
II
I
"F

«".




*E







"«
«l

( M
17




IN

«
a
H
^,,


u




H
"f

II




%,
"•i,
"o
TM /
11





I*
II
r>
11



~,T
*




I







*,
"•

LNV
It






M
O
II
II
"f


-f
H




Frr



"r



"F
fiT
"«

cm
»







u



t
"»
^


Ht
w
N
M

%
%
"l
%
%

H
*CA
II








j;





\

Hc



Hr

"«
'»
%

*
L 01
12









U












"t
N
"»


•A
U










H

1



HC



%

I
'.


1
rrt
M











u
cr
H
°*r


b
cr
H


"f
^
I
'«
\

"«
MAT
"I












U



"fr







HM
in
"e»

i*i<
u













IT










"l
"t

I!
IT



rtm
"l









a

H,







"F


tr
»
f
l
u
rir'
(,F










J»








"f


r»i»
»
















JO
H
U
H
CT
%
TTT
"t
'.
"o
"l

ICLY
M

















Jl


H,

"l
'•
%
".

ttl
31
V«l
u.
«»,

I4n













Jl

U



"fa
^fa

iCTTl
JJ
<*M>i 	 	
•««*• •< HW irtMmi
»fc.lll< 1 >-!..>..-•

(nvtalMHi. TMV. jtt4 iwuc |M (««mlMMi














11
V «
Id
"t "l "« '«
% "« '"
SIS"« S-
" ^*«S5i*
"Jr S'"

U M IM l« 1*3 1*4 IM |W NT
Figure  8.2.      Continued.
                                    416

-------
               DIVERSION  TERRACE
     WR
                        ROAD  WAT
       Water Retention Basin
       Waste  Application Area
   —*• Pathway  of  Diverted Water
   |WR| Wash  Rack  and  Parking Area
   — Diversion  Terraces
                                                           SLOPE
                                                              i
Figure  8.3.   Possible  layout of a land treatment unit in a
             gently sloping uniform terrain when only one
             plot is used.
                             417

-------
                                Area
                  ^ Water Retention Basin
                  I.""; Future Ceils
                  § Areas presently being treated
                 -»- Path of Water Flow
                 —Diversion  Terrace
                 	Future Diversion Terrace
Figure 8.4.    Possible  layout  of a land treatment unit  in a gently
                sloping uniform  terrain  when a progressive plot
                configuration is used.
                                       418

-------
8.1.3                   Rotating Plot Configuration


     The  rotating  plot  configuration  is  a  design approach  which may  be
used if  waste  is to  be  applied frequently or  continuously when  the  rate
limiting constituent (RLC) is low enough to allow large applications.   This
involves subdividing  the land treatment area into plots which  are treated
sequentially, cultivated, and then revegetated (Figs. 8.5  and  8.6).   Fol-
lowing a period of six months or more, depending on the rate of degradation
of the applied materials, a given plot  can be  reused.   The use of rotating
plots may  require  6,  12  or  even more  plots,  each capable of  degrading a
proportionate fraction of the annual  waste  load.   The use  of individual
disposal  plots  offers the  advantages  of  allowing the  systematic use  of
vegetation, minimizing the  area exposed to erosion,  and maximizing infil-
tration  and  evapotranspiration.   Enhancement of  infiltration and evapora-
tion is  often  of  primary  importance  where  no water  treatment  plant  is
available  for  handling  runoff  water.    Where  a  water treatment  plant  is
available, the  layout  may be similar  to Fig.  8.6 with runoff  water  chan-
neled or piped from the retention basin to the treatment plant.
8.1.4                          Overland Flow
     Overland flow  entails the treatment  of wastewater  as  it flows  at a
shallow depth over a relatively impermeable soil surface with a 2-8% slope.
Two treatment options having  considerable  applicability for industrial use
include:  using overland flow to treat runoff generated by a land treatment
facility or using this  method to  treat wastewater effluent from industrial
processes.  Either of these  treatment  options could be used in conjunction
with the treatment alternatives such as a land treatment system.  This type
of complementary treatment could greatly reduce the cost of treating efflu-
ent or  runoff  water as well as  reduce  the  load on  existing wastewater
treatment plants.

     Overland flow has  been effective in  removal  of  nitrogen, biochemical
oxygen demand (BOD), total suspended solids (TSS), a variety of metals, and
volatile trace organics (Carlson et al., 1974; Jenkins et al.,  1981; Martel
et al., 1982).  Carlson et al. (1974)  reports overland flow as  being effec-
tive  in reducing the  cadmium, copper, manganese, nickel, lead,  and zinc
level of  secondary  effluent.  Phosphorus  removal  by  overland flow systems
is limited  since the exchange  sites  are  used up rather  rapidly (Martel,
1982).   A more detailed  discussion of the  topic and  the  important para-
meters to be considered during the design phase of an overland flow system
can be  located  in the following  sources  (Carlson et al.  1974; Hoeppel et
al., 1974; Carlson et al., 1974; Peters and Lee,  1978; Thomas et al., 1976;
Jenkins et al.,  1981; Chen and Patrick,  1981; Dickey and Vanderholm, 1981;
Martel et al., 1982; Jenkins  and Palazzo,  1981).
                                     419

-------
   Water Retention  Basin
   Pathway of Diverted  Water
   Diversion  Terraces
   Retention  Levees
   Wash Rack and  Equipment Parking
   Contour  Lines
Figure 8.5.    Possible layout of a land treatment unit in rolling
              terrain showing 12 plots and  associated runoff reten-
              tion basins.
                                 420

-------
-c-
N>
                                       JATER RETENTION BASIN
                                                                              ROADS
WASTE

APPLICATION

AREA

                                                 PATHWAY OF DIVERTED WATER
                                                     •REVEGETATED AREA
                      Figure 8.6.   Possible layout of a land treatment  unit  in
                                    level terrain.

-------
8.1.5                          Buffer Zones
     Land  treatment  units should  be laid  out  to provide  adequate buffer
zones between the disposal site and the property boundaries.  State regula-
tions concerning  required buffer zones should be  consulted when designing
the HWLT, where no specific regulations exist, the following suggestions on
buffer zones may be useful.  For wastes which present minimal odor problems
and are  incorporated  into the soil surface  shortly  after application, the
buffer area is needed  mainly  for diversion terraces  and aesthetic reasons.
Waste storage  areas  should be provided with  larger  buffer zones, particu-
larly if odors are  associated with  the  storage  or  if aerators  are  used
which may  cause  aerosol  drift.   Water  retention  facilities  should  be
designed and constructed  so the  levees  and spillways can be easily inspec-
ted and  repaired.  Enough area should be provided  between the spillways and
the property boundary  to allow implementation of  emergency procedures,  if
needed,   to control runoff resulting from a catastropic storm event.
8.2                          LAND PREPARATION
     Preparing  the surface  of the  treatment area  generally  consists of
clearing  trees  or bushes  that obstruct  the operations.   Care  should be
taken during construction to ensure that design specifications are strictly
followed.   Surface recontouring  may be needed to  gather materials to  con-
struct external  diversion  terraces and levees, or  to  establish grades and
internal  terraces  for  water  management.   If recontouring is required,  top-
soil should be  stockpiled  and  then respread  as soon as  possible after re-
grading is completed.  It is often desirable, however, to keep on-site  dis-
turbances to a  minimum to reduce  soil  erosion.   If a vegetative cover is
established, it  will  tend  to  hold  the  soil  together  and provide traction
for the equipment  used to  spread the initial application of  waste.   There
is no need to plow a field before applying waste if the  equipment available
for waste incorporation  is  able  to break  the  turf  and  incorporate  the
waste.
8.3                    WATER CONTROL AND MANAGEMENT
     Water  is  the primary means  by which pollutants  are transported  from
HWLT units.  Hazardous  substances may either  be  dissolved or suspended  in
water and subsequently carried to off-site land surfaces,  surface waters  or
groundwater.  Consequently, water control is of primary importance in  land
treatment design.  When  hazardous waste is mixed with the surface soil  to
achieve the required degradation,  almost all water flowing over or through
the soil  comes  into  contact with  the  waste.   Water  management strives  to
limit the  amount of water  contacting  treated areas  by controlling  run-on
from untreated areas to reduce the amount of water contaminated.  Addition-
ally, runoff from treated areas is  collected  and either  stored, disposed,
                                     422

-------
or treated and released under a permit if  the water  is  shown to be free of
contamination.

     All water  movement on  an HWLT  unit  needs  to  be  carefully  planned.
When water  is directly  applied by  an  irrigation system,  it  must not  be
applied at rates above the infiltration  capacity  of  the soil.   When inter-
mittent flooding or ridge  and  furrow irrigation techniques are used,  care-
ful timing  of applications is needed so applications  immediately  prior to
natural rainfall  events  are avoided  as  much as  possible.   Smaller,  more
frequent applications  are  generally  better  than  a few,  very  large volume
applications; however,  this  consideration should  be based  on  the overall
design of  the facility.   Additionally,  all water applications to sloping
land should be done in association  with  some type of erosion control prac-
tice such as  contour  strips,  terraces,  benches, diversion ditches, or con-
touring.   It  may also be  desirable  on  some areas to  leave buffer contour
strips of  undisturbed vegetation to  help  slow water  flow.   Any  activity
that disturbs the  soil may  decrease the  effectiveness  of erosion control
structures, consequently,  these structures  should be  rebuilt  and revege-
tated as soon after a disturbance as  possible.

     To provide  overall water  management,  the  operator  should develop a
water balance for  the HWLT site and  keep  a cumulative  record of  rainfall
and available storage volume.   To  properly  manage water at an HWLT, other
important climatic parameters  may  need to be measured, including  tempera-
ture and  pan evaporation.    Proper  instrument  exposures,  calibration,  and
use are essential  in  order to obtain reliable  observations.  The National
Weather Service establishes the standards  for instrumental observations and
provides  the best  source of  information  on  this  topic.   Additionally,
Linsley et al.  (1975) provide good discussions of instruments  and observa-
tions,  and list  sources  of  climatic  data in their  chapter references.
Manufacturers  of  meteorological instruments   also  provide  pamphlets  on
proper usage.   Other  useful measurements  include  wind velocity, soil tem-
perature, soil moisture, and particulate and volatile emissions.

     During a wet  season,  the  operator should endeavor to provide suffi-
cient storage capacity for anticipated rainfall runoff  during  the  remainder
of the season.  For facilities  with no  discharge permit where  runoff water
is  disposed  by  evaporation  or  spray irrigation,  reapplication  of  water
should be concentrated during dry periods  to reduce  the  stored  volume.  The
objective  of  all  water management  planning and  effort  is to avoid  any
release of unpermitted or  contaminated water.
8.3.1                   Water Balance for the Site
     The development of hydrologic information for a site  can  serve  two  de-
sign purposes,  specifying acceptable  hydraulic  loading  rates for  liquid-
containing wastes and sizing runoff diversion (Section 8.3.2)  and  retention
(Sections 8.3.3  and  8.3.4)  structures.  Hydraulic loading rates are deter-
mined  somewhat  independently  of  the  natural  site water  budget while  the
                                     423

-------
 water  budget  is  the direct means for determining runoff and  the  associated
 control  structures.

     The amount  of water  which  can potentially move  into and through  the
 soil profile  is  primarily a function of  the hydraulic conductivity of  the
 most restrictive soil horizon and  the  site drainage,  which may have both
 vertical and  horizontal  components  available to remove water from  the sys-
 tem.   Measures for these parameters are  described  in Section 4.1.1.5.   It
 should be recognized that the waste may  dramatically affect the hydraulic
 conductivity  of  the  surface layer,  and  measurements obtained  from this
 layer  should  characterize the  waste-soil  mixture rather than the unamended
 native soil.   Additionally,  the  best results are obtained from field meas-
 urements taken at enough  locations  to  account  for the spatial variability
 of  this  parameter.

     Once the hydraulic  properties  of  the  soils  have been  characterized,
 the  amount of wastewater that  can  safely  be  leached through  the system
 should be determined.   This requires knowledge  of  the climatic setting  of
 the site, the soils,  and the mobility  of the  hazardous constituents to  be
 land treated.  In general, as the risk  of significant  leaching of hazardous
 constituents  increases,  the acceptable hydraulic  load decreases.   At  the
 extremes are  the  two choices described  below.  The  choice  of  hydraulic load
 for intermediate  risks should  be guided by results of  treatment  demonstra-
 tions  (see Chapter 7 for  test approaches).

     Highly mobile  hazardous constituents placed in a groundwater  recharge
 zone would be an  example of an extreme   case  where  the  leaching  risk  is
 great.   The objective in  this case  would  be to adjust hydraulic  loading  so
 no  leaching occurred.   In arid  regions,  this  objective may  be practically
 achieved by  controlling  waste   applications  to less  than  the  site water
 deficit.  Humid  sites may not  practically achieve the zero  leaching objec-
 tive,  so the  unit should be designed so  that  natural leaching rates would
 not be significantly increased.  At least two approaches may be considered.
 First,  applications can  be timed  to   coincide  with  dry  months,  such  as
 summer months in the southeastern  U.S.   Second,  a site  can be  chosen  to
 include  slowly permeable  clay  soils or  soils with shallow clay restrictive
 layers.

     The  other extreme  is where the mobility  of hazardous constituents  is
minimal  and  loading rates are  based on  saturated  hydraulic conductivity.
 Saturated  hydraulic  conductivity data  should  not be  used without adjust-
ment,  however, because field experience with land treatment  of nonhazardous
wastewater has shown that practical limits are much  lower.   Data are very
limited,  but  the USDA and U.S. Army Corps  of Engineers  (EPA,  1977)  indicate
 that the hydraulic loading rate should  be  a  maximum  of  2  to 12% of  the
saturated  hydraulic  conductivity for loamy to  sandy soils, respectively.
Some form of .field testing  is  again  necessary  to  provide  an  adequate
assessment and such information  should  be  developed in  conjunction with  the
waste-site interaction studies (Chapter 7).
                                    424

-------
8.3.2                      Diversion Structures
     The primary function of  diversion  structures  on a land treatment unit
is to intercept and  redirect  the  flow of surface water.  For  an HWLT unit
to function properly,  it  needs to be hydrologically  isolated.   This means
that if the treated  area  lies downslope, all  runoff  originating above the
treatment  area  should be  diverted around  the treatment site.   Diversion
structures must  at least  be  designed to prevent  flow onto  the treatment
zone from the peak discharge of a 25 year storm (EPA, 1982).

     Run-on control  is normally  accomplished  by  constructing  a  berm  of
moderately compacted soil around  the  site.   Excess material from construc-
tion of the retention ponds is a  good  material to use  for building these
berms.  If native  topsoil  is  used,  it must be free  of residual vegetation
that would prevent proper compaction.   Berms  should  run at  an angle up the
slope so  that water moving downslope is intercepted  and  moved laterally.
This design minimizes  ponding  behind  the berm and  also allows construction
of a smaller berm.  If the area draining to the berm is large, a terrace or
set of  terraces  may  be needed above  the berm to slow  the  velocity of the
water and to assist lateral movement.  The terraces and the diversion berms
should  discharge  into  a  grassed  waterway  sized  to safely  divert runoff
water without causing  serious erosion.  For  similar reasons, terraces and
diversion  structures  should be vegetated immediately  following construc-
tion.

     Just as diversion structures can be used  to prevent run-on  from enter-
ing the HWLT unit, they can be used  to  control water on-site.  Water flow-
ing from upland portions of the HWLT unit can  be carefully  channeled to the
retention  pond  to prevent  the release  of  contaminated water.   Diversion
structures may be useful In some cases to divide the unit into plots.
8.3.3                        Runoff Retention
     All  runoff from  an HWLT  unit must  be  controlled;  this  is usually
accomplished  by using  diversion structures,  as previously  discussed,  to
channel water  to a retention pond which is  normally located in the  lowest
spot.  Another method  for controlling runoff  is  to subdivide the unit  and
contain the  runoff from  each smaller area  in a  separate retention  pond.
One advantage  to using several ponds is that  if  water in one pond becomes
highly contaminated by waste overloading in one  plot, the volume of  water
to be treated  as a hazardous  waste  is minimized.

     Ponds and retention  basins must be designed to hold  the expected run-
off from a 25-year, 24-hour  return  period  storm (Schwab et al., 1971;  EPA,
1982).  There  are  two general  approaches  to meeting  this requirement,  one
is to  design a pond for  the runoff expected  from  the specified  storm  and
keep this  pond empty and the other approach  involves designing a pond to
contain rainfall runoff  collected from previous storms as well  as the run-
off for the  specified  storm.   In any case, since  the pond cannot be emptied


                                     425

-------
instantaneously, some  consideration  of accumulated water must  be included
in the design of runoff retention ponds.  If the environmental damage would
be extremely high  from an inadvertant discharge,  the operator  may want to
use the 50 to  100  year return period storm when sizing  the  basin.  Sizing
calculations  should take  into  consideration  the  potential carryover  of
water accumulated during previous rainfall events so that the design capac-
ity can be  mantained at  all  times.    If  a  land treatment unit  is divided
into plots and each plot  is equipped  with a  retention basin  designed for a
25-year,  24-hour  return  period  storm,  an  additional,  optional  retention
basin can be installed to retain any overflow from the smaller ponds.  This
basin can also be designed to hold the runoff expected to accumulate during
a wet season.  Retention  basins  should be lined to comply with regulations
concerning surface  impoundments (EPA,  1980a;  EPA  1982)  if  the  runoff is
hazardous.   On-site clay materials  may be  suitable  for use  in compacted
clay liners.

     It is  imperative that  the  best  available engineering principles be
used to design and construct  retention basins.   Earthern  dams  should be
keyed  into  the existing  soil material  whenever possible (Schwab  et al.,
1971).  There are  also  numerous sources of  plastic or  other composition
liners  for  sealing  industrial  storage ponds  if  clay  is  unavailable or
unsuitable for  the given situation.   All portions of  the  dam  areas that
will not be submerged  should  be  covered with 15 cm or more  of topsoil and
revegetated with appropriate plant species.

     Every  pond  and  retention  basin should  have an  emergency  or  flood
spillway.   Whenever possible,  ponds  should be  designed  to use an existing
ongrade vegetated  area as a  spillway.   Maintenance  of a good vegetative
cover or riprap in  the  emergency spillway is needed  to  hold soil in place
and prevent dam failure in the event of an overflow.
8.3.4                   Runoff Storage Requirements
     Runoff control must be provided to reduce the probability of an uncon-
trolled  release  of  contaminated  runoff  water.    Obviously,  protection
against all eventualities (zero probability) is unachievable; consequently,
the degree of protection provided should be  based on knowledge of the site
and  the risk  associated with an  uncontrolled  release.    The  latter  is
largely based  on the  characteristics  of  the  waste  and the  damage which
could be caused  by  those  constituents  which are  likely  to  be mobilized by
runoff water, with  erosion  control practices, waste  application rates and
methods, and site management acting as modifiers.

     Runoff retention  ponds  (impoundments) can be  likened  to multipurpose
reservoirs and,  as  such, can  serve two functions,  (1)  control of normal
seasonal  fluctuations  in rainfall  runoff  and (2)  maintenance  of enough
reserve capacity to contain stormwater runoff from peak  events.  Probabili-
ties defining the degree- of protection needed should be  assigned to each of
these  functions  based on  water  balance  calculations  and  severe  storm
records, respectively.

                                    426

-------
8.3.4.1  Designing for Peak Stormwater Runoff


     Consideration  of  the  climatic  record  for  a  site  includes  extreme
events, but the effects of  these  events  are  usually of little significance
to the long-term site water budget.  Peak events can, however, have immedi-
ate, devastating effects.   Therefore,  regardless  of the general water bud-
get, reserve  capacity  must  be maintained  for  these singular events.   The
length of the design storm is usually chosen to be 24 hours since this time
increment spans the length of singular storms  in  most  cases while being of
short  enough  duration to  be  considered  practically  "instantaneous"  in
comparison to the climatic record.

     A minimum probability which is acceptable for hazardous waste sites is
the 25 year,  24  hour storm, which  specifies a 4%  annual  probability that
this amount will  be equalled or  exceeded.   Figure 8.7 is  a  map of  the 25
year, 24 hour precipitation for the U.S.  Greater values (i.e., lower prob-
abilities), for example the  100 year,  24 hour storm can be used where the
given site conditions  pose  a greater  environmental risk.    These are pre-
cipitation amounts, however, and  not  runoff.  To  translate the chosen pre-
cipitation value  into runoff,  a  conservative  approach would  assume that
100% of the precipitation is lost  as  runoff.  Storage  volume is simply de-
termined by multiplying the  depth of  runoff  by the  total  area  of the site
watershed.  For  intense  storms and high antecedent soil moisture content,
this  assumption  may  be   acceptable,   but   some  refinement  is  usually
desirable.

     Direct runoff  from  precipitation can be  estimated using a  procedure,
often  called  the  SCS curve number,  developed  by the Soil  Conservation
Service (1972).  The estimate  includes  the effect of land management prac-
tices, the hydrologic characteristics of  the soil,  and  antecedent soil
moisture content on the amount of runoff generated.  Although this model is
a simple approach  to  a complex problem,  it  has an advantage over the more
physically  realistic  models in  that  the  curve number  method  does  not
require a great deal of input information  and  computer  time.

     To  use   the  curve number  method to  determine the  amount  of   runoff
(i.e.,  stormwater)  retention necessary,  first  determine  the  hydrologic
group of  the  soil in  the HWIT  unit as described  in Section 3.4.4.   Next,
make an estimate of the rainfall  amount which  has  occurred  in the past five
days using Table  8.2.  However, if fresh  waste is applied frequently, the
soil may be continually moist  and can be classified in antecedent moisture
condition  (AMC) III.   The  runoff  curve number can now be  ascertained from
Table 8.3.   For example, an HWLT unit planted with pasture grass in fair
condition on  a soil In hydrologic group C  yields  a curve number of 79.
                                     427

-------
-
c
                                                      OUR RAINFALL (INCHES)
                Figure 8.7.  25-Year, 24-Hour rainfall for  the United  States (Herschfield, 1961)

-------
TABLE 8.2  SEASONAL RAINFALL LIMITS FOR ANTECEDENT MOISTURE CONDITIONS*


                          Total 5-day antecedent rainfall (in inches)

            AMC Group          Dormant Season     Growing Season
I
II
III
<0.5
0.5 - 1.1
>1.1
<1.4
1.4 - 2.1
>2.1
* Soil Converstion Service (1972).
     The curve number  acquired  from Table  8.3  represents soils in  AMC II
and must be converted if the soil is in AMC I or III.  In this example, the
curve number of  79  is converted to a  curve number of 91 using  Table 8.4.
Figure 8.8  can  now be  used to  estimate  runoff  amounts.  If  the  25-year,
24-hour rainfall event is the design parameter, and that equals 7.5 inches,
the intersection of 7*5 inches of rainfall with the curve number line of 91
yields direct runoff of 6.4 inches.  Multiply  this amount of runoff by the
acreage of the HWLT watershed, and the total runoff and retention pond size
can be calculated in acre-inches.
8.3.4.2  Designing for Normal Seasonal Runoff
     Mindful  of the  two  functions  of runoff  retention  ponds,  designing
ponds  to control  normal  seasonal  fluctuations,  is more complex.   This
requires  knowledge  of  numerous  independent  variables,   many  simplifying
assumptions, and the choice of several management approaches.  The complex-
ity of the  hydrologic  cycle is concomitant with  the difficulty of charac-
terizing and measuring  the  important  parameters make the job of predicting
the water budget and sizing retention ponds, somewhat  of  an art,  based in
part  on  judgment  and  experience.  Two possible approaches  are discussed
here, one a relatively straightforward method  which can  be readily calcu-
lated manually  and  the  other  a general introduction to a  computer modeling
approach.   Where  accumulated  rainfall runoff  is discharged  or otherwise
managed so  that the  storage volume needed for the 25 year,  24 hour storm is
maintained, these  calculations  can  be run using the maximum discharge rate
for the pump, or wastewater treatment plant used to empty  the runoff stor-
age pond.   These calculations can also help the site manager decide between
various discharge  rates and pump  capacities.
8.3.4.2.1   Monthly Data  Apjgrgach.   An underlying  assumption  in  a water
budget for  a  site  must be that, on the average,  there  is  no net change  in
the volume  of runoff  stored on  a  long-term basis.   In other words, water
management  cannot  allow a continued increase in water stored because of  the
"multiplying  pond" syndrome (i.e., the need  to  periodically increase pond
                                     429

-------
TABLE 8.3  RUNOFF CURVE NUMBERS FOR HYDROLOGIC SOIL-COVER COMPLEXES*
(Antecedent moisture condition II, and Ia = 0.

Land use
Fallow
Row crops







Small grain







Close-seeded
legumes' or
rotation
meadow




Pasture
or range




Meadow
Woods


Cover
Treatment
or Practice
Straight row
Straight row
Straight row
Contoured
Contoured
Contoured
and terraced
Contoured
and terraced
Straight row
Straight row
Contoured
Contoured
Contoured
and terraced
Contoured
and terraced
Straight row
Straight row
Contoured
Contoured
Contoured
and terraced
Contoured
and terraced



Contoured
Contoured
Contoured




2 S)
Hydrologic
Hydrologic
condition
	
Poor
Good
Poor
Good
Poor

Good

Poor
Good
Poor
Good
Poor

Good

Poor
Good
Poor
Good
Poor

Good

Poor
Fair
Good
Poor
Fair
Good
Good
Poor
Fair
Good
A
77
72
67
70
65
66

62

65
63
63
61
61

59

66
58
64
55
63

51

68
49
39
47
25
6
30
45
36
25
B
86
81
78
79
75
74

71

76
75
74
73
72

70

77
72
75
69
73

67

79
69
61
67
59
35
58
66
60
55


soil group
C
91
88
85
84
82
80

78

84
83
82
81
79

78

85
81
83
78
80

76

86
79
74
81
75
70
71
77
73
70
D
94
91
89
88
86
82

81

88
87
85
84
82

81

89
85
85
83
83

80

89
84
80
88
83
79
78
83
79
77
                               —continued—
                                     430

-------
TABLE 8.3  (continued)
(Antecedent moisture condition II, and Ia = 0.
Cover
Treatment
Land use or Practice
Farmsteads
Roads (dirt)#
(hard surface)*
2 S)
Hydrologic
Hydrologic
condition A
	 59
	 72
	 74
B
74
82
84


soil group
C
82
87
90
D
86
89
92
* Soil Conservation Service (1972).
* Close-dilled or broadcast.
* Including right-of-way.
                                     431

-------
TABLE 8.4
CURVE NUMBERS (CN) AND CONSTANTS FOR THE CASE Ia = 0.2S
1
CN for
condition
II

100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
2
3
CN for
conditions
I III

100
97
94
91
89
87
85
83
81
80
78
76
75
73
72
70
68
67
66
64
63
62
60
59
58
57

100
100
99
99
99
98
98
98
97
97
96
96
95
95
94
94
93
93
92
92
91
91
90
89
89
88
4
S
values'
(inches)
0
.101
.204
.309
.417
.526
.638
.753
.870
.989
1.11
1.24
1.36
1.49
1.63
1.76
1.90
2.05
2.20
2.34
2.50
2.66
2.82
2.99
3.16
3.33
5
Curve* starts
where P =
(inches)
0
.02
.04
.06
.08
.11
.13
.15
.17
.20
.22
.25
.27
.30
.33
.35
.38
.41
.44
.47
.50
.53
.56
.60
.63
.67
1
CN for
Condition
II

60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
2
3
CN for
conditions
I III

40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
25
24
23
22
21
21
20
19
18

78
77
76
75
75
74
73
72
71
70
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
4
S
values *
(inches)
6.67
6.95
7.24
7.54
7.86
8.18
8.52
8.87
9.23
9.61
10.0
10.4
10.8
11.3
11.7
12.2
12.7
13.2
13.8
14.4
15.0
15.6
16.3
17.0
17.8
18.6
5
Curve* starts
where P =
( inches )
1.33
1.39
1.45
1.51
1.57
1.64
1.70
1.77
1.85
1.92
2.00
2.08
2.16
2.26
2.34
2.44
2.54
2.64
2.76
2.88
3.00
3.12
3.26
3.40
3.56
3.72
                                            —continued—

-------
U)
U>
TABLE 8.4
1
CN for
condition
II
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
(continued)
2
CN
3
for
conditions
I
55
54
53
52
51
50
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
III
88
87
86
86
85
84
84
83
82
82
81
80
79
78
4

S
values'
3.51
3.70
3.89
4.08
4.28
4.49
4.70
4.92
5.15
5.38
5.62
5.87
6.13
6.39
5

Curvet starts
where P »
.70
.74
.78
.82
.86
.90
.94
.98
1.03
1.08
1.12
1.17
1.23
1.28
1
CN for
Condition
II
34
33
32
31
30

25
20
15
10
5
0


2
CN
3
for
conditions
I
18
17
16
16
15

12
9
6
4
2
0


III
54
53
52
51
50

43
37
30
22
13
0


4

S
values*
19.4
20.3
21.2
22.2
23.3

30.0
40.0
56.7
90.0
190.0
infinity


5

Curve* starts
where P -
3.88
4.06
4.24
4.44
4.66

6.00
8.00
11.34
18.00
38.00
infinity


      * Soil Conservation Service (1972).

      * For curve number (CN) in Column 1.

-------
        HYDROLOGY:  SOLUTION OF  RUNOFF EQUATION
                                                                 P« 0 to 12 inches
                                                                 Q'O to B inches
-
-
                                    •  rsssB
                                      Q-p T !srwiu> p*fo:  »*VF:
                                         •Ia*!*tu  LI ••••: v • v •; • 'J.JI
Roinfall (P)
RUNOFF (O)
                                                  MJITIWIIU
                                      Curvii on (hit *h««l arc for lh«
                                         COM  Ia« O.2 S, M that ~
                                           I mi
                                              (P-0.2S)1
                                              P+0.8S
                                           4567
                                             RAINFALL  (P) IN INCHES
        Figure 8.8.   Estimating direct runoff amounts  from storm rainfall (Soil Conservation
                      Service,  1972) .

-------
capacity).  Apart from storage, the means of control for management are en-
hanced  leaching  and  evaporation  and/or  discharge  under  an NPDES  permit
(Section  8.3.5).    Given these  considerations,  the  water  budget can  be
derived from the following basic expression:

                           P + W - EVTS + L + R                       (8.1)

where

        P - precipitation;
        W • water applied in waste;
     EVTS - evapotranspiration;
        L - leachate; and
        R - runoff to be collected.

The equation assumes a negligible change  in soil water storage.  The runoff
(R) term can be broken into  two  components, storage (S) and discharge (D).
Using  these terms  and  rearranging equation  8.1,  the  expression  can  be
written:

                         S - P + W - EVTS - L - D                      (8.2)

In the  long-term,  storage will vary approximately sinusoidally with a con-
stant mean.

     Choosing  a  monthly  basis as a  convenient  time increment, to maintain
sensitivity while  simplifying  data requirements,  a water budget can be  run
for the given  site by using the  climatic record, the watershed properties
of the  proposed land  treatment unit, and  the assumption  (for the purpose of
these  calculations), that  adequate storage  is  available  to  contain  all
events  (i.e. no  spillway overtopping).   Best  results require using a  cli-
matic record of at  least  20  years.   By simulating the entire  record,  month
by month, changes  in  storage can  be  seen  with  time.   Appendix E provides an
example of how to  run the calculations.   Arriving at  a  design storage  using
this method involves  a four  step  process, as follows:

     (1)  Assume zero discharge  and run  the calculations.   If there  is

            S   Sj  <_ 0;  where   S^  -  annual  change  in  storage  from

          the  previous year),  then no  discharge is  needed;

     (2)  If   I    Si > 0; then  some discharge and/or enhanced  evapo-

          ration or leaching is necessary.  As a first  approximation,
          assume  that  the   enhanced water  losses  equal  the  average
          annual storage change (i.e.  L   Sj/n; where  n  - number  of

          years  of  record).   Now  rerun  the calculations with  the
          modified values.

     (3)  Based  on risk assessments,  choose an acceptable probability
          of  equalling or exceeding the  final  design storage capacity
                                     435

-------
          and  then  choose a design  storage capacity from  the record
          simulated  in  step  (1) or  (2) which  is  equalled or exceeded
          that portion  of  the  time (e.g.,  if acceptable probability -
          0.1, then  design storage should contain runoff all  but 10%
          of the time).
     (4)  Refinements in  the  storage capacity determined in  step (3)
          can  be made to  reflect  other considerations.   For example,
          as  water  loss   rates  are  increased,  the  storage  needed
          decreases.   Therefore,  cost considerations might encourage
          an applicant  to  treat and  discharge  more  water at some cost
          to save  even higher  incremental  costs of  constructing and
          maintaining larger retention ponds.

     Estimating the input data  for the water budget  may be  a difficult ex-
ercise.  Monthly precipitation data  are relatively easy  to locate.   Like-
wise, the amount of  water included in the  waste  is  directly ascertainable
from waste  analyses  and  projected production  rate   (volumetric),  and con-
verted to a monthly  application depth (cm/no) using  the  known unit water-
shed  area.     In   contrast,    monthly  evapotranspiration   and  leaching,
especially with  management modifications,   are  troublesome parameters  to
estimate.

     The watershed of the HWLT can be  divided into areas  which  behave as
free water  surfaces  (e.g., ponds, ditches, continually wetted  plots, and
well vegetated plots) and areas  of  bare soil or poorly  cropped surfaces
which can  vary dramatically in moisture  conditions and  evaporation rates
(e.g., plots,  roads  and levees).  On  a monthly  basis,  the  portion  of the
unit watershed falling  in each category should be  determined  and an esti-
mated evapotranspiration  (EVTS)  rate  determined  for  each.  Free water sur-
face evaporation can be estimated  using published monthly Class A pan evap-
oration  data.   The  assumption may  be made  that true  evaporation  equals
about 70% of Class A  pan  evaporation.   This assumption  may be somewhat in-
accurate and can  cause an error in  estimates since  pan coefficients vary
widely from month to  month, but monthly pan coefficients are not available
from any source.   If an  annual pan  coefficient  is  available  for a nearby
reservoir, this may  be used  instead of the 70%  figure.   Pan evaporation
data for  the  U.S.,  summarized  by Brown and Thompson (1976),  is  given in
Figures 8.9 to 8.20.  No data are  available for estimating EVTS from a bare
soil or the poorly cropped surface of HWLT units.

     The only  leaching  which  Is of  concern  here  is  that which  is  lost to
deep percolation.   Perched water having primarily a horizontal component of
flow should  properly be  intercepted by  water containment  structures and-
ultimately contribute  Co  the  storage or  discharge  term of  the site water
budget.  A conservative, simplifying assumption which may be acceptable for
clay  soils  or  those having  shallow,  restrictive   clay  horizons is that
leaching Is zero.   For less restricted conditions,  there is unfortunately
very  little  information  available  for  making   good leaching  estimates.
Therefore, unless  sound data are provided from field measurements of leach-
Ing losses (not hydraulic  conductivity),  then  the conservative strategy is
to  assume  zero leaching  or,  in  cases  of heavy  hydraulic  loading  by the


                                    436

-------
.-
- I
           Figure 8.9.    Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States
                         for the month of January based on data taken from 1931 to 1960
                         (Brown and Thompson, 1976) .

-------
-
Figure 8.10.
                             Average  pan  evaporation  (in  cm)  for  the  continental  United  States
                             for  the  month of  February  based  on data  taken  from 1931  to  1960
                             (Brown and Thompson,  1976).

-------
-
-
             i-igure 8.11.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States
for the month of March based on data taken from 1931 to 1960
(Brown and Thompson, 1976) .

-------
-
-
-
              Figure 8.12.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

for the month of April based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

(Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
-
-
              Figure 8.13.   Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

                             for the month of May based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

                             (Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
.
-
              Figure 8.14.   Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

                             for the month of June based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

                             (Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
-
-
-
               Figure  8.15.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

for the month of July based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

(Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
-
-
-
               Figure 8.16.    Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

                              for the month of August based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

                              (Brown and Thompson,  1976).

-------
.
-
               Figure  8.17.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

for the month of September based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

(Brown and Thompson, 1976) .

-------
-
-
-
              Figure 8.18.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

for the month of October based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

(Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
.
              Figure 8.19.   Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States
                             for the month of November based on data taken from 1931 to 1960
                             (Brcwn and Thompson, 1976).

-------
-
--
-
               Figure 8.20.
Average pan evaporation (in cm) for the continental United States

for the month of December based on data taken from 1931 to 1960

(Brown and Thompson, 1976).

-------
waste, use the  same  approach as previously discussed in  Section  8.3.1  for
hydraulic loading rates.


8.3.4.2.2   Computer  Methods.   Computer approaches for water  budgets  have
been designed for a  number of  special  purposes,  but none  are widely avail-
able which can  be applied directly  for sizing runoff  retention ponds.   The
deterministic model  described by Perrier  and Gibson (1980) is  one useful
approach which  is readily accessible to practically anyone having access to
a  computer  terminal; however,  the  model  only goes so  far as  to generate
daily runoff data, which must  then  be  manually  integrated into a retention
pond water budget.   Considerations in  the manual calculations would be pond
evaporation, discharge  and  enhanced evaporation (EVTS)  and  leaching  (L).
The enhanced EVTS  and L terms  would be handled as a feedback  loop in the
model  by  treating them  as  though  they were additional  precipitation (an
exception is that the quantity  reaching the plot must be  reduced  to account
for aerial evaporation losses  before the  water  reaches  the ground).  There
is much need  for a  package  model,  possibly  incorporating  the Perrier and
Gibson  (1980)  model  that   includes   these   additional  features.    Other
references  on  computer  modeling  are  listed   and  discussed  in  Fleming
(1975).
8.3.4.3  Effects of Sediment Accumulations
     One  final factor in  retention pond  sizing  is an  accounting for  de-
creases  in  effective capacity because   of  sediment  buildup.    Periodic
dredging will  often be necessary to maintain the designed  useful  capacity,
and  some  additional  capacity  must be included  to  handle  sediment  buildup
prior to dredging.   The  decision will primarily be based on management  and
cost factors which are beyond  the  concern of this document; however, this
factor must be included  in the pond design calculations.
 8.3.4.4   Summary  of Retention Pond Sizing
     The  final pond capacity design  must account for the  three  influences
discussed  previously:   (1)  peak storm runoff (8.3.4.1);  (2) normal seasonal
runoff  (8.3.4.2);  (3)  and sediment accumulations (8.3.4.3).  The  values for
each  should be  added  to obtain  a total design  pond  volume.  The  storage
facility  need not  be  designed to  hold  all seasonal  runoff  plus the  peak
storm runoff  if  the runoff  storage facility will be emptied to maintain the
design  capacity.    However,  in  practice  the  storage  facility  cannot  be
emptied instantaneously  so some  additional volume above  the 25 year,  24
hour volume will be needed.  The  design also  incidentally  specifies design
discharge  rate (size of water treatment  plant,  if  needed)  and/or the quan-
tity  of runoff which  should  be irrigated  onto  the land treatment  unit to
provide enhanced evaporation and  in  some  cases  leaching.    Dote  that  some
amount  of irrigation  is  desirable under any circumstances to control  wind
                                     449

-------
dispersal  of  contaminants,  provide  water  for growing  cover  crops,  and
sustain optimal  soil moisture conditions for organics degradation.
8.3.5                    Runoff Treatment Options


     Runoff collected in retention basins can be treated or disposed by one
of  several methods.   Water can either be released  via a wastewater treat-
ment  facility permit,  a National  Pollutant Discharge  Elimination System
(NPDES) permit, or treated  on-site  in a  zero discharge system.  The method
of  handling  runoff  should  be considered  during the  design  phase  of the
facility.  If the runoff from the land treatment unit is, itself, a hazar-
dous waste, then  it  must be handled  accordingly.   The definition and cri-
teria  for  identifying a waste as hazardous are  found in 40  CFR Part 261
(EPA,  1980b).

     If the plant or company that generates the waste owns  and operates a
wastewater treatment plant,  nonhazardous  runoff water may be pumped to the
plant  for  treatment  and disposal.  An analysis of  the  discharge from the
wastewater treatment facility should  be  performed to determine if existing
permit conditions can still  be met.   Care must  be taken to ensure adequate
water  storage  capacity  in the runoff retention basins  to hold water that
exceeds the capacity of the  treatment plant.

     Where the option of using an existing wastewater  treatment facility is
not available,  application for an NPDES  permit may be  appropriate if the
runoff water  is nonhazardous.   This  would  allow direct discharge  of the
collected runoff water (with or without treatment) after analyses show that
the water meets water quality standards  set  in  the permit.   Standard  engi-
neering principles concerning diversion structures  should be  followed and
care must be taken to keep erosion of drainage  ditches to a minimum.

     If a company operates  an HWLT  unit  as  a zero discharge system, runoff
water may be used as a source  of irrigation water when soils are dry enough
to accept more water.   It  may also be sprayed  into  the  air  above the pond
or treatment area to enhance evaporation if no hazard due  to volatiles or
aerosols would result.  When sprinkler irrigation systems are used for re-
application of runoff, the  systems  should be designed  to  apply water at a
rate not exceeding the  soil infiltration rate  to  minimize  runoff.  Proper
pressure at the nozzles will help spread water  uniformly; nozzles that form
large  droplets  are  advisable when spray  drift  and  aerosols must be  mini-
mized.  Collected runoff to  be reapplied should be analyzed to determine If
it contains nutrients, salts and  other constituents important in determin-
ing waste loading on the plots.   If  the  water  contains significant concen-
trations of  these constituents  a record of water  applications  should be
kept and the results used  to determine the  cumulative loading of the con-
stituents.   In most cases, however,  collected water  contains negligible
concentrations of the constituents  used in  loading  calculations  when corn-
oared to concentrations in the waste.
                                     450

-------
     Regardless of  the method used  for runoff control,  irrigation during
dry,  hot  periods  is  beneficial  to  supply  adequate  moisture  to  maximize
microbial degradation  of  waste constituents.   For this reason, it  may be
desirable to move the  irrigation  system around to  spread the water over as
much  of  the facility  as  possible.   In some  particularly dry  seasons or
climates,  additional   irrigation  water  from  off-site  may  be  applied  to
enhance waste degradation.
8.3.6                       Subsurface Drainage
     The primary purpose  of  subsurface drainage from below  all  or part of
an HWLT unit  is to lower and  maintain the water table  below some desired
depth, to increase aeration in the surface soil, and to decrease the hazard
of groundwater  contamination.   This  may be particularly  valuable to help
maximize the utility of low lying  or  poorly  drained areas of an HWLT unit.
The seasonal high water table  should  not rise  higher than 1  meter (3 feet)
below the bottom of the treatment  zone (EPA,  1982).  If  the  soil is perme-
able with a shallow water table, a ditch cut  to a specific depth below the
water table at the low end of the  field may be  sufficient  to drain the sur-
face  soil.    Agricultural drainage   systems  are  normally  constructed  by
digging sloped  trenches  and installing  drain  tiles or  perforated plastic
pipe.   The top  of the pipe  is protected  by a  thin  paper  or  fiberglass
covering and the overlying soil is replaced (Luthin, 1957).  By controlling
the depth of  the  unsaturated zone using  subsurface drainage,  a site which
would  normally  remain excessively wet  because of  a  shallow water table
might be accessible and usable for land  treatment.

     Design and spacing of a drainage system can be accomplished using one
of several  steady state  or  non-steady state relationships.   The decision
about which relationship  to  use is generally based on  experience and site
conditions.  The Soil Conservation Service has historically used  the clas-
sical Hooghaudt equation  (Hooghaudt,  1937; Hillel,  1971),  also known as the
ellipse steady state drainage  equation,  which includes  a number of simpli-
fying assumptions.   The  relationship* performs  well in  humid regions where
the steady  state flow assumption  is   a  fair  approximation  of  site condi-
tions.  In the western U.S., however,  the Bureau of Reclamation uses a non-
steady  state  approach,  particularly  the Glover  equation  (Glover,  1964;
Dummn, 1964; Moody,  1966), which  accounts for arid conditions where drain-
age is  intermittent.   Another  non-steady state solution  to drain spacing
design is  the van Schllfgaarde relationship (van  Schilfgaarde,  1963;  van
Schilfgaarde, 1965; Bouwer and van Schilfgaarde,  1963).   Additional steady
state  and  non-steady  state relationships have  been  developed  based  on
varying approaches and  assumptions,  as  discussed by Kirkham et al. (1974)
and van Schilfgaarde (1974).   Two important considerations in choosing and
using a suitable relationship are  that the explicit  assumptions used in the
equation fit  the  particular HWLT site  conditions  and  that the  necessary
inputs are accurately estimated.
                                    451

-------
      Collection  and  treatment  of  the  water   collected  should  generally
 follow guidelines discussed above for  runoff water.   In general,  the water
 should be collected in a pond or basin.  From there it may be discharged to
 a wastewater treatment plant, directly discharged under an NPDES permit, or
 used internally for irrigation or other purposes.  However, if the water is
 a  hazardous  waste,  it must  be  treated and/or  disposed  as  a  hazardous
 waste.
 8.4                        AIR EMISSION CONTROL
      Air quality may be adversely affected by a land treatment operation if
 hazardous volatiles,  odors  or particulates  are emitted  during  storage,
 handling, application and incorporation of waste or during  subsequent  cul-
 tivation. Wind dispersal of contaminants and dust  from traffic on facility
 roads may also present a problem.  Management  plans should  be developed to
 avoid such emissions as much as possible and to handle  these  situations if
 they arise.   On an operational  basis,  wind,  atmospheric stability, and  tem-
 perature are Important considerations  for timing the application of wastes,
 especially volatile wastes.
 8.4.1                             Volatiles
     Volatiles  may be reduced to an acceptable level  through  management  of
 loading  rates and proper placement  of the waste  as  determined from  pilot
 studies  (Section  7.2.3).    Wastes  containing a  significant  fraction  of
 easily volatilized constituents should be  applied at a depth of  15 cm  by
 subsurface  injection.   Volatilization  losses will  effectively  be reduced  as
 gases move  through the  soil  profile.

     Irrigation of the  soil  surface may also  aid  in  reducing the net  flux
 into  the  atmosphere,  lessening  the   impact   of   volatilized components.
 Application of  wastes containing significant quantities  of  volatiles should
 be made  when  soils are  in a moist but friable  state.   Soils which are too
 wet are  easily  puddled  by heavy machinery  which  could reduce aeration and
 the capacity  of  the soil to  degrade organic waste  constituents.


 8.4.2                              Odor
     If a waste  contains  sufficient  easily decomposable organic matter and
if oxygen  is limited, the  waste may develop  an undesirable  odor.   While
odors do  not indicate that  a land  treatment  system  is  malfunctioning or
that  environmental damage  is occuring,  it  has in  some  cases  become  a
serious enough  to prevent the use of land  treatment  at a  site which was
otherwise ideally suited.  Odors from waste materials often  are  a  result of
sulfides, mercaptans, indoles,  or  amines.    Disposal  techniques  can be
designed to avoid the formation and release of these compounds.

                                    452

-------
     The land treatment of waste having potential for emitting an odor gen-
erally results in some odor  during  the period between application and com-
plete incorporation.  Little can be  done  to  avoid or circumvent this prob-
lem,  just  as  the  farmer  can  do little  to  avoid odors  when he  spreads
manure.  Potential odor problems should be  considered when a disposal site
is selected, and design should be based on the acceptable limits for odors,
volatiles and particulates.  Proximity to housing and thoroughfares as well
as  the  prevailing wind  direction  need to  be  considered.    Frequency  and
severity of  atmospheric  inversions   that  may trap malodorous  gases should
also be evaluated.  Ideally, isolated sites should be selected but, in some
cases, this is not possible.  When  locations adjacent to public areas must
be used, certain steps can be taken  to minimize odor problems.

     Perhaps  the  best method  of odor  avoidance  is  subsurface injection.
Soil  has  a  large  capacity  to  absorb  gases.   If a  waste  is  subsurface
injected and does not ooze to the surface,  few odor problems are likely to
occur.  In  a properly designed system, the  waste application rate depends
on the waste  degradation rate.   Although  tilling helps to enhance  aeration
and  degradation,  where  a  significant odor  problem  exists,  tillage  may
aggravate the odor problem.

     If the waste is  surface applied,  either by dumping or spraying from a
vehicle or  irrigation system,  odor problems  can be  minimized  by quickly
incorporating the waste  into the soil.   Odors  often increase when organic
wastes are  spread  or when mixing occurs, particularly when heavy  applica-
tions are made.  It  may, therefore,  be desirable to spread and incorporate
wastes when  the wind is  from a direction  that  will  minimize complaints.
Emission  of  maladorous  vapors  can  often  be  reduced  substantially  by
thoroughly mixing the waste with the soil; this can be  achieved by  repeated
discing when the  ratio of  waste  to  soil  is  not  too high.    In other
instances, complete soil cover may be needed  to prevent odors.  This  can be
achieved by  using  turning  plows or   turning  (one-way)  discs.  Large  plows,
such  as those used for deep plowing,  may also be used for covering thick
applications of maladorous waste.

     Organic  wastes  that are spread on  the  land by  flooding followed by
water decantation  are likely to develop  odor problems between decantation
and incorporation.  As long as an adequate layer  of water  covers  the  waste,
odor  is  generally not  a problem.   Consequently,  it may  be desirable to
delay decantation  until  wind directions  are  favorble and clear weather is
likely.   With  proper design,  including peripheral drainage  ditches,  it
should  be  possible  to rapidly  decant excess  water  so incorporation can
begin.  While mixing is  often desirable to  hasten  drying and to speed the
oxidation of  the organic constituents,  it may be  necessary to minimize mix-
ing  after  the  initial incorporation  for  situations  with  potential odor
problems,  since odor will  often occur  again when  unoxidized material is
brought to the  surface.  Drying  and  oxidation may be  slower,  and  it may not
be  possible  to repeat applications  or establish vegetation as quickly as
with  more frequent mixing.   Therefore, more  land may be required  for  land
treatment  of a  waste having  this   characteristic and  odor  might be the
application  limiting  constituent in  this  situation.
                                     453

-------
      There  are  many chemicals  on  the  market  for  odor  control.    These
 Include:   disinfectants which act as biocides; chemical oxidants  which  act
 as  biocides  and also supply oxygen to the microbial  population;  deodorants
 which react  with odoriferous  gases to prevent  their release; and  masking
 agents  which may impart  a more  acceptable  odor to  cover the undesirable
 odor.   Hydrogen peroxide  is  a commonly used  biocide and oxidizing  agent.
 Pountney  and Turner  (1979) have  reported success using  hydrogen peroxide to
 control hydrogen sulfide  odors in wastewater  treatment  facitilites.   Strunk
 (1979)  suggests  that hydrogen peroxide acts primarily by  oxidizing  reduced
 sulfur  compounds.   Warburton et  al.  (1979)  conducted  a study testing  the
 effectiveness  of twenty-two commercial odor controlling products  including
 chlorine,  mechanical mixing,  waste  oil,  wintergreen  oil,  and   activated
 charcoal.  He  found that  only mechanical  mixing and chlorination signifi-
 cantly  reduced  odor  from  a swine manure.   Chlorination may kill  the  active
 soil  microbes which  are important to waste degradation.   Thus, while  it is
 possible  that  some  commercial  products may  be effective in reduction  of
 odors from certain wastes, alternate means including  avoidance or  oxidizing
 agents  should be considered first.

     Odor  controlling  chemicals  have been applied  by direct  incorporation
 into  the waste  prior to application,  by manual or solid set  spraying  along
 borders  or over entire  areas,   and  by point  spraying  using a manifold
 mounted on the  rear  of  the machine that spreads or incorporates  the  waste.
 Before  an odor controlling chemical is employed,  testing must demonstrate
 that  it does not inhibit  the waste-degrading  microbial  population.

     Presently,  there are  no instruments available  that  have  the  ability to
 provide an objective determination of  odor (Dolan, 1975).  Therefore, odor
 evaluation is  accomplished by using a panel of Individuals  to provide  an
 odor  intensity  ranking.  Experience has shown  that an eight  member  panel,
 consisting of  50% women yields the most reliable  results.   Generally,  the
 air sample collected in the  field is  diluted  in  varying proportions with
 fresh air to allow  the individuals to establish  an odor threshold.   The
 only  response  that  is required  from each  individual   is  a  yes   or   no
 response.  Using semilogarlthmic  paper, the threshold odor concentration is
 determined from the intersection of  the  50% panel  response line.   From
 these data the odor  emission rate  can  be computed.  A more detailed  discus-
 sion  of  the  odor panel   approach  is   included  in  the  following  sources
 (Dolan, 1975; Dravinicks,  1975).
8.4.3                              Dust
     Dust problems often occur  on access roads used to transport  the  waste
to various  plots within  an HWLT  unit.    Occasionally,  dust will also  be
raised during discing  or  mixing operations when  the  soil in the  treatment
zone is  dry.   The wind dispersal  of particulates  from  the treatment  zone
must be  controlled (EPA, 1982).   One method of controlling particulates  is
to surface  apply water.   A good source  of  water for  this is  often the
accumulated runoff.   Dust  suppressing treatments  including oil or  calcium
                                     454

-------
chloride may be used  on roadways,  if desirable, but excessive application
should be avoided.  Care should be  taken  in selecting  a dust control pro-
duct to be sure that it does not adversely affect the treatment process or
cause environmental damage.

     A windbreak may also be planted to help control the dispersal of dust
and aerosols.  A study of the spread of bacteria from land treating sewage
sludge showed that bacteria were recovered  3 m downwind in a dense brushy
area  and  61 m downwind in a  sparsely vegetated area  (EPA, 1977).   Van
Arsdel (1967) and Van Arsdel et al.  (1958) have used colored  smoke grenades
to study  the movement of wind around windbreaks and across  fields.   They
found that  a spot  of  dry soil such  as  a  levee or a bare  spot  in a  field
produces warmer air which causes an  updraft.   A windbreak of a single row
of trees  created a  complete circulation cell  around the trees.   There was
an updraft on the sunny side of the  tree  line  and a  downdraft on the  shady
side.   The air on  the shady  side  actually  moved under  the trees  and  up
along the sunny side of  the windbreak  (Van Arsdel et al.,  1958).  Although
windbreaks may be  helpful  in  certain cases, there  effectiveness should  be
evaluated on a case-by-case basis.


8.5                           EROSION CONTROL


     Control of wind  and water erosion during the active  life  and  closure
period for an HWLT unit  is needed both to assist  in the proper  functioning
of the unit and to prevent contaminants from moving off-site.  Soil  conser-
vation  methods,  developed  by the USDA, have  been  widely used to  control
erosion on  agricultural fields and  can readily be adapted for  use  on HWLT
units.  Wind erosion  may be a particular  problem during dry seasons  or  in
arid  regions,  but  maintaining a vegetative  cover  and moist  soil  should
lessen the problem.

     When sloping land is  used for an  HWLT  unit,  terraces  and  grassed
waterways  should  be used to minimize  erosion  by  controlling runoff water.
This  is essential  when large  areas  are left without vegetation for  one  or
more  seasons by repeated waste applications, which may  occur with a sludge-
type  waste  disposal  operation.    Proper conservation terracing  is  also
important  if  water   is  applied  to   a  continuously  vegetated  surface.
Terraces  slow the  flow of intensive  storm water, allowing optimal infiltra-
tion  and  putting less  strain on retention basins.  Furthermore, by decreas-
ing the slope length,  less sediment  will  erode and accumulate in the reten-
tion  structures.   Runoff water quality will be improved  before  the water
enters  retention structures;  this  will  reduce  the amount  of  accumulated
organics.    Improved  water quality  decreases  the  load on  the wastewater
treatment plant  and  increases the  possibility of  achieving water  quality
acceptable  for direct discharge.


8.5.1               Design Considerations for  Terraces


      Terracing is  a means of  controlling  erosion by constructing benches or
broad channels across  a slope.   The  original  type of  bench  terrace was


                                   455

-------
designed for slopes of 25  to 30% and  resembled a  giant  stairway.   They were
very costly and  not easily accessible for field equipment.  Modern  conser-
vation bench terraces, which are  adapted to slopes of 6-8% aid in moisture
retention as well  as  erosion prevention  (Schwab  et  al.,  1971).   The third
type of terrace  is the broadbase terrace  which consists of a water conduct-
ing  channel  and ridge  as  shown in Fig. 8.21.   The  general  placement  of
terraces is across  the  slope with a  slight grade  toward  one or both ends.
The collected runoff  then  drains off  the  terrace  into  a waterway.

     The number  of terraces  needed is governed by the slope, soil type  and
vegetative cover.  The vertical interval  (VI), defined  as  the vertical dis-
tance  between  the  channels  of  successive   terraces,  is  calculated   as
follows:

                            VI - aS + b                               (8.3)

where

     VI • vertical interval in feet;
      a - geographic  constant (Fig. 8.22);
      b - soil erodibility and cover  condition constants  (Fig.  8.22);
          and
      S - slope  of the land above  the terrace in  percent.

This  is  only an estimate of  the amount of  terracing needed and  can  be
varied up to 10% in the field without serious danger of failure.

     Terraces can be  constructed either  level or with  a grade toward one or
both ends.  If  level, barriers or dams  are needed every 120-150  meters to
prevent total washout in  the event of a.  break.   The  advantage to these is
that there is no length restriction nor  is a grassed waterway needed at  the
ends.  The disadvantage  is that  the  depth needs  to be greater to accommo-
date a rainfall  event without  overtopping.   For graded terraces,  with well
and poorly drained soils,  the  minimum grades  are 0.1 and  0.2%, respective-
ly.   Suggested  maximum grades decrease  as  terrace length increases (Table
8.5).  The  maximum terrace length is usually considered  to be 300 to  550
meters for a  one direction terrace and  twice that  for a terrace draining
toward both ends.  As slopes  increase, terrace width and  channel  depth  in-
crease, resulting  in more difficult   construction  and maintenance  (Tables
8.6 and 8.7).   The minimum  cross  sectional area for  a sloping terrace is
0.5 to  1  m^,  while  for a level  terrace 1 m^ is  considered  the minimum.
Most level terraces are  only designed to hold 5  to  10 cm of rain and thus
may not be well suited to  use at HWLT units in many parts  of the country.
                                     456

-------
               <2%  Slope
                    cut
          >% Slope   \
                                       fill
                  50ft            100 ft
                    BROADBASE
              .§% Slope
         ?__    /-Level
            DO       200        300
             CONSERVATION BENCH
                           Slope
            Level or
          reverse slope
                  ft
                   BENCH
                50ft
Figure 8.21.
Schematic diagram of general types of terraces
(Schwab et al., 1971). Reprinted by permission
of John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
                        457

-------
Figure 8.22.
Values of a and b* in terrace spacing equation,
VI - aS + b (ASAE, Terracing Committee, 1980).
Reprinted by permission of ASAE.
*Values for b vary and are influenced by soil
erodibility, cropping systems, and management
systems; in all zones, b will have a value of
0.3, 0.6, 0.9 or 1.2.  The low value is appli-
cable to very erodible soils with conventional
tillage and little crop residue; the high value
is applicable to erosion resistant soils where
no-tillage methods are used and a large amount
of crop residue remains on the soil surface.
                             458

-------
TABLE 8.5  MAXIMUM TERRACE GRADES*
Terrace length (m)
or length from upper
end of long terraces
153 or more
153 or less
61 or less
31 or less

Erosive soil
(Silt loam)
0.35
0.50
1.00
2.00
Slope (percent)
Resistant
(Gravelly or
0.50
0.65
1.50
2.50

soil
Rocky)




* Beasley (1958).


     Field layout of terraces may be done along the contours, often result-
ing in odd shaped areas, or  they  may  be made parallel, allowing for easier
mechanical operations such as waste application,  mowing and discing.  When
parallel terraces are used,  it  may be necessary  to  smooth the slope prior
to construction.  As  noted above, variations of  the vertical interval can
be made up to 10% and some lesser variances  in  channel grade can be toler-
ated.

     When the land  has  a slope  of less than 2%,  as  is the case along much
of the Gulf Coast,  contour levees similar  to those used in rice fields may
be used.  The vertical  interval between levees is typically  6 to 9 cm and
the  levees  are  put in along  the contour.   For  proper  water management,
spillways should be provided to  prevent wash  out in  the  event  of a heavy
storm.   Ideally, spillways will  conduct water  across a  grassed  area to a
retention pond or treatment  facility.

     Construction  is  normally  accomplished  using graders and bulldozers.
Allowances of 10-25%  must  be made for  settlement.  Any obvious high spots
or depressions  should be corrected quickly.  All traffic on sloped areas
should be  parallel  to the terraces.   All terraces  should be vegetated  as
soon as  possible using lime and  fertilizer  as  needed.  Maintenance  should
include  monthly  inspections,   annual  fertilization,  and  mowing.   Since
terraces channel the  flow  of water, any terrace  that  is  overtopped,  washed
out, or  damaged  by  equipment should be repaired  as soon as conditions per-
mit to prevent excessive stress on lower terraces.  Without proper mainten-
ance and repair, the  whole terrace system may  be ruined, resulting  in  the
formation of erosion  gullies and  highly contaminated runoff.
8.5.2          Design Considerations  for Vegetated Waterways


     A  vegetated waterway is a properly  proportioned  channel,  protected by
vegetation  and designed to absorb runoff water energy without damage to the
                                     459

-------
TABLE 8.6  TERRACE DIMENSIONS:  LEVEL OR RIDGE TERRACE*
                                                       t
Field slope
 (percent)
Terrace Channel Depth
       d (cm)
                                                 Approximate Slope Ratio*
CBS
RFS
RBS
2
4
6
8
10
12
15+
37
37
37
37
37
40
40
6:1
5:1
5:1
5:1
5:1
4:1
3.5:1
6:1
6:1
6:1
6:1
5:1
4:1
3.5:1
6:1
6:1
5:1
5:1
5:1
4:1
2.5:1
* Soil Conservation Service (1958).
t Channel capacity based on retaining 5 cm runoff.
* CBS - channel back slope; RFS - ridge front slope; RBS » ridge back
  slope.
+ Terrace ridge and RBS to be dept in sod.
TABLE 8.7  TERRACE DIMENSIONS:  GRADED OR CHANNEL TERRACE*^
Field slope
(percent)
Terrace channel depth, d (cm)
Terrace length (m)
61 122 183 244 305
Approximate
Slope Ratio*
CBS RFS RBS
2
4+
6
8
10
12
15
24
21
21
21
21
18
18
27
27
24
24
24
24
21
30
30
27
27
27
27
27
37
34
30
30
30
30
30
37
34
30
30
30
30
30
10:1
6:1
6:1
4:1

4:1
4:1
10:1
8:1
8:1
6:1

6:1
4:1
10:1
8:1
8:1
6:1

6:1
2.5:1
* Soil Conservation Service (1958).
* Channel capacity based on retaining 5 cm  runoff.
# CBS - channel back slope; RFS - ridge front slope; RBS  -  ridge back
  slope.
+ Terrace ridge and RBS to be kept in sod.
                                    460

-------
soil.  Waterways  are used to  safely channel runoff from  watersheds,  ter-
races, diversion channels and ponds.   Thus,  in  a typical HWLT unit, runoff
water from a sloping area  is intercepted by either  a  terrace or diversion
channel and flows  to a vegetated waterway which directs the water  to the
retention basin without causing erosion.  Emergency spillways for ponds are
also frequently designed as vegetated waterways.

     The three  basic shapes  for waterways are  trapezoidal,  triangular and
parabolic.  Since many of the waterways at HWLT units flow near a berm, the
parabolic  shaped waterway  will  function best  with the  least  danger  of
eroding the base  of the berm.  A cross section of  a  parobolic channel is
shown in Fig. 8.23.

     When designing  a waterway to fit  a particular site, the main consider-
ations are vegetation,  slope,  flow velocity, side slope and flow capacity.
Suggested vegetation for use in vegetated waterways  is presented  in  Section
8.7.2 (Table 8.11).   The permanent  vegetation  selected  needs to be chosen
on the basis of soil type,  persistence, growth form, velocity  and quantity
of runoff, establishment time, availability  of  seeds or  sprigs, and  compat-
ability with the waste  being applied.   Since the area periodically  carries
large quantities  of water, sod forming vegetation is preferred.    In many
cases, the vegetation being  grown on  the waste application areas may also
be suitable for the  waterways.

     The design velocity,  or flow velocity,  is the average velocity within
the  channel  during  peak  flow.    This can  be  estimated by  applying  the
Manning formula as follows:

                                1  49  »2/3 sl/2
                            V  -I^i.*' .s                          (8.4)
                                 n
where
     V - flow velocity  in  feet/sec  (fps);
     n - roughness  coefficient  (0.04 is  an estimate for most vegetated
         areas);
     t - design  top width  of  water  flow  (ft);
     d - design  depth of flow (ft);
     a - cross sectional area in ft^ calculated as 2/3 td;
     p » perimeter  calculated as
                                t +   -;  and

      S  -  slope of  the channel in ft/ft.

 Suitable  flow velocities for  various slopes are given  in Table 8.8.   The
 product of flow velocity and cross sectional area  of flow gives  the flow
 capacity, which is calculated as follows:
                                     461

-------
                                       a  v
                                                                 (8.5)
 where
Q » flow capacity In ft^/sec;
a » cross sectional area of flow
v » velocity in fps.
                                            ;  and
     A  properly  designed waterway  (Fig.  8.23) will  carry  away  runoff  from a
 25-year,  24-hour storm at  velocities equal to or less than the  permissible
 velocity  shown Table 8.8.   Nomographs such  as  the  one illustrated in  Fig.
 8.24  are  available  to  determine the  channel  size  needed  (Schwab et  al.,
 1971).  To  use these nomographs, place a mark  on the slope scale equal  to
 the  channel slope  and work  the  two  discharge  scales  with  the designed
 discharge rate.   Using a  straight  edge,  draw a line  from  the mark on the
 slope scale  through the mark on the nearest  discharge scale and extend  it
 until it  intersects the top width  scale.   This  is the total construction
 top  width (T).   From  this  point  on  the  top  width  scale, extend  a  line
 through the second  discharge  scale where  marked  and extend it  until  it
 intersects  the total depth  scale.   This  value is  the  total construction
 depth (D).
TABLE 8.8  PERMISSIBLE VELOCITIES  FOR CHANNELS LINED WITH  VEGETATION*
                                    Permissible velocity  (fps)
                       Erosion resistant  soils
                           (percent slope)
                                                Easily eroded soils
                                                  (percent slope)
  Cover
                  0-5
5-10
Over 10
0-5
                                    5-10
Over 10
Bermuda grass
Buffalo grass
Kentucky bluegrass
Smooth brome
Blue grama
Tall fescue
Lespedeza serica
Weeping lovegrass
Kudzu
Alfalfa
Crabgrass
Grass mixture

Annuals for
 temporary
 protection
3.5



 5


3.5
                           4


                          NR
                                    NR
          NR
          NR
                    2.5
                     NR
            2.5     NR
                   NR
                               NR
                   NR
* Schwab et al. (1971).
'  NR - not recommended.
                                     462

-------
  LEGEND:
       D = Total  construction depth
       d = Design depth of flow
       T = Total  construction top width
       t = Design top width of water flow
Figure 8.23.   Cross-sectional diagram of a parabolic channel.
                             463

-------
  Slope, per cent
     0.5 r
           v = 3.fps
                   Discharge
                     cfs
                      300
                      240
                      180

                      120
                      90
                      10
Top width
ft
-
-
~"
—
.•e.
-
—
—
—
—
—
-
-=
—
120

100
90
80---_
70
60
SO
45
40
35
30
2S
20
Discharge
cfs
300 r
240 -
180 -

120 -
""~— . «o -
60 ^
-
30 -
20 -
-
10 -


                                    Total depth
                               (including 0.3-ft freeboard)
                                        ft
                                         3.0
                                         2.5
                                         2.0
                                         1.5
                                                          1.0
                                                          0.9
                                                          0.8
                                                          0.6
                                                         - 0.5
                               -MS

                             Top width
                             Total {depth
                          Channel cross section
Figure 8.24.
Nomograph for parabolic cross  sections with a
velocity of  3 fps (Schwab  et al., 1971).
Reprinted by  permission of John Wiley  & Sons,  Inc.
                                     464

-------
     The actual  construction of  the waterway  needs  to be  done carefully
using  roadgraders  and  bulldozers,  as  necessary.    Careful  surveying  and
marking of  field  areas is needed  before  beginning earthwork.   The entire
waterway area  should be vegetated  as  soon as  possible  after construction
and normal  agricultural applications of lime  and fertilizer used in accor-
dance with  site-specific  recommendations.  Broadcast  seeding is  the most
common practice for  planting  but  drilling,  sprigging and sodding are other
possible techniques.   If drilling  or   sprigging is  used,  rows  should  run
diagonally  or  crosswise to the  direction of  water  flow.   Due  to  the  ex-
pense, sodding is usually done only on  critical areas needing immediate co-
ver.

     Maintenance practices for vegetated  waterways  include periodic mowing
to promote  sod formation.  Annual  fertilization is  necessary and should be
done according to  local recommendations.  Excess sediment and debris that
accumulates in waterways  after heavy rains, should  be  cleaned out to pre-
vent damage to vegetation.  A fan shaped  accumulation of sediment is likely
to  form where  the  waterway  joins  the  retention  pond.    These  deposits
need to be  removed if they accumulate to  a point that interferes with water
flow.  A more  complete discussion of waterway  design  and  construction can
be found in Schwab et al. (1971).

     In addition to preventing erosion, grassed waterways  provide a second-
ary benefit by  improving  water quality.   In  one study, a 24.4  m waterway
removed 30% of the  2,4-D  that originally entered the waterway (Asmussen et
al., 1977).   Thus,  areas which  may potentially  carry contaminated runoff
water should be  vegetated to help  improve water quality.   Other  critical
areas that  should  be vegetated are waterways  leading into runoff retention
ponds and emergency spillways.
8.6                        MANAGEMENT OF SOIL pH


     Management of  acid or alkaline soils  generally requires the  addition
of some type  of chemical amendment for the  land  treatment unit to  operate
properly.  If  a near  neutral soil pH is  not maintained, plant nutritional
problems may  develop,  soil microorganisms  may become less active,  and  sur-
vival of symbiotic  nitrogen fixing bacteria may be reduced,  resulting  in  a
slower rate of waste degradation.  Soil samples should  be  taken periodical-
ly and analyzed for pH.  Based on  the sample results, the  appropriate quan-
tity and type of chemical  amendment should  be applied.


8.6.1                    Management of Acid  Soils


     Numerous  methods  exist  for  measuring  soil  acidity.    The three  most
common methods are:

     (1)  titration with base or equilibration with  lime;
                                    465

-------
      (2)   leaching  with a  buffered  solution followed  by analysis  of
           the  leachate for  the amount  of  base  consumed by  reaction
           with  the  soil; and

      (3)   subtracting  the  sum of exchangeable bases from GEC  (Coleman
           and Thomas,  1967).

      Liming  of  soils refers  to  the  addition of  calcium or magnesium  com-
pounds  that  are  capable  of  reducing  acidity (Tisdale  and Nelson,  1975).
Although  the term "lime"  is  frequently  used  for  material such as  Ca(OH)2,
CaC03,  MgC(>3,  and  calcium  silicate  slags,  it  correctly  refers  only  to
CaO.  The  other materials  are properly referred to as limestone and  liming
agents.   When  liming  agents  react  with acid soils,  calcium or magnesium
replaces hydrogen on the exchange  complex (Brady,  1974),  as follows:

             »N
              Micelle + Ca(OH)2  — >  Ca-Micelle +  2H20
             H'
              Micelle + Ca(HC03)2 — > Ca-Micelle +  2H20 +  2C02
                        In solution
            H\
              Micelle + CaCC>3 — > Ca-Micelle -f H20 + C02
            Hx

     As  the  soil pH is  raised, plant  nutritional  problems that  accompany
low  soil pH  are reduced.   Soil microorganisms,  such  as  those  responsible
for  decomposition  of  plant residues and  nitrification,  are more  active  at
pH 5.5-6.5  (Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).   Nonsymbiotic  nitrogen  fixation  by
Azotobacter  spp.  occurs  mainly  in soils  above  pH  6.0  (Black,   1968).
Survival  of  symbiotic  nitrogen  fixing  bacteria,  Rhizobium   spp.,  and
nodulation  of  legume  roots  is enhanced  by liming  acid  soils  (Pohlman,
1966).   Many plant diseases caused  by  fungi are decreased by  liming  acid
soils.   Infection  of  clover by Sclerotinia trifoliorum was greatly  reduced
by liming acid soils In  Finland  (Black,  1968).   It is  also  desirable  to
maintain  the pH of  the zone of waste incorporation near neutral  to minimize
the  toxicity and mobility of most metals.

     Good management  practice  requires  application of  enough  liming agent
to raise  soil pH to the desired level  and addition of sufficient material
every three to five years  to maintain that level.  Soil sampling  and test-
ing  should  be employed  to predict  the need for additional  liming.   The
hydrogen  ion  concentration of  the  soil will not reach  the  desired level
immediately.  The  change  may  take  six to eight months  and, in  the  case  of
added dolomitic limestone,  the  pH may increase  for five years after liming
(Bohn et al., 1979).
                                     466

-------
8.6.1.1                      Liming Materials


     Liming agents must contain  calcium  or magnesium  in  combination  with  an
anion that reduces the activity  of hydrogen, and  thus  aluminum,  in the  soil
solution (Tisdale and Nelson,  1975).   Many materials may be used as liming
agents; however,  lime (CaO) is  the most  effective agent  since it  reacts
almost  immediately.    Thus,  lime  is  useful  when  very  rapid  results are
needed.  Lime is not very practical  for  common  usage  because  it  is caustic,
difficult to mix with soil, and  quite  expensive (Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).
The second most  effective liming  agent  is Ca(OH)2>  referred  to as slaked
lime,  hydrated  lime  and  builder's  lime.   Like  CaO, it  is  used   only  in
unusual  circumstances  since  it  is  expensive  and  difficult   to   handle
(Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).

     Agricultural  limestone  may be  calcitic   limestone (CaCC^), dolomite
               or  dolomitic  limestone,  which  is  a  mixture  of  the  two.
Limestone  is  generally  ground  and  pulverized  to  pass a specified  sieve
size.  If all the material passes  a  10-mesh sieve and  at least 50% passes a
100-mesh  sieve,  it  is  classified as  a fine  limestone  (Brady,  1974).   A
fine limestone reacts  more  quickly  than a coarse grade.   The neutralizing
value of these limestones depends  on the amount  of  impurities,  but  usually
ranges from 65-100%  (Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).

     In some  eastern states, deposits of  soft calcium  carbonate, known  as
marl, exist.  This material  which  is usually low in  magnesium is occasion-
ally used  as a  liming agent.   Its  neutralizing value is usually 70-90%
(Barber, 1967).  In  areas where  slags  are  produced,  they are sometimes used
as liming agents but  their neutralizing  value  is variable  and usually lower
than that of marl  (Tisdale and Nelson, 1975).

     Some waste materials may  be suitable  as liming  agents  and  can  be used
when  available;  but,  these materials  are  generally not  as efficient  as
agricultural limestone.  An  example  of a waste that may be used for liming
is blast furnace slag from pig iron  production, which is mainly calcium  and
magnesium aluminosilicates and may also  contain other essential micronutri-
ents (Barber, 1967).  Basic  or Thomas  slag,  a  by-product of the open hearth
method  of  steel  production, is  high in phosphorus  and has  a neutralizing
value  of  about  60 to  70%  (Tisdale and  Nelson,  1975).  The  composition of
slags varies quite a bit, another  type of  open hearth slag is high in iron
and  manganese,  but  has   a  lower  neutralizing   value   (Barber,   1967).
Electric-furnace slag,  a by-product of  electric-furnace reduction   of phos-
phate  rock,  is  mainly calcium  silicate.    It  contains 0.9-2.3% ?205  and
has a  neutralizing value of 65-80%  (Tisdale  and Nelson,  1975).   Miscella-
neous wastes  such  as flue dust  from cement plants, refuse  lime from sugar
beet factories,  waste lime  from paper mills, and by-product lime from lead
mines have been  used effectively as  liming agents (Barber, 1967).   Many  fly
ashes  produced  by coal  burning power plants  are sufficiently  alkaline to
increase the pll  of soil  and  are  frequently used  to replace a  portion of  the
lime needed to reclaim mine  sites  (Capp, 1978).
                                      467

-------
8.6.1.2                Calculating Lime Requirements


     The  lime  requirement of  a particular  soil  depends on  its buffering
capacity and its pH.  An equilibrium extraction of the soil with a buffered
salt  solution  followed by  determination of  exchange  acidity is  a common
method  for  determining the  lime requirement  (Peech,  1965b).   Many state
experiment stations have  determined  lime  requirements  for their  major soil
series and constructed buffer curves.  These curves (Fig. 8.25) relate base
saturation percentage  in  the soil to  soil  pH by  expressing  milligrams of
acidity in soil  as  a  function of soil pH.   In addition, lime requirements
are  expressed  in terms  of  the  calcium  carbonate equivalent  (Table 8.9).
TABLE 8.9  COMPOSITION OF A REPRESENTATIVE COMMERCIAL OXIDE AND
           HYDROXIDE OF LIME EXPRESSED IN DIFFERENT WAYS*
Forms of
Lime
Commercial
oxide
Commercial
hydroxide
Conventional
Oxide
Content
%
CaO - 77
MgO - 18
CaO » 60
MgO - 12
Calcium
Oxide
Equivalent
102.0
76.7
Neutralizing
Power
182.1
136.9
Elemental
Content
%
Ca - 55.0
Mg - 10.8
Ca • 42.8
Mg - 7.2
Brady (1974).
When using CaC03 as a liming agent, the following formula can be used:

            Required change in          C£C          .  kg CaCO
             base saturation                           required/ha

Using Fig. 8.25  as an example, to  raise  the soil pH from  5.5  to 6.0,  the
base saturation must change from 0.50 to 0.75.  Assuming the soil CEC  is  17
meg/100  gm,   the  lime  requirement  is  calculated  using  equation  8.6  as
follows:

              0.25 x 17 x 1121 - 4764 kg CaC03 required/ha

     When other liming agents are used, a correction factor is added to  the
equation.  This correction factor  is  the  ratio of the equivalent weight  of
the new  liming  agent to the equivalent weight of CaC03>   For  example,  if
CaC03  (equivalent  wt  - 50)  is replaced  by  MgC03 (equivalent  wt  -  42)
the lime requirement calculated using equation 8.6 would then be:

          0.25 x 17 x 1121 x 42/50 - 4287 kg MgC03  required/ha
                                     468

-------
    8.0
    7.0-
t


I
    6.0
    5.0
    4.0
     3.0
        0            25             50            75

                     PERCENT BASE SATURATION


  Figure 8.25.   General shape for the lime requirement curve for a
                sandy loam.
100
                               469

-------
 8.6.2                  Management of Alkaline Soils


     An  estimated 4 billion kilograms  of  waste  sulfuric acid are  produced
 each  year in the U.S., mainly  as  a by-product  of  smelting industries and
 coal burning  power  plants  (Phung et al.,  1978).   This acid may have  poten-
 tial for  use  in  the reclamation of  salt affected soils.  In addition, sul-
 furic  acid  could be disposed of by land treating  these  wastes  on saline,
 saline-sodic,  and sodic  soils.   Using  land treatment  as  a disposal mech-
 anism  for these  wastes could provide numerous benefits.  Land treating salt
 affected  soils with sulfuric  acid  could increase water penetration,  aid in
 vegetative  establishment,  and increase  water soluble P.   Thus,  the  use of
 surplus sulfuric acid may  be  beneficial to both farmers and waste  disposal
 operators.  The  value  of using surplus  sulfuric acid from copper  smelters
 to  increase water penetration into sodic soils  was  studied in the labora-
 tory.  At optimum application rates equivalent to 12,000-40,000 kg/ha, the
 waste  acid  effectively  increased water penetration  in the sodium-affected
 soil  (Ttahia et  al., 1975).   Another laboratory study showed ^804  to be
 more effective  in reclaiming of sodic  soils than  two  other  commonly used
 amendments,  CaS04 and  CaCl2  (Prather  et al., 1978).   Mine spoils in the
 Northern  Great  Plains are generally  saline, calcareous  shales  that  are
 quite  difficult  to revegetate  (Wali  and Sandoval,  1975).   Waste  sulfuric
 acid from coal  burning  power plants could  help  establish vegetation.  One
 study  found  that,  even in the  absence of  fertilizer,  ^804  amendments
 increased the phosphorus  content  of   thick spike  wheatgrass  and  yellow
 sweetclover (Melilotus  officinalis) grown  on  mine spoil  (Safay  and Wali,
 1979).    The  amount of  H2S04  needed   to  reclaim  sodic  soils  depends  on
 individual  soil  and water properties, and ranges from 2,000-6,000 kg/ha for
 moderately  sodium affected  soils to 6,000-12,000 kg/ha for severely  sodium
 affected  soils (Miyamoto et al., 1975).

     Waste  acid  may provide a  solution  to  nutrient deficiencies which are
 an  ever present  problem in  calcareous soils in the Southwest.  Acid  appli-
 cation to phosphorus (P)  deficient, calcareous  soils  in Arizona increased
 the water soluble P and the P-supplying  capacity of  the  soils.    Tomatoes
 grown on  these soils amended with waste acid from copper smelters  showed a
 significant increase in dry matter  yield and P uptake  (Ryan and Stroehlein,
 1979).  Spot  applications of acid were  effectively corrected iron deficien-
 cies in sorghum  (Sorghum bicolor)  (Ryan et al.,  1974).   The solubility of
 the essential nutrients, manganese, zinc and iron, increased with  applica-
 tion of sulfuric  acid to calcareous soils (Miyamoto and Stroehlein, 1974).

     Surplus  sulfuric acid  may  also be a  valuable addition for irrigation
water that  contains high levels of  sodium relative to calcium.  Such  water,
 if  untreated,  can adversely affect soil physical  properties  (Miyamoto et
 al., 1975).  Field  studies in Texas showed  that  acidification of irrigation
water reduced the hardness of calcareous soils and lowered the exchangeable
 sodium percentage of the soils  (Christensen and  Lyerly, 1965).  Acid  treat-
ment of  ammoniated irrigation  waters  reduced volatile  loss  of NH3  by as
much as 50% and  also prevented  plugging a  problem often caused by calcium
 and bicarbonate  (Miyamoto et al., 1975).
                                    470

-------
 8.7                              VEGETATION
      Although  vegetation is not essential,  it  may form an important part
 of  the  ongoing  management  plan  for  the  facility.  Revegetation is generally
 required  at  closure, unless a  regulatory  variance  is granted (EPA, 1982).
 In  all cases,  it is desirable to  establish a permanent  cover following
 closure to  prevent  long-term  erosional  hazards   even  when  not  strictly
 required  by  the regulations  for disposal facilities.

     The  site manager must be cognizant of  the major  components  required to
 obtain  successful revegetation.   The following   factors  are  needed for
 successful stand establishment  and  growth:

     1)   selecting species adapted  for  the  site;

     2)   preparation of an adequate seedbed;
     3)   planting during  correct season;

     4)   planting the proper quantity of seed or sprigs;
     5)   planting seed at the proper depth;

     6)   allowing sufficient time for plant establishment;

     7)   implementing a proper  fertilization  program; and
     8)   using  proper management practices.

 Contingency  plans should  provide for reseeding  if  the crop does not emerge
 or  fails  after  emergence.


 8.7.1                      Management Objectives


     The  specific objectives of the overall  management plan  for  the HWLT
unit are  critical to developing a  vegetative management plan.  Beneficial
uses of plants  Include use  to  improve site trafficability for waste appli-
cation  or other equipment,  to  indicate "hot  spots" where excessive quanti-
ties of waste  constituents  have accumulated,  to  minimize wind and  water
erosion,  and to take up  excess  nitrogen or metals  and remove excess  water
to  promote oxidation of organic material.   An optional and especially use-
ful function for vegetation  at  HWLT units  is  runoff water treatment,  where
water  will   be  discharged under a  permit  there are several  choices for
treating  the water.  One  of  these  options  is  to establish a water tolerant
species in an overland flow  treatment system.   The vegetation acts to re-
move certain types of contaminants  from the runoff  water through filtering,
adsorption,  and settling.   Other  treatment  mechanisms  are  enchanced' with
increased wastewater detention time.    Plants  may also be  used  in land
treatment  context   for  aesthetic   appeal;   since  much  of   the  public's
perception of  a  problem  or  hazard  is  linked to the  visual  impression of
the facility, a  green, healthy  crop cover will reassure  the public.
                                     471

-------
      One must  recognize that  there  are  some  limitations  associated  with
 using  cover  crops.   Some  arguments  against  a  plant  cover  include  the
 following:

      (1)  maintaining concentrations  of  waste in  soil which  are  not
           phytotoxic may limit  the allowable waste  application  rates
           to levels far  below  the capacity of  the soil  to  treat  the
          waste;

      (2) where wastes  are  applied  by   spray  irrigation,  hazardous
          waste constituents may stick to the plant surfaces;

      (3) plants  may translocate toxins to the food chain; and

      (4) a crop cover  may filter ultraviolet  radiation which  could
          aid in  the decomposition of certain compounds.

      Table  8.10 presents some of the  alternative  management techniques that
 can be used to replace the role of plants in  land  treatment.  The  uses  of
 plants at HWLT  units are further discussed below.

      Where  waste  is stored and  applied only during  the  warm season and  a
 vegetative  cover  is desired, the management schedule needs  to  allow enough
 time for the establishment  of  at  least  a  temporary cover  crop  following
 waste applications  before  conditions  become  unfavorable.   In  situations
 where waste is treated  year-round, it may be desirable  to subdivide  the
 area into plots so the annual waste  application  can  be made within  one  or
 two short  periods.  Following  incorporation,  surface contouring, or  other
 activities, each plot  can be  seeded.

      If  the objective  of using vegetation is to take  up excess  nitrogen,  it
 may be desirable to harvest  and  remove the crop.  The best use  of harvested
 vegetation  is as mulch  for newly  seeded areas.   The crop  should not  be
 removed  from  the  facility unless  a chemical analysis demonstrates  that  it
 is  acceptable for the  specific use.   If it is not possible  or  necessary  to
 harvest  the crop, it can be  left in place and plowed down when another  ap-
 plication of  waste is made.   In  this  case, the nitrogen  taken  up by  the
 crop  has not  been removed from  the system  but it  has  been  tied up in  an
 organic  form.  As  the crop  residue  decomposes,  nitrogen will  be  slowly
 released.  The mineralization rate  of  nitrogen should be  taken  into  account
when determining the nitrogen balance  for  the site.

     For liquid hazardous wastes,  it may  be possible to  use spray  irriga-
tion disposal in existing or newly  planted forests.   With  proper  design and
management,  including  controlled  application  rates  to  match  Infiltration
and storage, it may  be possible  to minimize direct overland  flow of  runoff
water.  Water storage may be necessary  to  avoid application of waste  during
unsuitable conditions  such  as when the site  is  already  saturated.   Such
systems  have  been  used successfully for  treatment  of municipal sewage ef-
fluent  (Myers,  1974;  Sopper  and Kardos,  1973;  Nutter and  Schultz,  1975;
Overcash and Pal, 1979).  The use of  such systems  when applying hazardous
industrial effluents should be fully justified by pilot scale field  studies
over a sufficient time period to demonstrate their effectiveness.  In addi-


                                    472

-------
TABLE 8.10  ALTERNATIVE MANAGEMENT TECHNIQUES TO REPLACE THE ROLE OF PLANTS
            IN A LAND TREATMENT SYSTEM
Plant function
Alternative management
Protective:

     Wind erosion
     Water erosion
Maintain a moist soil surface

Wastes often provide the necessary stability when
mixed with the soil.

Minimize slopes and use proper contouring to
reduce water flow velocities

Some wastes, such as oily sludges, repel water and
stabilize the soil against water effects.

Design runoff catchments to account for increased
sediment load.

Runoff water may need some form of treatment
before release into waterways.
Cycling:

     Transpiration
     Removal
Dewater the waste

Control applications of wastewater to a lower
level.

Plants have only a very minor role in this
respect; for organics, manage for enhanced degra-
dation; for inorganics, reduce loading rates.
                                    473

-------
 tion, a method of collecting runoff from this  type  of  system would need to
 be designed.

      At HWLT  units  where liquid  hazardous  wastes  are  spread on  the  soil
 surface by irrigation or subsurface injected,  it  may be desirable to main-
 tain a continuous vegetative cover.  Another use of vegetation where wastes
 are spray  irrigated  is  as  a  barrier  to aerosol  drift.   In some  cases  a
 border of trees may be desirable.

      At closure,  permanent  vegetation  is  established  following  the  same
 procedures used for temporary vegetation.  In  some  instances,  it is desir-
 able to cover  earth  structures with  10  to  15  cm of topsoil to  assist in
 establishing vegetation.  Lime may need  to  be added to  the  final surface,
 whether it is  subsoil or topsoil,  to  adjust  the pH for the species planted.
 Liming of  soils  is  discussed in  Section  8.6.1.   Fertilizer and  seed  may
 then be applied  by  the methods described  in the  following  sections.   On
 critical areas, the  use of sod or sprigs may be desirable for establishing
 certain species and mulching may  be  necessary  to  prevent erosion.   It is
 generally  advisable  to  use a  light  disc  or  cultipacker  to  anchor  the
 material against  displacement  by wind  and water.
 8.7.2                         Species  Selection
     Vegetation  should be selected which  is  easily established, meets  the
 desired  management goals, and is  relatively  insensitive to residual  waste
 constituents.   Common residuals occurring  at  HWLT units include  organics,
 salts, nutrients  and  possibly  excess  water.   Other important considerations
 include  disease  and  insect  resistance.    Grasses  are  often a good  choice
 because  many are relatively tolerant  of  contaminants, can  often  be  easily
 established  from seed, and  can  be used  to accumulate nitrogen.   Various
 nitrogen accumulating species  are  discussed in Section 6.1.2.1.4.

     Perennial sod crops  adapted to the area  are  often the most  desirable
 surface  cover since  they provide more protection against  erosion and  a
 longer period of  ground cover  than annual  grasses  or small  grains.   In cli-
 mates where  legumes are adapted,  it  may  be desirable to  include a  grass-
 legume mixture for  the final vegetative cover to provide a  low  cost  nitro-
 gen  supply for  the grasses.   Each  species  in a mixture  will be  better
 adapted  to specific  site  characteristics  than other  species  in that  mix-
 ture.  Rooting  habits will  vary according to  the  species  planted, thus  a
 mixture  of species  may allow more  efficient use of soil moisture and  nutri-
 ents at  various  depths.   In cases  where  a species requires intensive  man-
 agement, it should  be  planted  in a pure stand;  many introduced grasses  fall
 into this  category.

     Water tolerance  of vegetation is a concern at many HWLT  units  because
waste dewatering  is a common  practice.   Many  perennial grasses can  with-
 stand temporary flooding during dormant stages;  however, most of  the  small
 grains including  barley (Hordeum vulgare), oats (Avena sativa),  and  shallow
 rooted clovers are very  sensitive to flooding.   Some relatively  tolerant

                                     474

-------
 species   include  Dallisgrass  (Paspalum  dilatum),  switchgrass   (Pan!cum
 virgatum),  bermudagrass  (Cynodon dactylon), bahiagrass (Paspalum notatum),
 Reed   canary  grass  (Phalaris  arundinacea),  and  tall  fescue   (Festuca
 arundlnacea);  however, rice  (Oryza sativa)  is  the  most water  tolerant  plant
 available.    Table  8.11 lists  the  relative water  tolerance  of   various
 plants.

     Regardless  of  the specific  management  objectives, the species  selected
 must be adapted  to  the climate,  topography and soils of the  site.   Vegeta-
 tive parameters  considered during  plant  selection  include the following:

     1)   ease  of establishment;

     2)   plant productivity;

     3)   ability to  control  erosion;

     4)   ability to  withstand invasion by undesirable plants; and
     5)   availability of seed at a reasonable  price.

 Generally,  seed  of  native  species  should be obtained from local sources  or
 within 200  miles north  or  south,  and 100  miles  east or west of  the  site
 (Welch  and Haferkemp,  1982).   Introduced  plant  materials  do  not  follow
 these same  guidelines; they  may  be obtained from  sources over a  relatively
 broad geographic range.   It  is highly recommended that certified varieties
 of either native or  introduced plant materials be  used when available.

     Guidance  on species adaptation is  given  in Table  8.11   and Figs.  8.26
 and 8.27.   Other sources of  information  which  may  be useful are  the highway
 cut revegetation standards  available  from most state  highway  departments
 and recommendations  from the Soil  Conservation Service, state agricultural
 extension services,  and/or  the agronomy departments at state universities.
 In some  instances selected  plant  materials may be  used  in  climatic  zones
 other  than  those indicated  when   special  conditions unique to  the  land
 treatment unit would permit  their  use.   For  example,  where   irrigation  is
 available,  the season  for establishment is  often  longer than indicated  in
 Table 8.11.  Thus, Table 8.11  is a general  guideline and it is advisable  to
 check selections with  local  sources because  some  species  are adapted  only
 to certain  sites  within  a given geographic  region.


 8.7.3                        Seedbed Preparation


     Prior  to seeding, all  grading and terracing should be completed  and a
good seedbed prepared.   An  ideal seedbed is generally free from live  resi-
dent vegetation,  firm  below the seeding depth and has  adequate amounts  of
mulch or plant residue on the soil surface.  The most important  concerns  of
seedbed preparation  are  to  reduce  existing plant  competition and to create
a favorable microclimate for  developing  seedlings  or sprigs.

     Various methods of  seedbed  preparation exist; however,  plowing is the
most common.  Use of an  offset disc one-way  plow,  or moldboard plow appears

                                    475

-------
          TABLE 8.11  REGIONAL ADAPTATION OF SELECTED PLANT MATERIALS



Common and
scientific





Aeschynomene
Ufalfa
(Medicago satival



kl f f leria
(Erodium cicutarium)
Alycec lover
(Alysicarpus vaginal is 1
Bundlef lower, Illinois
(Desman thus illinoensis
Burclover*- California
(Medicaqo htspida)


Burclover f
southern or spotted
(Medicago arsbicaj
Burnet. small
(Sanguisorba minor)
Bushsunf lower . annua 1
Buttonclover
(Medicaqo orbicularis)

Regional adaptation




1
u
u

u








X






X








c
ef
1
5
**
c















X









•
2
3








X








X


c
m
S
*>
o
c
u
s
£






X













c
4
a.
w
8
&
S
S






X


















u
f


























A*
m
2
3
X



X



X



a





a






;
£
S























.c
^J
o
U
•s
1
s

u


H

M

C



C


c


c






•H
"
S
!

P


A

P

A



A




A
A


„
u

2
e
0
s
u
a




[

H

I



I


I

N
I

Plant adaptation
Tolerance






a

t . 5-*7 . S





















S
*
o>
1
2


a



3



3





3




v
0,
I




1-2



2



2-3


2


2






I




2-3



3



3


1


3




X
4J
C
•H

2






3



3


3


3

Soil*






I

I


1

2

2



2


2

2
2






I

1


1

1

1



1


1

1
1






u

2

2
2

1

2



2


2

1
2



v
b

s.:
et
. U
^J
ii

4.1


3.1

1.5

3.0*



3.0*


7.9







Special
considerations
and
adaptations




M .Pelt. IS* . Sod former . Host widely used legume for range
and pasture mixtures. Requires well-drained sandy loam to
clay soils. Great value as soil improving crop. A fine.
mellow, firm seed bed should be prepared. Sensitive to low
boron levels. Deep rooted.
M.p.R. 12*. Bunch former*


M.P.R. 16". Bunchforming. Deep rooted. Easily established.

Seeding rate based on hulled seed. Prefers moist, well-
drained fertile soils. Short season annual which usually
re-seeds. Produces less than crimson or arrowleaf clover.
Prefer soils high in calcium.
Seeding rate based on hulled seed. Prefers soils high in
calcium.

Forb with persistent leaves.

M.P.R. 16*. Bunchformer.
Prefer sods high in calcium. Coamonly used in over-needing of
bernuda>jras8. *
0\
                                               —cont inued—

-------
TABLE 8.11  (continued)


CoBMon and
scientific
names





Clover, alsike
(Tri toll urn hybriduB)


Clover, arrowleaf
fTrifoliu.1 vesiculosum)

Clover, ball
(Trifolium niqrescens)

'lover , b*tr.t««M
(Tri folium al*.fandrinum)

'lover, crimson
(Trifolium incarnatum)


Clover, hop (small)
(Trifolium dubiua)

Clover* Persian
(Trifolium resupinatuB)
Clover, red
(Tel foil urn prmten»e 1



Clover, rose
(Trifolium hirtuBl





Regional ariaptat ton


*
c
u
1
c
s
X









a






X



X






c
4
C
I
2
C
X
















X













I
=
s








X

















c
«•
o.
4
t.
O

s
*

s
I
















I















s





















X









;
«t
E
X









X






X













*
f.
*
a



a

X


b




X

X

X



X









£
i


















X










5
o
\t
"o
c
o
*}




c

c


c




c

c

c-w



c








*
.1
4
(
u
o





A


A




A

A

D



A





\
\

c
0
«
^
5





I


I




I

I

I



I




Plant adaptation
Tolerance






i






_






















^
•
;

X





1-2




3




1-2






3








1.

*








1-2

3




2






1










5
i







3

1











3







^
*>
c

OT
2-3








2












2




Soils





c
V.
2




2



2





3






2








f

-
1




1









2.

1



1









aj
"
1




1



2





1

2



2







u
8.2
• u
2j
*l 0
as
1.9

2 5


i.i«



6»
. 3




2.3*

3.2



6.2






Special
considerations
and
adaptations




Noncreepinq. Adapted to cool, Boist sites. Cow-only used in
irrigated pasture Mixtures. Generally dies after 2 years.
Not recosMended in areas of South where Ladl no clover is
adapted. Also produced in many parts of the northeast.
acidity and low fertility than crimson clover. Should use
Scarification is beneficial due to hard seed content (V70t).
Tall growth form. Produces growth one month later than
crimson clover. Excellent reseeder.

growth habit.
N.P.R. 14*. Bunch former* Winter legume. Read! ly reseeds
itself. Tolerant of medium .oil acidity. Thrive on both
clay and sandy soils. Tolerant of wide range of climatic
conditions. Thrives in association with other crops, such as
coastal bermudagrass. Commonly have 30 to 751 hard seed.
associated grass. Do not seed alone due to wind damage on
young seedlings.
Used for sol 1 improvement .

N.P.R. 19*. Bunchformer. Biennial, acts as short-lived
perennial but readily reseeds under mesic conditions.
Noncreeplng. Prefers fertile, well-drained soils high In
lime but will grow on moderately acid soils) often seeded
with other legumes and grasses. Susceptable to crown rot.
southern anthracnose, and mildew. Hyperaccumulates tine.
N.P.R. 12*. Bunchformer. widely seeded in California on
annual grassland and brush burns. Readily reseeds. Estab-
lished in Texas. Grows and persists well in areas of limited
rainfall (18-25- per year). Northeast Texas growth limited
to early apring season. Hill grow well In association with
summer perennial grasses. Does not oo well In poorly drained
areas.
                                —cont inued—

-------
          TABLE 8.11  (continued)



Campon and
scientific




Clover, sour
(Hell lot us; indical
Clover « strawberry
(TrifoliuM fraqiferiM)
Clover i subterranean




Clover t white (Ladino)
(TrifolliM repent)




Cowpeai
(Vlqna »inen«ia]
Crownvetch
(Coronilla varia)




Field pea
(Piwn eativuei
aubep. arvenae >
Plat pea
(Lathyruc lylvestrla)

Galllardia, (lender
(Caillardla
pjnnatltldal
Indigo, hairy
Regional adaptation




I
U

*M
o
c
O
s

u
c









u

c





c


c



H





«J
i

o
A
P
A









A

P





A




P

A

,j
u

u
4J
c
s
*
i

I
I









I

,










N


Plant adaptation
Tolec.ace





£














5.S-7.5












5.5-7.P


w
5
O*
as

1
2











2-J





3






2-3



f
o
;£

3
1-2











1-2

















S

2












1





1-2










•H
C
3

1-2


























Soils





ul

1












1





2

1


1

1




a

i
i











t





2




2

2




u

1
1











2





2




]

2


v
u
t>

i*
SL3
. U
I
i:

3.0
13. 4









30.0

3.0*







10.0








Special
considerations
and
adaptations


Seen in volunteer stands by roadsides. Hill tolerate more
acid soils than other members of Nelilotus genesis.
M . P . R. 19* . Sod former . Creepi ng by rhi zones f low growi ng .
H.P.B. 1C. Sod former. Hell adapted for Interaeedlng mesic
best on well-drained, fertile, loam soils with moderate rain-
fall. Used for erosion control, hay* pasture, soil improve-
ment and seed production. Prostrate growth habit. Tolerant
of acid soils.
irrigated sites. Creeping by stolons. Used in association
wl th grasses and other legumes . Used for sol 1 improvement *
erosion control and wildlife. Requires adequate quantities
of available phorphorus, potash and calcium, stand thickness
decreases after several years.
One of the most extensive legumes.

M.P.R. 18", Sodformlng. Should scarify seeds. Hard seed
•ay be up to 90t. Beat adapted to fertile vetl-dralned
soils; however, will tolerate some 4egree of infertility and
acidity after established. Excellent Cor erosion control .
Slow to establish but aggressive upon establishment. Common-
ly seeded with ryegrass.
Fall seeding in cotton growing states. Grows veil on all
so i 1 s except wet and poor 1 y dra i ned types . Grown for ha y ,
silage, pasture, scert and green manure.
Seed may be toitic to grazing animals. Slow gemination but
aggressive upon establishment. Climbing growth form. Moun-
tains a pure stand better than most legumes. Rhizomatous.
N. P.R. IS". Bunchforncr. Also adapted to part of Inter-
mountain region.
Fairly deep rooted and upright.
00
                                        —continued—

-------
TABLE 8.11  (continued)


Common and
scientific
names




Kochi, prostrate or
« Kochi pros t rat a )
ludzu
(Pueraria iabata)

Lespedeza, bicolor
(La spade za bicolor)
Lespedesa, comaton (kobe)
(Lcspedexa striata)



Lespedes*, Korean
(Lespedeza stipulacea)


Leapede z* , prost ra te
(Lespedeza daurica
var . schTsiadaH
Lespcdeza, sericea
(Lespedexa cuneata)



Medic* black
(Yellow trefoil)
(Hedicago lupulina)
Regional adaptation




1
u

s























c
|
1
f
c
X
























J
I
£
X



















c

a.

u
c
It
1
&
X



















•
c

&
4
O
£
S
S
X
























—
•
X






b


b


b


b









J
•
K
S






a


•





X









:
i
£




b

b


b





b







£

5
0
i
•






u


N





H









3
•=
1
0
p
p


A

A


A


P


P





I
3
S
U
c
b
O
*
«J
I





I


I





I




Plant adaptation
Tolerance






X
o.




5.0-6.0




5.0-7.0


S. 0-7.0"


4.5-7.0







It

JS
0»
X
3
2-3


2




2





2-3








^
tr
1
i
1—2


1-2




2





1-2


2







3
»
3







2





2








*•
c
s
1-2








3










Soils





^
c
ta
1



)




'





2

2







e
3
i
2


1




i





i

2







^
-4
O
1
2


1




1





1





*
u
*
u
8.J
3 o-
• v
• «
1.7








6.J*





6.3*

1.5*





Special .
consider at ions
and
adaptations



«. P. R. 1 2'. Bunch former . Long li ved . Extens i ve root

southern climatic conditions. Slow to establish, however,
grows rapidly after etablishment. Will not tolerate close
mowing. Other legumes are better adapted in the Southeast
Grows in low fertility soils. Generally not used for
forage.
Seed rate based on unhul led seeds . Low growing . Better
adapted to Texas than Korean lespedeza. Important for pas-
ture, hay and soil improvement. Grown in association with
other crops. Neutral to acid soils. Susceptible to bac-
terial wilt» tar spot, powdery mildew, and southern blight.
Hard seed 40-60%. Responds to li«»e and fertilizer applica-
tions. Good for soil Improvement, hay and seed. Mill grow
on most soil including poor and acid soils; however, less
to bacterial wilt, tar spot, powdery mildew, and southern
blight.



Seed should be scarified. Seeding rate based on scarified
soed since there in usually 75» or more hard seed. Valuable
on badly depleted soils as * pioneering legume. Tolerant to
low fertility. Should not be mowed in late summer — plant

like growth habit.
Seod scarse f no cowmorcia I cult I vers ) . 'Jso alfalfa in ocuLum.
Adopted to line soi Is,

                                  —continued—

-------
         TABLE  8.11   (continued)


scientific



ftllkvetch. clc«r
(Astragalus cicer)


PensteBon , pa l»er
(Pensteaon paimeri)
Penstc»on, Rocky Mountain
(Pen* tenon sir ictus)
Poppies, gold
ICschscholtzia 3pp. )

(Petalosteaua
purpuretmt
PC • i r i ec lover , wh i t e
(Petalosteaua candidtm)
Sainfoin
lOnobrychls viciafolia)
Singletary pea (Rough)
tl>athyru« hirsutus)
Sunflower, •aximilian

Sweetclover, stiff
(He 11 an thus
laetif lorusl

(Helilotus slbal



Reg iona 1 ad apt a t ion


**
5
u
s
X



X
X






X















c
•
«f
C
C
n
X


X
X







X
















*J
J
s




X
X




X



















5
X









X

X



X

X







•
c
•-*•
b
•»
•
l«
o
s
X



X





X





X

X











•
a:





























4>
S














X

X












*J
s
b



























£
v
0
u
v>
«M
o
^
5
w













c

w













*J
ji
1
o



p
p
A




P



A

P

P








3
?
«j
c
h
O
A*
3
i


N
N
N




II

I

t

II

N







Plant adaptation
Tolerance



3.
5.0-6.0



























t4
«l
4-1
o»
a
2











3

1













4J
£
1
2











2



2




1-2







5
1-2











2



1




1






>*
4J
j;
2











3



3




1-2




Soils



1
£
1


1
1
1

?


1

1

2

1

1


|







3
i


i
2
2

1


1

1

1

1

1


I







•
o
2


1
3
2

I


1

2

1

1

2


1





Cl
S!
U
X.S
• w
2
-------
         TABLE 8.11  (continued)


Common and
scientific




Sweetclover, yellow
IMelilotus officinalis)








Trefoil, blrdsfoot
(Lotus cornlculatus)




Vetch, American
(Vicia smericana)
Vetch, common
(Vicia estiva)

Vetch, hairy
(Vicia vlllosa)
narrow leaf
(Viet* sativa
var. ntqra)
'etch, winter (woodly pod)
(Vicia dasyearpa)
Zexmenla, orange
(Zeimenia hispidal

Regional adaptation


1
u
•U
V









X






a

a









c
g
C
t»
c









X








X










:
*
i









i








X







s
m
t*.
I
£
5
J









1








X












1
















X

X

X



X




«,

X
X








X


















*,
:
JZ
a
X








a






X

a

X








•
s
s









X








X









1
!
o
c
i









w






c

c

c








1
.c
.C
O









p




p

A

A

A



P


*
a
h
C

s
1









I






I

I



1

N

Plant adaptation
Tolerance




S









5.0-7.5








5.0-7.5








„
AJ

o»
ac
2








1-2






3

2

3







^
£
1
i








2-3






1-2

2











3
i








2






2

1-2



2





J
c
3
2








1-2








1-2







Soils




CO
1








2




2

2

1

1

2

1





3
i








i






i

i

i

i

i





L>
1








1






2

1

1

2

1



b
b
j;
. u
10
* 5
i!
3.4








2.1






,.7«

5.6*

10.0







Special
considerations
and
adaptations



H.P.R. 16". Bunchformer. Hore tolerant of drought and com-
petition but has a shorter growth period than white sweet-
clover. Reseeds better than white sweetclover. Acts like
biennial if spring seeded. One of the best soil improving
crops due to deep tap root. Seeds should be scarified.
Unusually susceptible to Injury from a number of chemicals
used for weed control. Can be established better than white
sweetclover in dry conditions. Neutral to alkaline and well
drained soils. Susceptible to sweetclover weevil, root borer
and aphirl.
H.P.R. 18-. Bunchformer. Does not cause bloat. Rhiioma-
tous. Mostly used in irrigated pastures. Hay be difficult
to establish. Should be planted in miiture with a grass spe-
cies. New varieties are being developed for the Southeast
which are resistant to crown and root diseases. Also adapted
to part of Southern Great Plains.
H.P.R. 18°. Sodformer.
Used in combination with small grains — vetch-rye combination!
less winter hardy thao other vetches. Best adapted to well
drained, fertile loam soils.
H.P.R. If. Sodformer. Host winter-hardy of cultivated
vetches; most widely grown.

Identified by black pods. Limited use.

H.P.R. 12". Bunch Corner. Less cold tolerant and wore heat
tolerant than hairy vetch. Prefers well drained soils.
H.P.R. 1Q-. Bunchformer.

00
                                              —continued—

-------
          TABLE 8.11  (continued)


Comjvon and
scientific



Bahiagrass
(Paspalum ngtaljim
and nedTal
Barley
Beachgrass, American
tAmmophila
breviligulata)
Seriwidagrass
( Cyrtodon dactylon )


Bluegrass* big
(Poa amplal
Bluegrass, bulbous
(Poa bulbosa) •
Bluegrass, Canada
(Poa compress a \
Bluegrass, Canby
(Poa canbyi)
Bluegrassi Kentucky
( Poa pratensts )



Bluegrass, upland
(Poa g taucanthal
Blues tens (Angel ton.
Cor Ho. Medio)
(Dichanthius: aristatuw]
Dluestesi, big
t Jmdropoqon gerard i i i )
Regional adaptation


u
1
u

C
M

X




X

X
X

X





X







«*
4t
S



X


X
















C
m
a.
«
*
u
A*
It
S






x


X

X





X




X
C
a
1
5
1



X















X







s
TJ
X

X







a
















^
«;
1
X
X
X
X















X






^
*J
I


X






X
















«>
9
1
o
I
•
H

c-w



C

C
C

C





C

H







I

1
p

p





p
p

p





p

p





I

e
1*
o
S
*J
s
I





H


,

H





!

I




Plant adaptation
Tolerance



X
a
«.S-7.5








4.5-7.5















tl
S
£
X
1

2-3
1


1-2

3
2









2


2


£
S1
I


1-2
1—2


1-2

1
2


2






1-2


2



5

1
i



i


i

i





i

2-3


1


«i
~4
e
.
0)


1
1



3

2










2


2
Soil.



V)


1
1


1

2
2

1





1

3


2



3






i

1
2

1





1

)


1



3


i
2


2

L
2

2





2

1


2


S
14
S.S
I
. ^J
I:

3 . 0*
3
1.0


1.5

1*9
8.7









1.0


6.0


Special
considerations
and
adaptations


M.P.R. 30". Sod former, Rhixomatous. Keep young by mowing.

Commonly sprigged 17- IB" apart. RMtomatous. Adapted to
Carolina. Possible use in gully Dot tons.
fertilization. Host varieties mist be grown fro* sprigs at
2'x2' spacing; however* cession and NK 37 can be seeded. Does
best at pit o£ 5.5 and above.
M.P.R. 12*. Bunchgrass. Seed In pure stands.

stem bases. Low yieldi unreliable producer.
Does well on soil too low in nutrients to support good stands
of Kentucky bluegrass.
M.P.R. 10*. Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow sites.

rhlr.omen. Low production and miMter dormancy Unit use t how-
ever, will grow on disturbed sites. Adapted to northern
Great Plains and Inter mountain region where Moisture is plen-
tiful. Shallow rooted.
M.P.R. !«•. Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow sites.

M.P.R. 25-30". ' Bunchgrass.


M.P.R. 25*. Bunchgrass. Very productive on mesic sites.
Strong, deep rooted. Effective in controlling erosion.
oo
to
                                              —continued—

-------
         TABLE 8.11   (continued)


Co-won and
scientific
naaies





Bluestesi, cane
(Andropoqon barbinodis)
Bluestea, Caucasian
(Bothriochloa
cancasica)
Bluestta, Kltberq
(Dichanthlun annulatu*)
Blueitea, little
ISchixachyriu*
icop»riu«)
BluesteB, Old World
(Oicanthiun spp -
Bothriochloa spp)
(blend)
BluesteB, Band
(Andropoqon ge radii
or kallil var.
pauclpilusl
Bluestet), yellow
(Bothriochloa
iachaesttm)

(Setsrta leucopila or
•acros-tachyj )
Broae. California
(Brows earlnatust
Bro>e. «ado»

H
1

i

N
I



II

I

M
a

i

H

Plant adaptation
Tolerance






5.
7.2-8.0




6.0-8.0









5.5-8.0








u
**
1
5
2



2

2




2

2

J




2






f
1




1

2
1



2

2

1




2







i




2

1
2



1

1

1
1



1





>»
e
5




2

3
2



3

2

2




2

Soils





„
1
2



2

1
2





2

1
1

2

2








1
1

1

1
1





1

1
2

1

1






^
u
1
1

1

t
1





2

1
3

1

1

§

§
ft
as
.a

?
ll

1.2

1.1

3.4
1.2





1.2

1.0




12. «



Special
considerations
and
adaptations




N.P.R. 12". Bunchgrass. Adapted to calcareous sites. Seed
available in United quanities.
N.P.R. 1>". Bunchqrass. Generally seeded in pure stand. An
"Old World" bluestcH.

H.P.K. 20*. Bunchqrass.

H.P.R. 16-20'. Bunchqrass. Dense root systea xith short
surface protection.
H.P.R. 14*.


od i
sjeslc. sandy soil.

N.P.R. 16". Bunchgraas. Adapted to shallow and calcareous
sites.

H.P.n. 12". Btinchgrass . Hell adapted to disturbed sites.
Good seed producer. Hay produce sore than one crop depending
on •ols.ture.
H.P.R. 14". Bunclxjrass. Self seeding.

H.P.R. 17". Bunchqns«. Rapid establishment.

H.P.R. 1>". Bonchgrass. Hot coeaonly used.

oo
                                           -continued—

-------
         TABLE 8.11   (continued)
co


scientific



Bros*, red
IBroeaia rubens)
1 Brosus inermls)
Br ras. field
(Brosus arvensl*)
Buf falograas
(Buchloe dactyloidea)

Buf Celgras*
(Cenchrus ctltare)
(Phalaris irundinacea)

Carpetqrass
Uionopus coxprsssus)
Centlpeoegrass
< C resocBloa
oph iuroides I
Chess, soft
Uromiu sullis)
Cottontop. California or
ArixoBa (Ditfitacia
californlca, or
Trichachne ealifornieal
Curlyawsquite. msann
(Hllarla belanosrl)

*egtona.l adaptation



1
tt
•**
*M
o
b













X









e
ft
c
X
























1
X










X




X


X

s
£
u
*•
o
c
i
1





."















1
£
4*
•
u
| Southern





X

X



b




X


X





1
B
























u
i









X

>












tt
tt
1























£
jj
9
i
1
c

c


H

V

H

H


C

U


H





i
s
A

*





P
P
P

P


A

P


P


1

j>
a
s
s
1
I

1





I

I

I


I

u


H

Plant adaptation
Tolerance



£


5.5-S.O






5 • 0—7 • 5














u
i
B


2






1
2









2-J




Drought


2





1
2
j






2


i




I


1





3
1
2-3

3




2







X
e
3


2


2

3
2







2




Soil!



3

2



3

2
2

1

2


2

2


J




j





1

1

1

1


1

1


1




i





i

2
I

2

2


1

2


1



j;
*
.8
Lbl. rU
•••ding


CtO
12.0

u.o

3.0
2 6

5.0






l.l






Special
cons iderat ion*
and
adaptations

H.P.K. 12*. Bunchqran. Cultlvtri arc unavailable.

HvP.lt. 17". Sodforaing. excellent grass for use with alfsl-
Ca. Reproduce* by seed, tillers and rhiioates.

easy to establish.
H.P.R. IS*. Sodlornlng. Seeding rate based on >eed In bur.
Seeding rate for grain Is 3.0 PLS. Lov production. Seed
zosws. Also adapted to part of aouthvect region.
N.P.It. IS'. Bunchgras*. lostlv rhlcooatous. Biggins,
Nueces. and Llano can be seeded at l.S Ib. PLS/A.
Sodforaing. Cut to prevent sttturity, seeded, or spread by
sort or cul" cuttings. will endure subner-jence . Seed does
not store well.
Stolen iferottS. FOT«S a very dense sod.

lakes a close turf and is very aggressive. Sod or gtolons.
BO seed available. Easily established, for«» « dense turf.
Legu*es not recoiwended because o< its aggressive nature.
M.P.R. 15-. Btinchqrass . Self seeding. Also used In Geor-
gia.
n.P.K. 15-. Bunehgrass. Reproducer by see*. Good seed set.


K.P.R. 14*. Cultlvars are unavailable. Stolen! ferous.

                                              —continued—

-------
          TABLE 8.11   (continued)


fOBSMin and
scientific
naa.es



Dallisarass
(Paspalua dllata.ua))
Deer tongue
(Pan 1 CUM clandestinun)


Dropseed * giant
(Sporobolus qiqanteu..)
Dropaeed , nesa
(Sporobolus f leKuqsui)
Dropaeed. sand
(Sporobolus
crypt and rus)
Dropseed, spike
(Sporobolus contractual
Fescue, annual
{Festuca ajeqalura)
Fescue, Arizona
( Festuca ariionica)
Fescue, hard
(Festuca ovina
var. duriuscula)
Fescue* Idaho
(Festuca idahoenais)
Fescue* meadow
(Festuca elatior)
Fescue* red (creeping)
(Festuca rubra)
Fescue* sheep
(Festuca ovina)

Regional adaptation


i


a
X





b



X


X
a






c
I

c




X
X
X

X

X


X
X


X




]
«J
i
'


X
X
X
X

X










5
m
A.
4*
1
E

I




X





X



X


X

e
m
a.
4*
o
ft

i
i


X
X
X
















a
%
T
I



•.










X







1

1
X















X





1

1

X












X

X




1
•M
0
•a

i
u
H

U
H
U
c

c

c


c
c

c
c




8
£
5
ft
S
p
'
P
p
p
P
A

P

P


P
P

P
P


?
1
S
ft


3
'
N

H
H
N
I

N

I


H
I

N
N

Plant adaptation
Tolerance




5.

3.8-5.0








5.5-6.5





S.0-7.5



I*
S

0*
3C
1
1-2


2





3


3
2

2




|
3
1
2
2


1

1

1

2


2
2

2
1





3
2
1


1





1


1


1
1



X
e

•-«
2



2





j


3


3


Soils




s
I
1
1
2
1
1
1

1

2


2
3

2-;
i




c
j
i
i
2
1
1
2
1

2

1


1
2

1
1





u
1
2
3
3
2
3
1

2

1


1
1

1
1




b
.8
2|
• «o
as
4.0
5.0


0.3





2.3


1.9
4.0

10




Special
considerations
and
adaptations



Difficult to establish stand because of low germinating seed.
use in combination with legumes.
Bunchgrass with strong fibrous root system. Spreads by
rhizomes. Adapted to low fertility soils. Requires 30 days
of field stratification, therefore, plant in late fall or
very early spring.
region.
mountain region. Short-lived.
M.P.R. 10". Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow and calcareous
sites. excellent seed producer. Seeded on dry sites where
H.P.R. 10". Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow sites. Excel-
lent seed producer. Cultivars not available.
N.P.R. 10". Bunchgrass. Arid tolerant. Aggressive. Excel-
lent fibrous root system and seedling vigor.
N.P.R. 16". Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow sites.
'
N.P.R. 14". Bunchgrass. Used mostly in erosion control;
robust form.

N.P.R. 16". Bunchgrass. Reproduces by seeds. Lack of good
seed yields restrict is use.
Valuable in Pacific Coast region (La), of limited value else-
where. Disappearing rather quickly, except on heavy moist
soils.
Remains green during summer. Good seeder. Hide adaptation.
Slow to establish.
H.P.R. 10*. Bunchgrass.

00
Ol
                                           —continued—

-------
         TABLE 8.11  (continued)



CoaaKMi and
scientific
naatea



Feacua, tall
( Featuca arundinacea t


Fescue. Thurber
(Festuca thurberil
Founta ingraaa
(Pennistttuai setaceua)
Foxtail* creeping
(Ajopecurua
arundinaceua )
Foxtail, swadow
(Mopecucum
pratenais)
Calleta, big
(Hilarla rigida)
GaLltta. coMKm
(Hilaria jaxteaii)
Graxu, black
(Bout el oua er iopoda )

Graika, blue
jBouteloua gracilis)
Craa-ft* aideoata
(BouteiQua
curt ipendula >

Hard inggraM
(Phalaria tuberoaa
var. stenoptera)
Indiangraas
(Sorqhaatrun nutana)
Regional



5
"
M
U
s







a


a




b









X




c
«
•*
5
s
4*
C



X



X


X






X














•
1
3





X







X

X

X


X

X





c
m
A.
4J
2
o
c
s
s







X


I









X

X





adaptation
c
«
a.
£
O
C
5
l















X

X


X

X


X







|
X







X


a











X









m
n
1






















a









m
| Nortlwi































1

0
1
s
c


c

u

c


c


H

H

H


U

H


C

H




u
a
JS
^jj
'


f

f

t


e


r

r

r


p




p

p

„

trodu
c
•*
S
I
1


H

I

I


I


H

N

U


N




I

H
Plant adaptation
Tolerance




S.
5.0-8.5



















4.0-8.5




5.5-7.5

5.5-7.5

u
S
s
JS
o>
X
1-2






1


1






3


3




2

2



Drought
2-3









2-3


1

1-2

1


1




2

3



S
3
1-2









1




2

2


1




2

1


>.
Salinil
1









3


1



3


2

2


2

2
Soils




I
2


2

1




2


2

3

1


2

2


3

1



1
l


1

1




1


2

1

1


1

1


2

1



u
1


1

2




1


1

1

3


1

1


1

2



S
h
8.S
3 "
H
3.8









2.2






1.5


1.5

5.5


2.5

4.5



Special
considerations
and
adaptations


N.P.R. 20*. Bunchqrass. Generally seeded in pure stands;
however* best results will be obtained by planting with an
adapted legune. Rapid gemination and vigorous seedlings.
Easy to establish. Deep rooted.
H.P.R. It". Bunchgrass.

N.P.R. t*. Bunchgrass. Seed difficult to harvest.

N.P.R. IV. Sodforaer. Acid tolerant. Strong rhlzoxes.


N.P.R. 20*. Sodformcr. Slightly rhizoMtons. Very useful
in Mixture on wet site*.

N.P.R. **. Sodfoming. Cultivars are not available.

H.P.R. 12". Sodforner. Rhlzoses. No cultivars are avail-
able.
n.P.R. 10'. Sodforming. Good quality seed is scarce. Hay
be difficult to establish. Adapted to shallow and calcareous
sites.
H.P.R. 10*. Ruitchgrass. Generally seeded in »ixtures. More
drought tolerant than sideoats. Extensive root syste*. Poor
seed availability.
n.P.R. 14". Bunchgrassi rarely forms a sod. Grows well in
placed by blue graM in dry areas. Helps control wind ero-
sion. Adapted to shallow and calcareous sites.
N.P.R. 1ft-. Sodfoming. Also adapted to Southwest under
irrigated conditions, "rimary species for seeding California
coastal and inland zones. Rhizomatous.
N.P.R. 22". Sodfoming. Provides quick ground cover. Rhi-
00
                                            —continued—

-------
          TABLE 8.11   (continued)



PiMssnn and
scientific





Johnsongraas
ISoraniM halpense)

Kleingrasa
(Panicua colors tuai)
Uwegraae, antherstone
(Eraqrostls
atharstonei 1
Lovegrass. Boer
lEraqrostts
chloroMlas)
Lovegrass, Korean
(Eraqroatis
terrungineal
Lovegrass , Lehnann
(Eraqroatis
lehsjanniana)
(E. lehaannlana H
E. trichophoral
Lovegraas, plains
(Eraqroatis intermedia]
Lovegrass, sand
(Craqroatia trichodeal

Lovegrass, weeping
(Eraqroatis curvula)


Lovegrass. wilaan
(Eraqrostis superbe)






I
I
"2







X





X











K
Reg




c
\
*
j
•


























ion




**
I
«






X
X





X



X



X



X
al
C
7
a?
*
C
%,
1



















X






adaptation
i
t
4
Ik
44
1
ft
a




X








X



X

X

X



X





•
1










b








b










*.
i
a




X
















X









:
c










b


















£
If
•J
e
s




w

H
H


W


H



H

W

W



W





Al
£


P


p

»
p





p



f

P

f






1
3

^
C
1
*

I


I

I
1





I



N

n

i



i
Plant adaptation
Tolerance
















5.5»








«.0-7.S

4.5-8.0






b
•
«<
j:

1


1


i





1





3

2







|
I
*

1-2


2


1





1





1

2








i
o
2


3

1-2
2





3





1-2

2







44





2


2





2





J

2




Soils





]
*
1


2

1
1





1



1

1

1








I
J
1


1

1
1





1



1

2

1








4
u
1


1

2
1





2



1

3

1






f
U

12
.8
2?
Ji
3 •
7.4


2.0


2.0





2.0



2.0

2.0

2.0







Special
considerations
and
adaptations



H.P.R. 1C. Bunchgrass. Rhiioaatous. Difficult to eradi-
cate; therefore, prevent from apreading to cultivated lands.
BCM potential. Very productive.
H.P.R. 20*. Bunehgrass. Some varietlea are rhlsosvtous.

H.P.R. 11*. Large vigorous bunchgrass. Generally larger and
sore productive than either Lehaann or weeping lovegraas.
Good seedling vigor.
H.P.R. 10*. Bunchgrass. Productive.





H.F.R. 10*. Bunchgrass. Sxaller and less cold tolerant than
Boer and weeping lovegrass. Reseeds quickly after disturb-
ance. Generally seeded in pure stands. Also adapted to
Southern Great Plaina IS). Adapted to calcareous sites.

n.P.R. 16>. Bunchgrass.

H.P.R. 1«*. Bunchgrass. Seed in Biitures. Short lived but
calcareous sites.
H.P.R. 16*. Bunchgrass. Seeded nostly In southern Great
Plains and in pure stands. Adapted to low-fertility sites.
Rapid early growth. Good root system. Grovs well on infer-
tile soils.
H.P.R. 10*. Bunchgrass. Adapted to calcareous sites.
00
                                            —continued-

-------
         TABLE 8.11   (continued)


Common and
scientific
names



Nillet, browntop
(Panicum ramosum)
Hi Hat. foxtail
(Setaria italica)
Hillet, Japanese
(Echinochioa crusgalli)
Hillet, pearl
(Pennisetum typhoides)
Nillet, proso
(Panicum miliaceum)

Huhly, bush
(rluhlenberqta porter!)

Huhly, mountain
(Huhlenberqia montana)
Huhly, spike
(Huhlenbergia wrlghtii)
Natalgrass
(Rhynchelytrum roseum)
Needle-and-thr«ad
(Sttpa comata)
Heedlegrass, green
(Stipa viridula)
Oatgrass, tall
(Arrhenatherum elatius)

Oats
(Avena sativa)

Regional adaptation


m
S
u
u













X








X


X



c
1
h
S













X

X



X

X
X







41
I
1











X



X

X

X


X




c
o.
«
0
£
C
•4
S
I



















X

X





S
4V,
S
U
U
C

s











X





X

X

X









f























X







JJ
1
1
X



X

X

X
















X




J.
£
£


X

X

















X


X



^5
1
o
c
o
J
H

H

C

H

„




H

W

H

C

C
c


c





1
I
1
A

A

A

A

A

p


P

P

P

P

P
P


A


I

§
0
*
2
N



1



I




M

H

I

N

N
1


1

Plant adaptation
Tolerance




5.


4.5-7.0

4.5-7.0

















5.0-7.5


5.5-7.0



.
J
•H
X


2

1

3














2
2-3


3




1.
o


3

3

I












1

2
2








1





















1
2


2




c
4





















2
2




soils




1
to










2


2

1

1

1

2
1








I













1

1

1

2

1
1








'













1

2

3

3

1
I







-------
          TABLE 8.11  (continued)
oo



scientific
names




Orchardgrass
(Dactylis g los* ratal


Pangolagrass
(Diqitaria decunbens)

(Fanicun antldotale)

(Panicusi purpurascens)

(Phalaris tuberosa
v. hlrtiglumis)
Red top
(Agrostis alba)

(Phraqmite* commnis
australis)

Reed, giant
(Arundo dona*)
Rescuegrass
(Bromus catharticus or
unlololdesj
(Chloris qayana)






«
*•*
t
u
s












I













Regional adaptation


c
4

i
j:












I

















£
£
S




















X





c
«
O.
4
Z


It












I













C
,g
0.
b
O

f.
I


















X

X










?
T
X












X


















4
s



X








*





X

X










2
b












X
















£
I
»
O
C
o
X
c


H








C





H

C









41

£
v
U
P


P








P


11


P

A






•V
0
s
u
—
c

It
s
1


i








,


"


i

,





Plant adaptation
Tolerance





5.
5.0-7.S











<.O-7.5














u

S
X
2-3


2
-







i





i










V*
I
2-3


3








2-3







2-3









3
2


3








1







1







^
**
C
-*
41
M
2-3











2













Soils





•



2








2





1

2









5



i








j





i

i









3



t








1





2

2







*
u
it
ni
=i
1:












0.3







11.0








Special
considerations
and
adaptat ions



N.P.R. 11*. Bunchgraii. Adapted to irrigated or naturally
••sic sites. Develops rapidly and is Ion9 lived. Seeded in
or brostegrass. Natures early. Tends to be inferior to tall
fescue Cor cover, establishment and persistence.
Stolon i t erous . He 1 1 adapted to tropica 1 and subtropica 1
areas. Established vegetatively by fresh stes. and stolon
cuttings.
good sites but will produce on droughty infertile soils.

available.



Establishes well fro* broadcasting on wet soils. Widely
adapted to Mixtures on soils too wet for other grasses.
Spreads by rhisooes.
long) per foot of row. Creeping rhizoaws and stolens.
Established using vegetative material. Heavy duty shoreline
protection.
ri.P.R. 20". Sodformer. Also adapted to part of 'Southwest.
Established using vegetative materials. Grows to 10* tall.
N.P.R. 25*. Bunchgrass. Annual grass under cultivation.
Short-lived.

parts of southwest and southern Great Plains. Host useful in
dry portion* of South Texas where other grasses are not as
well adapted.
                                          —continued—

-------
TABLE 8.11  (continued)


Crimmrm and
scientific
nastes



Ricegrass, Indian
(Dryxopis bymenoldest
Rye, winter
(Secale cereale)
Ryegrass . annua 1
(Loll urn suiltiClorum)

Ryegrass , perenni a 1
(Loliua perenne 1
Ryegrass, Wimmera
or Swiss
(Lolium rigidusu
Sacaton* alkali
( Sporobo 1 us at roidea 1

Saitgr*ss, inland
(Olst.chlii strictak
Sandreed, prairie
tcslamov.lt*
longifolia)
Slenders tern
(Diqitaria)
Smilograss
(OryKopim milea.ce*)


Sorghum almusi
(Sorghum almusi)
Sprangletop. green
(Leptochloa dub ia )
Regional adaptation


4*
•
5
o
u
i





a
X











b








c
•£

lnt*r*oun





*



X


X

X















i









X











X

X






Northern









X


X

X










*
c
-*4
*]
0>
4
S
0
[ Southarn





1



X











X

X






I
x





b

















b






•*
I

X



X










X




a








| Northiait

X



b





















JS
Q
£,

•8
J
c
c



c
c


H


W

U

W

c


H

H





«J
•H
J)
s
Xi
t
A



p
A


P


P



P

P


P

P



i
is
5

*
I
N
I



'
I


H


N





I


I

H

Plant adaptation
Tolerance




^





6 . 0~7. 0






















l*
5
w
3




2



i


1-2



2

3










Drought
1








2






3

1


2

1





i
i
,







i




i

3

3


2

1





Salinity
2

2



i


i


i

3






2

2

Solla




I
1
1
2



2


3


2
I




2


^

i





|
1
2




1


2


1
2




1


1

k





u
1
2




1


1


1





1


1

2


.
S
It
&*

2?
si
4.4
30
J. 5






1.0



3.2




1.5


IS.O

1.1



Special
considerations
and
adaptations


M.P.R. T. Bunchgrass. Hard, impermeable seed makes seeding
seeds .
Extensive root system. Generally used as temporary cover.

M.P.R. 25"* Bunchgrass . Excel lent for temporary cover. Can
be established under dry and unfavorable conditions. Quick
germination, rapid seedling growth.
M.P.R* 25*. Rapid developing, short "lived bunchgrass. Gen-
erally used *s short tern seeding. Easy to establish.
n.P.R. H-. Bunchgrass. Short-lived.


M.P.R. 10- . Bunchgrass . Desirable for seeding on sa 1 ine
viable Cor many years. Reproduces by seeds and ti Hers .
Culti vars not aval lable.
M.P.R. 14*. Sod forming. Poor s*ed producer . S«ed unavail-
able.
M.P.R. 11™ . Sodf ormlng. Seeding 1 imited by inadequate seed
supplies and low seed quality. Seed common in native grass
seed harvest. Rhixoiutous.


n.P.R. 16-. Bunchgrass. Adapted to broadcast seedling after
disturbance. Used principally in California. Reproduces by
seeds and tillers. Also adapted to portion of Pennsylvania,
Maryland and Virginia.
N.P.R. 18-. bunchgrass.

M.P.R. 10". Bunchgrass.

                                  —continued-

-------
          TABLE 8.11  (continued)
VO
CoMon and
scientific
names
Sudangraas
(Sorqhun *ud*n«ns«>
Switchgras*
(Panicun virigatim)
Ti«othy
(Phleua. pratense)
Tobosa
(Hilar.U Mitiea}
Trichloris. two flower
(Trichloria crinital
Vine -ate ..quite
(Panicua obtu*u«(
Wheat, winter
(Tritium aeatlviw)
wbeatgra**, beardless
(Agropyron in«nM)
Wheatgracs, bluebunch
(Agropyron »pic«tim>
erected
(Agropyron cri«t*tu»)
Uheatqtasa , in termed late
liV^ropyron intermedium)


i
t
t
o
s
X
X
X
Regional adaptation
r mountain
c
X
X
X
X
•
s

X
X
X
X
X
X
c
i
cu
!
C
1*

I
X
X
X
I
0.
i
o
j

X
X
X
X

T
«c

X
.
1

X
X
.
b

X

I

J
£
cr
X
2-3
2-1
]
3
a
3
2
u
c
£
i
3
2
2-3
1-2
1-2
1
2

•3
V

1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1-2
>,
*»
S

3
2
2-3
2
2
1-2
2-3
Soils

1

2
3
1
2
3
2
2
2
2

J

1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

4
£
i
l
l
2
1
1
1
1
1
1


S
Id
as
• Lt
§g-
3s
8*
3.5
1.4
6.1
30'
6.1
7.4
4.4
9.4
Special
considerations
and
adaptat ions
Generally used tor temporary cover.
N.P.K. 20-25-. Sodfor.inq. Seeding rate for Alamo is 2.0.
Rhizoutou*. Widely seeded in uar» season grans «i«es on
•e»tc «ite». Withstands eroded, acid and low fertility soil
Useful in drainage ways, and terrace outlets.
Leafy forage. Seeded in •i»turcs such as alfalfa and clover .
Stands are Mintained perennially by vegetative reproduction;
however, tends to be short-lived. Shallow, fibrous root
H. P. R. 12*. Cultivars are not available.
H.P.R. 8-. Bunchgrass. Adapted to shallow and calcareous
sites. Seed not commercially available.
Used principally for erosion control. Reproduction by seeds
rhizomes, and stolens.
U»«d as temporary cover.
H.P.R. 11-. Does well in shallow sites. Bunchgrass.
Bunchgrass. Adaptation and management similar to beardless
wneatgrass, but seed less available. Reproduces primarily by
seeds. Adapted to shallow and calcareous sites.
M.P.R. »'. Bunchgrass. Stands thicken sooner and spread
seeded alone or with alfalfa. Best results at altitudes of
1500 m or more. Easily established and extremely long lived.
Reproduces by seeds and tillers.
W.P.R. 13-. SodCormer. Productive on mesic sites and under
irrigation. Reproduces by seeds, tillers and rhizomes.
Eicellent seedling vigor.
                                          —continued—

-------
          TABLE 8.11  (continued)


Coawon and
scientific
names



Wheat grass, pubescent
(Agropyron
tricophorum)
Hheatgrass, Siberian
1 Agropyron stbiricum)
Hheagrass, slender
(Agropyron trachycalum)

Hheatgrass, standard
crested
{Agropyron desertorum)
Hheatgrass, stream bank
(Agropyron riparium)

Hbeatgrass, tall
(Aqropyron elonqatuaO

uheatqraas. thickapike
(Aqropyron da*y*tachy«l

Hheatgrass, western
(Aqropyron saiithii)


Hildrye, Altai
(Elysus anqustus)
Hildrye, basin at giant
(ElysMS cin«r«usl
Hildrye, beardless
(Ely»ua trttlcotdesl
Hildrye, Canada
IElys«is canadensls)
Hildrye, luuaBonth
(Elysus qiqanteua)
Regional


„
5
u
2
X


X




X















X

X






c
«
c
i
c
X


X

X


X


X




X





X

X

X


X





•f
fll
s
X


>

I


I

















X




c
«
B.
s
o
them
8
X


X

X


X


X




X





X

X

X


X

adaptation
c
a>
it
S
O
thsrn
S



































:
2








b


























•
&



































theatt
£

































J=
i
&
"S
s
c


c

c


c


c




c

c



c

c

c
f-

c
'




O
S
1
P


P

P


P


P

P


f

f



r

f

r
a

r


3
|
{•
c
s
3
i


,

N


I


N




N


"


I

N

N
II

I

Plant adaptation
Tolerance




S.













6 0— fl.O




4 5—7.0














u
Cl
S
s
2


2-3

1-2


2-3













2

1-2


2






£
i
1-2


1

2


1


1

2


1

2



1

2-3


2







3
1-2


1

1


1




2








1

1


1






c
(A
3


2

1


2


1

1








1

1-2

1
2

1

Soils



M
a
tn
1


1

2


J


1

2


1

j



2

3

2
1

1




e
3
i


i

i


i


i




i





i

i

i


2





5
o
2


1

1


1


2




2

1



1

1

1
1

3



jj
u
•
is
as
9.7


4.2

5.4


5.0




11 .0




7.0



5.0

9.2


1.2





Special
considerations
and
adaptations


H.P.R. 12*. SodforiMr. SiaiUar to Intermediate wheatqrais
but somewhat more drought tolerant.

H.P.R. >-. Bunchqrass. Sinllar to standard crested wheat-
grass in adaptation and use but less widely used.
K.P.R. 15*. Bunchqrass. Short life limits use. Seed In
Mixtures only. Tends to be steMHy. Reproduces by seeds and
tillers.
H.P.R. 9". Bunchqrass. Refer to Fairway crested wheatgrasa.
full stands slightly wore productive than Fairway.

N.P.R. 9*. Sodformer.


N.P.R. 13". Bunchgrass • nigh sod ium and sa Unity tolerance *
Seed alone rather than in Mixtures. Easy to establish.
Excellent seedling vigor.
H.P.R. 8*. Sod former. Excellent seedling vigor.

m
stands. Tolerates alkalinity and silting. Rhixomatous.
Long lived. Slow germination, spreads rapidly, sod forming.
Valuable for erosion control.
Similar to Russian wildryer deep root system.

N.P.R. 14. Bunchgrass. Vigorous, tali growing bunchgrass.
Reproduces by seeds and tillers.
N.P.R. 18* . Sodformer. Poor seed production and problems
with seed dormancy.
P Y
H.P.R. 10-. Sodformlng. Established using vegetative mate-
rial.
VO
ro
                                           —continued—

-------
        TABLE 8.11    (continued)
CoOTfton and
scientific
nance
Hildrye. Russian
(EryaMij junceus )
Regional adaptation
*j
!
u
•

c
tt
e
X
A*
a

irn Great Plains

£
X
e
0.
*«
c
JZ
a


j
z

t»
m
u
a

a
£
s

•s
s
s
c
a
.
£
£
A*
s

Ive or introduced
2
i
Plant adaptation
Tolerance
X
o.

w
•
•>
o>
SB
2
Drought
1
•a
3
i
Salinity
1
Soil*
1
2
3
t
u
1
S
S
a.:
» u
3 ^
11
5.0
Special
considerations
and
adaptations
M.P.R. !!•. sunchjrass. Seed alone or with alfalfa. Early
growth. Very hardy once established. Provide a weed-free
seedbed.
U)
NOTCSt  This table was  compiled fro. numerous sources*  th« following  syabols are used  in the table.
Season of Growth!  w *  warm C * cool
Growth Habiti  A • annual;  P • perennial
Native or Introduced!   N -  native) I -  introduced
Plant Adaptation i  1 »  well adapted
                  2 -  Intermediate
                  3 *  poorly adapted
PLS • pure live seed
• seeding rate based on bulk seed
N.P.R. - •inisMa precipitation

-------
     Mountains

     Wit land
                                     CompiM trr Morm L Auibn
Figure 8.26
Major land resource regions of  the United States.
(A) Northwestern forest,  forage and specialty
crop region.   (B) Northwestern  wheat and range
region.   (C)  California  subtropical fruit,  truck
and specialty crop region.   (D)   Western range
and irrigated region.   (E)  Rocky Mountain range
and forest region.   (F)   Northern Great Plains
spring region.   (H)  Central  Great Plains winter
wheat range region.   (I)  Southwestern plateaus
and plains, range and cotton  region.  (J)  South-
western prairies, cotton  and  forage region.   (K)
Northern lake states forest and forage region.
(L) Lake states fruit,  truck  and dairy region.
(M) Central feed grains and livestock region.
(N) East and Central general  fanning and forest
region.   (0) Mississippi  Delta  cotton and feed
grains region.   (P) South Atlantic and Gulf
Slope cash crop, forest and livestock region.
(R) Northeastern forage and forest region.   (S)
Northern Atlantic Slope truck,  fruit and
poultry region.  (T) Atlantic and Gulf Coast
lowlands, forest and truck crop region.   (U)
Florida subtropical fruit, truck crop and ranae
region (Austin, 1965).
                             494

-------
.
.
        Figure 8.27.   Seeding regions in the United States (modified from Vallentine, 1971).

-------
 to  be the most practical for land  treatment.   The method selected  depends
 on  the waste-soil interactions, present  condition of the soil surface  and
 cost-benefit  ratios  of  each  method.
 8.7.4                     Seeding  and Establishment
      Seeding  at  the proper time is extremely important to successful  stand
 establishment  since it  affects the physiological development of the plant.
 Cool  season species usually  perform best if seeded in late summer or  early
 fall.  Warm season  species are normally seeded during late winter or  early
 spring.   Generally, the best  time  to seed is just prior  to  the period of
 expected  high annual rainfall.   This provides  favorable  temperatures and
 soil  moisture  conditions to  the developing  seedlings.  Seeding method, rate
 and depth also have a direct effect on the  success of stand establishment.
8.7.4.1  Seeding Methods
     The most  commonly  used methods of seeding are broadcasting and drill-
ing.   Generally,  drilling  is preferred over broadcasting from an agronomic
standpoint  because  drilling places the seed  into  the soil, thus improving
seed-soil  contact and  the  probability  of seedling  establishment.   With
broadcasting,  seeds  are usually  poorly covered with soil  which  tends  to
slow  stand establishment.   Consequently,  broadcast  seeding is  seldom  as
effective  as  drilling  without  some  soil disturbance  prior  to   seeding.
Better results will  be  obtained if the broadcast seeding operation is also
followed  with  harrowing  or  cultipacking.     These  follow-up  operations
enhance  seed-soil contact,  thus  increasing  the probability  for  seedling
establishment.

     Broadcast  seeding   may be  accomplished   by  either  aerial  or ground
application.   Aerial application  uses  either a helicopter  or  an  airplane
equipped with a spreader and a  positive type metering device.  Broadcasting
by ground application may be done  by hand  using the airstream or exhaust  of
a  farm implement, a rotary spreader,  or  a  fertilizer-spreader  type seed
box.   Ground application tends to  be  slower  than  aerial application; how-
ever,  aerial  application is feasible  only for  large acreages due to the
cost Involved.
8.7.4.2  Seeding Rate
     Using the  proper  seeding rate is another  critical  factor to seedling
establishment.  The actual quantity of seed applied per acre depends on the
species, the method of  seeding,  and the  waste-site characteristics.  Seed-
ing rates should be adequate  for stand establishment without being excess-
ive.   When broadcasting  seeds,  the  rates  should be  increased 50  to 75%
since there is less seed-soil contact than is typical for drilling.

                                    496

-------
     The current  practice,  for calculating seeding  rates  is based on  the
quantity (Ibs) of  seed  required to produce 20  live  seeds  per foot.   Pure
live seed (PLS) is the percentage of the bulk seed that is  considered  live,
and it can be calculated using the following equation:

               PLS = (% germination + % hardseed) X % purity          (8.9)

The tag on the seed  bag should contain all the  information  needed  for the
various calculations.   To determine  pounds  of available bulk  seed needed
per acre use the following equation:

               Lb. PLS/acre t % PLS of available bulk seed =         ,g 1Qv
                      Lb. of available bulk seed/acre

For seeding  mixtures,  pounds of PLS needed  per acre can be calculated by
using the following equation:

           (decimal equivalent of the percentage for a specific
           species desired in a mixture) X (Ibs. of PLS/acre for     (8.11)
                         a single species seeding)

The quantity of  available bulk  seed (Ibs) needed  per acre  to  obtain the
desired mixture can then be  calculated using equation  (8.10).
8.7.4.3  Seeding Depth
     Optimum seeding depth of a particular species  depends  on  seed  size and
quantity of stored  energy and the surface soils at  the  site.   The rule of
thumb is to plant seeds at a depth of  4 to 7  times  the diameter  of  the seed
(Welch and Haferkamp,  1982).  Many seedings fail because seeds  are planted
too deep and not  enough  stored  energy exists to allow the  developing seed-
lings to reach  the  soil  surface.   The major problem with planting  seeds at
too shallow a  depth is the increased  potential  for desiccation.   Seed may
safely be planted deeper  in light  textured soils  than in heavy soils.
8.7.4.4  Plant Establishment
     Vegetative  establishment  may require lime,  fertilizer,  mulch and addi-
 tional moisture  to  assure  success.   Specific cultural practices needed vary
 according  to  season and  location.  Soil tests should be used as  a guide  to
 available  nutrients and  the need for pH adjustment.   In most instances, the
 area  will have  already  been adjusted  to a pH  of 6.5  or  above  to  obtain
 optimal  waste degradation.   Without  a proper  balance of  nitrogen,  phos-
 phorus and potassium,  plant growth may be poor.

     At  sites where excessive  heat or wind is  a  problem,  a cover  crop  or
 mulch  can reduce surface soil  temperatures, evaporation,  crusting and wind
 erosion.   Numerous  grasses including  various sorghums and millets  may  be

                                     497

-------
used  as mulch; however,  it  is  best  to obtain  recommendations from local  SCS
offices or universities.  Generally, seed  production of a temporary cover
crop  should be prevented.   To  accomplish  this objective,  the species should
be  planted late  in its growing season  or  cut  prior to seed set.  Permanent
species can  then be seeded or sprigged without excessive competition from
remnants of the  previous cover crop.
8.7.5                         Soil Fertility
     Soil  fertility  plays  a  major  role  in the  ability  of  plants   and
microbes to grow and  reproduce in a land  treatment operation.  When  vegeta-
tion  is part  of the management plan,  nutrient imbalances  may adversely
affect  plant  growth.   Even  if the  unit  operates  without  the   use  of
vegetation,  nutrient  toxicities  or  deficiencies   may  deter  growth   and
reproduction of microbes,  thus limiting waste degradation.

     Numerous  macro-  and  micronutrients  are considered essential to plants
and  microorganisms.    A general discussion  of   this  topic is  included in
Section  4.1.2.3.   Micronutrients must  be more  carefully controlled since
there  is  a narrower  range between the  quantity of  a particular nutrient
causing  a  deficiency or  toxicity  to plants  than with the macronutrients.
Attention needs to be given  to the total  quantity of  the  nutrient contained
in  the overall  land  treatment  operation  rather than just  the quantity
present in the treatment medium or the waste alone.

     Macronutrients are generally  applied in rather  large quantities when
compared to micronutrients.   The three major macronutrients  in  fertilizer
are  nitrogen  (N),  phosphorus  (P)  and  potassium  (K).   Other macroelements
which may need to be  applied include calcium, magnesium and sulfur.

     Micronutrients include  such elements as copper,  iron, boron, chloride,
molybdenum, zinc and manganese.  Other trace elements  essential  to specific
plant  groups  include  sodium,  cobalt,  aluminum,   silicon   and selenium
(Larcher, 1980).  Additions  of any one or  a combination of micronutrients
may  be  required depending on  the  characteristics of  the treatment medium
and the waste.
8.7.5.1  Fertilizer Formulation
     Two systems  currently  exist for reporting  composition percentages of
fertilizer components.   Under the  old  system,  a  13-13-13 fertilizer  con-
tained  13%  N,   13%  P205  and  13%  ^0;   however,   under   the  new   system
this same  fertilizer would contain  13% total N,  30% available  P  and  162
soluble K.  Conversion factors for P and K are as follows:
                                    498

-------
                   P2(>5 x .44 - P          K20 x .83 - K

                   P x 2.29 - P205         K x 1.20 = K20

The average composition of typical fertilizers are given in Table 8.12.


8.7.5.2  Timing Fertilizer Applications


     The optimum time to apply fertilizer depends on the amount and distri-
bution of  precipitation,  the type of fertilizer  and  the growth character-
istics of  the  plant.   Nitrogen is  highly mobile in  soils,  yet phosphorus
and potassium  move  very slowly.   Therefore,  nitrogen needs  to be applied
near the  period of most  active use by  the  plants, as  long  as sufficient
moisture is present.  Phosphorus and potassium can be applied over a longer
time frame because  precipitation  will  move them  into  the  active root zone
where they eventually can be taken up and used by plants.


8.7.5.3  Method of Application
     Two practical fertilizer  application methods for land treatment units
are broadcasting and  sprinkler irrigation.  The application method must be
compatible with the specific type of fertilizer to be applied.   Some  ferti-
lizers such as anhydrous ammonia, aqueous  ammonia and urea volatize rapidly
if they are broadcast so these must be  incorporated into the soil shortly
after application.

     Broadcasting is  generally the most  cost  effective method  of applica-
tion.   This method  is  commonly  used  when  applying granular fertilizers.
Minimal surface  runoff  of  fertilizer  occurs with  this application  method
since slopes and runoff  of  land treatment  units are  restricted.

     Sprinkler irrigation may  be effective for  applying noncorrosive  liquid
fertilizers.   This application method  could  be easily incorporated  into
existing  land  treatment irrigation  systems.  This  method allows frequent
uniform applications  of  fertilizer at  lower rates,  thus increasing nitrogen
utilization by the plants (Vallentine,  1971).
8.8                            WASTE  STORAGE
     Wastes may need  to  be  stored at  HWLT units  for many reasons,  including
 1)  holding to determine if  the waste  has  the  expected concentration  of
 hazardous  constituents,  2)  equipment  breakdown,  or 3)  climatic restrictions
 on waste application.  If climatic factors will  restrict waste application,
 then sufficient waste storage capacity must  be provided for wastes produced
 during  the season when wastes cannot  be applied  to the HWLT facility.
                                     499

-------
      TABLE 8.12  AVERAGE COMPOSITION OF FERTILIZER MATERIALS*
o
o

Fertilizers
NITROGEN FERTILIZERS
Ammonia , anhydrous
Ammonium nitrate
Ammonium phosphate sulfate
Ammonium sulfate
Di-ammonium phosphate
Mono-ammonium phosphate
Potassium nitrate
Urea
Sodium nitrate
% %
N P

82
33.5
16 9
20
21 22
11 21
14
45
16
% % %
K P205 K20



20

50
48 46
38


P solubility
in water



Over 75%

Over 75%
Over 75%



CaC03 Equivalence t
__«_-^-___«— __— _
S Basicity Acidity

147
60
16 88
24 110
75
2.6 58
23
71
28
PHOSPHATE FERTILIZERS
(see also under nitrogen
   fertilizers)
  Calcium metaphosphate
  Rock phosphate
  Superphosphate, single
  Superphosphate, triple
  Phosphoric acid
  Mono-potassium phosphate

POTASSIUM FERTILIZERS
(see also under nitrogen and
   phosphorus fertilizers)
  Potassium chloride
    (muriate of potash)
  Potassium sulfate
                                             28
                                             15
                                              9
                                             20
                                             24
                                             23
29
64
33
20
46
54
52
35
Slight
1% or less
Over 75%
Over 75%
Over 75%
Over 75%
                                  12
                                   1
Neutral
Basic
Neutral
Neutral

Neutral
                                                   50           60

                                                   44           53

                                                   —cont inued—
                                       Neutral

                                  18   Neutral
                                                    110

-------
      TABLE 8.12  (continued)
Ul
o
Fertilizers
ORGANIC FERTILIZERS
Manure, dairy (fresh)
Manure, poultry (fresh)
Manure, steer (fresh)
%
N
0.7
1.6
2.0
%
P
.13
.55
.24
%
K
.54
.75
1.59
%
P205
.30
1.25
.54
%
K20
.65
.9
1.92
P solubility
in water
50%
50%
40%
CaC03 Equivalence*
S Basicity
Slight
Slight
Slight
Acidity

SULFUR FERTILIZERS
(see also under nitrogen and
   phosphorus fertilizers)
  Calcium sulfate (gypsum)
  Magnesium sulfate
  Soil sulfur
  Sulfate potash magnesia

LIMING FERTILIZERS
  Calcium oxide
  Dolomite
  Limestone, ground
  Shell meal
                                                 21.5
26
18.6
  13
  99
  18
Acidic
Acidic
Acidic
Acidic
                                                                                          178
                                                                                          110
                                                                                           95
                                                                                           95
      * Vallentine  (1971)
      t Compared  to 100  basicity  for

-------
 8.8.1                    Waste Application Season
     The waste application season must be determined to enable the owner or
operator  to determine  the  amount of  waste storage  capacity needed.   If
accumulation  of  untreated waste  in  soil creates no  potential toxicity or
mobility hazard, waste  application will  only be limited by freezing  temper-
atures, snow  cover  and  precipitation.   Models, developed by Whiting  (1976)
can be used to determine the waste application season based on various cli-
matic  parameters.    In  the case  above,  the  EPA-1  or  EPA-3 model  can be
applied directly (Whiting, 1976).   The climatic  data required are the mean
daily temperature (°F), snow depth, and  daily precipitation for 20-25 years
of record.

     If accumulation of untreated  waste in  soil can  potentially  lead to
unacceptable toxicities to plants or soil microbes and/or leaching or vola-
tilization of hazardous waste constituents, then wastes may only be  applied
when soil temperature is greater  than  5°C  (41°F)  and soil moisture  content
is less  than  field  capacity.   These values  are  used  as  thresholds since
decomposition of organics  and other treatment reactions  essentially cease
at  lower  temperatures  or greater  moisture  contents.   Soil temperature
records are limited, so air  temperatures  are often  used as  described in
Section 4.1.1.6  to  estimate  soil temperature.   The EPA-1  or EPA-3 models
described above  may be applied  to  estimate the  waste  application  season.
When the waste application season is limited by cold weather,  the nonappli-
cation season for storage  volume calculations can be defined as being the
last day in fall failing to exceed  a minimum daily  mean temperature to the
first day in spring exceeding the minimum daily mean temperature.

     Additional  constraints  for  application  of  hazardous  waste must  be
evaluated in terms of soil parameters and the 5-year return, month-by-month
precipitation for  the  particular HWLT  site.   Wetness is  restrictive to
waste application operations  primarily  because saturated  conditions maxi-
mize  the  potential  for pollutant  discharge  via leachate  or  runoff  and
inhibit organic matter degradation.  An  application season based on  periods
of excessive  wetness can  be established  in  a  straightforward  manner by
applying the EPA-2  model  described by Whiting (1976).   The  required cli-
matic data should be for a 20 to 25-year period  of  record.   Specifically,
the required data inputs for the model are as follows:

     (1)  daily minimum, maximum and mean on-site temperatures (°F);
     (2)  daily precipitation (inches);

     (3)  site characteristics and climatic parameters for the station
          including:

          (a)   I, the heat index;

          (b)   b, a coefficient dependent on the heat index;

          (c)   g, the tangent of the station's latitude;
                                    502

-------
          (d)  W,  the  available water  holding capacity  of the  soil
               profile (in inches minus  1.0 inch  as  a  safety factor);
               and

          (e)  ()>, the daily solar declination, in radians.

Since the model  is driven  only  by  climatic factors, the  results  should be
interpreted carefully; biologic and hydrologic  factors  should  also be con-
sidered.   The  model provides a valuable first estimate  of the  number of
storage days needed.   The maximum annual waste storage days  for  the con-
tinental U.S.,  as estimated  by the  model  are shown  in  Fig.  8.28.   The
actual on-site soil profile characteristics  including  percolation, runoff,
profile storage, surface storage, and waste loading rates should be used to
determine storage days for a  specific HWLT  site when the limiting climatic
factor is excess precipitation.
8.8.2                    Waste Storage Facilities
     During the operation of an HWLT  unit,  there may be periods when waste
application  is  not  possible  due  to  wetness,  low  temperature,  equipment
failure, or other  causes.   Suitable  facilities  must  be provided to retain
the waste as  it  is generated  until field application  can  be resumed.   The
design  of  the necessary structure  depends on  the waste  material  and the
actual  size  of  the structure depends on the required waste storage capa-
city.    Waste  storage  facilities   should  be   sufficient   to  store  the
following:

     (1)  waste  generated  during  extended  wet  and  cold  periods   as
          estimated in Section 8.8.1;

     (2)  waste generated during periods  of field work,  i.e., plowing,
          planting, harvesting, etc.;

     (3)  waste generated during periods  of equipment  failure;

     (4)  25-year,  24-hour  return  period  rainfall  over  the  waste
          storage  structure if it  is  open; and

     (5)  waste  generated  in  excess  of  application  capacity  due  to
          seasonal fluctuations In  the  rate of  waste  production.

Runoff  retention areas  should  not  be used to store wastes  generated during
the above  situations;  runoff  retention areas are  designed  to retain runoff
from the  active land treatment  areas.    Waste  storage facilities are  dis-
cussed  below.
8.8.2.1  Liquid Waste  Storage
     Liquid  wastes  can  be  conveniently  stored  in  clay  lined  ponds  or
basins.  An  aeration system may be added to the pond  to  prevent the liquid
                                     503

-------
-
                                                                                          Shading  denotes
                                                                                          regions  where the
                                                                                          principle  climat
                                                                                          ic constraint  to
                                                                                          land application
                                                                                          is prolonged wet
                                                                                           spells.
                     Figure 8.28. Estimated maximum annual waste  storage days based on
                                  climatic factors (Wischmeier and Smith,  1978).

-------
waste from becoming anaerobic.  Wastes  which are  highly flammable or vola-
tile should  not  be stored in open  ponds.   Additionally, pond  liners  must
not be  prone to failure.   Clay liners  and  other liner materials  may not
acceptable for waste storage  if they are chemically incompatiable with the
waste.

     A second approach to liquid storage is  to  construct  a  tank.   The tank
may be either closed or open, is usually made of  metal or concrete and can
be equipped  with an aerifier.   Tanks  of  this nature are  more  costly  to
construct and require  periodic  maintenance,  but  they  assure  that no waste
is released to percolate through the soil.  If differential settling occurs
during storage,  some method of  remixing the waste may be needed  to assure
that  the  treatment site  receives  uniform applications.   If  any  of the
liquid wastes being stored are hazardous wastes,  the storage facilities for
the wastes  must meet  specific  regulatory  requirements for  storage  (EPA,
1981; EPA, 1982).
8.8.2.2  Sludge Storage


     Sludges can be stored in facilities similar to those used for liquids.
Under certain conditions, filling and emptying tanks with sludge may become
a problem.  Thus, a properly lined pond or basin may be more appropriate.


8.8.2.3  Solid Waste Storage
     The  most  common method  of solid  waste storage  is to  stockpile the
material.   If  these piles are  exposed  to the weather,  the  area should be
bermed sufficiently to contain water from the 24-hour  25-year return period
storm over  the storage area,  in addition to  the waste volume  itself.   A
buffer factor  of at least  20% should  be  added  to  the berm to allow for
slumping  of the  stockpiled  waste.    The waste  application  season must,
therefore, be  determined  to  enable the owner or  operator  to determine the
amount of waste  storage capacity needed.   Waste piles for hazardous wastes
must meet certain regulatory requirements (EPA, 1982).


8.9                    WASTE APPLICATION TECHNIQUES


     Waste  characteristics  such as  the  total volume  and  water  content,
along with  soil  properties,  topography and  climate,  need  to be  considered
to determine  the appropriate  waste  application  technique.   Liquid wastes
containing between  95% and  100% water with  a low volatility hazard may be
successfully applied by sprinkler irrigation;  while, relatively  dry, vola-
tile and/or  toxic materials  may require  subsurface injection  techniques.
Regardless of  which application system is chosen, two basic considerations
must be  examined.   First,  the  waste  application  rate chosen  should not
exceed the  capacity of the  soil  to  degrade,  immobilize  or transform the


                                     505

-------
 waste constituents.  Second,  the  waste should  be  applied as uniformly  as
 possible.   Waste applications  cannot  consist  of merely pouring  or  dumping
 the wastes  in one  spot.   A definite plan must be developed  and  implemented
 to uniformly  apply the  waste to  the soil at  the  design rate over  the
 desired  area.    There  are  five  basic  considerations  for  choosing  an
 appropriate application system for a given site  and waste.   They are  as
 follows:

      (1)  effect on public  health  and  the  environment;

      (2)  operator-waste  contact;

      (3)  ability  to handle solids content;

      (4)  service  life; and

      (5)  cost  (capital and operational).

 In the following sections,  application techniques  are discussed  with regard
 to the consistency  of the waste as shown in Table 8.13.


 TABLE 8.13  WASTE  CONSISTENCY  CLASSIFICATION


     Consistency                            Characteristics

 Liquid                       Less  than 8%  solids and  particle  diameter  less
                             than  2.5  cm

 Semi  liquid                 3-15% solids  or particle diameters  over 2.5  cm

 Low moisture  solids          Greater than  15%  solids

 Bulky wastes                 Solid materials consisting  of contaminated
                             lumber, construction materials, plastic, etc.
8.9.1                          Liquid Wastes
     As  a practical  definition,  a liquid  waste is  considered  to  have  a
solids content  of  less  than 8% and particles  with  diameters less than  2.5
cm.  Handling and transporting many hazardous  wastes may  be  more  convenient
when the  waste  is in liquid  form.   Many wastes are  generated in a moist
condition and usually require large amounts of energy  to  dewater  them.   The
cost of transporting  a  liquid  waste from the  source  to the land  treatment
unit is  a function  of  distance.   Pipelines  may  be   the  least costly  for
short distances, while trucks may  be necessary for greater distances.

     Applications of  liquid wastes are generally  accomplished by spraying
waste with a sprinkler system or by surface irrigating with  flood  or  furrow
irrigation  techniques.    Liquid wastes  should  be  applied  so  that   direct
runoff does not occur.   Both techniques may cause  air quality problems  if

                                    506

-------
the waste  applied Is highly  volatile.   Care  should  be taken  when liquid
wastes are applied to ensure  that  leaching does  not occur before treatment
of the hazardous constituents in the applied wastes is completed.
8.9.1.1  Surface Irrigation


     Surface Irrigation appears to be the easiest application technique for
a liquid waste and requires the least  capital  outlay.   This method is com-
monly used so all necessary equipment is readily obtainable.  One method of
surface irrigation involves laying out the area so  that  wastewater can be
applied by a set  of  trenches,  canals and ditches.    Waste  is  pumped to the
main canal where  it  flows by  gravity  through  trenches and ditches to all
areas of the field where it infiltrates into the soil.  There are,  however,
some drawbacks  to this  system.    Since the waste  stands in  the  trenches
until the water infiltrates, there is a potential for odor and insect prob-
lems.  Another disadvantage to this  system is  nonuniform application since
as  the  liquid flows  through   trenches  and ditches, less  of  the  waste is
carried  to the  far  end  of  the   field.    In   addition,  if  the  waste is
especially dangerous,  such as a   strong  corrosive  agent,  all  persons and
animals must be kept away from the active  area.

     Another common means  of  surface application involves using a  truck or
trailer mounted  tank  filled with  waste to spread  the  material across the
field.   The  liquid waste is released  by gravity flow  or  pumped through  a
sprayer or manifold (Wooding and Shipp, 1979).  Application rates  with  this
system  are easily controlled  by  varying  the   flow  rate  or  travel  speed.
Difficulties encountered  during  periods of bad weather may require  alter-
nate application  technologies  or  storage facilities.  One possible modifi-
cation is  to construct all weather roads  in a pattern that allows a  truck
or  spray rig to  discharge  wastes from  the  sides  onto  the disposal  area.
This would make  continued application  during  periods  of inclement weather
possible.  Waste  spread this way  should be incorporated as  soon as the soil
conditions permit.   One possible  disadvantage of vehicular applications  is
the  resulting  compaction and  deterioration  of soil structure  (Kelling  et
al.,  1976).   A  listing of  commercial equipment  for  land application  of
wastes is  included in  the Implement  and Tractor Red  Book  (1979).
8.9.1.2   Sprinkler  Irrigation


     Spray  application  of  wastewater has enjoyed much popularity (Powell et
al., 1972),  particularly  for municipal wastewater effluents (Cassel et al.,
1979).   This is primarily due to the  availability and reasonable  cost of
the equipment.   Sprinkler systems for use in  hazardous  waste disposal need
to be designed  by a qualified specialist to  conform to the American Society
of  Agricultural Engineers Standard  5376.    Highest  priority  needs  to be
given  to attaining a uniform application pattern  (coefficient  of uniform-
ity).   A completely uniform  application pattern has  a  coefficient  of uni-
formity  of  100%.  Average irrigation systems attain  a  coefficient  of uni-

                                     507

-------
 formity of approximately 60%.   Information on uniformity, which  is  avail-
 able from  irrigation  suppliers, should  be considered  before accepting  a
 system.   When  trying to  achieve a  uniform waste  distribution,  a  higher
 degree  of uniformity  is  required than  when disposing  of  runoff water  or
 wetting down plots for dust control.  All  materials need to  be tested  for
 corrosivity  with  the waste  to  be  disposed  to  ensure  that   premature
 equipment failure does not  occur.

      The basic sprinkler  irrigation system  consists of  a pump   to move
 waste from the source to the site,  a pipe  leading from  the pump  to  the
 sprinkler heads,  and the spray nozzles.  When  choosing  a pump, it must  be
 made of a material compatible with the proper  capacity  and  pressure  needed
 for the given situation.   For sludge applications,  1 to  2  inch nozzles  re-
 quiring 50-100 psi  water pressure  are  recommended  (White  et al.,  1975).
 Pumps for  these  nozzles generally  cost  more  and  require  more  energy  to
 operate  than  those  used  for  nonpressured   systems   such  as  surface
 Irrigation.

      Sprinkler systems,  if  properly  designed, are  applicable to flat, slop-
 ing and irregular terrain.  A site  can be vegetated at the time of waste
 application provided  the vegetation  will  not interfere  with  the  spray
 nozzle  operation  and  waste  interception by the vegetative cover will  not
 present a hazard  or inhibit waste treatment.   Generally, sites are cleared
 of  trees and  brush and planted to a  pasture grass.   In some cases,  however,
 It  may  be desirable  to dispose of wastewater in a  forested  area with  risers
 placed  in a pattern  that  avoids  interference by trees.   Pipes  can  be  either
 permanently buried below the  frost  line or cultivation depth,  or laid  on
 the surface as with  a  portable irrigation system.

      Although numerous  configurations  have  been  developed  for  sprinkler
 irrigation systems,  three variations are most  widely used.   The first  of
 the three main techniques  is  the fixed, underground manifold with  risers
 and rotating impact type  sprinklers.   This  system  is   the  most  costly  to
 install and  is  permanent  for the  life of  the  installation.    A  second
 approach is to use  a traveling  pipe and  sprinkler.   In  this  system,  a
 sprinkler connected  by a flexible hose to the  wastewater supply is mounted
 on  a self propelled  trailer device which  traverses a  fixed route  across
 the field.  The third  commonly used  spray system is  the  center pivot irri-
 gation  system.    Here  a  fixed central wastewater  supply comes up from  an
 underground main  and a self propelled  sprinkler system rotates around  the
 supply.   The  coefficient of  uniformity with this system  is  as  high as 80%.

     Of  the three major systems, the trailer mounted sprinkler has  the most
 versatility and can be easily moved  from one  location  to  another.   Above
 ground  detachable irrigation pipe,  normally  used  for agricultural irriga-
 tion, is  not  commonly  used because of the  hazardous nature of the liquids
 being handled.  In general, most spray systems  require little  land  prepara-
 tion and  can  operate under  a wide range of  soil moisture conditions.   The
major difficulties with spray irrigation  of wastewater  are odor  control,
power consumption by  high  pressure pumps,  clogging of  nozzles  causing  a
nonuniform  application,  and  aerosol drift  of hazardous waste materials.
Low angle impact  sprinklers have been developed to reduce aerosol  drift.


                                     508

-------
     Terrain and weather  conditions  should  also be considered when design-
ing  a  sprinkler  system.    Spray irrigation  on sodded  or  cropped  fields
should be done  only  on slopes  of 0-15%.  If  the spray application area is
forested, application  can be  done  on  slopes  up to  30%.    Slopes  at  HWLT
units are generally less  than  5%.  Low lying, poorly drained areas need to
be drained  as  described in Section  8.3.6.    Designers  of  spray irrigation
systems  need  to give  particular attention  to cold  weather alternatives.
Pipes will need to be  drained  and  flushed to prevent freezing and clogging
during down times.   Provisions must  be made to recycle the drained water
back to the original source.

     Two other  irrigation systems  less  frequently used  for waste applica-
tion are the tow line  and  side wheel roll systems.  These  systems are gen-
erally limited  to use  with wastes having a  very low solids since the small
nozzles clog easily.   A review of  irrigation systems and their suitability
for waste application  is presented by Ness and  Ballard (1979).
8.9.2                           Semiliquids


     Semillquids, also called sludges, typically contain 5 to  15% solids by
weight.   Application  of semiliquids  is normally  done either  by surface
spreading with  subsequent  incorporation or by  subsurface  injection.   Each
of  these systems,  with  its inherent  advantages  and  disadvantages,  are
discussed below.   Some general  factors to be  considered when choosing and
designing a system are  vehicle traction  and weight,  power  requirements,
topography and spreading patterns.
8.9.2.1  Surface Spreading and Mixing
     Surface spreading  and subsequent mixing  is  the conventional  applica-
tion  technique for  farm  manures.    Sludge may  be  applied in  a  similar
manner, by loading the waste material on a manure spreader which  applies  it
uniformly over the area.   The sludge is then mixed with  the  surface soil  by
means of discing, deep  plowing  or rototilling.  The main advantage to  this
system  is  the  low capital  outlay required.   Equipment  is conventional,
readily available  and of  reasonable  cost.   Since  this technique  requires
traversing the land  area twice, it is  neither energy nor labor  efficient.
Commercial waste applicators using this system often use large vacuum  tank
trucks equipped with  flotation  tires  and  a  rear manifold or gated  pipe for
spreading the waste.  Another option  for  moving sludges is to use  a hauler
box or a truck equipped with a waterproof bed.

     If the sludge is too  thick to pump (over 15% solids), the only choice
may be  to  bring the material to the  site and dump  it.   Typically,  a  pile
of sludge  slumps to  about twice  the  area of  the  truck  bed.    Additional
equipment is then  needed  to spread the waste over  the  soil surface.  The
most  efficient  piece of equipment for uniform  spreading appears  to  be  a
                                    509

-------
road  grader  with depth  control skids  mounted  on  the  blade.    A second
choice for this  job is a  bulldozer  similarly equipped with  depth  control
skids on the blade.   Dozer blades  may require wings on the edges  to avoid
formation of windrows.  Backblading with  a floating blade helps to  achieve
a uniform distribution.

     Uniformity of application  must be  stressed; .excessive applications to
small areas result in barren  "hot  spots"  and may  lead to  other environmen-
tal problems.   Underapplication is inefficient and  requires  more  land for
disposal than would otherwise be needed.  Normal cultivation practices such
as plowing and discing cannot be relied on to evenly distribute waste over
a field.   Windrows  should be avoided in  the spreading procedure.   Conse-
quently, there  must be a  definite planned procedure to  evenly distribute
the waste prior to incorporation.

     There are several basic pieces of equipment that effectively mix waste
material with  topsoil.   First, there  is  the  moldboard  plow which  very
effectively inverts the upper 15-30 cm  of soil.   Secondly, there are discs
which accomplish more mixing  and less turning of the soil material than a
moldboard plow.   Rotary  tillers do an  excellent  job of  thoroughly mixing
the waste  with the  surface soil,  but  it  is  generally slow  and  requires
large energy  expenditures.   It does,  however,  only require one  pass to
accomplish  adequate mixing  while  other   types  of  equipment  require  two
passes.  A tractor-like vehicle with a large auger mounted sideways is also
a very effective method for incorporating wastes into the soil in one pass.
A more extensive equipment review is provided in Section 8.9.4.

     The surface  spreading and mixing  technique  is not  particularly well
adapted for  use in applying  hazardous  volatile wastes since the material
lies  directly  on  the soil  surface and is  exposed  to the  atmosphere.   If
waste fumes will endanger the operator or the general public, or are objec-
tionable, this system will not be acceptable.


8.9.2.2  Subsurface Injection


     Subsurface injection  is  the  technique of  placing a  material  beneath
the soil surface.  It was originally developed by the agricultural  industry
for applying anhydrous ammonia.  Equipment  has also  been developed  for  sub-
surface injection of  liquid manures and  wastes.   Basic equipment  consists
of a  tool bar with  two or more chisels attached to  the rear  of a truck or
tractor.  Adjustable sweeps are often mounted on  or near  the bottom of the
chisels to open a wide but shallow cavity underground.  A  tube  connected to
the waste source leads down the back  of the chisel, and as the sweep opens
a cavity, the waste is injected.  With proper adjustment and use, very  lit-
tle waste reaches  the soil surface.  If  waste is forced  back  to  the  soil
surface in the  furrow created by the chisel, blades may  be attached which
fold the soil back into the furrow.

     Subsurface horizontal spreading  of the waste may be limited with  this
technique, but a horizontal  subsoiler may  be added  to  the chisel  injector

                                    510

-------
to Increase the subsurface area of incorporation.  The horizontal subsoiler
moves through the soil prior to the injector.  This also enhances the waste
degradation rate due to the increased waste-soil contact.

     Common depths of application vary from 10 to 20 cm below the soil sur-
face (Wooding and  Shipp,  1979).  Application rates are usually  about 375
liters/min/applicator with nominal loading  rates  of 22,000  to 66,000 kg of
dry  solids  per hectare  (Smith  et  al.,  1977;   Brisco  Maphis,  personal
communication).  An experienced operator  can achieve a uniform application
across the field.

     Where subsurface applications are made repeatedly over long periods of
time, an underground supply pipe  is  sometimes used to conduct the waste to
different areas of the field.  A long flexible hose is then used to connect
from the supply pipe  to the  truck  or tractor-mounted  injectors.   Sophis-
ticated systems have  radio  controlled shut-off valves  so  the operator can
turn the waste off when he needs to raise the injectors to make a turn.
8.9.3                       Low Moisture Solids
     Low  moisture solids are  characterized by  moisture contents  of leas
than 85%.  Basically, they can be handled  much as one would handle sand or
soil.  If the materials are dense and in large units, such as logs or rail-
road ties, it may be necessary to shred or chip the material before appli-
cation.  A dump truck is the conventional method of transporting and apply-
ing solids.  Piles of solids are then  spread over the field using either a
roadgrader or bulldozer.

     As is  the  case with surface spreading of  sludge  materials,  the most
important  concern is  to achieve  an  even  distribution.    Another common
implement used for spreading solid wastes  is the manure spreader, which is
particularly useful for  wastes having  moisture contents causing them to be
sticky or chunky.  The main disadvantage  of this system is the small capa-
city, resulting  in  a large number of  trips required to spread the waste.
If the  material IB granular and relatively free  of  large  chunks,  a sand
spreader  on  the back of a dump  truck may  be useful.   Such  broadcasting
methods are commonly used in northern states to  spread  sand  and salt on icy
roads.  Regardless of the spreading  system selected,  the waste needs to be
incorporated and mixed with the surface soil shortly  after spreading.  Gen-
erally, the sooner this is accomplished, the lower  the  potential for envir-
onmental damage.  Waste  incorporation  can be done according to the options
listed for semiliquids (Section 8.8.2.1.).

     If the  application of  low moisture  aolids will  cause a significant
Increase in the ground surface, special precautions may be required.  Under
proper operation, the treatment zone will  be a fixed  depth from the surface
where aerobic conditions promote  degradation.   Excessive loading of wastes
could prohibit  proper  degradation by isolating  nondegraded material below
the  zone  of  aeration.    Therefore,  sufficient  time must  be  allowed for
degradation of the waste before  applying  of additional waste.  This may be


                                     511

-------
 accomplished by using  a multiple plot  design and rotating waste  applica-
 tions between these plots  to  allow sufficient time  for  proper  degradation
 to occur.  Since this affects area  and  timing requirements it needs  to be
 considered in the  original design of the land treatment unit.

      The main disadvantage of  using a low moisture solid disposal system is
 the large  energy  requirements if  wastes are  initially wet.    First,  the
 material must be dried,  then transported to  the disposal  site,  spread,  and
 finally incorporated.   If the material is  dry  when  initially  generated,
 such as an ash residue,  the system becomes much more  economical.


 8.9.4                            Equipment
      In general, most HWLT  units use  specialized  industrial equipment  or
 agricultural  equipment adapted  to  satisfy to  their needs.   Care must  be
 taken to  obtain  compatible implements;  often  an agricultural implement can-
 not  be attached  to an industrial tractor  without special adaptors.   Where
 power requirements are  high,  the  use  of  crawler  type  and 4-wheel  drive
 articulated tractors  is  common.   As previously noted, a  comprehensive sum-
 mary of such equipment is available in  the Implement and Tractor Red Book
 (1979).

      The  equipment used to incorporate  waste materials  into the  soil vary
 according to  the size  and condition of  the site.  Discing is the  most com-
 monly used technique.  Under adverse conditions,  such as  hard, dry soil,  an
 agricultural  disc may  not penetrate  the soil  adequately to  obtain  satisfac-
 tory incorporation.    In  this  case, industrial discs with  weights  may  be
 used to obtain  sufficient penetration.   After discing  a  field,  a  spring
 tooth harrow  is  useful to further mix  the  waste  into the soil.   Moldboard
 plows are excellent for  turning  under surface applied waste.  The  disadvan-
 tages of  the  moldboard plow are  the high power requirements,  slow  speed and
 poor mixing.   Inadequate  mixing  may result in a layer of persistent  waste.
 Chisel tooth  plows may also be used for  waste incorporation.

      Tractor  mounted rotary  tillers  may be used to create a  thorough soil-
waste mixture  and  to provide effective  aeration,  in  a single  pass.  Compac-
 tion is kept  to a minimum  since only  one  pass  is  needed,  while  plows,
spring tooth harrows,  disc harrows, etc. generally require multiple passes.
A rototiller  also tends to be more  maneuverable than many other types  of
equipment.   The  power requirement  for  this  piece  of equipment  is  quite
high,  however, these other considerations  may be of  greater  importance and
a single pass with a rototiller  may take less  time and energy than multiple
passes with other equipment.   A special tractor with an auger  mounted  on
its  side has been developed for  use in  spreading, turning and incorporating
sludge.  It has many of the same advantages of  the rototiller.

     Specialized equipment, such as  tractors  with low bearing pressure for
use in wet soils, are readily obtainable.   Farm equipment such as  spreaders
and  tank  wagons  can  often  be  purchased  with flotation  tires.    Trucks
                                    512

-------
designed for field use in spreading  liquids  can  also  be equipped with flo-
tation tires, if necessary.

     Equipment for hauling  and spreading liquid and  solid  wastes are com-
monly available.   Tank trucks,  vacuum trucks and liquid  manure spreaders
are available for use with liquid wastes.  Manure spreaders, broadcast type
fertilizer spreaders, dump trucks, road graders and loaders may be used for
working with dry solid wastes.

     Subsurface injection equipment  has  been developed  and there are a few
specialized sources.  Many use  chisel  tooth  plows  often with sweeps on the
bottom.  Other systems use discs to  cut  a  trench followed  with a tube that
injects the waste into the ditch immediately behind the disc.  Still others
use a horizontal discharge  pipe mounted  on the side of a  truck.   The most
efficient  systems,  however,  use large diameter  flexible pipe  to feed the
applicator, eliminating the need of  nurse  tanks  and frequent stops for re-
filling.  Illustrations of such equipment can be found  in many publications
(EPA, 1979; White et al., 1975; Overcash and Pal, 1979).
8.9.5                 Uniformity of Waste Application
     Efficient use of the land  in an HWLT unit requires that maximum quan-
tities of waste be applied while  preventing microbial or plant toxicity  and
minimizing  the  potential  for  contaminated  leachate  or  runoff.    Thus,
hazardous waste loading rates are selected that rapidly load the soil to  a
safe  limit  based  on the  concentration  of  the rate  limiting  constituent
(RLC).   The benefits of this method include a  relatively  small land area
requirement, which minimizes the  volume of runoff water to  be  collected  and
disposed, and  low labor and energy  costs for operation.   When wastes  are
loaded to the maximum safe limit,  uniformity  of  application is essential to
prevent  the occurrence  of  "hot spots."   Hot spots  are  areas that  receive
excessive quantities of waste  causing an increased  probability of wastes
being  released  to  the  environment and  requiring  special  treatment   or
removal when closing the site.
8.9.5.1  Soil Sampling as an Indicator
     Field  sampling  of  soils,  in the treatment  zone  may be used  to  deter-
mine if the hazardous wastes are being uniformly applied.   Location  of  the
samples should be  selected  after first  visually  inspecting a given plot  for
differences  in  color,  structure,  elevation or  other characteristics  that
may  be  indicative  of   uneven  application.    When  such  differences  are
observed, samples  of  the  treatment  zone from these  areas should be obtained
and  analyzed for  elements  or  compounds that  are  characteristic of  the
waste.  Often analysis  of the  RLC can be used  to indicate hot spots.
                                     513

-------
 8.9.5.2  Vegetation as an Indicator


      Despite efforts  to achieve  uniform application  of waste,  excessive
 amounts of waste constituents  may accumulate in relatively small  areas  of
 the waste plot.   Nonuniformity in  soil  characteristics may  contribute  to
 the accumulation of certain  constituents  in isolated areas.   For  example,
 areas containing preexisting salts or  areas with  lower permeability may
 cause hot spots.   Growing vegetation between  applications of waste  helps
 identify such hot spots so that they can be  treated  to  correct the problem
 or so that  future  applications to  these  areas can  be  avoided.    In  areas
 where surface  vegetation  does poorly,  it   is  also highly  probable  that
 microbial degradation  of organic constituents is inhibited.   Thus,  vegeta-
 tion serves  as  a  visual  indication  of  the  differential  application  or
 degradation  of the applied waste.   Furthermore, if  nonuniform application
 has resulted  in areas  where  substances have accumulated  to  phytotoxic
 levels,   these  areas  may  also have  an  increased   probability  for  waste
 constituents to leach  to groundwater.  The soils in  and  below  the treatment
 zone should  be sampled  at  vegetative  hot spots  to  ascertain  the  cause  of
 unsatisfactory growth  and  to determine  if  any  hazardous constituents are
 leaching.
 8.10                           SITE  INSPECTION
     The  site  is  required to  be  inspected weekly  and  following  storm
events  (EPA,  1982); however,  daily inspections of  all  active portions  of
the HWLT unit are desirable.   These inspections  should include observations
to assure that wastes  are  being  properly  spread  and  incorporated.   Further-
more,  daily observations should be  made  to assure that adequate  freeboard
is available in  the various retention  structures at  all  times.

     Weekly inspections are sufficient  for all inactive  portions and  for
dikes,  terraces,  berms and levees.  Observations should include  indentifi-
cation  of hot spots where  vegetation is doing poorly.  Dikes,  terraces  and
levees  should be inspected for seepage and  for  evidence of damage by bur-
rowing  animals or unauthorized traffic.

     Operational,  safety  and  emergency  equipment  should  receive regular
inspection  for damage  or deterioration.  Special attention should  be  given
to this equipment  since  it  is  used  on  an  irregular basis.  When this equip-
ment is needed it  must perform properly;  therefore,  it should  undergo  test-
Ing at appropriate intervals to  ensure that  it will  be ready when  needed.
8.11                       RECORDS AND REPORTING
     As mentioned previously, a  land  treatment unit must be a well  planned
and organized operation.  Records  and on-site log books must be maintained
                                    514

-------
since they are essential  components  of  an organized facility,  and serve to
aid the manager  in  assessing  what  has and has not  been  done  and what pre-
cautions need to be taken.  These  records also  serve as  a permanent record
of activities  for new personnel and off-site personnel  including company
officials and government inspectors.  Finally, records must be kept of mon-
itoring activities  and  pertinent  data should be  maintained  throughout the
active life of the land treatment  unit.   Most of  these records can be kept
in a  log book  accompanied by  a  loose leaf  file  containing  lab reports,
inspection reports and similar  items.   A  checklist  of items  to be included
in the operating  record is  presented as  Table 8.14.   All reporting should
conform to the requirements of  40  CFR Parts  264  and 122 and any applicable
state regulations.

     Records to be kept at the  site  should include  a map showing the layout
of the land treatment units indicating the application rates for the wastes
disposed and the date and location where  each waste was applied and results
of waste analyses.  In addition, records  need to  be kept on the date,  loca-
tion, and code number of  all  monitoring samples  taken after waste applica-
tion.  These records will include  analyses of waste, soil, groundwater, and
leachate water from the unsaturated zone.  This  Information  may be needed
in case questions arise about the  operation of the  unit.  Efforts  to reveg-
etate the site may  also be documented.   This can be  done by recording the
date, rate and depth of planting,  species and variety planted, and the type
and  date  of  fertilizer   applications.   Measurements   of  emergence and
groundcover should be determined at  appropriate intervals and recorded.

     Although  climatic  records are  not  required by regulation,  they are
very  useful for  proper  management.   The amount  of  rainfall  should  be
measured  on-site and recorded  daily.  Additional climatic  data recorded
may  include  pan  evaporation,  air  temperature,  soil temperature  and soil
moisture.  When water is present in  the retention ponds,  the depth of  water
should be recorded at least weekly during a  wet  season.   These records are
easiest to use  if results are  graphed.   This allows visual interpretation
of  the  data  to  determine  important trends   that   influence  management
decisions.

     In  addition, all  accidents   involving  personal  injury  or  spills  of
hazardous wastes  are to be recorded  and remedial  actions  noted.  Any viola-
tions of  security  (i.e.,  entry of  unauthorized persons  or  animals) also
need to be  recorded.   Notes should  be  kept  on  all inspections, violations
and accidents.   They  should clearly  indicate the problem and the remedial
actions planned or taken.

     Another helpful management tool is  to  keep a balance  sheet for each
section of the unit that  receives  waste applications  indicating  the maximum
design loading  rate of each  of the rate limiting constituents and  those
within 25% of  being limiting,  as  well  as the maximum allowable  cumulative
load of the capacity limiting constituent.  As waste  applications  are  made,
the amount  of  each constituent added is  entered on  the balance  sheet and
subtracted from  the allowable  application to indicate the amount that can
be applied  in  future  applications.   A running account  of the capacity  of
each plot receiving waste is  a valuable  guide  to the optimum placement  so

                                    515

-------
TABLE 8.14  CHECKLIST OF ITEMS NEEDED FOR A THOROUGH RECORD OF OPERATIONS
            AT A LAND TREATMENT UNIT


 1.  Plot layout map

 2.  Inspections

     a.   weekly observations on levees and berms
     b.   observations of odor, excessive moisture, need for maintenance,
         etc.*

 3.  Waste applications
     a.   date
     b.   amount and rate
     c.   location

 4.  Waste analysis
     a.   original
     b.   quarterly waste analysis reports
     c.   any changes in application rate needed due to change in waste

 5.  Fertilizer and lime applications
     a.   date
     b.   amount
     c.   location

 6.  Vegetation efforts*
     a.   planting date
     b.   species planted
     c.   fertilizer applied
     d.   emergence date
     e.   groundcover

 7.   Monitoring sample analyses
     a.   soil samples
     b.   waste samples
     c.   groundwater samples
     d.   leachate samples
     e.   runoff samples
     f.   plant tissue samples*

8.   Climatic  parameters*
    a.   rainfall
    b.   pan evaporation
    c.   air  temperature
    d.   soil  temperature
    e.   soil  moisture

                              —cont inued—

                                    516

-------
TABLE 8.14  (continued)
 9.  Water depth in retention basins*

10.  Accidents
     a.  personal inj ury
     b.  amount and type of waste spilled
     c.  location

11.  Breaches of security

12.  Breaches of runoff retention resulting  in  uncontrolled  off-site
     transport

13.  Maintenance schedule
     a.  levees and berms
     b.  regrading of plots
     c.  grassed waterways
     d.  tilling activities
     e.  roads

* Not required by regulation but important  to  successful management of an
  HWLT unit.
                                     517

-------
that the cumulative capacity of all of the available soil is used.  Section
7.5  discusses  how  to determine  the  limiting constituents  of  the  waste
streams to be land treated.
                                   518

-------
                           CHAPTER 8 REFERENCES
ASAE. Terracing Committee. 1980. ASAE standard S268.2. pp. 522-525. In ASAE
Agricultural engineers yearbook, 1980-1981. Am, Sec. Agr. Etvgr.

Asmussen, L. E., A. W. White, Sr., E. W. Hauser, and J. M. Sheridan. 1977.
Reduction of 2,4-D load in surface runoff down a grassed waterway. J.
Environ. Qual. 6:159-162.

Austin, M. E. 1965. Land resource regions and major land resource areas of
the United States (exclusive of Alaska and Hawaii). Agriculture handbook
296. S.C.S., U.S.D.A. 82 p.

Barber, S. A. 1967. Liming materials and practices. Agron. 12:125-160.

Beasley, R. P. 1958. A new method of terracing. Missouri Agr. Exp. Stat.
Bull. 699.

Black, C. A. 1968. Soil-plant relationships. 2nd ed. John Wiley and Sons,
Inc., New York. 792 p.

Bonn, H. L., B. L. McNeal, and 6. A. O'Connor. 1979. Soil chemistry. John
Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York. 329 p.

Bouwer, H. and J. van Schilfgaarde. 1963. Simplified method  for predicting
fall of water table in drained land. Trans. Am. Soc. Agr. Engr. 6:288-291.

Brady, N. C..1974. The nature and properties of soils. 8th ed. MacMillan
Publ. Co., Inc. New York. 639 p*

Brown, K. W. and L. J. Thompson. 1976. Feasibility study  of  general  crust
management as a technique for increasing capacity  of dredged material
containment areas. Contract Report D-77. Texas A&M University, Research
Foundation. College Station, Texas.

Buckman, H. W. and N. C. Brady. 1960. The nature and properties of soils.
6th ed. MacMillan Publishing Co., Inc. New York.

Capp, J. P. 1978. Power plant fly ash utilization  for  land reclamation in
the Eastern United States, pp. 339-354. In F. W. Schaller and  P.  Button
(eds.) Reclamation of drastically disturbed lands. Am. Soc.  Agron. Madison,
Wisconsin.

Carlson, C. A., P. G. Hunt, and T. B. Delaney.  1974. Overland  flow treat-
ment of wastewater. Misc. Paper Y-74-3. U.S. Army  Engineer Waterways Exper-
iment Station. Vicksburg, Mississippi. 63 p.

Cassell, E. A., P. W. Meals» and J. R. Bouyoun. 1979.  Spray  application of
wastewater effluent in West Dover, Vermont - an initial  assessment.  U.S.
Army Corps of Engineers, Cold Regions Research  and Engineering Laboratory,
Hanover, New Hampshire. Special Report 76-6.

                                    519

-------
Chen, R. L. and W. H. Patrick. 1981. Efficiency of nitrogen removal in a
simulated overland flow wastewater treatment systems. J. Environ. Qual.,
10: 98-103.

Cheremisinoff, N. P., P. N. Cheremisinoff, F, Ellerbusch, and A. J. Perna.
1979. Industrial and hazardous waste impoundment. Ann Arbor Sci. Publ. Inc.
Ann Arbor, Michigan, pp. 257-280.

Chessmore, R. A. 1979. Profitable pasture management. Interstate Printers &
Publ. Danville, Illinois. 424 p.

Christensen, P. D. and P. J. Lyerly. 1954. Fields of cotton and other crops
as affected by applications of sulfuric acid in irrigation water. Soil Sci.
Soc. Am. Proc. 15:523-526.

Coleman, N. T. and G. W. Thomas. 1967. The basic chemistry of soil acidity.
Agron. 12:1-34.

Dickey, E. C. and D. H. Vanderholm. 1981. Vegetative filter treatment of
livestock feedlot runoff. J. Environ. Qual. 10: 279-284.

Dolon, W. P. 1975. Odor panels, pp. 75-82, Iii P. N. Cheremisinoff and R. A.
Young (eds.) Industrial odor technology assessment. Ann Arbor Science Publ.
Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Dravenieks, A. 1975. Threshold of smell measurement, pp. 27-44 In P. N.
Cheremisinoff and R. A. Young (eds.) Industrial odor technology assessment.
Ann Arbor Science Publ. Inc. Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Dummn, L. D. 1964. Transient flow concept in subsurface drainage: its
validity and use. Trans. Am. Soc. Agr. Engr. 7:142-146.

EPA. 1977. Process design manual for land treatment of municipal waste
water. EPA 625/1-27-008. PB 299-665/IBE.

EPA. 1979. Disposal to land. In Process design manual for sludge treatment
and disposal. EPA 625-1-79-011.

EPA. 1980a. Lining of waste impoundment and disposal facilities. U.S. EPA
SW-870.

EPA. 1980b. Identification and listing of hazardous waste. Federal Register
Vol. 45, No. 98,  pp. 33119-33133. May 19, 1980.

EPA. 1981. Hazardous waste management system; addition of general require-
ments for treatment, storage and disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol.
46, No. 7. pp. 2802-2897. January 12, 1981.

EPA. 1982. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol. 47, No. 43. pp. 32274-
32388. July 26, 1982.
                                    520

-------
Flemming, G. S. 1975. Computer simulation techniques in hydrology.
Elsevier Sci. Publ., Amsterdam.

Glover, R. E. 1964. Ground-water movement. U.S. Dept. Interior, Bur.
Reclam. Engr. Monogr. No. 31. 67 p.

Graham, E. H. 1941. Legumes for erosion control and wildlife. U.S.  Dept of
Agriculture. Misc. Pub. No. 412. 153 p.

Hafenrichter, A. L., J. L. Schwendiman, H. L. Harris, R. S. MacLauchlan,
and H. W. Miller. 1968. Grasses and legumes for soil conservation in the
Pacific Northwest and Great Basin States. U.S. Dept. of Agriculture.
Agriculture Handbook No. 339. Washington, D.C. 69 p.

Hanson, A. A. 1972. Grass varieties in the United States. U.S. Dept. of
Agriculture. Agricultural Handbook No. 170. Washington, D.C. 124 p.

Hatayama, H. K., J. J. Chen, E. R. de Vera, R. D. Stephens, and D. L.
Storm. 1980. A method for determining the compatibility of hazardous
wastes. EPA-600/2-80-076.

Heath, M. E., P. S. Metcalfe, and R. F. Barnes. 1973. Forages: the science
of grassland agriculture. Iowa  State University Press, Ames, Iowa. 755  p.

Herschfield, D. M.  1961. Rainfall  frequency  atlas of  the United States.
Engr.  Division, Soil Conserv. Serv., USDA. Washington, D.C.  Tech. Paper 40.
117 p.

Hillel, D.  1971. pp. 167-182 In_Groundwater  drainage. Academic Press,  New
York.

Hitchcock,  A.  S. 1950. Manual of  the grasses of  the United States. U.  S.
Dept.  of  Agriculture. Misc.  Pub.  No. 200.  Washington,  D.C. 1051  p.

Hoeppel,  R.  E., P.  G. Hunt  and  T.  B. Delaney. 1974. Wastewater treatment of
soils  of  low permeability.   U.S.  Army  Eng. Wasteways Expt. Sta.  Misc.  Paper
Y-74-2. Vicksburg,  Miss.  84 p.

Hooghaudt,  S.  B.  1937. Bijdregen  tot de  kennis van eenige  natuurkundige
grootheden  van den grand,  6.  Versl. Landb. Ond.  43:461-676.

Implement and  Tractor Red Book. 1979.  Implement  and Tractor Publications,
Inc.,  1014  Wyandotte,  St.,  Kansas City,  Missouri.

Jenkins,  T. F., D.  C.  Leggett,  C. J. Martel, and H. E.  Hare. 1981.  Overland
flow:  removal  of  toxic volatile organics. U.S. Army Cold Regions Research
and Engineering Laboratory. Special Report 81-1.  Hanover,  New Hampshire.
15 p.

Jenkins,  T. F. and A.  J. Palazzo. 1981.  Wastewater treatment by a prototype
slow  rate land treatment system.  U.S.  Army Cold Regions Research and
Engineering Laboratory.  Report 81-14.  Hanover, New Hampshire. 44 p.


                                     521

-------
 Kelling, K.  A.,  L.  M.  Walsh,  and A.  E.  Peterson.  1976.  Crop response to
 tank truck applications of  liquid sludge.  J.  Water Pollution Control
 Federation 48(9):2190-2197.

 Kirkham, D.,  S.  Toksoz, and R.  R. van der  Ploeg.  1974.  Steady flow to
 drains and wells, pp.  203-244.  In J.  van Schilfgaarde  (ed.) Drainage for
 agriculture.  Agron.  Monogr. No. 17. Am. Soc.  Agron., Madison, Wisconsin.

 Leithead,  H.  L.,  L.  L.  Yarlett, and T.  N.  Shiflet. 1971.  100 Native forage
 grasses in 11 southern states.  U.S. Dept.  of  Agriculture.  Agricultural
 Handbook No.  389. Washington, D.C. 216  p.

 Linsley, R. K., Jr., M. A. Kohler and J. L. H.  Paulhus.  1975. Hydrology for
 engineers. McGraw-Hill, Inc. New York.  482 p.

 Loehr,  R.  C., W. J.  Jewell, J.  D.  Novak, W. W.  Clarkson,  and G.  S.
 Friedman.  1979. Land application of wastes, Vol.  2. Van  Nostrand Reinhold
 Co.  New York. p. 305.

 Luthin,  J. N. 1957.  Drainage of irrigated  lands,  pp. 344-371. In J.  N.
 Luthin (ed.)  Drainage  of agricultural lands.  Am.  Soc. Agron., Madison,
 Wisconsin. 611 p.

 Martel,  C. J., T. F. Jenkins, C.  J. Diener, and P. L. Butler. 1982.
 Development of a rational design procedure for  overland  flow systems. U.S.
 Army Cold  Regions Research and  Engineering Laboratory. Report 82-2.
 Hanover, New  Hampshire. 29 p.

 Miyamato,  S., J. Ryan,  and J. L.  Stroehlein.  1975. Potentially beneficial
 uses  of  sulfuric acid in southwestern agriculture. J. Environ. Qual.
 4:431-437.

 Miyamato,  S.  and J.  L.  Stroehlein. 1974. Solubility of manganese,  iron,  and
 zinc  as  affected by application of sulfuric acid  to calcareous soils. Plant
 and  Soil 40:421-427.

 Moody, W. T.  1966. Nonlinear differential  equation of drain spacing.  Proc.
 Am.  Soc. Civil Engr., J.  Irrig.  Drain.  Div. 92(IR2):l-9.

 Myers, E. A.  1974. Sprinkler irrigation systems.  Design and operation cri-
 teria, pp. 299-309. In  Proc. Conf. on recycling treated municipal
 wastewater through forest and cropland.  EPA 660/2-74-003.  PB 236-313/3BA.

 Ness, L. D. and R. J. Ballard.  1979.  Land  application distribution  equip-
ment  alternatives. Paper presented at joint meeting of Am.  Soc.  of  Agr.
Engr. and Can. Soc. of  Agr. Engr. Univer.  of Manitoba, Winnipeg,  Canada.
June, 1979.

Nutter, W. L. and R. C.  Schultz.  1975.  Spray irrigation of  sewage effluent
on a steep forest slope.  I. Nitrate renovation. Agron. Abst.  Am.  Soc.
Agron.  Madison,  Wisconsin.
                                    522

-------
Overcash, M. R. and D. Pal. 1979. Design of land treatment systems for
industrial wastes - theory and practices. Ann Arbor Science Pub. Inc. Ann
Arbor, Michigan. 684 p.

Peech, M. 1965. Lime requirement. Agron. 9:927-932.

Perrier, E. R. and A. C. Gibson. 1980. Hydrologic simulation on solid waste
disposal sites (HSSWDS). Prepared for the U.S. EPA Municipal Environmental
Research Laboratory. SW-868.

Peters, R. E. and C. R. Lee. 1978. Field investigation of advanced
treatment of municipal wastewater by overland flow. Vol. II. p. 45-50. In
H. L. McKim (ed.) State of knowledge in land treatment of wastewater. U.S.
Army Cold Regions Research and Eng. Lab. Hanover, N. H.

Phung, T., L. Barker, D. Ross, and D. Bauer. 1978. Land cultivation of
industrial wastes and municipal solid wastes; state-of-the-art study, Vol.
1. Technical summary and literature review. EPA 600/2-78-140a. PB 287-
080/AS.

Pohlman, G. G. 1966. Effect of liming different soil layers on yield of
alfalfa and on root development and nodulation. Soil Sci. 34:145-160.

Pountney, P. J. and H. Turner. 1979. Hydrogen peroxide makes an excellent
sludge deodorant. Water & Wastes Engineering, September 1979. p. 56-59.

Powell, G. M., M. E. Jensen, and L. G. King. 1972. Optimizing surface
irrigation uniformity by nonuniform slopes. Paper presented at the 1972
Winter meeting of the ASAE. Chicago, Illinois.

Prather, R. J., J. 0. Goertzen, J. D. Rhoades, and H. Frenkel.  1978.
Efficient amendment use in sodic soil reclamation. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J.
42:782-786.

Ruffner, J. D. 1978. Plant performance on  surface  coal mine spoil in
Eastern United States. U. S. Dept. of Agriculture, SCS-TP-155. Washington,
D.C. 76 p.

Ryan, J., S. Miyamoto, and J. L. Stroehleln.  1975. Preliminary  evaluation
on methods of acid precipitation. Plant and Soil 41:11-13.

Ryan, J. and J. L. Stroehlein. 1979. Sulfuric acid treatment of calcareous
soils: effects on phosphorus solubility, inoranic  phosphorus forms and
plant growth. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J. 43:731-735.

Safaya, N. M. and M. K. Wall. 1979. Growth and nutrient relations of a
grass-legume mixture on sodic coal-mine  spoil as affected by some
amendments. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J. 43:747-753.

Schwab, G. 0., R. K. Frevert, K. K. Barnes, and T. W. Edminster.  1971.
Elementary soil and water engineering.  John Wiley  and Sons, New York.
316 p.

                                     523

-------
 Smith, J. L., D. B. McWhorter, and R. C. Ward. 1977. Continuous subsurface
 injection of liquid dairy manure. EPA-600/2-77-117. PB 272-350/OBE.

 Soil Conservation Service.  1958. Engineering handbook for soil
 conservationists in the Corn Belt. Agr. Handbook #135. U.S. Government
 Printing Office, Washington, B.C.

 Soil Conservation Service.  1972. National engineering handbook, Section 4,
 Hydrology. Chapter 10. U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington, D.C.

 Sopper, W. E. and L. T. Kardos. 1973. Vegetation responses to irrigation
 with treated municipal wastewater. pp. 271-294.  In Sopper, W. E. and L. T.
 Kardos (eds.) Recycling treated municipal wastewater and sewage through
 forest and cropland. Penn.  State Univ. Press. University Park,
 Pennsylvania.

 Strunk, W. G. 1979. Hydrogen peroxide treats diverse wastewaters.  Indus-
 trial Wastes, January-February, 1979. p. 32-35.

 Stubbendieck, J., S. L. Hatch, and K. J. Kjar. 1981. North American range
 plants. Natural Resources Enterprises, Lincoln, Nebraska. 468 p.

 Thomas, R. E., B. Bledsoe and K. Jackson. 1976. Overland flow treatment of
 raw wastewater with enhanced phosphorus removal. EPA-600/2-76-131, U.S.
 EPA, Washington, D.C.

 Thornburg, A. A. 1982. Plant materials for use on surface mined lands in
 arid and semi-arid regions. SCS-TP-157. EPA-600/7-79-134 .88 p.

 Thornwaite, C. W. 1948. An  approach toward a rational classification of
 climate. Geog. Rev. 38:55-94.

 Tisdale, S. L. and W. L. Nelson. 1975. Soil fertility and fertilizers. 3rd
 ed. MacMillan Publ. Co., New York.

 USDA. 1937. Range plant handbook. Washington, D.C.

 USDA. 1948. Grass: the yearbook of agriculture. Washington, D.C. 892 p.

 USDA. 1960. Plant hardiness zone map. Agricultural Research Service. USDA
 Misc.  Pub. No. 814.  Washington, D.C.

 USDA. 1973. Kentucky guide  for classification, use and vegetative treatment
 of surface mine spoil. Washington, D.C. 31 p.

Vallentine, J. F. 1971. Range development and improvements. Brigham Young
Univ. Press.  Provo, Utah. 516 p.

Van Arsdel, E. P. 1967. The nocturnal diffusion and transport of spores.
 Dhytopathology, 57(11):1221-1229.
                                    524

-------
Van Arsdel, E. P., E. C. Tullis, and J. D. Panzer. 1958. Movement of air in
a rice paddy as indicated by colored smoke. Plant Disease Reporter,
42(6):721-725.

van Schilfgaarde, J. 1963. Design of tile drainage for falling water
tables. Proc. Am. Soc. Civil Engr., J. Irrig. Drain. Div. 89(IR2):1-12.

van Schilfgaarde, J. 1965. Transient design of drainage systems. Proc. Am.
Soc. Civil Engr., J. Irrig. Drain. Div. 91(IR3):9-22.

van Schilfgaarde, J. 1974. Nonsteady flow to drains, p. 245-270. In J. van
Schilfgaarde (ed.) Drainage for agriculture. Agron. Monogr. No. 17. Am.
Soc. Agron., Madison, Wisconsin.

Wall, M. K. and F. M. Sandoval. 1975. Regional site factors and revegeta-
tion studies in western North Dakota, pp. 133-153. In M. K. Wali (ed.)
Practices and problems of land reclamation in western North America.  Uni-
versity of North Dakota Press. Grand Forks, North Dakota.

Warburton, D. J., J. N. Scarborough, D. L. Day, A. J. Muehling, S. E.  Cur-
tis, and A. H. Jensen. 1979. Evaluation of commercial products for odor
control and solids reduction of liquid swine manure. Paper presented at the
Illinois Livestock Waste Management Conference, March 6, 1979, Champaign,
Illinois.

Welch and Haferkamp. 1982. Seeding rangeland. Texas Agr. Exp.  Sta. B-1379.
10 p.

White, R. K., M. Y. Handy, and T. H. Short. 1975. Systems and  equipment for
disposal of organic wastes on soil. Ohio Agricultural Research and Develop-
ment Center. Res. Cir. 197.

Whiting, D. M. 1976. Use of climatic data in estimating storage days for
soils treatment systems. U.S. EPA, Ada, Oklahoma. EPA 600/2-76-250.
PB 263-597/7BE.

Wooding, H. N. and R. F. Shipp. 1979. Agricultural use and disposal of
septic tank sludge. In Pennsylvania information and recommendations for
farmers, septage haulers, municipal officials and regulatory agencies.
Pennsylvania State Univ. Coop. Ext. Serv. Spec. Circ. 257.

Yahia, T. A., S. Miyamota, and J. L. Stroehlein.  1975. Effect  of surface
applied sulfuric acid on water penetration into dry calcareous and sodic
soils. Soil Sci. Soc. Amer. Proc. 39:1201-1204.
                                    525

-------
 9.0                             CHAPTER  NINE

                                MONITORING
     A monitoring  program is an essential  component  at any land  treatment
unit,  and should be  planned to provide  assurance  of appropriate facility
design, act  as  a feedback loop to furnish  guidance on improving unit man-
agement,  and indicate the  rate at which the treatment  capacity  is being
approached.   Since many assumptions must  be  made in the design  of  a land
treatment unit,  monitoring  can be used to  verify whether the initial data
and  assumptions were correct  or  if   design or  operational  changes  are
needed.   Monitoring  cannot  be substituted  for careful  design based on the
fullest reasonable understanding of the effects of  applying hazardous waste
to the soil; however, for existing HWLT units (which must retrofit to com-
ply with  regulations), monitoring  can  provide much  of the data base needed
for demonstrating treatment.

     Figure  9.1  shows the  topics to be considered  when developing a moni-
toring program.   The program  must be  developed  to  provide  the following
assurances:

     (1)  that the waste being  applied does not  deviate significantly
          from the waste for which the unit was designed;
     (2)  that  waste constituents  are  not  leaching  from the  land
          treatment area in unacceptable concentrations;
     (3)  that  groundwater   is  not being adversely  affected  by  the
          migration of hazardous constituents of the waste(s); and
     (4)  that waste constituents will  not  create a food chain hazard
          if crops are harvested.

To accomplish these assurances the current regulations (EPA, 1982a) require
the following types of monitoring.

     (1)  Groundwater detection monitoring  to  determine  if  a leachate
          plume has reached  the  edge of the waste management area (40
          CFR 264.98).

     (2)  Groundwater compliance monitoring to determine if the facil-
          ity is complying  with groundwater  protection  standards  for
          hazardous constituents (40 CFR 264.99).

     (3)   Soil pH and concentration of  cadmium in the waste when cer-
          tain food-chain crops are  grown  on HWLTs where  cadmium is
          disposed (40 CFR 264.276).

     (4)   Unsaturated zone  including soil cores  and  soil-pore liquid
          monitoring  to  determine  if   hazardous   constituents  are
          migrating out  of the treatment zone (40  CFR 246.278).

     (5)   Waste  analysis  of  all  types  of  waste to  be  disposed at  the
          HWLT (40  CFR 264.13).
                                    526

-------
                               f HASTE
      TREATMENT ZONE
      CONCEPT (SECTION 9.1)
      ANALYTICAL
      CONSIDERATIONS
      (SECTION 9.2)
      STATISTICAL
      CONSIDERATIONS
      (SECTION 9,3)
      TYPES OF
      MONITORING
      (SECTION 9.4)
               r
POTENTIAL
  SITE
                                        DESIGN AND OPERATION
                                            CHAPTER EIGHT
C
                                            FINAL SITE
                                             SELECTION
   MONITORING
  CHAPTER NINE
                                       CONTINGENCY PLANNING
                                   AND ADDITIONAL CONSIDERATIONS
                                            CHAPTER TEN
Figure 9.1  Topics to be considered in developing a monitoring program
            for an HWLT unit.
                                    527

-------
 In   addition  to   these   required   types   of  monitoring,  other   types  of
 monitoring  may be  needed  in  a  thorough  monitoring  program  (Fig. 9.2).

      These  secondary monitoring components,  though  not specifically regu-
 lated are  important  to  successful land treatment.    For  instance,  to
 complete  the assurance that  no unacceptable human  health effect or environ-
 mental  damage  is  occurring,  air  emissions,  surface water  discharge  and
 worker exposure of hazardous constituents can be monitored.  The  treatment
 zone can be  monitored  to determine if  degradation  of waste  organics is
 progressing as planned and  whether adjustments in  unit  management  (e.g.,
 pH,  nutrients, tillage)  are needed  to  maintain the  treatment process, and
 to  gauge the rate  at which  the  capacity limiting  constituent  (CLC)  is
 accumulating in the  land  treatment  unit and at  what point  closure  should be
 initiated.    Any of  these components  could  be dropped from  the proposed
 monitoring  plan if treatment demonstrations show these types of monitoring
 are  not needed to  determine  the proper  performance of the  HWLT unit.
9.1                       TREATMENT ZONE CONCEPT
     As  is  depicted in Fig. 9.2,  the entire  land  treatment operation and
monitoring  program  revolves  about  a central component, the  treatment zone.
Concentrating on  the  treatment  zone is a useful approach to describing and
monitoring  a land  treatment system.   The treatment  zone  is the  soil to
which wastes are  applied  or incorporated; HWLT  units  are designed so that
degradation,  transformation and  immobilization of  hazardous constituents
and  their metabolites  occurs  within  this  zone.   In practice,  setting a
boundary  to the treatment zone  is difficult.   In choosing the boundaries of
the  treatment  zone soil  forming  processes and  the  associated  decrease in
biological  activity with depth should be  considered.   According  to soil
taxonomists, the  lower limit of a  soil  must  be set at  the  lower limit of
biologic  activity or  rooting of native perennial plants, typically about 1
to  2 m (USDA,  1975).   Since biological  degradation of  waste  organics is
often the primary objective in land treatment,  the lower  boundary of the
treatment zone  should  not exceed  the lower boundary of  the soil.  Current
land treatment  regulations  place  the lower limit of  the treatment zone at
1.5 m (EPA, 1982a).

     The  choice of  a  lower  boundary must be modified where  shallow ground-
water or  perched water can encroach  on this zone  and  thus  increase the
likelihood of contaminant leaching.  A distance of 1 m is the required min-
imum separation between the  bottom of the  treatment  zone and the seasonal
high water table  (EPA,  1982a).  From soil physics considerations, this sep-
aration is  necessary  because the  capillary fringe above  the water table,
resulting in elevated  soil  moisture content,  is often observed  to rise as
much as 50  to 75 cm.   A second  reason for aim separation is that the
height of the seasonal  high  water table is generally  an estimate based on
limited observation and there may be periods when  the saturated  zone is at
a higher elevation.
                                    528

-------
c
      DISCHARGE/
      RUNOFF
      (NPDES)
                                                WASTE
FOOD CHAIN CROPS
                                       UNSATURATED ZONE
        Figure 9.2.   Various types of monitoring for land treatment units.

-------
     A final  aspect  of  the  treatment zone that should be considered is the
rise  in  land surface elevation  which may result  from  the accumulation of
nondegradable waste  solids.  In  some cases, this  rise  can be significant
and  the  choice  must be  made whether  to  continually  redefine  the lower
treatment  zone boundary  or define  the  lower boundary  as a  static value
based on the original land surface  elevation.   The  latter  is the  logical
choice.    If  the  lower  boundary  were  continuously  redefined,  the waste
material  remaining below the redefined  boundary would  then  be considered
unacceptable  since  waste  consituents  must  be  degraded,  transformed  or
immobilized within the treatment zone.

     After considering  the  various aspects of the treatment zone, the gen-
eralized  definition  is  the zone  of  waste  and soil  in  which degradation,
transformation and/or immobilization occurs, extending no more  than 1.5 m
below the  original  land  surface and  separated  by at  least   1 m  from the
seasonal  high water table  (EPA,   1982a).    What constitutes  "complete"
treatment  varies  according to the specific hazardous constituent  and the
degree to  which  the constituent  and its  metabolites must be degraded or
immobilized to prevent both short  and long-term harm  to human  health or the
environment.  Where  data  are  available,  the  required  level of  treatment may
be  relatively  easy to   designate;  however,   if  data  are  lacking  or
inconclusive,  the desired  level  of  treatment  must  be  resolved   through
laboratory, greenhouse, and/or field  testing (Chapter 7).
9.2                      ANALYTICAL CONSIDERATIONS
     Certain  nonhazardous  waste  constituents  and/or   their  metabolites,
either singly or  in combination, are of  concern when managing land  treat-
ment facilities because  of their  effect  on treatment processes.   A sound
monitoring  program  should account  for  the potentially  harmful  effects of
all  waste  constituents.    Properly  designed   and  conducted  waste-site
interaction studies should indicate the existence of environmental hazards.
Nonhazardous  inorganic  constituents   that  are   significant   to  the   land
treatment  system  should  also  be  routinely  included  in the  monitoring
program.    These  unlisted  constituents  are  often  dealt  with  under  the
authority of State solid waste programs; therefore, facility permits  should
jointly address both  hazardous  and nonhazardous  constituents.   The  permit
officials and permit  applicants  should  both recognize that in many cases a
waste constituent, not regulated  as hazardous, will be the limiting  factor
(ALC,  RLC,  or  CLC)  in  facility  design.    Methods  for  determining  the
constituents  that  limit   the   amount   of  waste,   the  number  of  waste
applications, and the cumulative capacity  of  a  land  treatment  site  are
discussed in Section 7.5.
                                     530

-------
9.3                     STATISTICAL CONSIDERATIONS
     A monitoring plan  can be judged by its  ability to provide realistic,
unbiased data from which  valid  comparisons between the values of monitored
parameters  and  background  quality  can be  made.    The use  of statistical
principles  in the  monitoring design is therefore  fundamental to providing
the maximum amount of  relevant  information in the  most  efficient manner.
In general,  the  most common monitoring approach  compares  the sample means
of  two populations  assumed  to be  independent  and  normally distributed
(i.e., parameter values from a uniform area or individual location compared
with background, ambient  values).   It  is  suggested that the  land treatment
unit is designed and  operated such  that  no significant movement of hazard-
ous constituents occurs.   Thus, the null  hypothesis to be  tested is that
the population  means are equal (H:yj - y2> &-:Vl  f  V2^'  ^e keys to valid
comparison  between these  populations  are  the choice of sample size (number
of replications) and  the  use of random sampling.   Problems  arise in plan-
ning monitoring systems when one must decide how best  to meet the statisti-
cal requirements and  what balance  to  establish between the needed data and
economy of  design.   After defining the type  of  comparisons,  the choice of
test statistics  can be made.   The present  problem is well  suited  to the
"t" statistic, which  is in  fact generally  suggested  in  EPA monitoring guid-
ance and regulations  (40  CFR 264 Subpart F in EPA, 1982a).

     Often  the  difficulty  of  designing a  monitoring  plan  is in choosing
what is to  be measured, how replicate samples are to be  obtained, and how
many  replicates  are  needed.   Basically,  taking  replicate  samples  is in-
tended to provide a measure of  the  variability of the  sampled medium.  EPA
(1982b) provides methods  for developing a  statistical approach for  taking
and analyzing monitoring  samples.   One must be careful to avoid  interpret-
ing analytical errors as  actual differences  in the sampled media.  It is  a
good idea to  obtain  several samples In a  random fashion and  analyze  these
for the constituents of  concern.   For example,  samples  could be obtained
from monitoring wells or  soil-pore liquid samplers  at random times  over  a
period of several days, or  soil core samples  could be obtained from  several
random locations.   The number  of  samples taken  should depend on sampling
variability and may be  as few as three if  variability is  low.  Sample vari-
ability must  be  established for the media to  be  sampled  at  the HWLT  unit.
A good starting  point is  to obtain and  analyze  five replicate samples; if
the variance  is low  (e.g., 5-10% of  the  mean),  then  fewer  samples  would
suffice while a high  variance  (e.g.,  >25% of the  mean) indicates  that more
than five samples may be  needed.
9.4                         TYPES  OF  MONITORING
     As  discussed  earlier the monitoring program centers  around  the treat-
ment zone.   The required types of  monitoring for HWLT facilities  are  con-
tained in  the  EPA  (1982a) regulations and  are also listed in  Section  9.0.
The frequency  of sampling and the  parameters to be analyzed depend on the
characteristics  of the  waste being  disposed, the  physical  layout  of the


                                     531

-------
 unit,  and the surface and  subsurface characteristics of  the  site.  Table
 9.1  provides guidance  for  developing  an  operational  monitoring  program.
 Each of  the  types  of monitoring  are  discussed  below.


 9.A.I                        Waste Monitoring
     Waste  streams need to  be  routinely  sampled  and tested  to check  for
 changes  in  composition.   A detailed description of appropriate  waste  samp-
 ling  techniques,  tools, procedures,  and  safety  measures  is  presented in
 Section  5.3.2*1.   These procedures  should  be  followed during all waste sam-
 pling events.   Analytical  methods should follow established procedures  for
 the  given waste  described in Section  5.3.2 which  are  based  on  standard
 protocols.

     The  frequency at which  a waste needs  to be sampled and the parameters
 to be analyzed  depends greatly on the variables that  influence  the  quantity
 and quality of  the waste.  When waste  is generated in a batch,  as  would be
 expected  from an annual or biannual cleanout  of a  lagoon  or tank, the  waste
 should be fully characterized prior to each application.  When  the  waste is
 generated more  nearly continuously, samples  should  be collected  and  com-
 posited  based on a statistical design  over a period of time to  assure that
 that  the waste  Is of a uniform  quality.    For example,  wastes which  are
 generated continuously could be  sampled weekly or daily  on a flow  propor-
 tional basis  and  composited  and  analyzed quarterly  or monthly.   When no
 changes  have  been made In the operation of  the plant  or the  treatment of
 the waste which could significantly alter concentration of waste constitu-
 ents, the waste should, at a minimum,  be analyzed for (1)  the  constituents
 that  restrict the annual  application  rates (RLC)  and the allowable  cumula-
 tive  applications (CLC),  (2) the constituents  that   are  within 25% of  the
 level at  which  they would  be  limiting, and (3) all other  hazardous  constit-
 uents that have been  shown to be  present in  the waste in the Initial  waste
 characterization.  Since synergism and antagonism  as  well as unlisted  waste
 metabolites can create hazards  that cannot be described by chemical analy-
 sis alone,  routine mutagenlclty  testing  may  be performed (Section  5.3.2.4)
 if the treatment demonstration has  indicated a possible problem.   In  addi-
 tion, waste should be analyzed as soon as  possible after  a  change in opera-
 tions that could affect the waste characteristics.
9.4.2                   Unsaturated Zone Monitoring
     The unsaturated  zone  as  referred to In  this  document is described as
the layer of soil or parent material separating the bottom of  the  treatment
zone  (defined  earlier) and  the seasonal high water  table  or groundwater
table and is usually found to have a moisture  content  less than saturation.
In this zone, the movement of moisture may  often be relatively slow in re-
sponse to soil  properties  and prevailing climatic conditions; however, in
some locations, soils and waste management practices may lead  to periods of
heavy hydraulic loading which could  cause rapid downward  flux of  moisture.

                                    532

-------
         TABLE 9.1  GUIDANCE FOR AH OPERATIONAL MONITORING PROGRAM AT  HHLT  OMITS
         Media to be Monitored
                                           Purpose
                                        Sampling Frequency
                                               Number  of  Samples
                              Parameters  to be Analyzed
            Waste
                                    Quality Change
                             • Quarterly composites if continuous
                              stream;  each batch If Intermittent
                              generation.
                                                                                                           One
                                                                        At.least  rate  and  capacity
                                                                        limiting  constituents, plus
                                                                        those within 2SZ of  being
                                                                        Uniting, principal  hazardous
                                                                        constituents,  pH and EC.
            Soil cores   '         Determine slow movement      Quarterly
            (unsaturated Bone)    of hazardous constituents
                                                                         One composited from
                                                                         two per l.S ha (4 ac);
                                                                         minimum of 3 composited
                                                                         from 6 per uniform area.
                                                                        All hazardous  constituents  In
                                                                        the waste or the  principal
                                                                        hazardous constituents,
                                                                        metabolites of hazardous
                                                                        constituents,  and nonhazardous
                                                                        constituents of concern.
            Soil-pore liquid
            (unsaturated zone)
Determine highly mobile
constituents
Quarterly,  preferably  following
leachate generating  precipitation
snowmelt.
One composited from  two
samplers per  l.S ha
(4 ac); minimum of 3
composited from 6 per
uniform area.
All hazardous constituents In
the waste or the principal
hazardous constituents,
mobile metabolites of hazard-
ous constituents, and Impor-
tant mobile nonhazardous
constituents.
LO
CO
           Groundwater
                                  Determine mobile
                                  constituents
                             Semiannually
                                           Minimum of four sug-
                                           gested—one upgradlent,
                                           three dovngradient.
                            Hazardous constituents and
                            metabolites or select indi-
                            cators.
            Vegetation (If
            grown for food
            chain use)
Phytotoxlc and hazardous
transmitted constituents
(food chain hazards)
Annually or at harvests.
One per l.S ha (4 ac)
or three of processed
crop before sale.
Hazardous
and their
etals and organlcs
etabolites.
            Runoff water
                                  Soluble or suspended
                                  constituents
                             As required for NPDES permit.
                                           As permit requires,
                                           or one.
                            Discharge permit and back-
                            ground parameters plus
                            hazardous organic*.
            Soil in the
            treatment zone
Determine degradation,
pB, nutrients, and rate
and capacity limiting
constituents
Quarterly
7-10 composited to one
per l.S ha (4 ac).
            Air
                                  Personnel and population
                                  health hazards
                             Quarterly
                                                                                                          Five
                                                                       Participates (adsorbed
                                                                       hazardoua constituents) and
                                                                       hazardous volatile*.

-------
An unsaturated  zone monitoring plan should  be  developed for two purposes:
1) to detect  any  significant  movement  of hazardous constituents out of the
system and 2) to  furnish information for management decisions.  In light of
the variability in  soil water flux and the mobility of hazardous waste con-
stituents , the unsaturated zone monitoring plan should include  sampling the
soil to evaluate  relatively slow moving waste constituents (soil core moni-
toring) and sampling  the  soil-pore  liquid to evaluate rapidly moving waste
constituents.  Monitoring for hazardous constituents should be  performed on
a representative  background plot(s) until background levels are established
and  immediately below the  treatment zone  (active portion).   The number,
location, and depth of soil  core  and  soil-pore liquid  samples taken must
allow an  accurate indication of the quality of soil-pore  liquid  and soil
below the treatment zone and in the background  area.    The  frequency and
timing of soil-pore liquid  sampling must  be based on  the  frequency, time
and rate  of waste application,  proximity of the  treatment  zone to ground-
water,  soil   permeability,  and  amount  of  precipitation.   The data from
this program  must be sufficient to determine  if  statistically significant
increases in  hazardous constituents,  or selected  indicator constituents,
have occurred below the  treatment zone.   Location and  depth  of  soil core
and  soil-pore liquid  samples follow the  same reasoning, but  the number,
frequency  and  timing  of soil  core  sampling   differs  somewhat from that
required for  soil-pore liquid sampling.   Thus,  the unique aspects  of these
topics  will   be  considered  together with  discussions  of   techniques  for
obtaining the two types of samples.
9.4.2.1  Locating Unsaturated Zone Samples


     Soil  characteristics,  waste  type, and waste application  rate are all
important  factors  in determining  the  environmental  impact  of  a particular
land treatment unit or part of a unit  on the environment.  Therefore, areas
of  the land  treatment unit  for  which  these  characteristics  are similar
(i.e., uniform  areas)  should be sampled as  a  single monitoring  unit.   As
will be used  in further  discussions,  a uniform area  is  defined as an area
of  the active portion  of  a land treatment unit which is composed of soils
of  the same soil series  (USDA,  1975)  and to which  similar  wastes or waste
mixtures are applied at  similar application rates.   If, however, the tex-
ture of  the surface  soil differs  significantly  among  soils   of  the same
series classification, the  phase  classification of  the soil should be con-
sidered  in  defining  "uniform areas."    A  certified   professional  soil
scientist should be consulted in designating uniform  areas.

     Based on the above definition, it is  recommended that the location of
soil core  sampling or soil-pore  liquid  monitoring  devices  within a given
uniform area be  randomly  selected.   Random  selection of samples ensures  a
more accurate representation of conditions within a given uniform area.  It
is  convenient  to  spot the  field location  for  soil-coring  and soil-pore
liquid devices  by selecting  random distances on  a  coordinate system and
using the intersection of the two random distances as the location at which
a  soil core  should  be  taken  or  a  soil-pore  liquid   monitoring  device
installed.  This system works well for fields of both regular  and irregular

                                    534

-------
shape, since the points outside the area of  interest  are  merely discarded,
and only the points inside the area are used in the sample.

     The location, within a given uniform area of a land  treatment  unit
(i.e., active portion monitoring), at which  a  soil  core  should  be taken or
a soil-pore liquid monitoring  device  installed should be determined  using
the following procedure:

     (1)  Divide the land treatment unit into  uniform areas  under the
          direction of a certified professional soil scientist.
     (2)  Set up coordinates for each uniform area by establishing two
          base lines at right  angles  to  each other which intersect at
          an arbitrarily  selected origin,  for  example,  the  southwest
          corner.  Each baseline  should extend far enough for  all of
          the uniform area to fall within the quadrant.

     (3)  Establish a scale interval  along each base  line.   The units
          of this  scale may  be feet, yards,  meters, or other units
          depending on  the size  of  the uniform  area, but  both base
          lines should have the same units.
     (4)  Draw two random numbers from a random numbers table (usually
          available in  any basic  statistics  book).   Use these numbers
          to locate one point along each of  the base  lines.
     (5)  Locate the intersection of  two  lines drawn  perpendicular to
          the  base lines  through these  points.   This  intersection
          represents one  randomly selected location for collection of
          one  soil core,  or for  installation  of  one  soil-pore  liquid
          device.  If this location at the intersection is outside the
          uniform area, disregard and repeat the above procedure.

     (6)  For soil-core monitoring, repeat the  above  procedure  as many
          times as necessary to obtain the desired  number of locations
          within each  uniform area of the  land treatment unit.  This
          procedure for randomly  selecting locations  must be repeated
          for  each soil core  sampling  event but will  be needed only
          once in locating soil pore  liquid  monitoring devices.

     Locations  for monitoring on background areas  should also  be randomly
determined.   Again,  consult   a  certified  professional  soil  scientist  in
determining an acceptable background area.  The  background  area must  have
characteristics  (i.e., at  least  soil series  classification)  similar  to
those present  in  the  uniform area of the  land  treatment unit it is  repre-
senting, but  it should be  free  from possible contamination  from past  or
present  activities which could have  contributed to  the concentrations  of
the hazardous  constituents  of concern.   Establish  coordinates  for an arbi-
trarily  selected portion  of the background area and use  the  above procedure
'or randomly choosing  sampling locations.
                                     535

-------
 9.4.2.2   Depth to be Sampled


      Since unsaturated  zone monitoring  is  intended  to  detect  pollutant
 migration from  the  treatment zone,  samples  should logically  be  obtained
 from immediately  below  this zone.   Care  should  be taken  to  assure  that
 samples from  active  areas  of the  land treatment  unit and  background samples
 are  monitoring  similar horizons  or layers of parent material.   Noting  that
 soils seldom  consist of  smooth, horizontal  layers  but are often  undulating,
 sloped and sometimes discontinuous,  it would be unwise to specify  a single
 depth below  the land  surface  to  be  used for  comparative sampling.   A
 convenient method for choosing  sampling depths  is to  define the bottom  of
 the  treatment zone as the  bottom of a chosen diagnostic soil horizon and
 not  in terms  of  a rigid  depth.  Sampling depth would then be easily defined
 with respect  to  the  bottom of the treatment zone.   At a  minimum,  soil  core
 and  soil-pore liquid sampling should  monitor within 30  cm  (12  in) of the
 bottom of  the treatment  zone. Additional sampling depths may be  desirable,
 for  instance  if analytical results are inconclusive or questionable.   Core
 samples should  include only  the  0  to 15 cm  increment  below the  treatment
 zone while soil-pore liquid samplers should be  placed so  that they collect
 liquid from anywhere  within this  30  cm zone.
9.4.2.3  Soil Core Sampling Technique
     Waste constituents may move slowly  through  the soil  profile  for  a  num-
ber  of reasons,  such as  the lack  of  sufficient  soil  moisture to leach
through the system, a natural or artificially occurring layer  or  horizon  of
low hydraulic  conductivity, or waste constituents which exhibit  only a low
to moderate mobility  relative to  water in soil.  Any one or  a combination
of  these  effects can be  observed by  soil  core  monitoring.   Based on the
treatment zone concept, only  the portions of soil cores collected below the
treatment zone need to  be analyzed.    The intent is  to demonstrate whether
significantly  higher  concentrations  of  hazardous  constituents are present
and moving in material below  the treatment zone  than  in background soils  or
parent material.

     Soil core  sampling should proceed  according to  a definite  plan  with
regard to number, frequency and technique.  Previous  discussions  of statis-
tical considerations should provide guidance in  choosing  the number of  sam-
ples required.  Background values for  soil core  monitoring should be  estab-
lished by collecting  at  least eight randomly selected soil  cores for  each
soil series present in the treatment zone.  These samples can  be  composited
in pairs  (from Immediately  adjacent  locations)  to  form four samples for
analysis.  For each soil  series  a background arithmetic  mean and variance
should be  calculated  for each hazardous constituent.  For  monitoring the
active portion of the HWLT,  a minimum of six randomly selected  soil cores
should be obtained per uniform area and  composited as  before to yield three
samples for analysis.   If, however, a uniform area is  greater  than 5 ha (12
ac), at least  two randomly selected  soil cores   should be taken per 1.5  ha
(4 ac) and composited in pairs based on  location.  Data from the  samples  in

                                    536

-------
a given  uniform area should  be averaged  and  statistically compared.   If
analyses reveal a large  variance  from samples  within a given uniform area,
more samples may be necessary.  The frequency with which soil coring should
be  done  is at  least semiannually, except for background  sampling which,
after  background  values  are  established, may  be  performed   only occas-
sionally as  needed  to verify  whether background levels are changing over
t ime.

     It is important to keep an accurate record of the locations from which
soil core samples have been taken.  Even where areas have been judged to be
uniform, the best attempts  at  homogeneous  waste  application and management
cannot achieve  perfect  uniformity.   It is  probable in many  systems that
small problem areas or "hot  spots"  may occur which cause localized real or
apparent pollutant  migration.   Examples of  "apparent"  migration might in-
clude small areas where  waste  was  applied  too heavily or where the machin-
ery on-site mixed waste  too  deeply.   The sampling procedure Itself is sub-
ject to error and so may indicate apparent pollutant migration.  Therefore,
anomalous  data  points can  and should  be  resampled  at the  suspect loca-
tion(s)  to  determine if a  problem exists, even  if  the uniform  area as  a
whole shows no statistically significant pollutant migration.

     The methods  used  for  soil sampling are  variable and depend  partially
on  the size and depth of the sample needed and the number and  frequency of
samples to be taken.  Of the available equipment, oakfield augers  are use-
ful  if  small samples need  to  be  taken by  hand  while  bucket  augers give
larger samples.  Powered coring or drilling equipment, If available,  is  the
preferable  choice  since it  can rapidly sample  to the  desired depths  and
provide a clean, minimally  disturbed  sample  for  analysis.   Due to  the time
involved in  coring  to 1.5  m and sometimes  farther,  powered equipment  can
often be less costly than hand sampling.   In any  case, extreme  care must be
taken  to prevent  cross  contamination of  samples.    Loose soil  or waste
should be  scraped away  from the  surface  to prevent it from contaminating
samples collected from lower layers.   The  material removed  from  the  treat-
ment zone  portion of the borehole can  be  analyzed if desired, to  evaluate
conditions in  the  treatment zone.  It  is  advisable  to record  field  obser-
vations of  the  treatment zone  even if  no  analysis  is done.  Finally, bore
holes absolutely must be backfilled carefully  to  prevent hazardous constit-
uents from channelling down  the hole.  Native  soil compacted to about field
bulk density, clay  slurry or other  suitable  plug  material may be  used.

     Sample  handling,  preservation and shipment should follow a  chain of
custody procedure and a  defined preservation method  such as is  found in  EPA
(1982), Test Methods for Evaluating  Solid Waste, or  the analytical portion
of  this document  (Section 5.3).  If more sample  is collected than is needed
for analysis,  the  volume  should  be  reduced  by  either  the quartering  or
riffle technique.   (A riffle is a sample  splitting  device  designed for  use
with dried ground samples).

     The  analysis  of  soil  cores  must include  all  hazardous  constituents
which are  reasonably expected  to  leach or  the  principal hazardous constitu-
ents (PHCs)  which generally indicate hazardous  constituent movement (EPA,
I982a).


                                      537

-------
 9.4.2.4  Soil-Pore Liquid Sampling Technique


     Percolating  water  added to the soil  by  precipitation,  irrigation, or
 waste  applications may  pass through  the treatment  zone and  may rapidly
 transport  some mobile waste  constituents or  degradation products through
 the  unsaturated  zone to the  groundwater.  Soil-pore  liquid monitoring is
 intended  to detect these rapid  pulses of contaminants,  often immediately
 after  heavy  precipitation  events,  that  are  not  likely  to  be  observed
 through  the regularly  scheduled  analysis of  soil  cores.   Therefore, the
 timing  of  soil-pore  liquid  sampling  is  a key  to  the usefulness  of  this
 technique.   Seasonality is  the rule  with soil-pore  liquid sample  timing
 (i.e., scheduled  sampling cannot be on a preset  date,  but must be geared to
 precipitation events).  Assuming that  sampling is done soon  after leachate-
 generating  precipitation or  snowmelt,  the frequency  also varies depending
 on site conditions.   As  a starting  point, sampling  should be done quarter-
 ly.  More frequent sampling may be necessary, for example, at units located
 in areas with  highly  permeable  soils or high  rainfall,  or  at which  wastes
 are  applied very  frequently.  The  timing  of  sampling should  be  geared to
 the waste application schedule as much as possible.

     Land treatment units at which wastes are  applied infrequently  (i.e.,
 only once  or twice a year)  or where  leachate-generating precipitation is
 highly seasonal,  quarterly sampling and analysis of soil-pore liquid  may be
 unnecessary.   Because soil-pore liquid  is instituted primarily  to  detect
 fast-moving  hazardous constituents, monitoring  for  these constituents  many
 months  after waste application may  be useless.  If  fast-moving hazardous
 constituents are  to  migrate  out of  the  treatment zone,  they will usually
 migrate at  least  within  90 days  following waste application, unless  little
 precipitation  or   snowmelt  has  occurred.    Therefore,   where  wastes are
 applied infrequently  or  leachate generation is  seasonal, soil-pore  liquid
 may be monitored  less frequently (semi-annually  or annually).  A final note
 about timing is that  samples should  be obtained as  soon  as liquid is  pres-
 ent.   Following   any  significant  rainfall, snowmelt or  waste application,
 the  owner  or operator should  check the  monitoring  devices  for  liquid at
 least within 24 hours.

     The background concentrations  of  hazardous constituents  in  the  soil-
 pore liquid  should  be established by  installing two  monitoring devices at
 random  locations   for each  soil  series   present  in  the treatment   zone.
 Samples should be taken on at least a  quarterly  basis  for at  least one year
 and can be  composited to give one  sample per quarter.   Analysis  of  these
 samples should be used to calculate  an  arithmetic  mean and  variance for
each hazardous constituents.   After  background values are established,
additional soil-pore  liquid samples  should occasionally  be taken to  deter-
mine if the background values are changing over  time.

     The number of soil-pore  liquid samplers needed is  a function of  site
factors that influence  the  variability of leachate quality.  Active,  uni-
form areas should receive, in the beginning,  a minimum of six samplers per
uniform area.  For uniform areas  greater  than 5 ha,  at  least two samplers
per 1,5 ha  should be  installed.   Samples  may  be composited  in pairs  based

                                    538

-------
on location to give three samples for analysis.  The  number  of  devices may
have  to  be adjusted  up  (or  down)  as  a  function  of  the  variability  of
results.

     To date,  most leachate collection has been conducted by scientists and
researchers and there is not an  abundance  of  available field equipment and
techniques.   The EPA  (1977)  and Wilson  (1980) have prepared reviews  of
pressure vacuum  lysimeters and  trench  lysimeters.    The pressure  vacuum
lysimeters are much better adapted to field use and have been used to moni-
tor pollution from various sources (Manbeck, 1975);  Nassau-Suffolk Research
Task Group, 1969;  The  Resources  Agency of  California,  1963;  James,  1974).
These pressure vacuum  samplers  are readily available  commercially and are
the most widely used, both  for  agricultural and waste monitoring  uses.   A
third type of leachate sampler is the vacuum extractor as used in the field
by Smith et al.  (1977).   A comparison of in  situ extractors  was  presented
by Levin and Jackson (1977).
9.4.2.4.1   Pressure-Vacuum  Lysimeters.    Construction,  installation,  and
sampling procedures for pressure-vacuum  lysimeters  are  described by Grover
and  Lamborn  (1970),  Parizek and  Lane   (1970),  Wagner  (1962),  Wengel  and
Griff en (1971) and Wood (1973).   Some data indicate  that the ceramic cups
may contribute excessive amounts of Ca, Na, and K to the  sample and may re-
move P  from  the sample  (Grover and  Lamborn,  1970);  however,  more recent
work (Silkworth  and  Grigal,  1981) comparing  ceramic samplers  with inert
fritted glass samplers showed no significant differences  in Ca, Na, Mg, and
K concentrations.  No studies as yet  have  been done on the permeability of
ceramic samplers to organic samplers.  Recent data by Brown (1977) indicate
that ceramics  are  permeable to  some bacteria,  while Dazzo  and Rothwell
(1974) found ceramic with a pore size of 3-8    m screened out bacteria.  A
special design  (Wood, 1973) is  needed  if  samples  are  to be  collected at
depths greater than 10 m below the soil  surface.  The basic construction of
these devices  is shown in  Fig.  9.3  and consists of a porous ceramic cup
with a bubbling  pressure of  1  bar or greater attached  to a  short piece of
PVC  pipe of  suitable diameter.  Two  tubes extend down into  the device as
illustrated.  Data by Silkworth and Grigal (1981) indicate that,  of  the two
commercially available sampler  sizes  (2.2  and 4.8 cm diameter),  the larger
ceramic cup  sampler is more  reliable,  influences water  quality less, and
yields samples of suitable volume  for analysis.

     Detailed installation instructions  for  pressure-vacuum lysimeters are
given by Parizek and  Lane  (1970).  Significant  modification may be neces-
sary to adapt these instruments to field use where heavy  equipment  is work-
ing.  To prevent channelling of contaminated surface water directly to the
sampling device, the  sampler may be installed in the  side wall of an access
trench.  Since random placement procedures may locate a sampler  in  the mid-
dle  of  an  active area, the  sample collection tube should  be protected at
the surface from heavy equipment by a manhole cover,  brightly  painted steel
cage or other  structure.    Another  problem  associated  with  such  sampler
placement is that its presence may alter waste management activities  (i.e.,
waste applications, tilling,  etc.  will  avoid the location); therefore, the
sampler would not yield representative leachate samples.   This  problem may

                                    539

-------
           f .2
            1-
                                        TUBING  TO SURFACE

                                        CONNECTORS

                                        PIPE-THREAD  SEALANT

                                        PVC  PIPE  CAP

                                        PVC   PIPE


                                        PVC  CEMENT

                                        POLYETHYLENE  TU8INO
                                         BRANCH  "T"
                                         FEMALE  ELBOW
                                         POPPET  CHECK VALVE
                                         CONNECTORS
                                         EPOXY  CEMCNT
                                         POLYETHYLENE  TUIIN9
                                         POROUS  CUP
Figure 9.3.  One example of a pressure-vacuum lyaimeter  (Wood, 1973).
            Reprinted by permission of the American Geophysical Union.
                               540

-------
be avoided  by running the  collection  tube horizontally  underground  about
10 m before surfacing.

     For sampling  after  the unit  is  in place, a  vacuum is placed on the
system and the tubes are clamped off.  Surrounding soil water is drawn into
the ceramic cup and up the polyethylene tube.  To collect the water sample,
the vacuum is  released and  one  tube is placed in a  sample  container.   Air
pressure is applied to the  other  tube  which forces  the  liquid  up the tube
and  into  the  sample  container.   Preliminary  testing should  ensure  that
waste products  can pass  into  the  ceramic  cup.  An inert tubing  such as
Teflon may need  to  be substituted for the  polyethylene  to prevent organic
contamination.  Where sampling  for possible volatiles in leachate, a purge
trap such as suggested by Wood  et  al.  (1981)  or as described for volatiles
in the waste analysis section (5.3.2.3.2.2) of this  document may be used.

     The major advantages  of  these  sampling  devices  are  that  they are
easily available, relatively inexpensive to purchase and  install, and quite
reliable.  The major disadvantage  is the potential for water quality alter-
ations due to  the  ceramic cup,  and this  possible  problem requires further
testing.   For a given  installation,  the  device  chosen  should be specif-
ically tested using solutions containing the soluble hazardous  constituents
of the  waste  to  be land  treated.  Several  testing  programs  to evaluate
these devices  are currently in progress,  including  programs  sponsored by
the  U.S.  Environmental  Protection  Agency  and  the  American  Petroleum
Institute.
9.4.2.4.2  Vacuum Extractor.   Vacuum extractors were developed by Duke  and
Haise  (1973)  to extract moisture  from soils above  the groundwater  table.
The basic device consists of a stainless steel  trough that  contains  ceramic
tubes packed in soil.  The unit is sized not to interfere with  ambient soil
water potentials (Corey, 1974), and  it is installed  at  a given  depth in  the
soil with a slight slope toward the  collection  bottle which is in the bot-
tom of an adjacent access hole.  The system is  evacuated and moisture moved
from adjacent  soil  into the ceramic tubes and  into the collection  bottle
from which it-can be withdrawn as desired.  The advantage of this system is
that it yields a quantitative estimate of leachate flux as  well as provides
a water  sample for analysis.   The  volume  of   collected  leachate  per unit
area per  unit  time  is an  estimate  of  the  downward movement  of leachate
water at  that  depth.   The major  disadvantages  to this system  are:   it  is
delicate,  requires a  field  vacuum source,  is  relatively  difficult   to
install, requires a trained  operator,  estimates leachate quantity somewhat
lower than actual field  drainage,  and disturbs  the  soil above  the sampler.
Further details about  the use of the vacuum extractor are given by Trout et
al.  (1975).    Performance  of  this   type  device  is  generally  poor when
installed in clay soils.
9.4.2.4.3   Trench Lysimeters.   Trench lysimeters get  their name from  the
large access trench or  caisson  necessary  for  operation.   Basic  installation
as described by  Parizek and Lane (1970) involves excavating a  rather  large
trench  and shoring up  the  side walls, taking care to  leave open areas  so

                                     541

-------
 that  samplers can be placed in the side  walls.   Sample trays are  imbedded
 in the  side walls and connected by tubing to  sample  collection  containers.
 The entire trench area is then covered  to  prevent flooding.  One  signifi-
 cant  danger  in  using  this  system is  the  potential  for  accumulation  of
 hazardous  fumes  in the trench which may  endanger  the health and safety  of
 the person collecting  the samples.

      Trench lysimeters function by intercepting downward  moving water and
 diverting  it  into a collection device  located at a lower elevation.   Thus,
 the intercepting  agent may be an  open  ended pipe,  sheet metal trough,  pan,
 or other similar  device.   Pans 0.9  to  1.2 m in diameter have been  success-
 fully used in the field by Tyler  and Thomas (1977).   Since  there is no va-
 cuum  applied  to  the system,  only  free water  in  excess of saturation  is
 sampled.   Consequently, samples are plentiful during rainy  seasons but are
 nonexistent during the dry season.

      Another  variation of this system  is to use a funnel filled with  clean
 sand  inserted into the sidewall of  the  trench.  Freewater will drain into a
 collection chamber from which a  sample  is  periodically removed by vacuum.
 A  small sample  collection device  such  as  this may  be preferable  to the
 large trench  since the necessary  hole  is smaller,  thus making installation
 easier  (Fig 9.4).
9.4.2.5  Response to Detection of Pollutant Migration
     If  significant  concentrations  of hazardous constituents (or PHCs)  are
observed  below the  treatment zone,  the  following modifications  to  unit
operations  should  be considered  to  maximize treatment within the treatment
zone:

     (1)  alter the  waste characteristics;

     (2)  reduce waste application  rate;

     (3)  alter the  method or timing  of waste applications;
     (4)  cease application  of one or  more particular  wastes  at  the
          unit;

     (5)  revise cultivation or management  practices; and

     (6)  alter the  characteristics of the  treatment zone, particular-
          ly soil pH or organic matter content.

Hazardous constituents  movement  below the  treatment zone may  result  from
improper  unit  design,  operation,  or siting.    Problems  related  to  unit
design and  operation can  often be easily corrected, while serious  problems
resulting  from a  poor  choice  of  site  are  more  difficult  to   rectify.
Certain  locational  "imperfections"  may be  compensated  for through  careful
unit design, construction, and operation.
                                     542

-------
  SOIL SURFACE
                                                         VACUUM
                                                         SOURCE
Figure 9.4.   Schematic diagram of a sand filled funnel used to collect
             leachate from the unsaturated zone.
                                543

-------
      If  statistically significant  increases  of hazardous constituents  are
 detected below the treatment  zone  by the unsaturated zone monitoring  pro-
 gram,  the owner or operator  should closely evaluate the operation,  design
 and location of the unit  to determine the source  of  the  problem.   The char-
 acteristics  of  the waste  should  be  evaluated  for  possible effects  on  treat-
 ment effectiveness.    The rate, method,  and timing  of  waste  applications
 should also  be  examined.   Management of the treatment zone including main-
 taining  the  physical,  chemical and  biological characteristics necessary for
 effective treatment,  should   also  be  reevaluated.    Soil  pH  and organic
 matter  content  of  the treatment  zone  are two  important  parameters  that
 should be assessed.   Finally,  the owner or operator  should determine  if the
 design or location of  the unit is causing the hazardous  constituents  to mi-
 grate.    Topographic,  hydrogeologic,  pedalogic,  and climatic  factors  all
 play a role  in  determining the success  of the land treatment system.

     In  certain cases, the necessary unit modifications may be very  minor,
 while  in other  cases  they may  be  major.   Numerous unit-specific factors
 must be  considered to make this determination,  and  the exact elements  of
 the determination  will vary  on a case-by-case basis.  Activities  occurring
 near the  unit should  be carefully investigated  to confirm the source  of the
 contamination.   The procedures used  in  the unsaturated zone monitoring  pro-
 gram should  also be closely examined.   Resampling  of the unit may  be  re-
 quired to determine if errors occurred  in  sampling,  analysis, or evalua-
 tion.
9.4.3                     Groundwater Monitoring
     To  assure that  irreparable groundwater  damage does  not occur  as a
result of HWLT, it  is  necessary that the groundwater quality be monitored.
Groundwater monitoring supplements the unsaturated zone monitoring  program,
but  does  not replace  it.   A contamination  problem first  detected in  the
leachate water  may  indicate the need  to alter  the  management program  and
groundwater can then  be  observed for the same problem.   It is through  the
successful  combination of  these two systems  that  accurate  monitoring  of
vertically moving constituents  can be achieved.

     The complexity of groundwater monitoring is  beyond  the scope of this
document, and the reader is referred to  a few of the numerous publications
which together  cover  much of what is  to be known about  the  topic.  These
sources of information include  the following:

     (1)  Manual  of Ground-Water  Sample Procedures,  (Scalf  et  al.,
          1981);
     (2)  Ground-Water Manual,  (USDI, Bureau of  Reclamation,  1977);

     (3)  Procedures Manual for  Ground Water Monitoring at  Solid Waste
          Disposal Facilities (EPA,  1977); and

     (4)  Ground-water Monitoring Systems, Technical Resource Document
          (EPA, in preparation); and
                                     544

-------
      (5)  Ground-water Monitoring Guidance for Owners and Operators of
          Interim Status Facilities, (EPA, 1982c).

In general,  the  success  of a groundwater monitoring  program is a function
of many site-, soil-  and waste-specific variables.   The various aspects of
planning and  developing  an appropriate groundwater monitoring  program are
interdependent and  thus, design  and  development  should be performed simul-
taneously.  Mindful of these  points,  the  following  is a general outline of
the major steps and considerations in establishing a  groundwater monitoring
program:

      (1)  develop an  understanding of  the potentially mobile constit-
          uents in the waste  to be land treated and their possible re-
          actions and behavior in groundwater, compatability with well
          casing and sampling equipment, and toxicity;

      (2)  perform a thorough  hydrogeologic study of the land treatment
          site;

      (3)  choose well drilling, installation and sampling methods that
          are compatible with monitoring needs;

      (4)  locate wells based  on  hydrogeologic  study  results, but sam-
          ple and analyze  wells  one by  one  as they  are  installed to
          help guide the placement of subsequent wells; and
      (5)  begin sampling and  analytical program.

     The wells  should be  placed  to  characterize background water quality
and to  detect any  pollutant  plume  which leaves  the  site.   The number of
wells needed will vary from site  to  site  based on local conditions.  Wells
should  be  sealed against  tampering  and protected from vehicular traffic.
Finally, the  frequency of  sampling  should  be at least  semi-annually for
detection monitoring and at least quarterly for compliance monitoring (EPA,
1982a).
9.4.4                      Vegetation Monitoring


     Where food chain crops are  to  be  grown,  analysis of the vegetation  at
the HWLT  unit will aid  in assuring that  harmful quantities  of  metals  or
other  waste   constituents  are not  being  accumulated  by,  or  adhering  to
surfaces  of,  the  plants.  Although a  safety  demonstration before planting
is required  (EPA,  1982a),  operational monitoring  is  recommended  to verify
that  crop contamination has  not  occurred.   Vegetation monitoring  is  an
important measurement  during the  post closure  period where  the area may
possibly  be  used  for  food or forage  production.   Sampling  should be  done
annually, or at each harvest.  The  concentrations of metals and  other  con-
stituents in the vegetation  will change  with moisture  content, stage  of
growth, and  the part of  the  plant sampled, and thus  results must be care-
fully  interpreted.  The  number  of  samples to analyze is again based on a
sliding scale similar to  that   used  for   sampling  soils.   Forage samples
                                     545

-------
 should  include  all  aerial  plant  parts,  and  the  edible parts  of  grain,
 fruit,  or  vegetation  crops  should  be  sampled separately.
 9.4.5                      Runoff Water  Monitoring
      If  runoff water  analyses are  needed  to satisfy  NPDES permit  condi-
 tions (EPA,  1981),  a monitoring program  should be  instituted.   This  program
 would not  be  covered under RCRA hazardous waste  land  disposal  requirements,
 but  it would  be  an integral  part of facility  design.   The  sampling  and
 monitoring approach will vary  depending  on whether the  water is  released as
 a  continuous  discharge or  as a  batch  discharge following  treatment  to
 reduce the hazardous  nature of the water.    Constituents  to  be analyzed
 should be  specified in the NPDES permit.

      Where a relatively continuous  flow is  anticipated,  sampling must  be
 flow  proportional.   A means of flow measurement and an automated sampling
 device are a  reasonable combination for  this type of monitoring.  Flow  can
 be measured using a weir or  flume  (USDA,  1979) for overload  flow water pre-
 treatment  systems  and  packaged water treatment  plants  while  in-line flow
 measurement may be  an  additional  option on the packaged treatment systems.
 The sampling  device should be  set  up  to  obtain periodic grab samples  as  the
 water passes  through the flow  rate measuring device.  A number  of program-
 able,  automated samplers which can  take  discreet  or composite  samples  are
 on the market  and readily available.

      For batch treatment,  such as mere  gravity  separation or mechanically
 aerated systems, flow  is not so important as  is the hazardous  constituent
 content  of each batch.  Sampling before discharge  would,  in  this case,
 involve  manual pond sampling,  using multiple grab  samples.   The  samples
 would preferably represent the entire water  column to be discharged  in each
 batch rather  than a single  depth  increment.   Statistical procedures  should
 again be used  for either treatment and discharge approach.
9.4.6                    Treatment Zone Monitoring
     Treatment  zone  monitoring of  land  treatment units  is  needed for  two
purposes.   One  main purpose  is  to  monitor the  degradation  rate  of  the
organic fraction of  the waste material and parameters significantly affect-
ing waste treatment.  Samples are needed at  periodic intervals  after  appli-
cation  to  be  analyzed  for  residual waste  or waste  constituents.    Such
measurements need  to be  taken routinely as  specified  by a soil  scientist.
These  intervals may  vary from weekly to  semi-annually depending  on  the
nature of the waste,  climatic conditions,  and application scheduling.   The
second major function of  treatment  zone samples is to  measure the rate  of
accumulation of conserved  waste  constituents  as  it  relates  to facility
life.
                                      546

-------
9.4.6.1  Sampling Procedures
     In order to monitor the treatment zone, a representative sample or set
of soil samples must  be  collected.   Since all further  analysis,  data, and
Interpretation are based on  the  sample(s)  collected,  the importance of ob-
taining a representative sample  cannot  be  over-emphasized.   Some  of the
needed samples may be  obtained from soil  cores  taken  from unsaturated zone
monitoring, but additional samples  are often desirable.   The total area to
be sampled should be  first observed for  its overall condition (i.e., waste
application records, soil series, management techniques, soil color, mois-
ture,  vegetation  type  and  vigor,  etc.)  and those  areas  having obvious
differences need to be sampled separately.  Where possible, sampling should
most conveniently coincide with the "uniform areas" used in the unsaturated
zone monitoring, but some deviation may be necessary.   Uniform areas should
be divided into 1.5 ha (4 ac) subsections.  When sampling, care needs to be
taken  to  avoid depressions, odd  looking  areas,  wet spots,  former fence
rows, and edges of the field.  Surface litter should not be included in the
samples.  Compositing  of  samples, when necessary,  should  be done in large
inert containers, and subsampling of the mix should be done by the quarter-
ing technique or with a riffle subsampler.

     Background soils should be sampled to the extent of the  defined verti-
cal treatment  zone,  while sampling an  area that has  had waste  previously
applied need extend only to  about 15 cm below the depth  of waste  incorpora-
tion.   If the  waste is mixed  poorly or  not at  all,  the  soil  and waste
should be mixed manually to  the approximate expected depth of incorporation
prior  to  sampling.    Notes   should  be  taken  as  to how  well the waste is
incorporated  at the  time of  sampling.    Plots  that  have  had  subsurface
injections should be sampled by excavating a trench 10 to  20  cm wide and as
long as the spacing between  bands,  perpendicular to the  line  of application
and to a depth of 15 cm below the depth of incorporation.  Useful equipment
may include shovel, post hole digger, oakfield auger or  bucket auger.


9.4.6.2  Scheduling and Number of Soil Samples


     The sampling schedule and number of samples  to be collected  may depend
on management  factors,  but  a schedule may  be conveniently chosen to  coin-
cide with unsaturated  zone  soil  core sampling.   For  systems which will be
loaded heavily  in a  short  period, more  (and more frequent)   samples may be
needed to  assure  that the waste  is being applied  uniformly, and that  the
system  is not  being overloaded.   About  seven  to ten  samples  from  each
selected  1.5  ha (4  ac) area  should be  taken  to  represent  the  treatment
zone, and  these should be composited to obtain  a single sample  for analy-
sis.   In addition,  if there  are  evidently anomalous  "hot  spots,"  these
should be sampled and analyzed separately.
                                     547

-------
9.4.6.3  Analysis and Use of Results


     Parameters  to  be measured  include  pH,  soil fertility,  residual con-
centrations of degradable rate limiting constituents (RLC), and the concen-
trations of residuals which limit the life of the disposal site (CLC), plus
those  which if  increased  in concentration  by  25% would  become limiting.
Hazardous constituents of  concern  should also be monitored.   Based on the
data obtained, the facility management or design can be adjusted or actions
taken  as  needed to maintain  treatment  efficiency.   Projections regarding
facility life can also be made and compared to original design projections.
Since the treatment zone acts as an integrator of all effects, the data can
be Invaluable to the unit operator.


9.4.7                         Air Monitoring
     The need  for  air montitoring at a  land treatment unit  is  not neces-
sarily dictated  only  by the chemical characteristics  of the  waste.   Wind
dispersal of particulates can mobilize  even the most immobile, nonvolatile
hazardous constituents.  Therefore, it is suggested that land  treatment air
emissions  be monitored  at   frequent  intervals  to ensure  the health and
safety of workers  and adjacent  residents.   This effort may  be  relaxed if
the air  emissions  are positively identified as  innocuous  compounds or too
low in concentration  to have any effect.  In any  case,  although  air moni-
toring is not currently required,  it  is  strongly suggested since  this is a
likely pathway for pollutant losses from a land treatment unit.

     Sampling generally involves  drawing air over a known surface area, at
a known flow rate for a specified time interval.  Low molecular weight vol-
atiles may be trapped by solid sorbents,  such  as Tenax-GC.   The high mole-
cular weight compounds may be sampled by Florisil, glass fiber filters, or
polyurethane foam.
                                    548

-------
                           CHAPTER 9 REFERENCES
Brown, K. W. 1977. Accumulation and passage of pollutants  in domestic
septic tank disposal fields. Draft report to Robert S.  Kerr, Environ.
Research Lab. EPA.

Corey, P. R. 1974. Soil water monitoring. Unpublished report to Dept.  of
Agr. Eng. Colorado State Univ. Ft. Collins, Colorado.

Dazzo, F. B. and D. F. Rothwell. 1974. Evaluation of procelain cup water
samplers for bacteriological sampling. Applied Micro. 27:1172-1174.

Duke, H. R. and H. R. Haise. 1973. Vacuum Extractors to assess deep perco-
lation losses and chemical constituents of soil water.  Soil Sci. Soc.   Am.
Proc. 37:963-4.

EPA. 1977. Procedures manual for groundwater monitoring at solid waste
disposal facilities. U.S. EPA Office of Solid Waste. SW-616.

EPA. 1980. Hazardous waste management systems; identification and listing
of hazardous waste. Federal Register Vol. 45, No. 98, pp.33084-33133.  May
19, 1980.

EPA. 1981. Criteria and standards for the national pollutant discharge
elimination system.  Title 40 Code of Federal Regulations  Part 125. U.S.
Government Printing Office. Washington, D.C.

EPA. 1982a. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol. 47, No. 143. pp.
32274-32388. July 26, 1982.

EPA. 1982b. Test methods for evaluating solid waste. U.S.  EPA, Office of
Solid Waste. Washington, D.C. SW-846.

EPA. 1982c. Ground-water monitoring guidance for owners and operators of
interim status facilities. U.S. EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency
Response. Washington, D.C. SW-963.

Grover, B. L. and R. E. Lamborn. 1970. Preparation of porous ceramic cups
to be used for extraction of soil water having low solute concentrations.
Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 34:706-708.

James, T. E. 1974. Colliery spoil heaps, pp. 252-255. In_ J. A. Coler (ed.)
Groundwater pollution in Europe. Water Information Center. Port Washington,
New York.

Levin M. J. and D. R. Jackson.  1977. A comparison of in situ extractors for
sampling soil water. Soil Sci.  Soc. Amer. J. 41:535-536.

Manbeck. D. M. 1975. Presence of nitrates around home waste disposal sites.
Annual meeting preprint Paper No. 75-2066. Am. Soc. Agr. Engr.

                                     549

-------
 Nassau-Suffolk Research Task Group.  1969. Final  report of the Long Island
 groundwater  pollution  study. New York State Dept. of Health. Albany, New
 York.

 Parizek, R.  R. and B.  E. Lane.  1970. Soil-water  sampling using pan and deep
 pressure-vacuum  lysimeters. J.  Hydr. 11:1-21.

 The Resources Agency of California.  1963. Annual report on dispersion and
 persistence  of synthetic detergent in groundwater, San Bernadino and
 Riverside Counties. In a report to the State Water Quality Control Board.
 Dept.  of Water Resources. Interagency Agreement No. 12-17.

 Scalf, M. R., J. F. McNabb, W.  J. Dunlap, R. L. Cosby, and J. ^ryberger.
 1981. Manual of  ground-water sampling procedures. National Water Well
 Association, Worthington, Ohio. 93 p.

 Silkworth, D. R. and D. F. Grigal. 1981. Field comparison of soil solution
 samplers. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J. 45:440-442.

 Smith, J. L., D. B. McWhorter,  and R. C. Ward. 1977. Continuous subsurface
 injection of liquid dairy manure. EPA-600/2-77-117. PB 272-350/OBE.

 Trout, T. J., J. L. Smith, and  D. B. McWhorter. 1975. Environmental effects
 of land application of digested municipal sewage sludge. Report submitted
 to city of Boulder, Colorado. Dept. of Agr. Engr. Colorado State Univ., Ft.
 Collins, Colorado.

 Tyler, D. D. and G. W. Thomas.  1977. Lysimeter measurements of nitrate and
 chloride losses  and no-tillage  corn. J. Environ. Qual. 6:63-66.

 USDA.  1975.  Soil taxonomy, a basic system of soil classification for making
 and interpreting soil  surveys.  Soil Conservation Service USDA Agriculture
 (Handbook No. 436. U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington, D.C.

 USDA. 1979. Field manual for research in agricultural hydrology. USDA
 Agricultural Handbook No. 224.  U.S. Government Printing Office, Washington,
 D.C.

 USDI, Bureau of Reclamation. 1977. Groundwater manual. U.S. Government
 Printing, Washington, D.C.

 Wagner, G. H. 1962. Use of porous ceramic cups to sample soil water within
 the profile. Soil Sci. 94:379-386.

 Wengel, R. W. and G. F. Griffen. 1971. Remote soil-water sampling tech-
 nique. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. Proc. 35:661-664.

Wilson, L. G. 1980. Monitoring  in the vadose zone: a review of technical
 elements and methods. U.S. EPA. EPA-600/7-80-134.

Wood, W. W.  1973. A technique using porous cups for water sampling at any
 depth in the unsaturated zone. Water Resources Research. 9:486-488.

                                    550

-------
Wood, A. L., J. T. Wilson, R. L. Cosby, A. G. Hornsby, and L. B. Baskin.
1981. Apparatus and procedure for sampling soil profiles for volatile
organic compounds. Soil Sci. Soc. Am. J. 45:442-444.
                                     551

-------
 10.0                             CHAPTER  TEN

                CONTINGENCY  PLANNING AND  OTHER  CONSIDERATIONS
     Managers  of  all hazardous waste management  facilities must take pre-
 cautions  to safeguard the health  of  both workers  and nonworkers  during nor-
 mal  facility  operation  and in  the event  of  an environmental emergency.
 Routine  health and  safety  considerations  are  discussed  in  Section 10.1.
 Preparedness and  prevention measures and  contingency plans appropriate for
 HWLT units are also  discussed.   Figure 10.1  indicates  the key  points con-
 sidered by the permit  evaluator.   During the active life  of an HWLT unit,
 changes in the management or operation of the unit may  be  made that  require
 updating  the closure plan.   In  some cases,  changes in the waste stream be-
 ing disposed may  require modification of  the permit as well as changes to
 management and closure  plans.    Changing waste  streams are  considered in
 Section  10.4.   Requirements for  contingency  planning  and  other health and
 safety concerns are  given in the  EPA regulatons  (EPA,  1980; EPA, 1981) and
 are discussed  below.
10.1                     ROUTINE HEALTH AND SAFETY
     Although  the  management plans for  HWLT units are  designed to reduce
the  hazards  associated with  the  particular waste  being disposed  (Chapter
8),  there are  some additional health and safety considerations that need to
be specifically addressed.  The type and amount of  employee training neces-
sary to safeguard human health and reduce environmental  impacts  from sudden
or nonsudden  releases  of  contaminants are  based  on the characteristics of
the  waste.   Routine  health and  safety  procedures  must be  developed and
followed at all times.  To  protect  the health of the nonworker  population,
access to the HWLT unit should be restricted.
10.1.1                         Site Security
     The  necessary  site security  measures vary  with the  location of  the
facility, the presence or absence of on-site storage, and the nature of  the
wastes being disposed.   There  are,  however, certain minimum standards that
apply to  all HWLT units.   For example,  access  to  the site must  be con-
trolled at  all times.   At  a minimum  this may require  fencing the entire
HWLT site.  When  unknowing  entry will not  cause  injury to  people or live-
stock barbed wire fences are generally sufficient  for  the  outer perimeter
but fences intended to exclude people may  be desirable around storage faci-
lities,  runoff retention ponds  and  office buildings.  In heavily populated
areas where the public can easily gain access,  fences to exclude people  may
be needed around  the  entire  perimeter to  keep  children and others off  the
site.
                                    552

-------
                        (
                           WASTE
POTENTIAL
  SITE
ROUTINE HEALTH AND SAFETY
     (SECTION 10.1)
PREPAREDNESS AND PREVENTION
       (SECTION 10.2)

                                  CONTINGENCY  PLANNING

                                       CHAPTER TEN
                  ASK FOR
                  ADDITIONAL
                  PLANNING
                                 ARE CONTINGENCY PLANS
                                 AND EMERGENCY  RESPONSE
                                  MEASURES ADEQUATE?

                                             10.3)
                                  DO CHANGES IN WASTES
                                OR CONDITIONS REQUIRE RE-
                            DEVALUATION OF THE ABOVE STEPS?

                                     (SECTION 10.4)
\
f
PLANNING FOR SITE CLOSURE
CHAPTER ELEVEN
Figure 10.1.
              Contingency planning and additional considerations
              for HWLT units.
                                 553

-------
     Appropriate warning signs designed  to  keep out unauthorized personnel
should be posted at the main facility  entrance,  at  all gates and at inter-
vals along the site perimeter where access  could be made  by foot.   Traffic
control should be established to restrict unauthorized entry either through
use  of  gates or a  surveillance  system.   When  the  land  treatment  area is
adjacent  to  the  industrial plant  where wastes are  generated and  where
access can be gained only by passing through normal plant security, no fur-
ther actions may be needed to restrict access.
10.1.2                  Personnel Health and Safety
     Events that endanger the health of workers at land treatment units in-
clude accidents while operating heavy equipment, fires and explosions.  Ex-
posure to toxic or  carcinogenic  wastes is also of concern  since acute and
chronic health effects may occur if  proper  precautions  are  not taken.  The
U.S. Occupational Safety  and Health Administration  (OSHA) has the primary
responsibility for determining the adequacy of working conditions to ensure
employee safety.  This  agency has developed  specific operational criteria
for most situations  in the work place and may be consulted during the deve-
lopment of safety standards for a specific HWLT unit.  Quick medical atten-
tion  is  often  critical;  an  excellent guide  to  first-aid  information is
American Red  Cross  Standard First  Aid  and  Personal Safety  published by
Doubleday and Company, Inc.   It  deals with such topics  as  heavy bleeding,
stopped  breathing,  artificial respiration,  shock,  poisoning,  burns,  eye
damage, heat stroke, and moving injured victims.

     Accidents, fires and  explosions often occur as  a  result of careless-
ness  or  vandalism  and  can  therefore be  reduced  through  proper training
(Section 10.1.3) and controlled access (Section 10.1.1).  Probably the most
common cause  of injury  at land treatment  units  is operator  error  while
handling heavy  equipment;  however,  by following standard  operating proce-
dures, accidents such as  these can  be minimized.   Fires are a continuous
threat at  facilities handling flammable wastes;   waste  storage  areas may
be  set  afire  by vandalism,  carelessness,  sparks from  vehicles  or even
spontaneous combustion.   All  sources of  ignition  including vehicles  (where
possible) and  cigarette smoking should  be  prohibited  near  waste storage
areas.   Because the possibility of  spontaneous combustion  is greatly en-
hanced on very hot days, it may  be  advisable to keep certain storage tanks
cool by  continuous  spraying  with water  or  by a permanent  cooling system.
Waste storage areas  and  the  actual  land  treatment area may  be sources of
explosive gases.    Products  of  hazardous waste decomposition, oxidation,
volatilization,  sublimation   or  evaporation  may  Include   gases  that  are
explosive.   In sufficient concentrations, these low flash point  gases might
cause employee injury during tilling and waste spreading operations as well
as during storage or handling operations.  Fires, explosions or  releases of
toxic gases can also result  from mixing  incompatible wastes.   Section 8.9
deals with this subject in detail  and includes tables that  can be used to
determine incompatible waste combinations.
                                   554

-------
     Acute or chronic exposure to toxic wastes may cause immediate sickness
or long-term illness.  Many wastes give  off  toxic vapors  during storage or
when they are applied to the soil.  A simple respirator is often sufficient
to eliminate the dangers associated with breathing these vapors.  Long-term
carcinogenic risks  may be  harder to protect  against.   If the  hazardous
waste being handled  is  known  to be carcinogenic  or  acutely toxic,  special
protection is needed.   Information on protective  equipment  may be obtained
from the OSHA.
10.1.3                      Personnel Training


     As mentioned  in the previous  section,  many sources of  worker injury
can be reduced through proper training.  Training should be designed to en-
sure  that  facility  personnel  are  able  to  respond  effectively  during  an
emergency and are  able  to implement contingency plans  (Section  10.3).   In
addition to  training sessions  on standard operating procedures  and use of
equipment, two additional types of specialized training are appropriate for
HWLT facility perosnnel, as follows:

     (1)  familiarization  with the  possible  equipment or  structure
          deterioration  or  malfunction scenarios  that might  lead to
          environmental or human health damages; and

     (2)  procedures  for  inspecting  equipment  and   structures  to
          determine  the  degree  of  deterioration or   probability of
          malfunction.
10.2               PREPAREDNESS AND PREVENTION MEASURES
     Preparedness and prevention measures are intended to minimize the pos-
sibility  and  effects  of  a  contaminant  release,  fire  or  explosion which
could threaten human health  or  the environment.   Good management practices
are the  basis  of preparedness;  HWLT  units  should be operated to minimize
the likelihood of  spills,  fires,  explosions,  or  any  other  discharge or
release of hazardous waste.  Management  concerns  for HWLT are discussed in
Chapter 8.  Specific preparedness  and prevention measures include adequate
communications,  arrangements  with  local  authorities and  regulatory agen-
cies,   and proper  emergency  equipment.    Additionally,   aisle   space  and
roads should be  clear  and maintained  to  allow the unobstructed movement of
emergency response personnel and  equipment  to any area of the facility at
all times.
10.2.1                        Communications


     The  following  two types  of communications  systems  may  be  needed at
HWLT units (40 CFR 264.34; EPA,  1980):
                                    555

-------
     (1)  an internal  communicatIons  or alarm system  that  is
          of providing immediate  emergency instructions  to facility
          employees; and
     (2)  a device  capable  of  summoning external emergency assistance
          from  local  response agencies   (e.g.,  telephone  or  2-way
          radio).

Whenever hazardous  waste  is being mixed,  poured, spread  or  otherwise han-
dled, all personnel involved in the operation must have immediate access to
an  internal  alarm  or  emergency communication  device,  either  directly  or
through visual  or voice contact  with another  employee.   In  addition,  if
there is ever only one employee on the premises while the facility is oper-
ating,  he  must  have  immediate access  to  a  device,  such  as  a telephone
(immediately available at  the  scene  of  operation)  or a  hand  held two-way
radio, capable of summoning external emergency assistance.
10.2.2                 Arrangements with Authorities


     It is  advisable to make  arrangements  to familiarize  local  and state
emergency response authorities (such as police, fire, health, and civil de-
fense officials) with the following:

     (1)  the layout of the unit;
     (2)  entrance  to  roads  inside the  unit that  could be used  as
          possible evacuation routes;
     (3)  places where personnel would normally be working; and
     (4)  the quantities and  properties  of the hazardous waste being
          handled at the unit along with any associated hazards.

When more  than  one  police  and fire department might  respond  to  an emer-
gency, an agreement  should  be  made  designating primary emergency authority
to a specific department.   This  should  be accompanied by agreements with
other  agencies  to  provide support to  the  primary  emergency authority.
Agreements should  also  be  made with state  emergency response teams, emer-
gency response  contractors, and  equipment suppliers for  their  services or
products if there is a potential need for these.

     Arrangements  should be made to familiarize  local hospitals with the
properties of the hazardous waste handled at  the  unit  and the types of in-
juries  or illnesses which  could  result  from  fires,   explosions,  waste
releases, or other emergency related events.

     All of the above arrangements agreed upon by local police departments,
fire departments,  hospitals,   contractors,  and state  and  local  emergency
reponse teams to  coordinate emergency services  should be  included In the
contingency plan  for the HWLT unit (Section  10.3).   In  addition,  a con-
tinuously updated  list  of  names, addresses,  and  phone numbers  (office and
                                    556

-------
home) of  all  persons  qualified to act as  the emergency coordinator should
be included in  the  contingency plan.   Where  there is  more  than one person
listed,  one  must be  named as  the primary  emergency  coordinator  and the
home) of  all  persons  qualified to act as  the emergency coordinator should
be included in  the  contingency plan.   Where  there is  more  than one person
listed,  one  must be  named as  the primary  emergency  coordinator  and the
others must be listed in the order in which they will assume responsibility
as alternates.
10.2.3                           Equipment
     To facilitate a quick response during an emergency, a continuously up-
dated  list  of emergency equipment  available at  the  unit should  be kept.
This list should include the location and physical description of each item
and a brief outline of its capabilities.
10.2.3.1 Required Emergency Equipment
     Federal regulations require certain types of emergency equipment to be
maintained on-site (40 CFR 264.32;  EPA,  1980).   The types of communication
equipment required are  discussed in Section  10.2.1.   The following equip-
ment should also be maintained on-site:

     (1)  portable fire  fighting  equipment  including  special  extin-
          guishing equipment  adapted  to  the type of waste  handled at
          the facility;
     (2)  spill control equipment;
     (3)  decontamination equipment; and

     (4)  water in an adequate volume  and  pressure  to  deal with emer-
          gency situations.


10.2.3.2  Additional Equipment


     In addition  to  the  emergency equipment required by  federal regula-
tions ,  there  are several  other  types of  emergency equipment  or material
that are specifically needed  at  HWLT  sites.   Materials  that  may be needed
on-site include the following:

     (1)  bales of hay and other materials that  could  be used as tem-
          porary barriers  and as  absorbents  to  soak  up or  slow the
          spread of spilled or accidentally discharged materials;

     (2)  sand bags and other materials that could be used for filling
          or blocking overflow channels  in waste storage or water re-
          tention facilities;

                                    557

-------
      (3)  auxiliary  pumps  and  pipelines  to move or spray-irrigate ex-
          cess water to prevent overflow of retention facilities;
      (4)  appropriate  boots, rain  gear,  gloves, goggles, and gas res-
          pirators for personnel;
      (4)  appropriate  boots, rain  gear,  gloves, goggles, and gas res-
          pirators for personnel;
      (5)  basic hand tools to make "quick  response" repairs  to damaged
          or deteriorating equipment or structures; and

      (6)  lists of  the closest emergency  equipment  suppliers or con-
          tractors  (Including  sources  of  large vacuum trucks, and/or
          waterproofed dump trucks) to receive  spill debris.

      Plans  and  equipment should be  available  for removing,  retaining, or
redistributing previously  applied  waste.   This may  become necessary where
waste has been accidentally applied at too high a rate or where waste which
has  been applied is found  to  differ from that for which the application
rates were  developed.   Additionally, plans and equipment  should be avail-
able  to deal with the  full  variety of  natural and man-made disasters which
may  occur.   Examples  of  these disasters  include  excessive rainfall,   soil
overloads and  surface  water or groundwater contamination.   When materials
are  spilled in  transit or in  nontreatment areas of  the facility,  cleanup
will  require the types of equipment described above.


10.2.3.3 Inspection  and Maintenance


      Development of  and  adherence  to a  written schedule for inspecting all
monitoring  equipment, safety and emergency equipment, security devices, and
operating and structural equipment  (such as  dikes,  waste storage or handl-
ing equipment, and sump pumps) that are important to preventing, detecting,
or responding to  environmental or human health hazards is  critical.   The
frequency of these inspections  is  based  on the rate of possible deteriora-
tion  or  malfunction of the  equipment  and the  probability  of  an environ-
mental or human  health incident if  the deterioration,  malfunction,  or an
operator  error  goes undetected between   inspections.   Areas  subject to
spills  (such as  waste  loading,  unloading  and storage areas)  should be
inspected at least dally while they are  in use.  Any deterioration or  mal-
function of equipment  or structures should be corrected to ensure that the
problem does not lead to an environmental  or  human health  hazard.  Where a
hazard is imminent or  has  already  occurred,  remedial  action must be taken
immediately.
10.3             CONTINGENCY PLANS AND EMERGENCY RESPONSE
     Contingency  plans  and  emergency responses  are intended  to minimize
hazards to human health due to emergencies such as fire, explosions, or any
                                   558

-------
unplanned sudden  or nonsudden  release  of hazardous  wastes to  air,  soil,
groundwater or  surface water.   The  plan must  be carried  out  immediately
whenever such an emergency occurs and should describe the actions that fac-
ility personnel must take.   Copies  of the contingency plan  (and any revi-
sions to the  plan)  should be maintained  at  the HWLT unit  and  supplied to
all state and local emergency response authorities.   At  a minimum the plan
should include the following (40 CFR 264.52;  EPA, 1980):

     (1)  arrangements agreed upon with local and state emergency res-
          ponse authorities (Section 10.2.2);
     (2)  a continuously updated list with names and phone numbers of
          the people  qualified  to  act  as  the  emergency coordinator
          (Section 10.3.1);

     (3)  a continuously updated list of emergency equipment available
          on-site (Section 10.2.3); and

     (4)  an  evacuation plan for  personnel  including signals  to be
          used  to  begin evacuation,  evacuation routes  and alternate
          evacuation routes  (In  cases where  the primary  routes  may be
          blocked as a result of the emergency situation).

     The contingency  plan and should  be reviewed  on a  regular basis and
amended as  necessary.   Examples of situations  that  would require amending
the contingency plan include the following:

     (1)  the applicable regulations are revised;

     (2)  the plan fails in an emergency;

     (3)  the facility  changes  (in  its  design,  operation, maintenance
          or in any way that would change the necessary response to  an
          emergency);

     (4)  the list of emergency coordinator changes;  and

     (5)  the list of emergency equipment changes.


10.3.1              Coordination of Emergency Response
     At least one of  the  qualified emergency coordinators should be at  the
HWLT site or on call  (i.e.,  available  to respond to an emergency by reach-
ing the site  within a short period  of time) at all  times.   The emergency
coordinator has the responsibility for coordinating all emergency  response
measures.   Specific responsibilities  of the emergency  coordinator are  as
follows:

     (1)  to be familiar with all  aspects of  the contingency plan,  all
          operations  and  activities  at the  facility,  the location  and
          characteristics of the hazardous waste handled by the  facil-
          ity,  the  location of all  records within the facility,  and
          the facility layout;
                                    559

-------
      (2)  to have  the  authority and be  able to commit  the resources
           needed to carry out the contingency plan;

      (3)  to activate  internal  facility  alarms or  communication  sys-
           tems in case of emergency;

      (4)  to notify the appropriate emergency response authorities;

      (5)  to immediately identify character,  exact  source,  amount, and
           extent of any released materials;  and

      (6)  to immediately assess  possible hazards  to  human health  or
           the environment that may result from the  emergency situation
           including both  direct  (fire,  explosions,  comtaninant  re-
           leases) and  indirect (generation of asphyxiating  gas or  con-
           taminated runoff)  effects of  the emergency.

      If, during an emergency response,  the emergency coordinator determines
 that  there may be a threat  to human  health  or the  environment  outside  the
 facility,  he must report these findings.   If his assessment indicates that
 evacuation is advisable, he  must  immediately notify the appropriate  local
 authorities  and be prepared  to assist them in assessing whether local  areas
 need  to be evacuated.   In addition,  he must  immediately notify either  the
 government official designated  as  the  on-scene coordinator for  that  geo-
 graphical  area or  the  National Response Center  (using their  24-hour  toll
 free  number:   1-800-424-8802).   His report should include the  following:

      (1)  name  and telephone number of  reporter;
      (2)  name  and address of the  facility;
      (3)  time  and type of accident;

      (4)  name  and quantity  of material involved;
      (5)  extent  of  injuries;  and

      (6)  possible  hazards to human health or the environment  outside
           the facility.

During  the emergency, he should  take  all  reasonable  measures so that fires,
explosions,  and waste  releases  do not occur, recur,  or  spread  to  other
hazardous waste at  the  HWLT  unit.

     Immediately  after  an emergency,  the  emergency coordinator  must provide
for the  treatment, storage or disposal  of  the recovered waste,  contaminated
soil or surface water,  or any other  material that  results from  the  emer-
gency  (40  CFR 264.56;   EPA,  1980).    He must  ensure that  (in  the affected
areas of the facility)  no wastes that may be  incompatible with  the released
material  are stored,  disposed  or  otherwise handled  until  the  released
material is  completely  cleaned  up.   In  addition,  before operations resume,
all emergency  equipment listed  in the contingency plan must  be cleaned,
refilled and made ready for  its intended use.  To prevent repetition of the
emergency, the coordinator may need to  do the following, where  applicable:
                                   560

-------
     (1)  reject all future deliveries of incompatible waste;
     (2)  correct facility deficiencies;

     (3)  improve spill control structures;
     (4)  obtain  proper first  aid  or  other  emergency  equipment  to
          address identified deficiencies; and

     (5)  retrain or dismiss responsible  employees.

     Before  operations  can resume,  the  owner or  operator  must notify  the
proper federal, state and local authorities  that all  cleanup  procedures  are
complete and all emergency equipment is restored and  ready  for  its  intended
use.  The owner or operator must also record  the time, date,  and details of
any  incident that  requires  implementation  of  the   contingency  plan and,
within fifteen days of  the incident, he must  submit a written report  on  the
incident to  the appropriate regulatory agency  that includes the following:

     (1)  name, address, and  telephone number of  the owner  or opera-
          tor;

     (2)  name, address and telephone number  of  the facility;
     (3)  date, time, and type of  incident;

     (4)  name and quantity of material(s) involved;

     (5)  the extent of injuries,  if any;

     (6)  an assessment of actual  or potential hazards  to human health
          or the environment, where  applicable;  and
     (7)  estimated  quantity  and  disposition of  recovered  material
          that resulted from the incident.


10.3.2            Specific Adaptations  to Land Treatment


     In  addition to  the general  contingency  plans  discussed above  that
apply to all types  of  hazardous waste management  facilities, some  problems
or  emergency responses are uniquely characteristic  of HWLT  systems.   Such
contingences  should be  recognized and  specifically  addressed in an  HWLT
permit.


10.3.2.1 Soil Overloads
     The  capacity  of the soil to  treat  and dispose of wastes  may be over-
loaded  despite the  best  of plans.   There is  always  the  possibility that
occasional shipments of  wastes  will contain constituents which the facility
was  not  designed  to handle  or  in concentrations which  exceed  the designed
application  rates.   In some cases  it may  be  possible to  see  or  smell that
the waste is  off-specification  and, in such cases,  it should be placed in a
placed in a  special  holding basin or area.  The waste should be sampled and
analyzed  before it  is  applied  to the soil.  In other cases, the differences

                                    561

-------
may  not be  observed  until  the waste  is  applied  to the  land.    In such
instances, as much of the waste  as  possible  should be picked up and placed
in the  off-specification holding area.   In other  instances,  it  may not be
possible to pick up the waste and remedial treatment may be necessary.

     Areas  that  need remedial  treatment can  often be  identified because
they have  a different  color or  odor,  remain wetter  or drier, or  do not
support vegetation.   On-site observations  combined with  reports  from soil
samples sent for analysis  should be sufficient to  determine  the source of
the problem.  Several options for remedial measures to deal with waste "hot
spots"  are  discussed  below.   One option is  to physically  remove  the mat-
erial  and  store the  soil  in  an off-specification  storage area  until it
can be  analyzed to determine if  the material  can  be respread over a larger
area and degraded,  or if it should  be disposed elsewhere.

     Certain remedial treatments  and changes in HWLT management may be used
to overcome the problem without  removing the soil.  Acids  or bases may be
used to neutralize  areas  which have become  too  basic or acidic.   In most
cases,  it  is  advisable to use HC1 or  CaC03  or other  neutralizing agents
selected to avoid  the accumulation of  excess salts.   If  excessive sodium
(Na) salts are causing  the problem, it may be possible to overcome the pro-
blem by applying CaS(>4  or CaC03  to replace  the Na with Ca.   When exces-
sive volatile  organic materials  cause  a problem,  it  may  be  advisable to
apply  and  incorporate  powdered  activated  charcoal  or other  organic mat-
erials  to adsorb and deactivate the chemicals until they can be degraded in
the HWLT system.  Where excessive amounts  of  oil  have been applied, decom-
position  can  often be  enhanced  by incorporating appropriate  amounts  of
nutrients (particularly nitrogen) and hay  or  straw, which will help loosen
the  soil, absorb the  oil,  and allow oxygen  to enter the system.   In some
instances where hot spots  are  small,  it may be possible  to solve the pro-
blem by spreading  the  treated  soils  over a  larger  area  and subsequently
regrading to eliminate  any depressions.

     In a few cases, however, a  soil may become  so overloaded with a  toxic
inorganic or  nondegradable  organic chemical that  it is  not economically
feasible or environmentally  sound to spread  the  soil over a larger area as
a remedial  measure.   If there is  no  feasible on-site  treatment that will
alter  the  contaminated soil  sufficiently  to  render it  nonhazardous, the
zone of contamination should be  removed and  disposed in a  landfill author-
ized to accept hazardous waste.  The zone of contamination  will include the
soil in the treatment area at  least down to the depth  of the waste incor-
poration (20 to 60 cm)  and any additional underlying soil that is  also con-
taminated.
10.3.2.2 Groundwater Contamination
     The potential  for  migration of waste  constituents  to groundwater can
be predicted  from  pilot studies (Sections  7.2.2  and 7.4) performed before
land treatment of the waste begins.  Thus,  the facility can be designed  to
minimize this potential through waste pretreatment,  in-plant process con-

                                    562

-------
trols to reduce, eliminate, or alter the form of the waste constituents, or
soil amendments.   Groundwater contamination may  occur at HWLT  facilities
when water  percolates  through  soil  if  contaminants  occur  in  leachable
forms.   Water  enters  contaminated soil  in  the treatment zone  from direct
precipitation, surface water  run-on,  applied wastes  containing water,  and
from irrigation of the land treatment  area  to  enhance waste biodegradation
or  cover  crop growth.   Where groundwater  contamination occurs,  remedial
actions can be very extensive and costly.  Hence, the key to minimizing the
impact  of  the  contamination  incident  and  the  resulting expenses  is  the
early detection of contaminant migration.  This can be accomplished through
the proper use of unsaturated zone monitoring discussed in Chapter 9.

     If the  waste constituent that  is  leaching  has  not yet  reached  the
groundwater, contingency plans may involve pressure-injecting a bowl-shaped
grout bottom seal  above  the groundwater table  and  below the zone  of con-
tamination.    The  leachate contained  by the bowl-shaped  seal can  then be
pumped out and treated or  land treated  at rates that preclude water perco-
lation.   Further  information is  available in  the  publication,  entitled
Technical Information Summary;  Soil Grouting, (Applied Nucleonics Company,
Inc., 1976).   Cost estimates  for constructing  portland cement bottom seals
are given in Table 10.1.   In  some cases, it may  be  possible  to remove the
zone of waste  incorporation to cut off  the source  of  the  leachate.   Soil
and waste in  the  zone of  incorporation  could  then  be  disposed at another
location.
TABLE 10.1  COSTS OF CONSTRUCTING A PORTLAND CEMENT BOTTOM SEAL UNDER AN
            ENTIRE 10 ACRE (4.1 HECTARE) LAND TREATMENT FACILITY*


Thickness of injected        Voids in soil        Cost of portland  cement
    grout layer             receiving grout         cement bottom liner
Meters           Feet             (%)             (Millions of  1978  dollars)
1.2
1.2
1.8
1.8
4
4
6
6
20
30
20
30
1.115
1.672
1.667
2.500
- 2.786
- 4.180
- 4.166
- 6.250
* Tolman et al. (1978).
     If  the  leaching waste  constituents  have already  reached the  ground-
water, the leachate may be recoverable  downgradient  from the  land  treatment
facility by using a well point interception  system.  This involves install-
ation of short  lengths  of  well screen  on  5-8  cm diameter pipe that  extend
into the water  table.   These well points  should be  spaced on 90  to  150  cm
centers  (depending on  the  soil permeability) downgradient from the  area  of
                                   563

-------
leachate  Infiltration (Tolman  et al.,  1978).    If suction  extraction is
used,  the depth  of  extraction  is  limited  to  10  m.    For  extraction of
leachate from greater depths, air injection pumps may be required.
10.3.2.3 Surface Water Contamination
     Surface water  contamination  may occur due to  a break or  leak in the
earthen wall of a water or waste  retention facility or due to water runoff
from  a  treatment  area.   These  problems  can  generally  be  avoided  and
remedied with  readily available  earth  moving or excavating  equipment and
suitable fill material.

     Prevention is  the best approach  to surface water  pollution,  as pre-
viously described in  Section 8.3  and summarized below.  To prevent surface
water from running  onto active  treatment areas, earthen berms or excavated
diversion ditches should  be  constructed upslope of  active areas to direct
the water  toward  natural drainage  ways downslope from  the treatment area
(Tolman et al., 1978).  These structures should be  designed to control and
withstand water from the 25-year 24-hour storm.    To  prevent contaminated
water  from leaving  the  land treatment unit,  earthen berms  or excavated
diversion  ditches  should  be constructed to  establish  drainage  patterns
which direct the water into the appropriate water retention facility.  With
this  in mind,  water  retention   facilities  should   be  constructed  at  the
lowest  possible  downslope position within  the HWLT  unit boundary while
leaving  enough buffer area  to  permit access  of emergency vehicles between
the facility boundary and the retention pond.

     Breaks or leaks  in water diversion or storage  facilities can be reme-
died by placing sandbags or fill  material  at  the  problem area.  To prevent
this problem from recurring, vegetation should be established on the sides
of the diversion or storage structures.  However, the vegetation may  take a
year to  become  fully established, so it  may be necessary to use mulching
and hay bales to maintain soil stability in the meantime.

     Overflow of water or waste storage facilities  usually can be  overcome
by sandbagging the low side wall.   Unless  the overflow is caused by  an ex-
traordinary  event  (i.e., one-time waste  load, hurricane,  or  a  100-year
storm),  the  owner or operator  should  immediately   consider  enlarging the
existing water and/or waste capacity at  the HWLT unit.
10.3.2.4 Waste Spills


     Waste spills may affect soils, surface water and groundwater and,  con-
sequently, procedures  developed in  the sections  dealing with  soil over-
loads, surface water  contamination,  and groundwater  contamination  may all
be important when dealing with  spills.   Spills of volatile wastes may  also
cause air quality problems.  In the case of spills, rapid action is  the key
to limiting environmental damage.

                                    564

-------
     If the spill occurs while  the  waste is being transported  to  the land
treatment unit, the  appropriate emergency equipment should  immediately be
dispatched to the scene.  This  equipment  may  include sandbags  or fill dirt
to  check  the  spread of the  spilled material,  a vacuum  truck to  remove
liquids from surface pools , and a backhoe or  front-end  loader  and  a water-
proof dump truck to  begin the excavation and  removal  of contaminated soil.
If the waste was spilled at the land treatment unit, it may be a relatively
simple matter to excavate the contaminated soil  and respread it within the
actual treatment area.  If solid debris such as lumber pallets or trash are
contaminated  with the  hazardous  materials,   they may also  be  disposed
on-site after being ground.

     Specialized equipment may  be needed for  some types of hazardous waste
spills.  The response time to spills of volatile wastes is particularly im-
portant to minimize air pollution.  Techniques for handling spills of vola-
tile hazardous substances have been reviewed (Brown et al., 1981).  The use
of dry  ice  or liquid nitrogen  to cool  the spill  to  reduce volatilization
and  the use  of vapor containment methods were found to be most effective
for  dealing with volatile spills (Brown et al.,  1981).  If the spilled mat-
erial is  flammable ,  appropriate extinguishing equipment  is needed  at the
accident  site.   If  the  material is  toxic,  breathing  gear  and protective
clothing will be needed for all personnel  active in the cleanup  operations.
If  the  spill  involves  explosive materials,  an effort  should  be  made to
determine if there are deactivating  procedures to reduce the chance  of ex-
plosion.  In  any  of  these  cases, area evacuation  may  be  advisable.  Where
public health is threatened, the speed and appropriateness of  the emergency
response is of special importance.

     For spills of oily  liquids on  soil,  an  approximation can be made for
the  volume  of soil  required to  immobilize a known  volume of  the  liquid
(Davis, 1972), as follows:

                              v
                                    (P)  (Sr)

where

     V8 - Volume of soil in cubic yards  (1 yd3 -  0.76 m3);
     V0 - Volume of liquid in barrels;
     P - Porosity of the soil (percent); and
     Sr - Residual oil saturation of  the soil  (percent).

Residual  saturation (Sr)  values which may be  used  in the  equation  are
0.10 for light oil or gasoline,  0.15  for light fuel  oil  or  diesel,  and 0.20
for heavy fuel oil or lube oil  (Davis,  1972).
                                     565

-------
 10.3.2.5 Fires and Explosions
     Fires and  explosions  are  ever present threats where hazardous materi-
als  are stored,  disposed  or otherwise  handled.    Safe handling  of these
wastes  requires  a  knowledge of  their  physical  and  chemical  properties.
This  information, as well as  an  understanding of any dangers associated
with  the waste,  such  as  flammability,  shock  sensitivity  and  reactivity,
should  be  obtained  prior  to transporting,  storing, or disposing hazardous
wastes.  Where  ignitable waste  is  to be land treated,  subsurface injection
is the  suggested application technique.   Subsurface  injection  reduces the
rate of flammable vapor release and decreases  the possibility  that ignit-
able gases  will  accumulate  to  critical concentrations  in the  air  at the
HWLT unit.  Timing applications to correspond with cooler weather will help
to minimize the risks associated with treating  ignitable wastes.

     Flash point  and ignition  temperature  are the most commonly used indi-
cators  of  the  hazards  associated with  ignitable  materials.   Although liq-
uids do not burn, the  flammable  vapors given off  by  the stored or handled
liquids  can  cause fires or  explosions  (Stalker,  1979).   These  low flash
point  vapors  given  off from  hazardous wastes  can travel  long  distances
downwind or downhill to reach an ignition  source  and  then flash back (NFPA
Staff,  1979).   Fires involving unconfined  liquids  resulting from a spill,
leak, or storage  vessel overflow may spread over  a much greater  area than
is represented  by the  extent of  the flammable  liquid  spill.   During emer-
gencies  involving ignitable  materials,  immediate evacuation  may  be neces-
sary to save lives.

     Three  types of explosions  are possible  at  HWLT units.   Combustion
explosions involve the quick combination of flammable vapors with air where
heat, light and an increase  in pressure result.  To explode, the flammable
vapor and air must be  within the explosive range and  then ignited.   Deto-
nation  explosions are  similar  to  combustion  explosions  except  the  heat
release  is  considerably higher for the  detonation  explosion and  is accom-
panied  by a shock wave  that moves at  approximately 1.5 to 8 km per second
(Stalker, 1979).  Boiling-liquid,  expanding-vapor explosions (BLEVE) occur
when sealed containers  of  flammable liquids  are  heated past their boiling
points  by  an external  heat  source.   The  explosion  occurs  when released
vapors are ignited by the  external heat  source.  Explosions generally occur
only  in poorly  ventilated  areas  where  one of  the   following conditions
exists  (Stalker,  1979):

     (1)  the flash point  of the liquid  is  less than -6.7°C;

     (2)  the flash  point  of  the  liquid  is less  than A3°C and the
          liquid is heated to greater than  16°C above its flash point;
          or

     (3)  the flash point  of the  liquid  is less than  150°C, and the
          liquid is heated above its boiling point.

Sensitivity to shock is another important factor to consider when handling,
storing or  disposing explosives such  as organic peroxides  or  wastes from

                                    566

-------
the explosives industry.  Another cause of explosions  is  the  occurrence  of
a critical dust concentration in the presence of an ignition source.

     The potential for an explosion can be minimized by the following:

     (1)  prevent a critical dust or vapor concentration from
          occurring;

     (2)  eliminate sources of ignition;

     (3)  keep all work areas well ventilated;
     (4)  train facility personnel about the dangers; and
     (5)  post warnings in critical areas.

Although fires and  explosions  are very similar processes,  there  is  a dif-
ference in the speed of the reaction.  With explosions, the event is almost
instantaneous and hence cannot  be  controlled.   This makes preventive meas-
ure even more important.
10.4                          CHANGING WASTES
     Since land treatment is a dynamic process, the demonstration of effec-
tive treatment considers  the interaction of given waste  applied to a par-
ticular  treatment  site.   Not only  is  the waste altered  by treatment, but
the  waste residuals  continually  change  the  character  of  the treatment
medium.   The  characteristics  of   the  waste  and  the  specific waste-soil
interactions form  the basis for design  and  management decisions.  Permits
are  also issued to HWLT  units  based on specific waste-soil  combinations.
Consequently, if waste stream characteristics change  or  if new wastes are
substituted  or  added to  the waste  mixture  being  applied  to  the  soil,
changes  may be necessary  in  both the design  and management  of  the HWLT unit
and permit modifications  may also be required.

     Assessing  the capacity of an  HWLT  unit  to accept  a different  waste
often  involves  calculating  a new application  rate  based  on the new waste-
soil  combination  (Chapter 7).   In the  case of a drastic  change in  waste
characteristics, a complete  facility redesign  may be required.   Waste  char-
acterization and pretreatment options should  be  reevaluated  using the new
waste  mixture.  To show that the  goal  of land treatment will  be met,  addi-
tional laboratory  and/or  field  studies may be  necessary to  demonstrate that
the wastes will be made less hazardous.   If the soil is already in use for
waste  treatment, the  demonstration  must  use  the  loaded soil and account for
accumulated waste  constituents.   Modifications to the  management,  monitor-
ing, contingency,  and site  closure  plans may also be necessary.
                                    567

-------
                           CHAPTER  10 REFERENCES
Applied Nucleonics Company, Inc.  1976. Technical information summary: soil
grouting.  Prepared for U. S. Environmental Protection Agency.  15 p.

Brown, D., R. Craig, M. Edwards,  N. Henderson, and T. J. Thomas. 1981.
Techniques for handling landborne spills of volatile hazardous  substances.
EPA-600/S2-81-207. PB 82-105-230.

Davis, J. B. 1972. The migration  of petroleum products in soil  and ground-
water: principles and counter measures. Am. Petr. Inst. Washington, D.C.

EPA. 1980. Hazardous waste and consolidated permit regulations.  Federal
Register Vol. 45, No. 98, pp. 33066-33258. May 19, 1980.

EPA. 1981. Hazardous waste management system; addition of general require-
ments for treatment, storage and  disposal facilities.  Federal  Register
Vol. 46, No. 7, pp. 2802-2897. January 12, 1981.

NFPA Staff. 1979. Industrial waste control, p. 901-918. In_ Gordon P.
McKinnon (ed.) Industrial fire hazards handbook. National Fire  Protection
Assoc., Inc. Boston, Massachusetts.

Stalker, R. D. 1979. Flammable and combustible liquid handling  and storage.
p. 719-743. In Gordon P. McKinnon (ed.) Industrial fire hazards handbook.
National Fire Protection Assoc., Inc. Boston, Massachusetts.

Tolman, A. L., A. P. Ballestero, Jr., W. W. Beck, Jr., G. H. Emrich. 1978.
Guidance manual for minimizing pollution from waste disposal sites. EPA-
600/2-78-142. PB 299-206/AS.
                                    568

-------
11.0                          CHAPTER ELEVEN

                         CLOSURE AND POST-CLOSURE
     The satisfactory  completion  of a land treatment operation  depends on
carefully planned closure activities  and  post-closure  care.   The necessary
considerations  in  formulating closure  and post-closure  plans  can  be  de-
scribed, but  the  point of distinction between  closure  and post-closure is
somewhat vague.   This is  because  land treatment  closure is  a  continuing
process rather than a set of distinct engineering procedures.  An exception
would be the  case where  the treatment zone or  the  contaminated  portion of
the  treatment  zone  is  removed  and  disposed  in  another hazardous waste
facility.   Certification of  the  completion  of closure  and  initiation of
post-closure  care  would be  based  on  the approved  closure  plan  and such
things as monitoring  results,  the degree  of treatment  achieved,  changes in
runoff water quality, and the  condition of the  final cover.   Following the
closure certification, the  post-closure care  period begins,  this period is
characterized  by  decreasing  management  and  monitoring  requirements over
time.   Figure  11.1  indicates  the various  aspects of  closure  and post-
closure care discussed in this chapter.
11.1                      SITE CLOSURE ACTIVITIES
     After the last load of waste is accepted for treatment, the process  of
closing the land  treatment  unit  begins.   In practice, management and moni-
toring  during  closure differ  very little  from routine  management during
operation.  The application of stored wastes continues along with  cultiva-
tion  to  stimulate degradation.    Cultivation,  fertilization,  liming  to
assure  proper  pH, and possibly irrigation  continue  until the  organic  con-
stituents  are  sufficiently degraded.   The required  degree  of degradation
depends on the procedure  to  be used  for  final closure.   Monitoring  con-
tinues  as  before  with some modification, as  do run-on and runoff  control.
The  time  required  for  closure will  vary  considerably  from  site  to  site
based on  the rate at  which waste organics  are  degraded  and final  cover  is
established.
11.1.1                   Remedying Metal Overload
     If  immobile  metallic elements  have accumulated in  the zone of  waste
incorporation  to  phytotoxic concentrations, consideration  may be given  to
the use  of deep plowing  to  mix the zone of incorporation  with subsoil  or
addition  of  uncontaminated soil  for  mixing.   Such  a procedure will  lower
the  concentrations  of  the phytotoxic  elements  to  levels  tolerated  by
plants.   This  option  should be exercised only if there is  sufficient  field
evidence  that  (1)  the practice will  not lead  to mobilization  of  hazardous
constituents,  (2)  deep plowing or dilution with  clean materials will  not
disrupt  a soil horizon which  is  instrumental  in preventing migration,  and

                                    569

-------
  REMEDYING METAL
  OVERLOAD  § 11.1.1
  PREPARATION OF A FINAL
  SURFACE  § 11.1.2
  VEGETATIVE COVER
  REQUIREMENT  3 11.1.3
  RUNOFF CONTROL AND
  MONITORING  § 11.1.4
  MONITORING  § 11.1.5
                                    CLOSURE AND POST-CLOSURE
                                      PLANS  CHAPTER ELEVEN
      SITE CLOSURE
ACTIVITIES (SECTION 11.1)
           I
                                         POST CLOSURE
                                     CARE (SECTION 11.2)
           I
                                        . PARTIAL CLO'SURE
                                        (SECTION 11.3)
                                      PERMIT APPLICATION/
                                          ACCEPTANCE
                                         HWLT OPERATION
Figure 11.1.  Factors to consider when closing HWLT units.
                                570

-------
(3) the organic components of the waste have degraded sufficiently to allow
deeper incorporation without endangering groundwater.   Furthermore,  if  the
subsoil or the soil added has a pH below 6.5, sufficient lime to neutralize
the mixed soil may need  to  be  incorporated prior to plowing  or  soil addi-
tions.   Greenhouse or  field  data  should  be  used  to  determine if  these
actions will  remedy  the metal  overload and allow  the  establishment of  a
permanent vegetative cover  before deep  plowing  or  dilution with uncontami-
nated soil is begun.
11.1.2                Preparation of a Final Surface


     Closure  generally requires  that the  treatment  zone be  revegetated
(EPA, 1982).  Planting can proceed as soon as the waste is sufficiently de-
graded, immobilized  and  detoxified to allow the  establishment  of  a perma-
nent vegetative  cover.   If the closure  plan  calls  for the removal  of the
treatment zone,  it  will be  advantageous to continue  management  until the
last application of  waste  is sufficiently degraded  to minimize the amount
of material that needs to be removed.  Whether or not material has been re-
moved, the  remaining surface should be  terraced, fertilized,  and  limed as
necessary and planted  to establish vegetation.   In  the event  the  soil or
subsoil exposed by removal of the treatment zone is not physically suitable
to support  vegetation,  or  if the  desired contours cannot  be  achieved, it
may be necessary to bring in additional suitable soil materials.   Except
for fairly level terrain, the final  grade of  any of  the surfaces should be
developed into a system of terraces and waterways to minimize erosion.  The
details of design procedures have been discussed in Section 8.5.
11.1.3                 Vegetative Cover Requirement
     Except, where  no significant concentrations  of hazardous constituents
remain'in the treatment zone, the final surface must be covered with a per-
manent vegetative  cover  to prevent water  and wind borne  erosion and off-
site transport of  soil and/or waste materials (EPA, 1982).  Where the soil
in  the treatment  zone  is removed  or no  hazardous constituents otherwise
remain, a vegetative  cover is not required  by  regulation; however, in  the
interest of soil erosion control, a vegetative or other cover  (e.g., build-
ing construction)  should be provided  in any  case.   Following preparation of
the  final  surface,  the  soil should be  fertilized  and  limed  again,   if
needed, and a seedbed should  be prepared and  planted.    Depending on  the
season, it may be  desirable or necessary  to  plant a temporary crop to pro-
vide a protective  cover until  the proper planting season  for  the permanent
vegetation.  If this is done, a  clear plan must be  provided for removing or
destroying  the  temporary  vegetation  at  the  proper time in  order to allow
optimum conditions for establishing permanent vegetation.   Guidance on  the
selection and  establishment  of permanent  vegetation has  been discussed  in
Section 8.7.   Preferably,  the permanent cover will consist  of native,  low
maintenance  plant  species to  eliminate the need  for  intensive long-term
crop management.

                                     571

-------
 11.1.4                 Runoff  Control  and Monitoring
     Along with the establishment of permanent vegetation, the  collection,
 treatment, and  on-site  disposal  or  permitted  discharge  of  runoff water  must
 continue.  As  waste organics degrade  and  disturbances  of the land  surface
 decrease  in  frequency and effect,  runoff  water quality will gradually  im-
 prove.   This improvement  is  significant  in  two respects.   First,  better
 quality  runoff  means that  less  rigorous  treatment  may be  needed to  meet
 NPDES  permit conditons.  If a discharge permit had  not  been feasible  be-
 fore,  improved  runoff quality  might make such a permit possible or  econom-
 ically more  attractive.  Second, when runoff monitoring reveals that water
 is practically  free from hazardous  and key nonhazardous constituents,  this
 is one indication  that  closure is nearly complete and  less management  will
 be required  at  the  HWLT unit.
11.1.4.1  Assessing Water Quality


     Various  criteria may  be used  to assess  the  quality of  the  runoff
water.   Certainly the runoff  water should  be analyzed  for  the hazardous
constituents which were  disposed  at  the site.  Water quality criteria  data
should  then be consulted to  determine when  concentrations are acceptable
for direct  discharge.  Most states have developed discharge standards,  but
they  often  do not include  guidelines  on hazardous  constituents and their
metabolites.   In general,  water  quality  criteria  depend  on  the  type  of
receiving stream  or  the uses  to be made  of the  receiving stream.  Water
quality  standards for  drinking water,  for  irrigation,  and  for  watering
cattle  are  given in  Table  6.48.   For organic  constituents,  data on  the
specific biological activity  should  be consulted.  For compounds which are
toxic to organisms present  in the receiving streams, concentrations  should
be less than 10% of the 1059.    Additional  constraints  will  need  to  be
applied to  compounds  which  are bioaccumulated or  which are known  to cause
genetic  damage.    A  supplementary approach  to  chemical  analysis  of   the
Individual  constituents  and their metabolites is  to use bioassay  tests  to
demonstrate the acceptability  of runoff water quality (Section  5.3.2.4).

     Classical indices  of water quality, including  BOD,  COD,  TOG, and  oil
and  grease, are  valuable  as  indications  of changes  in  the  release  of
organics from areas  to  which hazardous  wastes  have  been applied.    The
indices do  not,  however, adequately  assess  the  degree of hazard, nor  do
they provide assurance that the concentrations of  hazardous waste constitu-
ents are decreasing,  since many  hazardous organic  chemicals  are  biologi-
cally active at very low concentrations.

     There  is  only scant information available  on the  concentrations  of
hazardous chemicals or  the  biohazard  in  runoff  water  from soil which  has
been treated with hazardous waste.  However,  there  are data available  for
selected pesticides  which  have   been  applied  to  lawns  or   agricultural
fields.   The data have been summarized by Kaufman  (1974).
                                    572

-------
     Acceptability of  runoff  water  quality for direct discharge  should  be
based on a series of samples taken over a period of time.  Often there will
be  only  one or  two  parameters  of  concern.    The  impact  of  seasonal
variability on the release rate is likely to affect the data, but a general
trend should be evident.  Runoff should be  sampled  at  least  quarterly on a
flow  proportional  basis  from  the  entire hydrograph  of  a  variety  of
antecedent rainfall intensities and  durations.   Samples  should  be obtained
from channels leading  from previously active plots to  the retention ponds
rather than from grab sampling the ponds.  The use of flumes or weirs along
with automated  sample  collectors is  one  possible approach.  Runoff water
quality  acceptability  should  be   based   on  at  least  three  consecutive
sampling events from representative storms.
11.1.4.2  Controlling the Transport Mechanisms


     Chemicals  applied  to  soil may  be transported  in the  runoff  waters
either  in solution or  in association  with suspended  particulate matter.
Water soluble  organics  are often  rapidly  degraded,  so  that  it is antici-
pated that  the major mode  of transport will  be in  association  with sus-
pended  particles.   Thus,  methods  for decreasing runoff and erosion during
closure will probably decrease  the amounts and concentrations of  hazardous
chemicals which enter the  runoff.   Terracing and vegetative cover, both in
the treatment  area  and  in adjacent buffer zones through which  runoff water
will pass, may be  effective  in  trapping suspended solids and thus decreas-
ing transport.

     The  decreased concentration  of  organic  constituents  in runoff water
with time is  likely to depend  on  the mechanisms  and rate of  degradation.
For materials  which are photodegraded, the  amount  of material on the soil
surface  likely to  be  transported will  decrease  rapidly  once cultivation
ceases.    For  compounds  which  are  metabolized  by  microorganisms,   the
decrease  at  the surface will depend on the  impact  of  environmental para-
meters  on the rate  of  decay.   These  factors and  probable decay data  are
discussed in Section 7.2.1.
 11.1.5                           Monitoring
     During  the closure  period  soil core  and  groundwater monitoring  must
continue  as in  the operational  plan.    Soil-pore liquid  sampling may  be
discontinued  90 days  after  the  last  application of waste.   Runoff  water
monitoring  (discussed  above)  and  treatment zone  monitoring are  optional
during  closure.   The  treatment  zone  plan should  be  patterned  after  that
described  as  optional  during active land  treatment unit  operation (Section
9.4.6),  particularly  emphasing  analyses  of  the entire  treatment zone  by
horizon or  depth increments.   Treatment zone monitoring allows the owner or
operator  to make a determination of the degree  of  degradation of hazardous
constituents.    This  type of  monitoring will  also be needed to  obtain  a
variance  from  certain post-closure requirements  if  the  analyses show  no


                                     573

-------
 significant  increase  over  background  of  hazardous  constituents.   Even  where
 a  vegetative cover  is not  required, it may be important  to  establish  vege-
 tation to  control soil erosion.

      Cessation of soil-pore  liquid monitoring is  possible during  closure
 due  to the nature of  the system  and what it is intended  to  detect.   Rapidly
 moving hazardous  constituents are the targets for detection by the  system,
 so movement  of these  constituents would  logically  occur  very soon after  the
 last waste application.  Although soil-pore liquid monitoring may be termi-
 nated 90 days  after the last  waste  application,  it may be wise to continue
 monitoring these  liquids until three  consecutive samples  are free of signi-
 ficant increases of hazardous constituents over background.

      Monitoring of  food chain crops  if  they are  grown  during closure,  is
 also needed  to provide assurance that residual materials  in  the soil  are
 not  being  taken up  by plants  in  concentrations that are  phytotoxic  or that
 could be  bioaccumulated in animals.   There is little  information   at this
 time,  other   than  for  selected  pesticides and  metals,  on the  uptake   of
 hazardous  materials  by crops.    If   food  chain  crops  are  grown  during
 closure, the  pH must  be maintained  at a level sufficient to prevent signi-
 ficant crop  uptake  of hazardous   constituents (e.g.  pH  6.5  or greater)  and
 all  other  food chain  requirements must  be met  (EPA, 1982).  Additionally,
 the  harvested  portion of the  crop should be  determined to be free of  unac-
 ceptable concentrations of hazardous  constituents.
11.2                         POST-CLOSURE CARE
     During  the  post-closure period  management  activities  are  reduced.
Present regulations call for  continuation of post-closure activities  for up
to  30 years  unless  it  can be  demonstrated  that  a  shorter period is
acceptable (EPA,  1982).   The intent of post-closure  care  at a land  treat-
ment unit is to complete waste treatment and stabilization of  the remaining
soil and waste residuals while checking for any unforseen long-term changes
in  the  system.    For  example, if pH  of a  naturally  acidic  soil  has  been
artificially raised to control metal mobility, gradual return  to the  native
soil pH or some new equlllbruim pH may mobilize metals.

     An obvious advantage of  land  treatment is that wastes are degraded or
otherwise made unavailable  to the environment with time.   Other land  dis-
posal techniques, especially landfills  and surface  Impoundments,  present
long-term  risks   of  contaminant  leakage  and  lead  to  continued intensive
monitoring  liabilities.    The   post-closure   monitoring  schedule  may be
relaxed to include a decreasing number of samples over time.   A land  treat-
ment  unit that  has  been  properly  designed,  managed,  and  closed   should
exhibit little  potential for releasing undesirable  constituents  into the
unsaturated zone  or into the groundwater.  A typical  schedule  for soil  core
and groundwater monitoring  following  the  initiation of post-closure  should
include samples collected on a geometric progression  at  1/2,  1, 2, 4, 8, 16
and 30 years.  The  parameters of interest should be  plotted with time and
additional samples  should be taken,  as needed, in  the  event unacceptable


                                    574

-------
concentrations are  found.   Post-closure  care should include activities for
enhancing and  sustaining treatment,  and precautions for  managing against
unacceptable releases (e.g., run-on/runoff controls).  Therefore, treatment
may  be completed  during the  post-closure  care  period without  increased
environmental  risk.   Soil  pH,  nutrient  levels, and  significant physical,
chemical, or biological  disturbances  of  the treatment zone may  all play a
major  role  in  sustaining treatment and  site stabilization.   These factors
should be examined and corrected periodically, if necessary, throughout the
post-closure  care  period  to  ensure  maintenance  of treatment  processes.
Management  should strive,  however, for  a  system  requiring  only minimal
attention since  ultimately  (after 30 years)  all maintenance  may cease and
the system will  then revert to an uncontrolled condition.
11.3                          PARTIAL CLOSURE
     Considerable  management  and expense may  be involved  in  treatment or
on-site  disposal  of runoff water  from large  areas;  therefore,  it  may be
desirable  to  design a land treatment  unit  with plots which  will be care-
fully loaded  to  the CLC  maximum in a few years  or  even  one year, and  then
to proceed  to  close the  area.  In the meantime, waste  would be applied to
new plots  which  would be  opened as needed.   The  system would  need to be
designed so that runoff  water from the individual  plots would be  collected
either  in  separate retention basins, or  in a central  retention basin.  A
more detailed  description of this  type  of design  is  presented in  Section
8.1.2.  Once runoff water  quality  from a  given plot is acceptable, its  run-
off can  then  be  diverted and released under less restrictive permit condi-
tions.   Another  advantage  is that a  portion  of the unit  can be released
from  long-term  post-closure  care  sooner  than  remaining  active   plots.
Finally,  information learned through partial   closure  may be  helpful in
improving  the management  of  active  portions.   The  timetable  for  partial
closure  depends  greatly  on  the rate at which  the waste  constituents of
concern are degraded or  sorbed  by  the soil.
                                     575

-------
                           CHAPTER  11 REFERENCES
EPA. 1982. Hazardous waste management system; permitting requirements for
land disposal facilities. Federal Register Vol. 47, No. 143 pp.
32274-32388. July 26, 1982.

Kaufman, D. D. 1974. Degradation of pesticides by soil microogranisms. pp.
133-202. In W. D. Guenzie (ed.) Pesticides in soil and water. Soil Sci.
Soc.  Amer. Madison, Wisconsin.

Nash, R. G. 1974. Plant uptake of insecticides, fungicides and fumigants
from soils, pp. 257-314. In W. D. Guenzi (ed.) Pesticides in soil and
water. Soil Sci. Soc. Amer. Madison, Wisconsin.
                                    576

-------
                                APPENDIX A
     The enclosed survey was  conducted for EPA by  K.  W.  Brown and Associ-
ates, Inc., during 1980 and some of the information contained  in  the  survey
may be out of date.  In addition, the  source of most of the  information was
permit files and no attempt was made  to verify either the types  or quanti-
ties of the wastes disposed at the listed  facilities.  Even  so, this  survey
provides a useful overview of  hazardous waste  land treatment facilities,
their location and size, and types of  waste disposed.
                                      577

-------
    A Survey  of  Existing Hazardous Waste

          Land Treatment Facilities

                   in  the

                United States
                     by

          K. W.  Brown  &  Associates
       707 Texas Ave. S.,  Suite  207D
       College  Station, Texas  77840
          Contract No. 68-03-2943
              Project Officer

               Carl ton Wiles
Solid and Hazardous Waste Research Division
Municipal Environmental Research Laboratory
   U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
                August 1981

                    578

-------
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                           Page
LIST OF TABLES	111
LIST OF FIGURES	    1v
FUNDAMENTAL NEEDS AND SURVEY OBJECTIVES  	  .  	    1
INFORMATION ACQUISITION 	    3
SURVEY FINDINGS 	    5
                                        579

-------
                                LIST OF TABLES


Table                                                                      Page
  1    Sources consulted for Information listed  1n  the
       survey 	     3

  2    Existing hazardous waste land treatment
       facilities in the United States  	     7
  3    Geographic distribution, by region and state, of
       the 197 facilities described 1n the survey	   44

  4    Industrial classification of land treatment
       facilities	   46

  5    Land treatment usage by Industry 	  ...........   52
                                      580

-------
                                LIST OF FIGURES

Figure                                                                     Page
  1    Area! distribution of land treatment facilities  	  43
  2    Size distribution of land treatment facilities   	  53
                                        581

-------
                     FUNDAMENTAL NEEDS AND SURVEY OBJECTIVES

      The  practice  of land treatment  for  disposing of  various  types  of wastes
 has  been  employed  by  industries  for  a  considerable  number  of  years.   The
 petroleum refinery  industry  has  historically been  the primary industrial user,
 with  records of organized  landfarming  operations  dating  to the  early 1950's
 (Exxon  Co.   U.S.A.,  Personal  Communication).   Even  predating  what  one would
 consider  organized  landfarming,  it  was recognized  in  a  1919  journal  article
 that  oil is  degradable  in soil.  In  the years hence, it became common practice
 to  treat  oily and  leaded  tank  bottoms  by  first  "weathering" them in  soil  to
 degrade the  oil  and oxidize  the  tetraethyl  lead to  less toxic  form.   However,
 it has not been  until the last decade that  land treatment  was recognized as an
 environmentally  sound  and  effective treatment and  disposal   technique  which
 could be useful  for many classes of industrial waste.
     Consequently,   the  data   base   for   determining  what   constitutes   a
 well-designed  land  treatment operation  and  which  wastes are  readily amenable
 to land treatment has been slow to develop.   As the state  of the art advances,
 some past practices have been found to  be inadequate while important design and
 management   considerations   have  begun to   be  understood.    However,  many
 potentially  land treatable wastes have  not  been tested, and many facilities at
 which  land  treatment  is  practiced have   until   recently  lacked  sufficient
 documentation as to their  effectiveness and  environmental  safety.   Therefore,
 the objectives  of  this  survey  are  to:  (I)  identify  the  existing  hazardous
waste land treatment  facilities  in the United States;  (2)  identify  the types
and  amounts  of  hazardous  waste   which  are  being   land  treated  at  these
 facilities;  and  (3)  determine which  industries have member companies  utilizing
 land  treatment.     Such expanded  information can  better  clarify  important
                                      582

-------
research and regulatory concerns  as  well  as lead to a better  prediction of how
a given waste will fare under  the  varied  Influences of  climate, site and soil.
                                       583

-------
                             INFORMATION ACQUISITION

     The   lists   of  land  treatment   facilities,  along  with   the   important
descriptive  information,  were compiled  using  numerous sources  of  information.
A  large  core  of  the  information  was  obtained  from  the  Part  A  RCRA  permit
applications which  are on file in  the  EPA regional  offices.   Eight  of  the  ten
regions  were  visited,  and  their  permit  application  files  were  thoroughly
reviewed.   Of  the  remaining two  regions,  Region  I probably  would not  have
yielded  any  identifications  since  other Information  sources  did not note  any
land  treatment  facilities  in this region.    Other  sources  did note  several
facilities  in  Region  V,  but it was   expected  that   there  would  not  be  many
additional  facilities  in  the regional  files  because  of  the  region's  cold
climatic  regime.    In  addition  to  the EPA  records,  all  of   the  state  and
territorial  environmental  agencies were  contacted,  and,  in  most cases,  these
agencies  willingly  provided information on facilties  under  their jurisdiction.
Although  the bulk of the Information  was obtained from  governmental  agencies,
several other sources  proved  useful in  Identifying  or confirming facilities  and
in providing any missing  data (Table 1).

Table 1.  Sources consulted for information listed  in the survey.
Category	Source	
Governmental       EPA regional offices
                   State environmental  agencies
                   Territorial environmental agencies
Industrial         Industrial  associations
                   Petroleum  refiners
                   Waste disposal companies
                   Disposal  equipment manufacturers
                   Companies  Identified as operating  land treatment facilities.
Other              Literature (e.g., journals,  proceedings,  and  magazines)
                   Environmental  consultants
                                      584

-------
     In accordance with  the survey  objectives,  the  Information  which  was  sought
was  of  a  general   descriptive  nature.    Facility  identifiers  consisted  of
facility  name,  address  and EPA ID number  along  with  the name  and  phone  number
of the environmental contact  person.   Descriptive Information included facility
size  and  the  type  and  amount  of  waste  applied  annually.    The  industry
generating  or disposing of each  waste was also  identified  by  type  and  by its
standard  industrial  classification  (SIC)  code.
                                        585

-------
                                 SURVEY FINDINGS

      The  land  treatment facility  listings  are presented  in various  ways  for
 user convenience.  The  master  list is a  table  containing  all of  the acquired
 information  and categorized according to  facility  location  (Table  2).  Table 3
 is  a tally of  the  number of facilities  in  each state and  region  totaling  197
 facilities.   As  expected,  land  treatment is most  frequently utilized  in  the
 South,  Southeast and West  (Regions  VI,  IV and  IX),  where warm  climate allows
 year-round  operations  and  where the  petroleum  refining   industry,   the  most
 frequent  user of land treatment, is concentrated.  Selected  information about
 all  facilities  is  rearranged  into  a listing  according  to  industrial  waste
 source  (SIC  code)  in Table 4.   Summarizing  land treatment  use  by industry
 (Table  5), the  petroleum refining industry is by  far  the biggest user with  101
 facilities.   Other industries  which  have  several  locations  relying  on  land
 treatment include  commercial   disposers,  which  land  treat  largely  petroleum
 industry  wastes,  and the  Industrial   organic  chemicals  and  wood  preserving
 industries.
     Some broad observations about  facility  characteristics  may  be enlightening
 at this point.   First, of the 182 facilities for which areas  are reported,  the
 facility  sizes  range  from 0.005 to  1668 acres;  however,  the  median size is only
 13.5  acres.   Therefore,  although there  are  a few very  large facilities,  the
 distribution  1s strongly skewed toward the small  facilities,  as  illustrated by
 a bar  graph  (Figure 2).   Second, with regard  to  quantities of  waste applied,
 the  range is  similarly  very large.   However,  the  methods used by  industry  for
 reporting waste quantities  were Inconsistent and yielded questionable results.
For  instance, a  common method was where a permit applicant  reported the applied
quantity of a listed  waste  stream and then separately listed  the quantities of
                                       586

-------
the waste stream components.  Such  an  approach  would  yield a double accounting
of  some  wastes.   Additionally,  a  listed  waste  stream  can  vary  widely  from
company to  company  (e.g.,  water  content,  metals  content), and  one waste  type
can  differ  greatly  from  the  characteristics  of  another.     Therefore,
generalizations about waste type  and quantity results are  not possible.
                                       587

-------
Table 2.  Existing hazardous waste land
          United States.
                         treatment facilities 1n the
Region
I
State
Connecticut
Maine
Massachusetts
New Hampshire
Rhode Island
Vermont
Region State
VI Arkansas
Louisiana
New Mexico
Oklahoma
Texas
  II
 III
  IV
New Jersey
New York
Puerto Rico
Virgin Islands

Del aware
District of Columbia
Maryland
Pennsylvania
Virginia
West Virginia

Alabama
Florida
Georgia
Kentucky
Mississippi
North CarolIna
South Carolina
Tennessee

Illinois
Indiana
Michigan
Minnesota
Ohio
Wisconsin
 VII
VIII
  IX
  Iowa
  Kansas
  Missouri
  Nebraska

  Colorado
—Montana
  North Dakota
  South Dakota
  Utah
  Wyoming

  American Samoa
  Arizona
  California
  Commonwealth of the
    Northern Marianas
  Guam
  Hawaii
  Nevada

  Alaska
  Idaho
  Oregon
  Washington
                                    588

-------
                                              EPA         PlMMlMMr                     TW« Md                         iMtwtrld Sourc.            MtfltloMl

      •ml Mdrws                           10 Mn*i«r       and Co«tKt        Sli* («cr«s)    tat. Hast* (t/yr)                 SIC   OMcrlptlon           UfonMtlo*






                                                          ID DC BEST OF OUt mOMLBKC. 1MERC ME NO UNDFMMS  IN THIS REGION
on
CO
lO

-------
                                                                                            REGION II
       and Address
                                                  EPA
                                                ID Nuetoer
                 Phon* Nueber
                 and Contact
                Type and
Slz. (acres)     tat. Mast*  (t/yr)
Industrial  Source
SIC    Doscr Ipt Ion
Additional
Information
       State of Men Jersey

       Exxon Refinery
       MOO Park Ave.
       linden. (Union Co.) MJ 07036

       Texaco USA
       Box 98
       Nestvllle. NJ 08093
       Location
       Junction o< Hwy. 295 t 130
       N.  Deptford. NJ
MJT000029447     201/474-0100
                 Royal Altreuter
                                        6.5
                                                   K049  I05t KO5I 8500
                 609/843-8000           I* 1/4      KOJO; KOSt; K052
                 R. J. Flschbach      acre plots
                                                  2911   Refinery
                                                  29)1   Retlnery
                                                                                Temporarily  Inactive.
                                                                                Per*It  Is Mltlng N.J.
                                                                                ray I sad  rags.  State
                                                                                penult  expired I960.
       State of Me» York

       Borden Chemical  A t C OlvUlon
       108-112 N.  Main Street
       Balnbrldge (CtwnangoCo.)  MY 137}}
MVDOO069IMS
                 M8/WI-2IU
                 Raywmd Ned linger
                                                   U1BB 250
                                                  3999   Liquid t solid
                                                         resins aanu.
Ln
vo
       Virgin Islands

       Hess Oil  Virgin Islands Corp.
       P. 0. Box 127
       Klngsvllle, St. Crolx OO8»0
VITOOOOI0025
                 809/773-1101
                                        32
                                                   K05X) 200; KOSI  15,512; K052 7.4    2911   Refinery
       Puerto Rico

       Carbareon Services
       Phillips Core
       Guayava, Puerto Rico

       Serai las Dost (Merles
       Ponce, Puerto Rico

       Travenul tabs
       Trujlllo Alto
                 809/835-1678
                 Carlos Bartolcoe'

                 809/8M-I5I5
                 Rolando H. Mendel

                 809/843-1000
                 Sra. Silvia Santiago

                 809/762-0050
                                                                                Have applied  for  land
                                                                                treatment pern It

                                                                                Have applied  for  land
                                                                                treatment para It

                                                                                Have applad  tor  land
                                                                                treatment pemlt

                                                                                Have applied  for  land
                                                                                treatment pern It

-------
                                                                                           KEBION  III
Ul
Nan*
and Address
Stat* 0« Delaware
Getty Refining 1 Marketing Co.
Mrangla Hill Md.
Del a«are City. DE 19706
St»t» of Maryland
Chevron USA Inc.
1913 Chesapeake Ave.
Bait Inure. M> 21226
Taaneco Chaalcals. Inc.
•artca M.
Chestertowt, M> 21620
State o* Pennsylvania
Arco Petroleua Product* Co.
Passyink Aye.
Philadelphia. PA
G.R.O.W.S. tic. Uatfllll
BordentoM t NM Ford Mill M.
Horrllvllle. (Bucks Co.) PA 19067
State ol »lral»l»
AMOCO Oil Co.
479 GoodulK Neck Rd.
TorktoM. VA 236SO
Hercules. Inc.
Off H»y. f*
FrwiklU, VA 23851
EPA Phone Muaber Type en« Industrial Sourc* Additional
in **+mr aed Contact Sit* (acre*) Aat. Haste It/yr) SIC Description Inforaatbn
KD002I297M 302/B34-6I62 47 K04S 260Q; K049 910% N»0 M( 2911 Refinery
Richard W. ladd M»l 2600; K032 MM
Prof. Special lit
ND09936S6II6 MI/J5J-7800 0.75 K046, K0» 2911 R^l.^y IF .Ite Is currentl y
JaM* P. NcOweii '••ct '»• "~" '
Rel. Manqar
MDOOOia90060 301/778-1991 2.0 UOM 200j U069 IJ; 0002 4250 222 Weaving all Is
H. Grubar lynthetlcs
Plant HaMger
PA00022B9700 2 15/J 39-2000 13.5 K048 11.600; K049 IMOj KO5I 200 2911 Refinery
George Snlth
Env. Manager
PA000004JBI8 2I5/29J-8II4 64 Industrial landfill leachate 49J3 Refusa syttaa Waste aanunt Is wknom.
Rhett 0. RagsdaU
President
VAOO»OM03»7 804«»»-973» 45. 73 K04» 2.3i W»0 6.5; KO3I ISO; 2911 Refinery
Norton Boston. Jr. K0» 264
EC 1 S Supt.
VA0003I22MI 804^62-3121 2.J F003 76.700 2911 Refinery
Henry J. Edxln
Plant Manager

-------
                                                                                    MGMON I*
Name EPA
and Address . ID Number
State of Alabama
BTOM Mood Preserving Co.. Inc. AL0082066I92
County M. 34
BrcMivllla (Ncrthport),
(Tuscaloosa Co.) AL 35476
Evans Transportation Co. ALOOM 54764)
P. 0. Box 958
Mar ley Mill Rd.
Ozark. (Dale Co.) AL 36360
Hercules, Inc. ALO004009t63
P. 0. Box 190
NcAdcry Jet.
Bessemer. (Jaf (arson Co.) AL 35020
Hunt Oil Co. TescalooM Refinery ALD004009320
P. O. Bw 1850
Sanders Ferry Rd.
Tuscaloosa. (Tuscaloosa Co.) AL 35401
Maxuett Are AL0570024I82
3800 Air Base, Group Dae
Maxvel 1 AFB (Montgomery Co.) AL 361 12
Plantation Pipeline Co.. HE Facility AL00843673I7
Skelby County Rd. 52
Helena. (Shelby Co.) AL 35080
Ret table Metal Products. Inc. ALD03I6I2732
P. 0. Box 580
Hvy. 27 North Rt. 1
Geneva. (Geneva Co.) AL 36340
T. R. Millar Mill Co.. Inc. ALD008I6I4I6
Treating Plant
708 Olar St.
Bravton. (Escambla Co.) AL 36426
State of Florida
Vmco. Inc. FLD064675978
Rt. 2 Box IA
Hllduood, (Sumtar Co.) FL 32785
Ben Hill Griffin. Inc. FLD000823369
P. 0. Box 127
A 1 t IIS 29 t Fifth Ava.
Frostproof. (Polk Co.) a 33843
Holly Mill Fruit Products Co. FLTI3OOI034I
Springfield
P. 0. Box 708
PIlOlM MUeffatr+f"
and Contact SUe (acres)
205/339-4666 10
Ray 0. Bobo.
Vlce-Pres.
205/774-2621 1.38
M. E. Baxter
Plant Hjr.
205/428-2391 1
Herbert Kn Igkt
Tech. Supv.
205/758-6675 21
Ted Johnson
Coord, of Safety
205/293-6908 0.01
Lt. John Mlkulkn
404/261-2137 8.5
George Jeff ares
Supv. Engineer
205/684-362) 5
Jeees E. McOovell
Finishing Manager
2O5/B67-433I 1
R. Bert Hevk
HP, Treating
904/748-1313 4.4
Albert Hresh
Plnnt Engineer
813/635-2251 330
Preston Troutman
Vlce-Prasldent
813/422-1131 54
John H. May
Vice-President
Type end
Amt. Waste (t/yr)
KOOI 9
U002 1; U05I 1; UOI9 0.5;
III 05 1; 0054 1; UII5 0.5;
UI54 1; UI39 1; UI65 1;
UI69 1; UI22 0.3; UI88 1;
UI90 1; 0147 1; U220 1
F005 0.05; U002 0.25
F003 12,500; K044 1300
K048 69; K049 5: K052 1;
K03I proposed; KO87 proposed
0008 0.15; solvent*, nste oil/
lubricants
0000 37.3; tank btm sludge
3 tanks/yr
F002 1.43; F003 0.94; FOI8 0.03
KOOI 1 s 0004 0.01 ; 0005 0.01 ;
P090 0.5; 0051 0.1
K063 31
0001 0.005; 0002 500 caustic;
P053 0.001; PI05 0.001; U044
0.001 ; UI22 0.001 ; UI44 0.001 ;
UI59 0.001; UI88 0.001; IBM 0.001
UI54 0.001; 0001 O.03; D002
250 caustic
Ind us 1r let Source Additional
SIC Description Internet KM
2491 Mood preserving
3743 RR eqtdpeant repair Tank car cleaning effluent
2892 Explosives menu.
2911 Refinery
9711 National security
29 Petroleum prod.
349 Alunlnum prod.
2491 Mood preserving
3498 Steel pipe menu.
203 Citrus processing
2O3 Fruit processing
U.S. Hoy. 17 t 92 at M. Blvd.
Davenport, (polk Co.) FL  3)837

-------
REGION IV (continued)
Naae
and Address
01 In Corp.
P. 0. Box 222
Corner of US 98 I SR 363
St. Marks (Makulla) FL 32355
Orange Co. of Florida, lac.
P. 0. Box 391
U.S. 17 South
Bar tow, (Polk Co.) FL 33830
Tropical Circuits Inc.
P. 0. Box 21355
1981 SH 36 St.
Ft. lauderdale, (Broward Co.) FL 33319
Tyndall AfB
4756 Air Base Group/DEEV
U.S. H»y. 98 110 Biles E. Pane»a City)
Tyndall AFB (Bay Co.) FL 32403
State of Georgia
|f> ABOCO Oil Co. Savannah Refinery
Foundation Dr.
Savannah, (Chat has Co.) GA 31408
General Electric Co.
P. 0. Box 9646
MM Savannah Rd.
Augusta, (RIchBond Co.) GA 30906
Gilbert I Bennett Manu. Corp.
Liberty Hill Rd..
Meadow Brook Ind. Park
Toccoa, (Stephens Co.) GA 30877
Gl Iddea C 1 R Dlv. of SCM Corp.
P. 0. Box 296
White Rd.
Oakvood. (Hall Co.) GA 30966
Southern Mills Inc. Senola Dlv.
P. 0. Box 218
Andrews Pkwy.
Senola. (Coweta Co.) GA 30276
union Carbide Agricultural Co. Inc.
P. O. Box 428
Harrltt's Bluff Rd.
Woodbine. (Ca«Jen Co.) GA 31969
MB. Wrlgley. Jr. Co.
Routes 13 1 365
Flowery Branch, (Hall Co.) GA 30542
EPA
ID NuBber
FL004 7096 924



FLD059396842



FL00831 14421


FL 1570024 124


GAD003292877


GAD06069920*



GAT 000606164.



GAT000622985


GA0079386694


GA0030033356



GADO562O67I »


Phone NuBber
and Contact Size (acres)
904/923-61 1 1 25
J. R. Katie
Dlr. PDR t COCO op

813/533-0551 40
Deae Hayes
Tech. Dlr.

305/467-3771 0.13
Robert G. Selth
V Ice-President

904/283-4354 83
Arturo McDonald
Env. Coord.


912/964-6130 1
John Consldlne
Supv. Environ.
404/793-7610 0.23
Francis E. NlBBons
Shop Manager

4O4/8B6-81 36 4
Grant Prable
Plant Manager

404/967-2030 2.2
Howard J. Norton
Plant Manager

404/599-6659 1 1
Clyde C. Lunsford
Plant Manager

912/265-0180 5
D. B. Cunningham
Dept. Head EA/O.H.

404/967-6181 5
Joseph M. Hajek
Factory Manager
Type and
Aat. Haste (t/yr)
K044, K046 - total 250



0001 0.03; 0002 250 caustic;
PI20 0.001


F006 1.25; F009 0.5


0001 18; 0002 0.2; 0006 0.53;
FOI7 22.5; UI59 1.25; U220 0.42;
U238 0.21 U239 0.09; Ind. 18.230


K03I 250; DOOI 2; D002 1 ; D003 5


0002 9.34



K063 283: K062 285



K079 1564


U004 19.1; U239 0.05; UI23 16.2


P070 17347



FOOI 0.68; DOOI 1.85; D002 1.44


Industrial Source
SIC Description
348 Ordnance



203 Fruit processing



3679 Pr Intel circuit
board Banu.


9711 National security


2911 Refinery


3589 Ind. aqul pewit repair



3496 Wire products Banu.



2851 Paints 1
allied products


222 Heaving Bills
synthet Ics


2879 Pesticides



2067 Chewing gun Banu.


Additional
Inf oraat Ion




Sprayfletd






Spray Irrigation





Stea* cleaner ef fluant



Steel red cleaning
ef f 1 tant



Spray Irrigation













-------
NEBUM If (cant In
Nan*
and Address
State of Kentucky
Borden Chemical A t C
6200 Caan Ground Rd.
Louisville, (Jefferson Co.) KY 40216
General Electric Co.
Appliance Park Bldg. 1-312
Louisville. (Jefferson Co.) KY 4O223
Lexington - Blue Grass Depot Activity
Haley Rd.
Lexington. IFayette Co.) KY 40311
State of Mississippi
Anerada He»s Corp.
P. O. BOK 425
U.S. H»y. II
Purvis. UMT Co.) MS 39473
<-" Anarlcan Bosck Electrical Products
*£ P. 0. Box 2228
••*• McCrary Rd.
Colunbus. (Lowndes Co.) MS 39701
Chevron Refinery
P. 0. Box 1300
Bayou Cssotte
Ind. Hry.
Pascagoula, MS 39367
Coppers
P. O. Box 160
Tie Plant. MS
Pearl River Mood Preserving Corp.
P. 0. Box N
1900 Rosa St.
Picayune. (Pearl River Co.) MS 39466
Plantation Pipeline Co.
H»y. 588
Collins ICovlngton Co.) MS 39428
Rogers Rental t Landfill - Exxon
P. O. Box 123
Ceatrevllle. MS 39611
State of Mart* Carol Ine
XVI 1 1 Airborne Corps t Fort Bragg
At In. AF2A-FE-CE Butaar t Rallly Rds.
fort Bragg. (Cumberland Co.» *C 2B3O7
EPA
ID Number

KYD03383209I
KYD00638702I
KYO2IO02030)
MS007946I406
MSD0040I0724
NSOO34I79401

M500081 94144
MSO2WOIO27I
MSD03 3453009

MC82UM20I2I
Phone Mucuber
and Contact Slie (acres)

302/447-1322 10
Harold Armstrong
Eng. Manager
302/432-3934 4.8
Morris Mosar
Env. Program Mgr.
606/293-4201 13
Gary L. Matcalf
Civil Engineer
601/794-8021 34
S. Lonnes
Ref. Mgr-
601/328-4 150 7.8
Join W. East
Ind. Eng. Hjr.
601/938-4290 13
Bob Wallace
601/226-4301 3
Ray Bart la,
601/798-8603 20
R. B. Jones
VP i Gen. Mjr.
404/261-2137 0.17
George Jeff ares
601/643-5972 72.5
Lynn Wallace

919/396-8207 100
Bruce Parker
Env. Officer
Type erd Ind in
Ant. Waste (t/yr) SIC

0000 3 3999
F006 3700 3999
0001. 0003 • total 600 348
K04B 2750; K05I . K049. K050 - 291 1
total 310; K052. PI 10 • total 3.3
OO06; 0008 3621
K048 230; K049 80O, K05I ISO 291 1
2491
KOOI 1 2491
DOOO 30 29
K048, MMT blast udoe 60,000 2911

0002, ISOOO - total 30.3; OO02. 971 1
DOOO • total 6.3; 0002, 0000 •
total 0.85; 0002. DOOO - total 2.3
ilrlal Source
Description

Menu. Ind.
Hone appliance aanu.
Ordnance
Refinery
Motors eaiui.
Refinery
Mood preserving
Hood preserving
Petroleum prod.
Ref 1 nary

tot tonal security
Additional
Information

Blotludga LT
Electroplating sludge
Amy supply depot

LF site Is currently
Inactive (7-81)

IF site Is currant! y
Inactive (7-81)





           0000 1.3; 0000 3.3;  0092, DOOO
           total 13.3;  0002.  DOM.  0003 -
           total 3; UI22 0.6; U2M  0.3; 0000.
           D002 - total 0.6;  DOOO 0.6

-------
RGBION IV Icarthwea)
Na»e EPA
and Address ID Nueber
FlMtex Inc. - Soutkera Dlv. NCDO063273I3
Box 164
Heckett Street
Spencer, (Ro.au Co.) MC 281)9
General Electric Co. NCO079044426
P. 0. Box 863
Spartanbwg H.y.
East Flat Rock. (Henderson Co) NC 2*726
Neuse River Westenter Treatment Plant NCT3M010496
P. 0. Box 590 Utility Oept.
End of Battle fld. le (felhnin Co.) SC 29169
General Electric Co. SCD030092373
2490 Debonair Street
Charleston, (Charleston Co.) SC 29403
Sandoz Inc. Mart la Works SCOOB2228347
H»y. 102
Martin. (M lendale Co.) SC 29836
end Contact Slie (acres)
704/633-B028 1
Anthony F. Bo It on
.704/S93-2378 21.7
Bernard Under
Mgr. Qua). Assur.
919/179-2010 426
flllly R. Creeck
S*p*r Intend ant
919/136-6901 0.9
Henry UBracque
Env. Coord.
919/479-1348 6
Charles Thaggard

803/576-6821 7
John Broadnax
Plant Manager
615/246-2111 31.4
Jas. Edvards
Mgr. Clean Env.
803/T47-7644 0.06
Stephen Wilson
Shop Manager
6DV5M-432I 26
W. B. Yarborough
VP, Works Manager
Type and Industrial Source Additional
tat. Waste (t/yr) SIC Description Information
UI94 3.63; UI47 0.13; i)009 0.01; 229 Mlac. textile goods
POO) 1.0)
F006 300 3641 tlgarina fixtures ElectrcplarJre) operatloei
•anu. sludge
FOOI 0.6; F007 1.4; FON 19; 3471 Plating
FOI7 0.73
00030.1) 9711 National (ecurlly
UI22 9 249 Mlac. «ood prolucts

D006. 0007. FOOI, F002. F003, 289* Misc. cheekal prod.
F004, F003. F006, F007, F008.
F009. K052, P049, U002. U007,
UOOt, 11009. UOI2, UOI7. UOI9.
U03I. U037. 11043, (1044, IBM,
U092, UII2. UII3, III 19, UI22,
III 40, UI47. UI54, UI59. UI62.
1116), UI88, UI97. U2I9, U220.
U226. IBM, U239, 0001. D002.
0003 - total 8000
F002, F003. F005 - total 9.1 289 Misc. cnaelcal prod. In tfce p-ocess of
dellstlifl itastes.
0002 5 3589 Ind. eqidpemt repair
FOOS 3.5; UW2 3.5; U009 .03; 229 Misc. textile goods
U092 .06; UI69 6

-------
                                                                                      REGION IV (ccatlnuM)
NaM
and M4r«»
                                                  EPA
                                               ID Muafcar
                                                        Pbona Nuabar
                                                        and Contact
                                                                                  Slia facr«M
            lypa  mot
            tat.  Mast*  (t/yr>
Industrial  Source
SIC    Description
Mdlt fond
InfoTBat loo
Shan *FB
363 C3GAXEV 7 •!!«* H. «f Su.t«r
Hry. 37J
SiMtar Co.. 9D 79132
                                              SC7S70024466
                                                               601/668-8110 EX 325)
                                                               Kwmath Man
                                                               Env. Coord.
BOO         POO I  ,012; POO4 .OOOJj. M2i »0lej.
            P042  .071; POM .007; PO»» .007;
            PI03  .0001;  PI2J .06 tffri UK»
            .012; U002 .042; 0034 ,00«j  UOJJ
            .00&; 003& .004; U344 .014; UOM
            .001; U075 .021; 0080 .042; U1I7
            .001; UI21  .001; U134 .004; U138
            .01;  U1M .006; UI54 .02; Ul«
            .041; U161  .042; U18B .024; ICOO
            .006; U20I .006; U205 .OO6; U2IJ
            .001; U220  .0); U223  .007; U226
            .0};  U228 S.25; U259 .05; D006
            .007; DOOJ  .007
                                                                                                                                    9TII   Mat Icnol  s«cir Ity
            ol
      Vapahoa Gtt«ilc*ls Inc.
      P.  O.  Box 480
       Nntpirt, (Cock* Co.) IN 37621

Ui     McGhM Tr*on Air Nat I. Guard ftas*
vo     McGhH Tvton Alrpcrt
                  
-------
                                               REGION V
     fPA         PbaM Muriiw                       Typ* a«d
  10 Nuntwr       and Contact        Slo locrasl    A»t. Wait* (t/yr>
                                                                                                                               Industrial  Sourca
                                                                                                                               SIC    Dascrlptlon
                                                                                                                                                            Additional
                                                                                                                                                            Inforutlon
 Stata of  Illinois

 Marathon  Oil
 »9 S. Main Street
 Flndlay.  OH 45840
 Location
 Marnthon  Av*.
 Robinson. IL

 Mubll Oil
 P. 0. Box 874
 Jollatt.  IL 60434

Union Oil Co. of California
 LuMat, IL
                  6ie/»44-2l2l       ItaavallabU     Oily -ait a
                  Larry McCrlvy
 IUM6440IIM     615/42 J-5571       tkuvallabl*
                                                                                       2911    Roll nary
                                                                                       Uhav.llatl.
                                                                                                                                                            Aaauat of vast* Is
                                                                                                                                                            i«avallabl<.
                                                                                                                    LF lit* w>s closed 10/80.
                                                                                                                    Proposed If facility.
Stat* of  Indian*

Indian* far. Byraan Coo.. Auoc.         IND04490»663     •l2/Me-434l           14
P. 0. Box 271                                            Gary to*kr
Mt. »«f«on. IN 47620

Rock Island Rafl.1.0, Cora.               IMM064I7430     317/291-1200           40
5000 H. Both Srraat                                      Ml 11 Ian t. Laqua
Indianapolis, IN 4626*
                                                    KOfl. Mil - total 25.0OO
                                                    ItVaoath
                                                                                                                              2911   Raflnary



                                                                                           K049, MM. KOSI, KOJ2 « total 312 2911   Raflaary
                                                                                                                    30 acr*s uud for 1  tlaa
                                                                                                                    only a?pl., 10 «cr« ar*
                                                                                                                    curriMtly 1* usa.
Stata of Michigan

Slapson Paper Co.
Vlcksburg. Ml
MI00492406M     6I6/649HWIO
                 ftaynund Wagnar
                                                                             3-19 acra
                                                                               flald*
                                                                                           Prlnary clarl liar owtn «t*r
                                              2611   Pyltalll
                                              2621   Papar Hill
Spray Irrigation.  Alfalf*
Is karvwtad on 2 flatds.
Stat* of Minnesota

Conocu Inc.
Carlto*. MM

Kocn Raflnary
P. O. Box 43S96
St. Paul MN 55164
                                                         2M/M4-4I74


                                        MMOOO*I«I30I      612/437-4141
M>


12
                                                    All  oily  M»t*s  and  talosludg**     2911   Raflnvy
                                                    Sap MM  1; OAF t  dlgastlv*
                                                    rasldiMt  50; tank  claanlng
                                                    raxldoas  SO; prv-coat  III tar
                                                    raslduat  15; flar* drum raslduas
                                                    2;  dasaltar rasldws 2
                                                                                      2911   Raflnary
Stat* of Ohio

a cos
5092 AtMT M.
M111 laanburg, OH 4SI76
0)001743)744
                 SIVoBI-5731
                 Hary Bauar
                                       2»
                                                                                             *•'•*• sr*t<
                                                                                                                                                            f •"*•
                                                                                                                                                            Inactlva

-------
REGION V (continued)



















in
VD
Co






Nee*
and Address
Fondessey Enterprise
FEI Landlam Sight «
Cedar Point t Wayne Rd.
Oregon, OH
Fondessey Enterprise
FEI Landlana Sight /3
Oupoiit Rd.
Oregon. OH
Fondessey Enterprise
FEI landfane Sight 14
•76 Otter Creek M.
Oregon. OH
Gull Oil Co. US
P. 0. Box ?
Cleves, OH 4)002
Gull Oil
Toledo. Oil
Standard Oil Co.
Cedar Pt. Rd.
Toledo. 01 436*4

Standard 01 1 Co. (Ohio)
11)0 S. Hotcalf St.
Una, Oil 4)804
Sunoco Refinery
Betveen Browi 1 Dickie 1 1-280
Toledo. OH
EPA Phone Number
ID NuMber and Contact
OHS00072I4I5 419/726-1)21
Jaem Heallto*


OHG00072I42) 419/726-1)21
James MM II ton


OHGO45243706 419/726-1)21
Jaees Hamilton


4IV353-3400
Ed Maxy

419/698-8040

CMX»»057M2 419/693-0771
E. J. Stehel


01000)0)1826 419/226-2300
R. F. Guenthar

419/691-3)61
Ed Mohler
Env. Coord.
Type and Industrial Source Additional
Size (acres) tat. Weste (t/yr) SIC Description Intonation
49 Petro. sludges 24)0 2911 Rellnery



14 Petro. sludges 2490 2911 Refinery



2) Petro. sludges 312) 2911 Refinery



3.) K0)l 2911 Refinery Proposed LF. Will begin
operation apfx-QK. 10-dl.

4 K0)lj K0)2 2911 Refinery

20 K048. K049. K0)l • total 15.600 2911 Refinery



10 K04«. K049, K05I • total 938 2911 Refinery


8 x 1)0' plots K048; M»l; K0)2 2911 Refinery Proposed LF to tog In
operation •ld-1982.


-------
                                                                                            REGION VI
vO
Name EPA
and Address ID Mjmber
State of Arkansas
Arkansas Eastman Co. ARO089234M4
(01*. ot Eastman Kodak Co.l
P. 0. Box 511
Klngsport. TM 17662
location
&ap Road
BatesvllU. Aft 72501
Tosco Core. AMM0002I998
McHenry Ave.
El Dorada. (Union Co.) Aft 71730
Stale of Louisiana
Cho»roo Chemical Co. LAOOJ4 199802
P. 0. Box 70
LA Hwy. 21
Bella Chase. (PlaquamUes Parish) LA 7O037
Cities Service Co. LAOOOMM01XI
P. 0. Box 1562
LA Ikry. 106
Lake Charles. LA 706O2
Conoco Inc.. Lake Charles Rel leery LA0990o«J7l6
P. 0. Box 37
Old Spanish Trail
Westlake. LA 70669
Exxon Co. USA Baton Rouge Rel leery LAD062662M7
P. 0. Box SSI
404S Scenic Hwy.
Baton Rouge, (E. Baton Rouge Parish) LA 70807
Gulf Oil Co. - U.S. LADOS602439I
Alliance Rel leery
p. 0. Box 39*
LA Hwy. 23 S.
Bella Cnasse, (Plaquemlnes Perish) LA 70017
Gulf Oil Corp. LA004I5I48II
P. 0. Drawer 6
Tidewater Rd.
Venice. (Plaquemlnes Parish) LA 70091
Marathon Oil Co. LA Rellnlng Dlv. LAD08I999724
P. 0. Cox AC
U.S. Hwy. 61
Garyvftte (St. John the Baptist Co.). LA 70091
Murphy Oil Corp. LAD008OM47I
P. 0. Box 100
St. Barnard Ihiy.
Phone Number Type and
and Contact Size (acres) Amt. Haste (t/yr)
615/246-2111 66
James C. Edwards
Minager CEP
501/862-8111 5
Donald Comer
Eiv. Engineer
504/194-4)20 IO
E. C. Hofmeen
E«v. Specialist
318/491-6318 22
Mm. A. Madsack
Env. Sup.
JIB/491-5222 6.9
Irv. F. Wagner
Ret. Manager
504/359-8430 14.6
Robert Denbo
Env. Coord.
S04/656-77II 9
Charles Sanders
Process Engr.
504/514-74 52 0.65
Charles Coarser
Director Proc. Engr.
504/535-2241 4
.. E. Oous
Env. Coord.
504/271-4141 3
All den rrederlckson
My. GP i E

K048 2I.70O; K049 17,940

KO48; KOSI; KD52
0007 4257; KO48 1419
K048 45.500; K049 1400;
KOSI 12.100
K04B MOO; K049 WOO; K050 500;
KOSI 1000; 0002 100
K048 175; K049 ISO; K050 75;
KOSI 75; OOO2 20
K.048 17; KO49 14; K050 i;
KOSI 35; K052 .1; 0001 220
K048 1400; KO5I 220O
Industrial Source Additional
SIC Description Information
2865 Organic Intermediates LF site Is currently
2869 led. organic chemicals Inactive (7-81)
2911 Refinery
2869 Ind. organic dtemlcals LF site Is currently
Inactive (7-81)
2911 Refinery Amt. of waste wasn't
recorded In the past.
2911 Refinery
4441 Marine terminal
2911 Rail nary
2669 Ind. organic chemicals
2911 Rel leery
1321 Natural gas proc.
2911 Rail nary
2911 Rail nary
2911 Refinery
      Maraux.  (St.  Barnard Co.l  LA 7007}

-------
                                                                                 REGION VI  (continued)





ON
O
0





Ham*
and Address
Plantation Pip* UM Co.
MO Facility
P. O. Box 18616
Atlanta. GA
Location
Blount Road
Baton Rouge. LA 70607
Rollins Environmental Services
P. 0. Box 7J877
13351 Scenic Mvy.
Baton Rouge, (E. Baton Rouge Paris*) LA
Shall Oil Co.
P. 0. Box 10
Rlvar Road
Norco, (St. Charles Parish) LA 7007*
Shrevepart Sludge Disposal Facility
P. O. Box 3006}
H»y. I
Shreveport. (Cadda Parish) LA 71 IS!
Taxaco USA (Olv. of Taxoco Inc.)
P. O. Box 37
Convent. (St. Jaaws Paris*) LA 7072}
State o« MM Max lea
Ole*a tieath Co.
49OI E. Hal*
FarBlngtan. (San Juan Co.) Ml B74OI
Shell Oil Co. Inc.
Mlngale Star Rt.
Gallup, (NcKlnley Co.) IM 87101
Hhlte Sands Nlssll* Range
Stow* FE
Unite Sands Mlsslla Rang* (Dona An* Co.
State ol OMa*o»e
Basin Retlalng Inc.
P. O. Box 916
1001 N. Porter Straet
Ohnulgae lOkmulgee Co.) OK 74447
Chaaolln Petroleua Co.
P. O. Box SSI
26th t HI lion
EPA
10 MmtMM-
LAD0007262Z4
LAOOI0399I27
70607
LADOHO&S79I
LA0000709774
LA006»4aSI46
NMXM7I053M
WC00013I2II
W07S02II255
I. M< 66002

OK000499622S
OK0007214SM
Phona Hi—bar
and Contact Slza (ocras)
404/261-2117 S4
Caorga Jaf lores
Sup. Eng 1 naer
SO4/776-I234 60
Charles Calllcott
Vice President
S04/44I-7767 1.6
H. L. Caughaan
Env. Can.
318/797-7550 353
Halter A. Klrkpatrlck
Superintendent
504/562-3MI 37.3
Jerry Brinjiur
Sup. A i HC
505/J2i-450a 600 II.2
Rodney Haath
Pros 1 dent
SOS/722-3133 IS
C. D. Shook
Supt of Operation
505/678-5924 3.S
Francis R. Gelsel
Col. CE

9I8/756-4600 4
G. E. Moore
Vice President t
Can era 1 Manager
405/233-7600 13.4
Bruce Hadgde*
Type and Industrial Source Additional
A«t. Haste (t/yr) SIC Description Intonation
0000 165 2911
K046 30.100 49S3
MSI 67S; W»2 3*0; PUO 20; 2911
0001 20; OOOI 1000; O007 MOO 2821
0004 .011; 0005 .767; 0006 .005; 49S3
0007 .26; 0008 .26; 0009 .0015;
0010 .026; 0011 .26
K049 501.356; KO50 25; KO5I SKI; 2911
K052 6.5; PI 10 1; 0007 I2.4SO; 2619
0007 700 4463
5171
FOI7 300 gal Ions 349
KOSO 1; KOS2 t. MM* 2.S; 2911
KOM 250
000) .06; 0009 .0001; 001 1 .0001; 9711
OOOI .07; 0002 1.37; 0003 13.65;
0004 16.25

K046 92; KO49 2160 2911
K046 634; K049 S004; KOSI 62S.S; 2911
KOS2 10.4
Refinery
Refuse systems
Red nary
Plastic MtM-lals.
synthetic r*slncf and
nonvu la* liable elastawrs
Refuse systaas
Refinery
Sulfur recovery
Marine cargo handling
Patroleu* terminal
Fabricated natal FOI7 Is paint thinner.
Refinery
National security

Refinery
Refinery
Enid. (GarHeld Co.) OK  73701

-------
                                                                                 MBICM VI  (continued)
Naa» EPA
and Address ID Maetiir
Conoco lac. Pone* City ONM07233836
P. 0. Box 1267
1000 S. Pine
Ponca City. (Kay Co.) OK 74601
Dayton Tire 1 Rubber Co. 00000803205
P. 0. BOM 24011
2900 S. Council
Oklahona City. (OklahoM Co.) OK 73124
Hudson Refinery 00082471988
P. O. Box HII
401 M. Maple
Cusblng. OK 74023
Kerr McGee Refinery Corp. OO000396949
P. 0. BOM 309
906 S. Powel 1
tfyaneirocd. (Gary In Co.) OK 73098
Lee C. Moore Corp. OO007222I28
P. O. BOM 216
1109 M. Peor la Aye.
& Tulsa. (Tulsa Co.) OK 74101
O
•— Sun Petroleua Products Co. 00098078779
P. O. Box 2O39
1700 S. Union
Tulsa. (Tulsa Co.) OK 74102
Texaco USA (01*. of Texaco Inc.! OO999790MO
P. 0. BOM 2389
902 ». 25 tk Street
and Contact Slie (acres)
4O9/767-39I6 38
George O'Brien
Rel. Manager

409/749-3421 16.9
R. K. Raid
ST. Stall Eng.

918/225-1000 10.7
Ray Russell
Env. Protection

403/D69-43II 32
John Dobson
Mgr. Tech. Serv.

918/983-4127 1.49
R. D. Hoods
Plaat Manager


918/986-7273 120
R. 6. Ho.thorn
Raf. Manager

9I6/9M-3663 70
0. W. Cunningham
Plaat Manager
Type and
tat. Vesta (t/yr)
K049 342.3; K09I 37.9; 0001 990



0001. FOOI. F002. FOOJ. F009 -
total 1290


Cooling toner sludge 7; K09I 6;
K092 90; NMT sludge 61; petro.
coke 1

K049 780; K090 4; K09I 1300;
K092 2300


F003 . 18; 0001 1.96



0002 2400; K092 23; 0000 990



K049 23OO; KO5O 1 ; KO9I 25O;
K092 1; 0007 170

Industrial Source Additional
SIC Description Infonaatlon
2911
2869


3011


2911



2911



3933



2911



2911


Refinery
led. crgenlc chemical aux.


Pneumatic tire mtml.


Refinery



Refinery



Derricks, oil t gas
field subs truct ires t
relate! Iteas


Refinery



Refinery


Tulsa, (Tulsa Co.l OK 74101

Tosco Corp. - Duncan Refinery
P. 0. Box 820
Duncan. (Stephens Co.) OK 73923

Vletters Petroleun Corp..
Industrial Add'a
P. 0. B
-------
REGION VI (continued)
Naa» EPA.
and Address 10 Numbar
Arco Petrol eua Products Co. TXD082688979
Houston Refinery
P. 0. Box 2431
12000 Lamdal*
Houston, (Harris Co.) TX 77001
Calanes* Tract K
P. 0. Box 937
Pempa. TX 79063
Champlln Petroleum Co. TXD051 161990
P. O. Box 9176
I8OI Nuecas Bay Blvd.
Corpus Chrlstl , (Nueces Co.) TX
Coastal States Petroleum Co. TXDOOS 132268
P. 0. Box 521
Cant»ell Drive
Corpus Chrlstl, (Nuecas Co.) TX 78403
Comlnco AMT|CM Inc. CMMX Operations TXD08I7I5302
P. O. Box 5067
_ FM 1551
g Borger. (Hutchlnson Co.) TX 79007
10 Cosden 01 1
(Subsidiary of A»*r. Petrol IM)
P. 0. Box 2159
Dallas, TX 75221
Location
Rellnary Rd.
1-20 IE. of Big Spgs.)
Big Spring, TX
Crowi Central Petroleum Corp. TXD00809I290
P. 0. Box 1759
Houston. TX 77001
location
III Red Bluff Rd.
Pasadena. TX 77506
Exxon Co. - TXD000782698
Baytovn Refinery t Chemical
P. 0. Box 3950
2800 Decker Or.
Baytovn, (Harris Co.) TX 77520
Gull Coast Waste Authority
910 Bay Area Blvd.
Houston, TX 77058
Location
Loop 19. S.
Texas City. TX
Gulf Coast Haste Disposal Authority TXDOOM35249
P. 0. Box 1026
la Marque, (Ralveston Co.) TX 77567
Phone Number
and Contact Size (acres)
713/475-4507 172
Jamas T. Mams
Mgr. Env. Cngr.


806/665-1801 34.74
Brian Hanson

512/882-8071 20
Davis Scharll
Env. Affairs Coord.

512/887-4247 388
Hindi* Taylor
Env, Engineer

806/274-3204 100
Kenneth M. Hrlght
Manager

915/263-7661 Unavailable
Ted Narln






713/472-2461 176
G. H. Munson
Sr. Env. Eng.



713/428-3115 40
J. E. Hendon
Sup. Solid Haste


713/488-4115 6
Char 1 la Gam*




713/935-4783 80
Robert H. Dyer
Fac. Manager
Type and Industrial Source Additional
A»t. Mast* (t/yr) SIC Description Information
KOJO 6; K05I 1700; K052 12; 2911 Refinery
0007 2.5



K05I; K052 2869 Ind. organic Amt. of vaste Is unknown.
chemicals sine* uostes go to
landfill 1 IF.
K044 3900; K05I 4500; D007 400 2911 Refinery



K05I 7598; 0001 6838.1; K052 8.37; 2911 Refinery
0001 16.9; DOOI 6838.1;
0001 37.987.3

D002 31,000; 0007 90,000 2873 Nitrogen fertilizer manu.



WVT sludg*; K052 2911 Refinery Mast* amounts are
unavailable.






K050 9; K049 450; K051 1250; 2911 Refinery
P022 .0005; PI 10 .0005; POI9
.0005; P077 .0005; 015} .0005;
UI34 .0005; UI54 .0005; UI88
.0005; U2II .0005; U220 .0005;
U239 .0005; 0010 .0005
K05I 8212.5 2911 Refinery




K048. K049, K050, K05I. K052 - 2911 Refinery
total 70




DOOI 4067; DD03 946; DOO4 7866; 4953 Refuse syslees
D007 6228; F003 20; F005 20;
K048 4000; K049 4544; K05I 954;
           K052  1013; U054  1266

-------
                                                                                 REGION ¥1 (continued)
Name
end Address
Kerr-McGee Chemical Corp.
155 Buckanan Rd.
Texarkana, TX 75901
Lone Star Army Ammunition Plant
IWy. 82 W.
Texarkana, (Bon la Co.) TX 75901
Mobil Oil Corp.
End of Burt St.
Beaumont, (Jefferson Co.) IX 777O4
Phillips Petroleum
Box 866
Soeaney. TX 77480
Ouanax Corp. Gulf States Olv.
P. O. Box 952
Rosenberg, (Ft. Band Co.) TX 77471
Relchold Chemicals
P. O. Box 9608
Houston, TX 77019
O Roman Mire Co.
U> p. 0. Box 1251
Sherman, (Grayson Co.) TX 75090
Shell Oil Co. Odesse Refinery
P. 0. Box 2152
S. Grandvlev St.
Odessa. (Ector Co.) TX 79760
Slgmor Refining Co.
P. 0. Box 490
Three Rivers. (Live Oak Co.) TX 78071
Southwestern Refining Co. Inc.
P. O. Box 9217
Corpus Chrlstl, (Neuces Co.) TX 78408
Sun Ol 1 Co. of PA
P. 0. Box 2608
Suntlde Rd.
Corpus Chrlstl. (Nueces Co.) TX 78401
Sweeney Refinery 1 Petrochem. Compl.
1004 Phillips Building
Bartlesvllle, OK 74004
Location
Si. Iky. 35 1 FM 524
Old Ocean, TX 77461
Texaco Inc.
P. 0. Box 30110
315 S. Grand
EPA
ID Number
TXD057I 11403
TX72 1382193!
TXO9907977I4
TXD0462 10645
TXD000449397

TX000295426I
TXO026896290
TXD990709966
1X0000807899
TX0088474663
TX004B2 10645
TXD007578993
Phone Number
end Contact Slie (acres)
214/794-5169 4
Robert Coapton
Manager
214/818-1109 20
Jerry Hall to
Chief Engineer
711/839-3328 54
R. G. Sanders
Manager Conservation
713/647-4431 5OO
Larry Chiles
7IV342-540I 6.8
P. Klrkham
Sup. Eng. 1 Malnt.
7IV493-543I 2 LF sites
Bob Redd In 1.27 each
214/895-7474 2
Dale Duenslng
General Manager
915/337-5121 81
Dan HcNelll. ST.
Process Engineer
512/786-2556 4
Fred Ulenlk
Plant Manager
512/884-8865 319.9
H. R. Sager
Vice President
512/241-4811 17
J. R. Kamphenkel
Env. Engineer
918/661-5550 500
B. F. Bel lard
Olr. Env.
806/574-4691 50
E. A. Enloe
Plant Manager
Type and Industrial Source Additional
Ant. Waste (t/yr) SIC Description Information
KOOI 9 2491
5485
K048 16,500 2911
K048 2500; K050 59; K05I 488; 2911
K092 415; 0001 5.9; 0007 2129;
K049 473; UOI9 1400
K061 168 1117
Phenol formaldehyde glue vaste 2821
2869
K062 60 1 30 1496
K052 15; K05I 400; O007 30.5OO; 2911
0008 4.5; 0007 200; 0007 4.9
K09I 1200 2911
KD46 112; K049 519.5; KOSO 1.05; 2911
K05I 121.29; 0007 61.5; FOOI 1.76;
F002 .0001; FOOI 1.2; F005 1.96
KO9I 1900; K048 5410; K049 70; 2911
K090 2.18; K052 17.5; K087 112.9;
0001 290; FOOI; F005; F004; F009;
PI 10
DOOI 5.5; K048 2500; K05I 488; 2911
K092 419; K050 19; K049 471;
0007 2125; 0019 1400
KO48 185; K049 5.5; K03I 12.5; 2911
K052 .9
Hood preservative
Ammunition LF site Is currently
Inactive (7-81)
Refinery
Ref Inery
Steel pipe 1 tubing manu.
Plastic materials Maste amt. Is unknown
t resins since vaste goes to
Ind. organic chemicals different systems.
Hire prod.
Refinery
Refinery
Refinery
Refinery FOOI, FOOI, F004. F009 and
PI 10 go directly to API
separator
Refinery
Refinery
Amarlllo, (Potter Co.) TX 79120

-------
MOION VI (con
MM* EPA
Md AMr**s ID »**ir
T*K«eo Inc. TXXXMW7J2*
P. 0. BOK 7IZ
Pt. Artftir. IJ*lf«rseii Co.) TX 77«40
into*. Carblo* Cor*. TW04IIIV42O
P. 0. Bw IB6
Pt. Uv*e«. TX 77»7»
Location
H»y. !•»
SM Orllt. TX 77»7»
M**t* DIspoMl Ctr. TXMMM1ZM
P. O. Box IO*5
Slutoft. ISM Patrklol TX MM7
HlMto« Itef Ulug Co. TXM64Z4B7W
P. 0. Box 1900
M.E. »«• & N. Sylvaul*
ft. «krttt. (TwrMt Go.) TX IflOt
M< Contact Six* !«<•••) tat. MMt* (t/yrl
7U/9»-97ll 10 K09Z l»i HM9 820j 0004. 0011
*. L. KorMil
Sup. A * HC
SI2/JH-97II ZOO
V. D. OntdMT
toy. Prot. Coord.

M2/JM-I244 ZO NH* ZOM.Ii K05Z IZ48.*
f ra»kl 1* K«l 1 y
Owwr
•I7/UO-Z346 Z7.3 K04B 1379; KOSI lOSOk MHZ 107;
MH*i NOSO
iKdwIrlri Sourc*
SIC 0*acr Ipt lo.
ZMI
2RI
ZM1

4*93
Z»ll
RcflMry
PUstbs
Ind. orgwilc cK

R«fu«* systm
•Wi^ry
Atfdlt k»d
lul oraat ton

Lf tit* Is currcntl y
••lull Uoctlv* 17-M)


K049 t KOIOgo directly
to API t*pirator.

-------
RESIGN VII
MaaM
aad Addrass
Stata of lorn
Chavron OMB leal Co.
P. 0. B« 282
OrthoRd.
Ft. Mad 1 sen. (Laa Co.) IA 92627
Uadllll Sarvlca Cor*.
1509 E. Maskbura
aatarloo. IA 30703
Stata of Kansas
CRA. Inc.
Rural Rt. 2. Box 60S
Phllllpsburg. KS 67661 (H. of tow)
CRA, lac.
P. 0. Box 970
North lladaa Straat
Cottayvllla. KS 67337
Darby Raflalng Co.
P. 0. Box 1030
MOO E. 21st Straat
Mlchlta. KS 67214
Gatty Raflalag a Marketing Co.
P. 0. Boc 1121
I4OI S. Douglas Rd.
El Dorado. KS 67042
Kansas Industrial Masta Facility, Inc.
P. 0. Box 3220
Shawiaa, KS 66203
Mobil Oil Corp.
P. 0. Box 546
Second 1 Oak Straat
Augusta. KS 67010
Pastar Raflalng Co.
P. O. Box 791
El Dorado. KS 67042
Total Patrolaua Inc.
Box 857
1400 S. M. Straat
Arkansas City. KS 67009
Stata of Missouri
ABOCO Oil Co. Sugar Craak Raf Inary
11400 E. Kantucky Rd.
Sugar Craak. MO 64054
EPA
10 Nuabar
IAD0051 73992
IA0073MM63
KSD0071 34693
KSDOO71 38609
K9D0006I0543
K5D007233422
KS0000689930
KS000723SI3B
KSD000829846
KSDOS74 18693

MOD007I6I425
PaoaaNuafcar
anJ Contact Slia (acras)
3I9/372-60I2 4
Joha 1. Malar
Fac. Rap.
3I9/345-63K 16
Cardall Patarson
Prasldant
913/343-5246 14
Craven Brant
Rat. Supt.
3W/23I-4000 3
Joha Prultt
Hor. Eav. t
Sataty Sys.
3M/267-036I 12.66
Oavld Erlckson
Proc. Eflgr.
316/321-2200 6.6
R. B. Millar
Pollution Control Olr.
913/631-3300 160
Mark Rosanau
Manager
316/775-6371 4.3
Donald Robinson
Tack. Managar
316/321-9010 3.12
Urn PI area
Eav. Control Coord.
316/442-5100 2.0
lao Relnkeneyar
Raf. Managar

816/252-4800 20
John C. Laakla
Supt. ol Labs
Type flnJ
tat. Nasta (t/yr)
0016 2.5
0001; 0002; 0003; D006g 0007;
0008; 0010; FOOI ; F002| FO06;
F007; F008; F00»; FOIO; FOI2j
K03I. K049. K048 • total 600
K04B, K04» - total 20
K046 14; K049 144; K030 2.5;
K05I 130
K050 3; K05I 750) K052 14;
KO48 IOO; K049 II
K048; K049; K05I; K052; DOOOj
DOOIj 0008
K049 1000; K05I 50; K050 . 1
K049. KOSO - total 500; K05I .
K052, PI 10. U022. U054. UI34
• total 300
K049 5; K05I 50; K052 8;
K050 2; O008 2.3

K048 1200; K049 275; K050 350;
K05I 8400; K052 80; K05I 6000
Industrial Source Additional
SIC Description Inforaatlon
2875 Nltrqienojs lert II liars
2874 Phcsphatlc tartllltars
3471 Plating Proposed IF.
2831 Paints 1 allied
predicts
2911 Refinery
2911 Refinery
2911 Refinery
2911 Rail nary
2911 Rail nary Proposed IF
2911 Raf Inary
2911 RaHnery
2911 Refinery

2911 Raf Inary

-------
                                                                                      RBJIOM VII (continual)
Naaw
and Address
Atlas Powder Co.. Atlas Plant
P. 0. OOM 87
Jopl In. HO 64801
Kerr McGee Cheajlcal Corp.
P. 0. Box 2815
2800 K. High Street
Springfield. MO 65803
Syntax Agribusiness Inc.
P. 0. Box 1246
555 First Street
Verona, MO 65769
State of Nebraska
Of futt Air Force Base
3902 ABW/K
Of futt AFB. MB 68113
EPA Phone Nuaber
10 Nuaber and Contact Size (acres)
MG0077867909 4I7/624-O2I2 2
G. E. Pollock
Plant Manager
H000071 29406 4I7/B3I-2838 1
C. M. DurhaB
Superintendent
H000074S2I54 4I7/B66-729I 10
Gaae Wallace
Group Leader

NE0571 924648 402/294-5500 0.005
Col. Ralph HoltBWM
Type and
A»t. Waste (t/yr>
0000 30; 0000 43; 0000 3000;
0001 2.5S F003 .5
KOOI 1200; KOOI 12
F003 1.5

0001 .35
Industrial Source Additional
SIC Description Intonation
28 W
2873
2491
2869

29
Explosives Manu.
Fertilizer
Wood preserving
Organ Ic chev leal s

PetroleuM prod.
0»
o

-------
                                                                                     ftEBION VIII
Name
and Address
State of Colorado
Colorado state University
Environmental Health Services
Ft. Collins, CO M923
Gary Refining Co.
Rural Van
Frulta. CO 81921
U.S. Vmy
DFAE Blog. 304
Ft. Carson, 00 80913
State of Montane
Conoco Oil Refinery
P. 0. Box 2948
401 S. 23rd
Billings, MT 39103
Conoco Land farm
P. O. Box 2948
Alexander Rd.
Billings. MT 39103
EPA Phone Number
10 Number and Contact Site (acres)
000069712792 303/491-6743 0,23
N. Morrison SMI ir
000067319390 303/B98-98II 140
Lloyd Nordkausan
002210020130 303/379-4828 290 yds.1
Robert Rothmea
MTD006229409 406/292-3841 20
R. B. Bloaeyer
NTOQ008I8096 406/292-3841 10
R, B. Bloneyar
Type and Industrial Source Additional
Ant. Haste (t/yr) SIC Description Informntlon
P037 .009; P03I .009; P073 .003; 8221 Education
POB9 .003; U036 .123; 0051 .00);
IB24 .23
FOOI. F003, FO05. H049, WHO, 2911 Refinery
K09I • total 40
0002 12 9711 Mitloaal security
K048 1230; KO3I 300 2911 Refinery
K048 1990; K049 100; K090. K03I 2911 Refinery
- total 790
Exxon Billings Refinery
P. 0. Box 1163
Billings. KT 99103

Farmers Union Central
Exchange/Cenex
P. O. Box 909
H>y. 310
Laurel. MT 99044

General Electric Co.
6994 S. Frontage M.
Billings. MT 99102

Phillip* Greet Fell*
Petroleum Refinery
1900 10th Street
Black Eagle. NT 99414
MTDM03S0974     406/697-9361
                 Tla Snug
MTD00623S083     406/626-4311
                 Hllllam Starr
MID0602809I4     406/696-8700
                 Dave Johnson
MTDOOO419I94     406/OJ-O7I
                 R. E. Jones
                                                                               39
                                        10
                                         0.29
                                                                                           K049 I30O;  K09I  2000t K092 39      2*11   Reflnary
                                                   K048 43.2; K049 97.2; K09I 79.6    2911   Refinery
                                                   0002 .79
                                  0001  .5; NMB 24; KO49 IO,
                                  K050  .1; K09I 9; K092 .5
                                                                     7699   Repair t relate!
                                                                            service* (NEC!
                                                                     7691    Araature reulnd Hop
State of Utah

taoco Oil Co. S.C Tnnfc fmrm
1700 N. 1200 M.
Salt Lake City. Iff 84103

Husky Oil Co. ol Delaware
P. O. Box 179
333 M. Center
North Salt Lake. UT 84O94
UTOOOOK6370
UT0049267I27
801/364-3015
Daniel Orinller
Super Intent eat

801/328-2292
T. Ferris
0001 3» K04S 23,000s  K049 300;
MHO 4; K05I 6000; K092 9
K049 10;  KO50 .2; KO5I  79;
W»2 .29
                                                                                      2911    Refinery
                                                                                      2911    Refinery

-------
REGION VIII (continue.)
Ham*
and Address
Phillips Petroleum Moods Cross Refinery
P. 0. Box 196
Moods Cross. UT 84067
Location
55J 5. Boo M.
M. Bountiful. UT 84087
State of My oa Ing
Amoco PI pal Ine Tenk Far*
P. 0. Box 160
Casper, MT 82602
Location
1 Mile N. of Caspar Refinery
Mast of Caspar 82602
Husky Oil
P. 0. Box 380
Cody, MT 82414
Location
Cneyenne, MT
O Husky Oil Co. of Delaware
0° P. 0. Box 380
Cody, MT 82414
Little America Refining Co. lac.
P. 0. Box 510
Evansvllla. Mr 82636
Sinclair Oil Corp.
P. O. Box 277
Sinclair, MT 82334
Myomlng Raflnlng Co.
P. O. Box 820
740 M. Main Street
Newcastle, Wt 82101
EPA
ID Number
UTD00909058O

WYTOOOOIOI 16

MYD0062 30189
•"ID048743009
MYD079959183
MYD04370SI02
Pat Havener
Phone Nuabar
and Contact
801/295-2311
J. Oa.ell

307/265-3390
Lor In Leleyre
Superintendent
307/578-1445
Donald R. Ha (us
307/578-1445
Donald R. Mai us
307/265-2800
Frank C louse
307/324-3404
L. Cor put
307/7*6-4445
Type anl Industrial Source Additional
Size (acres) Aait. Masta (t/yr) SIC Description Information
1.5 0000, 0001, 0002 • total 11.5; 2911 Refinery
F003. F004. F005 - total 2;
K048, K049. K050. K05I - total 300;
K032 .6; UOI3 25; UI34 50;
PI 10 .5; 0004. D007, 0006 - total 5

8.3 DOOI 120; DOO7 II;K049 15; 2911 Refinery
K05I 710
Unavailable Unavailable Unavailable
14 KO49 37) K050 .45; K05I .9; 2911 Refinery
K052 .45
6 K05I 100.5; K052 52.5; K049, K050 2911 Refinery K049 1 K050 go directly to
API separator
600 OO02 56 5O 2911 Rail nary
I.I K05I 1.2; K052 130 2911 Refinery

-------
                                                                                 REGION IX
Ham,
and
»
Address
ID
EPA
Nuafcer
Phone Nuefoer
and Contact
Size
Caere*)
Type an)
Aa>t. Haste
Ct/yr)
Industrial Source
SIC Description
Additional
iRforwat Ion
State ot California

CasMlla Disposal
NTU Rd.
CasMlla.  (Sta.  Barbara Co.)  CA 93429
CAD020748I23
                 (09/969-9897
                 JOMS McBrld.
                 Olr. Tech. Services
                                        20          F006 780; F007 1080; F008 780;
                                                    F009 780; FOIO 19; K048. K049.
                                                    K090. K09I . K052 - total 380;
                                                    K096. K097. K038. K099 - total
                                                    10; K062, K063 - total 10; OOOO
                                                    61,300; 0000 96.600; 0000 1200;
                                                    0002 900; OOOO 700; 0002 240;
                                                    0000 900
                                                                                       4993   Refuse systex
Chaalcal Haste Management
P. 0. Box  197
Kettleaan City. CA 92329
                                         CAT000646II7
                 209/933-2002
                 John Market ay
                                                                                220
Ctievron  USA
324 H. El  Segimda Blvd.
El Segundo. CA 90249

Environmental  Protect Ion Corp.
Easts Ida Disposal Fare
304O  I9tti  Street
Baker sf I eld. (Kent Co.)  CA 93301
                                        CAD00833690I
CAOO303M267
                 213/322-3430
                 Korean leroy
                 805/327-9681
                 M*. H. Park
                 President
                                       920
                                                    K048 16,000; K049 2330; K090
                                                    2390; K09I 19.000;  K092 10.720
                                                    0001 98.337; 0001 4; 0004 218;
                                                    FOOI 30; F002 64; F003 I2O;  FO04
                                                    136; F005 213; F006 3200; KOOI
                                                    18; K009 8; KOIO 7; KOI6 197;
                                                    KOI7 210; KOI8 320; KOI9 211;
                                                    K020 199; K022 160; K023 175;
                                                    K024 246; K029 88;  K026 194;  K027
                                                    7;  K028 60; K029 70; K030 30;
                                                    K06I 209; K063 236; K064 274;
                                                    K063 182; K066 307; K067 29; K068
                                                    251; K069 237; K072 27; K073 36;
                                                    K078 12.000;  K079 2300; K08I
                                                    2730; K082 8S; K083 2;  K083 4;
                                                    K086 3243; POOS 7;  POIO 623; POM
                                                    2100; POIB 400; P020 60; P022
                                                    29,430; P030 104; P047  4480; P048
                                                    9200; POM 9400;  P054 10,400;
                                                    POM 4300; UOOI 4400; U002 943;
                                                    U004 2190; UOI2 2790; UOI9 4279;
                                                    U020 2000: 11021 2099; O03I 2790;
                                                    1)037 2793; U039 2790; U044 3;
                                                    U043 2790; 0051 2790; U032 2790;
                                                    UOS6 6; U097 2790;  0069 2969;
                                                    0066 2620; UO67 2780; U068 2790;
                                                    U070 3090; U07I 2790; U072 3377;
                                                    U073 3000; U076 2790; 0077 3377;
                                                    U078 4131; UO8I 1123; UO62 1123;
                                                    O092 20; UI04 19; UI08  H; UII2
                                                    19;  UII4 12; UI22 110;  UI33  18;
                                                    UI34 10.300; UI35 28; UI40 320;
                                                    UI33 3; UI54 98; UI59 1479;  UI6I
                                                    2788; 0169 2790; UI69 2790; U182
                                                    113; UI8B 8900; 1C20 310;  1C26
                                                    88; 0227 124; 1)228 99;  0239 2OO

                                                    K04B 4023; K03I 4828; K052 612;
                                                    cooling tower sludge 66
                                                                                                                                4993   Refuse systw
                                                                                                                                2911    Refinery
29 additional acres
being developed.
                                                    Oil su«p sludge 23.400; oil field  2911
                                                    brine 24.900; drilling fluid
                                                    rotary aud 68.200; tank bt«rs
                                                    sedleents 14.800; scrubber wastes
                                                    80,000; other 30,000
                                                                                              RefInery

-------
                                                                            R8BIM IX (centlMed)
NMM
•Hi Address
Environmental Protection Corp.
Mesttlee Olapoeal Fan
3040 191k Street Suit* 10
Bakarsf leld, (Kern Co.) CA 93301
TIM Grass Valley Group, Inc.
13024 Bltnay Spring* M.
Cress Valley. (Nevada Co.l CA *3949
Hugh*] Research labor ctor IK
301 1 Hal IbH Cwyon M.
Hal Ibu. (Los Angetes Co.) CA 90269
IT Corp. - Benson Ridge Fac.
336 «. Anafcele St.
Locatloa
7260 Hvy. 29
Kelteyvllle, CA 99437
IT Corp.
Mcnteiusa Hllli
336 N. Analietn St.
Wilmington, CA 90744
Location
TE*r""TT~
twy. ic
Rio Vlst«. CA
IT Carp.
336 H. Anaheim St.
MIlBlngton, CA 90744
Location
End of Vthur Rd.
Martin*!. CA
JT Cora.
336 N. Ananalai St.
Hllwlngton, CA 90744
Location
Laka Haraan Rd.
Bwilcla, CA
IT Transportation Co. - lanwlal
336 M. Anakata St.
NllBl«|toii, CA 90744
H.P. OUpo»l Co.. Inc.
4506 HcUvlsk Ct.
B>k«rsll»l
-------
RGSION IX (cwtlauad)
MOM EPA
and Address 10 Nuafaar
Shall Oil Co. CAD009I64O21
Martina* (tony. Couple*
P. 0. BOK 711
Marina Vista Ava.
Martina* (Centra Costal CA 943)3
Slal valley Sanitary Land fill CAD990638399
III E. las Angelas Ava.
Slal Val lay, (Vaatia-a Co.» CA 91069
Ualo» Oil Co. at CA Saata CAT0800I0796
Maria Refinery
Rt. 3 BOK 7600
Arroyo Grand*. (Saa Uls Oblspo Co.l CA 93420
Ualoa Oil Co. o« CA CAD009IOI7O3
County M.
Rodeo, (Contra Costa Co.) CA 94972
O«aa
A*4arsoa AFB GU&97I9999I9
Hq. 43rd Coabat Support Group
APO Saa Fraaclsco. CA 96334
Location
Per latter Rd.
Vlgo. Guam 96912
Paoria Nu^>ar
ami Coatvt Slia (Kras)
413/228-6161 13
Jaaas Haasoa
Staff Cnglnaar
809/699-2 139 33
Andy Holguli
Civ. Eag. Asst. 2
805/34 J-l 776 2
Jack N. Mast
Maaagar
413/799-4411 6.4
D. M. Oabusa
EaV. Big. Supv.
366-7101 2
Patrick Mcftaikaa
Dap. B. Civ. Eag.
Typa and Indwlrlal Sourca
Ajit. Vasta (t/yr) SIC Oascrlatlon
2869 Organic chtailcal a
2911 Rat 1 nary
K048, K049. K050, K032 - total 49S3 Raima systa*
50; K09I 90; DOOI 1000; 0002
10.000; 0003 100; 0017 10,000;
F003, r009 - total lOOj F007.
FOOB. F009. FOIO. FOI 1 - total Ids
FOI3 10
K048; «M9; K030; K03I 29 P»*rolaui prod.
0001 670; 0003300; K048 I73O; 2911 Raflnary
K03I 230
000027 348 AMUtltloa
Additional
Inforaat Ion
aau. IF slta Is cirrantly
Inactlva (7-9 )
Hydrqgaolqi Ic study
In prograss
If slta Is cirrantly
Inactive (7-« )



-------
                                                                                              REGION X
Haw B-A
and Address ID Nuabar
Stata of Alaska
MAR Special Haste Sit*. Inc. AKT0400IOI34
Mil* 3 Swansea River M.
Starling. (K«nal Peninsula Borough) AK 9*672
Hailing Address
P.O. Box 1660
Soldotna, AX 99609
Phoee Hunter
and Contact
907/262-487}
Ray O'Oocharty
President
Typa and Industrial Source Additional
Slza lacrasl A»t. Waste (t/yr) SIC Description Information
40 FOOI; F002j F003; F005; FOI7; 49S3 Refuse system II acres currently In use.
FOISi U043: U044; U066; U069;
U07I; U072; U080; U06I; U092;
UI02; UII2; UII7; UI22| UI23;
UI27; UI32; UI33; UI34; UI40-.
UI44; 11146; UI5I; UI54; UI38;
UI59; UI6I; UI62; UI65; UI69;
UI72; UI88; UI96; U20I; U2IO;
UZIIj 1C 16; IB20; U222; U223j
U22S; U226; U227; U233; U239;
POOIj POM; P022; POJO; P035;
P037; P098; PIOJ; U002; UOII;
UOI2; UOI3; U022; U03I; U03&;
0038; K048; K049; H050-, K05I;
KOK
      Stata ot Idaho

      OMTk Indvstrlas,  lac.
^    P. 0. Box 066
|1,    Lwlston CNai Pare* Co.)  ID 83501
rO
K000906648I
                 206/746-2391
                 Ja»es Hard
                 Chief
                                    6000 ft.2
                                   Clarltlar «aste containing
                                   Pb. Nt. C«. Zn
3471   Electroplating         Ant. of waste Is unknown
3482   Small Anas Ammunition
      Stata of Oregon
             curity Systen. lac.
      Cedar  Springs Rd. (Star Rt.l
      Arlington (Gillian Co. I OR 97612
                                               CROOB943Z3M
                 503/454-2777
                 Frank Doaant
                 Slta Manager
                         1.9        K03) 24; KO42 6; KD43  2; K049
                                   20; K05I 10; KOS2 490; K060 45;
                                   P090 60; PI02 6; UOOI  2; U002  9;
                                   UOI9 40; U02I I; 0037  6; U039  2;
                                   U044 10; U09I 50; U070 13; U072
                                   3; U076 5; U077  13; U076 15;
                                   U079 5; U06I 4;  U062 3; UII2 3;
                                   UI22 120; UI27  I; UI40 3; 11154
                                   100; UI59 200; UI63 2; UI86 730;
                                   U202 I; U2IO  13; U220  50; U239
                                   13; UI34 WOO
                                                                                                                                      2911    Refinery
                              Partially  land HI led,
                              partially  land faraed
      Stata of Mas»l»gtoa

      ARCO Patrol aw Products Co.
      P. 0. Box  1127
      4319 Granvlaw Rd.
      Faradata (Matoc*  Co.)  MA 98248

      Boise Cascada/Papar Groua
      P. 0. Box  300
      Mallula. *H  99363

      Modi I OH  Cora.
      P. 0. Box  8
      3901 Unlck Rd.
      Faradala,  MA 98248
MA0069348I94
MW009032432
MMMMM29O366
206/364-2216
Richard Ogar
Manager Air t
Matar Control

309/347-2411
Dennis Ross
                 206/364-1011
                 Cloyoa Ml I lar
                 Tech. Manager
                                        60
                                        30
                                         16
                                                    K049  WOO; KO5O  50; K05I  I5OO;      2911    Refinery
                                                    K032 873; KOB7  10
                                                    Clarlflar  sludge 7,000
2600   Paper products
                              23 acras currently  In use.
                                                    K049  1400; KO5I  940; M>30  .13       2911    Refinery

-------
                                                                                 MC6KM X (continued)
Nan* EPA
and Address ID tUfcer
Phillips Pacific Cnaatlcal Co. NAD044393226
Gee* Far* Rd., East End
Flnley. (Benton Co.) W
Prlngle Menu. CO., Inc. MUWO 1482457
3301 E. Isaacs
Mai la Mai la (Malta Walla Co.) MA 99362
Shall Oil Co. IMD0092790S2
P. 0. Box 700
Anacortes (Skaglt Co.) MA 98221
Texaco USA (01 v. of Texnco, Inc.) MAD009276I97
March's Point. P. 0. Box 622
Anacortes, (Skaglt Co.) MA 98221
YaklM Firing Center MA62 14053995
Vaklav. M 98901
Phone Number
and Contact Sit* (acres)
918/661-1330 13.8
B. F. Bel lard
Olr. Env. Control
909/925-4423 Unnval Inkle
Mark Marner
Prod. Managw
206/293-3111 7.9
H. C. Fllcklnger
Env. Cbnsv. Manager
206/293-2131 14.9
C. R. Ferguson
Plant Manager
206/967-4076 1668
Stephen Millar
ChUf DFAE-CECO
Type and Industrial Soiree
Ant. Mast* (t/yr) SIC Description
000826 2873 Fertilizer IUMU.
K062 I30-. 0007 MOO Unavailable
K049 690; KOMI 20; K03I 390; 2911 Refinery
K092 1
K049 W80; K090 10; K032 9; 2911 Refinery
DOOI 1 (tank seal* F*S>; D002 20
(acid t caustic tank bt»)| O002 20
(Pol* catalyst); 0007 490 Uestewter
treating sludg*); 0007 30 (cooling
tomr sludge); 0001 M (filter cltys)
0001. 0003 - total 80 97 Nstlonal security
Additional
Intonation




Disposal of Ignltables
and mnctlves
ON

-------
-
—
-
                                     Figure J.   Areal  distribution of  land  treatment facilities.

-------
Table 3.  Geographic  distribution, by  region  and  state, of  the  197  facilities  described  In  the
          survey.


Region                      Regional Office                                    Number of facilities
VI
IV
IX
VIII
V
VII
X
II
II 1
1
Oa 1 1 as , Texas
Atlanta, Georgia
San Francisco, California
Denver, Colorado
Chicago, Illinois
Kansas City, Missouri
Seattle, Washington
New York City, New York
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
Boston, Massachusetts
58
45
19
18
16
J5
12
8
7
0
State or territory	Number of facilities

Texas                                                                                   29

California                                                                              18

Louisiana                                                                               13

Oklahoma                                                                                It

Ohio                                                                                     9

Alabama                                                                                  8
Kansas                                                                                   8
Wash Ington                                                                               8

Florida                                                                                  7
Georgia                                                                                  7
Mississippi                                                                              7

Montana                                                                                  6
North CarolIna                                                                           6
Wyoming                                                                                  6

South CarolIna                                                                           5

Missouri                                                                                 4
Puerto Rico                                                                              4

Colorado                                                                                 3
Illinois                                                                                 3
Kentucky                                                                                 3
New Mexico                                                                               3
Utah                                                                                     3

Arkansas                                                                                 2
Indiana                                                                                  2
Iowa                                                                                     2
New Jersey                                                                               2
Maryland                                                                                 2
Minnesota                                                                                2
Pennsylvania                                                                             2
Tennessee                                                                                2
Virginia                                                                                 2

Alaska                                                                                   1
OeI aware                                                                                  1
Guam                                                                                     1
Idaho                                                                                     I
Michigan                                                                                  I
Nebraska                                                                                  1

                                                 615

-------
                                      Table 3.  (continued)
State or territory                                                            Number of facilities

New York                                                                                1
Oregon                                                                                  1
Virgin Islands                                                                          1

American Samoa                                                                          0
ArIzona                                                                                 0
Commonwealth of the Northern Marianas                                                   0
Connecticut                                                                             0
District of Columbia                                                                    0
Hawaii                                                                                  0
Maine                                                                                   0
Massachusetts                                                                           0
Nevada                                                                                  0
New Hampshire                                                                           0
North Dakota                                                                            0
Rhode Island                                                                            0
South Dakota                                                                            0
Vermont                                                                                 0
West Virginia                                                                           0
Wisconsin                                                                               0
                                              616

-------
Table 4.  Industrial  classification of land treatment facllties.
SIC Code Region
025
1321
1389
203
2067
222
229
249
2491
2600
2611
2621
2819
2821
2834
2851
2865
2869
Poultry Feed
Natural Gas Proc.
01 1 & Gas Services
Fruit Processing
Chewing Gum Many.
Weaving Mills, Synthetics
Misc. Textile Goods
Misc. Wood Products
Wood Preserving
Paper & Al 1 led Products
Pulp Mills
Paper Mills
Industrial Inorganic
Chemicals
Plastics, Materials & Resins
Pharmaceutical Preparations
Paints & Al lied Products
Cycl Ic Crudes &
Intermediates
Industrial Organic Chemicals
IV
VI
IX
IV
IV
IV
IV
III
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
VI
VII
X
V
V
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
IV
IV
VII
IX
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
State
Tennessee
Louisiana
Cal 1 torn la
Florida
Florida
Florida
Georg 1 a
Maryland
Georgia
North Caro 1 1 na
South Carol Ina
North Carol Ina
Alabama
Alabama
Mississippi
Mississippi
Texas
Missouri
Washington
Michigan
Mississippi
Louisiana
Texas
Lou I s 1 ana
Texas
Texas
Tennessee
Georgia
Iowa
California
Arkansas
Arkansas
Louisiana
Louisiana
Oklahoma
Texas
Land farm Fact 1 Ity
Arapahoe Chemicals Inc.
Gulf Oil Corp.
IT Corp. - Benson Ridge Facility
Ben HII 1 Griffin, Inc.
Holly Hill Fruit Products Co.
Orange Co. of Florida, Inc.
Wm. Wrlgley, Jr. Co.
Tenneco Chemicals, Inc.
Southern Mills Inc. Senola Dlv.
FInetex Inc. - Southern Oiv.
Sandoz Inc. Martin Works
U.S. Industries, Inc.
Brown Wood Preserving Co., Inc.
T. R. Mil ler Co., Inc.
Coppers
Pearl River Wood Preserving Corp.
Kerr-McGee Chemical Corp.
Ken— McGee Chemical Corp.
Boise Cascade/Paper Group
Simpson Paper Co.
Simpson Paper Co.
Texaco USA (Dlv. of Texaco Inc.)
American Petroflna Co. of Texas 4
Cosden Oil & Chemical
Shell Oil Co.
Relchol d Chemicals
Union Carbide Corp.
Arapahoe Chemicals Inc.
Glldden C&R Oiv. of SCM Corp.
Landfill Service Corp.
Envlrc mental Protection Corp. -
Wests I de Disposal Farm
Arkansas Eastman Co.
Arkansas Eastman Co.
Chevron Chemical Co.
Exxon Co. USA Baton Rouge Refinery
Conoco Inc. Ponca City
Celanese Tract K
                                                617

-------
Table 4.   (continued)
SIC Cod* Region
2869




2873



2874
2873


2879
289


2892

29




2911






















Industrial Organic Chemicals VI
(continued) VI
VII
IX

Nitrogenous Fertilizers VI

VII
VII
Phosp hat 1 c Pert 1 II zer s VII
Fertilizers, Mixing Only IX

X
Agricultural Chemicals IV
Misc. Chemical Products IV
IV

Explosives IV
VII
Petroleum Production IV
IV
VII
IX

Petro 1 eum Ref 1 ner y 1 1
II
1 1
III
III
III
III
III
IV
IV
IV
IV
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
State
Texas
Texas
Missouri
Cal Ifornla

Texas

Iowa
Missouri
Iowa
California

Washington
Georgia
South Carol Ina
South Carolina

Alabama
Missouri
Alabama
Mississippi
Nebraska
California

New Jersey
New Jersey
Virgin Islands
Delaware
Maryland
Pennsylvania
Virginia
Virginia
Alabama
Georgia
Mississippi
Mississippi
Illinois
Indiana
Indiana
M 1 nnesota
Ohio
Ohio
Ohio
Ohio
Ohio
Ohio
Ohio
Land farm Facility
Relchold Chemicals
Union Carbide Corp.
Syntex Agribusiness Inc.
Shell ON Co. -Martinez Manu.
Complex
Comlnco American Inc. Camex
Operations
Chevron Chemical Co.
Atlas Powder Co., Atlas Plant
Chevron Chemical Co.
Environmental Protection Corp. -
Wests Ida Disposal Farm
Phillips Pacific Chemical Co.
Union Carbide Agricultural Co. Inc.
Abco Industries Inc.
Carolina Eastman Co. (01 v. of Eastman
Kodak)
Hercules, Inc.
Atlas Powder Co., Atlas Plant
Plantation Pipeline Co.. HE Facility
Plantation Pipeline Co.
Offutt Air Force Base
Union Oil Co. of CA - Santa Maria
Refinery
Exxon Refinery
Texaco U.S.A.
Hess Oil virgin Islands Corp.
Getty Refining & Marketing Co.
Chevron U.S.A., Inc.
Arco Petroleum Products Co.
Amoco 01 1 Co.
Hercules, Inc.
Hunt Oil Co., Tuscaloosa Refinery
Amoco 01 1 Co. Savannah Refinery
Amerada Hess Corp.
Rogers Rental & Landfill - Exxon
Marathon Oil
Indiana Farm Bureau Coop. Assoc.
Rock Island Refining Corp.
Koch Refinery
Fondessey Enterprise LF Site 12
Fondessey Enterprise LF Site 13
Fondessey Enterprise LF Site 14
Gulf ON Co. U.S.
Sunoco Refinery
Standard Oil Co.
Standard Oil Co. (Ohio)
                                              618

-------
Table 4.  (continued)
SIC Cod*
2911 Petroleum Refinery
(continued)










Region
VI

VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
State
Arkansas

Louisiana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Lou 1 s 1 ana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Louisiana
Land farm Facility
Tosco Corp.

Cities Service Co.
Conoco Inc., Lake Charles Refinery
Exxon Co. U.S.A. Baton Rouge Refinery
Gulf Oil Co. - U.S.
Gulf Oil Corp.
Marathon Oil Co. LA Refining Dlv.
Murphy 01 1 Corp.
Plantation Pipeline Co.
Shell Oil Co.
Texaco U.S.A. (Dlv. of Texaco Inc.)
                                    VI

                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI
                                    VI

                                    VI
New Mexico

Oklahoma
Ok Iahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma
Oklahoma

Texas
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VII
VII
VII
VII
VII
VII
VII
VII
VII
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Texas
Kan, is
Kansas
Kansas
Kansas
Kansas
Kansas
Kansas
Kansas
Missouri
ShelI  011  Co. Inc.

Basin  Refining Inc.
Champlln Petroleum Co.
Conoco Inc. Ponca City
Hudson Refinery
Kerr-McGee Refinery Corp.
Sun Petroleum Products Co.
Texaco U.S.A. (Dlv. of Texaco Inc.)
Tosco Corp. - Duncan Refinery
Vlckers Petroleum Corp.

American Petroflna Co. of Texas &
Cosden Oil & Chemical
Amoco 01 I Co. Land Farm
Arco Petroleum Products Co.
Champlln Petroleum Co.
Coastal States Petroleum Co.
Cosden Oil
C^own Central Petroleum Corp.
Exxon Co. - Baytown Refinery &
Chemical
Gulf Coast Waste Authority
Mobil  Oil Corp.
Phil IIps Petroleum
Shell  Oil Co. Odessa Refinery
Slgmor Refining Co.
Southwestern Refining Co.  Inc.
Sun Oil Co. of Pennsylvania
Sweeney RefInery i Petrochem. CompI.
Texaco  Inc. - Amarlllo
Texaco  Inc. - Pt. Arthur
Winston Refining Co.

CRA,  Inc. - Phllllpsburg
CRA,  Inc. - Coffeyvllle
Derby Refining Co.
Getty Refining & Marketing Co.
Kansas  Industrial Waste Facility,  Inc.
Mob11 011 Corp.
Pester Refining Co.
Total Petroleum,  Inc.
Amoco Oil Co., Sugar Creek Refinery
                                                 619

-------
Table 4.   (continued)
SIC Coda
2911 Petroleum Refinery
(continued)





























2969 Ind. Organic Chemicals

3011 Pneumatic Tire Manu.
3317 Steel Pipe & Tubing Manu.
3471 Plating 4 Polishing


348 Ordnance & Accessories



3483 Ammunition
349 Misc. Fabricated
Metal Products
3496 Misc. Fabricated Wire
Products
Rag Ion
VII
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
VI

VI
VI
VI
VI
VI
IX
IX

IX

IX
IX
IX
IX
IX
IX
X
X
X
X
X
IX

VI
VI
IV

VII
IV
IV
X
X
VI
IV
VI
IV
VI
State
Colorado
Montana
Montana
Montana
Montana
Montana
Utah
Utah
Utah

Wyoming
Wyoming
Wyom 1 ng
Wyoming
Wyoming
California
Cal Ifornla

Ca 1 1 f orn 1 a

California
California
Cal Ifornla
Ca 1 1 f orn 1 a
Ca 1 1 f orn i a
California
Oregon
Wash 1 ngton
Washington
Wash 1 ngton
Washington
Cal Ifornla

Oklahoma
Texas
North Carol Ina

Iowa
Florida
Kentucky
Guam
Idaho
Texas
Alabama
New Mexico
Georgia
Texas
Land farm Facility
Gary Refining Co.
Conoco Oil Refinery
Conoco Land farm
Exxon Billings Refinery
Farmers Union Central Exchange/Cenex
Phil lips Great Falls
Amoco Oil Co. SLC Tank Farm
Husky Oil Co. of Delaware
Phillips Petroleum Woods
Cross Refinery
Amoco Pipeline Tank Farm
Husky Oil Co. of Delaware
Little America Refining Co., Inc.
Sinclair 01 1 Corp,
Wyoming Refining Co.
Chevron U.S.A.
Environmental Protection Corp. -
Easts Ide Disposal Farm
Environmental Protection Corp. -
Wests Ide Disposal Farm
IT Corp. - Benlcla
IT Corp. - Martinez
IT Corp. - Montezuma Hit Is
IT Transportation Co. - Imperial
Shell Oil Co., Martinez Manu. Complex
Union ON of Cal Ifornla
Chem-Securlty Systems, Inc.
Arco Petroleum Products Co.
Mobl 1 01 1 Corp.
Shell Oil Co.
Texaco U.S.A. (01 v. of Texaco. Inc.)
Environmental Protection Corp. -
Wests Ide Disposal Farm
Dayton Tire & Rubber Co.
Quanex Corp. Gulf States DIv.
Neuse River Wastewater
Treatment Plant
Landfill Service Corp.
Olln Corp.
Lexington - Blue Grass Depot Activity
Anderson AFB
Omark Industries, Inc.
Lone Star Army Ammunition Plant
Reliable Metal Products, Inc.
Olman Heath Co.
Gilbert 4 Bennett Manu. Corp.
Roman Wire Co.
                                              620

-------
Table 4.   (continued)
SIC Code Region
3498 Fabricated Pipe & Finings
3533 Oil Field Machinery
3589 Service Industry Machinery
3621 Motors & Generators
3641 Electric Lamps
3662 Radio & TV Communication
Equipment
3679 Electronic Components
3743 Railroad Equipment
3999 Manufacturing Industries
4441 Marine Terminal
4463 Marine Cargo Handling
49 Geothermal Energy Production
4953 Refuse Systems
4990 Refuse Collection & Disposal
5171 Petroleum Terminal
7694 Armature Rewind Shop
7699 Repair & Related Services
8221 Col leges & Universities
IV
VI
IV
IV
IV
IV
IX
IV
IX
IV
II
IV
IV
VI
VI
IX
IX
IX
IX
III
V
VI
VI
VI
VI
IX
IX
IX
IX
IX
IX
VI
VIM
VIII
VIII
State
Florida
Oklahoma
Georgia
South Carol Ina
Mississippi
North Carolina
California
Florida
California
Alabama
New York
Kentucky
Kentucky
Louisiana
Lou 1 s 1 ana
California
California
California
California
Pennsylvania
Ohio
Louisiana
Louisiana
Texas
Texas
California
Cal Ifornla
California
California
California
California
Louisiana
Montana
Montana
Colorado
Landfarm Facility
Armco, Inc.
Lee C. Moore Corp.
General Electric Co.
General Electric Co.
American Bosch Electrical Products
General Electric Co.
The Grass Valley Group, Inc.
Tropical Circuits, Inc.
Hughes Research Laboratories
Evans Transportation Co.
Borden Chemical A&C Division
Borden Chemical A&C
General Electric Co.










Conoco Inc., Lake Charles Refinery
Texaco U.S.A. (Dlv. of Texaco 1 nc
IT Corp. - Benlcla
IT Corp. - Montezuma Hills
IT Corp. - Martinez
IT Transportation Co. - Imperial
» )

G.R.O.W.S. Inc. Landfill
Cecos
Rollins Environmental Services
Shreveport Sludge Disposal Facility
Gulf Coast Waste Disposal Authority
Waste Disposal Center
Casmal la Disposal
Chemical Waste Management, Inc.
IT Corp. - Benson Ridge Facility
M. P. Disposal Co., Inc.
SIml Valley Sanitary Landfill
Oakland Scavenger Co.
Texaco U.S.A. (Dlv. of Texaco Inc
General Electric Co.
General Electric Co.
Colorado State University

• /



                                               621

-------
Table 4.  (continued)
SIC Code	Region   State	Land farm Facility	

9711  National Security             IV     Alabama          Maxwell AFB
                                    IV     Florida          Tyndal I AFB
                                    IV     North Carolina   XVIII Airborne Corps 4 Fort Bragg
                                    IV     North Carolina   Seymour Johnson AFB
                                    IV     South Carolina   Shaw AFB
                                    IV     Tennessee        McGhee Tyson Air National Guard Base
                                    VI     New Mexico       White Sands Miss!la Range
                                  VIII     Colorado         U.S. Army
                                     X     Washington       YakJma Firing Center
                                                622

-------
Table 5.  Land treatment usage by  industry.*
SIC Code
2911
4953
2869
9711
2491
49
29
348
203
2821
2851
2873
3999
222
229
2819
2875
289
2892
3471
349
3496
3589
3679
025
1321
1389
2067
249
2600
2611
2621
2834
2865
2874
2879
2969
3011
3317
3483
3498
3533
3621
3641
3662
3743
444 1
4463
4990
5171
7694
7699
8221
Description
Petroleum Refinery
Refuse Systems
Industrial Organic Chemicals
National Security
Wood Preserving
Geothermal Energy Production
Petroleum Production
Ordnance & Accessories
Fruit Processing
Plastics, Materials & Resins
Paints i Allied Products
Nitrogenous Pert 1 1 Izers
Manufacturing Industries
Weaving Ml 1 Is, Synthetics
Misc. Textile Goods
Industrial Inorganic Chemicals
Fertf llzers, Mixing Only
Misc. Chemical Products
Explosives
Plating & Polishing
Mtsc. Fabricated Metal Products
Misc. Fabricated Wire Products
Service Industry Machinery
Electronic Components
Poultry Feed
Natural Gas Proc.
Oil & Gas Services
Chewing Gum Manu.
Misc. Wood Products
Paper & Allied Products
Pulp Mills
Paper Mills
Pharmaceutical Preparations
Cyclic Crudes & Intermediates
Phosphatlc Fertilizers
Agricultural Chemicals
Industrial Organic Chemicals
Pneumatic Tire Manu.
Steel Pipe & Tubing Manu.
Ammunition
Fabricated Pipe & Fittings
01 1 Field Machinery
Motors & Generators
Electric Lamps
Radio & TV Communication Equipment
Railroad Equipment
Marina Terminal
Marine Cargo Handling
Refuse Collection & Disposal
Petroleum Terminal
Armature Rewind Shop
Repair & Related Services
Colleges & Universities
Number of facl 1 Itles
100
11
9
9
6
4
4
4
3
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
J
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
t
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
t
1
   In some cases, the  land treatment  facility  handled  waste from more than one Industry.




                                                623

-------
s«i»  a.-,, ii „
                                                    ACREAGE
                          Figure 2.   Size distribution of land  treatment facilities.

-------
                                APPENDIX B

                          HAZARDOUS CONSTITUENTS
                           REGULATED BY THE EPA
Acetaldehyde
(Acetato)phenylmercury
Acetonttrile
3-(alpha-Acetonylbenzyl)-4-
  hydroxycoumarin and salts
2-Acetylaminofluorene
Acetyl chloride
l-Acetyl-2-thiourea
Acrolein
Acrylamide
Acrylonitrile
Aflatoxins
Aldrin
Allyl alcohol
Aluminum phosphide
4-Aminoblphenyl
6-Amino-l,la,2,8,8a,8b-hexahydro-
  8-[hydroxymethy1]-8a-methoxy-
  5-methylcarbamate azirino[2',3':
  3,4]pyrrolo[1,2-a]indole-4,7-dione
  tester] [Mitomycin C]
5-[Aminomethyl]-3-isoxazolol
4-Aminopyridine
Amitrole
Antimony and compounds, N.O.S.*
Aramite
Arsenic and compounds, N.O.S.
Arsenic acid
Arsenic pentoxide
Arsenic trloxide
Auramlne
Azaserine
Barium and compounds, N.O.S.
Barium cyanide
Benz[c]acridine
Benz[a]anthracene
Benzene
Benzenearsonic acid
Benzenethiol
Benzidine
Benzo[a]anthracene
Benzo[b]fluoranthene
Benzolj]fluoranthene
Benzo[a]pyrene
Benzotrichloride
Benzyl chloride
Beryllium and compounds, N.O.S.
Bis[2-chloroethoxy]methane
Bis[2-chloroethyl]ether
N,N-Bis[2-chloroethyl]-2-naphthyl-
  amine
Bis[2-chloroisopropylJ ether
Bis[chloromethyl] ether
Bis[2-ethylhexyl] phthalate
Bromoacetone
Bromomethane
4-Bromophenyl phenyl ether
Brucine
2-Butanone peroxide
Butyl benzyl phthalate
2-sec-Butyl-4,6-dinitrophenol  [DNBP]
Cadmium and compounds, N.O.S.
Calcium chromate
Calcium cyanide
Carbon disulfide
Chlorambucil
Chlordane  [alpha and gamma isomers]
Chlorinated benzenes, N.O.S.
Chlorinated ethane, N.O.S.
Chlorinated naphthalene,  N.O.S.
Chlorinated phenol, N.O.S.
Chloroacetaldehyde
Chloroalkyl ethers
p-Chloroaniline
Chlorobenzene
Chlorobenzilate
1-[p-Chlorobenzoyl]-5-methoxy-2-
  methylindole-3-acetic acid
p-Chloro-m-cresol
l-Chloro~2,3-epoxybutane
2-Chloroethyl vinyl ether
Chloroform
Chloromethane
Chloromethyl methyl ether
2-Chloronaphthalene
2-Chlorophenol
1-[o-Chlorophenyl]thiourea
3-Chloropropionitrile
alpha-Chlorotoluene
Chlorotoluerie, N.O.S.
Chromium and compounds, N.O.S.
Chrysene
                                     625

-------
                          APPENDIX B  (continued)
Citrus red No. 2
Copper cyanide
Creosote
Crotonaldehyde
Cyanides  [soluble salts and
  complexes], N.O.S.
Cyanogen
Cyanogen bromide
Cyanogen chloride
Cycasin
2-Cyclohexyl-4,6-dinitrophenol
Cy clopho s phamide
Daunomycin
DDD
DDE
DDT
Diallate
Dibenz[a,h]acridine
Dibenz[a,j jacridine
Dibenz[a,h janthracene(Dibenzo[a,h]
  anthracene)
7H-Dibenzo[c,g]carbazole
Dibenzo[a,e]pyrene
Dibe nz o [ a, h ] py rene
Dibenzo[a,i]pyrene
1,2-Dibromo-3-chloropropane
1,2-Dibromomethane
Dibromomethane
Di-n-butyl phthalate
Dichlorobenzene, N.O.S.
3,3'-Dichlorobenzidine
1,1-Dichloroethane
1,2-Dichloroethane
trans-1,2-Dichloroethane
Dichloroethylene, N.O.S.
1,1-Dichloroethylene
Dichloromethane
2,4-Dichlorophenol
2,6-Dichlorophenol
2,4-Dichlorophenoxyacetic acid
  [2,4-D]
Dichloropropane
Dichlorophenylarsine
1,2-Dichloropropane
Dichloropropanol, N.O.S.
Dichloropropene, N.O.S.
1,3-Dlchloropropene
Dieldrin
Diepoxybutane
Diethylarsine
0,0-Diethyl-S-(2-ethylthio)ethyl
  ester of phosphorothioic acid
1,2-Diethylhydrazine
0,0-Diethyl-S-methylester
  phosphorodithioic acid
0,0-Diethylphosphoric acid, 0-p-
  nitrophenyl ester
Diethyl phthalate
0-0-Diethyl-0-(2-pyrazinyl)
  phosphorothioate
Diethylstilbestrol
Dihydrosafrole
3,4-Dihydroxy-alpha-(methylamino)-
  methyl benzyl alcohol
Di-isopropylfluorophosphate (DFP)
Dimethoate
3,3'-Dimethoxybenzidine
p-Dimethylaminoazobenzene
7,12-Dimethylbenz[aJanthracene
3,3'-Dimethylbenzidine
Dimethylcarbamoyl chloride
1,1-Dimethylhydrazine
1,2-Dimethylhydrazine
3,3-Dimethyl-l-(methylthio)-2-
  butanone-0-[(methylamino)carbonyl]
  oxime
Dimethylnitrosoamine
alpha,alpha-Dimethylphenethylamine
2,4-Dimethylphenol
Dimethyl phthalate
Dimethyl sulfate
Dinitrobenzene, N.O.S.
4,6-Dinitro-o-cresol and salts
2,4-Dinitrophenol
2,4-Dinitrotoluene
2,6-Dinitrotoluene Di-n-octyl
  phthalate
1,4-Dioxane
1,2-Diphenylhydrazine
Di-n-propylnitrosamine
Disulfoton
2,4-Dithiobiuret
Endosulfan
Endrin and metabolites
Epichlorohydrin
Ethyl cyanide
Ethylene diamine
Ethylenebisdithiocarbamate  (EBDC)
                                    626

-------
                        APPENDIX B   (continued)
Ethyleneimine
Ethylene oxide
Ethylenethiourea
Ethyl methanesulfonate
Fluoranthene
Fluorine
2-Fluoroacetamide
Fluoroacetic acid, sodium salt
Formaldehyde
Glycidylaldehyde
Halomethane, N.O.S.
Heptachlor
Heptachlor epoxide (alpha, beta,
  and gamma isomers)
Hexachlorobenzene
Hexachlorobutadiene
Hexachlorocyclohexane (all isomers)
Hexachlorocyclopentadiene
Hexachloroethane
l,2,3,4,10,10-Hexachloro-l,4,4a,5,
  8,8a-hexahydro-1,4:5,8-endo,endo-
  dime thanonaphthalene
Hexachlorophene
Hexachloropropene
Hexaethyl tetraphosphate
Hydrazine
Hydrocyanic acid
Hydrogen sulfide
Indeno(1,2,3-c,d)pyrene
lodoraethane
Isocyanic acid, methyl ester
Isosafrole
Kepone
Lasiocarpine
Lead and compounds, N.O.S.
Lead acetate
Lead phosphate
Lead subacetate
Maleic anhydride
Malononitrile
Melphalan
Mercury and compounds, N.O.S.
Methapyrilene
Me thorny 1
2-Methylaziridine
3-Methylcholanthrene
4,4'-Methylene-bis-(2-chloro-
  aniline)
Methyl ethyl ketone (MEK)
Methyl hydrazine
2-Methyllactonitrile
Methyl methacrylate
Methyl methanesulfonate
2-Methyl-2-(methylthio)propional-
  dehyde-o-(methylcarbonyl) oxime
N-Methyl-N'-nitro-N-nitrosoguani-
  dine
Methyl parathion
Methylthiouracil
Mustard gas
Naphthalene
1,4-Naphthoquinone
1-Naphthylamine
2-Naphthylamine
l-Naphthyl-2-thiourea
Nickel and compounds, N.O.S.
Nickel carbonyl
Nickel cyanide
Nicotine and salts
Nitric oxide
p-Nitroaniline
Nitrobenzene
Nitrogen dioxide
Nitrogen mustard and hydrochloride
  salt
Nitrogen mustard N-oxide and
  hydrochloride salt
Nitrogen peroxide
Nitrogen tetroxide
Nitroglycerine
4-Nitrophenol
4-Nitroquinoline-1-oxide
Nitrosamine, N.O.S.
N-Nitrosodi-N-butylamine
N-Nitrosodiethanolamine
N-Nitrosodiethylamine
N-Nitrosodimethylamine
N-Nitrosodiphenylamine
N-Nitrosodi-N-propylamine
N-Nitroso-N-ethylurea
N-Nitrosomethylethylamine
N-Nitroso-N-methylurea
N-Nitroso-N-methylurethane
N-Nitrosomethylvinylamine
N-Nitrosomorpholine
N-Nitrosonornicotine
N-Nitrosopiperidine
N-Nitrosopyrrolidine
                                   627

-------
                          APPENDIX  B   (continued)
N-Nitrososarcosine
5-Nitro-o-toluidine
Oc tame thylpyrophospho rami de
Oleyl alcohol  condensed with  2 moles
  ethylene oxide
Osmium tetroxide
7-Oxabicyclo[2.2.1]heptane-2,3-
  dicarboxylic acid
Parathion
Pentachlorobenzene
Pentachloroethane
Pentachloronitrobenzene (PCNB)
Pentacholorophenol
Phenacetin
Phenol
Phenyl dichloroarsine
Phenylmercury acetate
N-Phenylthiourea
Phosgene
Phosphine
Phosphorothioic acid, 0,0-dimethyl
  ester, 0-ester with N,N-dimethyl
  benzene sulfonamide
Phthalic acid esters, N.O.S.
Phthalic anhydride
Polychlorinated biphenyl, N.O.S.
Potassium cyanide
Potassium silver cyanide
Pronamide
1,2-Propanediol
1,3-Propane suitone
Propionitrile
Propylthiouracil
2-Propyn-l-ol
Pryidine
Reserpine
Saccharin
Safrole
Selenious acid
Selenium and compounds, N.O.S.
Selenium sulfide
Selenourea
Silver and compounds, N.O.S.
Silver cyanide
Sodium cyanide
Streptozotocin
Strontium sulfide
Strychnine and salts
1,2,4,5-Tetrachlorobenzene
2,3,7,8-Tetrachlorodibenzo-p-dioxin
  (TCDD)
Tetrachloroethane, N.O.S.
1,1,1,2-Tetrachloroethane
1,1,2,2-Tetrachloroethane
Tetrachloroethene (Tetrachloro-
  ethylene)
Tetrachloromethane
2,3,4,6-Tetrachlorophenol
Tetraethyldithiopyrophosphate
Tetraethyl lead
Tetraethylpyrophosphate
Thallium and compounds, N.O.S.
Thallic oxide
Thallium (I) acetate
Thallium (I) carbonate
Thallium (I) chloride
Thallium (I) nitrate
Thallium selenite
Thallium (I) sulfate
Thioacetamide
Thiosemicarbazide
Thiourea
Thiuram
Toluene
Toluene diamine
o-Toluidine hydrochloride
Tolylene diisocyanate
Toxaphene
Tribromomethane
1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene
1,1,1-Trichloroethane
1,1,2-Trichloroethane
Trichloroethene (Trichloroethylene)
Trichloromethanethiol
2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
2,4,6-Trichlorophenol
2,4,5-Trichlorophenoxyacetic acid
  (2,4,5-T)
2,4,5-Trichlorophenoxypropionic
  acid (2,4,5-TP) (Silvex)
Trichloropropane, N.O.S.
1,2,3-Trichloropropane
0,0,0-Triethyl phosphorothioate
Trinitrobenzene
Tris(1-azridinyl)phosphine sulfide
Tris(2,3-dibromopropyl)phosphate
                                    628

-------
                          APPENDIX B  (continued)
Trypan blue
Uracll mustard
Urethane
Vanadic acid, ammonium salt
Vanadium pentoxide (dust)
Vinyl chloride
Vinylidene chloride
Zinc cyanide
Zinc phosphide
                                     629

-------
                           APPENDIX B  REFERENCE
EPA. 1980. Identification and listing  of  hazardous  waste.  Part 261.  Federal
Register Vol. 45, No. 98. pp. 33132-33133.  May  19,  1980.
                                     630

-------
                                APPENDIX C

                         SOIL HORIZONS AND LAYERS
Organic Horizons


 0—Organic horizons of mineral soils.   Horizons:   (1)  formed  or forming in
    the upper part  of  mineral soils above  the mineral part;  (2)  dominated
    by fresh or partly decomposed organic material;  and (3)  containing more
    than 30 percent organic matter  if  the mineral fraction  is  more  than 50
    percent  clay,  or  more  than  20 percent  organic matter  if  the  mineral
    fraction has no clay.   Intermediate clay  content requires  proportional
    organic-matter content.

01—Organic horizons in which essentially the  original  form  of most  vegeta-
    tive matter is visible  to the naked  eye.

02—Organic  horizons  in which  the  original  form of most  plant  or animal
    matter cannot be recognized with the naked eye.
Mineral Horizons and Layers


     Mineral  horizons  contain  less  than 30  percent organic matter  if the
mineral fraction contains more  than  50 percent clay or less than 20 percent
organic matter if the mineral  fraction has  no clay.  Intermediate clay con-
tent requires proportional content of  organic matter.

 A—Mineral horizons consisting of:   (1) horizons of organic-matter accumu-
    lation  formed  or forming  at or  adjacent  to the  surface;  (2) horizons
    that have lost  clay,  iron,  or aluminum with resultant concentration of
    quartz  or other resistant minerals  of  sand or  silt  size;  or (3) hori-
    zons dominated  by  1  or 2 above  but transitional  to  an underlying B or
    C.

Al—Mineral horizons,  formed or forming at or  adjacent  to the surface, in
    which  the feature  emphasized is  an accumulation of  humified organic
    matter  intimately associated with the mineral fraction.

A2—Mineral horizons in which the  feature emphasized  is  loss of  clay,  iron,
    or aluminum, with  resultant concentration of quartz or other  resistant
    minerals  in sand and  silt sizes.

A3—A  transitional horizon  between A and B,  and  dominated  by  properties
    characteristic  of  an  overlying Al or A2 but  having  some  subordinate
    properties of  an underlying B.
                                     631

-------
AB—A horizon  transitional between A and B,  having  an upper part dominated
    by properties of A and a lower  part  dominated by  properties  of B, and
    the  two  parts cannot  conveniently be  separated into A3 and Bl.

A&B—Horizons  that would  qualify  for  A2  except  for  included parts consti-
    tuting less  than 50 percent  of the volume that would qualify as B.

AC—A horizon  transitional between  A and C, having  subordinate properties
    of both  A  and C,  but not  dominated by  properties  characteristic of
    either A or  C.

 B—Horizons in which the dominant  feature  or  features  is  one  or  more of
    the  following:   (1) an  illuvial concentration of  silicate  clay,   iron,
    aluminum, or humus,  alone or  in combination;  (2) a residual concentra-
    tion  of  sesquioxides  or  silicate clays,  alone or mixed,  that has formed
    by means other than solution and removal of  carbonates or more soluble
    salts;  (3)  coatings   of  sesquioxides   adequate   to  give  conpicuously
    darker,  stronger,  or  redder  colors than  overlying and  underlying  hori-
    zons  in  the same  sequum  but without apparent illuviation  of  iron and
    not genetically  related  to  B horizons that meet  requirements  of 1 or 2
    in the same  sequum; or (4)  an alteration of  material  from its original
    condition  in sequums  lacking  conditions defined in 1,  2,  and  3 that
    obliterates  original  rock structure,  that forms  silicate clays, libera-
    tes  oxides,  or  both, and  that  forms  granular,  blocky, or  prismatic
    structure if  textures  are such that volume  changes accompany changes in
    moisture.

Bl—A  transitional  horizon between  B  and Al or  between  B and A2  in  which
    the horizon  is dominated  by  properties of an underlying B2 but has some
    subordinate  properties of an overlying Al or A2.

B&A—Any  horizon qualifying  as  B  in  more  than 50  percent  of   its volume
    including parts  that  qualify as  A2.

B2—That  part of  the B horizon where the  properties  on which the B is  based
    are  without  clearly  expressed  subordinate  characteristics  indicating
    that  the horizon is transitional in an adjacent  overlying A or an  adja-
    cent  underlying C  or R.

B3—A  transitional horizon between  B and C  or R in which  the  properties
    diagnostic  of  an overlying B2 are clearly  expressed  but  are associated
    with  clearly  expressed properties  characteristics of C or R.

 C—A mineral horizon  or  layer,  excluding bedrock,   that is  either  like or
    unlike the  material  from which  the solum  is presumed to have  formed,
    relatively little  affected by pedogenic  processes,  and  lacking proper-
    ties  diagnostic  of A  or  B but  including materials  modified by:   (1)
    weathering outside  the zone  of major biological  activity;  (2)  reversi-
    ble cementation,  development of brittleness,  development of  high bulb
    density,  and other properties  characteristic of  fragipans; (3) gleying;
    (4) accumulation  of  calcium  or magnesium  carbonate  or more  soluble
    salts; (5)  cementation by such  accumulations as calcium or  magnesium

                                    632

-------
    carbonate or more  soluble salts; of  (6)  cementation by  alkali-soluble
    siliceous material or by  iron and silica.

 R—Underlying consolidated  bedrock,  such as  granite,  sandstone, or  lime-
    stone.  If presumed to be like  the  parent rock from which  the  adjacent
    overlying layer or horizon was  formed,  the symbol R is used  alone.   If
    alone.  If presumed to be unlike  the overlying material, the R  is pre-
    ceded by a Roman numeral  denoting lithologic  discontinuity  as explained
    under the heading.
              SYMBOLS USED TO  INDICATE  DEPARTURES SUBORDINATE
                   TO THOSE  INDICATED BY CAPITAL LETTERS


     The following symbols are  to  be used in the manner indicated under the
heading Conventions Governing  Use  of Symbols.

 b—Buried soil horizon

ca—An accumulation of carbonates  of alkaline  earths, commonly of calcium.

es—An accumulation of calcium sulfate.

en—Accumulations of  concretions  or hard nonconcretionary  nodules enriched
    in sesquioxides with or  without  phosphorus.

 f—Frozen soil

 g—Strong gleying

 h—Illuvial humus

ir—Illuvial iron

 m—Strong cementation,  induration

 p—Plowing or other  disturbance

sa—An accumulation  of  salts more soluble than  calcium  sulfate

si—Cementation  by siliceous  material,  soluble  in  alkali.   This symbol  is
    applied only  to  C.

 t—Illuvial clay
                                     633

-------
                           APPENDIX C REFERENCE
USDA.  1975.  Soil  taxonomy:   a  basic  system  of  soil  classification  for
making  and  interpreting  soil  surveys.  Agricultural  Handbook  No.  436.
754 pp.
                                    634

-------
                                APPENDIX D

         INDUSTRIAL LAND TREATMENT SYSTEMS CITED IN THE LITERATURE
     A variety of experiences with land  treatment  of  industrial  wastes  have
been reported in the literature.  No  attempt  was made to to verify  whether
the  reported  wastes were  classified as  hazardous,  however,  the list  ex-
cludes  references  to wastes  which were  identified  as  likely  to  be  non-
hazardous.
            Industry
        References
Textile (SIC 22)
   Industrial Wastewater
   Industrial Wastewater
   Wool Preserving
   Wool Scouring

Lumber (SIC 24)
   Wood Distillation

Pulp and Paper (SIC 26)
   Pulpmill
   Pulpmill
   Pulpmill
   Pulpmill
   Pulpmill
   Pulpmill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Papermill
   Hard Board
   Paper Board
   Straw Board
   Insulated Board
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
Sayapin (1978)
Wallace (1976)
Wallace (1976)
Wadleigh (1968)
Hickerson and McMahon (1960)
Wadleigh (1968)
Hayman (1978)
Watterson (1971)
Blosser and Owens (1964)
Kadamki (1971)
Flower (1969)
Vercher et al.  (1965)
Jorgenson (1965)
Dolar et al.  (1972)
Das and Jena  (1973)
Aspitarte et  al.  (1973)
Wallace (1976)
Hayman (1978)
Parsons (1967)
Koch and Bloodgood  (1959)
Meighan (1958)
Phillip (1971)
Crawford (1958)
Wisniewski et al. (1955)
Billings (1958)
Blosser and Owens (1964)
Gellman and Blosser  (1959)
Kolar (1965)
Kolar and Mitiska (1965)
Hashimoto (1966)
Yokota and Hashimoto (1966)
Pasak (1969)
Yakushenko et al. (1971)
Minami and Taniguchi (1971)
                                    635

-------
                          APPENDIX  D  (continued)
            Industry
                                 References
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Sulfite Pulp Mill
   Kraft (sulfate)
   Kraft (sulfate)
   Kraft (sulfate)
   Semi-Chemical
   Drinking
   Not Specified  (saline)

Other Inorganic Chemicals (SIC 2819)
   Waste Sulfuric Acid

Chemicals (SIC 282-289)
   Biological Chemical
   PCB
   PCS
   PCB

Pharmaceuticals (SIC 283)
   Mycelial Waste
   Fermentation
   Antibiotic Production
   High Nitrogen Industrial Wastewater
   High Nitrogen Industrial Wastewater
   High Nitrogen Industrial Wastewater
   High Nitrogen Industrial Wastewater
Explosives (SIC 2892)
Petroleum Refining
Petroleum Refining
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Ref inery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
   Ref inery-Decomp.
   Refinery-Decomp.
(SIC 2911) and
(SIC 2992)
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
 of Oily Waste
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
in Soil
                         Knowles et al. (1974)
                         Flaig and Sochtig (1974)
                         Blosser and Owens (1964)
                         Crawford (1958)
                         Wallace et al. (1975)
                         Voights (1955)
                         Flower (1969)
                         Hayman (1979)
                         Wallace (1977)

                         Shevstova et al. (1969)
                         Woodley (1968)
                         Griffin et al. (1978)
                         Tucker et al. (1975)
                         Griffin et al. (1977)
                         Nelson (1977)
                         Colovos and Tinklenberg (1962)
                         Uhliar and Bucko (1974)
                         Brown (1976)
                         Wallace (1976)
                         Deroo (1975)
                         Woodley (1968)

                         Lever (1966)
Jensen (1958)
Grove (1978)
Dhillon (1973)
Dotson et al. (1971)
Franke and Clark (1974)
Jobson et al. (1974)
Kincannon (1972)
Lewis (1977)
Maunder and Waid (1973)
Giddens (1974)
Nissen (1970)
Plice (1948)
Raymond et al. (1975)
Raymond et al. (1976)
Ongerth (1975)
                                     636

-------
                          APPENDIX D (continued)
            Industry
                                 References
   Refinery-Decomp. of Oily Waste in Soil
   Refinery-Decomp. of Oily Waste in Soil
   Refinery-Decomp. of Oily Waste in Soil
   Tank Bottom
   Refinery Wastes:  Biosludge, Tank
     Bottoms, API Separator Sludge
   Refinery Waste
   Refinery Waste
   Refinery (1) Tank Bottom Crude
            (2) Slop Oil Immulsion
            (3) API Separator Sludge
            (4) Drilling Mud
            (5) Cleaning Residue

Leather Tanning and Finishing (SIC 3111)
   Leather Tanning
   Leather Tanning
   Leather Tanning
   Leather Tanning
   Leather Tanning
   Leather Tanning
and Finishing
and Finishing
and Finishing
and Finishing
and Finishing
and Finishing
Blast Furnace Slag (SIC 3312) Steel

Primary Aluminum Smelting (SIC 3334)
   Waste Oil from Aluminum Manufacturing

Electricity Production (SIC 4911)
   Utility Waste
   Fly Ash
   Fly Ash
   Fly Ash
   Fly Ash
                         Dibble and Bartha (1979)
                         Knowlton and Rucker (1978)
                         Baker (1978)
                         Cansfield and Racz (1978)

                         Cresswell (1977)
                         Akoun (1978)
                         Huddleston (1979)
                         Lewis (1977)
                         Ibid.
                         Ibid.
                         Ibid.
                         Ibid.
Parker (1965)
Parker (1967)
Jansky (1961)

Wallace (1976)
S.C.S. Engineers (1976)

Volk et al. (1952)

Ongerth (1975)
Neal et al. (1976)
                         Page et al. (1977)
                         Martens (1971)
                         Plank and Martens (1974)
                         Plank et al. (1975)
                         Schnappinger et al. (1975)
                                    637

-------
                            APPENDIX D REFERENCES
Akoun,  G.  L. 1978. Hydrocarbon  residues biodegradation  in  the  soil. Study
conducted  by: Esso  Saf,  Shell Francaise, and Inra Rouen.

Aspitarte,  T. R., A.  S.  Rosenfeld,  B. C. Sarnie and H. R. Araberg. 1973. Pulp
and paper  mill  sludge disposal and crop  production.  Tech.  Assoc. Pulp Pap.
Ind. 56:140-144.

Baker,  D.  A. 1978. Petroleum processing wastes,  p.  1269-1270  In  J. Water
Poll. Control Fed.  June  1978.

Billings,  R.  M.  1958. Stream improvement through  spray  disposal of  sulfite
liquor  at  the Kimberly-Clark Corp.,  Proc. of the 13th Industrial Waste Con-
ference. Purdue Univ.  96:71.

Blosser, R.  0., and E. L.  Owens.  1964.  Irrigation and land disposal  of pulp
mill effluent. Water  and Sewage  Works 3: 424-432.

Brown,  G.   E.  1976.  Land   application   of  high  nitrogen industrial waste
water.  In  Water -  1976 II  biological  waste  water treatment.  ALCHE symposium
series,~73(167):227-232.

Cansfield,  P. E.,  and G.  J.  Racz. 1978.  Degradation  of  hydrocarbon  sludges
in the  soil. Can. J.  Soil  Sci. 58:339-345.

Colovos, G.  C.,  and N. Tinklenberg.  1962.  Land disposal of  pharmaceutical
manufacturing wastes.  Biotech.  Bioengr. 4:153-160.

Crawford,  S. C. 1958.  Spray irrigation  of certain sulfite pulp mill  wastes.
Sewage  and  Industrial Wastes  30(10):1266-1272.

Cresswell,  L.  W.  1977. The  fate  of   petroleum  in  a  soil  environment. Pro-
ceedings of  1977  Oil  Spill Conference.  New  Orleans,  Louisiana.  March 8-10.
p. 479-482.

Das, R. C.,  and M.  K. Jena.  1973.  Studies on the effect  of soil application
of molybdenum, boron  and paper mill  sludge  on the  post harvest qualities of
potato  tuber (Solanum Tuberosum  L.)   Madras  Agr. J.  60 (8):1026-1029.

Deroo,  H.  C.  1975.  Agricultural  and  horticultural  utilization of fermenta-
tion residues.   Connecticut  Agr. Exp.  Sta.   New  Haven,  Connecticut. Bull.
750.

Dhillon, G.  S. 1973.  Land  disposal of refinery wastes. Environmental Devel-
opment, Bethel Corp.  San Francisco,  California.

Dibble, J.  T. and R.  Bartha.  1979. Leaching  aspects of oil sludge biodegra-
dation in soil. Soil Science  0038-075 x/79  p.  365-370.
                                    638

-------
Dolar, S. G., J. R. Boyle, and D.  R. Kenny.  1972.   Paper mill sludge dispo-
sal on  soils:   effects on the  yield and mineral  nutrition of  oats (Avena
Satival). J. Environ. Qual.  (4)  405-409.

Dotson,  G.  K.,   R.  B. Dean,  B.  A.  Kenner,  and  W.  B.  Cooke.  1971.  Land-
spreading,  a conserving  and  non-polluting  method  of   disposing   of  oily
wastes.  Proc.  of  the 5th  Int.  Water  Poll.  Conference. Vol.  1  Sec.  II.
36/1-36/15.

Flaig, W., and H.  Sochtig.  1974. Utilization of  sulphite waste  of  the cel-
lulous  industry  as an organic nitrogen fertilizer. Netherlands  J.  of Agr.
Sci. 22 (4):255-261.

Flower, W. A. 1969. Spray irrigation for  the disposal of effluents contain-
ing deinklng wastes." Tech.  Assoc.  Pulp Pap. Ind. 52:1267.

Francke,  H. C.,  and F.  E.  Clark. 1974. Disposal  of  oily waste by microbial
assimilation.  Union  Carbide,  Doc  Y-1934. May 16.  Prepared  by U. S. Atomic
Energy Commission.

Gellman,  I., and R. 0. Blosser.  1959.  Disposal of pulp and paper mill waste
by land application and  irrigation use. Proc. of  the 14th Industrial Waste
Conference. Purdue Univ. 104:479.

Giddens,  P. H.  1974.  The early  petroleum industry.  Porcupine Press, Phila-
delphia,  1950. 195 p.

Griffin,  R.,  R.  Clark,  M.  Lee and  E.  Chain. 1978.  Disposal  and removal  of
polychlorinated  biphenyls in soil.  Proc.  of  the  Fourth Annual Research Sym-
posium. August.  EPA-600  9/78-016.  p. 169-181.

Griffin,  R. A.,  F. B.  Bewalle,  E.S.K.  Chain, J.  H. Kim, and A. K. Au. 1977.
Attentuation  of  PCBs  by soil materials and  char wastes,  p.  208-217. In  S.
K.  Banerji  (ed.)  Management of gas  and  leachate  in  landfills. Ecological
research  series, EPA.  Cincinnati,  Ohio. EPA 600/9-77-026.

Grove,  G. W.  1978. Use  land farming  for oily waste  disposal.   Hydrocarbon
Processing. May. p. 138-140.

Hashimoto,  T.  Y.  1966.  Edaphological  studies on  the  utilization of  waste-
pulp  liquor.  2.  Effects of  the  liquor on  the absorption of nutrient ele-
ments  by crops.  J.   Sci.  Soil  Manure  Tokyo  37:223-225;  J.  Soil  Sci.   PI.
Nutr.  12  (3):39.

Hayman, J.  P.  1978.  Land disposal  of  mineralised  effluent  from a  pulp  and
paper mill. In Progress  in  water technology. Vol. 9,  No.  4.

Hayman,  J.  P.,  and  L.  Smith.  1979.  Disposal of  saline effluent  by con-
trolled-spray irrigation.  J. Water Poll.  Control Fed. 51(3):526-533.

Hickerson,  R. D.,  and E.  K.  McMahon. 1960.  Spray irrigation  of  wood distil-
lation  wastes. J.  Water  Poll. Control. Fed. 32(55).

                                     639

-------
 Huddleston, R.  L.  1979.  Solid waste  disposal:  landfarming.  Chemical  Engi-
 neering.  February 26. p. 119-124.

 Jansky, K.  1961.  Tannery-waste  water disposal.  Kozarstvi 2:327-329,  355-
 360.

 Jensen, V. 1958. Decomposition of  oily wastes in soil. Dept.  of  Microbiol-
 ogy and  Microbial Ecology  Royal  Veterinary and  Agricultural University.
 Copenhagen, Denmark.  Rolishedsvej 21.

 Jobson, A., McLaughlin, F.  D.  Cook,  and D.W.S.  Westlake.  1974.  Effects  of
 amendments  on  microbial Inc.  utilisation  of oil  applied  to soil.  Appl.
 Mlcrobiol. 27(1):166-171.

 Jorgensen, J.  R. 1965. Irrigation  of  slash pine with paper mill  effluents.
 Bull.  La.  State Univ. Division of Engineering Res.  No. 80.  p.  92-99.

 Kadamki,   K.  1971.  Accumulation  of  sodium in  potted soil  irrigated  with
 pulpmill  effluents.  Consultant 16: 93-94.

 Kincannon, C.  B.  1972. Oily  waste  disposal  by  soil  cultivation  process.
 EPA. EPA-R2-72-110.

 Knowles,  R., R. Neufild and S. Simpson.  1974. Acetylene  reduction  nitrogen
 fixation  by pulp and  paper  mill  effluent  and by  klebsiella  isolated  from
 effluents  and  environmental  situations. Appl. Microbiol.  28  (4):608-613.

 Knowlton,  H.  E.,  and J.  E. Rucker.  1978.  Land  farming  shows promise  for
 refinery  waste disposal.  Oil and  Gas Journal, May 14. p.  108-116.

 Koch,  H.  C. , and D.  E. Bloodgood.  1959.  Experimental  spray  irrigation  of
 paper  board mill wastes.  Sew.  Ind. Wastes 31:827.

 Kolar,  L.  1965.  Alteration of  moisture properties of soil  and  technical
 soil constants by application  of  waste waters from cellulose works.  Rada.
 3  (5):91-95.

 Kolar,  L.,  and  J.  Mitiska.  1965.  The  influence  of the presence of  sulphide
waste  liquor in irrigation  water  on  the biological,  chemical and  physico-
 chemical  conditions of  the  soil.  Budejovic. 3  (4):11-20.

Lever,  N.  A.  1966.   Disposal  of  nitrogenous liquid  effluent  from modder
fontein dynamite factory. Proc.  of  the  21st Industrial  Waste Conference.
Purdue University 121:902.

Lewis,   R.   S.   1977.  Sludge farming  of  refinery  wastes  as  practiced  at
Exxon's Bayway  refinery  and chemical plant. Proceedings  of  the  National
Conference  on  Disposal  of   Residues  on  Land.  Information  Transfer,   Inc.
Rockville,  Maryland,  p. 87-92.
                                    640

-------
Martens,  D.  C.  1971.  Availability  of  plant  nutrients in  fly  ash.  Compost.
Sci. 12:15-19.

Maunder,  B.  R., and J.  S.  Waid.  1973.  Disposal of waste oil by land spread-
ing. Proceedings  of  the Pollution  Research  Conference. Wairakei,  New Zea-
land. June 20-21.

Meighan,  A.  D. 1958.  Experimental  spray irrigation of  straw  board wastes.
Proc. of  the  13th Industrial  Waste  Conference. Purdue University 96:456.

Minami,  M.,   and  T.  Taniguchi.  1971.  Effects  of  water  pollution  on  the
growth and yield of rice plants.  1. Effects  of waste water from a pulp fac-
tory.  Hokkaido Perfectual Agricultural  Experiment  Station.  Bull.  24.   p.
56-68.

Neal, D.  M.,  R. L. Glover  and P.  G. Moe. 1976.  land  disposal  of oily waste
water  by  means of spray irrigation.  Proc.  of  the 1976 Cornell  Agr. Waste
Management Conference.  Ann Arbor  Sci.  Publ.  Inc. Ann Arbor,  Michigan, p.
757-767.

Nelson, D. 1977. Laboratory and  field scale  investigation of mycelial waste
decomposition in the soil  environment. Presented to the Soc. for Industrial
Microbiology  meeting.   Michigan  State  Univ.   East  Lansing, Michigan. Aug.
1977.

Nissen,  T.  V.  1970.  Biological  degradation  of  hydrocarbons  with  special
reference to  soil contamination.  Tidssk 2 PI.  Arl. 74:391-405.

Ongerth,  J.  E. 1975.  Feasibility  studies  from  land  disposal  of  a  dilute
oily waste water. To  be presented  at  the 30th Industrial Waste Conference.
Purdue Univ.

Page, A.  L.,  F. T. Bingham, L. J.  Lund,  G.  R.  Bradford, and A.  A. Elseewi.
1977.   Consequences  of trace element  enrichment  of soils  and vegetation
from  the  combustion of  fuels used in  power  generation.  SCE  research and
development  series 77-RD-29.  Rosemead, California.

Parker, R. R.  1965.  Spray  irrigation  for industrial waste disposal.  Cana-
dian Municipal  Utilities 103:7:28-32.

Parker, R.  R. 1967.  Disposal of  tannery wastes.  Proc. of  the 22nd  Indus-
trial Waste  Conference. Purdue Univ.  129:36.

Parsons,  W.   1967.  Spray  irrigation  from  the  manufacture of  hard  board.
Proc. of  the  22nd Industrial  Waste Conference. Purdue Univ. p. 602-607.

Pasak, V. 1969. Sulphite waste liquor for protecting soil against wind  ero-
sion. Ved, Prace Vyskum. UST. Melior. 10:143-148.

Philipp,  A.  H. 1971.  Disposal of  insulation  board  mill  effluent  by  land
irrigation.  J.  Water Poll. Control Fed.  43:1749.
                                     641

-------
Plank, C. 0.,  and  D.  C.  Martens. 1974. Boron  availability  as influenced by
application of fly ash to  soil.  Soil  Sci.  Soc. Proc.  38:974-977.

Plank,  C.  0., D.  C.  Martens,  and D.  L.  Hallock.   1975.  Effects  of  soil
application of fly ash on  chemical composition and yield  of  corn (Zea Mays
L.)  and  on chemical  composition  of  displaced  soil  solutions.  Plant  Soil
"42:465-476.

Plice,  M.  J.  1948.   Some  effects  of  crude  petroleum  on soil  fertility.
Proc. of The  Soil  Sci. Soc.  13:412-416.

Raymond, R. L.,  J.  0. Hudson, and  V.  W.  Jamison. 1976. Oil  degradation in
soil. Appl. Ehviron.  Microbiol.  31:522-535.

Raymond, R. L.,  J. 0.  Hudson, and V.  W. Jamison.  1975.  Assimilation of oil
by  soil  bacteria, refinery  solid  waste  proposal.  Proc.  40th  Mid-Year
Meeting, API. May  14. p. 2.

Sayapin, V. P. 1978.  Nutrition value  of fodder harmlessness  of plant output
grown with  textile industry  waste  water  irrigation. Cold  Regions Research
and Engineering  Laboratory.  Draft Translation 671.

Schnappinger,  M.  G.,  Jr.,  D.  C.  Martens,  and  C.  0.  Plank.  1975.  Zinc
availability  as  influenced by application of  fly ash to soil. Environ. Sci.
Technol. 9:258-261.

S.C.S.  Engineers.  1976.  Assessment of  industrial  hazardous waste practices
- leather tanning  and finishing industry.  NTIS PB 261018.

Shevtsova, I.  I.,; V. K. Marinich;  and S.  M.  Neigauz.   1969.  Effects  waste
water  from capron  production on higher  plants  and soil  micro-organisms.
Biol.  Nauk.  (4):91-94.  Chem.  Abstr. 71.

Tucker,  E.  S., W. J.  Litschg,  and W.  M.  Mees.   1975.  Migration of  poly-
chlorinated biphenyls in  soil  induced  by percolating water.  Bull.   Envi-
ron. Contain.  Toxicol.  13:86-93.

Uhliar,  J.,  and M. Bucko.   1974.  The use of industrial  wastes for  anti-
biotic production  in  crop  production.  Rostlinna Vyroba 20 (9):923-930.

Vercher,  B.   D., M.  B.  Sturgis,  and  0. 0.  Curtis.   1965.  Paper mill  waste
water for crop irrigation  and its effect on  the  soil.  Bull. La. Agr.   Exp.
Stat. No. 604. p.  46.

Voights,  D.   1955.  Lagooning  and spray disposal  of neutral sulfite  semi-
chemical  pulp mill liquors.  Proc.  of the  10th Industrial  Waste  Conference.
Purdue Univ.  89:497.

Volk, G.  W.,  R. B. Harding, and C.  E. Evans. 1952. A comparison of  blast
furnace  slag  and limestone  as  a soil  amendment.  Res.  Bull.  708, Ohio Agr.
Exp. Sta., Columbus,  Ohio.
                                     642

-------
Wadleigh,  Cecil H.  1968. Wastes  in relation  to  agriculture and  forestry.
USDA.  Washington,  D.C. Misc. Publication 1065.

Wallace,  A.  T.  1976. Land disposal of liquid industrial wastes,  p.  147-162.
Jin_ R.  L.  Sanks  and Asano (ed.) Land treatment  and disposal  of municipal  and
industrial  wastewater. Ann Arbor  Science  Publishers Inc.   Ann Arbor,  Mich-
igan.

Wallace,  A.  T.  1977.  Massive  sulfur  application  to   highly   calcareous
agricultural  soil  as a sink for waste sulfur.  Res.  2:263-267.

Wallace, A.  T.,  R.  Luoma, and M. Olson. 1975.  Studies of  the feasibility  of
a  rapid infiltration system for disposal of Kraft Mill effluent.  To  be pre-
sented at the  30th Industrial Waste Conference. Purdue Univ.

Watterson, K.  G.  1971. Water quality  in relation to fertilization and pulp
mill effluent disposal.  Consultant 16:91-92.

Wisniewski,  T.  K.,  A.  J. Wiley,  and  B. J.  Lueck.  1955.  Ponding and soil
infiltration  for  disposal of  spent sulphite liquor in  Wisconsin. Proc.  of
the 10th Industrial  Waste Conference.  Purdue Univ. 89:480.

Woodley, R.  A.  1968.  Spray  irrigation  of  organic  chemical  wastes.   Proc.
of  the  23rd  Industrial Waste  Conference.  Purdue Univ.  Lafayette, Indiana.
132:251-261.

Yakushenko,  I.  K.,  I.  Y. Kazantsev,  and  V.  G.  Cvsyannikova.  1971. Waste
sulphite liquors  of  the  cellulous industry  and  their use  for irrigation.
Vest. Sel1- Khoz. Nauki.  Mosk  1:87-92.

Yokota, H.,  and  T.  Hashimoto.  1966.  Edaphological  studies  on  the utiliza-
tion of waste  pulp  liquor.   3. Effects of  the liquor on phosphorus fixa-
tion. J.  Sci. Soil  Manure,  Tokyo 37:294-297;  J.   Soil Sci.  PI.  Nutr.   12
(4):40.
                                    643

-------
                                APPENDIX E

                             SAMPLE  CALCULATIONS
     In  order  to   illustrate  the  interpretation  of  data  from  the  site
assessment,  waste  analysis and  pilot  studies,  sample  calculations  and
design recommendations are  given  for  a  hypothetical  land treatment unit and
a given waste.  The components of the waste  are considered individually and
compared  to  determine  the application limiting  constituents  (ALC),  rate
limiting  constituent  (RLC) and  capacity limiting constituent (CLC).   The
assumptions  and calculations  used  in  the  design  of  the  HWLT  unit  are
discussed in detail in  Section 7.5.  The  required treatment  area size and
the useful life of  the HWLT unit  are then calculated  for  the example waste
(Appendix E-7).   Additionally, an  example  of  water  balance  determinations
and runoff retention pond  sizing  is  presented.
                                    644

-------
                               APPENDIX E-l

            WATER BALANCE AND RETENTION POND SIZE CALCULATIONS
     As discussed in  Section  8.3.1.1  the water balance method  can be used
to evaluate hydraulic load  and  required storage for  surface  runoff.   This
is a very simplified approach to calculating the water balance and conserv-
ative values should  be  used  to  guard against any inaccuracy  in parameter
estimates used  in the method.   The value  used  in these  calculations  for
discharge can be varied to  account  for  the  method  of  runoff water control,
in this case the  storage  volume  calculated  includes  the seasonal accumula-
tion of water.

     Initially, climatologlcal  data  or  estimates  should  be  made  for  the
parameters in the water balance.  Precipitation values are derived from the
long-term rainfall  data  collected at   a  nearby  weather   station,  chosen
according  to  the  criteria  given in   Section  3.3.    Estimates  of  the
evapotranspiration  can  be  obtained by  using  the  class A pan evaporation
value for each month  (Figs. 8.9-3.20  show monthly  pan evaporation data for
the U.S.).   This value is then multiplied by  an appropriate  annual  pan
evaporation coefficient.  These coefficients are used to relate pan data to
evaporation expected  from lakes.   An  estimation of the  amount of leachate
may  be  calculated  based  on  the  hydraulic  conductivity  of  the  most
restrictive layer as  reported In the Soil  Conservation  Service (SCS) soil
series  description  ("blue  sheets")  or, preferably,  as  measured  for  the
soil.   The  actual leaching may  be  only 10-15% of  that listed  by SCS data
yet to  maintain a liberal  estimate of runoff,  leachate  should  be  set at
zero since waste  application  may affect the soil  permeability.  The depth
of water applied  monthly  in the waste is calculated  from  water content of
the waste, waste production rate, and total area of the land treatment unit
watershed.  In  this  example it  is assumed  that  waste quality and quantity
are relatively  constant, but if it  is known  that   these  assumptions  are
false,  monthly estimates will  vary  and can  be  ascertained   from  a more
detailed accounting  of  the  waste stream.   For  this  example, water content
of the  waste  is  70%  and  waste  production  rate  (PR)  is 20 metric tons or
about 20,000 liters/day.  The total watershed  area of the HWLT unit  is 6.6
hectares.  Therefore, water application  per month  is  calculated as

      W(c / o)    PR x water content x 10~5  x # of  days in  the month
                                 Watershed area (ha)

               m  2.0  x  104  I/day x  0.7  x 10"5 x  t  of  days/month
                                      6.6 ha

               »  0.021  (days  in  the given month).

Watershed area is generally  larger than the  unit area actively receiving
wastes  (A), to  be determined later, but the watershed  is  a function of A.
This is because for  any unit  area A,  there are  usually additional areas  in
the watershed made up of  runoff  ponds,  waterways,  roads, levees,  etc.
                                     645

-------
     Now using the water balance method from  Section  8.3.1.1,  first  use  the
entire  climatic  record assuming zero  discharge (Table  E.I).   The  example
shows  only two  years  of record  for illustrative  purposes  only.   A much
longer  record  is needed in  practice (20  years  if available).   Since  the
last  column  in  the  table,  cumulative storage,  never drops  to zero, some
discharge  or enhanced water  loss will be necessary.

     Next, one  chooses  a discharge  rate  (D)  by taking  the average  annual
increase in cumulative storage (CS)  for the simulated period  of record.   In
this example, CS is  9.66 and 8.76 for years one  and two, respectively.   The
CS is  thus 9.2  and  D will  assume a  monthly value  of  0.77  (9.2/12 =  0.77).
Now rerun  the  simulated record, this time using the  D  term  in the  budget
(Table E.2).

     Based on the potential  hazards  of  an uncontrolled release of water,  a
0.10  probability is  considered  acceptable in  this  example.   The  storage
value corresponding  to this  from the second run water budget  is not  readily
apparent due to  the  short record.

     If  20 years of data  were  available, then  the  highest  annual  value
which  is  exceeded only  in  10% of the  years  (i.e.,  in  2  years  of  the  20
years) would  be chosen  as  the design  value  for  normal seasonal storage.
For convenience  in this example, 15.62 cm  storage  is  chosen.

     In addition to  this volume, capacity must be available  to store  the
runoff from the  25-year, 24-hour  storm.   The 25-year, 24-hour  rainfall  for
this site  is 20.1 cm.  Using the  SCS curve number method described  in Sec-
tion 8.3.4, the  runoff  from  the site would be  19.5 cm assuming  antecedent
moisture group III,  fallow land use, and soil hydrologic group C.

     Finally, management chooses to design  an  additional  10% volume  for
sludge and sediment  buildup  in the ponds.  This  would amount  to 0.10(15.6 +
19.5) - 3.5 cm.   Minimum freeboard   (does  not  contribute to storage) of  at
least 60  cm  should  be provided above  the 38.6 cm  spillway  level to  guard
against levee overtopping or failure.   Since  the HWLT unit area is  6.6  ha,
this 38.6  cm storage translates into 254.75 ha-cm.

     The assumption  of zero  leaching will  be  invalid  in  many  circumstances,
but it allows a  sufficiently conservative water balance for  safe  retention
pond design.  Where  leaching of  waste constituents is of concern, however,
better estimates of  leaching are needed.   In  this  case, use of the  Perrier
and Gibson (1980) computer  model is suggested.  Aside from computer  tech-
niques, a  liberal leaching estimate  can be estimated  by  assuming  runoff  and
discharge are zero and setting leaching equal to the  runoff values found in
the first  run of the water balance (Table  E.I).
                                     646

-------
TABLE E.I  FIRST RUN WATER BALANCE, ASSUMING  DISCHARGE  RATE (D)  EQUAL TO
           ZERO
Month
S
0
N
D
J
F
M
A
M
J
J
A
S
0
N
D
J
F
M
A
M
J
J
A
Precip.
(cm)
6.4
6.0
6.5
8.1
8.2
7.2
6.7
8.3
7.8
4.3
5.4
6.4
5.2
5.8
9.4
7.3
6.1
6.3
6.9
9.8
8.2
5.0
4.1
5.8
Water
in
Waste
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.59
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.59
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
Evaporation
(cm)
6.0
5.4
4.6
3.8
4.0
4.9
6.1
6.9
7.6
9.4
10.6
8.7
6.3
5.2
4.7
4.1
4.1
5.1
5.9
6.8
7.5
9.7
10.8
8.4
Deep
Percolation
(cm)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
A
Storage
(cm)
1.03
1.25
2.53
4.95
4.85
2.89
1.25
2.03
-0.45
-4.47
-4.55
-1.65
-0.47
1.25
5.33
3.85
3.85
1.79
1.65
3.63
1.35
-4.07
-6.05
-1.95
Cumulative
Storage
(cm)
1.03
2.28
4.81
9.76
14.61
17.50
18.75
20.78
20.33
15.86
11.31
9.66
9.19
10.44
15.77
19.62
19.62
23.86
25.51
29.14
30.49
26.42
20.37
18.42
                                     647

-------
TABLE E.2  SECOND RUN WATER BALANCE, ASSUMING CONSTANT DISCHARGE  RATE  (D)
           OF 0.77 CM/MO
Month
S
0
N
D
J
F
M
A
M
J
J
A
S
0
N
D
J
F
M
A
M
J
J
A
Precip.
(cm)
6.4
6.0
6.5
8.1
8.2
7.2
6.7
8.3
7.8
4.3
5.4
6.4
5.2
5.8
9.4
7.3
6.1
6.3
6.9
9.8
8.2
5.0
4.1
5.8
Water
in
Waste
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.59
0.05
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
0.59
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.63
0.65
0.65
Evapo-
ration
(cm)
6.0
5.4
4.6
3.8
4.0
4.9
6.1
6.9
7.6
9.4
10.6
8.7
6.3
5.2
4.7
4.1
4.3
5.1
5.9
6.8
7.5
9.7
10.8
8.4
Deep
Perco-
lation
(cm)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Discharge
(cm)
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
0.77
A
Storage
(cm)
0.26
0.48
1.76
4.18
4.08
2.12
0.48
1.26
0.08
-5.24
-5.32
-2.42
-1.24
0.48
4.56
3.08
1.68
1.02
0.88
2.86
0.58
-4.84
-6.82
-2.72
Cumulative
Storage
(cm)
0.26
0.74
2.50
6.68
10.76
12.88
13.36
14.62
14.70
9.46
4.14
1.72
0.48
0.96
5.52
8.60
10.28
11.30
12.18
15.04
15.62
10.78
3.96
1.24
                                    648

-------
                                APPENDIX E-2

                    LOADING RATE CALCULATIONS  FOR MOBILE
                         NONDEGRADABLE  CONSTITUENTS


      Since  mobile  constituents   are   relatively free  to  migrate  to  the
 groundwater, some limits  should  be set for the  acceptable  leachate  concen-
 tration of each sp«cies.  The following  concentrations  In  the  leachate will
 be assumed to be the acceptable maxima  (Table 6.48 contains  a  list of  other
 elements).   These  values are  the permissible  water  criteria  for public
 drinking water supplies.

                                       Concentration  in  Water
                Constituent            	mg/1	

                    N                          100.0
                    Se                          0.01
                    Cl                        250.0

 The values to be used in actual design may vary  from site  to site depending
 on the  state regulations or  the possible  use   of  the groundwater.    The
 leachate concentration limits may be  used  in conjunction with the composi-
 tion of the waste and  the depth  of water  leaching water  (Appendix E-l)  to
 compute the amount  of  a given waste  that,  if applied, will result  in  the
 maximum acceptable concentration in the leachate.

      All soils  will  have some capacity to adsorb  and retain  limited  amounts
 of mobile species.  Additionally,  plants may take up N, Se and Cl.  If  the
 adsorption capacity  and  plant uptake  rates  are  known, they  may  be  taken
 into  account in the  calculation.   Once the adsorption capacities are satis-
 fied,  however,  subsequent additions  will likely  leach  to  the groundwater.
 Since  plant uptake  is  limited and  sorption capacities will eventually  be
 satisfied,  it  is  best  to calculate  the  required treatment area assuming
 that  both are negligible.

     For  example,  a  waste containing  10 mg/kg Se and 580  mg/kg  Cl is pro-
 duced  at a- rate of  20  metric dry tons/day  and  is to be land  treated  on  a
 site  having  an  estimated leaching rate of  29  cm/yr.   From  the above infor-
mation,  the  following can be  computed.

                                                               Waste
                        Concentration        Annual           Loading
                          in Waste          Application         Rate
       Constituent          'mg/kg             (kg/yr)         (kg/ha/yr)

          Se                10                7.3          1.5 x 106
          Cl               580                420          1.3 x 106

Chloride  is  the most limiting of  the  mobile  constituents,  with  a maximum
waste  loading  rate  of  1.3xl06 kg/ha/yr  to  maintain  leachate  concentra-
tions  at  or  below  250 mg/1.
                                     649

-------
                                APPENDIX E-3

         CALCULATION OF WASTE APPLICATIONS BASED ON NITROGEN CONTENT
      The  fate of  applied  nitrogen  (N)  in soil  has been  extensively dis-
 cussed  in Section 6.1.2.1.   There are many processes by which N may be lost
 from the  system,  but  N transported in runoff and  leachate  water is of pri-
 mary interest  since  it  can have  an adverse  impact  on  the  environment.
 Since direct  discharge from HWLT units  will  be prevented, only  the N con-
 centration leaving  the  site  in the  leachate  is  generally  of  concern.
 Typically,  10 ppm nitrate-nitrogen is taken as  the upper limit for drinking
 water and as  the  upper limit  of acceptable leachate  concentration.   The
 equations  used  to calculate  the  acceptable  load of  nitrogen-containing
 waste are  given  in Section  7.5.3.4  and are shown below:

               LR  = 105  |  10(C + V + D) + (L,)(L )  - (P.)(P )
                                   	   d    c      d   c

                                    I +  S  (M)(0)
where

     LR « waste  loading  rate  (kg/ha/yr);
      C = crop uptake  of N  (kg/ha/yr);
      V = volatilization (kg/ha/yr);
      D = denitrification (kg/ha/yr);
     Ld = depth  of  leachate  (cm/yr);
     Lc = N concentration in  leachate  (mg/1);
     Pj • depth  of  precipitation  (cm/yr);
     PC = concentration  of  inorganic N  in  the  waste (mg/1);
      I - concentration  of  inorganic N  in  the  waste (mg/1);
      M = mineralization rate  given in  Table 6.4;
      0 = concentration  of organic N in the waste  (mg/1);  and
      t = years  of  waste application.

Example

     A waste  containing  30 mg/1  inorganic N  and produced at a rate  of  20
metric tons/day, is to be land treated.  From this  information  and  that  in
Table E.3 loading  calculations can be  made and  are shown in the  following
equation:
              LR
                   105
10(C + V + D) + (Ld)(Lc) - (Pd)(Pc)
            I + (M)(0)
•1
                 _ 105  FlO(280 + 0 + 0) + (29)(10)  - (63.5)(.5)
                        L            30 +  (.35X260)

                 - 2.53 x 106 kg/ha/yr
                                     650

-------
TABLE E.3  WASTE CHARACTERISTICS USED IN EXAMPLE FOR NITROGEN
           LOADING RATE CALCULATIONS
             Parameter                   Value
             I (mg/1)                      30
             Lc (mg/1)                     10
             0 (mg/1)                     260
             Pc (mg/1)                      0.5
                 M                  0.35, 0.1, 0.05
            Pd (cm/yr)                     63.5
           C (kg/ha/yr)                   280
           D (kg/ha/yr)                     0
           V (kg/ha/yr)                     0
            Ld (cm/yr)                     29
             p (cm/gm3)                      1
                               651

-------
                                APPENDIX E-4

                EXAMPLES  OF  PHOSPHORUS  LOADING CALCULATIONS
     The  equation  presented  in  Section  7.5.3.5 is  used  to  calculate  the
acceptable  phosphorus  application limit.   Among the parameters  that  must be
known  are   soil   horizon  depth  (d.^),   the  P sorption  capacity  (bm^),
P  content  of  the  waste,  (pex),  the  rate  of waste  production,  and  the
crop cover,  if any.  Using  these values  and  the equation one can  calculate
the area needed for land  treatment  of  a waste  containing P.

     A  waste  having  wet  weight  P  content  of 2000  rag/kg  is   to  be  land
treated on  a soil having  a  20  cm deep  A horizon,  30  cm deep B  horizon  and
50 cm  deep  C  horizon.   The sorption  capacities of  the horizons are  54,  23
and 89 mgP/100 g, respectively.
Horizon
A
B
C
Depth
(cm)
20
30
50
P
g/cm-*
1.3
1.35
1.45
''max
mg/kg
540
230
890
pex
mg/kg
2
1
3
The applicable equation LC =  (10)   y  d    p(b    -  P  )
                                    L  i      max    ex


where

       d^ - thickness  of  the  ith horizon;
        p » bulk density  of the soil  (g/cm-*);
     bmax " p sorption capacity estimated  from Langmiur  isotherms (mg/kg);
      Pex - NaHC03 extractable P (mg/kg);  and
       LC = phosphorus loading capacity (kgP/ha).

Using the above data the  P loading  rate can  be calculated as follows:


         LC = 10  J  (20)(1.3)(540  -  2) +  10  E  (30)(1.35)(230-1)


              + 10  ?  (50)(1.45)(890 - 3)
                   t=l

            - 139,800  + 92,745 + 643,075 - 875,700  kg P/ha.

The phosphorus loading capacity (LC)  of the  soil is 875,700 kgP/ha, which
for a waste containing 2000 mg P/kg is equivalent to a waste loading
capacity of

                  875,700 kgP/ha                 8
                                      = 4.38  x  10 kg waste/ha
               2000 kgP/10  kg waste                8

                                     652

-------
                               APPENDIX  E-5

                CHOICE OF THE CAPACITY LIMITING CONSITUTENT
     The  example  contained in  this section  is  designed to  illustrate the
appropriate  approach   to   identifying  the  potential   capacity  limiting
constituent from among  the conserved species of a waste.   Conserved refers
to those  constituents,  usually only metals,  which are  practically immobile
and nondegradable  in the soil.   It  is  important  to  be sure that the soil pH
is at or  adjusted  to  6.5 or above  before  application.   The  soil CEC needs
to be measured and if less  than 5,  the loading  capacities should be reduced
by 50%.   For most  purposes, the loading capacities  presented in Table 6.47
are acceptable estimates.

     A waste is to be land  treated  on  a soil that  has a pH of 7.0 and a CEC
of 12.0  meq/lOOg.   The choice  of  potential CLC is made easily using the
ratio  of  each metal  concentration  in the  waste  residual  solids fraction
(RS) to its respective  acceptable  concentration in the soil  as shown in the
table below.  The  most  limiting metal  is Cr since  it has the largest ratio,
4.1.
TABLE E.4  CHOICE  OF  CAPACITY LIMITING CONSERVED SPECIES BY THE RATIO
           METHOD
          Metal
   mg/kg in
Waste Residual
    Solids
Metal Loading
  Capacity*
   (mg/kg)
Ratio
As
Cr
Cd
Cu
Pb
Ni
V
Zn
230
4,097
3.4
4.98
1,740
53
387
96
300
1,000
3
250
1,000
100
500
500
1.30
4.1
1.13
0.02
1.74
0.53
0.77
0.19
* Taken  from 6.47.
                                      653

-------
                                  APPENDIX E-6

                        ORGANIC LOADING RATE CALCULATIONS
     This  appendix includes examples of waste  characteristics and the  cal-
culations  which are  used  to  determine  the  organic  loading  rate  for  each
waste.   The second example  is  the general example being  used elsewhere  in
this appendix.   The greenhouse and respirometer studies that  can be used  to
generate  data  for these  calculations  are  described  in  Sections  7.3 and
7.2.1,  respectively.   The  first  step  in  determining  the  organic loading
rate is  to determine the  phytotoxicity  or microbial  toxicity limit.    This
limit is used as the maximum  tolerable level of organic waste constituents
from which the organic  half -life  is determined.   There  are  two  equations
which are  used  in  the determination of organic  half-life.  The first  equa-
tion determines the fraction of the applied carbon evolved as (X>2«

                                 (C02w - C02s)0.27
                            °t          ^

where

       Dt  » the portion of the applied  carbon which is  evolved as
             from the  organic fraction after time t.
     C02W  = the cumulative C02 evolved  by waste amended soil;
     C02S  - the cumulative C02 evolved  by unamended soil;
        t  = time;  and
       Ca  « carbon applied.

In addition to  the fraction calculated from  equation  1, the rate  of  degra-
dation  should be determined  for  the extractable organics and organic  sub-
fractions  using the following equation:
where

     dt. =  the  portion of  the carbon degraded from the organic
            fraction  or fraction 1,  2 or 3;
     ca . *  the  carbon  applied in the organic fraction or fractions  1 ,
        1    2 or 3;
     cr. *  the  residual carbon in the organic fraction or fraction  1,
            2 or 3; and
     cs. •  the  background  concentration in unamended soil of the
            organic fraction 1,  2 or 3.

The loading rate  can be calculated  for  the bulk organic fraction or for  any
subtraction of  interest which  may  better indicate  the  rate of degradation
of the hazardous  constituents.
                                     654

-------
      The residual  values given  In the  waste characteristics  tables  were
calculated  with  the  soil  carbon content  already subtracted.   The  lowest
fraction of organics degraded  (Dt) as  calculated above  is  used  to  deter-
mine  the halflife of  the waste, as follows:
The  half-life is then used  to  calculate the organic  loading rate in  (Cyr)
in kg/ha/yr.


                                            ccrit


where Ccrit  is the  maximum tolerable  limit  (kg/ha) of  organic  waste con-
stituents  as  determined by plant or microbial  toxicity.   This loading rate
is  based  on laboratory  data  obtained  under  controlled  conditions,  and
should  be  verified  by  field  data.   It  is  assumed that  the  waste has been
demonstrated  to  be  land treatable and will also  be monitored in  the field.
The  units are  derived  from laboratory data,  an assumed  plow  or  mixing
depth,  and the waste-soil  mix bulk  density.

     The bulk waste loading rate (LR)  based on  organics applied is calcu-
lated as follows:

                             LR - (Cyj.)/^

where  Cw  is  the  fraction  of   the  bulk  waste  constituted  by   degradable
organics.

Example 1:  An oil  waste which is produced at a rate of 20 metric dry
            tons/day is  to  be  land  treated on a vegetated site.   Ccrit
            is determined  to  be 2.7% (1.2x10^ kg/ha-15 cm) organics in
            soil.   Waste characteristics are  as follows  (Data from
            Schwendlnger (1968):

Waste characteristics:

            Extractable  organics (mg)	Total  Fj    F2   F3

            Carbon  applied  (Ca)            2500mg  Data not given

            Carbon  residual  (Cr)                   Data not given
            Respiration data -   C02  (mg)     Day 14     28    49

            Waste + soil                        620    1563  2104

                     soil                         20      63   104
                                     655

-------
Calculations:

1) Residual  Carbon:

   data not  given

2) Evolved C02:
3) Half-life:
                             _ (2104-104).27      2
                          49       2500'
                      t     -     =- - 111 days = .30 yr
4) Organic loading  rate:

                         2 x  105 ke/ha)
                                        tl/2
yr = 1/2(1.2 x 105 kg/ha) -r-- -  2 x  105  kg/ha/hr
5) LR = 1T77;	2 x  106 kg/ha/yr
         U • 1U

   where the organic content  of  the  waste C^ is  10% (0.10).

Greenhouse studies indicated  that  2.7%  oil in soil reduces the yield of rye
grass by 25%  compared to  the yield  of  unamended soil,  therefore Ccrit is
2.78% or  1.2  x 10^ kg/ha.   A respiration  study  was conducted for  49 days
and  the cumulative  C02  evolved  determined  for  the  entire  time  period.
The percent of  carbon  evolved as  002 Was  calculated to be 22% over the 49
day period.  The half-life  of the carbon applied  was  then calculated to be
111 days, or 0.30 years.  Using  the  half-life value, it was then determined
that 2  x  10^  kg/ha/yr oil  or 2 x 10^  kg  waste"/ha/yr could  be  applied to
the soil at the  land  treatment facility "while still retaining a vegetative
cover.   One  limitation  of  this study  is  that no information  is provided
which describes the degradation  of the  organic subfractions.
                                     656

-------
Example 2:  An API separator sludge from a petroleum refinery is
            produced at a rate of 20 metric tons/day and is to be land
            treated.  The site will be vegetated with ryegrass.  Waste
            characteristics are as follows (Brown et al. , 1980):

Waste characteristics:

        Extractable organics (mg)        Total    Fj    ?2     F$
Carbon applied (Ca)
Carbon residual (Cr)
Respiration data - C02 (mg)
Waste + soil
soil
550
220
Day 45
675
85
396
153
90
954
149
121
52
135
1111
215
33
14
180
1241
271
Calculations:

1) Residual Carbon:

                                  550-220
                            °to - --
                                  396-153
2) Evolved

                        D    »  (1241-271).27
                         180 "      550

3) Half-life:

                           .50      .50
                                   .48(180)  " 187  ' '
4) Organic loading rate:


  Cvr -  1/2 (Ccrlt) — — -  1/2(2.2 x 105 ^    1      - 2.2 x 105 kg/ha/yr
                    cl2                 ha (-51 yr)
5) LR -  to    -  2.2 x  106 kg/ha/yr


                                     657

-------
It  was  determined in  a greenhouse  study  that the  yield  of rye  grass  100
days  after  application of  5% wt/wt  (2.2  x 10^  kg/ha)  sludge  was  reduced
40%  below  control  yields.   After  180  days  of  incubation  in  a  soil
respirometer,   the   hydrocarbon   was   extracted   and   separated   into
subfractions.  Data  analysis  indicated that the slowest  rate of degradation
was  for  carbon evolved  as 002»  tne  va^ue  ^8% was  used  to calculate  the
half-life which was  determined to  be 187 days.  This value was  then used to
determine the maximum  loading rate with plant cover which was  2.2 x 10^ kg
organics/ha/yr.   For  this organics  application  rate,  2.2 x  106 kg/ha/yr
of bulk sludge would be applied  to the top 30 cm of soil.
                                    658

-------
                              APPENDIX E-7

                 CALCULATIONS OF  FACILITY SIZE  AND LIFE


      The waste  loading  rate,  unit size  and  the  unit life are  dependent  on
 the waste  and site  characteristics.   For  the following calculations,  the
 characteristics of  the  waste,  the climate,  and  the  soil used  in  the  above
 examples (Appendices E-l through  E-6) will be  assumed, and the  resulting
 design conditions will  be determined.

      For the  case  under study,  the RLC  and the  design  waste  loading  rate
 are determined by  a tabular comparison of  values previously  calculated  for
 each waste constituent  (Table E.5).   By  comparison,  the RLC is found  to  be
 bulk organics degradation with  a loading rate of 2.2  x  10^ kg/ha/yr.   For
 this example,  no  constituent  was found  to limit  the  size  of individual
 applications (ALC).

      Calculation of  the required land  treatment unit area is  done  using  the
 equation from Section 7.5.4.
                                       LR

where

     A - required treatment area (ha);
     PR = waste production rate (kg/yr) on a wet weight basis; and
     LR - waste loading rate (kg/ha/yr) on a wet weight basis.

Waste  production Is 20 metric tons/day,  so the required area is as fol-
lows:

                A a, 20 mt/day(103 kg/mt)365 days/yr   3 3
                          2.2 x 103 kg/ha/yr

     The capacity  limiting constituent  and  unit  life  are determined  by
calculating  unit  lives  for chromium  (Cr)  (the most  limiting  conserved
species)  and  phosphorus and  choosing  the more  restrictive  value.   For
phosphorus,  unit life is easily determined directly from the equation:


                                  BL-4P-
where
        UL - unit life  in  years;
      LCAP • maximum allowable  waste  load based on phosphorus (kg/ha);
            and
     LRRLC " loading rate  based on RLC  (kg/ha/yr).
                                     659

-------
TV,,    j      .      4.4 x 108 kg/ha
This  reduces  to:  - z- - a -
                   2.2 x 10° kg/ha/yr

for  the  example and  thus  the facility will  last  200 years  based  on phos-
phorus.

      For  chromium calculations , several  choices  or  determinations  must be
made.  In this  case, assume  a  plow  layer (Zp) of  30 cm  and  a time between
applications  (ta)  of 1  for each  plot.    Given  that  the  residual solids
(RS)  content  of the waste is 0.2 and  a bulk density (  3^3) of ttie  residual
solids mix  of 1.4 kg/1,  the application depth (Za) is found as follows:


                                LRinr x RS      c
                           z  -- E£ - x io-5
                            a      PBRS

                              m 2.2 x 106(0.2) x 10_5
                                     1.4

                              » 3.1  cm

The  background   soil  contains  100 mg/kg  Cr  (Cpo),  the  application limit
(Cpn) for Cr from  Table 6.47  is  1000 mg/kg,  and the  given concentration
of  Cr in the  waste  residual  solids  (Cfl  is  4097  mg/kg.   The  number of
applications of waste (n)  may be made can thus be  calculated:
                                  za    cpn~ca
                                  30  .   100-4097
                                » — -  In
                                  3.1     1000-4097

                                - 2.5

Unit  life  (UL) based on  Cr  is n ta,  and since  ta  is one  year,  UL equals
2.5 yr.   Comparing this  with results for  phosphorus, Cr  is  more limiting
and is  thus  the  CLC.   In  addition  to  hazardous  constituents,  the above
results aid  in the choice of  monitoring parameters  in  the subsequent site
monitoring program.
                                     660

-------
TABLE E.5  WASTE CONSTITUENTS TO BE COMPARED IN DETERMINING WASTE
           APPLICATION (ALC) AND RATE (RLC) LIMITING CONSTITUENT
                             Potential                     Potential
Constituent           ALC (kg/ha/application)            RLC (kg/ha/yr)

Organics                        x                          2.2 x 106

  o volatization                x
  o leaching                    x
  o degradation                                            2.2 x 106

Nitrogen                        x                          2.53 x 106

Inorganic acids,
  bases and salts

Halides                                                        x
                                     661

-------
                            APPENDIX E REFERENCES
Brown, K.  W.,  K. C.  Donnelly,  J.  C.  Thomas,  and L.  E.  Deuel.  1980.  Fac-
tors  influencing biodegradation of  an  API  separator  sludge  applied  to
soils.

Perrier, E. R. and A. C. Gibson.  1980.  Hydrologic  simulation on solid waste
disposal sites (HSSWDS). Prepared for the U.S. EPA toinicipal  Environmental
Research Laboratory. SW-868.

Schwendinger,  R.  B. 1968.  Reclamation of  soil contaminated  with oil.  J.
Inst. Petroleum 54 (535):182-197.
                                    662

-------
                                 APPENDIX F

                                  GLOSSARY
acute  toxicity:   An adverse effect which occurs shortly after exposure to a
     substance.

adsorption:   The attraction of ions or compounds to the surface of a solid.
     Soil  colloids adsorb large amounts of ions and water.

aerosols:  Microscopic droplets dispersed in the atmosphere.

ammonification:   The biochemical process whereby ammoniacal nitrogen is re-
     leased  from nitrogen-containing organic compounds.

anaerobic:    (i) The  absence  of  molecular  oxygen.    (11)  Growing  in the
     absence of  molecular  oxygen  (such  as  anaerobic  bacteria).    (iii)
     Occurring  in the absence  of  molecular oxygen (as  a biochemical proc-
     ess).

annual  crop:  A  crop which completes its entire  life  cycle  and dies within
     1  year  or less; i.e., corn, beans.

application  limiting  constituent  (ALC):   A compound,  element,  or waste
     fraction in a  hazardous waste which  restricts    the amount  of waste
     which can be  loaded onto soil per application (kg/ha/application).

aquifer:  Stratum below the surface capable of holding water.

available water:  The portion  of water in a soil  that can  be  readily ab-
     sorbed  by  plant roots.   Considered by most workers to  be  that water
     held in the soil against a pressure of up to approximately 15 bars.

base-pair  mutation:   Substitution mutation  in which  the  wrong  base  is
     inserted into  the DNA which then  pairs with its  natural partner during
     replication which  results in  a  new pair  of  incorrect  bases  in the
     DNA.

base-saturation  percentage:   The extent to which the  adsorption complex of
     a  soil  is saturated with exchangeable  cations  other than hydrogen.  It
     is expressed  as a  percentage of the total cation-exchange capacity.

biodegradatlon:    The breaking  down of  a chemical  compound  into  simpler
     chemical components under  naturally occurring  biological processes.

bulk density:  The mass  of dry soil per unit bulk  volume.   The bulk volume
     is determined before drying to constant  weight at 105°C.

calcareous soil:   Soil containing  sufficient  calcium  carbonate  (often with
     magnesium carbonate) to  effervesce visibly when  treated with cold 0.1N
     hydrochloric  acid.

                                     663

-------
 capacity limiting constituent  (CLC):   A compound,  element,  or waste frac-
      tion in a hazardous  waste which  restricts  the total  amount  of waste
      which can be loaded onto soil (kg/ha).

 carbon  cycle:  The  sequence of  transformations  whereby  carbon dioxide is
      fixed in  living  organisms  by  photosynthesis  or by  chemosynthesis,
      liberated by respiration  and by  the death  and  decomposition  of  the
      fixing organism,  used  by  heterotrophic  species, and  ultimately  re-
      turned to its original state.

 carbon-nitrogen ratio:  The  ratio  of the  weight  of organic  carbon  to  the
      weight of total  nitrogen  in  a  soil  or in organic  material.   It is
      obtained  by  dividing the percentage of  organic carbon  (C) by the per-
      centage  of total nitrogen  (N).

 carcinogen:    A  chemical,  physical,  or  biological  agent  which  induces
      formation of cells that are  no  longer  affected  by normal regulations
      of  growth;  such  formations  are  capable  of  spreading  cells  to other
      tissues  resulting  in  the  loss  of  the specific  function  of  such
      tissues.

 cation exchange:   The reversible  exchange  between  a cation  in solution and
      another  cation  adsorbed onto any surface-active material  such as clay
      or  organic matter.

 cation exchange  capacity:   The sum  total of  exchangeable  cations  that  a
      soil  can adsorb.   Sometimes  called  "total-cation capacity,"  "base—
      exchange  capacity,"  or "cation-adsorption  capacity."    Expressed  in
     milliequivalents  per  100 grams of  soil (or of  clay).

 chelating  properties:   The property of certain chemical compounds  in which
      a metalic  ion is  firmly combined with the compound by  means  of multi-
      ple  chemical bonds.

 chromosome  aberration:    Changes  in   the  number,  shape,  or  structure  of
      chromosomes.

 chronic  toxicity:  A prolonged health  effect which may not  become evident
     until  many years  after  exposure.

 clay:  (i)  Soil separate consisting  of  particles  <0.002  mm  in equivalent
     diameter,  (ii)  Soil  material containing  more  than  40 percent  clay,
     less  than  45 percent  sand  and  less  than  than 40 percent silt.

compost:   Organic  residues,  or  a mixture  of organic residues and soil, that
     have  been  piled,  moistened,  and allowed to  undergo  biological  decom-
     position.    Often called  "artifical manure" or  "snythetic manure" if
     produced primarily  from plant  residues.
                                     664

-------
 composite:   To  make up  a sample  of distinct  portions  so the  sample is
     representative of  the  total  material  being  sampled  rather  than any
     single  portion.

 denitrification:   The biochemical  reduction of nitrate  or  nitrite to  gas-
     eous nitrogen either as  molecular nitrogen or as an oxide nitrogen.

 diversion terrace:  A terrace to divert  runoff from the watershed above the
     land treatment area.

 DNA  repair:    Repair  of  genetic  material  by cellular  enzymes  which can
     excise  or recombine alterations  in  structure  of  DNA to restore origi-
     nal information.

 drain  tile:  Concrete or  ceramic pipe used to conduct water from the soil.

 effluent:  The liquid substance, predominately water,  containing inorganic
     and organic  molecules of those  substances which  do not precipitate by
     gravity.

 electrical  conductivity:   An  expression of  the  readiness with  which an
     electrical impulse  (generated  by ionic  activity) flows through a water
     or soil system.

 erosion:  (i)  The wearing away  of  the land  surface by running water, wind,
     ice, or other geological agents, including  such  processes  as gravita-
     tional creep,  (ii)   Detachment and  movement of soil or rock by water,
     wind ice, or  gravity.

 eutrophication:   The reduction of  dissolved  oxygen in surface waters which
     leads to  the  deterioration  of  the aesthetic  and life-supporting quali-
     ties.

 evapotranspiration:   The  combined  loss of water from a given area, and dur-
     ing a specified period  of  time,  by  evaporation from  the  soil surface
     and by transpiration from plants.

 exchange acidity:    The  titratable  hydrogen  and  aluminum  that  can  be re-
     placed from  the adsorption complex  by  a neutral salt  solution.   Usu-
     ally expressed  as milliequivalents per  100 grams of soil.

 fertility, soil:    The  status of   a  soil with  respect  to  the amount and
     availability  to  plants of elements necessary for plant growth.

 field  capacity (field moisture capacity): The amount of water remaining in
     the soil  after excess gravitational water has drained away  and after
     downward movement of water  has practically ceased (normally considered
     to be about  1/3 bar  soil moisture tension).

forage crop:   A crop such as  hay,  pasture  grass,  legumes, etc.,  which is
     grown primarily as forage or feed for livestock.
                                     665

-------
frameshift  mutation:   Mutation  resulting from  insertion or deletion  of a
     base-pair  from a triplet codon  in  the  DNA; the  insertion  or deletion
     produces a scrambling  of  the   DNA or a  point mutation.

gene mutation:   A  stable  change  in a single  gene.

genetic  toxicity:   An adverse event  resulting in damage  to  genetic mater-
     ial; damage may occur  in exposed individuals  or may be expressed  in
     subsequent generations.

groundwater:   Water  that fills all  of  the  unblocked  pores of  materials
     underlying the water table, which is the upper  limit of  saturation.

heavy metals:   Generally, those  elements in  the  periodic table  of elements
     which  belong  to the  transition  elements.   They  may  include  plant
     essential  micronutrients and  other nonessential  elements.   Examples
     are mercury,  chromium,  cadmium and  lead.

heterotrophic organism:   Requires  preformed,  organic  nutrients  as a source
     of  carbon  and  energy.

hydraulic  conductivity:    The  proportionality  factor  in Darcy's  law  as
     applied to the viscous  flow of water in  soil,  i.e.,  the flux of water
     per unit gradient of hydraulic potential.

hydrologic  cycle:   The  fate of water from the time of  precipitation until
     the water  has been  returned  to the  atmosphere by  evaporation  and  is
     again  ready to be precipitated.

infiltration  rate:   A  soil  characteristic   determining  or  describing  the
     maximum rate  at  which  water can enter  the  soil under specified condi-
     tions,  including the  presence  of   an  excess  of  water.   It  has  the
     dimensions  of Velocity  (i.e.,  cm3 cm~2  sec"1 -  cm sec"1).

land  treatment:   The controlled  application of  hazardous  wastes  onto  or
     into the aerobic surface soil horizon,  accompanied  by  continued moni-
     toring and  management,  to alter  the physical, chemical,  and biological
     state  of the  waste  to  render  it less  hazardous.   The  practice simul-
     taneously  constitutes  treatment  and final disposal.

leachate:   Soil solution moving  toward   the  groundwater  under  the  pull  of
     gravity.

lime requirement:  The mass  of agricultural  limestone, or the equivalent of
     other  specified  liming  material, required per  acre  to  a soil depth of
     15  cm  to  raise  the pH of  the  soil to  a  desired  value  under  field
     conditions.
                                     666

-------
 loading rate:   The  mass or volume of waste  applied  to  a unit area  of  land
      per unit time  (kg/ha/yr).

 lysimeter:  (i)  A  container  used  to  enclose a volume of soil and  its  con-
      tents and  associated  equipment  used to measure the  evaporative and/or
      drainage components of  the  hydrological balance,   (ii)  A  device  used
      to collect soil solution from the unsaturated zone.

 metabolic activation:   The use  of extracts  of  plant  or animal tissue  to
      provide enzymes which can convert a promutagen  into  an active  mutagen,
      or a procarcinogen into an  active carcinogen.

 metal toxicities:  Toxicities arising from too great a content of metals  in
      the soil.

 micelle:  A minute  silicate  clay colloidal  particle that generally  carries
      a negative charge.

 microorganism:  An organism so small  it  cannot  be seen clearly  without the
      use of  a microscope.

 moisture volume percentage:  The ratio of the volume of  water in a  soil  to
      the total bulk volume of the soil.

 moisture weight percentage:  The moisture content expressed  as a percentage
      of the  oven-dry weight of soil.

 mulch:   (1)   Any material  such  as straw,  sawdust,  leaves,  plastic film,
      loose soil, etc.,  that is spread upon the  surface  of the soil  to pro-
      tect  the  soil  and  plant  roots   from  the  effects  of  raindrops, soil
      crusting, freezing, evaporation,  etc.    (ii)   To  apply mulch  to the
      soil  surface.

 mutagenic:   Compounds with the ability to Induce  stable  changes in  genetic
      material  (genes and chromosomes).

 nitrification:   The  biochemical  oxidation of  ammonium to nitrate.

 permeability,  soil:    (i)   The   ease  with  which  gases,  liquids,  or plant
      roots penetrate or  pass  through  a  bulk mass  of  soil  or  a  layer of
      soil.   Since different  soil horizons vary in  permeability,  the par-
      ticular horizon under  question should be designated,   (ii)   The prop-
      erty  of  a  porous  medium itself  that  relates to  the ease  with which
      gases, liquids, or other  substances  can  pass  through it.

pH, soil:  The negative logarithm  of  the hydrogen-ion activity  of  a soil.
     The degree  of acidity  (or alkalinity) of a  soil  as determined by means
     of  a  glass, quinhydrone,  or  other suitable  electrode or indicator at a
     specified moisture content or  soil-water ratio,  and  expressed in terms
     of  the pH scale.
                                     667

-------
 primary degradation:   Conversion of waste  constitutes  into  a form which no
      longer  responds  in the same manner  to the analytical measurement used
      for detection.

 rate  limiting  constituent  (RLC):  A compound, element, or waste fraction in
      a  hazardous waste  which  restricts  the  amount of  waste which  can be
      loaded  onto soil  per  year (kg/ha/yr).

 respirometer:   An apparatus which can be used to measure microbial activity
      and monitor waste decomposition under  controlled  environmental condi-
      tions.

 retention basin:   A basin  or pond used to collect or store runoff water.

 runoff:   Any  rainwater,  leachate, or  other liquid  that drains  over  land
      from any  part of  a waste  treatment  or disposal facility.   That which
      is  lost without  entering  the  soil  is  called surface  runoff  and  that
      which enters the  soil before reaching  the stream is called groundwater
      runoff  or seepage flow from groundwater.    (In soil science, "runoff"
      usually refers to  the water lost  by  surface  flow;  in geology  and
      hydraulics,  "runoff"  usually  includes  both surface  and  subsurface
      flow.)

 run-on:   Any  rainwater,  leachate,  or other  liquid  that  drains  onto  any
      waste treatment area.

 sand:   (i)   A  soil particle between 0.05 and 2.0 mm in  diameter.   (ii)  Any
      one of  five  soil separates,  namely:  very  coarse  sand,  coarse sand,
      medium  sand,  fine  sand, and very fine  sand.

 silt:  A soil  separate  consisting of  particles  between 0.002 and 0.05 mm in
      equivalent  diameter.

 soil  horizon:   A layer of  soil  or  soil material  approximately parallel to
      the land  surface  and  differing from adjacent  genetically related  lay-
      ers  in  physical,  chemical,  and  biological properties  of characteris-
      tics  such as color,  structure,  texture, consistency, kinds,  and  num-
      bers of organisms  present,  degree  of acidity or alkalinity,  etc.

 soil  profile:  A vertical  section of the soil  from the  surface through all
      its  horizons, including C  horizons.

 soil  series:   The basic  unit of soil classification being a subdivision of
      a  family  and consisting of soils  which are essentially  alike  in all
     major profile characteristics  except the texture  of the A horizon.

 soil  solution:   The aqueous liquid phase of  the soil and  its solutes  con-
     sisting of  ions  dissociated  from the  surfaces  of  the  soil  particles
     and  of  other soluble  materials.

soil  texture:   The  relative proportion of  the  various  soil  separates  in a
     soil.   The  textural classes may be  modified by the  addition of suit-

                                     668

-------
      able  adjectives  when  coarse  fragments   are  present  in  substantial
      amounts;  for example, "stony silt loam,"  or  "silt  loam,  stony phase."

 sorption:  See  "adsorption."

 subsurface injection:   A method applying fertilizer  and  waste materials in
      a band below the  soil surface.

 suspended solids:   Solid  particles which  do not precipitate out of solution
      or do not  easily  filter  out.  They may be  colloidal  in nature.

 terrace:   (i)   A  raised,  more or less level or horizontal strip  of  earth
      usually constructed  on  or  nearly on  a contour  and supported on  the
      downslope  side by rocks  or  other similar  barrier to  prevent acceler-
      ated erosion,  (ii)   An  embankment with the uphill  side sloping toward
      and into a  channel  for conducting water,  and the downhill  side having
      a relatively sharp decline,  constructed  across  the direction of  the
      slope to conduct water  from the area above the  terrace at  a  regulated
      rate of flow  and to prevent  the accumulation of  large  volumes of  water
      on the downslope side.

 toxicity:   The  ability  of a  material to  produce  injury  or  disease upon
      exposure,   ingestion,  inhalation,   or  assimilation by  a  living  organ-
      ism.

 treatment zone:   the area  of  a land treatment  unit  that is located  wholly
      above the  saturated zone  and  within which  degradation,  transformation,
      or immobilization of hazardous  constituents occurs.

 uniform area:   Area of the active  portion of an HWLT  unit which  is composed
      of soils  of  the  same  soil  series  and to  which similar  waters  are
      applied  at similar application rates.

 unsaturated  flow:  The movement  of water  in a soil which is not  filled  to
      capacity with water.

 uptake:   The process  by  which  plants  take elements  from the  soil.    The
      uptake  of  a  certain  element  by a plant is  calculated by  multiplying
      the  dry weight by the concentration of the element.

 volatilizaton  - vaporization:   The  conversion  of a  liquid or  solid into
      vapors.

 waste:   Any  liquid, semiliquid,  sludge,  refuse,  solid,  or  residue  under
      consideration for  disposal.

 watershed:   The total  runoff  from a region  which  supplies the  water of a
      drainage channel.

water table:  The upper surface  of ground  water or that  level below which
      the  soil  is  saturated with water; locus  of points  in soil  water  at
     which the  hydraulic  pressure is  equal to atmospheric pressure.

                                      669

-------
                                APPENDIX G

                 USEFUL LAND TREATMENT CONVERSION FACTORS


  1. a. 1 cubic yard  (yd.3)  - 27 cu.  ft. (ft3)
    b. 1 gal. water  =  8.34  Ib.
  2. a. 1 acre-inch of  liquid - 27,150 gallons =  3,630 ft3 -
         102,800 liters = 0.01028 hectare-meters
    b. 1 hectare-cm  of liquid - 100,000 liters -  100 m3

  3. 1 metric ton =• 1,000 kg. - 2,205 Ib.

  4. cu. feet per second x 5.39 x mg./liter « Ib./day
  5. a. million gallons per  day x 8.34 x mg./liter - Ib./day
    b. (8.34 x 10~3) x mg./liter - lb./l,000 gal.

  6. 1 acre - 4,480 yards2 - 43,560 feet2 « 4,047 meters2 - 0.4047 hectare

  7. acre-inches x 0.266 x mg./liter  - Ib./acre
  8. ha.-cm. x 0.1 x  mg./liter - kg./hectare

  9. English-metric conversions
    a. acre-inch x 102.8 = meter3
    b. quart x 0.946 - liter
    c. English ton x 0.907  - metric  ton
    d. English tons/acre x  2.242 - metric tons/hectare
    e. Ib./acre x 1.121 - kg./hectare
    f. 1 Ib. - 0.454 kg.

10. a. Ibs. P x 2.3  -  Ibs. P205
       b. Ibs. K x 1.2 = Ibs. K20
11. Sludge conversions in English units
    a. wet tons sludge x % dry solids/100 - dry  tons sludge
    b. wet tons/.85  «  cubic yards sludge*
    c. wet tons sludge x 240 • gallons sludge*
    d. 1,700 Ib. wet sludge * 1 yd3  wet sludge*
12. Concentration conversions
    a. 10,000 ppm -  1%
    b. % x 20 - Ib./ton
    c. (ppm/500) or  (ppm x  .002) - Ib./ton

13. Wet weight conversions
    a. micrograms/milliliter ( g/ml) - milligrams/liter  (mg/1) ppm  (wet)
    b. ppm (wet) x 100/% solids - ppm (dry)

14. Rate Conversions
    a. 1 Ib/acre -1.12 kg/ha
    b. 1 ton/acre -  2.24 ton (metric)/hectare

                                          *j
* Assumes a sludge density of about  1 g/cm .
                                     670

-------
     CONVERSION FACTORS
U.S.  Customary to SI (Metric)
U.S. Customary Unit
Name
acre
acre-foot
cubic foot

cubic feet per second
degrees Fahrenheit
feet per second
foot (feet)
gallon(s)
gallons per acre per day
gallons per day
gallons per minute
horsepower
incb(es)
inches per hour
mile
miles per hour
million gallons
million gallons per acre
million gallons per day
parts per million
pound (s)
pounds per acre per day
pounds per square inch

square foot
square inch
square mile
ton (short)
tons per acre
Abbreviation
acre
acre-ft
ft3

ft3/s
•F
ft/3
ft
gal
gal/acre. d
gal/d
gal/min
hp
in.
in./h
mi
mi/h
Hgal
Mgal/acre
Kgal/d
ppm
Ib
Ib/acre .d
lb/in.2

ft2
in. 2
mi2
ton (short)
tons/acre
Multiplier
0.405
1.234
28.32
0.0283
28.32
0.555{»F-32)
0.305
0.305
3.785
9.353
4.381x10-5
0.0631
0.746
2.54
2.54
1.609
0.45
3.785
8.353
43.8
1.0
0.454
1.12
0.069
0.69
0.0929
6.452
2.590
0.907
2.24
Symbol
ha
m3
1
n,3
1/s
•C
m/s
m
1
1/ha .d
1/s
1/s
kw
cm
cra/h
km
m/s
Ml
m3/ha
1/s
mg/1
kg
kg/ha .d
kg/cm2
N/cra2
m2
cm2
km2
Mg (or t)
Mg/ha
SI
Name
hectare
cubic meter
liter
cubic meter
liters per second
degrees Celsius
meters per second
meter (s)
liter(s)
liters per hectare per day
liters per second
liters per second
kilowatt
centimeter (s)
centimeters per hour
kilometer
meters per second
megaliters (liter x 106)
cubic meters per hectare
liters per second
milligrams per liter
kilogram(s)
kilograms per hectare per day
kilograms per square centimeter
Newtons per square centimeter
square meter
square centimeter
square kilometer
megagram {metric ton)
meg ag rams per hectare

-------